Amateur Work, Illustrated. Vol 1 - 1883 London
Amateur Work, Illustrated. Vol 1 - 1883 London
Amateur Work, Illustrated. Vol 1 - 1883 London
&
1 I
aovrnxmENT RORun emoi
118026
*
i
s
UNITED STATES PATENT OFFICE
|
V
;;#*'
'.-
.-/
:.-
, . /
.
A USEFUL AND ORNAMENTAL HANGING WALL-CABINET.
For Description and Working Drawings to Scale,
See Page 24
4?\
-t
AMATEUR WORK,
ILLUSTRATED.
EDITED BY THE AUTHOR OF
"EVERY MAN HIS OWN MECHANIC."
\Aj
WITH LITHOGRAPHIC SUPPLEMENTS,
Containing
Resigns, kcichcs, nno forking gratoings,
AND
FIVE HUNDRED WOOD ENGRAVINGS IN THE TEXT.
Or.
/.
Iionbon
:
WARD, LOCK, & Co., WARWICK HOUSE, SALISBURY SQUARE, E.C.
igeto |9orft:
i0, bond street.
&0
\
-j
INDEX TO ILLUSTRATIONS.
Bar, horizontal, and frame, 502, 03
Barometer, cistern, 14S
Barometer, siphon, 143
Barometer, stationary cistern, 149
Bath for sensitising solution, 57
Battery, Leclanehe, the, 415
Bell, electric, chattering, with all parts to-
gether, 323
Bell, electric, parts of an, 322, 323
Bell, electric, plan of common form of, 322
Bell, electric, position of parts of, 367
Bell, electric, pushes for, 518
Bell, electric, switches for, 519
Bell, electric, wires and connections of, 450,
451
Bench, German carpenter's, 430
Bench, shoemaker's, 29
Bench, wood-carver's, 275
Bench-lathe, 65
Blowpipe for inflating skins of caterpillars,
165
Blowpipes, amateur's, 273
Boards, bevelling for junctions, 338
Boat, life, plan of, 326
Boat, life, rowlock for, 327
Boat, life, side of carriage for, 327
Boat, Norwegian fishing, 483
Boit, Norwegian, sections of, 486
Boat, outline of section in wire, 180
Boat, section of keel of a, 180
Boat, stem of a, 180
Eook, groove and rounded hack of, 3C3
Bookbinder's work-tub, 362
Bookbinding, specimens of old, 247
Bookcase, home-made, 459
Bookcases, metal fittings for, 286
Bookshelves, hanging, and drawer, 230
Bookshelves, hanging, details of, 231
Boot, hand-sewn, inner sole of a, 299
Boot, hand-sewn, with welt sewn in, 299
Eoot, lasting a, 85
Brace, American drill, 96
Bracket for modelling in clay, 60
Brackets, wall, for corners, 137
Brush, wire, scratch, 10
Brushes, scratch, 205
Burner, low temperature, 184
Burner, solid flame, 184
Bust, pot-lid in mould for, 390
Cabinet, hanging wall, details of, 25
Cabinet, skeleton wall, details of, 177
Camera, dark slide for a, 303
Camera, sliding body, 32
Camera, section of, 32
Canoe, cleat for a, 227
Canoe, mainmast and sail for a, 227
Canoe, mizenmast and sail for a, 227
Canoe, paddle for a, 227
Canoe, rib of a, 227
Canoe, rudder for a, 227
Canoe, sections of a, 226
Canoe, shape of stem in, 181
Canoe, stem, keel, and sections of on bench,
181
Casting in plaster, tools for, 387
Catch, simple, for box, 386
Chair, Elizabethan, in carved oak, 306
Chair, home made, 458
Chair, old-fashioned, to strengthen leg of,
350
Chest of drawers in miniature, 68
Chest of drawers, details of, 67, 69
Chisel-shaped tool, for modelling, 12
Cistern, rain-water, 35
Clamp, bench, Murphy's, 144
Clay, applying to figure drawn on slab, 61
Clay, badly applied, 60
Clay, brackets modelled in, 108, 109
Clay, building up ed^e with, 60
Clay, diagram showing how to avoid burr
on edge of, 107
Clay, making small roll of, 60
Clay, patterns for modelling in, 156, 157
Clay, properly applied, 63
Clcck, common Dutch or German, 153
Clock, hall, movements of a, 77
Clock, Henry de Wyck's, 76
Clock-making, tools for, 152
Clocks, escapements of, 403
Clothes, folding horse for, 375
Clothes, rack for, 375
Cork-borer, a, 133
Corner cupboard, handy, 145
Crucible for charcoal, 131
Crucible, iron, simple, for charcoal, 291
Crwths, ancient, 72, 73
Cupboard, handy corner, 145
Cyanide solution, method of pouring out, 172
Dark lantern, home-made, 418
Dark room, plans and sections of n, 120, 121
Dark slide, shutter for, 303
Dark tent, the, 121
Desk, home-made, standing, 350
*'
Diaper work for casting, 391
Dining room, sideboard for the, 49
Drawers, miniature chest of, 68
Drawers, details of, 67, 69
Drawings, working, appliances for produc-
ing, 8
Drill brace, American, 96
Echolin, Collins's, 506
Electric bell, see Bell, electric
Electro-plating, amateur's plant for, 97
Electro-plating, buffing wheel for, 262
Electro-plating, burnishers for, 263
Electro-plating, Daniell battery for, 80
Electro-plating, Walker battery for, 81
Fan-screen, method of putting together, 434
Fiddles, ancient patterns of, 72, 73
Filter, cask, 223
Filter, kitchen, 132
Filter, large compound, 133
Filter, ornamental, 133
Filter, photographic, stand for, 57
Filter, pocket, 222
Filter, tap, 222
Filter, tap, stirrup for, 222
Floors, designs for decorating, 243
,
Folder at work, 362
Foot, diagram of measurements of a, 29
Forge, charcoal, for brazing band-saws, 315
Fountain, self-acting pneumatic, 144
Fountain, self-acting, Rushton's, 383
Fret-sawing machine, simple, 37
Fret-sawing, machines for, 500
Furnace, draft muffle, 185
Furnace injector, 185
Furnace ladle, 185
Gas-fitting, minor fittings for, 293
Gas-fitting, sundries for, 411
Gas-fitting, taps for, 410
Gas-fitting, tongs for, 411
Gas-fitting, tools for, 196
Gas-fitting, unions and fittings for, 197
INDEX TO ILLUSTRATIONS.
Gas-tongs, illustration of using, 295
Giant Stride, elevation of, 370
Giant Stride, section of top of, 370
Gigue, ancient, 72
Greenhouse, .section of rafter for, 13
Grinding, tool holders for, 20, 21
Guards, insertion of, in biudn:g, :JG3
Gun, duck, arrangement for a, 479
Gymnasium, lawn, '102
Haemorrhage, methods of checking, 101
. Hail-clock, movement of a, 77
Hammer, binder's, 470
Handle, the drop, 308
Harmonium, bellows of, 339, 511
Harmonium, case of, 339
Harmonium, feeders for, 339
Harmonium, interior of, 339
Harmonium, sound-board for, 514
Hexagon, construction of a, 159
Hive, cheap bar-frame, sections of, 112, 113
Hive, details of, 113
Hoops, how to fix on tubs, 44
Horizontal Oar and frame, 502, 503
Horse, clothes-, new form of, 4-S2
Jar, deflagrating. 131
Joint-stool, old, 307
Keyboard, organ, details of, for making,
466, wi
Loat&Cty dark, home-made, 418
Lathe, an amateur's plain, 4
Lathe, ""bench, f5
Lathe, double-gear gnp-bed, 5
Latue, poppit-head of a, 423
Lathe, scratch- brush, 205
Lathe, screw-cutting, with overhead gear, 5
Lathe, single-speed
gap-bed, 5
Lathes, headstocks and mandrels of, 200, 201
Lawn gymnasium, the, 402
Light, electric, cells for, 355
Light, electric, lamp for, 354, 463
Light, electric, method of connecting 355
'463
;
Le'clanchd' battery, the, 415
Machine, circular and band-saw, combined,
314
Machine, simple fret-sawing, 37
Measure, spring tape, 169
Metals, use of hand-turning tools for, 251
Modelling, stand for, 12
Modelling, tools for, 12, 13
Modelling, turn-table for, 12
Nuta, manufacture of, for model engines
510, 511
Organ, Atiwigement of pipes, 2JO
Organ, bellows for a small, 5
J, 53
Organ, bel owp, details of, 53
, design for a small, L21
Organ, front elevation of a small, 176
Organ, pedals for a small, 220
Organ, pipes of a small, 16
Organ, scale for pipes of a small, 190
Organ, sound-board of an, 116, 117
Organs, springs for an, 117
Org;in, stop action in a small, 431
Organ, wind-chest of a small, 116
Panels, carved, for modelling, 216, 217
Perambulator, a home-made, 443
Perambulator, details of, 443
Percolator, Buck's patent, 447
Photography, the plate and its accessories,
419
Picture-frame vice, patent, 144
Pipes, sections of, 16, 2S7
Pipes, organ, shortened, 287
Pliers, clock-maker's, 152
Plough, and cutting-knife, the, 515
Plumb and level, 189
Polygons, a scale for, 334
Polygons, diagrams showing how to con-
struct, 235
Press, binder's, home-made, 515
Press, printing, the
"
Model," 3s2
Press, sewing, 470, 471
Rain-water, tanks for collecting and storing,
447
Refrigerator, home-made, 338
Room, dark, plans and sections of a, 120,
121
Saw, band, American foot-power, 316
Saw, band, forge for brazing, 315
Saw, band, hand or steam, 315
Saw, band, hand power, 213
Saw, band, hand-power attachment, 314
Saw, band, small foot-power, 3'5
Saw, circular, hand-power, 212
Saw, circular, fences for, 315
Saws, positions of file in sharpening, 501
Screw-driver, clock-maker's, 152
Screw-drivers, small, for watch-makers, 48
Sewing books, method of, 470
Sewing stand, home-made, 515
Shoemaker's bench, the, 29
Sideboard, a dining-room, 49
Sideboard made from two old chests, 351
Slide rest, compound, 64
Sole, diagram of a, 84
Stained glass, designs for, 55
Stand, portable photographic, 33
Stand, portable, folded up, 33
Stand, studio, 33
Starrett's combination try-square and level,
48
Strings, violin, tests for, 439
Summer-house, plan and elevation of, 270,
271
Sui-dial for wall, 22
Swing, garden, frame and boat of 266, 267
Swing, portable, 474
Swing, portable, stake to hold guys of, 475
Sycamore trunk, section of, 168
Table, eight-legged, 307
Table, Jacobean, in carved oak, 306
Table, simple home-made, 455, 453
Table, three-legged occasional, a, 128, 129
Table, to strengthen le* of, 350
Telephone, amateur's, in section, 342
Telephone, Bell's, 343
Telephones, bells for, 495
Telephones, cells for, 495
Telephones, stations for, 495
Tent, the dark, 121
Three-legged occasional table, a, 128, 129
Timepiece, Queen Anne, 497
Tin cans, new uses for old, 273
Bird houses, 278
Bread-grater, 278
Flower-stand, 279
Hanging flower-pot, 273
Hanging log for flowers, 278
Rockery, 279
Vase for plants, 279
Tool-case, an amateur's, 258
Tool-holder, wooden, 242
Tool-holders for grinding, 20, 21
Tools, modelling, 12, 13
Tools, properly and improperly sharpened,
359
Tools, useful roll for, 478
Tools, wood-carver's, 276, 277
Try-square, Starrett's combination, 48
Tub, hoops on a wooden, 44
Tub, how to hoop a, 192
"Vase, how to make model of, 390
Velocipedes, cranks and pedals of, 435
Vices, clock-makers', 152
Violin, diagrams of front and back of a,
101
Violin, diagram of interior of a, 169
Violin, Chanot, 507
Violin, Howell's, 507
Violin, nail, 507
Violins, accessories and fittings for, 395
Violins, ancient, 72, 73
Violins, bridges for, 254
Violins, cases for, 399
Violins, diagram for making, 208
Violins, diagrams of thickness for, 209
Violins, /-holes, of different, 105
Violins, iulaying and purfling, 255
Violins, neck and scroll of, 254
"Wall-brackets, corner, 137
Wall-cabinet, hanging, details of, 25
Washstand, Spanish, 458
"Wire, steel, nippers for, 286
"Wood-carving, bench for, 275
"Wood-carving, tools for, 276, 277
"Wood, some enigmas in, 40
a
ty
PRESENTED WITH PART I. OF
'isi wff&z, iiiasfMil
...
L'J.IMVL'J
^^rav BB^^^^^^
Ik
'
r
fcr When thin pieco is used u a Middlo
Partition, tbo portion between oiul above
the line* ST, TO, UV, VW, WX XT,
TZ, mint be out clem away, !..v.ir...
oolj the upright endi and the tenon in
i ],l middle
l 1
H> 1
Iw -M^
^
DESIGN FOR JAPANESE FRET-WORK CABINET FOR CHINA OR BRIC-A-BRAC.
AMATEUR WORK, ILLUSTRATED.
INTRODUCTORY.
T the completion of the First Volume of a new Magazine, for which may be claimed
the merit of being unique in itself and entirely novel in its aims and object, a few
words with respect to its rahon d'etre, and what has been accomplished during the
first year of its existence, may not be altogether out of place.
The present age is eminently practical, and the majority of those who live in it work with
a zeal and will that, speaking generally, were not to be found in the generation that has
almost passed away, or, where they did exist, expended their force in widely different
directions. To this sweeping assertion there are, as a matter of course, notable exceptions
;
but, as exceptions invariably do with regard to everything that is accepted and acknowledged
as a rule, these only serve to substantiate the truth of that which has been just advanced.
That the present age is practical, and perhaps practical to a degree that has never yet
been attained since the world was young, is to be attributed, on the part of some, to an
unhealthy craving for money as the means of acquiring luxuries of all kinds, and, on the part
of others, to a healthy desire to utilise their time to the utmost, and to help themselves by
doing many things for themselves, for which, to a great extent, they have hitherto been almost,
if not completely, dependent on others. Of these desires, the former degenerates into avarice
or self-indulgence
;
but the latter blossoms into habits of thrift and manly independence and
self-dependence.
To attempt to trace the present desire to engage in active practical work to its origin and
Term, would occupy too much space, and is, moreover, altogether foreign to the purpose now
in view. It is sufficient to point out that the truth is self-evident, and declares itself in the
relish with which men of intellect and education, whether richer or poorer, turn to carpentry,
gardening, and the various constructive and decorative arts instead of seeking relaxation in
pursuits for which the exercise of thought and manual dexterity is by no means necessary.
This desire for work and increased knowledgea marked characteristic of the present age,
as it has been remarkedwhatever its beginning, has been of long and very gradual growth.
It has given rise to Technical Education for the artisan, and a general wish to make education
for all and every state and condition of life as technical and practical as it is possible to render
it. The pioneers of Technical Education were busy in many a little town in England long
before the leaven began to work in any way in the Metropolis, and the Press brought its
|
energies to bear on advancing it, and City Guilds became its foster-fathers. The writer was
I one of these pioneers, for he was working in this direction full seven-and-twenty years ago in
a distant corner of the kingdom, impressing on a class of carpenters, joiners, coach-builders,
wheelwrights, and smiths that he had gathered together, that, if they would attain excellence
in their respective callings, it was absolutely essential for them to acquire a knowledge of
drawing, and be able, so to speak, to put their work on paper. A few years later, he was
endeavouring to show that book-work in all schools should be mingled with and relieved by
practical teaching in the most ordinary handicraft trades. The proposal was received coldly
and with a smile that implied pity for the proposer's weakness of mind and credulity. The
INTRODUCTOR Y.
fact, however, that the means of gaining a knowledge of carpentry are afforded in many large
schools at the present time, and the desire of so many to engage in handicraft work, have
combined to show that he was right
;
and this has been substantially confirmed by the favour
with which
"
Every Man His Own Mechanic" has been received, which, in its turn, coupled
with expressions 9f desire for such a serial from many a different quarter, led to the production
of Amateur Work, Illustrated.
On all sides a wish for progress is evinced by able men, and the old Latin proverb,
"
Bos optat ephippia" may in very truth be applied to the greater number of those who work
with hand or brain ;
for the mechanic seeks to acquire the theoretical knowledge of the
brain-worker, while the latter longs to be possessed of the manual skill of the artisan. The
apprentice, who has everything to learn in his trade, and the skilled workman, who has learnt
everything as far as the modus operandi and rule of thumb are concerned, desire a knowledge
of theory and the why and wherefore : the one to gain a shorter cut to excellence, and the
other to assist his skill by technical knowledge, and thus to increase his earnings. On the
other hand, the clerk, the curate, and the struggling professional man and man of letters,
who in many cases are well up in theory, and know why this, that, and the other are, and
should be done in ordinary trades, and who can even offer suggestions worth having to
mechanics, when at work, finding themselves, of late years, falling to the rear, as far as position,
political status, and worldly progress are concerned, are beginning to try to help themselves,
and to this end are seeking practical instruction in what may be not inaptly expressed as the
how, and when, and in what way to do it. For the former much has been done in the shape
of technical works and trade journals
;
for the latter, however, as yet but next to nothing has
been attempted. They can gather but little that they want from the books and papers
written and got up for workmen, because in all these a knowledge of the practical part of the
subject is presupposed, and the A B C of elementary work is consequently ignored. That
practical instruction is a popular want of the times with amateurs of the middle classes, and
that there are no existing books or serials that will satisfy their wants to the full, there is
more than sufficient evidence to show in the letters that have reached the Editor and
Publishers since the First Part of this Magazine was issued. It was, indeed, to fill up this
manifest hiatus in the literature of self-help that AMATEUR WORK, ILLUSTRATED, was
commenced, and in this is to be found its raison d'etre.
The contents of this Volume may be taken as being fairly typical and representative of
the subjects that will be brought under the consideration of the reader, in Amateur WORK,
ILLUSTRATED : to those, however, who seek to inquire more fully into the scope and purpose
of the Magazine, it may be said that in its pages from year to year it will be sought to treat
on all subjects that are embraced in the ever-widening Circle of the Industrial Arts that are
of interest to, and can be accomplished by, the Amateur. It will be sought in future Volumes,
as in this, to guide everyone who is willing and wishful to work, to everything that he may do,
and can do, in all things connected with the House and its Surroundings, whose execution
and performance demand constructive skill and manual labour, and to show him, by means of
description and illustration, verbal and pictorial, simply but clearly, briefly but comprehen-
sively, technically but intelligibly, so that none can possibly fail to understand
giving
hints as to the proper tools to be used, the
methods to be employed, and other details
Most of these, however, have been of an
exceedingly
elementary
character,
and best
suited to the
wants of
those who,
knowing
nothing of
wood - work-
of the carpenters' and joiners'
With these elementary
-MODELLING STAND,
ing and the use
tools, wish to learn to carve
steps the carpenter and the amateur artisan who has
made some progress in the handicraft that he has
adopted, are already familiar. They understand the
management of wood and the care of their tools, and
there are, perhaps, only a few hints in regard to the
special tools used in carving which will be of any ser-
vice to them.
Like a great many carpenters and amateurs, the
writer has carefully read the articles published on this
subject, as well as many of the books which have been
written in regard to it, hoping to find such instruction
as would enable him to take a design, put it upon a
panel or piece of
wood, and then
produce a carv-
ing which should
be useful for the
ornamentation
of some article
of furniture.
There was an abundance of tools at hand, and
there was no lack of skill in their handling, and,
as in most carpenters' shops, stones and hones
were at hand for keeping them in order. When,
however, the pattern was outlined upon the wood
and the real work of carving began, he awoke to
the fact that the directions stopped short at the most
important point. Like him, too, the carpenter will be
*
From a Series of Articles in Carpentry and Building. By
W. E. Partridge. With Alterations and Additions.
" ii
' j '
IT
.'..am
-TURN-TABLE FOR
STAND.
FIG. 3.CHISEL-SHAPED TOOL, WITH BENT POINT.
surprised to find that after all his experience, he does
not know how to
"
think in solid wood." And if the
skilled artisan be altogether at sea in this most neces-
sary part of the ornamental wood-working that he
aspires to carry out, how much more will the amateur
find himself at fault, and if it be desirable that ths
professional carpenter
should learn to
"
think in
solid wood," to repeat the
form of words of which
use has just been made
before he puts his tools
to the wood, how much
more necessary must it
be for the unskilled ama-
teur to seek to become
acquainted with what may
be fairly called the firt
steps to this pleasing and attractive decorative art ?
When we have houses and other structures to
build, we find ready at hand plans, drawings, eleva-
tions, and working drawings in detail, together with
elaborate descriptions. By means of these the car-
penter is taught to think in panels, mouldings, and
skirtings. With the framing plan before him, it is
easy to think in timber and beams. When the eleva-
tion is given, it is easy to think in walls and windows,
doors, foundations, and roofs, and, in the mind's eye,
to bring up an exact image of what the finished
structure will be. But when a plain block of wood is
laid upon the bench with a pattern drawn upon its
face, the carpenter soon realizes, as he begins to cut
away the surface, to obtain relief, that the directions
that he has met with in books have given him no clue
which will enable him to think in wood. He has no
guide as to the relative elevations and curves of the
different parts and surfaces. He has to feel for the
effect which will
make the pat-
tern look best,
and he often
finds that he has
made a leaf hol-
low which would
look far better
convex. His only recourse is to take another block
and try again. In this way much hard work must be
wasted, and in the end it will be found that the result .
has not been altogether what could be expected from
an equal amount of labour intelligently applied under
a competent instructor.
The object of the present series of papers is to give
in detail a description of the methods by which the
process of
"
thinking in wood
"
may be begun, or, to
put it in other words, the process of
"
thinking in
MODELLING IN CLAY.
FIG. 4.DOUBLE BENT SrATULA, OR SPOON-SHAPED TOOL.
relief,'' or
" in the solid." The shortest and most
practical way to arrive at this result is by modelling in
clay. Modelling is, perhaps, the only means by which
the learner can attain a knowledge of carving without
the experience of a teacher. It enables him to try
experiments in relief, to build up and take down, to
spread out or
bring together
the parts of his
pattern, until he
obtains the best
effect.
A little prac-
tice with plastic
materials soon
enables himto get aknowledge ofsurfaces in relief. When
this is once attained, the task of
"
thinking in wood
"
is practically accomplished. Knowing this fact, many
persons have bought works devoted to the subject of
modelling, hoping to find instructions which would
enable them to
go on without
a teacher. After
reading the few-
vague directions
contained in
these works they
have eenerallv
FIG- 5-sword blade and pointed spoon combined
been disheartened, finding the practical part of the
subject dismissed with the remark, that a few minutes'
instruction from a teacher, or ten minutes spent in
watching a person at work in clay, is worth more than
all the instructions that could be given in a book.
This is only too
true, yet it was
the object of the
books to teach,
and not to refer
to teachers.
It is possible,
however, by
means of direc-
tions and en-
gravings, to
teach the ele-
mentary steps in
the art ; and it
parts of Devonshire and Cornwallit is, in fact, the
clay that is used in making earthenware. Before it is
used the clay must be carefully refined and cleansed to
free it from grit ; indeed, it is a sine qua non that all
clay used in modelling should be thoroughly clean.
It may be procured ready for use at any of the
Lambeth pot-
teries, notably
at Doulton's.
Its price is from
four shillings to
five shillings per
hundredweight,
and the amateur
will not find it
serve his purpose to buy less than a quarter of a
hundredweight, even for work on a small scale, as clay
is very heavy, its specific gravity being great, and its
bulk, so to speak, is not in proportion to its weight.
Modelling clay is apt to crack in drying, and on
this account it
should be kept
moist by sprink-
ling water over
it occasionally,
and a piece of
work in progress
should be kept
carefully covered with a damp
cloth. The best
repository for clay is a wooden box, lined with lead,
tin, or zinc, but even when kept in such a receptacle
as this, the clay must be damped
occasionally. It
is possible that pipe-clay might be used for making
models of
smaller size, but
the same routine
must be ob-
served in the
use of this ; that
is to say, it
must be kept
in a plastic con-
dition by damp-
ing it occasion-
a 1 1 y. With
regard to the
use of pipe-clay,
is also possible to give the practical man such i this is only put forth as a suggestion
; it is worth
the trial, and amateurs who may make the essay are
requested to furnish the result of their experiments.
Pipe-clay can be purchased in small quantities, and
at a low rate, of any oil and colourman.
The tools and appliances necessary for working in
clay are not numerous, and any one, whether pro-
fessional carpenter or amateur, who wishes to take up
FIG. 6.- OBLIQUE CHISEL EDGE AND GEEATLY CUKVED SI OON LOU'L.
FIG. 7.TOOTHED SWORD BLADE AND BENT POINT.
directions as will enable him to use the clay as a con-
venient means for trying experiments, and determining
in advance the effect which his work will have when
finished in wood.
The necessary outfit is simple and inexpensive.
The clay that is used is the ordinary blue clay, found
in the valley of the Medway, in Dorsetshire, and in
'4
MODELLING IN CLA Y.
the art, need have no expense beyond that of getting
the clay. Every necessary article can be made or
extemporised by any one who has sufficient ability to
use the carpenters' tools, and to do a little simple
carpentry. The modelling-stand shown in Fig. I is
made of deal, and can soon be cut out and put together
in any odd time. Its size must depend in a great
measure upon the size of the work to be done. It will
be large enough if the top or sloping board opposite
the operator be about 24 inches in length by 18 inches
in breadth. To prevent warping, the ends should be
clamped, and a good coat of paint or a couple of coats
of shell-lac varnish should be laid over it. If a school
slate of a large size be at hand, it may be laid upon
the stand, and the model laid upon it. Slate is one
of the best of all foundations for a clay model.
It will be found of great convenience if a kind of
turn-table like that shown in Fig. 2 is made to hold
the slate. This is simply a disc of wood, with a pin at
the back, as shown at a, which fits into a hole bored
in the stand, shown at Fig. 1. A couple of holes are
bored in opposite sides of the frame of the slate,
through which two pins are thrust, entering holes
made for their reception in the disc, and holding the
slate firmly fixed to the disc. This board or disc may
be made square or oblong in form, and of the shape of
the slate, if it be preferred ; but in this case the hole in
the stand must be placed high enough up to allow the
corners to clear the projecting ledge at the bottom.
If a little extra expense can be afforded, the disc of
deal may be covered with sheet lead, turned over and
tacked down round the edge, or a piece of sheet zinc
can be cut out to fit the board. Lines of tinned tacks
can be run across the face of the disc, when thus covered
with metal, in order to keep the surface of the metal
flat. A table of this kind permits the work to be
turned round at the pleasure of the operator, so as to
bring it into different lights, and enable the hand to
get at all parts of the design.
The tools are very simple, and can be made from
boxwood, logwood, beech, pearwood, or any other
hard, close-grained wood of similar character. All of
them can be obtained from Buck, of Holborn Viaduct,
and possibly of all dealers in edge-tools, and also of
some oil and colourmen. They are to be had in two
sizes, six and nine inches long, the smaller size costing
about sixpence and the larger ninepence each. As
the work progresses, necessity will suggest many useful
forms of tools to the operator. These can be fashioned
out of a piece of hard wood, and finished with a file
and sand-paper, and will be found to answer just as
well as the most expensive.
Modellers' tools are also made of ivory and bone,
but these are of course more expensive, and of no
greater use than the wooden ones. Metal tools may be
purchased for cutting and digging out the clay from
the lump.
Of each tool which it is desirable to have in the
beginning, two views have been given, as the reader
will see on looking at Figs.
3 to 7. These are so
simple that he will find no difficulty whatever in making
them. In all the figures, excepting Fig.
7,
of which
only one view has been supplied, the sketches termi-
minating in long points show the tool when regarded
in elevation, or when looking directly at its side, while
the other sketches, terminating in obtuse points, and
in the case of Fig. 6, in a square end cut obliquely,
show the tool when looked on in plan, as when laid on
the table with the eye directed downwards upon it.
For small work, six inches is long enough for any and
all of these tools, but for designs of any considerable
size, larger tools are needed. Fig. 3 shows a tool,
chisel-shaped at one end, having at the other end a
point which is somewhat bent. Fig.
4 shows a tool
bent at both the ends, which in shape are something
like the bowl of a spoon. Fig.
5 shows a tool which
has the end to the left thin and sword-shaped, while
that to the right is bent, and terminates in a somewhat
pointed, spoon-shaped form. That shown in Fig. 6
has an oblique, chisel-shaped edge at one end, while
the other is well rounded. Fig.
7 shows a tool having
a sword-like blade at one end cut into teeth. It is a
useful tool for cutting away portions of the clay, and
for digging out pieces of the material.
These ends are not always associated one with
another in the manner represented in the illustrations.
It is not unusual to find the sword-like blade of Fig.
5
combined with a point like that in Fig
3,
or with a
knob, as in Fig. 6. The way in which the ends are
combined makes no difference whatever, except in the
convenience of working. If there are practically two
tools in the hand at one time, it is only necessary to
turn the stick end for end to make either of them
available.
In making the tools saw the strips of wood roughly
into shape, and then work them down with a rasp.
Finish with fine sand-paper, and then polish the sur-
face as perfectly as possible.
The crooks in the tools are very valuable, and it is
the opinion of those who are most familiar with their
use, that the crooked tool is the most serviceable, other
things being equal. It is difficult in purchasing at
shops at which these articles are sold, to get tools
with much bend in them ; hence the workman who
makes his own will have certain advantages over the
one who buys. All the earlier pieces of work under-
taken by the learner will suggest special tools with
which to work in difficult places. The time occupied
in making and using these tools will be well spent, and
though as more experience is gained they will be dis-
HOW TO BUILD A SMALL ORGAN.
IS
carded to some extent, yet they will have assisted in
teaching valuable lessons.
The next paper on this subject will be devoted to
the materials used and directions for taking the first
steps in making a clay model, which is to form the
subject of a carving. In the meantime, the amateur
will find abundant occupation in making the tools and
appliances described above.
(To be continued?)
HOW TO BUILD A SMALL ORGAN.
-General Principles of Construction. Materials
for the Pipes.Method of Making- the Stopped
Tenor C Pipe.
F the manufacture of an article, ornamental
or otherwise, that can be seen only, affords
considerable pleasure to the maker, how
much greater must be the gratification
and self-satisfaction enjoyed by the ama-
teur, who, after long hours of anxious care and labou^
has produced an instrument that can be heard as well as
seen, and therefore appeals to two out of the five senses
instead of but one.
Construction, or in other words, the making of the
various component parts of any article, bit by bit, and
putting them together, may be taken to be the siimmum
bonum of most amateurs. The accomplishment of the
object now in view, inasmuch as it involves plenty of
making as far as the separate parts are concerned, and
plenty of careful putting together, affords an excellent
exercise of ingenuity and patience to any who may be
enamoured of mechanical work, so without taking up
their time and occupying valuable space with prelimi-
nary remarks on the history and progress of organ-
building, which they may gather for themselves from
any good encyclopaedia, such as
"
Beeton's Illustrated
Encyclopaedia of Universal Information," I will at
once enter upon my subject and proceed to sketch out
for their information the processes necessary in making
a small organ.
By a
"
small organ
'"'
I do not mean such an instru-
ment as would be placed in a church or school-room
;
I mean such a miniature organ as will discourse sweet,
quiet music in a drawing-room or library, and which
may serve as a pleasing accompaniment to the voice of
a singer. If some little contempt should be expressed
for so tiny an instrument, as a mere
"
kist o' whistles,"
let it be remembered that I write not so much for more
fortunate amateurs who have gained experience in
carpentry, and are possessed of the means to supply
themselves with what they will, but for young carpen-
ters with slender purses, and that I desire to avoid
taxing severely either the ability of the first or the
capacity of the second.
I shall assume that the would-be organ-builder has
access to a convenient workshop, with a bench and
tools ; and that he is handy with the plane. But I
shall not assume more than this ; I shall not even take
it for granted that he is musical. James Watt built a
very remarkable organ, though he was destitute of
musical talent. Above all, I shall not assume that he
has the command of considerable sums of money
;
and in all my directions I shall keep economy strictly
in view.
First, then, let us clearly see our task before us.
The simplest organ consists of a wide, shallow box,
called a wind-chest, with a top called a sound-board,
divided internally into compartments called grooves or
channels, and filled with air by a pair of bellows. The
wind-chest is supported horizontally above the bellows
by corner-posts and cross-rails making up the "building-
frame." On the top of the sound-board the pipes are
planted ; and each pipe is made to speak or sound at
pleasure (when the bellows are blown) by opening a
valve in the wind-chest connected with a key or note
in the finger-board. So that if there are fifty keys or
notes in the finger-board, then there will be .fifty pipes
(at fewest) in the organ; and as every pipe must have'
its channel and its valve, there will be fifty channels
and valves in the sound-board and wind-chest. But I
shall show that the fifty channels and valves may supply
ten times fifty pipes, if an organ with numerous pipes
be desired.
I propose that the amateur organ-builder shall
commence operations by making the pipes. I do this
because the first outlay for the requisite wood need not
be great, and because he will be much encouraged at
the outset of his undertaking if he find himself suc-
cessful with the essentially musical part of it. Our
pipes will be partly of the kind called "Stopped
Diapason," and partly of the kind called "Clarabella."
The whole of them will be made of half-inch pine
boards, which should be very dry and clean, i.e., free
from knots ; and we shall require a few lengths of
harder wood, such as mahogany or oak, in scantlings
of about two inches square and a few feet long, or in
short pieces. The odds and ends of a cabinet-maker's
shop often serve useful purposes in pipe-making.
Let us begin by making the stopped pipe called
Tenor C (Fig. i) ; it will serve as a sample of all the
other stopped pipes, whether larger or smaller. Take
a piece of the scantling, say 2 inches square, and 2 or
3
feet long. Dress down one side with the jack-plane
until the piece is if inches wide by 2 inches deep
;
smooth the whole piece nicely with the "jointer," taking
i6 HOW TO BUILD A SMALL ORGAN.
care to keep the angles perfectly square. Cut off a
piece
3
inches long for the "block" (Fig. 2, b) of the
pipe, and another
4
inches long for the "stopper" (a).
Across the narrower side of the block, and three-
quarters of an incl. from one end, make a deep saw-
cut ; about half an inch from this saw-cut make
another, and take out the intervening wood with a chisel.
The gap thus made, called the
"
throat " (c), should be
1 2 inch in depth. Now prepare the two sides of the pipe,
cut the boards somewhat more than 2 inches wide, and
about 2 feet 4
inches long ; dress them nicely, and glue
them to the two wider sides of the block ;
take care
that the joint is good, and allow the whole to dry.
When it is so, dress the edges of these boards with
the jointer so that the glued-in block shall be perfectly
level with them. Then prepare the back
and front boards, observing that while the
back board must be of the full length of
the pipe, the front board mayjust overlap
the inner edge of the block. Smear over
with thin glue the whole interior surface
of all the four boards ; then apply the
back and front boards, and bind them
round with strong twine, using all your
strength to draw it tight, and winding the
string round a little roller of wood to avoid
cutting your hands. Allow the whole to
dry for a night at least. If, on removing
the twine, and dressing the pipe over with
a fine plane, the joints are perfectly close
and good, the maker may hope for a pure
tone from the pipe.
To enable it to give a tone at all, how-
ever, it must now be
"
voiced." With a
pocket-knife (which is much used in
organ-building) and a sharp chisel form the
sloping or chamfer in the front board
shown at f in the cut (Figs. 2 and
3).
Then, guiding your knife by means
of a square, cut across the chamfered part to form
the mouth of the pipe. This mouth, in a stopped
pipe, is, in height, commonly about one-third of the
width of the pipe internally ; in the present pipe it will
therefore be somewhat more than half an inch in
height. With the chisel bring the chamfer of the
mouth to a neat but not sharp edge. Prepare the
"
cap " (see d, Figs. 2 and
3)
by taking a piece of
mahogany, or other hard wood of the requisite size,
and cutting a hollow in it with a chisel, deep at G, and
diminishing to nothing at H.
When fitted to the pipe the upper edge of the block
must just show (say the sixteenth of an inch) above
the upper edge of the cap. Between the block and
cap a
"
wind-way
"
is made by carefully filing the cap at
H before it is fixed on. This wind-way should present
fig. 1. STOP
I'KD PIPE,
COMPLETE.
a cleft not much wider than the thickness of a common
playing-card. Fix the cap on by two sprigs or screws
(not more), running into the edges of the side boards.
Next take the piece of wood,
4 inches long, which
was reserved for the stopper.
Fashion it into a convenient
shape, as in the cut ; cover its
lower part with soft white leather
(the thinner the better, if the
stopper fits well), and insert it
carefully in the top of the pipe,
using a little soap, or tallow, or
black-lead, to facilitate its slid-
ing easily but closely within it.
All that now remains is to
bore a hole with the brace-and-
bit in the bottom of the block, and
insert the foot (e). If the ama-
teur has no lathe he may plane
the foot up, and make it as round
as he can
;
it should be
5 or 6
inches long, and the hole through
the middle may be bored with a
large gimlet, or the brace-and-
bit. If the wood be turned con-
tinually as the hole is bored, it
will probably be central. Burn
the hole afterwards with a red-
hot iron.
Now, on blowing through the foot, the labours of
the amateur will be rewarded by a good musical note.
Of the quality of the note, and how to modify its
power and vary its tone, I shall treat hereafter.
Enough, at present, if it is seen that the note is pro-
duced by the edge of the lip ( F)
cutting or
dividing the sheet of wind thrown against
it from the cleft between the block and
cap ; and, therefore, that a nice adaptation
of these several parts is essential to suc-
cess. (See Fig.
3.) Some builders file
little nicks in the front of the block, and
sometimes in the edge of the cap, to
facilitate the passage of the sheet of wind
against the lip or edge of the mouth
;
others omit these nicks. The stopper
enables us to shorten our pipes ; thus, an
open pipe producing the note Tenor C~
must be 4 feet in length, while our stopped
.
'
rr
fig. 3. SliC-
Tenor C is but 2 feet or thereabout. Into tion of
the acoustical reasons of this I can-
stopped pipe
not now enter. But if the pipe gives a husky, bad
note, examine the stopper, and see that in inserting it
you have not opened one of the seams. An aperture
no larger than a pin-hole will spoil the tone of a pipe.
Hence the internal sizing with glue.
fig. 2.detail of
stopped pipe.
A, Stopper ; B, Block
;
c, Throat ; d, Cap
;
E, Foot ; F, Lip.
A
JAPANESE
CABINET FOR CHINA AND BRIC-A-BRAC. i7
Of course this one pipe is an experiment. In my
next paper I will proceed to show how time and
material may be economised in making the whole set
of pipes, with their varying sizes and lengths. After
that I shall direct the maker's attention to the bellows
and building-frame, proceeding thence to the important
wind-chest.
Before I conclude, however, a few words of advice
re necessary, and I cannot impress too strongly upon
the amateur the necessity of paying strict attention to
what I am about to say, as it will greatly facilitate his
labours. The dimensions of the pipe that we have
been considering have been given in every particular,
and the shape of the pipe and the relations of its
various parts have been set forth in the figures with
which this article is illustrated. From these let the
amateur construct working drawings to scale. It will
help him to master the construction of the pipe before
he applies a single tool to the wood of which it is to
be made ;
but, by effecting this, will abridge the time
taken in making the pipe by about one half.
{To be continued.)
A JAPANESE CABINET FOR CHINA AND
BRIC-A-BRAC.
{For Illustrations, see the Supplement to this Part.)
RET-CUTTING is a work that is both
pleasing in itself and useful in its out-
come, and for this reason it commends
itself to many amateurs who take up
wood-working as a congenial pursuit and
employment Among the various objects that the pro-
jectors of Amateur Work, Illustrated, have in
view, one of the most important, and one, possibly,
which will find much favour with its readers, is the
production of clear and accurate working drawings of
different things that the amateur artisan may construct
or use for the purpose of decoration, on such a scale,
that he may have no difficulty in working direct from
the pattern itself in the size given, or in enlarging it to
such dimensions as may suit his requirements, always
preserving the relative proportions*
With reference to the special piece of work now
under consideration, it will be useful to many to review
its separate parts in detail, with reference to their pre-
paration ;
then to dwell briefly on the method to be
followed in putting the various parts together ; and,
*
For hints and instructions on this kind of work, the reader
Is referred to the article on "Working Drawings : How to Pre-
pare and Produce them," in page 7.
lastly, to make some remarks on various accessories
and modes of finishing the cabinet, which will greatly
improve its appearance, and tend to render it a more
elegant article of ornamental furniture.
"
There is a great deal of work in a thing of this
kind," many an amateur will doubtless say, when he
has our Supplement spread out before him,
"
and it
will take a fellow a precious long time to get through
with it all." It will, indeed ; but he must remember
that the value of all work, and especially of work of
this nature, may be taken to increase in geometrical
proportion to the time and labour that is bestowed on
it
;
and with this consolatory reflection let him take
courage, and go to work with a will.
First of all, every separate and individual part
necessary for the construction of the cabinet, as shown
in Fig. 13, will be found in the Supplement, drawn
accurately to scale ; and it may be said at once, with
regard to Figs. 12 and 14,
that in these it is shown
how, by an additional number of some of the pieces
represented, other cabinets of greater capacity and
somewhat different form may be contrived. Thus, in
Fig. 12, in the solid part of which, to the.right hand
it is shown how the different parts of the cabinet are
to be put together, and their mutual relation to one
another ; the addition of the dotted lines to the left
hand indicate how the amateur may add another wing,
so to speak, in this direction, similar to that to the
right of the compartment, which, in this form of the
cabinet, becomes the central compartment. In Fig.
14, on the other hand, it is shown how a compartment
similar to that on the left hand in Fig. 13 may be
added to the right, thus exhibiting another form of the
cabinet, also consisting of three compartments, but
having the larger compartment in the centre, and the
smaller compartments one on either side. These
alternative forms have been represented, in order to
make the fretwork designs given more generally
useful.
A scale of inches has been given with the designs,
to enable every one who is desirous of using them to
ascertain their dimensions with as little trouble as
possible, and it will be found, on measurement, that
the simple cabinet, as shown in Fig.
13, when made
according to the actual dimensions of the parts as
drawn, will be
9!
inches in height by 8 inches in width,
and 3
inches in depth. As to the material, the amateur
may use white holly, which may be afterwards
ebonised, or walnut wood, or any of the woods ordi-
narily used in fret-cutting that may suit his fancy; but
he must remember that if he makes the cabinet of the
size shown by the working drawings in our Supple-
ment, regarding it as a mere toy, or as a cabinet for
jewellery and small articles of this kind, the thickness
of the material used must not be more than an eight>
i8 A JAPANESE CABINET FOR CHINA AND BRIC-A-BRAC.
of an inch in thickness. If, however, he determines
to enlarge the working drawings given, and make the
cabinet one and a half times the size indicated
namely, I4
1
TI
inches X 12 inches X 45
inches he
should use stuff three-sixteenths of an inch in thick-
ness
; if twice the sizenamely, 195 inches X 16 inches
X 6 incheshe should use wood a quarter of an inch
in thickness, and so on in proportion to the increase of
the dimensions of the working drawings supplied.
"Nothing further need be said on this point, but we may
at once proceed to notice the various parts that are
required, and their construction, taking, of course, the
simple form of the cabinet as shown in Fig. 13, inas-
much as if the amateur can manage to make this, he
will have no difficulty in determining what parts are
required in duplicate for producing the alternative
forms shown in Figs. 12 and 14.
First let us take Fig. I (a), the
"
upright," which
forms the left end of the simple cabinet as in Fig. 13.
Of this upright two will be required, one complete,
precisely as shown in the working drawing, with all
the ornamentation at the top, which will be found to
form part of a ledge surrounding the whole extent of
the top shelf. In theuprght, which is placed between
'the two ends, dividing the cabinet into two unequal
parts, only the ends or horns outside the lines S T and
Z V, will be required, and the outline of the top will
take the form indicated when the part enclosed by the
lines ST, TU, U v, vw, wx, xy and yz, is removed. The
fret sawyer is now aware of the difference of form that
exists between the upright to the left and the upright
in the centre, and will prepare his work accordingly.
When the cabinet is made in accordance with the form
exhibited in Fig. 12, the ornamentation within the lines
already mentioned must be omitted in both uprights.
If the amateur desire to make the cabinet of the size
shown in the drawings given, he may paste down each
part on the wood before commencing the work of
sawing, but if he desires to make it on a larger scale,
he must prepare his working drawings to paste down,
or draw the pattern on the wood.
These two uprights completed to his satisfaction,
the amateur will proceed to prepare and cut out the
upright that forms the end to the right of the cabinet,
as shown in Fig. 13. This is as elaborate a piece of
work as the other end and central upright, and will
require care and patience in executing it. Its chief
difficulty lies in its consisting entirely of right lines, to
cut which greater nicety of manipulation is required
than for curved lines. The pattern for this upright is
given in Fig. 2 (b).
Having got through this part of the work, the ama-
teur will naturally turn his attention to the top shelf,
which should be made in one piece, as shown in Fig.
3
(c). This piece is cut with two tenons at either end,
which fit into the mortises shown at Tand Y in Fig. 1
(a), and into the corresponding mortises shown at the
top in Fig. 2 (e) ; the mortise in the centre fits over the
tenon uvwx in Fig. 1 (a), when cut as directed to form
the middle upright, and the openings on either side of
this central mortise fit over and receive the ends or
projections outside the lines ST, zy, in Fig. 1 (a). The
bottom shelf must of necessity be made of two pieces,
as shown in Fig.
4
(d) and Fig.
5
(e), but in order to
give strength to the whole structure these pieces may
be cut with tenons, as shown in each by the shaded
parts, suitable mortises being cut for their reception in
the parts indicated by the double dotted lines at the
bottom of Fig. 1 (a) and Fig. 2 (b). A duplicate of
Fig.
4
(d) will be required to form the central shelf of
the compartment to the right hand, and a duplicate
and triplicate of Fig.
5
(e) must be made to furnish
the intermediate shelves of the compartment to the
left hand. The left end of the central shelf of the
right hand compartment may be tenoned in to the
middle upright, but there will be a difficulty in providing
for this process in the ends of the other shelves as the
reader will see on examining the parts of the uprights
to which they must be fixed. In the small size of the
cabinet the amateur must therefore content himself
with glueing up and bradding the parts together,
because the thickness of the wood is too slight to bear
reduction into very thin tenons, but when wood a
quarter of an inch in thickness is used the difficulty
vanishes, and tenons of one-eighth of an inch in thick-
ness may be made in the ends of the shelves, and
mortices of corresponding width cut in the uprights to
receive them.
To prevent any difficulty in fitting the different
parts together, portions of the front elevation on either
side and in the centre have been attached to Fig. 1
(a) and Fig. 2 (b), and the letters attached to the
figures of the separate parts are repeated in Fig. 12 as
a guide to the amateur artisan.
The parts that have already been mentioned
having been cut out and carefully adjusted, it is
desirable that they should be fitted together and
glued up, slight brads being driven into the ends of
the shelves which are devoid of tenons through the
uprights, in order to give additional strength and
stability to the structure. Until the glue is perfectly
dry, the whole should be held firmly together by
clamps, two in front and two behind, pressing against
each end of the cabinet.
The framework is now complete, and all that is
now necessary is to cut out and put in place the doors,
the backs of the compartments thus enclosed, and the
remaindc : of the ornamentation. The doors are
shown in Fig. 8 (h) and Fig.
9
(k)
;
plain pieces only
of the same size are required for the backs of the com-
TOOL-HOLDERS FOR GRINDING.
19
partments to which the doors are respectively attached.
The doors may be attached by small brass hinges, and
secured by small catches that may be procured from
any ironmonger who supplies tools and materials for
fret-sawing.
The ledge round the top shelf is already formed as
far as the ends are concerned by the fret-work at the
top of each upright ; but to complete it and carry it
all round, two pieces as indicated by Fig. 10 (l), and
two pieces as shown by Fig. 11 (m), must be pre-
pared. These pieces must be inserted between the
uprights both in the front and at the back of the top
shelf, and resting on it, the longer pieces between the
right hand end and the central upright and the shorter
pieces between the central upright and the upright to
the left. Two pieces of the form shown in Fig. 6 (f)
must be cut out to be attached to and from an under
ledge to the larger section of the top shelf to the right,
and four pieces of the shape shou-n in Fig.
7 (g) to
form the under ledges of the smaller portion of the top
shelf to the left and the small intermediate shelf below
it These ledges are attached, both in front and be-
hind ; hence the number required. They should be
glued up, and held in place by clamps until the glue is
perfectly dry.
Finally, the whole work must be cleaned down, and
perfected where necessary by the application of glass-
paper. The wood, if of oak, may be left unpolished
;
if of white holly, varnished simply, or ebonized
; and
if of walnut or mahogany, carefully polished, or var-
nished. Of course dark wood will best show up china
and other small articles of bric-a-brac. If the cabinet
be made three times the linear dimensions given in
the Supplement, carving may be resorted to in order to
enrich the doors and the fret-work generally. If the
wood is of a dark colour, the doors may be lined with
a thin panel of gilt wood or cardboard, or with a panel
of light wood, so as to afford an agreeable contrast.
The salient parts of the design, also, such as the bird,
some of the leaves, and the crossing of the bars, may
be touched up with a little gilding. The backs of the
open compartments can either be left open as they are,
if the wall paper against which the cabinet is to stand
is of a suitable colour for showing up the articles dis-
played on the shelves, or they can be filled in with
panels covered with dark velvet, or with looking-glass.
It must be remembered that if the openings at the
back of the cabinet are thus filled up, there will be no
necessity to provide under ledges for the top shelf and
intermediate shelf at the back. This portion of the
ornamentation will, in this case, be required in front
only.
TOOL-HOLDERS FOR GRINDING.
HE ingenuity of the Americans, if it be
not proverbial already, bids fair to be'
come so before long, for it is certain that
in contrivances for lessening labour, and
to secure accuracy, ease, and expedition
in carrying out work that has hitherto been done by
the aid of the hands only, they excel every nation in
the world. One of the best examples of the adaptation
of mechanical contrivance to ensure correctness of
adjustment in a constantly recurring bit of manual
work, that must be done not only every day, but
possibly many times in the day, and which is done
with the utmost ease by a skilled hand, and with diffi-
culty and uncertainty by an amateur, is to be found in
the Adjustable Planes of the American makers, Stanley
and Bailey, in which, by simple pressure on a com-
pound lever, the plane-iron may be adjusted for fine
or coarse work at pleasure, and set so nicely, that the
cutting edge of the plane-iron is always in a plane
that is precisely parallel to the surface of the sole of
the tool.
It is in setting the plane-iron that nine amateurs
out of ten find most difficulty in using the plane, or
rather, in fitting it for use, and it is only long and con-
tinued practice that will ensure perfect accuracy of ad-
justment. Another difficulty that the amateur artisan
finds it hard to overcome, is that of grinding edge
tools, and more especially chisels, and the cutting irons
of planes. It is manifest that in order to reduce the
surface of wood to anything approaching regularity
and evenness, it is needful that the edge of the tool
should be a straight line, or, to borrow Euclid's de-
finition of a straight line, should lie evenly between its
extreme points : many an amateur will readily confess
how difficult he has found it to bring the edge of the
tool he is grinding into this necessary condition. He
finds it anything but easy to keep the tool throughout
the operation in such a position that the evenness of
the edge is assured. Even if the face of the grind-
stone be accurately true, he is prone to depress the
tool towards one or other of the extremities of its
edge, and the result is that more is taken off towards
the corner that has suffered depression, and the
straightness and evenness of the work is destroyed,
to the detriment of the work that is done with the tool
after the grinding is completed. But in this, as in
many other matters, the Americans have come to the
rescue, and put forth various practical means and
appliances for assuring accuracy in grinding. It is to
help amateur artisans generally to grind tools in a
thoroughly workmanlike and efficient manner, that the
following aids to the performance of this necessary
20 TOOL-HOLDERS FOR GRINDING.
operation, invented by clever American mechanics,
are described and represented by illustration in the
present paper.
In Fig. I, a grindstone of the old-fashioned form is
-.hown. It is supported on a frame made of stuff,
2 inches thick and
5
inches deep, consisting of two
FIG. I. GRINDSTONE WITH CARVED TOOL-HOLDER.
parallel bars connected by a cross piece at either end,
.vhose extremities are mortised into them. This
frame, open in the centre for the reception of the
grindstone, is supported by four legs, cut after the
manner of the legs of a sawing stool, and sloping out-
wards on either side of the frame, so as to render the
base on which the frame and grindstone rest as
large, and therefore as stable as possible. Inside the
legs two cleats are nailed, which serve as supports for
a shallow trough, containing water to moisten the
surface of the grindstone as it revolves.
Such is the framework by which the grindstone is
supported. It differs in little, if anything, from the
frame usually made for this purpose, except in the
means used to moisten the stone. The contrivance for
holdingthe plane-iron or other cutting tool to be ground,
is equally simple, but like most simple things is
effectual for carrying out the purpose for which it is
intended. An upright piece A, cut as shown in the
illustration, in a curved form, is furnished with notches
all along the inner surface, which serve as resting
places for the blunt edge of the plane-iron, or the
handle of a chisel, for which the notches should be
cut in a different manner to those shown in the illus-
tration, which are only adapted for the reception of a
plane-iron. This piece extends below the frame for
about four inches, and is secured by a key. As it fits
between the ends of the rails that form the sides of
the frame, a block should be driven through it above
and below, so that it may be pushed backwards and
forwards along that end of the frame to which it
is attached. It can be kept in position by means of
a key driven through a slot made on each side
of the frame, or it may be so contrived as to be secured
in any position in which it has been placed by means
of thumbscrews, working through the ends of the
cross-pieces and against the upper and lower surface of
the frame. The amateur, however, can work this out
for himself without any further detail in the way of
illustration. The notches in the tool-rest admit, it should
be said, of the tool being ground at any desired level
;
and, further, enable the operator to keep the edge of
the tool in proper contact with the face of the grind-
stone along its length from one corner to the other.
In Fig. 2 the same end is attained, though by some-
what different means. In this it has been considered
unnecessary to show the connection between the
grindstone and the tool-holder, or rather the support
against which the tool-holder rests, for a new element
is introduced into this contrivance in the shape of the
tool-holder proper, whereas in Fig. 1 nothing of this
kind is required. The tool-holder consists of a piece
of hard wood, a little wider than the widest tool
that it may be required to grind. Thus, to be generally
useful, it should be wider than the widest plane-
iron in the possession of the amateur. A clamp, also
made of wood and fastened by two screws, secures the
tool in place during the operation. In the engraving
a chisel is shown, and the screws pass apparently on
either side of the narrow part of the chisel and
through the holder, being secured by nuts below.
Another way of holding the tool would be to pass a
small iron frame of the same width as the tool-holder
within over both the tool and the holder, fixing it in its
place by means of small thumbscrews below. A
single clamp of this kind would do equally well for
FIG. 2. TOOL-HOLDER SUPPORTED BY TOST.
plane or chisel, whereas the clamp shown in the illus-
tration is, from the peculiarity of its construction,
fitted only to hold down a chisel. The end of the
tool-holder furthest away from the grindstone is
bevelled, as shown in the illustration. The grindstone
itself is placed near a square post, which is fixed in
the ground, and grooved horizontally along its face.
When the grindstone has been adjusted and placed in
TOOL-HOLDERS FOR GRINDING. 21
a proper position, and the tool secured in the tool-
holder, the latter is placed against the post, its bevelled
edge fitting into one of the grooves, care being taken to
select such a one as will give the tool the proper pitch
for ^rinding. The inventor of this clever contrivance
claims, as one of its chief merits, that it is possible,
FIG. 3.NEWTON'S GRINDING REST.
with such adjuncts as the tool-holder and the grooved
post, for one man to turn the grindstone, and at the
same time hold the tool, and complete the operation
in a satisfactory manner.
In Fig. 3
another contrivance is shown, which
enables anyone who makes use of it to hold the tool
with one hand while turning the grindstone with the
other. This is an American novelty, and from its
simplicity and practical utility will doubtless attract
the attention of the readers of this magazine. It is
the patented invention of Mr. A. D. Newton, of Wor-
cester, Massachusetts, U.S., who describes it as a
grinding rest. It consists of a frame through which
the plane-iron or other article to be ground is passed,
being held in position by a clamp, which works
through the upper part of the frame, and which is
raised or depressed at pleasure by means of the thumb-
screw shown at the top. The bit is allowed to pro-
ject through the frame more or less, according to the
angle desired to be imparted to the edge. A small
wheel travels against the face of the stone, enabling
the operator to keep the iron to be ground steadily
fixed in one position. If the name and address of the
inventor be given there will be no difficulty in procur-
ing it through any importer of American tools and
specialties in this country.
There is yet another method of using the grind-
stone, which appears to be more simple than any that
have yet been described. The grindstone is mounted
on a frame similar in construction to that shown in
Fig. i, and nothing more is required to be added to
the frame than a block of wood across each end, and
in close proximity to the face of the grindstone, bevelled
to suit the desired pitch for plane-irons, chisels, etc.
The blocks of wood should be four inches in width,
and two inches thick, and they should be bevelled
along the inner upper edge, as shown in the illustra-
tion. The iron to be ground is to be held down upon
the bevelled block in such a position as to bring the
bevel of the tool in contact with the face of the grind-
stone. The tool may be held in this position with one
hand while the operator turns the grindstone with the
other. The inventor says:
PORTABLE
STAND,
FOLDED UP
IS 2
34
FILTERING CISTERNS FOR RAINWATER.
terial ; this may be obtained at most dealers in photo-
graphic apparatus for about two shillings per yard.
About two yards of black
"
Silesia " lining, which
costs about sixpence per yard, is a cheap substitute
for velvet, and answers equally well.
Next to the lens and camera, the most necessary
piece of apparatus is a stand, which is usually made in
the form of a tripod, the most suitable wood being ash.
Its essential quality is stability, and this must not be
sacrificed for any other good quality, as the least vibra-
tion of the stand will result in defective photographs.
The kind of stand required depends almost entirely
upon the kind of work which it is intended to perform.
For home or studio use the more solid and heavy the
stand is the better, but for outdoor photography porta-
bility is, of course, a desideratum. A fairly light
portable stand and top may generally be obtained for
about fifteen shillings, but care must be exercised in
seeing that stability has not been sacrificed to porta-
bility. There are at present in the market several stands
which are pre-eminently portable, but they are seldom
sufficiently rigid, and a thoroughly portable, and at the
same time perfectly stable, stand has yet to be made.
In Fig.
3
is given an illustration of a good studio stand,
the top of which can be raised or lowered at pleasure
by means of the handle. Being upon castors this
stand can be readily moved from one part of the studio
to another ; the top may also be rotated when
necessary.
Fig.
4
shows one of the best forms of the portable
stand
; the top fixes on the frame by means of a screw
and nut, the screw passing through the hole in the
centre of the frame, which is of iron. This stand is
very rigid, and is in this respect thoroughly reliable,
but its portability is not all that could be desired. It
is on the whole the best kind of portable stand that has
yet been made, and for short journeys nothing better
need be wished for or sought for, as its weight is by
no means wearisome to the person who carries it. In
Fig.
5
this stand is shown folded up and ready for
transportation from place to place.
FILTERING CISTERNS FOR RAIN-WATER.
WRITER in the Rural New Yorker
has recently called attention to the
storage of rain-water for drinking, cook-
ing, and all domestic purposes, and has
given the following description of the
method he has adopted for providing himself and his
household with a constant supply of sweet and whole-
some water, from a source which, in ninety-nine cases
out of a hundred, and perhaps to even a greater extent,
is disregarded in this country. The importance of
storing, purifying, and utilising rain-water has been
frequently urged by writers on sanitary questions, and
cannot be too strongly or too frequently insisted on.
The method about to be described is at once practi-
cable, simple, and easy, and one which any amateur,
with the assistance of a labourer, may easily carry out
for himself. Mr. Dodge, the writer of the article,
says :
"
Our bread and meat are no more important for
our well-being than the liquids we drink. The outlay
for food is so constant, that purchasing all the variety
of which our solid nutriment is composed has with us
become a second nature, but when we see water upon
every side, and are often injured by the too plentiful
torrents from above, we find it difficult to realise that
there may at some time be a scarcity, and are not
willing to bestow much labour in laying by a store of
this luxury and necessity of every day and almost
every hour. Experience, however, has taught us that,
although the heavenly supply is generally bounteous,
its fall is so irregular that, in general, provision in time
of plenty must be made for coming times of scarcity,
and wells and cisterns were hence needed and con-
structed by the most ancient of our race.
"
For many years my daily drink at Montclair, New
Jersey, was rain-water, falling upon an ordinary tin
roof, covered with some sort of metallic paint, said to
contain no lead, and flowing into a large cemented
brick cistern, whence it was pumped into the kitchen.
This cistern differed from the usual construction in
this manner : across the bottom, about three feet nearer
one side than the other, was excavated a trough or
ditch about two feet wide and two feet deep ; along
the centre of this depression was built a brick wall
from the bottom up to the top of the cistern, and
having a few openings left through it at the very
bottom. The whole cistern, bottom, sides, and canal
included, was then cemented as usual, excepting the
division wall. Upon each side of the wall, at its base,
from six inches to a foot of charcoal were laid, and
covered with well-washed stones to a further height of
six inches, merely to keep the charcoal from floating.
The rain-water passing from the roof into the larger
division of the cistern, passes through the stone cover-
ing, the charcoal, the wall, the charcoal upon the other
side, lastly, the stones, and is now ready for the pump
placed in this smaller part. It is much better that the
water at first pass into the larger division, as the filtra-
tion will be slower, and the cistern not so likely to
overflow under a very heavy rainfall. I used this cis-
tern for many years, and was troubled only once, when
some toads made their entrance at the top, which was
just at the surface of the ground, soon making their
FILTERING CISTERNS FOR RAIN-WATER.
35
presence known by a decided change in the flavour of
the water.
"
If your house chances to be in a dusty situation,
several plans will suggest themselves whereby a few
gallons at the first of each rain may be prevented from
entering the cistern, but I employed no such means,
and never felt the need of any. Should the house be
small, and therefore the supply of water from its roof
be limited, do not lessen the size of the cistern, bet
rather increase it, for with one of less capacity some
of the supply must occasionally be al'.owed to go to
waste during a wet time, and you will suffer in a
drought, w-hereas a cistern that never overflows is the
more to be relied upon in a long season without rain.
"
Rainfall varies exceedingly in different places, and
even in the same situation it is impossible to foretell
DIAGRAM SHOWING CONSTRUCTION OF CISTERN.
the amount to be expected during any short period of
time, but the most careful observations show us that
about four feet in depth descends at New York and
vicinity every year, or nearly one inch a week. If this
amount were to be furnished uniformly every week,
the size of a cistern need only be sufficient to contain
one week's supply, but we often have periods of four
weeks without receiving the average of one, and we
must build accordingly.
"
The weekly average of one inch equals one cubic
foot upon every 12 feet of surface, or
3,630 cubic feet
upon an acre, weighing about 113 tons. Upon a roof
40 feet by 40 feet, 1,600 square feet, it would be
133
cubic fret,
1,037
gallons, or about 26 barrels of
40
gallon . each. A cistern eight feet across and ten feet
deep rould contain 502 cubic feet ; and one of 10 feet
p.cross and 10 feet deep, 785 cubic feet, or 6,120 gal-
lonsabout the average fall upon a roof of the above
size for six weeks ; while the smaller cistern would
hold
3,900
gallons, or a little less than four weeks'
rainfall. The weekly supply of
1,037
gallons is equal
to 148 gallons per day, or neasly
15
gallons to each
individual of a family of ten. This is certainly enough,
and more than enough, if used as it should be ; but
where water is plentiful it is wasted, and in our capri-
cious climate, whether we depend upon wells or
cisterns, it is wise to waste no water at all, at least
during the warm summer months, and lay by not for
a wet but a dry day."
It may be useful to the amateur if Mr. Dodge's
remarks be supplemented by a diagram exhibiting the
construction of the cistern, and some further remark?
in explanation of the diagram itself, and the method t'
s
be adopted in building the cistern. The diagram, it
should be said, does not show the containing or outer
walls of the cistern : these are left to the imagination
of the amateur, and only the coating of cement with
which the walls are lined is shown in the illustration.
In this, w, x, Y, z shows the excavation that must be
made for the cistern, and supposing the diagram to
exhibit, as it does, a section of the cistern, the recep-
tacle for the water will be, when finished, taking the
relative proportions of the different parts into conside-
ration, just about
9
feet wide and
45
feet deep. Of
course, the dimensions and capacity of the cistern
must be left to the amateur himself, who may have
decided on constructing one ;
all that it is sought to do
here is to bring before him the method of making the
cistern in a manner that shall admit of no mistake.
Of course, the excavation must be made greater in
breadth and depth than the dimensions given to allow
for the surrounding walls and the bottom. The walls
may be of brick, cemented within, and backed with
concrete or puddled clay without, or of monolithic
concrete, as the amateur may choose, but the bottom,
in any case, should be made of concrete. The trench
running across the bottom of the cistern is two feet
broad and two feet deep ; this trench is represented in
the illustration by E, F, H, G. In the middle of this
opening is built up a nine-inch brick wall, or a party-
wall of concrete, shown by c, D, Along the bottom of
the wall openings are left at intervals
;
one of these
openings is shown in section at D. The party-wall
divides the entire space into the larger outer cistern A,
and the smaller inner cistern B. Supposing the breadth
from E to F to be two feet, and the wall nine inches,
spaces of 7-k inches will be left on each side of the
wall. These are filled to three-fourths the height, or
for 18 inches, with lumps of charcoal, smooth pebbles
from one to three inches in diameter being laid along
the top of the charcoal till the trench is filled up. The
cistern is so constructed that the water from the roof
enters A ; it passes downwards through the stones and
charcoal, as shown by the arrow at F, passes through
the opening, and forces its way upwards in the direc-
tion of the arrow at E into the cistern B, in which it
rises to the level of the water in A, to be drawn thence
for use by a small pump.
36
A SIMPLE FRET-SAWING MACHINE.
A SIMPLE FRET-SAWING MACHINE.
CORRESPONDENT of an American
contemporary gives in its columns the
accompanying design for a home-made
scroll saw, which has been reproduced
here as a suggestion to amateur artisans
who may be desirous of constructing an appliance of
this kind. It is stated by the inventor, that he has had
it in use for five years, and that it has given him great
satisfaction ;
the test of time and trial is therefore
entirely in its favour.
With reference to its capability and the great range
of its power, the inventor states that it will cut stuffs
from one-eighth of an inch in thickness, to
5
and
even 6 inches. A scroll saw that will do this will do
everything that is required or desired of a saw of this
description, for it may be used for cutting out the most
delicate fret-work, or made available for fashioning a
bracket or cantilever, which is of considerable thick-
ness, and which is to be finished by the carver's tools.
As far as regulation of power is concerned, it re-
sembles the Nasmyth hammer, which can be made to
deliver a blow with such gentleness as to crack a nut
without crushing it, or be brought down with force
sufficient to forge the largest engine shafts, and to
crush a piece of three-inch timber, and send it flying
into splinters.
Its power and capability depend altogether upon
its being properly constructed and put together
;
and
on this account, although the method of making the
machine is clearly shown in the illustration, a careful
description of its various parts and their connection,
and the working and action of the contrivance is de-
sirable. The representation of the machine is given
in perspective, but any amateur will be, or ought to be,
able to make working drawings for himself, if he
require them, exhibiting it in plan, section, and eleva-
tions.
First of all a stout frame-work must be made. In
the machine made by the inventor for his own use,
the uprights were formed of two pieces of spruce, mea-
suring 4
inches by 4 inches, and apparently from 6 to
7 feet long. This, however, is not given in the too
brief description that accompanies the saw. The
omission is due to the fact the writers on technical
subjects too often take for granted on the part of their
readers, the possession of special knowledge with re-
gard to these matters, and so too often fall into the
error of leaving out particulars which, as a matter of
course, a*e well known to themselves, and which, con-
sequently, they imagine to be self-evident to every-
body else. Those who contribute to the pages of this
magazine, and who may be inclined to describe their
experience in carrying out any kind of amateur work,
for the benefit and guidance of their brother handicrafts-
men, must be clear and careful both in illustration and
description, even to what may appear an undue excess
of minuteness, and the present opportunity to give this
caution and lay down this rule at starting, is too good
to be lost. No apology is necessary for this slight
digression, which, being driven home, may be appro-
priately clenched by the old saying, Verbum sat
sapienti.
To return, however, to the construction of the
frame. The two stout uprights are mortised at the
lower end into stout pieces of plank, screwed down to
the floor of the workshopfor the machine must of
necessity be a fixture, if the treadle be hinged to the
floor, as shown in the illustration. If the machine is
to be movable from place to place, transverse pieces
should be placed between the timbers which receive
the uprights, so as to form a broad framing, and to the
piece that forms the front of the frame the treadle may
be hinged. The top of each upright is tenoned, and
passed through a mortise in the end of a transverse
beam 6 feet long, 4
inches broad, and about 3 inches
thick, the beam being kept in place by pegs, through
holes cut to receive them in the tenons at the top of
the uprights. The space between the uprights is
stated to be 5 feet 6 inches in the clear, and this
affords a valuable guide to the construction of the
outer frame.
The inner frame is made of pine,
3 inches wide
and 2 inches thick, but to impart additional strength
to it, the transverse pieces are composed of two pieces
of inch pine with the grain reversed, glued together,
and secured by screws. Into these pieces the up-
rights or sides are framed and pegged in the usual
way. A piece of iron plate similar to that which is
used for the track on which sliding-doors are moved
backwards and forwards, is fastened to the inner
surface of the uprights of the outer frame, and other
pieces of iron fitted to work against this track are
fastened one to either upright of the inner frame on
the outer surface. For the easy working of the
machine, it is obvious that the friction between the
outer and inner frames should be reduced to a
minimum.
The spring at the top of the frame is made of
three pieces of ash, three-eighths of an inch in thick-
ness, planed gradually down from the centre of either
extremity until the material is reduced to the thick-
ness of one-eighth of an inch at each end. A bolt is
passed through the centre of the ashen spring and the
transverse beam that forms the top of the outer frame,
the spring and the beam being drawn together as
tightly as possible by a nut at the upper end of the
bolt. It will be noticed, in making the spring, that
A SIMPLE FRET-SAWING MACHINE.
37
each piece of ash is shorter by about 4 or 5
inches
than the piece immediately above it. In general
principle of construction it is similar to the iron
springs of this form used for carts and carriages. A
hole is made at either end of the spring to admit of its
connection with the inner frame by means of a short
piece of small rope or chain. If rope is used, a knot
must be made to prevent its slipping through the
spring ; but, if chain is used, it may be secured by
passing a nail or piece of wire through the last link or
last link but one. The lower end of the rope must be
formed into a loop, and this loopor, if a chain be
used, the last link of the chainmust be passed over a
hook inserted in the end
of the upper part of the
inner frame, as shown in
the illustration.
The treadle, as it has
been said, must be hinged
at one end to the floor, as
shown in the illustration,
or, if a frame be made to
form the base of the
machine, to that part of
it which forms the front
The other end rests on a
strap or piece of twisted
gut, attached to the bot-
tom part of the inner
frame by two metal eyes.
It is as well that grooves
should be cut in either
side of the free end of
the treadle into which the
gut may fall, and thus be
held in place. The action
of the machine is so
simple that it scarcely
needs explanation. When
the treadle is pressed
downwards by the foot, the inner frame is brought
down, to be pulled up again by the recoil of the
spring as soon as the pressure of the foot is with-
drawn. Two battens are screwed to the front and
back respectively of the outer frame, to afford a sup-
port for the table, through a hole in the centre of
which the saw passes, and which forms a support for
the work to be sawn. This table is 2 feet long and
18 inches in width. It has been said that the space
between the uprights of the outer frame is
5
feet 6
inches in the clear. The inventor of the frame, in his
too brief description of it, says,
"
Deducting the space
occupied by the inside frame and the slides, it leaves
4 feet 1
1
; inches net (between the inner surfaces of Ihe
sides of the inner frame), which gives 2 fee
f
5! inches
A SIMPLE FRET-SAWING MACHINE.
swing for the work which may be done in this tool."
This, therefore, allows
3!
inches for the width of the
uprights of the inner frame and the iron slides
; from
which it is to be inferred that the width as well as the
thickness of the uprights of the inner frame must be
3
inches, and the thickness of the irons that form the
tracks and slides, about 3-i6ths of an inch, and that they
are simply screwed to the sides of the frames, and not let
into them. Whatever may be the contrivance that is
used for effecting the easy working of the inner frame
against the sides of the outer frame, it is clear that the
friction must be diminished as much as possible, and
that the inner frame should work as easily as may be,
and with perfect freedom
from oscillation. The saw
is attached to two clamps,
provided for its reception.
These clamps pass, one
through the upper part
and one through the lower
part of the inner frame,
bringing the saw truly
perpendicular in its very
centre : they are secured
by nuts above and below,
by which the saw may
be brought to its proper
tension.
The chief objection to
this home-made fret-saw-
ing machine is, that it is
cumbersome, and takes
up a great deal of room
;
its chief merits are its
simplicity of construction
f and its cheapness. It has
been described here, not
so much in the belief
that amateur artisans will
construct one of the di-
mensions given for their own use, but that they will
note the principles on which it is made, and adapt
them to their own requirements.
It will not be a matter of great difficulty to any
ingenious amateur to do much useful work with a saw
of this kind, that he might not be able to accomplish
so easily in the ordinary way. For example, he would
be able to cut out circular work far more easily with a
machine, as described above, than with the common
compass saw; for instead of sawing with one hand and
steadying and holding the wood with the other, he can
use both hands for guiding the wood to the saw, the
foot being used as the motive power. He would also
find it useful in cutting out brackets, cantilevers, etc.,
of more tho" ordinary -Iiickness.
38
INSECT TAXIDERMY.
INSECT TAXIDERMY.
ANY amateurs who have been accustomed
to collect and preserve butterflies and
moths will, without doubt, have often
wished that they could hit on some method
of preparing specimens of the caterpillar
and chrysalis of each perfected insect, in order to show
the various stages through which it has passed before
arriving at the winged form in which the beautiful
object which was once merely able to crawl from leaf
to leaf, is at last able to flit through the air from flower
to flower with a speed which, when viewed in com-
parison to its former lagging pace, is as that of the hare
when considered with the pace of the tortoise, or the
mile a minute of the rapid locomotive viewed with the
four miles an hour of the tardy carrier's van.
Readers of Amateur Work, Illustrated, who
have a taste for natural history, and especially in the
direction indicated, will not fail to be interested in
the following remarks on the subject from, the pen of
Mr.
J.
B. Holder, in the "Art Amateur."
"
The practice of taxidermy, as applied to the pre-
paration and preservation of insects, is almost unknown
in this country (America). Those who have conve-
nient access to the cabinets of the American Museum
of Natural History in Central Park, may see there
some beautiful work of this kind. An old school-
teacher of Stuttgart, in Germany, prepared a large
series of insects for Professor Agassiz, after whose
death the specimens were transferred to the American
Museum. They consist of insects of various orders,
each species being illustrated by a prepared specimen
of the various phases in which it appears, from the egg
to the perfect form. The plant on which the insect
feeds is arranged with the specimens, together with
the nest that each makes. The worms are emptied of
their contents and preserved with much care, showing
the various stages ; many of them are of brilliant
colours, and retain a very natural appearance. The
cocoons and the silken or other products are also
shown. In some instances spiders' nests prove to be
made up of a tough and beautiful silk.
"
This new art, though in its infancy, is yet within
the reach of many a young amateur, and it is beyond
question that a tolerable exercise of ingenuity will pro-
duce such results as to claim unwonted interest, even
from those scoffers who cry
'
beetles
!
' and
'
rocks
!
'
much to the discomfiture of young naturalists. The
principal manipulation is with the worms or larva;.
You wish to preserve, for example, one of the great
green worms that you find eating your grape-vine.
Make an incision across the posterior portion, just
sufficient to include the end of the alimentary canal
;
press the contents of the worm out through this open-
ing, gently, and with especial care in the case of the
tussock-moth worms and others that have hairy or
other appendages. Though seemingly a hazardous
thing to do (as respects the integrity of the specimen),
yet the most delicate hairy caterpillars may be very
successfully emptied of their contents. Indeed, they
are by this process so cleaned internally that, practi-
cally, they are skinned, and you have the skin now to
deal with.
"
Select a good straw, of size proportioned to the
specimen
;
this is to be used as a blow-pipe, and should,
therefore, be a whole one, and several inches in length.
Introduce the straw carefully within the cut end of the
worm, and tie the end around the straw with fine silk.
If the operation of squeezing has been successful, it re-
mains to inflate the body for preservation. Prepare a
dish of live embers, and over these hold the specimen,
using great care in the degree of heat applied. While
holding the worm in this way, keep it inflated. The
form which the insect is to assume for the cabinet
should be considered while this drying process is going
on. Some light wooden frame, such as will be readily
suggested to the operator, will often be of service to
hold the specimen in the proper position. Some worms
may require to be curved, or put into a shape charac-
teristic of them while living
' surveyors,' or
'
inch-
worms,' for example. Attention to these points will
contribute greatly to the value and pleasing appear-
ance of the specimen. The straw, after the drying, is
cut off near the body, as it is convenient to allow a
small portion to project outside, so that the specimen
may be pinned to the cabinet through it, thus avoiding
the injury that results from passing the pin through
the body.
"
The specimen is now complete unless we choose
to adopt some method ofpoisoning it. Corrosive subli-
mate, which is sometimes used, is likely to injure the
colours. A strong arsenical solution may be applied
with a brush, safely, as regards the colours. Cater-
pillars prepared in this manner preserve their colour
and form nearly perfect, the hairs and other appen-
dages retaining a remarkably natural appearance,
which, of course, enhances greatly the beauty and use-
fulness of an entomological cabinet.
"
An extended field is open to any who may practise
this branch of taxidermy. Among the various objects
that may be gathered by an insect collector some are of
peculiar interest. The pine-borer (Rhagium lineatum)
is found under the bark of white pine-trees, and speci-
mens of its nests brought in from Central Park, and
now exhibited in the cabinets of the American Museum
of Natural History, show the most delicate structure.
On the smooth, flat inner surface of the bark is a shallow
channel, two or three inches long, cut as exactly as if
SOME ENIGMAS IN WOOD.
39
with a chisel or carpenter's gouge. This leads to a
circular excavation of the same shallowness, coiled
around which is a collection of fibres of bark as care-
fully and exactly laid as the straws and horse-hairs in
some exquisite bird's nest. In this hollow the larva
lies after its labours, and undergoes the change from a
wingless grub to a winged beetie, all ready to flit
around the pines and deposit its eggs.
"The carpenter-bee (Xylocopci) is a remarkable
insect builder, whose work is very beautiful, yet emi-
nently practical. In the museum at Central Park is a
piece of white pine wood, about eight inches in length,
bored crossway sufficiently to admit the bee, which is
about the size of the ordinary humble-bee. Achannel
follows at right angles to this entrance passage, and on
a line with the fibres of the wood. The channel is so
handsomely cut that it has the appearance of having
been made with a carpenter's auger, but it is genuine
insect work, recalling to mind Mercutio's
'Joiner squirrel, or old grub,
Time out of mind the fairy's coach-maker.'
"The channel is about twelve inches in length.
Imagine all this bitten out by the not particularly hard
jaws of the carpenter-bee ! Like the joiner, the bee
leaves a pile of chips or sawdust This dust is utilised,
being moistened with a gluey substance secreted by the
bee ; and when one egg, with its complement of pollen
or honey for the forthcoming young grub, is deposited,
a thin but substantial partition is constructed of this
gluey mixture, completely shutting in the cavity from
the air. The tunnel is divided in this manner into ten
or twelve apartments, in each of which a single egg is
deposited. The length of lime required to finish this
work may be imagined. One naturally wonders how
it will be with the first grub, seeing that it must
necessarily come to active life somewhat sooner than
the remainder. How does it escape ? The mother-
bee unerringly provides the means by boring a side
passage through which No. I, when it has burst from
the egg and eaten its supply of honey, emerges from
the cell, its newly-grown mandibles serving to gnaw
through the barrier of dust and glue which the mother
has erected. Nos. 2 to 12 inclusive come forth, each
in turn, through the same passagethe last traversing
the whole gallery- ere it reaches the outlet or back-
door."
By his description of the method of preserving
the curious and beautiful caterpillars that are, as it
were, the precursors of the many-tinted moth and
butterfly, and calling attention to the work of the pine-
borer and carpenter-bee, Mr. Holder will doubtless
have excited a desire to look more closely into the
work of nature in many an amateur, which will bear
good fruit when the season of the year for butterfly
collecting comes round once more.
SOME ENIGMAS IN WOOD.
O those who have sufficient time on their
hands to turn their attention to the manu-
facture of articles whose merit lies h
singularity of construction rather than i 1
utility, the following curiosities in car-
pentry and joinery cannot fail to prove interesting.
If any amateur artisan can make them, he will show
himself to be possessed of no little ingenuity and
mechanical skill ; but if he can execute the work in a
workmanlike manner, and with perfect accuracy in the
fitting together of various parts, he will have made
good his claim to be considered a workman of no
ordinary merit and capacity.
Let him take, first of all, a piece of boxwood or
pearwood about the thickness of an ordinary carpen-
ter's flat two-feet rule, or thereabouts, and cut in it
three holesa circle, a square, and a rectangular
figure like the letter T, as shown in Fig. 1. Before
making the holes, he should outline them with per-
fect
accuracy on the surface of the wood, observing
that the three apertures lie exactly between two parallel
lines," one of which touches each perforation in and
along its upper part or edge, the other touching each
in and along its bottom part or edge. It will be noted
that the diameter of the circle, the sides of the square,
and the measurements of the T-shaped hole, taken
vertically and horizontally, are exactly equal. Of what-
ever size he may make his perforations, this similarity
indeed, identityin certain measurements, must
govern and regulate them all. So much for the piece
of wood. What is now requiredand herein lies the
difficulty, or apparent difficultyis to cut out a piece
of wood of such a size and shape that it will fit each
of the three orifices in turn with perfect exactness.
Abraham Lincoln, the senior of the two Presidents
of the United States who have unhappily fallen be-
neath the death-dealing bullet of the assassin, leaving
the whole world to mourn their loss, was note-
worthy for his persistence in
"
pegging away," or, in
other words, for his marvellous perseverance
; but, in
his pegging away, he was often accustomed to declare
that every hole must have a peg to fit it, and that it
was no more use to put a square man into a round
hole, and vice versa, than it was to fill a square hole
with a round cork or bung, or a round hole with a
four-sided and rectangular wooden brick. He would
have shaken his head, and shown his incredulity by a
kindly but pitying smile, had he been told that it was
possible to fill up with the utmost exactness each of
the different holes shown in Fig. 1 with one and the
same piece of wood.
If any reader of Amateur Work, Illustrated,
40 SOME ENIGMAS IN WOOD.
is equally incredulous, let him look at Fig. 2, in which
he will find the form of the piece of wood that will
satisfactorily solve the difficulty. This piece of wood
is of the same dimensions every way ; that is to say,
its height, its breadth, and its width in the widest part
are exactly equal, and, moreover, equal to the dia-
meter of the circle, the side of the
square, and the height and breadth
of the T-shaped hole. Viewed in
plan from the top, it represents a
perfect circle ; regarded in elevation,
with the fiat side of the under part
of the piece of wood turned to the
spectator, it represents a perfect
square ; and
looked at in side
elevation, as we
may term it, in
all its parts, it
assumes the
shape of a T,
whose vertical
and transverse
portions are of
precisely the
same width. It
is manifest that
the piece of
wood, when
thrust into each
and all of the
perforations in
turn, in the pro-
per direction,
will exactly fill
fig. 3.dovetailed in
., , ., EACH OF THE FOUR
them, and thus
SIDES
,
AN APPAKENT
satisfy all the
impossibility. how
requirements of
was it managed ?
the case.
The second of these enigmas
in wood is a rectangular block,
composed of two different pieces
of wood, which are so fitted to-
gether that each side of the upper
part appears to be dovetailed into
the corresponding side of the lower
part, as shown in Fig. 3. Now, here
is a puzzle indeed, and one that would perplex most of
our most clever carpenters and joinersto say nothing
of amateurs unless they happened to possess the
clue to its solution. Every one will allow that at first
sight it appears to be perfectly impossible to put two
pieces of wood together in such a manner, but a glance
at Figs.
4, 5, 6, and 7 will unravel the seeming mys-
tery ; for it will be seen from Fig.
4,
which represents
Illustrated
Scientific News.
Nickel Plating.A simple process of nickel
plating by boiling has been described by Dr. Kaiser.
A bath of pure granulated tin tartar and water is pre-
pared, and after being heated to the boiling point, has
added to it a small quantity of pure red-hot nickel
oxide. A portion of the nickel will soon dissolve and
give a green colour to the liquid over the grains of tin.
Articles of copper or brass plunged into this bath
acquire in a few minutes a bright metallic coating of
almost pure nickel. If a little carbonate or tartrate of
cobalt is added to the bath a bluish shade, either light
or dark, may be given to the coating, which becomes
very brilliant when it is properly polished with chalk
or dry sawdust.
Scientific American.
Electricity in Bee-Keeping.Perhaps one of
the most singular applications of electricity to the
useful arts is its employment in the hiving of bees
when they swarm. The old-fashioned way of accom-
plishing this interesting feat of domestic economy
was, if not absolutely dangerous, at least quite annoy-
ing and provoking. German scientists of a practical
disposition conceived the notion of utilising the
electric force to stupefy, without injuring, the bees for
a short period. The plan was found to work like a
charm. It was first tried upon bees that had gathered
upon trees. Whether the clusters were large or small,
the result was perfect. The bees fell upon the ground
in a trance, that admitted of safe handling. The next
stage in the experiment was to capture the bees when
they were about to swarm. By introducing the ends
of two conducting wires into a fully occupied honey-
comb, and turning on the current for an instant, the
insects were rendered inactive for about thirty minutes.
Persons interested in the matter should test the Ger-
man idea of hiving bees by electricity. The chance is
not remote that bee proprietors will apply too strong a
shock and lose their bees, but they will gain in science,
which ameliorates all small disasters in this progres-
sive age.
Iron Age.
A New Filling for Wood.Amateurs desirous
of French polishing or varnishing articles in wood, will
find
"
Wheeler's American Wood Filler" an excellent
preparation for filling the pores of the wood, and thus
making a good foundation for the reception of the
polish or varnish, as the case may be. It is supplied
by Messrs. Fordbam and Sons,
43
and
45,
Curtain
Road, London, E.C., who thus speak of its merits in
their circular :
''
It seals the pores, and wholly pre-
vents the absorption of polish by the wood, and
entirely obviates what is called
'
sweating,' namely,
the exuding of the oil of the wood driven to the sur-
face by the polish absorbed. It gives an imperishable
marble-like base for the polish, and retains it upon the
surface where it is required, and where it will remain
with double the brilliancy and durability. No pre-
vious preparation of the wood is required, except
simply sand-papering, and it saves largely in polish
or varnish, and proportionately in labour. It is cheap,
durable, easily applied, is unaffected by any climate,
or by heat, cold, wet, or dry, and never shrinks
or expands. It is transparent under polish or var-
nish, and adapted to any kind of wood or finish,
and is equally practicable for outside or inside pur-
poses, or for any purpose from a piano to a railway
can iage."
42 WAYS AND MEANS.
A Wonderful Decorative Process." Eido-
graphie" is the name given to a process invented by
Professor A. F. Eckhardt, a German chemist.
According to the inventor,
"
silken cushions, such as
ladies have been accustomed to spend weeks in
embroidering from designs in coloured silk, are
decorated elegantly by the pencil of the
'
Eido-
graphist' in a few hours, and the work is done in
metal, which will not wear off as the silk of embroi-
dery does. Instead of the expensive stained-glass
windows used in churches, windows decorated by the
'Eidographie' process can be employed, producing
similar effects, and at a comparatively nominal cost.
Wooden ware can be embellished by the same process,
as can paper, metal, ivory, leather, wire-screens, and
any solid surface. The designs being in solid metal,
and the brilliant colouring a compound part of the
metal, the decorative work is permanently fixed, and
will last as long as the material upon which it is
placed." The worker in Eidographie is supplied with
a number of pencils containing the metal which
Professor Eckhardt has compounded, and the com-
position of which is his secret, in a fluid form. It is
said that every known colour can be produced. The
moment the fluid meets the air, upon issuing from
the pencil, it hardens and becomes a metal, adhering
so closely to the material upon which it is laid that
it cannot be removed without breaking. One of the
uses to which Eidographie is capable of being applied
is said to be the production of copper and steel
plates for engraving. The design is first made by the
new process, and, a negative is then taken. The
labour of engraving is thus saved. This is all very
wonderful. We hope it is true.
Art Amalcur.
Rice Paste or Cement.The following prepa-
ration is said to afford a beautiful white and almost
transparent paste, which is well adapted for fancy paper
work, and all purposes for which a strong but colour-
less adhesive cement is required. Mix some ground-
rice or rice-flour with a little cold water, and
then add boiling water until a thick cream-like con-
sistency is acquired. The mixture must be well
stirred all the time, and, when the required consis-
tency is attained, it must be boiled for a minute in a
clean saucepan. When cold it may be used in the
same way as ordinary flour paste.
Cement for Marble.
Sift plaster of Paris
through muslin, and mix with shellac dissolved in
alcohol or naphtha. As soon as mixed apply quickly,
and squeeze out as much of the composition as
possible, wiping off that which squeezes out before it
sets. The cement will hold better if the parts to be
joined be roughened by a pointed tool before cement-
ing, which can be done without destroying the edge
of the fractured part.
Scientific American.
Black Fluid for Ebonizing.Take one gallon
of strong vinegar, two pounds of extract of logwood,
half a pound of green copperas, a quarter of a pound
of China blue, and two ounces of nutgalls. Put these
in an iron pot, and boil them over a slow fire till they
are well dissolved. 'When cool, the mixture is ready
for use. Add to the above half a pint of iron rust,
obtained by steeping iron filings in strong vinegar.
The above makes a perfect jet black, equal to the best
black ebony; and the recipe is a valuable one.
American
'Inventor.
To Keep Iron from Rusting.To keep iron
goods of any kind, and especially those parts of
machines which are made of steel or iron, from rust-
ing, take half an ounce of powdered camphor and
melt it before the fire in one pound of good lard. To
give it a dark colour add as much fine black lead as is
necessary to produce the desired effect. Clean the
ironwork and smear it over with this preparation.
After this it should be allowed to remain untouched
for twenty-four hours, when the grease should be
removed by wiping the ironwork with a soft cloth.
Carbon Tracing Paper.This may be prepared
by rubbing into a suitable paper a mixture of six parts
of lard, i part of beeswax, and sufficient fine lamp-
black to give it a good colour. The mixture should
be applied warm, and care should be taken not to put
on too much of it.
Imitation of Japanning.The peculiar glossy
surface on the so-called japan trays can only be given
by practice, but a near imitation may be effected as
follows :
Mix ivory black with melted size, apply the
mixture quite hot to the box, or any other wooden
article that it may be desired to treat in this manner
;
when dry, sand-paper the box, then give another coat
of black ; when this second coat is dry, bring to
smoothness with sand-paper, at the same time taking
care not to remove the stain so that the light wood
below is exposed. Now procure one pound of black
japan and one gill of turpentine
; mix enough of the
black japan for present use with turpentine, of which
only sufficient should be used to make the japan fluid
enough to run from the brush. A fine-haired paint-
brush should be employed. If properly done one coat
will be sufficient. The box will look nearly equal to the
japan goods. Dry the varnished box in a warm room
free from dust.
Liquid Glue.A glue always ready for use is
made by adding to any quantity of glue common
whiskey instead of water. Put both into a bottle,
cork it tight, and put it on one side for three or four
days, when it will be fit for use without the applica-
tion of heat. Glue thus prepared will keep for years,
and is at all times fit for use except in very cold
weather, when it should be set in warm water before
using. To obviate the difficulty of the stopper getting
tight by the glue drying in the mouth of the vessel,
use a tin vessel with the cover fitting tight on the out-
side, to prevent the escape of the spirit by evapora-
tion. A strong solution of isinglass made in the same
manner is an excellent cement for leather.
Preserving Natural Colours of Plants.
A recent improved receipt for preserving plants with
their natural colours is to dissolve one pint of salicylic
acid in 600 parts of alcohol, heat the solution up to
boiling point in an evaporating vessel, and draw the
plants slowly through it. Shake them to get rid of
any superfluous moisture, and then dry between sheets
of blotting paper under pressure in the ordinary man-
ner. Too prolonged immersion discolours violet
flowers, and in all cases the blotting paper must be
frequently renewed. The novelty appears to be the
salicylic acid.
Art Amateur.
Coating for Woodwork.Good lime slaked
with sour milk and diluted with water till it is about
the consistence of ordinary whitewash, makes an
excellent coating for woodwork, which is said to be
effectually protected against the weather for at least
ten years by this application This is well worth a trial.
44
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
In the multitude of councillors there is wisdom."
Prov.
T is almost needless to say that this section
of Amateur Work, Illustrated, is
set apart for the purpose of helping
those who may attempt to carry out any
description of work that is treated in its
pages, out of any difficulty, real or imaginary, which may
tend to hinder their progress. To show that care has
been taken to insure a careful answer to any question
that may be asked, it may be stated that arrangements
have been made with the writers of the various articles
that will find a place in the magazine to reply to
queries, each taking up those which touch directly or
indirectly on the subject which he has in hand. By
this means greater accuracy of information is insured,
and the instructions given will result from actual ex-
perience, and not, as is too often the case in answers
supplied to correspondents, be gathered mostly, if not
altogether, from books of reference. All questions
will, in the first instance, come under the Editor's
notice, and he, as it has been already said elsewhere,
reserves to himself the right of refusing a reply to any
query that may be frivolous, inappropriate, or devoid
of general interest.
Every question proposed by, and answer given to,
amateurs in council, will be genuine, and not vamped
up for the purpose of filling up space. It stands to
reason that, before a magazine is in the hands of the
public, it is most unlikely that anyone, even though
he may be an intending reader, will take the trouble
to put a question on speculation, as it were, with the
mere idea of seeing if an answer will be given. Thus
it is that very little in the form of replies to queries
will be found in the present Part, and the questions
that are answered refer rather to subjects mentioned
in "Every Man His Own Mechanic," than to Ama-
teur Work, Illustrated. The paucity of queries,
however, is by no means to be regretted, as it affords
the opportunity of commenting on letters of suggestion
and encouragement, sent by many a well-wisher, whose
communication it has not been found possible, for
various reasons, to acknowledge in any other manner.
A. E. M. (Putney) has found some difficulty in
making an iron hoop to fit a tub.
"
On trying toJit it
on," he says,
"
the upper side would cut into the wood,
and the lower side would form itself into awkward
bulges." 1 his was because A. E. M. did not put the
ends of the hoop together in a proper manner. The
following extract from "Every Man His Own Mecha-
nic" will show him how to perform the operation of
b joping a cask or tub with perfect success :
I
c
m
HOOPS ON WOUHLN
Tur.
FIG. 2. -OVERLAPPING OF
ENDS OF IRON HOOP.
"
Let Fig. i represent a wooden tub in elevation.
It will be seen that it is wider at the top than at the
bottom, and that it is in the form of a cone turned
upside down, with the top cut off. A cask resembles
in general form two of these frusta of cones con-
nected at their bases, the
widest part being in the mid-
dle, where the cask swells or
bulges out, and the narrowest
part at the two ends, or top
and bottom. From this it is
apparent that the further a
hoop is driven on, the tighter
the staves of the tub or cask
are brought together. Sup-
pose that it is necessary to
put a new hoop on the tub
shown in Fig. I, at A. Having
the hoop iron ready, measure
the girth of the tub a little
below the place where the
hoop is to be fixed, so that
the hoop may be sure to fit tightly, allowing from two
inches to two and a-half inches at each end, as from
B to C, for the overlapping of the iron through which
the rivets are to be thrust. Bring the ends together
somewhat in the manner shown in Fig. 2,
though this
is exaggerated in order to show better what is meant,
and then with a piece of chalk mark on each end the
places through which the rivets are to be driven. T his
inclination of the ends of the hoop is made in order to
make the circumference of one edge of the hoop a
trifle less than the circumference of the other edge
;
and it must be remembered that it is the larger cir-
cumference which must be passed first over the bottom
of the tub. The holes for the rivets must then be
punched with a steel punch. The rivets are then put
through the holes, the shoulder end being inward,
and laid on an anvil, the riveting being completed by
hammering the uppermost end of the rivet until the
face is beaten out beyond the circumference of the
hole made by the punch, thus bringing the ends of the
hoop closely and tightly together. To fix a hoop in
its place, slip it over the bottom of the tub, having
first turned the tub upside down, and then beat the
hoop on as far as it will go by holding a piece of flat
iron against the edge, and striking the iron with a
hammer. Care should be taken that the hoop be
equidistant in all parts from the edge of the tub."
A. M. {Thurso, N. B.) is an amateur in wood-
working, and does a good deal in fret-work, often
having to use white wood, which he would like to stain.
He says, "Perhaps in your new magazine, entitled
Amateur Work, Illustrated, you might kindly
devote a page or two to explaining the composition
of
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
45
the different wood-stains." Papers on wood-stains and
wood-staining will be given shortly, which will put
A. M. in possession of everything that is necessary to
know on the subject about which he writes.
A.
J.
M. {Dalkey, Dublin) has found difficulty in
cutting out the rabbits or rebates in a fret-frame, and
Las been able hitherto to find no implement that will
effect what he requires, and none of the tool-makers
to whom he has written can give him any information
ca the subject. The following passage in his letter
affords a clue to the cause of his difficulty :
"
/ have
seen an implement on the principle
of
a cutting-gauge,
but it fails in the square frame, as it leaves angles in
iliefour corners. It will answer for a round or oval,
but not quite for a carte-de-visite frame" A.
J.
M.
made up his frame before he tried to cut out the
rebate. He must cut out his rebate before he makes
up his frame, and then he will find that a simple rebate
plane will do all he requires.
These are, in point of fact, the only queries that
require an answer in the present Part. The reply to
the first has been given at great length ; but it is
almost needless to say this is an exceptional case, and,
in future, when, as it may be reasonably expected,
inquiries and appeals for guidance and assistance will
be numerous, answers must of necessity be briefer.
I must now turn to letters from amateurs, called forth
by the "Preliminary Notice" of this magazine, and
give extracts from a few of them, heartily thanking the
writers of these, and many more which must remain
unnoticed, for their kindly promises of support and
assistance by contributions.
H. G. S. C. {Mulley, Plymouth) wishes for "in-
structions enabling an amateur to make lattice windows
with lead bars instead
of
wood." He shall have them
in due course. He will readily see that it is not pos-
sible, with every wish to do so, to meet the require-
ments of every amateur immediately.
C. W. (Holborn) and
W.J.
(Aldershot) will find
that their wishes have been anticipated in the opening
paper on
"
Boots and Shoes : How to Make Them and
Mend Them," in the present Part of Amateur Work,
Illustrated. The former lends emphasis to his
request by writing,
" '
I wish to Heaven I could make
my own shoes,' is a remark very often heard from
those who suffer from tender feet."
S. C. {VVatlington, Oxon) will find ample scope for
the kind of carpentry that most commends itself to
him in the Supplement that accompanies this Part.
A thoroughly practical paper on Wall-brackets, with
working drawings, will be given in Part II. None of
the articles that he mentions will be forgotten, as
"
Garden Carpentry " will be specially and fully
treated in this magazine.
W. H. R asks to be told
"
how to mend as well as
how to make" and further desires special teaching in
wire-working, and
"
simple matters
of
black-smithing,
ifhe may coin a word." These industrial arts, he may
rest assured, will not be neglected.
C. W. {Roselea, Bishopbriggs) is thanked for his
letters and the encouragement that is afforded in
them. Papers from his pen will always be acceptable
when time and inclination permit him to write for our
pages.
F. W. W. {Toronto).As the magazine is made up
of many various papers, there would be much difficulty
in treating it in the manner adopted for
"
Every Man
His Own Mechanic." Each volume will have a good
Index. A paper will be given shortly on
"
Map-
mounting and Varnishing." The plan of the magazine
will gradually develop itself according to the wishes
and requirements of its readers, and in accordance
with your suggestion, perhaps it will be found abso-
lutely necessary, at some future time,
"
to set apart a
certain portio7i for correspondence in solution to prac-
tical difficulties which the amateur may be assisted in
overcoming by having the help
of
experience"
C. R.
(
Ttnbury) asks for directions "with regard to
dados and other things which an amateur might
attempt; the simplest way to imitate stained glass
j
stencilling
j-
wooden mantelpieces
j
fashionable cup-
boards and brackets
;
picture-framesj stuffing furni-
tzirej large plates, giving patterns
of
easily-made
furnittire, brackets" etc. C. R. says that he has suc-
ceeded in accomplishing most of the above with some
success. Why does he not put his experience on
paper, and send us some articles for the benefit of his
brother amateurs. A Supplement devoted to Sten-
cilling is in preparation.
J.
M. (Cheadle) is thanked for his letter, and the
valuable suggestions that it contains. They will be
borne in mind, and acted on at some future time, when
anyone can be found who is competent to write on
"
The Use of the Lathe as applied to Amateur Cabinet
Work," in the manner
J.
M. points out. His letter
shall be submitted to a writer on "'Wood-working
Machinery," who is well versed in his especial subject.
G.
J.
{IVolvej-hampton) will find that due promi-
nence will be given to the Lathe and Lathe Work
generally ; and as a means to this end, a series of
papers on Lathe-making has been commenced in this
Part. G.
J.
would " suggest that all subjects
of a
frivolous nature, or such things that might be worked
out by the average amateur himself should be rigo-
rously excluded." Nothing frivolous will at any time
obtain a place in the pages of this magazine
; but
many of the amateurs who will buy it will doubtless
be amateurs that are only making a beginning, and
are, perhaps, below the average. These, indeed, most
require help, and on their account it will not do to
4
6 NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
neglect matters that may appear simple and below the
notice of the more skilful workman.
F. S., R. C. M., W.
J.,
and F. R. (Lisburn, Ireland)
write collectively as follows
:
Do you
not think that you are giving young men but afaint
glimmer
of
trade when you only show them the prac-
tical part
of
the work? Why not show them the
'
science
of
work ' also ?
If
you spare a few pages
each monthfor this, you will find the little work will
!
'e
of
a more flourishing character, and you will save
yourpupils a good deal
of
money du> ing the winter
season
for paying night-school masters to teach them
geometry and drawing suitable for a workman in this
a
ff
e
> f
or
if
a tradesman do not understand some-
thing
of
these things, he is nowhere now-a-days.
We hope to see our new serial work furnished with
some useful sciences which would enable young me?i to
understand something about their trade!'' The first
portion of the preceding remarks apply, it is fair to
suppose, to "Every Man His Own Mechanic," and
the last to Amateur Work, Illustrated. Neither
of these works are intended to be
"
science-teachers
;"
they are purely practical, and intended for the amateur
who knows something of theory. F. S. and his friends
will find what they require in Cassell's
"
Technical
Educator," in which theory and practice are admirably
combined.
Expectant.We cannot answer your letter, as re-
quested, thiough the medium
of
The Christian Herald,
but in the hope that this will meet your eye, we will do
so here, by saying that at some future time papers will
be given on the Manufacture of Fishing-Rods, and all
kinds of Fishing Tackle.
E. P. C. {Muswell Hill) is thanked for his sug-
gestions, and still more for his promise of a contribution
now and then. His requirements as to a discussion on
small lathes best suited for the amateur will be fully
met in our pages. New inventions and new tools and
appliances of all kinds, likely to be of service to the
amateur, will be noticed and discussed in our
"
Notes
on Novelties." E. P. C. will be able to judge from
this, the first Part of Amateur Work, Illustrated,
that all who are concerned in its production are
anxious to make the Magazine in every respect useful
and reliable.
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
N my Introductory Remarks, I have en-
deavoured to direct the attention of
inventors, manufacturers, sellers, and
buyers, to this section of Amateur
Work, Illustrated, by pointing out
that from month to month notices will be given of
new inventions, appliances, tools, and machinery
which are calculated to be useful to the amateur. It
is my intention to conduct this portion of the maga-
zine in very much the same way as that in which
Reviews and Notices of New Books are managed in
all newspapers and serial publications in which this;
valuable kind of literary work is admitted. I say;
"
in very much the same manner" advisedly, because
I mean to go a little further than the etiquette of
reviewing apparently permits in giving the reader all
the information that he can possibly" require with
regard to the article under notice. To make my
meaning perfectly clear, it will be sufficient to say,
that in reviewing a book it is thought enough to
mention its title and the names of its author and
publisher, leaving the reader entirely in the dark as
to the size, the number of pages, the price, and the
general
"
get-up
"
of the book, if I may be allowed to
use the expressionall of which are most desirable
items of information to those whom the description of
its contents and the manner in which the writer has
handled his subject, may have tempted to become
buyers. Now, in every notice that I may write of
any article, be it what it may, it is my intention to
give all these particulars fully and clearly, believing
it to be to the interest both of buyer and seller that
this should be done. That there are those who are
averse to anything of this kind I am well aware
; and
I have been amused more than once at the idea which
is always implied in their objection, and sometimes
expressed in a special rider appended to it, that the
Publishers and Editor derive benefit in some way or
other from saying all that it is possible to say about
the article itself, its price, and where and of whom it
is to be bought. Such a supposition is as absurd as
it is groundless : the publicity that is accorded to any
article is, after all, given in the interest of those who
may be inclined to buy rather than that of the makers
and sellers
; and of those who would infer that the
submittal of any manufactured article for notice in-
clines the person who has to weigh its merits to
decide in its favour, I would ask, if they think for a
moment that the sending of a copy of any work for
review has anything whatever to do with influencing
the opinion of the reviewer ? And as with the Notices
of Books, so it is with the notices of articles composed
of other materials than paper, cloth, and pasteboard.
Having thus endeavoured to clear the ground, and
to show that neither Publisher nor Editor do, or can,
derive any benefit from the Notices of Novelties given
herein, let me point out 'to inventors and makers, that
any article they may send to be examined and tested
shall receive fair and impartial consideration. Exami-
nation and test are as necessary to the reviewing, so
to speak, of a plane as of a pamphlet, or of a brace-
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
47
and-bit as of a book. Many things will, of course,
require notice that are too large and too costly to be
sent for notice ;
but in any such case, after the manner
of Mahomet and the mountain, the Editor will endea-
vour to go to the article, time and distance permitting,
if the article cannot be sent to the Editor. If neither
alternative be possible, he can only insert the manufac-
turer's own description, taking care to relieve himself
from responsibility by stating that such description
is in no way due to him, and that he is not in a posi-
tion to testify positively to the worth of the thing
described. Anyhow, he trusts that manufacturers and
makers who desire to have mention of their specialties
made in the magazine will take the trouble to make
him 'acquainted with them, by letter or otherwise
;
remembering that it is impossible for even the best
detective to know a tithe of all that it is desirable for
him to know without information given.
Mr. Edward Smith, the manufacturer and patentee,
has sent me a new preparation called Lunadine, by
which, it is said, articles made of any metal, except
iron, steel, and pewter, can be covered with a coating
of silver, without trouble and far cheaper than by the
old electro process. As its action has been described
by Mr. Edwinson, in his opening article on
"
Electro-
Plating at Home," in this Part of Amateur Work,
Illustrated, all that is necessary for me to say is
that those who wish to try it may procure it of the
manufacturer at
3,
Cheapside, London, E.C., and that
its price is is. and 2s. 6d. per bottle, or is. 2d. and
2s. ad. post free. Full directions for use are given
with each bottle.
Messrs. Bemrose and Sons, of 23, Old Bailey,
London, E.C., and Irongate, Derby, who have long
made the publication of patterns for fret-cutting one
of their specialties, have sent me Sheets 80 to 87
inclusive, of their latest designs for fret-sawers' work.
These designs have the advantage of being full-sized
working drawings, and are sold at 4d. per sheet ; a
full list, with prices, being forwarded to any applicant
on receipt of a penny stamp. The designs before me
comprise brackets of various sizes, trays, and per-
forated boards to fit into the upper part of stoves and
fire-grates. Of these last, Sheet 86 affords a beautiful
and elaborate design for this purpose, which may be
utilised for other kinds of decorative work. Of the
trays, the square form in Sheet 85 is perhaps the most
useful, and certainly the most easily cut. Two brack-
ets of pleasing form and design are given in this
sheet ; while in Sheet 82 amateurs will find a bracket
of large size and of bold but elegant design, well calcu-
lated for a clock, a lamp, a vase, or a small bust.
Amateur wire-workers will derive much assistance
in their work from making use of Hall's Double Com-
pound Lever Cutting Nippers, an instrument which
is at the same time both powerful and durable, and is
warranted to cut steel wire. Messrs. Charles Churchill
and Co., American merchants, 28, Wilson Street,
Finsbury, E.C., have been appointed sole agents for
the sale of this handy instrument in the United King-
dom. Of these nippers the Scientific American re-
marks
:
In the table,
"
s
"
signifies
"
sharp," and the pipes
so indicated will correspond with the black keys of
the pianoforte. "Gamut G" and "fiddle G" are
convenient names by which those notes may be dis-
tinguished.
And now to our carpentring again. It will already
have been perceived that an obvious and interesting
rule or law is laid down by the terms 8 ft.,
4
ft., and
2 ft., as applied to the first notes of the three lower
octaves
; and the reader has probably arrived at the
correct conclusion that the other dimensions of the
pipes will be regulated by the same easy proportion.
In truth, each octave of pipes will be as nearly as
possible half the length, and half the size in all
respects, of the octave of pipes immediately below
it ; or double the length, and double the size, of the
octave of pipes immediately above it.
Thus, if we made Tenor C 2 feet long, 2 inches
deep (internal measurement), and if inch wide, with
a mouth i an inch high, then CC will be
4
feet long,
4 inches deep, 35
inches wide, with a mouth 1 inch
high ; and Middle C will te 1 foot in length, 1 inch
in depth, and
J
of an inch in width, with a mouth
i
of an inch in height. We have, then, an easy
method of obtaining the dimensions of all our pipes.
Take a large sheet of paper (see Fig.
4)
; near one
5*
HOW TO BUILD A SMALL ORGAN.
edge draw a long straight line (or make a straight
crease) ; at one end of this line draw a perpendicular
to it of 4
inches in length; at the other end draw
another perpendicular 2 inches in length
;
join these
by a straight line passing through their
extremities. Divide the space between the
two perpendiculars into 12 equal portions,
and draw perpendiculars parallel to the
first. Then these 12 perpendicular lines
will give you the lengths of all the pipes of
the first octave infeet and inches, and all
the depths in inches andparts
of
an inch;
and it is evident that you may get all the
widths also by drawing another line through
the perpendiculars from
3$
inches at CC
to if inch at Tenor C, as shown in the
figure.
From this
"
Diapason," or Scale, the
amateur artisan may cut out all his ma-
terial, and see his work clearly before him.
It will be well to make the lowest, or first,
octave before the others, because the odds
and ends of board left after finishing these
will work up in the smaller pipes. Each
TEHOR.C.
1 ai JMcI\$&j__i
I 4- vtxJics..
J
FIG. 4. DIAPASON ON
SCALE FOR PIPES.
the width and depth of the pipes as we rise upwards.
Thus, Middle C may be allowed a clear inch, or rather
more, of width, with Ij inch of depth.
Of the upper pipes we shall say nothing at pre-
sent, because you will do well to finish the
two lower octaves (24 notes) first, and then
to make the bellows. To the bellows-
making let us now proceed, then
;
and in
the outset let me remark that you may
prepare yourself for a rough but not diffi-
cult operation. We shall require a piece
of good inch board, about 10 feet or 12 feet
long and 14 or 15 inches wide
pine is
the best, but as pine of this width cannot
be had, the width must be obtained by
clamping two pieces of stuff
7J
inches
wide, together. We shall also want some
"
mill-boards," as used by bookbinders for
the sides of ordinary books, and two or
three skins of white sheep leather, which
may be bought at the curriers' or at a
shoemaker's. This leather cannot be too
supple, but it may be reasonably stout
;
the druggists keep an excellent quality
8 ft. "gamut."
4 ft. "fiddle." 2 ft. in alt.
CC, s, DD, s, EE,FF, s G, s, A, s, B, C, s. D, s, E, F,
g, g,
s, a, s, b, c, etc f
2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, io, 11, 12,(13, J
4>
"S"
If>" *7i 18, 19, so, 21, 22, 23, 24, [25, etc
54
first octave. second octave.
FIG. 5. THE SCALE.
pipe will be made precisely as Tenor C was made
;
but the four or five larger pipes will be all the better
if put together with f-inch boards
; and material may
be saved by making the
stoppers out of ii-inch
board, fixing a strong
handle or peg in each. Do
not glue in the feet, how-
ever, until a subsequent
stage of the proceedings.
It is evident that the
same
"
Diapason," or
Scale, will serve for the
Tenor Octave, by taking
half the dimensions
marked thereon
; and
it may be remarked
that by taking double the dimensions we should be
enabled to set out the large pipes called
"
Bourdon,"
if we were concerned with them. But it will generally
be found convenient to draw a new scale for the other
octaves ;
and no harm will be done if, in drawing
this, a somewhat gentle diminution be allowed in
-THE BELLOWS, PARTLY IN SECTION, TO SHOW
ESCAPE-VALVE.
AA, the feeder ; BB, the middle board ; CC, the upper board
;
dd, the box, or trunk-band ; ee, ribs ; F, escape-valve, with
spring ; GG, gusset-pieces.
of it for the purpose of making adhesive plasters,
but their prices are somewhat high. "Wash-leather"
will not answer the purpose. Of course, if an organ-
builder will spare a few
skins, it is impossible to
get wrong.
I propose that our
bellows shall be 2 feet
6 inches in length, by 14
inches or more (accord-
ing to the size of your
boards) in width. A
glance at Fig. 6 will
show you that a begin-
ning must be made by
cutting out and planing
three boards, aa, BB, and
CC ; AA belongs to the
"
feeder ;" CC is called the
upper board ; and BB we will call the middle board.
B must be 3 feet in length, because its ends must rest
on the organ-frame ; a and c will be 2 feet 6 inches
each. Upon B fix four bars or pieces of inch stuff
very strongly, with screws and glue,^^.form a
HOW TO BUILD A SMALL ORGAN.
53
shallow box 2 feet 6 inches long (outside measure-
ment), and as wide as the board will allow, with
a depth of 3
inches (dd, Fig. 6).
Bore a number
of holes in B with your largest centrebit ;
eighteen
holes will not be too many if the bit is 1 inch in
gauge. Over each of these holes place a flap or
valve, made by gluing together two thicknesses of
the white leather ; each flap or
valve must play easily upon the
hole by allowing a single thickness
only of the leather to act as hinge
;
but take care that no valve plays
so freely as to be completely
thrown back or over. Prepare
a similar series of holes, with
valves, in the board aa for the
feeder ; and connect aa with the
under side of bb by a strong hinge
made of stout leather, or by several
hinges made of pieces of leather
strap nailed and glued to each
board.
It is now evident that to com-
plete the feeder, as shown in the
figure, two sides and one end will
be required, so arranged as to expand or contract at
pleasure. These are called "ribs," and in ordinary
organs are made of thin wooden boards, connected
together by hinges of the white leather. In the very
small bellows, however, which we are now making,
the bookbinders' mill-boards may answer the purpose
sufficiently well, and
may save much labori-
ous planing. From a
mill-board of the re-
quisite size, cut out two
side ribs and the end
rib, shaped as in Figs.
7,
8. Run a knife along
the lines A E, C D,
cutting the boards
about half through, to
form a hinge, and glue
a long strip of leather
upon the hinge so
formed. Connect these
three ribs with the feeder-board AA (Fig.
6)
by means of similar long strips of leather about 2
inches wide ; and when the glue has had time to
"
set," connect the upper edges of the ribs with the
under-side of bb (Fig. 6) in a similar manner. Open
and close the feeder cautiously in doing this, that you
may insure the neat and flat folding of the ribs.
Lastly, close up the corners by gluing on "gusset-
pieces
"
(Fig.
9)
of supple leather, amply large enough
NS
FIG. 7 PIG. 10-
FIG. 7. SIDE RIB OF FEEDER. FIG. 8.END
EIB OF FEEDER. FIG. 9. SHAPEOF GUSSET
PIECE. FIG. 10.SIDE RIB OF RESERVOIR.
lc~
FIG. II. BELLOWS, CLOSED, SHOWING COUNTERBALANCES.
The pin o is fixed in the rib frame ; the pin L is fixed in the
the pin N is fixed in the upper board. trunk-band
;
to allow the feeder its full expansion ; and glue wide
strips of leather over the main hinge of the feeder
and over the junction of the ribs with the main
hinge. All this gluing on of leatheran unpleasant
and dirty businesswill be greatly facilitated by
using a bit of sponge, moistened with warm water, to
press down the various strips into their places. The
moistening aids the adhesion of
the leather, while it cleans the
work, leaving all neat and white.
If the feeder is successful it should
now work on its hinge freely and
pleasantly, without any creaking
or any stiffness
;
and it should suck
in the air through its own valves,
and expel it through the valves in
B, with entire facility.
The upper part, or reservoir,
of the bellows is made precisely as
the feeder was made, except that
the side ribs will be rectangular,
as in Fig. 10. Glue the leather
hinges of the first, or lower, set
(see Fig. 6) to the upper edges of
the box formed on BB ; to the other
hinge of these ribs attach a light wooden frame made
of !-inch stuff; to this light frame, again, attach the
leather hinge of the second or upper set of ribs, to
which, again (but not just yet) the upper board cc will
be connected. Or it may be found less troublesome to
connect both sets of ribs first of all with the light
wooden frame by
means of inside strips
of calico glued to each,
reserving your outside
strips of leather for
the final putting toge-
ther, when the gusset-
pieces are worked in.
But, at any rate, take
care (as in the case of
the feeder) that the
ribs and frame lie
closely and flatly when
folded down.
In the upper board
CC (Fig. 6), an escape-valve must be prepared.
Cut a rectangular aperture in it
5
inches by
3
inches ; cover this aperture by a valve made of
perfectly level board, 6 inches by 4 inches, faced
with white leather, with the rough side outermost.
Fix the valve by a leather hinge on the inside
of cc, so as to open inwards
;
and on the outside fix a
strong spring (or two) of iron wire, so arranged as to
keep the valve shut. Nail the end of a string to the
54
A NEW STYLE OF STAINED-GLASS WINDOW.
middle of the board bb, and bring the other end
through a hole in the valve, tying a knot so that
the string may be tight, and may pull the valve
open, when the reservoir is quite full of air. If
the reservoir rises about 10 inches, which is amply
sufficient, then the string maybe nine inches in length,
or somewhat less. The frames, or counterbalances
(k, l, m, n, Fig. u), are for the purpose of making the
ribs of the reservoir expand equally and properly.
They may be made of any tough wood, with screws at
the jointed points. See that each screw
"
bites
"
in one
arm only, passing clear through the other
;
and use
tallow in putting these screws in, with a little black-lead
where the arms rub against each other. It will be
well to strengthen the upper board C by screwing
two ledges of inch stuff, i| inch deep, across the top,
near the ends.
I am far from denying that the bellows-making is
a rough and rather distasteful business ; but there is
no difficulty in it which patience will not readily sur-
mount. Let it be remembered that perfect air-tight-
ness must be secured in every part ; cover the corners
of the box on B with leather, and allow no crevice
whatever to remain unstopped. Leaky bellows not
only waste the wind, but give rise to unpleasant hiss-
ings which do not improve the music.
{To be continued.)
A NEW STYLE OF STAINED-GLASS
WINDOW.
HE following method of producing stained-
glass windows in large and strong sheets
suitable for the decoration of churches
and other buildings is described in a
recent part of the Art Amateur.
"
Cover the full sized cartoon with bits of flashed
glass of the appropriate colour, cut out upon the
cartoon with the diamond, the coloured face down.
Thus a mosaic of glass will be formed. Probably only
two shades of each colour will be needed, for these
pictures are seen at such a distance that the half tints
are, in a measure, lost. But if greater detail be
needed, three tints of each colour might be used
Hyposulphite of soda
Water
... 4 ounces.
... 5 ounces.
Either of these fixing solutions may be used over
and over again almost indefinitely, so that they may
be poured back into the bottle each time after using.
When the picture is fixed it has a very unpleasant,
sandy tint, and to remove this it is usual to employ a
"toning solution." Several materials are used for this
purpose, the most common being
"
bichloride of mer-
cury," or "bichloride of platinum." The former is
almost infinitely cheaper than the latter, and is, in the
writer's opinion, quite as effective. About fifteen
grains of either material, in as many ounces of water,
is a very good strength to employ. As in the case of
the fixing solution, the toning material may be used
over and over again, and should be returned to the
bottle each time after use. Toning a picture is not an
essential process, but it greatly improves the appear-
ance of a positive photograph, as it turns the sandy
tint to a pleasing purplish black.
In addition to the chemicals mentioned above, the
beginne, will require three or four ounces of photo-
grapher's varnish with which to coat his pictures when
finished, in order that they may be less liable to get
scratched or otherwise injured. A four-ounce bottle
of good varnish may be obtained for about a shilling.
As my readers will perceive for themselves, a pair
of apothecaries' scales and a set of weights will be
absolutely necessary, in order that they may make up
the necessary solutions. These may be obtained for
about three shillings and sixpence in a neat box.
Two or three glass measures will also be necessary.
The best sizes are one twenty-ounce measure, one
ounce measure, and one four-ounce measure ; all three
may be obtained for about four shillings and sixpence.
It will also be necessary for the photographer to
familiarize himself with the system of weights em-
ployed by the apothecary, including the symbols em-
ployed to represent them. In case any of my readers
have forgotten the lessons learned at school on this
subject, I subjoin a table of
Apothecaries Weight,
20 grains make one scruple
3
scruples one dram
8 drams one ounce
12 ounces one pound
9
3
3
ft
The table of liquid measure is also given here, a;
all glass measures are graduated in accordance with it
Apothecat ies' Fluid Measure.
60 minims make one fluid dram.
8 drams
one fluid ounce.
20 ounces one pint.
8 pints one gallon.
In making solutions it is important to adhere rigidly
to the formulas given, or disappointment and failure will
result. I would also remind my readers that many
of the materials employed in photography are deadly
poisons, and the most scrupulous care should be
observed in using them. Always wash the hands care-
fully before partaking of food, and be sure that all
chemicals are put out of harm's way when done with.
In addition to the chemicals named above, it will
be necessary for the beginner to supply himself with a
few more necessaries, but these are all comparatively
inexpensive. The most important will be the squares
of glass upon which the pictures are to be taken.
These may be obtained ready-cut at any photographic
repository, for from one and sixpence to fifteen shillings
per gross, according to size and quality of glass.
For cleaning the plates previous to use a soft cloth,
as free as possible from lint, will be required, and a
little
"
tripoli powder
"
will be found useful in removing
occasional stains. An ounce of this powder, which
may be obtained at any chemist's for a few pence,
should be placed in about a pint of methylated spirit,
and well shaken. A spot of this on a dirty plate,
supplemented by a little
"
elbow grease," will soon
remove the most obstinate stains.
Cleaning plates with a duster invariably leaves a
quantity of small particles on them, and it will there-
fore be necessary to provide a small camel's-hair brush,
such as is used by grainers, with which to lightly brush
these particles away.
A very useful tool is a pair of horn forceps, which
cost ninepence, and save staining the fingers.
Many operators wear a pair of India-rubber gloves
while at work, and this of course effectually prevents
the chemicals staining the hands, but as these gloves
cost six shillings a pair, and are not very durable, many
will probably look upon them as a luxury rather than
as a necessity.
The bath, and some of the other solutions, will
require occasional filtering. This is effected by means
of a piece of filter paper being r>laced in a glass funnel,
and the fluid poured on top of it. A glass funnel costs
but a few pence, and a packet containing one hundred
filter papers, ready cut, can be obtained for ninepence.
A stand to hold the filter can be easily made, or one
can be bought for about a couple of shillings. If the
fluid which is being filtered be allowed to run into a
MODELLING IN CLA Y.
59
bottle no stand is required, as the funnel can be placed
in the neck of the bottle. The filter papers are circu-
lar in shape, and when about to be used one should be
folded into four, and then opened out, when it will fit
into the funnel with ease. Care should be taken to
prevent the solution getting between the paper and the
sides of the funnel, as in this case the solution will not
be filtered at all. As some of my readers may wish to
make a funnel stand, Fig. 6 shows a very good form.
When the amateur has supplied himself with the
above apparatus and materials the next indispensable
requisite for carrying out the process is a dark
room, in which to prepare and develope the plates.
In my next paper I intend giving full instructions for
building a special dark room, accompanied by working
drawings
; but some of my readers may have a small
room at their disposal, which they may, with a little
trouble and ingenuity, adapt for the purpose. I will,
therefore, point out the essentials which are, >n
"urn
h
case, absolutely required. It must be borne in mind
that in the "wet" process, which I intend first to
describe, it is of importance to exclude all -dilute
light; but the room may, nevertheless, be fairly lighted
with orange-coloured light, which has no action upon
iodide of silver, and is therefore said to be
"
non-
actinic." If, therefore, a suitable room is at hand it is
only necessary to carefully exclude all white light, and
to fill in the window, either with orange-coloured glass,
or to cover the white glass with paper of the requisite
tint. The cost of this paper is two shillings per quire.
It must be borne in mind that every chink which
will admit white light must be stopped up, and that the
door should shut quite close
;
if it do not it is best to
have a black curtain on the inside, which can be drawn
over after the door is shut. If these precautions be
neglected your pictures will be spoilt.
Havingsecurely shut out all but non-actinic light from
the operating room, all that is necessary will be a shelf
upon which to keep the necessary solutions, and some
means ofwashing the plates. If the water is not laid into
the room, a jug and basin will answer for this purpose.
If it is not convenient to fill the window of the
work-room with non-actinic material, the room may be
entirely darkened, and a lamp or candle used, but in
this case an orange-coloured glass or shade should be
placed round the light. A good plan is to place some
green glass or other materLl over the orange, as this
neutralises the somewhat unpleasant effect of a yellow
light, without interfering with its non-actinic properties.
Whatever be the nature of the dark room employed,
a small spirit lamp will be required, not as a source of
light, but for warming plates previous to varnishing
them. Some glass stirring rods, which costs one
shilling per pound, will also be found very useful.
(To be continued.)
MODELLING IN CLAY.
AN INTRODUCTION TO THE ART OF CARVING
IN WOOD.
II.The Management and Manipulation of the Clay.
LAY is a very peculiar substance, and when
the amateur first begins to handle it, he
will encounter a great many difficulties
which to him will appear to be insur-
mountable; and possibly they would be
so, if he neglected to attend with scrupulous care to
the instructions which are about to be given for ovei-
coming them. By this means, however, its manage-
ment may be made quite easy, and its use attended
with very little trouble.
Perfectly pure clay, like Kaolin, or porcelain clay, is
much too soft and greasy for use in its raw state ; and
the amateur, as it has been stated in the previous
article, must not attempt to use it in this condition,
but must procure it prepared for the purpose in view
from one or other of the sources that have been indi-
cated. It must not be supposed, however, from what
has been just said, that clay is an utterly intractable
material. On the contrary, it has so many good and
pleasant qualities, that, although numberless efforts
have been made to find a substitute for it for making
models of work in relief, none have yet been discovered
which at all approach it in its almost numberless
advantages.
In order to trace all the steps necessary to be taken
in its manipulation, it is needful to describe the pro-
gress of a piece of work from its commencement to
its completion. A bracket which is not to be perforated
will form a very good lesson. In actual practice the
design will probably be given in some such form as
shown in Fig. 8
at least, no more than this will be
found in a tracing, or the outline patterns usually fur-
nished to work from. This design consists of a spray
of leaves. There is little or no indication of relief;
the whole of this portion of the work is to be left to
the carver. In the first place, the design must be
transferred in lead pencil to the slate or board on which
the modelling is to be done. White marble slabs offer
a very good surface on which to prepare a model, as
they show lead-pencil marks so plainly. Lead pencils
may also be used upon slate. The amateur modeller
must be careful to have the whole outline upon the slab
before beginning the work of putting on the clay.
Little inaccuracies need not be noticed, as they can be
corrected during the progress of the work. When the
outline has been traced on the modelling board, the
work is ready for the clay. The design presented to
the amateur in Fig. 8 is intended to be carved in a
sunken panel. No portion of it will, therefore, rise
6o
MODELLING IN CLA Y.
FIG. II.CLAY PROPERLY
APPLIED.
above the general level of the sides
or framing which encloses the
panel, as shown in the profile.
The drawing is not made to scale,
and the modeller may suit the
work, as far as size is concerned, to
his own requirements. In the bracket
now before him, the measurement trans-
versely may be taken at
9
inches, and vertically
at
10J
inches, or even 11 inches.
After getting a bowl of water, and a tolerably large
brusha painter's dusting-brush will do, or even a small
whisk-brush, made of cocoa-nut fibrewith which to sprinkle
the clay from time to time, to prevent it from drying too rapidly,
the operator is ready to begin work. The first thing to be done
is to take a piece of clay, and roll it into a little cylinder between
the thumb and finger, as shown in Fig. 9. This cylinder, when made,
must be laid along some portion of the outline, and the modeller must
press it down firmly with the forefinger of the left hand upon the slate, at
the same time preventing it from spreading over the line by means of the
chisel-shaped tool (see Fig.
3,
page 12), which
is held against the slate upon the outline. The
method of doing this is clearly shown in Fig. 10.
In this way the whole outline can be easily followed
in all its details. It is necessary to be sure that the
clay is packed closely down upon the slate, touching
it in every part, so that no air-bubbles are left, and no
cracks or upraised edges are to be seen. If the leaf is
wide, and the roll of clay does not spread all the way
across, the margin will appear in section as shown in Fig. 1 1.
Both edges when they meet the slate are squeezed down
firmly, so as to be in close contact with it.
Fig. 11, it should be said, shows how the work
would appear if it were properly laid down
on the slate, and then cut across with some
suitable instrument, so as to show the section,
a portion being removed for this purpose from
one side of the incision or the other. Fig. 12,
on the contrary, shows in section a piece of clay that has been
improperly put on the slate, and not pressed firmly down to it,
the edges appearing rough and upraised from the slate, and an
air-bubble below the mass towards the edge on the right.
When clay is put on in this manner, it is liable to crack off, and
cannot be firmly united to anything that may be put on after-
wards. The amateur modeller may be recommended to try the
effect of two pieces of clay placed near together on the slatethe
one properly and perfectly, the other improperly and imperfectly,
and to note the result. He will thus gather knowledge from actual
trial, and the experience thus gained will be of as much use to
him as any that may be gained by mere accident ; and he will
have the satisfaction of not having obtained his experience
through coming to grief over any piece of actual work. In
making the stems, where a rough roll of clay, when pressed
firmly, will extend all the way across the outline, or, rather, the
space between the outlines that indicate its limits on either side.
A
FIG. 12. CLAY BADLY APPLIED.
FIG. 8. PATTERN
OF BRACKET TO
BE MODELLED
IN CLAY.
FIG. 13.BUILDING UP EDGE WITH ROLL OF CLAY.
FIG. 9.MAKING SMALL ROLL OF CLAY.
MODELLING IN CLA Y. 61
the tool can be used first on one side and then on
the other, and so the clay can be kept within bounds
while being pressed down upon the slate.
In joining two pieces of clay together, or putting a
piece upon work already begun, it is necessary to make
the surfaces smooth that are to come together, and
somewhat moister than the other portions. Then, after
they have been joined with the tool, or fingers, smooth
up and obliterate any trace of the joint. They will
thus adhere firmly. If the line of joining is not oblite-
with the other. No portion will have to be destroyed,
because it has been modelled without a suitable foun-
dation.
After the outline has been solidly fastened by pres-
sure and guidance of the chisel-shaped tool to the
slab or board, the building-up may be begun by apply-
ing little rolls of clay along the middle or sides, as the
case may be. How this is done is shown in Fig.
13,
in which the process of building-up, or heightening an
edge with a roll of clay, is exhibited. After the roll is
FIG. 10.APPLYING CLAY AND FILLING UP FIGURE DRAWN IN OUTLINE ON SLAB.
rated a crack is begun, and the added piece is
always liable to come off, or the work will inevitably
j
break at that point.
When the outline is all finished, and no more can
be done to perfect it, the work is necessary for the
next step. Here it is necessary to observe in model-
ling no two steps should ever be mixed
; all parts of
the work should be in the same stages. The reason
for this the amateur will find out to his sorrow when-
ever he violates it. He must take care to have all the
outline filled before the following step of building-up
is begun, and then there will be no interference of one
pressed down in place, the chisel-shaped- tool must
again be brought into operation to smooth the edge
and obliterate the mark where the clay joins upon the
edge of the work, and the finger can do the same
work for the seam upon the surface.
This process of building-up should be carried on
until the outside wall, which represents the surface of
the board from which the design is to be carved, is as
high as it is designed to make the bottom of the panel
deep. When a leaf or a stem is raised to a proper
height, smooth it up, giving it vertical sides and a flat
top, as if it were intended to have it in this condition.
62
MODELLING IN CLA J".
The finish, indeed, should be carefully imparted as if
it were intended to leave it thus.
In order that the beginner may have as little
trouble as possible in carrying out his work, he should
attend to the following items in regard to the manage-
ment of his material. He has been already made
acquainted with the modes and method to be scrupu-
lously and precisely followed in its manipulation.
Do not, on any account, hold a piece of clay too
long in the hand. It soon becomes warm, and the
consequence is that the moisture will rapidly evaporate
from it, leaving the clay too dry to be worked properly.
This should be noted, and the piece in the fingers
frequently changed, throwing that which has become
too dry, ^and which has, in consequence, hardened,
back into the bowl or box in which the supply is kept.
Clay absorbs water with great rapidity, and in very
considerable quantities. During the progress of the
work the beginner must be constantly on his guard to
have water enough, and, at the same time, not too
much. The consistency of soft putty is what should
be aimed at, and this will be a good guide for the
amateur in keeping his material fit for manipulation
and in thorough working order. There is this diffe-
rence, however : soft putty when worked about in the
hand, in fastening in a pane of glass, gets sticky and
clings to the fingers, small portions breaking away
from the main mass, but clay will not do this, as it is
more truly cohesive than putty. It will soil the fingers,
but when of a suitable consistency for working it will
not stick to them.
When beginning any piece of work, the clay may
be used in a much softer condition than is necessary
as the work progresses. After the first stage, the clay
that is applied to the work should be softer than the
work itself. It then stays in place better, and does
not disturb the mass. When laid on wet, the absorp-
tion of the water by the drier clay below brings the
two portions closely into contact, and makes a solid
joint.
The clay can best be kept in a wooden pail with a
tight cover. Amateurs will find the wooden tubs in
which lard is sent to this country from America suitable
receptacles for clay, when carefully washed and freed
from grease. Some of these are already fitted with
covers, and are used in many households as flour-tubs.
They are furnished with a wooden handle, which
turns on two pins, one on either side, after the manner
of the handle of a pail, and is convenient for lifting
them from place to place. They may be bought of
most grocers or buttermen, for a shilling or there-
abouts. When set aside for a time, the clay must be
sprinkled with water, and a wet cloth thrown in on top
of it, to prevent the moisture from evaporating. While
at work, especially in a warm room, it may need fre-
quent sprinkling in order to keep it in good working
condition. As the clay has a constant tendency to
grow drier by the evaporation of moisture, it is desirable
after it has been standing for some days, to knead it
thoroughly before beginning work, so that all portions
may be of the same consistency. Other things being
equal, a light-coloured clay is better than one of a
darker tint, because it brings out the light and shade
of the work better.
When the work has been under way for some time,
and is considerably hardened, so as to be somewhat
firm to the fingers, it can be finished much better than
when it is in the soft and plastic condition so desirable,
and, indeed, so necessary, at the commencement.
Moist clay is not entirely plastic, though it seems
so at first touch. In working the clay after the model
has been blocked out, the amateur must not attempt
any alteration of form by pressure. He must not try
to make a hollow by pressing the finger into the mass,
or to make an elevation by squeezing the materials
up. Any attempt to work in this way invariably
results in the distortion of the neighbouring parts.
When hollows are required, the clay should be cut
out ; and when a projection or elevation is wanted, it
should be obtained by building it up with new material.
If the clay that is added is a little softer than that
on which it is placed, there will be no danger of dis-
turbing the surrounding portions of the work. Careful
attention to this rule will save a great deal of annoy-
ance and unnecessary labour after a subject is well
advanced.
It is little by little, and step by step, that the
greatest results are invariablyaccomplished and brought
about ; and if the amateur sedulously follows the in-
structions given in these papers seriatim, noting every
particular as to what to do and what to avoid, care-
fully putting them into practice, he cannot fail to attain
proficiency in the art of modelling in clay, in due time.
He has been shown how to make all the tools and
appliances that are required, and how to manage and
manipulate the material that he must use. He has
also been fully instructed in the mode of drawing a
subject in outline on the board, executing this outlin
in clay by the aid of his fingers and modelling tool,
and building it up to the necessary height. The best
thing that he can do for the present is to practise the
manipulation of the clay in making outlines, and
placing it firmly on the board, bearing in mind that
this practice will help to produce perfection when he
proceeds to carry a piece of work from its commence-
ment to its completion. Time employed in practising
is never time lost, although to those who wish to have
something to show for the time taken up it may some-
times appear so.
(
To be continued.)
LATHE-MAKING FOR AMATEURS.
63
LATHE-MAKING FOR AMATEURS.
By PAUL N. RASLVCK.
An Amateur's Lathe Described.
EFORE proceeding to describe the details
of a plain lathe that could be constructed
by an amateur, it will be advisable to
make him acquainted with the general
construction of a lathe of more compli-
cated form. The objects of various contrivances will
be made known in this manner. The amateur will
also become acquainted with the technicalities of lathe
making. Before attempting to make for oneself it is
well worth while to carefully examine what has been
made by others. The investigation can but lead
to the' acquirement of knowledge. A careful in-
spection of a good lathe will enable us to judge the
particular essentials that are most to be desired in a
lathe adapted to suit any special purposes. Those
who intend to devote their attention chiefly to wood
turning will require a light running lathe
; one that
can be driven at a high speed. If metal work is to
be undertaken, a heavier tool is wanted, and for large
work back gearing is necessary. For many purposes
a slide-rest is indispensable ;
it is, however, a costly
addition to a lathe, and as much work is done without
the aid of a slide-rest, this adjunct is frequently dis-
pensed with. It may be e.dded to a lathe at any
subsequent time, and when an amateur has thoroughly
mastered the uses of hand-turning tools he will be
better able to appreciate the value of a slide-rest.
Tools fixed in a slide-rest cannot be made to
accommodate themselves to the peculiarities of the
work, as may be managed with hand tools. A gouge,
or chisel may be tilted a trifle more or less, at the
discretion of the operator, who judges by the effect
produced. When it is obvious that the best result is
attained, the workman at once knows that he is apply-
ing the tool to the best advantage. In the slide-rest
the tool is fixed, and therefore it is of the greatest
importance that it should be fixed in the best position.
The great difference in the effect caused by a very
trifling alteration in the height of a tool, or the angle
at which it is applied can only be estimated justly by
those who have themselves worked with hand tools.
The best advice that can be given to a learner is, com-
mence by using hand tools, and thoroughly master
them before attempting to work with slide-rests and
automatic gear. Also begin with wood-turning in
preference to metal-turning. The former is more
difficult than the latter to a novice, but nevertheless it
should be the first branch for practice.
Tools used for wood have keener edges, and the
material under operation is more easily wrought. It
follows naturally that the difference between good and
bad workmanship is more easily discerned. Cutting
and scraping are obviously different processes when
wood is operated upon, but in dealing with metal the
totally unpractised manipulator may be less able to dis-
tinguish clearly the difference. Some metals crumble
under the action of the cutting tool, and the portion
removed falls in powder, that it is difficult to recognize
as having been cut off. In wood the action of a
cutting edge is apparent at a glance
; if the material
is separated by splitting, the surface reveals the fact.
A turning chisel applied too nearly approaching a
radial position will
"
dig in," and by stopping the lathe,
or breaking will at once show it. If too much in the
other direction tangentially it will not cut. The
operator will soon learn to appreciate the difference,
and will profit by his experience when working in
other substances. At a future time the cutting angles
of various turning tools may be discussed more fully.
A good plain slide-rest is shown at Fig.
5. The
apparatus illustrated is one made by the Britannia
Company, Colchester, and the design is of the best.
The figure shows a top view, the lower slide is at right
angles to the lathe-bed, the upper one lying parallel
with it. Having the two slides, it is called a com-
pound slide-rest, but it may be mentioned here that
a slide-rest with only one slide is, comparatively
speaking, an object that may take rank with a one-
wheeled coach, both for usefulness and rarity. The
price of the apparatus shown, is in accordance with its
size, and ranges from 2 for a rest suited to a 2A inch
lathe, to ,8
for one suited to an 8 inch. The large
rests being somewhat different in design.
Such apparatus as slide-rests cannot be made by
amateurs, unless they be very expert ; it will there-
fore be advisable to purchase them complete and
ready to fit on the lathe-bed. To guide those who
may contemplate purchasing, I have only to repeat
that a slide-rest should be strong enough at all parts,
not merely to resist absolute breakage, but to main-
tain perfect rigidity under the wear and tear of a
heavy cut. Several items have to be taken into con-
sideration, when judging the strength, or rather in-
flexibility, of a slide-rest. A certain amount of metal
is requisite to make a solid tool, but much more
depends upon the way in which it is fashioned than
appears to be generally understood. The design,
independent of the weight, is an item of great import-
ance, though judging from the clumsy apparatus that
are frequently seen, it is one that is often neglected.
Good fitting in the sliding parts is essential to the
main object in view. A carefully-fitted slide-rest, of
neat and elegant design, will stand more hard wear
and tear than half-a-dozen of the clumsy, heavy* badly-
64 LATHE-MAKING FOR AMATEURS.
proportioned tools that are sometimes manufactured
for sale.
The screws that actuate the sliding saddles, and
called leading-screws, should be made of steel. The
saddles should be long, to afford ample bearing sur-
face, and also to protect the screws from dust and
turnings. The tool-holder shown is good for small
rests and light work, but one having two clamping
screws should be used on large rests for heavy work.
Unless the slide-rest tool rested flat on the top saddle
of the rest the tool would be apt to chatter if clamped
by one screw only.
The slide-rest is well designed, and very similar to
the illustration (Fig.
5),
with a saddle-piece added to
it. The rack fixed under the dovetail is to allow the
slide-rest to be wound
along the bed quickly. The
long handle, which is
slightly out of place in the
drawing, has a pinion gear-
ing in the rack, and by this
contrivance the slide-rest
may be wound along the
bed from end to end. It
will be readily understood
that the saddle being fitted
to slide tightly on the bed,
the rest cannot be shifted
along as in ordinary lathes.
The top slide of the rest
swivels over on either side,
about 50
for turning
cones, etc. The saddle on
which it swivels is gradu-
ated in degrees, so that
the amount of taper may
be readily determined. The
back poppit is fitted with
a square-threaded steel screw, and a bright turned
hand-wheel.
The entire lathe weighs i cwt., and is sold com-
plete for fifteen guineas. This includes two chucks,
a face plate and centre plate, spanners, band, etc.,
as illustrated.
While on the subject it will be well to give full
particulars of screw-cutting gear. This particular
branch will then be done with, and need not be brought
up again in a subsequent chapter. "Lathe-Work."
contains an entire chapter devoted to screw-cutting
by self-acting motion, and it will be found a compre-
hensive treatise on the subject
To fully understand the theoretical principles of
screw-cutting in the lathe, by automatic traverse, we will
hypothetically treat a cylindrical rod turned true, and
tunning between the lathe-centres. A cutting tool is
fixed in the slide-rest, this is geared with the leading
screw which runs in bearings parallel to the cylindrical
rod. When the rotary motion of the cylinder is
imparted to the screw, and they are both revolving,
the slide-rest will traverse in the direction of the
axis of the work. If the tool is made co cut the
work, a spiral groove will be produced, this being the
screw-thread. It is evident that when the cylinder
and the guide-screw make equal revolutions contem-
poraneously, the thread cut on the cylinder will be the
same rate or pitch as that of the guide-screw. Further,
if the guide-screw and the cylinder revolve in the same
direction, the threads will be in the same direction,
but if the rotation is in contrary directions the threads
will be reversedthat is, one will be right-handed, and
the other left-handed-
When the relative velocity
of the guide-screw and
cylinder is varied, the ratio
between the respective
threads is varied in the
same proportion. Thus
when the cylinder m; kes
two revolutions to each one
revolution of the guide
screw, the thread cut will
have twice the number of
threads per inch that the
guide-screw has. These
conditions, once perfectly
understood, screw-cutting,
by means of change-wheels,
will be no longer the
mystery it is to some.
When the pitch of the lead-
ing screw is known, the
production of threads of
any desired ratio is
merely a matter of calculation.
Heavy screw-cutting lathes, and indeed most lathes
in general use, have cast-iron change-wheels. These
are very cheap and effective. High class lathes,
made without regard to cost, are frequently fitted
with gun-metal, or brass, engine-cut wheels. The
teeth in these engine-cut wheels are much finer than
those that are cast. Cast wheels, for foot-lathes, are
generally about 10 or 12 pitch, cut wheels are from
16 to 20 pitch. Here we may explain that "pitch"
means the number of teeth per inch diameter. A
wheel
5
inches in diameter, and 10 pitch, would have
50 teeth ; if it were 20 pitch, it would have 100 teeth.
A simple train of wheels consists of three only
;
two have to be in definite proportion, the third is
merely an idle wheel. One is fixed on the mandrel
rl
^7
CJ M
FIG. 4.DETAIL OF FRONT AND RUNNERS.
Vr
FIG. 5.CONSTRUCTION OF DRAWERSSIDE VIEW.
FIG. 7.NOTCHED SLIPS IN DRAWER TO HOLD KNIVES.
been done, it will be better
to secure the casing thus con
structed with clamps, and
leave it thus for about
twenty-four hours, until the
glue is perfectly hard.
For the bottom a piece
of wood must be cut 11
inches x 8 inches, which may
be dropped into its place,
and be fitted against and
glued to the runners attached
to the sides, to receive the
large drawer at the bottom,
and two extra pieces | inch
square placed between the
ends of these at front and
back, so as to form a frame.
Small blocks may be put at
intervals in the angle formed
bythe bottom and the interior
of the casing
that surrounds
it, in order to
strengthen the
structure. For
theplinthpieces
must be cut
2 inches wide,
andofthe shape
shown in Figs. 1
and 2, and
attached to the
exterior of the
casing, so as to overlap it,
and extend or project
beyond it. One inch is
allowed for the attachment
of the plinth to the casing,
the bottom of which is
denoted in these illustra-
tions by dotted lines. In
order to take away from
the abruptness of the
angle formed by the plinth
and casing, a small
moulding,
\ inch square,
hollowed along one edge,
as shown on a larger scale
at N in Fig.
4,
may be
dropped into the angle all
round by way of finish.
It was in order to form a
holding for the plinth and
moulding just described,
H
D; F |E
FIG. 6.END VIEW OF
DRAWER.
70 A CHEST OF DRA JVERS IN MINIATURE.
and the similar moulding at the top, that the casing
was made 14 inches in height.
In order to complete the casing, nothing now re-
mains but to put on the top. The board which forms
the top is 14 inches X 11 inches. The edges are
rounded, as shown at O in Fig.
4,
and a moulding is
placed below it, attached to the casing, as at N. When
the top has been fastened down, ledges should be
placed round it at the back and sides. The ledges
should be 2 inches deep, and] made of \ inch stuff.
They are fitted on to the top, directly over the sides
and back of the casing below.
The length of the drawers in front will depend on
the width of the drawers at the sides of the cabinet,
and vice versa. Suppose, for the sake of argument,
that the width of the side
drawers is
5
inches, as shown
in Fig. 2, then the length of
the front drawers will be
5
inches, measuring from
fig. 8.partition in large
the surface of the framing
DRAWER.
that forms the front_ Qf
course, it will be understood that it is necessary to
regulate the width and length of the drawers respec-
tively in front and at the sides before commencing the
work
; and before the amateur puts tool to wood, he
should prepare accurate working drawings of every
part.
The construction of the drawers is shown in Figs.
5
and 6, which are drawn on a scale of 6 inches to the
foot. First of all, a piece of wood is cut, 1% inches
square, supposing the drawer under consideration to
be one of the small drawers in front, which should fit
accurately but easily into the opening in the framing
of the front whkflfc it is intended to fill. In order to
secure a close joint, a piece of wood % inch thick, and
overlapping the block on every side by inch, and
therefore 2# inches square, is^glued to the front. This
accounts for the projections shown at the sides of
Fig. 1, and on the left side of Fig. 2. The edge of
this projecting piece should be taken off all round,
being bevelled or gently rounded as the amateur artisan
may prefer. Before proceeding with the construction
of the drawer, it may be said that the drawer may be
finished in front by a small knob, not more than
J
inch
in diameterless than this would be betteror a ring
passing through a small knob, to which a screw is
attached. This, however, is a matter of minor detail,
n which the amateur must be left to follow the bent o;
his inclination.
To return to the construction of the drawer, the front
block,
\
inch thick and 2| inches square, is shown by E F
G H, and the overlapping piece by the dotted lines out-
side and parallel with the lines E F, F G, G H, H e. Fig.
5
gives a longitudinal section of the drawer, showing
how the different parts are put together. Thus A is
the piece that enters the opening in the framework
of the front, and B the piece that overlaps it. Sup-
posing that the drawers are made of
\
inch stuff, a
rabbet
i
inch square must be made round the
\
mcn
block. Two pieces of wood
4!
inches by 2I inches
are then cut for the sides, and another piece of the
same length, and if
inches wide for the bottom,
shown in section at c in Figs. 5
and 6, while the sides
are shown in section at D and E in Fig. 6. At \ inch
from the inner end of the sides and bottom a shallow
groove, say
to
inch in depth, is made to receive the
back. F, shown in section in Fig.
5,
and in elevation
in Fig. 6, the dotted lines showing the extent of the
back, and the solid lines the extent of the sides and
bottom in section. When the pieces are ready, each
drawer should be glued up, and secured otherwise
with a few small brads. If it be thought desirable, a
cover may be made to the drawer, sliding in small
grooves in the sides and front, as shown at G in
section in Fig.
5,
and in elevation in Fig. 6, the
depression at H denoting a thumb-notch for the with-
drawal of the sliding cover.
The large drawer at the bottom, if used for the
reception of knives as a knife-box, or for putting away
chisels or carving tools, may be fitted with slips cr
even blocks of wood from
f
inch to
\
inch thick, and
from i inch to I inch deep, placed apart at such dis-
tances as may be found necessary. These are de-
noted in Fig.
7,
by the notched slips A, B, c. In the
figure which represents a view of the interior of the
large drawer, these slips are arranged for the reception
of table-knives. The figure is not drawn to scale, as
the dimensions and notches must be regulated by the
amateur according to his own requirements. For
knives blocks about 1 inch in length would be as well
as, or even better than slips, but the slips need not be
glued down to the bottom of the drawer, and are
therefore removable at pleasure. A slip might be
placed on each side of the drawer, and another in the
centre, as shown in the figure, so regulated that the
narrow openings in the middle slip are opposite the
wide openings in the side slips. Thus the handles of
two knives oppositely placed, may be dropped into
the wide openings at the sides, and their blades
would fall into the narrow opening in the centre. If
intended for the reception of cutlery, the drawer should
be lined entirely, and the blocks covered with green
baize or soft leather. It will be found useful if the
large drawer at the bottom be used as a knife-box, to
put a partition across it from side to side, shaped as
in Fig. 8, and slipped into the shallow grooves in the
sides. The partition, which helps to strengthen the
drawer, must be well glued and bradded in.
Lastly, to those amateurs who may not be skilful
VIOLIN MAKING: AS IT IV AS, AND IS. 7i
enough to make these small drawers, or who may be
disinclined to make so many, it may be said that they
can save themselves much labour and trouble in this
way, by buying at a tobacconist's a number of small
cigar-boxes to serve as the drawers, and adapting the
carcase to the dimensions of the boxes. Nothing
more is then necessary than to glue on a piece of thin
wood, larger than the end of the box every way by
f
inch, to form the overlapping face, and secure a close
joint. The wood used for the carcase of such a chest
of drawers in miniature as has been described, should
be good clean pine, and the drawers, if not formed of
cigar-boxes to save trouble, should be made of the
same material. Mahogany may be used, of course, if
the amateur prefers it, and this would look better than
pine for household use.
VIOLIN MAKING: AS IT WAS, AND IS.
By EDWARD H. ALLEN.
H
I.The History and Origin of Bowed Instruments.
HE series of articles, of which this is the
first, is dedicated to that large brother-
hood of amateurs whose ambition has
prompted them to inquiretoo often
without response "How to make a
fiddle?" The object of these chapters will be to
enlighten them on this subject, and to set before them
the directions and rules which they must follow to
attain their object The exterior form of this king of
musical instruments varies considerably when viewed
with the eye of a connoisseur
; but though with a little
experience these differences are easily discernible, it
requires the study of yearsnay, of a life time, it has
been said, before one can say, on seeing an instru-
ment,
"
That scroll was chiselled by Nicolaus Amati,
that outline was cut by Stradivarius, this vamish was
compounded and laid on by Guarnerius," and so on.
"
Bah
!
" I fancy I hear some one say,
"
as if there
was any difference in fiddles." To that man I should
say,
"
Go to any collector, and get him to show you a
Long Strad and a Grand Amati, a Gasparo Tenor
and one by Kennedy, and come back
"
a wiser and
humbler man." This art of
"
naming" instruments is a
very rare one
;
perhaps no one ever understood it better
than the late Mr. Charles Reade, who is no better
known for his literary and dramatic works, than as an
enthusiastic and genuine collector and connoisseur
of
the members of the violin family. To his valuable
letters, published in the
"
Pall Mall Gazette,"
August,
1872 (the time of the Great Exhibition of Musical
Instruments at South Kensington), we are indebted
for much valuable information in the forthcoming
chapters.
Before entering upon the purely mechanical portion
of the art of violin making, I will, as shortly as pos-
sible, go over in review, the history, origin, and makers
of the violin, and its relations, which since its perfec-
tion in its present form, in the sixteenth century, may
justly be said to have ruled the musical world. For
fuller details, into which time and space forbid me to
go, I cordially recommend to my readers the valuable
and interesting works of Messrs. Hart, Dubourg,
Sandys and Forster, and those of MM. Fetis and
Coussemaker, whose principal works have been trans-
lated from the original French, and which ought to
form a leading feature in every violinist's library.
With these few remarks, by way of introduction, for
which I crave the indulgence of my readers, I will pro-
ceed to consider the history and origin of the four
instruments, which are the principals in every or-
chestra, and of whom the smallest is the king : namely,
the Violin, Viola (Alto, Tenor, Ouinte), Violoncello
(Basse), and Violon (Double-bass, Contre-basse). I
shall confine myself to rapidly sketching the outlines
of the progress of the instrument from the earliest
antiquity to the sixteenth century, which saw the com-
pletion of the violin in its present form, which has not
altered since that time, though a few important experi-
ments on alteration of shape, to which I shall refer in
a future chapter, have been made.
Going straight back to the ancient Egyptians, we
find, on the Tomb of Osirtasen I., (the probable
Pharaoh of Joseph,) a group of figures, perhaps repre-
senting the arrival of the Israelites in Egypt, one of
which is playing an instrument (Fig.
1), which it will
be seen is, roughly, very like the
"
crwth " of the
Ancient British and Welsh ; but with this difference,
that it was played with the fingers, or plectrum. It is
on this word plectrum that, a great deal turns. If the
word
"
plectrum
"
can properly be construed
"
bow," as
it too often is, the use of bowed instruments is little
short of pre-historic ; but it is not so : the highest
authorities agreeing that the plectrum was an instru-
ment used for hitting or plucking the strings. It is
held by learned classics and antiquarians, that the
Phoenicians colonized Spain, and that Britain was
peopled from thence long before the Roman invasion
;
and as they naturally took their music with them, it is
at least plausible to argue that the bow was an inven-
tion introduced in this country, suggested by the
friction of the plectrum. According to Mr. Carl Engel
(who advances strong evidence in support), the inven-
tion of the bow belongs to the Hindoos, who used it
with an instrument called
"
ravanastron," at least
2000 years ago. That the chrotta, crwth, or crwd,
was a British instrument, is evidenced by the words
72
VIOLIN MAKING : AS IT WAS, AND IS,
I.ANCIENT STRINGED IN-
STRUMENT.
some considered identical with the
chrotta, or crwth, is the "rotta,"
or
"
rote," which was more or less
incurved at the sides, to give play
to the bow, as in the old oblong
shape the bow must necessarily
have struck several strings at once,
though, according to M. Fetis, the
rote was a percussion instrument of
the guitar description.
M. de Coussemaker gives an
illustration from a MS. of the
eleventh century, at Limoges, of a
crwth, or rote, with three strings,
which is reproduced in Fig. 2.
There is also one in Worcester
Cathedral (Fig.
3),
of about the
twelfth century, which is figured by
Carter in his
"
Antient Sculptures,"
which will be seen to have been
held like the modern violin. M. de
Coussemaker gives an illustration
(Fig.
4)
of a crwth of the thirteenth
century, from the Cathedral at
Amiens, which has six strings, and
sound-holes
of Venantius Fortu-
natus, Bishop of Poic-
tiers, who, A.D.
570,
mentions the "Chrotta
Britanna." This early
instrument has lasted
to comparatively re-
cent times among the
Welsh, and we can
trace its existence from
century to century
among old sculptures,
MSS., and the like.
Derived from, and by
one John Morgan,
of Newburgh, Angle-
sea. I give a figure of
the six-stringed crwth
(Fig. 6), which conse-
quently needs no
further description.
Attention is directed
to the arrangement of
the six strings, four on,
and two off the finger-
board, which last
appear to have been
played pizzicato with
VIOL (10TH CENTURY).
FIG. 2.ANCIENT CRWTH OR ROTE.
FIG. 3. CRWTH
TURY).
not unlike the
modern/ holes. We find it
again among the sculptures
ortside Melross Church, built
in the fourteenth century
;
and we have a poetical des-
cription of the instrument
given us by Edward Jones,
in his
"
Reliques of the
Welsh Bards," from which
description it appears that
the back of the instrument
bulged like the modern violin
back. As late as 1770, Daines
th cen-
Barrington described the
crwth as being played by
the thumb, the flattish bridge placed
obliquely, the circular sound-holes,
through the left of which one of the
legs of the bridge passing to the
back serves as a sound-post, the
other resting naturally on the belly.
I believe only one specimen of this
primitive instrument now exists,
the property of W. G. Wynne, Esq.,
who exhibited it at South Kensing-
ton in 1872. This unique instru-
ment is figured by Sandys and
Forster, without strings, bridge, or
tail-piece. It is labelled
1742, but
is probably of far greater antiquity
;
it measures 22 inches in length,
gj
in width, and 2 in depth ; the
finger-board measuring io| inches.
From the word chrotta, crwth, or
crwd, comes the old English word
"
crowd," for a fiddle, which is met
with in a Cornish play of the four-
teenth century (the Cornish dialect
being identical as to origin with the
Welsh). Middleton uses the word
seventeenth, and in the
Richards in the eighteenth
century. It is also met with
in the works of Ben Jonson
and Marston.
The word
"
fiddle
"
is of
immense antiquity, being
derived in all languages from
the old Gothic. Thus we
have in the old German, vide
(a fiddle), videtere (a fiddler)
videln (to fiddle) ; in the
Icelandic, fidla ; in th
Danish, fedel ; in the Dutch
videl, viool, and veel ; the
Flemish, videl
;
and the
FIG. 5.GIGUE (BOS-
CHERVILLE).
VIOLIN-MAKING : AS IT WAS, AND IS.
IS
FIG. 10. THREE-STRINGED
VIOL 'I2TH CENTURY). FIG. 14.VIOI. DA GAMRA ft6;oV
FIG. IS
PERA, OR POCHE,
WITH BOW '1636V
74
VIOLIN MAKING: AS IT WAS, AND IS.
modern German, fidel, or fiedel. All these are given
in M. Dubourg's interesting work on the violin. As
an Anglo-Saxon word,
"
fythele
"
is of great antiquity,
as countless extracts prove, of which I shall only quote
one, from the legendary life of St. Christopher, written
about A.D. 1200, In this we find
"
Chrystofre hym served longe,
The Kynge loved melody of fythele and of song.**
From the word
"
fythele " is probably derived the
French word
"
vielle," which is now only applied to
the hurdy-gurdy, which is nearly allied to the old
"
organistrum," which is well represented in the
museum at Rouen, from a bas-relief of the twelfth
century, at Boscherville.
A great advance in the way of change of shape is
mentioned in a MS. of the fourteenth century, which
ascribes to one Albinus, who seems to have lived
about A.D. 804, the invention of a four-stringed instru-
ment, tuned C, D, G, E, much incurved at the sides, as
shown in the figure (Fig. 7). The Cotton MS., tenth
century, gives a figure playing a viol held up to the
chin, and played with a bow (Fig. 8). It is pear-
shaped, and has a slim neck and two circular sound-
holes, but no appearance of bridge or finger-board.
There is also one (Fig.
5)
from the bas-relief ; t
Boscherville, to which reference has been already made,
similarly held, and having two semicircular sound-
holes and three strings, with four pegs, but no bride e
or finger-board : this was probably a gigue. From the
same bas-relief is another similar figure playing on an
instrument, possibly a rebec, held not unlike the viol
da gamba of a later day (Fig. 9). In the porch of the
Cathedral of Notre Dame de Chartres, also of the
twelfth century, is found a viol with three strings and
a bridge (Fig. 10). It is particularly thick, heavy, and
cumbrous in make, the bridge deeply grooved to re-
ceive very thick strings, and the sound-holes very
large.
The gigue, from which is derived the modern
German word
"
geige," was a pear-shaped viol with
three strings and four sound-holes, but no bridge or
finger-board. It was in vogue in the thirteenth and
fourteenth centuries, and towards the end of the four-
teenth the head was not unlike the modern scroll.
Fig. 11 is from the Cathedral at Mans, fourteenth
century. Martin Agricola
(1545)
mentions four sorts
of geig, or gigue ; the Discantus (Fig. 12, which shows
the improving head), the Altus, Tenor, and Bassus,
which all had a bridge, a tail-piece, three strings, two
crescent-shaped sound-holes, and practically a finger-
board, as will be seen in Fig. 12. This last date,
1545,
brings us very near indeed to the invention of
the present perfect violin. In 1542, Luscinius, a
Benedictine, in his
"
Musuragia seu Praxis Musicae,"
gives rough figures of a true viola da gamba, and also
of a rebec, a sort of three-stringed violoncello, which is
also mentioned by Gerson, in the fourteenth century.
A most interesting figure, playing the rebec, held to
the chin, is found in the Minstrels' Gallery at Exeter
Cathedral, of the fourteenth century.
It is now that we arrive at the time of the true
viols, the immediate forerunners, and, indeed, early
companions, of the violin as it now exists. At the
beginning of this fifteenth century, viols began to be
well incurved, and as makers we hear of Ott, and Frey,
of Nuremburg
; and, about the middle, Joan Kerlino,
of Brescia, the probable founder of the Brescia school.
There was extant in
1450, according to Laborde, a
viol of Kerlino, dated
1449,
which was exhibited by
Koliker at Paris in 1804, which was converted into a
viola by the substitution of a new head. In the first
half of the sixteenth century we come across Duiffo-
prugear of Bologna, Linarolli of Venice, Dardelli of
Mantua, and others, who have been cited by some as
violin-makers ; but it is now certain that they only
made the viol class of instrument, such as the viola
d'amore, or treble viol, the viola bastarda, or alto viol,
the viola da braccia, or tenor viol (hence the modern
German bratsche for tenor), and the viola da gamba, or
bass viol. These all had six strings, and frets to stop
the notes with. We sometimes come across tenors
ascribed to one or other of these old
"
Luthiers," as
M. Fetis calls them ; but they can only be thus as-
cribed when they have new heads, necks, and finger-
boards. There were two such in the Exhibition of
1872, made about 1520 by Ventura Linarolli, of Venice;
both of these had the old six or seven-pegged heads,
replaced by the modern (or rather sixteenth century)
four-pegged scroll. As Mr. C. Reade justly remarks,
the immense breadth between the
J/
holes shows that
they were meant for five, six, or seven strings. They
were played upon the knee ; and as the same connois-
seur points out, old tenors and basses always appear
much older than they really are, from the fact that at
that time (1550
et seg.) such instruments were, as a
rule, hung up against a wall when not in use, not nursed
in cases.
From about
1555
we find the instruments of Gas-
paro da Salo, the first maker of violas and violins, and
as such he will be spoken of in his proper place in the
next chapter ; but he also was a maker of viols
;
and
there exist some inestimably rare tenors by him, having
only two corners. In
1530, John Oporinus, a printer
at Basle, had for his device a six-stringed instrument
(Fig.
13),
which comes very near the true tenor. The
violin proper is first referred to by Zacconi in 1 596,
who
describes it with a compass identical with the modern
one, without Hie shift, which would imply that the shift
was then unknown or little used, as it was certainly
impossible with the frets on the old viols, which were,.
HOUSEHOLD CLOCKS.
75
used fretted late on into the seventeenth century, with
frets made, as a rule, of pieces of glued catgut, tied
round the neck at intervals, so as to project over the
finger-board.
Perhaps the most perfect viola da gamba in exist-
ence is that in the possession of Mr. G. A. Forster,
who figures it in his
"
History of the Violin." An illus-
tration of this instrument (Fig. 14) is taken from an
instruction book,
"
The Division Violist," published in
1659. The remarkable similarity to the modern double-
bass should be noted. The first known violin player
of any renown was Baltzarini, who went to the Court
of France from Italy in
1577. Mersennus,
1636, gives
an illustration of a
"
pera," or
"
poche," which seems
to have been the equivalent of our almost modern kit,
a long oval instrument, very like the old gigue (Fig.
1
5)
which, being a small instrument used by dancing-
masters, probably originated the word "jig." The
same author also figures a barbiton major, which is
identical with the viol da gamba, and a barbiton minori
which is identical with our modern tenor. In 1620,
one Prastorius gives a list of instruments, among which
he names1. Gross contrabass geig, like our modern
contrebasse, with five strings, s S sound-holes, no frets,
and modem scroll and bow; 2. Violone, like our
violoncello, modern scroll, six strings, six frets, two
S S sound-holes
; 3. Viola da gamba, much the same as
the violone, with two crescent-shaped sound-holes,
carved head, seven frets, six strings
;
4. Viola bastarda,
the same shape, six strings, modern scroll, two crescent
and one round sound-hole, and seven frets
; 5. Klein
posche (or kit), a little oval instrument like a gigue,
with one S hole in the centre under the strings
;
6. Rechte Discant geig, almost identical with the
modem violin; 7. Tenor geig, much like a modem
short-necked viola; 8. Bass geig de bracio, like a
clumsy short-necked 'cello.
Mr. Lidel, in 1849, exhibited an instrument made
in 1687, called a "barytone," which had six gut-strings
fastened to the tail-piece, passing over the bridge, and
eleven steel strings passing through or under the
bridge, from an ebony bar placed there obliquely,
which, being tuned in unison, vibrated in unison when
the others were struck with the bow, with a very sweet
effect. In 1676, a Piedmontese, named Todini (the
supposed inventor of the double-bass), published a
pamphlet describing certain inventions of his, amongst
which werea violin which could be instantaneously
heightened from a tone to a fifth by a mechanical con-
trivance
; another, which had a second set of octave or
** kit" strings so disposed, that either, or both together,
could be played at the will of the performer
; and,
lastly, a viola da gamba, on which, without shifting,
the treble, alto, tenor, or bass viol could be played.
Thus far it has seemed necessary, before entering upon
the actual manufacture of the violin, to notice the
various instruments which led up to it. In the next
chapter I shall, as briefly as possible, sketch the various
characteristics of the violin's most celebrated makers,
before entering upon the practical and mechanical part
of our work.
(To be contimced)
HOUSEHOLD CLOCKS:
HOW TO ADJUST, CLEAN, AND REPAIR THEM.
By PAUL N. BASLVCK.
in 1370.
Movements described
;
tools required.
HE illustrations given herewith show the
construction of ordinary English clocks.
The first is one of the first clocks of
which we have any authentic description.
It was made for Charles V. of France,
The vertical verge, shown in Fig. 1, was
afterwards placed horizontally so that it might carry
a weighted bob, or pendulum. To effect this alteration
the scape-wheel had to be placed with its axis vertical,
and it was driven by a crown-wheel in the place of
the wheel H. The second illustration, Fig.
3,
shows
the movement of an ordinary long-case hall-clock.
These are frequently to be found in country houses,
and are almost invariably family heir-looms, in the
conventional sense.
The clock made by Henry de Wyck, and briefly
mentioned in our first chapter is, shown by the illus-
tration, Fig. 2. This is handed down to us as one
of the most ancient balance clocks, and a description
of its going parts will be interesting for comparison
with that shown by Fig.
3,
which is a superior kind
of house clock. This will be described later on.
Referring to Fig. 2, and describing it minutely, we
shall get a knowledge of the various parts, their names
and functions. Reid's "Treatise on Clock and Watch-
making," published upwards of half a century ago,
contains the illustration here copied, and also the
description. To a professional artist, a mere view of
the illustration would suffice, but to an amateur the
following particulars are necessary :
"Grindery"Preparing the
LeatherHow to Last the BootsTo affix the Soles and
HeelsWithdrawing the Last.
T must be understood that the list of tools
which is given below by no means com-
prises all that a skilled workman would
consider as indispensable in the formation
of a complete
"
kit," as he would term his
collection. Nevertheless, the articles here mentioned
will be sufficient for the amateur's purpose, and by
their aid he may construct or repair almost any kind
of boots.
First and foremost is the shoemaker's knife, which
will cost 3d. This, a plain steel blade, about 4 in.
long, fixed in a simple wooden handle, must be kept
very sharp, if even passable workmanship is hoped for.
Not to be able to use the knife well, or keep a keen
edge on it, means in the shoe trade that the user is an
indifferent workman. The buff strap, as the sharpen-
ing apparatus is termed, is simply a piece of wood
fashioned like a razor-strop, having on one side a strip
of emery cloth pasted to the wood, and on the other a
piece of buff leather, similarly fastened. Any old
piece of military belting will answer this purpose.
The method of sharpening is to lay the blade of the
knife nearly flat on the emery side of the buff strap,
and draw it steadily backwards and forwards half-a-
dozen times, reversing the side of the blade at each
stroke. By so doing a thin edge will be obtained.
The same process is repeated on the buff side, and
this smoothens the edge, making the knife cut keenly.
A hammer of the kind specially made for shoemaking
will be necessary, the cost being from 8d. for the com-
monest kind, to 2s. or 2s. 6d. for the best. A pair of
pincers will cost is., or thereabouts, size No. 1 or 2
being large enough for any purpose. The use of these
is to draw the upper tightly over the last ; and, as
ihey have to stand very heavy strains, more especially
in the hands of beginners, the purchaser should see
that the articles he selects are not too light in the jaws.
Among other articles necessary for putting the boot
together, are : a
"
sleeking-stick," which is a round
piece of box-wood, about a foot in length and
f
in. in
thickness, used for rubbing down the sole into posi-
tion before it is sewn or othenvise fastened, and for
hardening it afterwards
;
and a
"
driver," which is
simply a worn half-round file, with its ends broken off
so as to leave about 10 in. of the centre. This is
used in driving rivets or nails into the so'e and heel,
the holding surface preventing the rivet or nail from
slipping on one side, as it is apt to do if struck with
a hammer. For finishing, a small rasp will be re-
quired, costing is. This is used to get the edges of
the boot into shape after they are pared by the knife.
Next is an edge-knife, or scraper, which can be made
from a stay-busk, or any piece of thin steel. The size
required is about l in. by 1 in. To make it ready
for work it must be slightly rounded, and made per-
fectly smooth at the ends, which are, however, left
their proper substance, and not brought to a thin edge.
By passing the blade of an awl over this edge, a small
portion of the metal is turned outwards, forming what
would be generally known as a
"
burr." This, when
passed round the edge of the leather, after rasping,
will take off all remaining roughness. Before the
steel-edge knife was in vogue, this operation was per-
formed with a piece of broken window-glass. As a
substitute, this is always at hand if the material for an
edge-knife should not be obtainable ; still, as its use is
somewhat dangerous, both to the work and the hands
of the workman, it is preferably avoided. A "fore-
part-iron
"
will be required for
"
setting up
"
the edges
of the soles, and a
"
waist-iron
"
for the bevelled part
of the soles in the waist, or arch. These, together
with their handles, will cost about is. each. If, on
account of a variety of boots with soles of different
substances having to be made, several irons have to
be purchased, a considerable reduction is made on the
set. A
"
burnisher
"
may be made with any fragment
of smooth rod-iron, to which a handle can be added at
each end. This, when moderately heated, is used to
obtain the bright polish on the edges of the heel we
are accustomed to see. The
"
seat-wheel " is the only
remaining tool of which the cost is an appreciable one.
The commonest kind of seat-wheel is sold at about
half-a-crown. Its use is to press in any irregularities
at the
"
seat " (by which is understood that part of the
back of the boot where the heel joins with the upper),
while a small wheel revolving on a central pivot makes
that line of small indentations which is to be seen a
little distance away from the actual edge. Beside
these articles, the amateur will need a small collection
of awls of different sorts and thicknesses, in view of
his requirements in sewing, stitching, and repairing.
These articles may as well be purchased before the
commencement of the work. The kinds necessary are
sewing-awls, which are curved in the blade
; stitching-
awls, which may be straight or slightly curved
; stab-
bing-awls, which are fine straight piercers only
; and
peg-awls, which are short and square, and are used in
making the holes for any needful pegs. The cost of
this collection need not be more than a couple of
shillings.
6
4
BOOTS AND SHOES.
I now come to
"
grindery," or the general furnishings
of the shoemaker's bench. For making riveted boots, the
first requirement in this line is a quantity of
"
tingles."
These are very small tacks, about
\
in. in length, and
correspondingly fine. As they are only used for the
purpose of tacking the upper to the inner sole, the
finer and smaller they are, as long as they are capable
of holding it down, the better. Tingles cost from gd.
to is. per pound. An assortment of brass rivets will
be needed, the lengths most required being -r%in., ^in.,
and | in. Brass rivets cost is. per pound. Their use,
it is scarcely necessary to say, is to hold the sole,
upper and inner sole firmly together. Besides these, a
small quantity of \
in. iron sprigs or brads, and some
fin. iron rivets for the heels will be required. The
sprigs cost 2d. per pound, and the iron rivets 4d. A
quarter of a pound of each kind of the above articles,
except the two last named, and half a pound of these,
will be sufficient to last the amateur for some time.
For the purposes of finishing he will only need a small
quantity of finishing ink and a black and a white heel-
ball, the cost of these
articles being about 3d.
If pegged boots are to be
made or repaired, wooden
pegs will have to be pur-
chased. The lengths will
be the same as those given
for the brass rivets. For
hand-sewing, a ball of
hemp for sewing, a ball
of flax for stitching, some
bristles and shoemaker's wax, will be all that is needful
the whole costing, say, 6d.
Having now described the uppers, lasts, bench,
tools, leather, and
"
grindery," and supposing that the
amateur has all these necessaries ready for use, he
now needs to be shown how to construct the boot. As
has previously been remarked, the riveting system of
construction is the simplest, and it is therefore advis-
able to explain it first, leaving the more difficult
systems until the amateur may be supposed to have
obtained some insight into the work. The first opera-
tion is that of
"
fitting the stuff." By this is meant
getting the rough or bottom leather cut out, trimming
the loose fibres, technically known as "flesh," from the
under sides, so as to leave none but useful leather to
6e worked up,
"
skiving
"
the stiffenings, or bevelling
Aem off at the edges, and separating the split-lifts. In
order to allow this to be done, all the leather except
that intended for the inner soles should be placed in
1 tub of water and allowed to remain until it is tho-
roughly wetted through. It must then be taken out
ind allowed to drain. When the water has drained
r
rom it, if it is left for a couple of hours or so, it will
then be in the state in which it is easiest and best to
work. In this condition the shoemaker applies to it"
the appropriate adjective
"
mellow." In this mellow
condition, the soles, top-pieces, and lifts may now be
hammered, to increase their solidity and wearing
qualities. Care should, however, be taken not to
overdo the hammering, or the leather will become un-
workable. In order to get the shape of the sole
correctly, it will be necessary to round up the inner
sole to the shape of the last, and then cut out the sole
according to it. The iron last must be placed on the
upright stand, and the two small holes at the toe and
ball filled up with pieces of hard leather driven in
tightly by the hammer. The leather for the insole is
next to be temporarily attached to the last by a couple
of long rivets driven through it into the holes above-
mentioned. It must now be pared round evenly, the
edge of the last being taken as a guide in the
"
fore-
part
"
and at the heel, and the waist shape being ob-
tained by making a very gentle inward curve on the
hollow side, keeping the outer side nearly in a straight
line. The rounded inner
sole may now be taken off
the last, to be used as a
pattern for the sole. In
marking out the sole
shape, an allowance of
j*
in. must be left on all
round the forepart from
the joints (i.e., where the
sole broadens at the ex-
tremity of the waist), this
allowance being slightly increased at the end of
the toe. The sole in the waist will need only about
tV in. allowance of extra width, but as the heel part is
approached more allowance must be made, and beyond
the corners of the heels the allowance of ^ in. will
again be necessary. The accompanying diagram will
make this clear, the joints being shown at A a, and the
commencement of the heels at B B. One sole having
thus been prepared, it will be an easy matter to cut the
other one from it, taking care that in marking the
second sole the first one must be laid with its grain side
to the grain side of the one to be cut, otherwise both
soles will be cut for one footan accident which not
infrequently happens to inexperienced workers. Any
loose fibre which may show itself on the flesh side of
the leather should now be taken off with the knife, and
the soles are ready for use.
The middle soles may be shaped from the sole-
pattern. They reach from the toe to just below the
joints. The lifts and top-pieces may be roughly cut
out by the back part of the sole, the size being slightly
decreased if small and high heels are required. For
low heels they should be the same size as the back, or,
-DIAGRAM OF THE SOLE.
BOOTS AND SHOES.
85
as it is termed,
"
the seat " of the sole. The split-lifts
have now to be divided. The method of doing this is
to lay the leathera piece
7 k in. long and
J
in. wide
Take
3
pounds of quick stone lime, slack the lime in
water, and then add 1 pound of American pearl-ash.
Apply this to both sides of the glass, and let it remain
for twelve hours, when the putty will be softened, and
the glass may be taken out without being broken. To
destroy paint, apply it to the whole body of the work
which is required to be cleaned ; use an old brush, as
it will spoil a new one ;
let it remain about twelve or
fourteen hours, and then the paint may be easily
scraped off.
Paste FOR Laeels.For adhesive labels dissolve
ii ounces of common glue, which has laid a day in
cold water, with some candy sugar and \
ounce gum
arabic, in 6 ounces hot water, stirring constantly till
the whole is homogeneous. If this paste is applied to
labels with a brush and allowed to dry, they will then
be ready for use by merely moistening with the
tongue.
Effect of Zinc on Hot Coals.A piece of zinc
placed upon the live coals in a hot stove, it is said,
will effectually clean out a stove pipe, the vapour pro-
duced carrying off the soot by chemical decomposition.
Cleaning Metals.A writer in the Metal World
says that he has found the following recipe very good
for cleaning all kinds of metals. It is very satisfactory
indeed, he says, for copper, brass, and zinc, as anyone
will find who gives it a fair trial. To make the mix-
ture, dissolve in one gallon of rain water
4
ounces
oxalic acid
;
add
4 ounces pulverized tripoli,
4 ounces
dark rotten-stone, and 20 drops alcohol. Shake well,
apply briskly, and wipe dry.
Uses of Asbestos in Laboratories.
The
remarkable properties of asbestos, such as its noncom-
bustibility and its resistance to the action of acids,
render it peculiarly well adapted for use in chemical
operations. It was employed centuries ago for the
orocess of filtration of liquids, a plug of the material
oeing inserted in the neck of the funnel through which
the liquid was poured. The asbestos paper produced
at the present time presents an excellent material for
filter paper, as the latter can be washed an almost
infinite number of times without being destroyed. The
working tables of laboratories may be furnished with
coverings of thick sheets of this paper, which coverings
prevent any destructive action of acids, however strong
the latter may be. In addition, the material is elastic
to such an extent that articles of glass may be allowed
to fall upon it without serious risk of fracture. The
paper under consideration is moreover employed in
the manufacture of porous cells for electric batteries,
gloves, coverings for the hands when handling corro-
sive products, and various other articles of utility.
Air-tight and Water-tight Corks.A Ger-
man chemical journal commends the use of paraffine
as the best method of making porous corks gas and
water-tight. Allow the corks to remain for about five
minutes beneath the surface of melted paraffine in a
suitable vessel, the cork being held down by a per-
forated lid, wire screen, or similar device. Corks thus
prepared can be easily cut and bored, have a perfectly
smooth exterior, may be introduced and removed from
the neck of flask with ease, and make an absolutely
perfect seal.
Coloured Photographs.A recent communica-
tion to the French Academy of Sciences announces a
new method of taking photographs in colour, which,
although it is not a solution of the prime problem for
photographers, how to produce Nature in her own
hues, is at least some mechanical approach to it. It is
the invention of MM. Ch. Cros and
J.
Carpentier, and
consists in taking three separate photographs of the
red, yellow, and blue tints, then combining them.
Three negatives of the object are first takenone
through a screen of orange liquid, one through a screen
of green liquid, and one through a screen of violet.
The varying opacities and transparencies of these
negatives indicate the relative qualities of red, yellow,
and blue tints in the object. The proofs are taken on
plates of glass, coated with coagulated albumen, which
has imbibed bichromate of ammonia. A transparent
negative, or first photograph, is applied to one of these,
and exposed for some minutes to a diffused light, so
that the transparencies and opacities of the negative
shall imprint themselves on the sensitive albumen.
The proof plate is then plunged into a colouring bath,
and in the parts protected by the opacities of the
negative the colouring matter spreads and fixes itself.
By repeating this operation with the three different
negatives the three colours are combined on one glass
plate, and a fair imitation of the original object is the
result. Of course, for the image obtained through the
green screen the colouring bath is red, for that through
the orange screen blue, and that through the violet
9
2 AMATEURS IN COUNCIL,
screen yellow. The same screens and pigments serve
to reproduce all sorts of polychromes. The screens
hitherto used are glass vessels filled with solutions of
chloride of cobalt, chromate of potash, and sulphate of
copper. When the electric light is used the screen is
put before the lamp, so that the object will be illumi-
nated by a monochromatic light and photographed in
the ordinary way.
Colouring Zinc Roofs.Among recent German
inventions is a simple process, depending on the use
of acetate of lead, by which every kind of colour is
applicable to sheets of zinc. By mixing blacklead, for
instance, with the salt, a very agreeable light brown
hue is obtained. It is by this process that the cupola
of the synagogue at Nuremberg has been painted. A
sufficient length of time has already elapsed, it is said,
to show that the atmosphere has had no influence on
the zinc sheeting of the roof, thus showing the practical
value of the process in such cases. By the addition of
other colouring matters, light or dark shades of yellow
or grey may be produced.
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL
[The Editor reserves to himself the right of refusing a reply to
any question that may he frivolous or inappropriate, or devoid of
general interest.]
ERY numerous are the suggestions and
offers of assistance that have come from
writers in all parts of the United King.
yjTi
y
|H
|
dom, and even in many of the Colonies,
and in reply to these, individually and
collectively, it may be said that all proffered aid is
welcome, and will be accepted if the papers that are
sent prove suitable, and that careful attention shall be
given to every suggestion whatever may be its nature.
With regard to questions proposed by those who are
seeking information on various subjects in which they
take an interest, they are so numerous th&t it will not
be possible to satisfy all in this present part of
Amateur Work, Illustrated, having regard to
the space at command. It will be sought, however,
by the use of smaller type in this portion of the
magazine, in future numbers, to clear up all arrears as
speedily as possible, and to find room without unne-
cessary delay for prompt replies to all querists.
St. E. says :
"
I want a few hints as to sharpening lancets
and other surgical instruments. What is the right
oilstone to use, and what oil ? What are the tests
of
proper sharpness ? How is the polish added ?
"
Can
any reader who has had experience in this matter
supply the desired information ?
J.
E.Our space is limited, and it is not possible
to treat on everything at once. A thoroughly practi-
cal article, with working drawings to scale, on making
a model locomotive, is on the list of papers to appear
in Amateur Work, Illustrated, in due course.
J.
B. (Telsworlh, Oxon), commenting on the reply
given to A.J.
M., in Part I., says:
"
I fail to see
how I can use a rebate plane for cutting the back
of
fret-frames, as I have mostly cut them out of a single
piece
of
thin wood, and fastened or7iamental slips oj
wood oti the front to form the rebate for picture and
glass, and I have done it with pegs behind." In this
J.
B. has given a useful hint to amateurs who may
wish to make frames for photographs and small pic-
tures, without cutting out the four sides and putting
them together by the aid of the mitre-box. Having
formed his rebate by putting two layers of wood to-
gether, so that the upper layer overlaps the lower
layer all round, there is no necessity whatever for him
to bring the rebate-plane into action. A.
J.
M. had put
the four sides of his frame together without first fornv
ing the rebate in the separate pieces before gluing
them up, and he found a difficulty in making the
rebate after this was done. Hence the reply, that if
he made the rebate before joining up the pieces, a
rebate-plane wao the only thing that he stood in need
of to enable him to do so.
94
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
E. G. (Blackjiiars).In due time it is intended to
give articles on Harmonium Building, but these must
be deferred until the present articles on Organ Build-
ing aie completed.
E. P. P. {Syston, Leicester).Thanks are due to
you for your commendation of Amateur Work,
Illustrated, and your good services in making it
known to your friends and procuring subscribers. The
magazine is especially produced to meet the require-
ments of men, and to treat on practical work to which
men may turn their hands. Few amateurs, if any,
would care to take to tailoring, and inquire into its
mysteries ;
and, indeed, it is too closely allied to milli-
nery and dressmaking to find a place in its pages.
There are many magazines devoted to these subjects
which would doubtless respond to an appeal for in-
structions in cutting out and making up boys' clothes.
S. G. {Brixworth).With reference to the draw-
ings you mention, will you kindly point out in what
respects they do not appear to agree with the text.
P. C. (Leig/ilon Buzzard).It is not desirable to
make this magazine an educational work, strictly
speaking. The instruction given in it applies only to
practical work of all kinds. As it has been stated,
there are works which will in every way meet your
requirements. One of these is
"
Scientific Recrea-
tions," also published by Messrs. Ward, Lock, & Co.
R. C. {Cults, Aberdeen) wishes for practical hints
on wicker-work, and the manufacture of baskets,
hampers, etc. . Papers on this subject will be given
in due course, with instructions for the culture of
osiers, which is highly remunerative.
A. M. {Holbom).The Pentagraph is useful for
enlarging or diminishing drawings. Instructions, with
working drawings for making a fret-work book-case,
shall be given in a future number.
"
Every Man His
Own Mechanic" is published by Messrs. Ward, Lock,
and Co., complete in one volume, at 7s. 6d.
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
HEN woodwork has to be repainted it is
very frequently found to be necessary to
remove the whole of the old paint, and
to go through the whole work de novo,
from the priming to the finishing coat.
There are certain preparations used by painters for
the removal of old paint, but as the action of these is
found to be detrimental to the wood, the process is
usually performed by the application of heat, which
softens the old paint, and so enables the painter to
scrape it away. For the amateur this is both a tedious
and a difficult process, and he will naturally desire to
resort to the aid of a
"
remover." The question then
arises as to what may be the best and most effectual
preparation to use, and there would still be some diffi-
culty in meeting the inquiry in a satisfactory manner,
had not Messrs. W. E. Rendle and Co., of
3,
West-
minster Chambers, Victoria Street, S. IV., already
solved the difficulty, and given a sufficient answer by
the production of a patented novelty, to which they
have given the name of "The Electric Paint Remover,"
and which is a chemically-prepared compound for re-
moving old paint, varnish, tar, rust, grease, etc., from
wood, metal, stone, and fabrics of all kinds, including
textile fabrics. I have not yet had an opportunity of
testing this useful composition, and therefore cannot
speak from personal experience as to its merits, but it
is a preparation so likely to be of use to, and to be used
freely by, amateurs, that I do not hesitate to borrow, for
the benefit of my readers, the following account of its
properties and action from the Building News, one of
the best authorities in matters of this kind. The writer
of this account, it should be stated, had been invited
by Messrs. Rendle and Co. to witness some experiments
made with the new remover upon various specimens of
painted wood and metal.
These specimens, he tells us, "were all old samples,
well painted with several coats of good oil colour.
The compound, which is of a cream-like subsistence,
quite white, is spread over the painted surface, and
after being left on a few minutes, is \riped off. The
inventor made some remarks upon the chemical
properties of different sorts of paint ' removers ' known
to the trade. These were generally compounded of
alkalies, soda and potash, mixed with lime, which
latter was known to have a dehydrating action on the
fibre of the wood. The result of the use of these pre-
parations was, that only the first film of paint was
removed, the body of paint being imperfectly acted
upon. While some of these preparations remove
paint of ordinary work, for paint-work of several coats
they are quite inoperative. The new
'
Electric Paint
Remover' is chemically prepared according to a
scientific formula, in which potash and soda are the
principal ingredients, but in which there is not a trace
of lime present. Its action upon the body of the paint
is thorough and complete ; a soporification is set up
which continues, the soda is liberated, and fresh soap
formed ; and this process goes on, the alkali being
liberated as it is wanted until the whole of the paint
is removed."
To continue the description of the process. The
specimen that was acted upon
"
only remained about
a quarter of an hour subjected to the action of this
caustic preparation, and the compound being wiped
off, every trace of paint was found cleanly removed,
and the wood exposed appeared as if it had been
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
95
planed. Nothing could be a more satisfactory test of
the destructive action set up by this material. Directly
the compound touches, soporification is set up. The
action of this preparation seems to be twofold : there
is first the destructive action of the applied alkali,
always caustic, and next a continued sponge-like
action going onin other words, a constant and per-
fect causticity is maintained. The result of the pre-
paration on metal was equally convincing. A gas-
meter which had been thoroughly coated was exposed
to the compound for about twenty minutes, after
which the japan was removed, and the bright metal
exposed.
"
The other forms of this preparation were of a
weaker character, and nearer soap in their composi-
tion. They are intended to remove dirt, and their
action is just the reverse of the compound already
described. The preparations are liquid, and are
soluble in water, and their cleansing power upon cloth
of an unmistakably greasy and dirty character was
almost magical. For delicate carvings and fabrics
of all kinds, these solutions are admirably adapted
;
and, it is probable, their use by restorers, decorators,
and others, will be highly esteemed. The modifica-
tion of the solution for cleaning cloth is well adapted
for restoring the linings of railway carriages and stuff
seats of all descriptions. No scraping or erasing is
necessary." There is nothing injurious, it is said, in
the preparation which can attack or injure metals or
cloths. They all produce a minimum action on
brushes, which is a consideration, and, what is very
mportant, colour is not taken out by the use of these
solutions. The price is less than that of other prepa-
rations. The "Paint Remover" can be easily applied
by being spread over the surface of the paint to be
removed. It is sold in 5 lb. tins, at 2s. 6d. each.
For the benefit of those who wish to know some
method of softening putty without having recourse to
the
"
Electric Paint Remover," the following is taken
from Spon's
"
Workshop Receipts
"
" 1 lb. of Ameri-
can pearl-ash,
3
lbs. of quick stone lime
; slack the
lime in water, then add the pearl-ash, and make the
whole about the consistence of paint. Apply it to
both sides of the glass, and let it remain for twelve
hours, when the putty will be so softened that the
glass may be taken out of the frame with the greatest
facility."
Messrs. C. Churchill and Co., Importers of Ame-
rican. Tools and Machinery, 28, Wilson Street, Fins-
hery, .C, send me the following letter, which, in
justice to these gentlemen, I reproduce here. They
say
:
I
Referring to your notice of Starrett's Combination
Square, in Amateur Work, Illustrated, page
48,
we'beg to inform you that we are the sole agents of
the maker, and we are the introducers from America
;
and our advertisement of this tool appears on the back
page of Part I. of Amateur Work, Illustrated.
This information we give you, as in your Notes it is
given to another firm."
The same firm also send the description of a new
Drill Brace, which they will have on sale very shortly,
and which, if I mistake not, is the novelty from
America, mentioned in my last
"
Notes." This is
accompanied by their new Amateur Catalogue, about
which I will take the opportunity of saying a few
words before entering on a description of the new
brace. The catalogue which, to follow the American
plan of giving the sizes of books, is a small quarto
measuring
5J
in. by \\
in., is a handy vade
mecum that may well find a place in the pocket of
every amateur artisan, to whom without doubt, Messrs.
Churchill's larger catalogue is well known. This large
quarto catalogue is too large to be carried about, and
would be liable to injury if thrust into the pocket
;
the small one, on the contrary, is in every way fitted
for carrying on the person, and will serve to while
away many a half-hour passed under compulsion in
comparative idleness, when travelling or otherwise.
It is a reproduction of the greater part of the large
catalogue, by photo-lithography, and the beauty of the
wood-engravings thus reproduced, and the clearness
of the descriptive matter and prices speak volumes for
the utility of this process. This catalogue is sent to
any applicant who may wish to become possessed of
it, on receipt of six penny stamps.
The Drill Brace, of which an illustration is given
in Fig.
7,
is a 10 in. sweep brace, with a gear-wheel
speeded about three to one, to be used not only in
drilling metal, but also for boring holes in wood
" '. -
'
'
PRESENTED
WITH PART III. OF
AMASSSI
Will,
lilBSfMJIS
DESCRIPTION OF ILLUSTRATIONS.i. Reading Chair and Escritoire foliiL
1
8. End Elevation of Hanging Shelve., etc. 9. Shield iih Mono,,,,, , M li'y,
f"*'
~ E"d EIion of Escritoire. 3 and 4 Arm-chair. In, SI..I
'
Hall Table, Front Elevation. ,6. Hall Table, etc, End Elevation. ,,
s
"
n
H- El '"' ClB > '4 tc. ,0. Small || a ,.. Cu , ,?
S""'
" <*,. 3. Side-Table, adaoled to f r. , n , ,.
I
P**"i ' Sil-Table, Front Elevation ,8 I d F , r
'
, ) e',
t
"' E"d E,> W Hanging C,
2
, T
C
'""7 ' 6. End Elevation ol Side-Table. 7- Hanging Shelve, and Glared
^^,^^^^__^^^^^_J^^_ -
tS- End Elevatton of Small S,de-Tablc, etc. ,, EM nTrdfniS ,, Wn- kT" 'J**'"
' 3' &d Elera,i" ' E"!"- '4- Couch in Imitation of Austrian Bent
f
UE
S GNS FOR SIMPLE AND A aTT<=T-,r.
"
Stde-Table, ,n Japanese Style, i,h Mir,,,. ==-,6. Monogram, fT.l-P.-A.P.L-E.G.H.-C. B.C.-
-AND
ARTISTIC
HOME.
MADE
FURNITIJRE
ANQ GARNITIJRE.
"
Cupboard for China and Brie-a- Brae.
Wood Furniture. 15. Aquarium or
-M.G.)
I
I
'i I
ELEZTRO-PLATiNG AT HOME. 97
ELECTRO-PLATING AT HOME.
By GEORGE EVWTNSON.
III.Batteries, Vessels, Wires, Connectors,
Distilling
Apparatus, etc.
ATTERY.I frequently get such questions
as these sent to me by amateurs :
"
I
have not a Daniell battery, but I have a
battery that has been used to ring electric
bells, it has got a zinc rod sticking up out
of some whitish
liquid, and a white pot coatee
3
with pitch
must now dismiss the subject, but hope to take it up
again when I treat of it under the head of Electric
Bells. Another says,
"
I have some cells of Fuller's
constant battery, can I use them to electro-plate some
spoons?" Now Fuller's bichromate battery, Ander-
son's bichromate battery, and Dale's constant bichro-
mate battery are all electric bell or telephone batteries,
but, unlike the Le'clanche', their construction may be
modified to suit the wants of the electro-plater. Mr.
Dale's battery is one easily altered and made suitable
to deposit metal on fairly large surfaces. When made
up with strips of zinc in the porous cell instead of a
cast zinc rod, and an increase of the carbon surface
FIG. 14.
FIG. 17.
FIG. 18.
FIG. 16.
amateur's PLANT FOR ELECTRO-PLATING.
Fig. 12.Socket to receive Swell of Bell-Glass. Fig. 13.Foot of Bell-Glass. Fig. 14.Cathode Hoop for Bound Vats. Fig. 15.BeTI-
Glasa, fitted up as Vat, showing arrangement of Anode and Spoons. Fig. 16.Slinging Wire, partly covered with Gutta Percha.
Figs. 17, 18.Wire Clips, substitutes for Binding Screws. Figs. 19, 20.Wire Connectors. Fig. 31.Apparatus for Distilling Water.
out of which sticks a strip of carbon. Can I use this
battery instead of the Daniell
?
" The answer to this
must be a decided negative. Silver may be deposited
by the current from such a battery, just as a boy may
move a heavy bale of goods from one room to another,
but if you wish to have the bale moved carefully across
the street or to the top of the building, it will be best to
employ a strong man to do it for you. The boy ca7i move
the bale, and the Le'clanche", or manganese battery, can
'
deposit silver, but by employing either the boy or this
io" of battery, you unnaturally test their strength and
j,^.',ws of endurance, and must not be surprised to find
them fail just when failure is most disastrous, and thus
spoil the work. With this reference to a useful battery I
this battery wi' ">osit silver and copper in very good
condition. ? may yet be done with batteries in
which a solution of bienromate of potash is used,
mixed with other suitable solutions of acids and salts.
Some progress in this direction has been made by
myself in the invention of a combination superior to
any I have met with elsewhere, but I am not at present
at liberty to make the results public. Others ask me
whether or not they may use a Grove or a Bunsen cell,
or, failing this, convert either of those into a Daniell ?
Both the above forms have been used in the electro-
deposition of silver, and, when the nitric acid in the
Bunsen has been replaced by strong sulphuric acid it is
even now largely used in France and Germany by
E
9
3
ELECTRO-PLATING AT HOME.
electro-platers. But I do not wish my readers to run
any more risks than absolutely necessary, of either
ruining their own healths and property, or annoying
their neighbours, so I will tell them how to convert
their Bunsen's or Grove's into Daniell cells.
Well wash the porous cells, or, better still, get new
ones, and into these put the elements and material, of
the Daniell battery given in my last. Whatever bat-
tery is selected, vr~ must look forward to the class of
work to be done with it, and bear in mind this axiom .:
" cata,"
"
down," and
"
Iwdos,"
"
a way," signifying
that the current of electricity leaves the solution by
this way down to the battery. This "way" must
ELECTRO-PLATING AT'HOME.
99
always be connected by wire to the positive or dis-
solving plate of the batter)'. The opposite part of the
vat fittings has received the name of anode rod or
wire (the plate of metal being the anode), and this
term is also compounded from two Greek words
pardon
methere is much that is impure in the best spring-
water. Carbonic, nitric, sulphuric, and other acids,
exist in some one or other of our spring-waters, com-
bined with some mineral or earthy base held in solu-
tion by the acids. Even rain-water, as it descends
from the clouds, carries with it traces of ammonia and
sulphur. There is only one method of obtaining pure
water suitable for our purpose, and that is by distilla-
tion. Distilled water can be purchased of nearly all
druggists and chemists, or it may be easily prepared
at home without the use of a costly
"
still." Of course,
where a proper
"
still," with a worm of pure tin, can
be procured, it should be used in preference to any
other contrivance. No licence is required to use a
"
still " for this purpose ; and if used for any distilla-
tion of herbs or spirits, it will be rendered almost
useless for distilling water.
Distilled Water.Sailors cast on a desert
island where fresh water cannot be procured, have
improvised an apparatus for distilling sea-water, and
thus probably invented the
"
still." The rude appara-
tus used by them consists frequently of a kettle, to the
spout of which is attached a gun-barrel. The water in
the kettle is made to boil until steam issues from the
end of the barrel, wet cloths are then hung on the elon-
gated spout and kept wet with cold water, this cools
the barrel and condenses the steam in it, the condensed
steam is distilled fresh water free from salt. But this
water will be sure to contain traces of iron washed off
from the interior of the gun-barrel, and this iron would
combine with the cyanide of potassium to form a
foreign iron salt, therefore an iron condensing pipe is
not suitable. But a pipe made out of the best block
tin seamed and soldered (with the seam in the upper
side of the pipe) will do very well, and last for a long
time, or until the tin has been worn away to expose the
iron plate. An ingenious tinker or a worker in tin-plate
may easily improvise a still out of an ordinaryhalf-gallon
tin saucepan (Fig. 21, a) and a preserved meat tin
(Fig. 21, B). Secure the lid of the saucepan by solder-
ing it closely, cut a hole in the lid on one side to
receive the end of a tin tube 2 in. in diameter, and
on the other side a hole to receive a short tin tube
just large enough to be stopped closely with a bottle
cork. Solder both tubes in their respective holes
;
to the large one attach a closely fitting tube of block
tin made to taper down through a length of 2 feet
from 2 in. to i in. (Fig. 21, c). Cut two holes in
the preserved meat tin, one near the top, and the
other near the bottom, the lower one just large
enough to receive the tip of the taper tin tube
above mentioned, which must now be soldered into
the holes in an oblique position running through the
meat tin. This tube must be connected to the larger
tin tube in the lid of the saucepan by an elbow piece
of tin tubing made steam tight. It will be best to
make the taper tube in two sections, to solder one
section into the meat tin and use the other to connect
this with the elbow piece, as suggested in the annexed
sketch. All joints in the tube must be made steam
tight by wrapping some tinfoil around the joint and
luting it with white lead. Fill both the saucepan and
the meat tin with clean water, place the saucepan on
the fire and the meat tin on a stand in the chimney
comer
; when the water boils in the saucepan, stop the
smaller tube with a cork, and the steam will be driven
into the taper tin tube, where it will condense and run
out as distilled water at the 5 in. opening on the
outside of the meat tin. This water must be caught in
a clean jug or clean bottle for use in making up silver
solutions. Whilst the water in the meat tin is kept
cool, all the steam will condense in the tube running
through it, but if steam is made faster than it will con-
dense, it will issue with the water at the small end of
the tube. In such a case as this, hang wet cloths on
the part of the tube outside the upper part of the meat
tin to assist in condensing the steam there. Some few
years since, Mr. Griffin, of Garrick Street, W., made
and advertised some cheap stills from 2s. upwards,
very suitable for an amateur, but I have not seen his
advertisements recently, so cannot say whether he
makes them now or not.
(To be continued.)
VIOLIN-MAKING: AS IT WAS, AND IS.
By EDWARD H. ALLEN.
II. As it Was, and Is (Italian School).
S I said before in the first chapter, the
differences in the models, styles, etc., of
the greatest makers, are so considerable,
that my work would, to say the least of
it, be incomplete were I to enter upon the
practical part of it without sketching, as briefly as
possible, these
"
peculiarities of great men," for the
guidance and instruction of the would-be amateur
VIOLIN-MAKING : AS IT WAS, AND IS.
fiddle-maker. To impart to the following notes any
matter of a biographical description would be ob-
viously outside the object of these chapters, so I shall
confine myself purely and shortly to the mechanical
characteristics
of the "great
few " whose
names are
householdwords
alike to the
amateur and the
professional. I
say the few, for
though the
names of the
fiddle-makers is
legion, they
mostly fol-
lowed the prin-
ciples of their
chiefs, it is only
necessary to no-
tice these great
originals. For
classification of
names and bio-
graphical details
I must refer our
readers to Mr.
Hart's most val-
uable and inte-
resting work,
"The Violin: its
Famous Makers
and Imitators."
That the tech-
nical terms used
in the following
remarks may be
fully understood,
I have given in
Fig. 1
6, on a
tolerably large
scale, diagrams
of the front and
back of the vio-
lin, showing its
different parts
and the names
that are applied to them. These diagrams will suffici-
ently explain their purpose without further description.
The violin, as we have before seen, assumed its pre-
sent form rather suddenly in the sixteenth century, and
certain old
"
Luthiers
"
have been cited and fully
discussed in Chapter I. ; these were Joan Kerlino
FIG.
FRONT
"
BACK
16. DIAGRAMS OF THE FRONT AND BACK OF VIOLIN, SHOWING ITS
DIFFERENT PARTS.
A. Scroll. E. Finger-board. I. Beak. N. /Holes. R. Lower Bouts
B. Cheeks of Scroll. P. Neck.
Purflin
S- O. Bridge. S. Nut.
C. Peg-box. G. Button. .'
Corner^
' p- Tail-piece. T. Shoulder.
D. Pegs. H. Belly. M. Inner Bouts. Q. Tail-pin. U. Eye of Sci oil
(Brescia),
1449;
Pietro Dardelli (Mantua),
1500;
Gaspard Duiffoprugcar (Bologna), 15 10 ; Ventura Lina-
rolli (Venice), 1520 ; Peregrina Zanetto (Brescia),
1540 ; Morglato Morella (Mantua.\ 1550. Which last
date brings us
to the Brescian
School, founded
in
1555,
or there-
abouts. I shall
notice the ma-
kers of this and
other schools
in chronological
order, as nearly
as possible.
Gaspard da
Salo (Brescia),
15551610. So
called from
having been
K
born at Salo in
Lombard
y.
Seems to have
been originally
a maker of viols
but set to mak-
ing violins and
tenors. It seems
probable that
the tenor was
invented before
the violin ; at
any rate Gas-
pard da Salo's
tenors are much
commoner than
his violins. His
model is excel-
lent in every
respect, varying
a little, but
generally high.
The centre
bouts often short
and primitive.
The/holes very
long and point-
ed, but not out
of proportion to
the instrument, the scroll particularly marks the
primitive state of the instrument. He made many
instruments of pear wood as well as of sycamore,
especially basses. His varnish is principally a
light brown amber, very rich and deep, the grain of
his bellies generally very straight and even. The
'02 VIOLIN-MAKING : AS IT WAS, AND IS.
most perfect specimen I ever saw is a tenor in the
possession of Mr. Edward Withers, a grand old primi-
tive instrument, from which the
f
hole (Fig.
17), is
traced. His ticket is
"
Gasparo di Salo in Brescia."
John Paul Maggini (Brescia),
1 5901640. Was pro-
bably a pupil of Gaspard da Salo ; his pattern is large,
and broad in outline, the arching sloping away to the
purfling and flattish, the sides rather shallow. The
f
holes long and pointed, the scroll primitive, but not so
much so as that of his master. He made the bellies of
his instruments very strong, the back in proportion to
the belly, rather thin, and generally ornamented by
elegant curls of the purfling, which is generally inlaid
in a double line. Varnish, light yellowish, or deep
brown, and very rich. The tone of his instruments is
grand and melancholy, the wood cut
"
on the layers."
His instruments are often confused with tlose of
Gaspard da Salo. The great violinist, De Beriot, used
one of his instruments. Ticket, "Gio Paolo Maggini
in Brescia."
Others makers of the Brescian school inferior to
these were Mariani, Buddiani, and Bente, all from
15701620.
The Cremona school was founded by Andrew
Amati (Cremona), born (about) 1520, died about 1580;
the first of his illustrious family. Possibly a pupil at
Brescia before he started at Cremona. Most of his
instruments are small or medium, model high towards
the centre, bellies fairly strong. Backs often made of
pear wood cut on the layers. Varnish, excellent light
brown, or deep golden, work not unlike Gaspard da Salo,
but that the_/"holes (Fig. 18) are rather broad and in-
elegant. Ticket, "Andreas Amati Cremona, fecit 15
."
Anthony and Jerome Amati (Cremona), 1570
"
Jacob Stainer (Absom), birth probably about 1620
and death uncertain. More properly a German maker,
of whom he was the greatest. Was probably for
some time a pupil of Nicholas Amati. His model was
highly original ; at his best his instruments were small
in the pattern, the
f
holes rather narrow and very
round at the top and bottom (Fig. 20). His edges
net very strong, the purfling set rather near them,
the scroll shorter than Amati's but broader in front.
The grain of his wood wide, and the varnish deep rose
colour like Nicholas Amati's. His instruments are
very high built, especially between the upper bouts,
and often almost "tubby," the scroll often finished
with a carved lion's or other animal's head
;
when of
the ordinary shape, he made his scrolls broad and
VIOLIN-MAKING: AS IT WAS, AND IS.
103
rather short. He has by some been preferred to the
highest Cremonese masters
(!)
His most celebrated
instruments were the
"
Elector Stainers," which were
sixteen fiddles made by him, it is said, in a monastery
at the end of his life, and sent by him, one to each of
the Electors, and the remaining four to the Emperor of
Germany. The wood is very handsome, and the
varnish a lovely rose colour ; they are decidedly
Cremonese, or at least un-German in style. Ticket,
"Jacobus Stainer in Absom, prope CEnipontum
16
1720, surnamed
"II per" from his ticket, which runs "Francisco
Ruggieri detto il per Cremona 16
" A follower of
the Amati school. His outline is original and grace-
ful, his purfling broad, his arching perfect, his material
fine and used thick ; his scroll is equal to the rest of
the instrument ; the varnish, which is generally deep
brown and very first-rate, is very well and evenly laid
on. His/ hole (Fig. 21) has been cited as a blending
of that of Stradivari and Nicholas Amati.
Anthony Stradivari (Cremona), born
1644, died
!737>
the. greatest fiddle maker that ever lived.
He was a pupil of Nicholas Amati, with whom he
worked till 1670, before which time he used not lo
sign his works. Between 1670 and 1690 he worked
on Amati's
"
grand
"
model, but modified the extension
of the comers
; these are known as
"
Amatese Stradi-
variuses." The arching is not so high as Amati, but
his/holes and scroll are something similar. The wood
often cut across the grain
; though acoustically good
is often not so handsome as later on. After 1690 his
individuality began to assert itself, his model became
more graceful and flatter, the
/
holes elegant and
reclining, the centre bouts gracefully drawn out, as also
the corners
; the scroll is bold and striking, and the
purfling rather narrow, the varnish beautiful golden or
light red. It was at the end of this period that he
made the fiddles known as
"
Long Strads," so called
from their narrowness between the
/ holes, giving
them a
'
inky appearance, the actual size varying, the
vi iish amber or light red. The year 1700 brings us
to his best period, the model flattish, the wood cut on
the quarter, and thickest in the centre under the
bridge, the curves gentle and harmonious, the wood
of the blocks very light, often formed of willow, the
scroll perfect in its symmetry. The graceful
/ holes
(Fig. 22), the transcendently glorious amber or ruby
varnish, are all characteristics of this greatest maker's
greatest talent Some of his best instruments have
the purfling pointed across the corner instead of fol-
lowing it round, and it is not uncommon to find it run-
ning completely through the corner. His ticket runs,
"Antonius Stradiuarius Cremonensis faciebat Anno
17
" Between
1725 and 1730 the master began to
show signs of approaching age {Eheu! fugaces
labuntur anm"), the swell became more rounded. The
fiddles made after 1730 show a decided falling off,
many being made in part or wholly by his sons and
pupils Omobono and Francis Stradivari and Charles
Bergonzi, and signed
"
sub disciplina Stradiuarii."
In common with all old Italian instruments, the sound
bar is too weak to support the modern high tension of
the strings, and nearly all have to be rebarred.
(Ofteratio maxime deflendd) Stradivari made but few
Tenors, what he did make being grand and glorious
instruments.
Joseph Guarnerius (Cremona), 1690
1730,
eldest
son of Andrew, than whom he was a better workman.
At first copied Stradivarius and then his cousin
Joseph del Jesu. The waists of his instruments are
narrow, the lower and upper bouts wide in proportion,
the curves so very graceful as to have served (as some
suppose) as models to the great Joseph del Jesu him-
self. The
f
holes (Fig. 23) a mixture of Andrew
Guarnerius and the Amati and very like Gasparo da
Salo's, whose idea he seems to have worked, and
improved upon. They are rather lower in the belly
and nearer the edge than is usual. Varnish very
good, rather thickly laid on.
Peter Guarnerius, 1690
J
735-
This maker's model, which was flattish, was broad and
very bold in its conception, his /holes varied in form,
being sometimes like those of Guarnerius del Jesu
;
his scroll very good and original. His fiddles have a
beautiful mellow tone. Ticket, "Lorenzo Guadagnini,
Cremona, Alumnus Stradiuarius. Fecit Anno Domini
17."
Jean Baptiste Guadagnini (Placentia), 1710
1750,
probably was a brother of Lorenzo, and with him
pupil of Stradivarius, whom he copied persistently,
particularly in the form of his scroll. His backs are
very handsome, and generally joined, his bellies
acoustically good, his varnish bright and highly trans-
parent. Ticket, "Joannes Baptista Guadagnini, Pla-
centinus, fecit Mediolani, 17
."
Domenicus Montagnana (Cremona and Venice),
1700
1740,
pupil of Stradivari. A very excellent
104
VIOLIN-MAKING: AS IT WAS, AND IS.
maker, indeed one of the best, but many of his fiddles
are labelled "Joseph del Jesu"
(whom he resembled in
his /
holes), which has tended to eclipse his talent
somewhat. His model is large, and all his curves are
rather gentler than those of his master, the inner ones
being particularly drawn out. The figure of his wood
is usually large, and his scroll is larger and more
powerful than that of Stradivari. His varnish is
superb, and deservedly ranked among the best.
Ticket,
"
Domenicus Montagnana,
Sub-Signum Cre-
mona;, Venetii, 17
."
Sanctus Seraphino (Venice),
17101748, to my mind the
neatest and most careful maker
of the Italians. It is a pity he
did not strike out and apply
his care to a model of his own,
instead of following a rather
ugly German one, a mixture
between Stainer and Amati. His
/ holes (Fig. 24) and scroll well
cut, but of a poor model ; brilli-
ant red varnish of a perfect
quality, which, being sometimes
too thick, gives his instruments
an opaque appearance. His
instruments are unmistakably
like one another in style,
though his model varied, the
wood always showing the grain
;
n clear even stripes. He
branded his instruments with
his initials, S. S., in various
places, particularly under the
tail-piece. He used a very
large, well-engraved, highly-
ornamented label, worded,
"
Sanctus Seraphin, Utinensis,
Fecit Venetiis, Ann. 17
."
Charles Bergonzi (Cremona),
1718
1755,
the best pupil of
Anthony Stradivari. At first
copied his great master closely and well, and sub-
sequently started a model of his own of fine size and
good thickness of wood, flat and even, the wood
handsome and the work excellent. The lower bouts
being rather broad, the inner bouts set rather at an
angle, the upper bouts larger than those of Stradivari,
the scroll cut rather flat, but very bold, though not
so well proportioned and finished as that of Stradivari
;
the eye of the scroll being rather prominent and with a
considerable individuality. His
f
holes (Fig.
25) are
set lower in the belly than those of his master ; in
form they are between those of Stradivari and
Guarnerius, and are set rather near the edge of the
17. GASPARD DA SALO
(E. Withers.)
fiddle. His varnish varies from amber, through
pale, to deep red, put on sometimes thickly, sometimes
thinly. His fiddles are sometimes confused with
those of Guarnerius, but are more Stradiuarian. His
ticket is, "Anno 17. Carlo Bergonzi fecit in Cre-
mona." His son and pupil, Michael Angelo Bergonzi,
17501780, was inferior to his father as a workman.
Franciscus and Omobono Stradivari, 1720
1743,
were pupils and sons of the great Stradivari, and
worked together after the death of their father. As
workmen inferior to their
father, they worked up much
of his refuse and unfinished
material after his death. Francis
was better than his brother, and
his work, which shows his high
tuition, is not without merit and
originality, differing much from
his father in his
/
hole. His
tone is very intense and good.
Joseph Anthony Guarnerius
(Cremona), born 1683, worked
1725
1745. The best of the
family of Guarneri ; surnamed
"del Jesu," from the device
4. he was in the habit of
I H S placing on his labels.
His work may be divided into
four periods. In the first, his
model varied, but he chiefly
copied Joseph (son of Andrew)
;
the scroll rather mean, the wood
cut out at the shoulder, the
f
holes long and marked.
Second period.Cut his backs
chiefly on the quarter ; the
pattern rather small, not too
highly arched, gently sloping
to the sides ; the varnish very
good ; the wood left rather
thick, especially in his backs
;
the pattern on the whole not
unlike Stradivari in the rather drawn out centre
bout and the narrow waist. The
f
holes were
considerably curved, the scroll very bold and well
cut, the purfling often running through both pegs, and
the varnish of a rich golden brown. Third period.
The pattern rather large and very original ; the
wood cut on the quarter ; the thicknesses perfectly
proportioned, though sometimes a trifle excessive in
the centre of the back. His varnish during this period
was his best, and has been considered equal to Stradi-
vari's. The fiddles of this period are broader in the
waist, the inner bout long but very elegant, the/holes
long and perpendicular (Fig.
20),
the scroll perfect,
1610.
VIOLIN-MAKING: AS IT WAS, AND IS. 105
FIG. 22.STRADIUARIUS, 1714.
(E. Withers.)
FIG. 20. STAINER, 1650.
(E. Withers.)
FIG. 21.RUGGIERI, 1720.
(E. Withers.)
fig. 23.-
J.
GUARNERIUS, 1730.
(E. Withers.)
and the varnish of a lovely orange shade. His_/"holes
at this time may be described as the perfection of
Gasparo di Salo's model. In his fourth period, Joseph
Guamerius del Jesu seems to have cast away his high
ideal and worked carelessly to satisfy present wants,
so roughly and imperfectly finished are his later
instruments. It is said that many (known as
"
Prison
fiddles,"
"
Drunken Josephs," etc.) were made in
prison, with tools, wood, and varnish brought him by
the gaoler's daughter. They are high built, the scroll
stiff, and the
f
holes too long and clumsy, the wood
and varnish alike inferior. In his better days it has
been said that he made a great many of his bellies
from one piece of wood, from a corresponding stain
down each side of the finger-board in all of them. I
have seen many
"
Josephs," but never such an one.
He seems to have in a great measure varied his thick-
nesses according to the acoustic qualities of his wood.
Paganini's celebrated violin was a Joseph Guarnerius
(1743).
His ticket runs
:
polished to such an
extent that it reflects any object
that is placed upon it almost as
clearly as a mirror, and, if
ebonised, it may be said, without
fear of contradiction, to be
"black but beautiful," if Messrs.
S. and H. Harris will permit
me to borrow the legend that
encircles the trade-mark of
their blacking, of which I dare say no more, lest I
be accused, as heretofore, of ulterior purposes and an
alleged greed of gain, to which I need only say, "Honi
soil qui vial
y
pense."
So much for the top : let us turn now to the legs.
These members in the poor pot-house table are
straight up and down, perpendicular to the floor and
the under-surface of the table,
and not always placed, as they
should be, in the relative posi-
tion held by the three corners
of an equilateral triangle.
And, in order to cover as
ample a base as possible,
because they are perpendi-
cular, it has been found
necessary to attach them to
the table as near the edge as
may be
;
and in order to save
as much trouble as possible
in notching in the rails that
connect them at the top,
slight indentations have been
made in the top of each leg
on either side of the angle
FIG. I. HALF ELEVATION OF TABLE
Scale, ij inch to the foot.
that is turned outwards, taking
out pieces of a wedge-like shape,
and into these the rails have been
dropped and nailed without the
slightest regard to appearance.
And if to give stability to the
structure additional rails have
been run from leg to leg at the
bottom, they have been attached
in the same clumsy, perfunctory
manner. From this maltreat-
ment of material, excellent in
itself, like all God's creatures,
but marred by man's want of art
and constructive skill, let us turn
again to our own table. In this,
the legs are disposed in the form
of the frustrum of a symmetrical
three-sided solid rising from an
equilateral triangle at its base,
that is to say, the bottom of each
leg stands on the angle of an
equilateral triangle, and this
position is preserved in decreas-
ing proportion upwards until the
tops of the legs meet the under-
surface of the top of the table at
a slight bevel or inclination.
Each leg is made out of a piece
of timber planed up four-square,
and then worked in the lathe until it presents the form
depicted in the illustration. The legs are so placed
that each presents a flat face outwards and a flat face
inwards of those parts which have not been touched in
the lathe, and which are utilised for the insertion of
the rails which connect them. The turned work is
simple but highly ornamental, and every bit of the
grooving necessary for the
junction of the several parts
may all be done in the lathe
;
but this is a subject on which
even many good turners may
require instruction, and mea-
sures are being taken to
insure its being given in
future parts of this magazine.
The angle at which the
legs incline to the floor and
the under part ofthe table-top
is shown in Fig. r, in which is
given half the elevation of the
table on a scale of i^ in. to the
foot, and from which, with the
other illustrations, any one
wishing to make a table of
2.PLAN OF LOWER RAIL AND SECTION OF LEGS.
Scale,
iJ inch to the loot.
A THREE-LEGGED OCCASIONAL TABLE. 129
this description can furnish himself with full-sized
working drawings. The angle to which reference has
iust been made may be, and must be, accurately deter-
mined from this figure, and preserved throughout the
work of preparing the pieces by means of a bevel,
otherwise the amateur will fail to cut the shoulders of
the tenons of the upper and lower rails at the right
inclination, which must be the same for all, though
reversed in the case of the upper rails, and perpendi-
cular to either edge at the inner ends of the lower
rails. The top, it may be as well to say here, is
rails of which it is composed is shown in Fig.
3,
from
which it will be seen, on measurement, that they are
3$ in. deep and 1 in. in thickness, the top of the table
being 2 feet 6 in. in diameter. The manner in which
the rails are let into the tops of the legs is shown in
Fig.
4,
which represents the plan of the under side of
the top of the table, showing the top of the frame work
on which it rests, and its position in relation to the
superincumbent disc. This plan, it should be said, in
common with all the other drawings which are not of
full size, are on a scale of li in. to the foot, that is to
L*-i
K-.
-
V
v_,
s
S
.
L
"
:
: '
FIG. 5.GROOVING FOUND
EDGE OF TABLE. Full size.
FIG. 4.PLAN OF UNDEK-SIDE OF TABLE AND FRAME.
Scale, i| inch to the foot.
TIG. 3.SECTION OF
FRAME. Full size.
intended to be about ij-in. in thickness, therefore, ij-in.
or if in. stuff will be suitable for it, which will be
reduced to the necessary thickness by planing the sur-
faces at top and bottom. The boards of which it is
composed should be connected by means of a dovetail
joint, if the amateur can manage it ; but at all events
they must be dowelled and glued up under pressure of
clamps until the glue is perfectly dry and set. The
grooving round the edge shown in full-size in Fig.
5,
may be effected by a grooving plane.
To return to the connection of the legs and rails.
The frame upon which the top of the table rests is a
triangle in shape, as it has been said, the triangle
being equilateral. A full-sized section, through the
say, each line in a full-sized working drawing will be
eight times as long as its corresponding line in the
diagrams given. The outer side of each rail at the
top of the frame, on which the disc of the table stands,
is deeply grooved, as shown in Fig.
3,
in correspond-
ence with the edge of the top.
The most noteworthy feature in connection with
the lower rails of the support of the table is that in-
stead of running from leg to leg, as in the framework
of rails at the top, they are each turned inwards,
being inserted in the legs at right angles, and are all
mortised into a cylindrical spindle, turned in the
lathe, and terminating in a larger ball above and a
smaller one below. Each rail is shown in full size in
F 2
13 FILTERS: THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND MAINTENANCE.
section in Fig. 6, and a plan of the rails, showing their
connection with the legs, and the short central post,
or spindle, is given in Fig. 2, on a scale of \\ in. to
the foot. It is almost needless to say that on account
of the inclination of the legs, great care and good
workmanship is required in cutting out the various
parts, and fitting them together. The upper edges of
the rails, as shown in Figs. 1, 2, and 6, are stop-
chamfered, and the lower ones scalloped. The sides
of the lower rails are also grooved to match the
grooving in the upper rails and the ed^e of the table-
top. When every part has been accurately fitted to-
gether, the tenons, etc., of the rails should be secured
in their respective mortises and notches by wooden
pins, after having been glued up. The holes and pins
may be got ready before the glue is applied.
The question with some amateurs will doubtless
now be how to connect the framework of the legs and
the table-top. Naturally an inclination will arise to
bore holes through the disc into the rails below, and
screw the top on, counter-sinking the holes to receive
the tops of the screws, and filling up the deficit with
putty, or some kind of filling. But this would be
wretched carpentry, and disfigure the top of the table
past redemption. How then is it to be managed?
Easily enough ; for all that the amateur has to do is
to cut some notches, of the shape of thumb-notches
in the sliding lids of boxes, in the inside surface of the
top rails, the round part downwards, or pointing to-
wards the bottom of the rails, and the flat part up-
wards. He must then lay the table-top on the ground,
underside upwards, turn the framework topsy-turvy
upon it, carefully adjust it to the proper position, which
may have been previously marked out in pencil, and
then screw the frame-work to the underside of the
table-top, by screws inserted in the notches, and
passing upwards through the rails and into the table-
top in a slightly slanting direction. This connects the
top and frame rigidly and immovably, and entirely
obviates the ricketiness that seems inseparable from
round tables, whose tops are movable to a certain
extent, turning on thumbscrews, passing into a square
block at the top of the pedestal, and held down by a
catch which always seems to get out of order after a
few months' wear.
This table makes a specially appropriate piece of
occasional furniture for a room with a polished floor,
or one whose sides are polished all round in front of
the skirting. It will look equally well if made in
mahogany, walnut, or oak, or in good pine, ebonised
or stained and varnished. A little gilding might be
introduced here and there in the depressions and pro-
jections of the turned work, to relieve the blackness of
the table when ebonised, but if this kind of ornamen-
ation be used at all it should be used sparingly. The
bjauty of the table any way will chiefly depend on the
minner in which it is finished, and to this part of his
work the amateur should pay the utmost attention.
I have dwelt much on the merits of this occasional
tible, but I trust I may be forgiven if I again urge on
the amateur wood-worker that these consist in the
simplicity, and therefore beauty, of its design
; the
s ability afforded by its ample base ; and the immova-
b lity of its top. What better could be found for that
imposition on the stomach, known in the present day
a? "five o'clock tea," so often a point d'appui for pull-
ing one's friends and neighbours to pieces. The ugly
1 ttle gipsy table, so-called, which consists of six spikes
s icking out of a ballthree in one direction, to form
a pedestal, and three in the opposite direction to sup-
port the fringed table-top, covered with cloth or velvet,
cannot be compared with it. But whether uncovered,
in the tone imparted to it by its finish, or draped with
a cover, temporary or otherwise, of damasked linen,
white or brown, or of a silk or woollen fabric, of a
colour that will blend and harmonise with it, this table
cannot fail to recommend itself to all whose eyes may
light on it.
=-$=
FILTERS :
THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND MAINTENANCE.
By ALFRED W. SOWARD.
I.IntroductionSimple Filters.
HE scope of the paper in which these
articles appear does not permit me to
offer any remarks upon the theory of
filtration
;
it must therefore be sufficient
for me to merely indicate that the ends
desired to be attained in causing water to pass through
a filtering medium are three, namely :
"
Permanent white, ivory-yellow, mixing-yellow,
silver-yellow, light-grey, dark-grey, warm-grey, carna-
tion Nos. I and 2, capucine-red, iron-violet, etc.
"Figure Pai?iting.For the flesh take carnation
No. I, and indicate the lines of the eyes, nostrils, mouth,
and ears, and wherever there is a line or outline in the
shade, reserving the light side, which should stand out
upon the ground by its local tint only. After the local
tintis placed, prepare a little yellow-brown and apply
it in the reflections with another brush. The local tint is
made to blend with the reflections by the putois.
Should the figure be that of an aged person, iron-violet
may be added to the above colours, and some small for-
cible strokes may be given before the tint is dry. For the
cast shadows, yellow-brown may be used and brown
No. 108 ; and for the strong shadows, iron-violet, blue-
green, and delicate grey. Never use any black in
shading the faces. Before using the putois, the tints
under the eyebrows may be made with pure carnation
No. 1. If the eyes be blue, use sky-blue, a little blue-
136
WALL-BRACKETS FOR CORNERS.
green, and some blue-grey. For brown eyes, yellow-
brown, retouched with sepia, or brown bitume. For
grey eyes use black-grey, light-grey, and a little blue.
The pupil is in raven black, and lastly the brilliant
point is left white, is removed with a penknife, or is
put in with permanent white. The nose is shaded with
carnation No. 1. In the nostrils iron-violet may be
added. Attention should be paid to the management
of the light on the angle of the nose. In painting the
mouth a line should never be made upon the upper
lip nor below the lower lip. The lips are painted with
carnation No. 1, and slightly retouched with No. 2. If
more vigour is desired, red-brown and neutral grey
may be employed in very small quantity, together with
iron-violet. Do not use the putois on the hair
;
it is
painted with strokes in its natural direction. Blonde
hair is sketched in ivory-yellow, and shaded with
yellow-brown, brown No. 108, and finished with grey-
brown, bitume, and sepiano black. Black hair is
outlined with yellow-brown, sepia, dark brown, No.
4,
and shaded with black and brown. Draperies are
painted in colours, as in monochrome. A general
tint is laid on, and is modelled with the same colour.
Other colours may be employed for the reflected
lights ; a rose drapery may be shaded with blue ; a
yellow drapery (ivory-yellow), with rose and capucine-
red. A white drapery, of which the white is reserved
in the light, will be begun in very light-blue mixed
with grey and a little green in the shadows. Upon
porcelain, a very light coat of ivory-yellow has a
good effect upon white draperies. Bear in mind
that purple and carmine, golden colours, should
never be used in flesh-tints, as they would not har-
monize with the other colours. Mr. Piton gives the
following general palette for figure-painting :
"
Greenish-blue, brown bitume, yellow-brown, deep
red-brown, brown No. 108, grey No. 1, warm grey,
iron-violet, silver-yellow, ivory-yellow, mixing-yellow,
black, ochre, carnation No. 1, carnation No. 2, orange-
red," etc.
WALL-BRACKETS FOR CORNERS.
HERE are few minor adjuncts to a house,
whether from a utilitarian or an orna-
mental point of view, that are more desir-
able and serviceable than wall-brackets
;
and of brackets of all kinds, shapes, and
sizes, those that are adapted to fit into the angle made by
the meeting of two walls at right angles to one another,
are perhaps the most serviceable and best calculated
for purposes of adornment. It is true that the bracket
which is constructed to fit against and stand out from
a single plane surface, has uses and advantages
peculiar to itself and the position it is intended to
occupy, but it is a centre of attraction only to the
eye in the midst, possibly, of the plane surface that
extends from it in every direction, upwards, down-
wards, to the right and to the left ; and though, in
especial cases, it may be made to break the continuity
of the framing of a panel or even the expanse of the
panel itself, whether broad or narrow, it can never be
instrumental in producing so striking an effect as the
bracket in a corner, which breaks to so much advan-
tage, the long lines in which the planes of the meeting
walls intersect ; rising so often in undisturbed mono-
tony, from the skirting below to the cornice above
that surrounds, or should surround, the top of the
room, taking away in its turn the abruptness of the
right angles in which the four walls and superincum-
bent ceiling meet.
To point out all the uses to which corner brackets
may be turned would occupy more space than is
desirable, and would, moreover, be unnecessary ; but it
may be permitted me to remind my readers, what an
agreeable resting-place for the eye, when taking in
survey every part of the walls of a room in order, is a
bust, or a vase, or some quaint piece of bric-a-brac,
sustained by a bracket set with due regard to the effect
that placing it at a proper height will give, in an other-
wise bare corner. Again, what can be found more use-
ful in the angle of a wall close to a bed-room door, if
space permit, than a bracket about two feet nine
inches, or three feet from the floor, which may be
brought into service as a support for a lamp for the
temporary lighting of the passage of the staircase, or
for so prosaic and common-place an object as a jug of
hot or cold water, or in summer time for the reception,
if large enough, of a cache-pot filled with a cool green
fern, or a specimen of the old fashioned bow-pot, or
bough-pot, a pleasure to our forefathers, which is now
almost wholly forgotten, and whose revival in these
later days is much to be desired.
I have no intention of dwelling on the ordinary
modes of making comer wall-brackets, for there must
be few amateurs who are unacquainted with them.
For out of the way corners it is sufficient to nail two
ledges on the same level, one to each of the adjacent
walls, to which to nail the inner edges of the bracket
;
and if the bracket be larger than usual to supplement
these supports by a piece extending from the end of
one ledge to the end of the other, occupying a position
similar to that which the cross stroke of the letter A
holds with regard to the slanting strokes that form the
sides of this letter, or even by a long strut extending
from the under surface of the shelf of the bracket to
the corner below. My object is rather to put the
amateur artisan in possession of some pleasing forms
of brackets which are well contrived and ornamental
WALL BRACKETS FOR
CORNERS.
FIG. 9.ELEVATION I I
^HRf
OF BRACKET WITH TILE. FIG. 8.
^&
M
Scale, 2 inches to the foot. bracket with tile, perspective view.
FIG. 10. PLA N OF BRACKET
WITH TILE.
Scale, 2 inches to the foot.
138
WALL-BRACKETS FOR CORNERS.
in character, and which from these very circumstances
will render the labour he has devoted to their con-
struction far more satisfactory than it could have been
if he had been contented to follow any of the stereo-
typed methods of putting up a small shelf of this kind,
which are known and practised by every village
carpenter.
In Fig. i is given the perspective view of a strong
but handsome wall-bracket of a character that renders
it well adapted for construction, not only by amateur
wood-workers, but by carpenters and cabinet-makers
generally. The form in itself is very pleasing as far as
its outline is concerned. The parts are so simple that
the merest novice in woodwork will have no difficulty in
constructing the bracket either in pine or in any of the
hard or fancy woods. Taking its form generally, it is
composed of three pieces, a shelf and two side-pieces.
The side-pieces, whose form is shown in Fig. 2, the
elevation of the bracket, regarding it from the left, are
partly in the form of a quadrant with a projection in
front at the upper end, and a pendant below. These
pieces, when cut out and ornamented, as shown in the
illustration or according to the fancy of the workman,
are dovetailed together at right angles. The shelf
which is a portion of an octagon, showing three of the
sides of this figure, is then attached to the side-pieces,
either by nailing it down to them or by connecting it
with them by notching or dovetailing. The plan of
this shelf is shown in Fig.
3 ; the view being taken as
looking on the under part of the shelf, the whole
bracket being turned upside down. This is evident
from the marks on either side of the rectangular part
of the shelf, which show the sides in plan. If the view
of the bracket in plan had been taken when looking at
its top and from a point of view above it, the sides
would not have been visible, being covered over and
entirely hidden from view by the shelf. There is a con-
dition of form in which Fig. 3
would have served as a
view of the upper surface of the shelf, regarding it
from above, and that is if the sides had been continued
upwards, so that their prolongation in that direction
would form a ledge round the shelf, the latter mem-
ber of the entire bracket being mortised into the sides.
The short transverse lines across the plan of the sides
would then indicate notches or diversity of surface in
the edge of the ledge, after the manner of those shown
in the perspective view in the sides below the shelf.
The ornamentation of the edges of the sides, and
the engraved lines on the inner sides of these sup-
ports, add much to its appearance, and make it a very
desirable object for internal decoration. The inner
edges of the rounded part of the supports, as shown in
Fig. 1 and Fig. 2, are notched and gently rounded
along the outer part of the notching. The engraved
lines may be deeply incised in a V-form, or grooved
and filled with wood of another colour. Either method
will look well, and prove satisfactory to the eye. The
design, it may be said, will look well executed in
almost any kind of wood. If inlaid, the lines should
be either light or dark, according as the wood of which
the supports are made is dark or light. The bracket
would present a very handsome appearance if made of
light hardwood and ebonised. In this case the lines
should be incised deeply, and gilded, in order to
brighten up its appearance, which some might be
inclined to consider somewhat sombre. What are
known as cabinet-hangers are provided on the inner
sides of the shelf for hanging the bracket in position,
as may be seen in the perspective view.
For those who require wall-brackets of a more
elaborate description, Figs.
4 and 8 will furnish designs,
that will in all probability prove eminently satisfactory,
both as regards the form and ornamentation of the
brackets, and the work involved in their construction.
It may be that in their general form all the brackets
exhibited in the illustrations that accompany this
paper, are similar ; but as they are all intended to
serve the same purposenamely, that of corner
bracketsthis similarity, perhaps, is not to be won-
dered at. It will be useful, however, to note the
principal points in, and method of, construction in
each case ; but before going any further with refe-
rence to the brackets which are about to be noticed,
let me point out to the reader that Fig. 2 will serve as
well for the elevation of a bracket to be used against
a flat surface as for a corner bracket, but he must
remember that if the bracket be constructed to serve
this purpose, the side now in view will form a projec-
tion running outwards from the wall, along the centre
of the shelf, the other side being extended in a reversed
form to supply a back-piece, into which the projecting
part of the bracket may be mortised. The side that
is converted into the support of the shelf in front, must
be notched on both sides of the edge, and the shelf
must be doubled in size, being extended in a reversed
form in the same manner as it has been found neces-
sary to extend the side which now forms the back.
To return to Fig.
4,
in which a perspective view of
the second bracket is shown. This bracket is largei
in size than the first, more elaborate in its ornamenta-
tion and construction, and of greater capacity, as it
contains a small shelf below the larger one, which may
be used as a depository for any choice piece of china.
The full size of the bracket may be gathered from the
figures showing the elevation, plan, and details which
are done on a certain scale, the plan and elevation
being on a scale of ij inch to the foot, and the
details on a scale of 6 inches to the foot, or one-half
the full size. In making a full-sized working drawing,
the amateur artisan must remember, that in the
WALL-BRACKETS FOR CORNERS.
139
plan and elevation every line in the figures must
be exactly eight times as long as those shown
in the drawing, to the scale of ij inch to the foot,
and twice as long as each line shown in Fig. 7. The
side-pieces, as shown in the elevation, must first be
accurately cut out and dovetailed together, mortises
being made for the reception of the shelves, as shown
in the plan. The profile of the two side-pieces is
shown in Fig.
5,
which is the elevation of the bracket,
regarding it from the left. The plan is shown in Fig.
6, the observer being supposed to be looking down-
wards upon it from a point of view above it. In this
figure the upward extension of the sides so as to form a
ledge round the upper shelf is clearly shown. The
circlets along the edge of the shelf show the position
of the little spindles of turned work that form a dwarf
rail in front of the shelf. The spindles are bedded
into the front of the shelf, but the top of each enters a
rail in the form of a quadrant, or quarter of a circle,
whose ends enter a square piece of wood, with turned
ends, into which the projecting part of each side, for a
little distance, both above and below the upper shelf,
is securely mortised. A part of the upper shelf is
supposed to be removed in Fig. 6, in order to show the
plan, or rather a part of the plan of the smaller bot-
tom shelf, which, as well as the top shelf, is notched
along the under part of its edge. The detail of the
small spindles, and the square projecting member, with
turned ends, resembling chess pawns, is clearly shown
in Fig. 7. Much that was said about the wood of
which the bracket, shown in Fig. I, was to be made,
and the method to be followed in finishing and orna-
menting it, applies as well to this as to the first bracket
described, and there is no occasion to waste time and
space in repeating it
The bracket shown in Fig. 8 is more elaborate even
in construction and embellishment than that which is
shown in Fig.
4,
although straight lines greatly pre-
dominate in the outline of the sides, the only curved
lines in these members of the bracket being the small
arches surmounting the columns and the trefoil-shaped
ornament at the bottom, assuming this form when the
sides are joined together. There are only four prin-
cipal pieces in this bracketnamely, the two side-pieces
and the top and bottom shelf, the balustrade on the
upper shelf being simply supplementary. The bracket
would perhaps be improved if the side-pieces were
extended upwards, as in the case of the bracket shown
in Fig.
4,
so as to form a back to the upper shelf ; this,
however, is a mere matter of taste, and can be easily
carried out by any amateur if this style be preferred.
The side-pieces in this bracket present no structural
difficulty, except in the insertion of the small columns,
which are added for the sake of elaborating the design,
and adding to its ornamental appearance. The detail
of these columns on a scale of 6 inches to the foot are
shown in Fig. 12. They are plain in character, though
in perfect harmony with the other parts of the bracket.
To make these columns square pieces of wood must be
planed up, and from these the columns must be pro-
duced in the lathe. The caps and bases of the columns,
when fixed in their place, will project slightly beyond
the surface of the sides in front and back. In order
that the sides may rest flatly against the walls in rear
of them, the projecting parts at the back must be taken
off with a smoothing-plane, as clearly shown in Fig.
9,
the elevation of the bracket regarded from the left, and
drawn on a scale of 2 inches to the foot. The upper
shelf is either notched into the sides or nailed down
to them, the former method being preferable ; the
lower shelf is mortised into the sides, which are joined
by dovetailing. Cabinet hangers are attached to the
sides at the top of the bracket, as a means of suspend-
ing it against the wall. The plan of each shelf is
shown at one view in Fig. 10, in which they are sup-
posed to be viewed from above, part of the upper
bracket being removed in order to show the plan of
the lower bracket. Fig. 10 is drawn on a scale of 2
inches to the foot. The front edge of each shelf is
moulded. The top shelf is surmounted by a light
balustrade, formed by spindles, whose details are shown
on a scale of 6 inches to the foot in Fig. 1 1, which also
exhibits the edge of the shelf in which the spindles are
fixed, and a section of the curved quadrant-shaped rail
by which they are surmounted.
The principal feature in this bracket is the intro-
duction of an ornamental tile, inserted diagonally
instead of square. Considerable scope is given to the
taste and ingenuity of the amateur in the general cha-
racter and ornamentation of this tile. Some will prefer
one of painted china ; others may like a terra-cotta
tile in relief. If the amateur can manage itbut I
fear there will be but very few who could a piece of
repousse work in metal would present a good appear-
ance
; and if embossed work is liked, a piece of Lin-
crusta-Walton might be pressed into the service, though
I much doubt the possibility of being able to get a
small piece of it, unless the amateur happened to be
acquainted with any one who was using it in quantity
for internal decoration. If any one, however, is in-
clined to ask the question, he should apply at the
Show-Rooms,
9,
Bemers Street, London, W., where it
may be seen as fixed in various styles and for various
purposes.
Perhaps, after all, the most suitable and efficient
tile for the amateur's use in this kind of decorative
work is the Papyrotile, a new patented tile, which has
the merits of being cheap, light, durable, and easily
applied, and which, if wanted in large quantities, can
be made to order in any design that may be preferred.
140
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL,
The Papyrotile is produced by a company whose offices
are at 14,
Holborn Viaduct, London, .C, where
specimens may be seen and ever)' information obtained
from the manager, Mr. A. W. Duret. The tiles, how-
ever, cannot be obtained here, as the company supplies
the trade only. More will be said about these tiles and
their application to various decorative purposes in a
future number.
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
[The Editor reserves to himself the right of refusing a reply to
any question that may be frivolous or inappropriate, or devoid cf
general interest. Correspondents are requested to bear in mind
that their queries will be answered only in the pages of the Maga-
zine, the information sought being sxipplied for the benefit of its
readers generally as well as for those who have a special interest
in obtaining it. In no case can any reply be sent by post.]
ANY inquiries have arisen out of the
papers devoted to organ-building, ar.d
much interest has been displayed in the
subject by many readers of Amateur
Work, Illustrated. To prevent any
undue disappointment through the non-appearance of
answers to queries in this Part, it may be stated that
they will be given in a collected form in Part IV., in
which a smaller type will be used for replies to corre-
spondents, and an attempt made to classify the
information given under various headings, for the con-
venience of readers when looking for answers to their
inquiries.
Several correspondents, including H. H. and
H. W. H. (Brompton), ask for instruction on the mode
of fixing and managing
"
Electric Bells." Arrange-
ments have been mcde for a series of articles on this
subject, which will be commenced on the completion
of the papers on "Electro-plating at Home." L. W. B.,
and others who are interested in "Bookbinding" are
informed that full instructions in this useful art have
been promised by a contributor, whose papers on this
subject will be commenced at no distant date.
L. R. L. (Sheffield).If possible your request shall
be complied with at an early date.
J.
F. B. W. H. (Whitchurch) asks where the cheap
saw called
"
The Holborn" mentioned in a reply to a
correspondent in Part II., can be obtained. I am
told it is sold by Mr. Fordham, of High Holborn,
who has other specialities so called, so that the name
must be considered rather as a trade-mark for certain
of his wares than as the name of the saw. The second
query proposed by
J.
F. B. W. H. will be answered in
Part IV. This reply also answers the inquiries made
by
J.
M. (East Wemyss) and T. L. (Clapham) ; but I
must remind the former that I did not recommend the
saw in question "as suitablefor holding ordinaryfret-
saws" but as being fitted with a blade longer than the
ordinary fret-saw, which might be used with advantage
in the
"
Simple Fret-Sawing Machine " described in
Part I. The teeth of the blade are somewhat coarse
and rendered unfit for fine work, but for rough work
and cross-cutting it will do very well.
Fox.You say, and say truly enough, with regard
to organ building, fhatzV wouldhave been a good thing
to have given the idea
of
the cheapest pipesfirst, or at
least at the same time as those
of
wood. The appear-
ance of the first paper on
"
How to Build a Small
Organ," caused an amateur organ-builder to write
with reference to an invention of his own for making
pipes at a far cheaper rate than those of wood. This
has led to an arrangement for a new series of papers
on the subject, in which these cheap pipes, and the
method of making them, will be described, and in-
structions given for building organs on a larger scale.
These papers will be commenced in Vol. II. In a
magazine of this description there are many sub-
jects that require treatment, and it is not fair to its
readers generally to devote too much space to any one
particular subject.
J.
C. (Partick).You will find the promised paper
on "Wall Brackets for Corners
"
in this Part. It was
crowded out of Part II. Your wish for instructions
on how to make a camera
of
the
"
sliding body
"
kmd,
suitable for taking, say,
\
plate photos" with working
drawings to scale, shall be satisfied as soon as possible,
but I cannot promise that a paper on the subject shall
appear, without fail, in Part IV.
Snowball, in reply to E. P. C.'s request for a few
hints as to sharpening lancets and other surgical in-
struments (see page
93)
says :
"
/ have always
shatpened mine on a slip
of
Turkey stone, and used
glycerine and enough alcohol to make it run easily.
Practice alone can tell you when they are sharp enough,
unless you try them. I cannot tell how the polish is
put on unless with a leather wheel andfine emery"
F.
J.
R. (Stoke Newington).The vulcanization of
india-rubber was effected, in the first instance, by im-
pregnating pieces of the rubber with sulphur. This
has the effect of depriving it of its adhesiveness, and
increasing its pliancy, while its elasticity is altogether
unimpaired. The addition of magnesia, sulphide of
antimony (which makes red rubber), and other sub-
stances, is resorted to in order to increase its solidity
and power of resistance. Vulcanization of rubber, for
manufacturing purposes, is effected by the application
of steam in special machinery, contrived for the incor-
poration of the ingredients. You may possibly suc-
ceed in vulcanizing the rubber for making stamps by
melting sulphur in an iron pot, and dipping pieces of
the material into it, until they are thoroughly per-
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
141
meated by the sulphur. This may be ascertained by
cutting open the rubber. The action of the sulphur
deprives it of its dark colour, and if the rubber present
a light colour throughout the piece, it is sufficiently
impregnated with the sulphur as far as mere permea-
tion is concerned. To effect complete vulcanization,
however, the rubber must be left for an hour, or there-
abouts, in the sulphur bath, at a temperature of about
2/5
D
, and it should be suspended in the bath by wires,
so as to keep it just below the surface of the melted
sulphur, in order to prevent hardening and loss of
elasticity, through being subjected to the greater heat
at the bottom of the bath.
W. R. P. (Bournemouth).Wood that has been
warped may be brought straight again, in some cases,
by wetting the convex side and placing it in the sun,
or at a moderate distance from the fire. Fret-work
brackets, reading-desks, etc., cut out of smooth wood
should be stained of the colour required, if the maker
is not satisfied with the ordinary colour of the wood.
When the staining is dry, the work must be sized.
The size, which can be bought of the oil and colour-
man, must be melted in an earthen pipkin, and applied
to the work when warm. As soon as the sizing is dry,
apply a coat of hard white varnish, or even two coats,
if necessary. Papers on finishing wood-work and
pieces of furniture will be given in due course.
J.
C. (North Shields).A good filling for wood is
mentioned in Part I., page
43 ;
you should try this.
In using plaster of Paris for filling, it should be brought
to the consistence of thick cream with water, colour-
ing matter being added to assimilate it to the colour
of the wood. This must be rubbed across the grain
with a piece of rag until the pores are filled, when the
surface of the wood should be carefully wiped, and
when thoroughly dry, rubbed over with fine glass
paper. The French polish should then be applied
lightly and with a semicircular motion of the hand
until the entire surface is completely polished. The
polish will be partially absorbed by the wood, and it
may be found necessary to repeat the process again,
and even for a third time, rubbing down the former
coat with glass paper that has been already worn down
by use before repolishing.
R. C. (Bradford) is thanked for the receipts for
dyeing wood that he sends. A description of a com-
plete suite of doll's furniture, with designs and work-
ing drawings, shall be given in a future number, when a
suitable opportunity offers.
Amateur.Plaster casts can be taken from busts
or statuettes, modelled in ordinary modelling clay. It
is not possible to give "<z short description
of
the
process" here, which would be a sufficient guide for
the performance of the operation. It must be reserved
for a paper on the subject
F. C. (Brighton).Articles on the mode of con-
structing and finishing a good astronomical telescope,
with directions for grinding the lenses, will be given
as soon as opportunity offers.
H. A. H. (Shane Street).Engraving on ivory is
carried out in very much the same manner as engrav-
ing on metal or wood, as far as the work of incision is
concerned: that is to say, it is done with graving tools.
There are many recipes for making French polish, but
perhaps the most simple one is as follows :Shell-lac,
6 oz.
;
wood naphtha, 1 pint : dissolve the shell-lac in
the naphtha, and then add
i
pint of linseed oil. French
polish gives a glossy appearance to the surface of the
wood, but it will not darken a light-coloured wood.
To effect this the wood must have been previously
stained.
W. C. (Bromley-by-Bo-w).Luminous paint can be
bought in small quantities of Messrs. D. Judson & Son,
Southwark Street, S.E.
J.
P. V. M. (Bishop's Stortford).In the forth-
coming papers on
"
Carving in Wood," intending wood-
carvers will be told where they can purchase good
seasoned woods suitable for carving.
E. B. (Dublin).In
"
Notes on Novelties," in this
Part, you will find that mention is made of a shooting-
board intended to help the amateur in bevelling pieces
of fretwork at suitable angles. You might try this,
and report on it. If it does not answer, a way shall
be found to help you and others who find a similar
difficulty in bevelling edges at any required angle.
C. H. D. (Gz/ernsey).Papers descriptive of the
best modes of imitating stained glass will be given in
due course ; and in the second series of papers on
"
Organ Building " a Supplement will be supplied,
giving working drawings of the organ-front and diffe-
rent parts of the instrument on as large a scale as
possible.
Amateur (No. 2).To stain your white wood,
decide what wood you wish to imitate, and then pur-
chase that variety of Stephens's Wood Stain which is
prepared to produce an imitation of the wood chosen.
Old furniture must be scraped and well sand-papered
before re-staining, which must be effected in the usual
manner.
Gio.Your kindly criticisms and good wishes are
alike welcome. The date of issue is now given on the
Wrapper, as you may have learnt from Part II. All
the modern practical applications of electricity to
household use will be dealt with in turn. By all means
write a paper for Amateur Work, Illustrated, on
your experiences in constructing a telephone at home
;
it will be useful to and appreciated by many. The
reversal of the T
square was an oversight. You did
right in addressing your letter to the Editor, to the
care of the publishers.
142
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
R. L.
J. (
Wincanton).It is not possible to indi-
cate a more
"
simple method
of
setting, up a small cir-
cular saw" than that shown in "Every Man his Own
Mechanic." Any smith would make you a spindle,
with a shoulder against which the saw could be butted,
and held in place by a nut working on a screw-thread.
The puzzle you send shall be mentioned in a future
paper on
"
More Enigmas in Wood."
R. S. (Puddletown), says,
"
I have some thermome-
ters ; the degrees are etched on the glass, but by con-
tinued exposure to the weather, the black composition
that filled the degrees has been washed out. What is
the composition to be used for re-filling them ?
"
Can
any reader of Amateur Work, Illustrated, help
R. S. in this ? To give full-sized working drawings of
large articles to be made by amateurs is well-nigh im-
possible : there is no real difficulty in constructing a
full-sized working drawing from a drawing to scale.
Still, if it can be accomplished occasionally at some
future time, you may rely upon it that it shall be done.
C. M. H.Papers on "the making and working
of
model engines of
various forms" will be useful.
Kindly send a specimen paper at your convenience.
You will notice that attention has been paid to the
request in the postscript to your letter.
Captain.You will see that, in accordance with
your wishes, it is sought to describe tools and mecha-
nical appliances as clearly as possible, and give their
prices, etc. If you require information with regard to
the capabilities and price of any particular tool you
nay wish to purchase, it shall be supplied in this part
of the magazine.
Merry {an ardent Cyclist) says, "In reading
your admirable Introduction, I
find
no reference to
any intended instruction as to repairing cycles. Surely
vou do not inte?id to omit this most useful subject.''
Certainly not ! but at present there is no one on the
staff of Amateur Work, Illustrated, who is
sufficiently experienced thereon to handle it thoroughly.
Will any cyclist and amateur smith volunteer his
services ?
C. L. {Bloomsbury).If any new suggestions for
making tool-chests are offered at any time, they will
appear in the pages of this magazine. Meanwhile, you
will find various methods, described in detail, in
'
Every Man his Own Mechanic."
F. M. S. {Whitby).In accordance with the pro-
mise made to
J.
C. (Partick), a practical paper on the
construction of cameras shall be given in an early
number, accompanied by working drawings on as large
a scale as possible.
E. W. {Headley).Your wood being only three-
eighths of an inch in thickness, when planed down is
rather thin for parquetry. The pieces, as you suggest,
may be joined oy grooving and tonguing
; but as the
wood is thin, it will be as well to glue it to the floor,
which should be planed, if in any way rough and un-
even, so as to present a perfectly smooth and level
surface before the blocks are laid upon it.
A. K.To colour your bookcase, use Stephens's
Rosewood Stain, which affords as good an imitation
of rosewood as you can obtain. After the staining is
perfectly dry, the work must be sized and varnished.
M. G. F. supplies some useful information with
reference to some of the receipts given in
"
Ways and
Means," Part I. He says that the Gutta Percha
Cement, described in page 42,
"
has been used by shoe-
makers and by engineers for joining belting, in this
country, for the last thirty years." The Black Fluid
for Ebonising (page
43)
"
is a most valuable receipt."
Its efficiency is in no way impaired by long keeping,
and one great advantage is that it can be used
cold ; in fact, M. G. F. never uses it otherwise.
In making the Liquid Glue mentioned in page
43,
"
the glue should be steeped in cold water for a few
hours before being put into the whiskey. It will form
a stiff jelly
if
the glue is good, and should be melted by
setting the bottle in a basin
of
boiling water.
If
liquia
when cold, it is
of
little or no use. Any spirit will do,
if not above proof strength" M. G. F. will render
great service to the readers of Amateur Work,
ILLUSTRATED, by sending for insertion in
"
Ways and
Means" any tried receipts that he has been in the
habit of using.
*q* To prevent disappointment to readers who
may be specially interested in them, it may be said
that Mr. Paul N. Hasluck's papers on "Lathe-Making
for Amateurs " and
"
Household Clocks : How to
Adjust, Clean, and Repair Them," will be resumed in
Part IV. Extreme pressure of work has unfortunately
delayed the production of
"
copy," and so prevented
their appearance in due continuance in the present
Part.
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
MONG recent inventions of merit that will
especially commendthemselves to amateur
wood-workers is the new Patent Bench
Clamp, designed by Mr. James Murphy
of Providence, Rhode Island, U.S., whose
name it bears, and manufactured and supplied by the
New England Butt Company. The chief peculiarity
of this Bench Clamp is that it is self-fastening, as may
be understood from an inspection of Figs. 9 and 10,
of which the first represents the ordinary appearance
of the machine, the second being in elevation in order
to show the form of mortise that must be cut in the
bench-top in order to receive the projecting foot of
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
143
the clamp, which is bevelled forward and downwards,
and grooved that it may hold more firmly against the
wood of the bench-top, and the form and action of the
double-acting ratchet lever, which is depressed in Fig.
9
and raised in Fig. 10. It adapts itself to any thick-
ness of bench-top or other place where its use may be
required, a simple mortise in the wood, as shown in
Fig.
T
o, being all that is necessary to secure it wher-
ever it may be wanted. Mortises may be placed in
the bench-top at suitable distances apart, thus adapt-
ing the tool to use in connection with work of various
sizes. One of the great advantages resulting from its
use is the protection of the work as well as the bench
from the destruction so often caused by the use of
bench-knives and nails. The ratchet is so constructed
that a projecting member fashioned within the slot of
the handle engages in the slots shown in the head of
the screw, making it possible to turn the screw either
way. By lifting the handle or drawing it forward, it is
released from the slot. The screw may then be turned
by the hand in either direction, for which purpose the
edge of the screw-head is milled. It will be found
most valuable for holding work securely in any posi-
tion upon the bench between the projecting end of the
screw and any bench stop, and without injury to the
work, and it is also available for holding these strips
while being worked, and also for clamping up doors,
sashes, frames, and glued work. I do not think it has
found its way into this country yet : at all events, I do
not find it in Messrs. Churchill & Co.'s Catalogue, and
so I commend it to their notice. A sample Clamp is
sent by the manufacturers in America for $2.75, which
would make its cost here about us. or 12s., no great
price for so useful an adjunct to the carpenter's bench.
It is neat, compact, strong, and finished in black
japan.
Amateurs who are in the habit of making their own
picture frames will find Porter & Burnham's Picture
Frame Vice, which is represented in Fig. 11, a most
useful appliance for gripping and holding the adjacent
sides of a frame prior to nailing them together. The
sole agents for the manufacturers in this country are
Messrs. C. Churchill & Co., of 28, Wilson Street,
Finsbury, E.C., who supply this Frame Vice complete
for 225. 6d. To help the reader to form a better idea
of it than he can gain, perhaps, from the illustration,
it may be said that the vice itself is 24 inches high and
8 inches wide at the top, where are the jaws which
grip and hold the pieces of the frame at right angles
to each other. The vice can be fixed to a table or
bench, and removed at pleasure. It possesses the
advantages of simplicity, strength, and durability, and
can be easily and quickly adjusted to mouldings of
any width and frames of all sizes. The pieces being
adjusted and fitted together, after mitring over the two
pieces of iron connected by a quarter of a circle which
appear below the corner of the frame shown in the
vice, a pair of jaws parallel to these pieces are brought
down on the sides of the frame gently but firmly by
means of a cam lever attached to a treadle and
depressed by the foot of the operator, holding them
immovably fixed till the pressure is relaxed. The
hands of the frame-maker are thus left at liberty to do
whatever may be necessary. This frame-vice, which
is made entirely of iron, is used much by professional
picture-frame-makers in the United States, where it
has given great satisfaction to all who have made trial
of it.
The Patent Auto-Pneumatic Fountain, represented
in Fig. 12, manufactured by Messrs. Kessel & Son,
and illustrated in Fig. 12, will be welcomed by those
who wish to place anything of this kind in bay
window or conservatory. Its appearance may be
gathered from the engraving. It is a self-contained
and self-acting fountain, entirely free from the objec-
tionable appliances of springs, valves, weights, etc.,
which hitherto have been so commonly used in the
construction of machines of this sort. It consists of
three chambers, of which A is the uppermost one, or
the aquarium, into which the water is poured when it
is desired to charge the fountain. The water, perco-
lating through some fine holes pierced in a cone, finds
its way into the bottom chamber, B, and when this
chamber is full, the water will maintain its height in
the aquarium, A. At the top of the cone already
mentioned, three leaves are placed round the jet, one
of which forms the handle of a piston-rod, and if this
be worked up and down for about five minutes, the
water is raised into the third air-tight chamber, C. As
soon as the tap is turned on, the fountain will imme-
diately begin to play, the water falling into the aqua-
rium ;
but by a scientific internal arrangement the
water is again carried into the chamber b, which is
now the air-tight chamber, and the air, having no
means of escape as the water rises in B, becomes
compressed with the weight of water in the aquarium.
Then, of course, there is a connection between B and
C, conveying the compressed air into the middle
chamber, which air, pressing on the surface of the
water, forces it up through the jet tube, and hence the
fountain. The principle is compressed air automatically
arranged, so that there is, as it were, a fight between
air and water for the mastery. The air is forced into
the fountain, and is only there as in any other empty
space ;
but the air that is forced in is so completely a
captive slave that it cannot possibly escape, and is
compelled to do its work. The fountains are made
with one-hole, three-hole, and five-hole jets, and in
two sizes, sold at % 8s., and ,10 10s. respectively.
The smaller size will play from
5
to 6 hours with a
IAA NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
one-hole jet, the larger size from 7 to 8 hours. Of
course, the greater the number of holes, the less time
the fountain will play.
A new colouring matter for wood, which appears
to be cheap and useful, has been lately introduced
under the name of
"
Otto's Permanent
Wood Stain," manu-
factured only by
Messrs. Otto & Co., 20,
RedLion Square, Lon-
don, W.C. The mate-
rial, which is sold in
the form of a powder,
in tins of different sizes,
at is., 2s.,and4s., yields
a stain of a good brown,
having a close resemblance
to the colour usually known
as dark oak. All shades of
brown, from the lightest to
the darkest can be produced,
by adding coat after coat,
until the depth of colour re-
quired is obtained. The first
coat is a light golden brown.
The contents of the canis-
ter must be dissolved in
water, according to the direc-
tions given on each, and
applied with a brush. Before
the final coat is quite dry,
the wood should be wiped,
after which it must be sized
and varnished, or polished in
the usual way.
Messrs. R. Melhuish
and Sons, of 85 &
87,
Fetter Lane, London,
E.C., have sent me a
card of tools, whichwill
certainly be found use-
ful in houses where
nothing more than a
little simple every-day
work is done with car-
penter's tools when
absolutely necessary.
The card is also calculated to form an acceptable
present to a boy of about 8 to 10, who shows a liking
for hammers and saws. The price of the card is
4s. 3d., for which the buyer becomes possessed of
nine tools, namelya small saw, a hammer, a chisel,
pincers, small screw-driver, tack-lifter, bradawl, gim-
let, and nail-punch. The tools are of fair quality, and
for the purposes mentioned are certainly very cheap.
From the same firm I have also received several
designs for fret-sawing, by Russell and Pomeroy, some
of which are bold and well conceived. Among these
is a corner dtagere, which would amply repay any
fret - sawer for his
labour in cutting it.
Those who are content
with smaller subjects
would do well to send
for one of the pattern
books, in music size or
thereabouts, that Mr.
Melhuish supplies at
2 s. each, post-free.
There are 20 plates in
each number.
I have also received some
fret - work designs from
Messrs. Harger Brothers,
Goldielands, Settle, which are
all good except one,into which
some animals
two grey-
hounds and a hare are intro-
duced. Figures of men,
women, children, and animals,
should never be found in fret-
work, unless of Japanese
design, in which, perhaps,
animals are admissible. In
fret-work symmetry is natu-
rally looked forthat is to
sny, symmetry of parts in
correspondence ofoutline,and
this is marred by the intro-
duction of figures. Messrs.
Harger Brothers also
; 10. supplyashuteingboard
or shooting board
with
articles in metal-work, china, glass, and bric-a-brac,
has rendered places of deposit for these things abso-
lutely necessary
;
and, in Addition to brackets and
shelves in positions that our forefathers never dreamt
of, the corner-cabinet or cupboard has been revived,
and resorted to^^nce again as a suitable means
for the display of all sorts of pretty art-fancies in
wares of v? .ous kinds. It is easily made and easily
'as many an amateur will doubtless have a
'
, ;
corner here or there that he may like to "fit up in this
way, a design for a composite cabinet of shelves and
cupboard has been given here, from which he may
gather useful hints for the treatment of a piece of garni-
ture of this kind, and which he may easily alter in any
point of detail to suit his own particular requirements.
The front elevation of the corner-cabinet, as shown
in Fig. i, and the plan of
it as exhibited in Fig.
2, are
set out to a scale of one-
eighth, or in other words, so
as to be more explicit, one-
eighth of an inch to an inch;
every measurement, there-
fore, in the cabinet itself
when made, or in a full-sized
working drawing of the
cabinet, should be exactly
eight times as much as the
corresponding
measure-
ment in the drawing. Being
drawn to scale, the amateur
will experience ho difficulty
in making a full-sized work-
ing drawing from the illus-
tration given. According
to the scale, the sides of the
cabinet which butt against
the walls that form the
corner of the room in which
the cabinet is to be placed
are 15 inches in width, the
measurement across the
front being 21 inches, and
the height from its base to
the top of the members that
rise above the top rail being
41 inches; the height, there-
fore, is very nearly double
the breadth, and, if it please
the amateur to do so, for
the sake of attaining exact-
ness of proportion between
the length and the breadth,
he may make his cabinet
exactly 42 inches in height.
It has been said that the measurement across the
front is 21 inches. For all practical purposes this
is near enough ; but the width of the sides being
exactly
15 inches, the precise width of the front
will be 21.21 inches, or 21-^ inches. Any one
who has got to the end of the first book of Euclid
knows, or at all events ought to know, that the square
of the side which subtends a right angle is equal to
the squares of the sides by which the right angle is
G
I.A HANDY CORNER-CUPBOARD.FRONT ELEVATION,
Scale, ij inches to the foot.
146
A HANDY CORNER-CUPBOARD.
contained. The angle at which the sides of the cabinet
meet is a right angle, the sides of the cabinet are
15 inches in width, consequently the square of each
side of the cabinet is 225 ; the aggregate sum of the
squares of the two sides is
450,
and the square root of
450,
which represents the square of the width of the
front, subtending the right angle contained by the
sides is 21.21 inches. To the great majority of the
readers of Amateur Work, Illustrated, these
remarks may possibly appear needless ; but there may
be some to whom a simple lesson in geometry of this
kind will be useful, and for their sakes the opportunity
of giving it must not be thrown away.
It is possible that some who may be thinking of
making for themselves a cabinet of this description
may consider that the dimensions, as given above, are
too small ; and they will be, perhaps, confirmed in
this opinion, if they hold a two-foot rule before them,
FIG. 2.PLAN OF HANDY CORNER-CUPBOARD.
and see how small a length 21 inches appears to be.
They will find, however, when the cabinet is made
and put in its place, that it is quite large enough, and
that, if it had been larger, it would have presented a
heavy and unsightly appearance. It has been found
from experience that corner cupboards and cabinets
invariably appear to be larger than they really are,
and that there is nothing more deceptive than trusting
to the eye alone in judging of the size of corner
articles. The amateur, therefore, is advised not to
exceed the dimensions given, for the reason that has
just been stated. The area of each triangular shelf in
t
he cabinet, allowing
f
inch for the thickness of the
sides, will be 101A square inches
; and as there are
shelves and a small cupboard, this will afford room for
the display of many pretty pieces of china and glass,
large and small. According to the plan shown in
Fig. 2, the sides are of
J
inch stuff, grooved and tongued
together, and framed into rectangular slips of wood,
1 inch squareone at the angle in which the sides
meet, and one at the outer edge of each side. There
is no necessity whatever for the square rod at the
back, as the edge of one side may be made to overlap
the edge of the other, and be nailed to it ; and if it be
desired to break the stiffness of the angle, as shown in
(.BOT-
TOM
TOP
SHELF.
GREATEST
DEPTH OP
FILLET.
TOP OF
CCPBOAED.
the elevation, all that is necessary is to saw an inch-
square rod down cornerwise, from end to end, and,
after planing up the face, to nail it in the angle. Such
a piece as this is not shown in the plan (Fig.
2), but it
is apparent in the elevation (Fig. 1). The principal
use of the square rod in the angle is to afford a
holding into which to mortise the rail that forms a
capping to the spindles
;
but when the sides are
nailed edge to edge, a piece may be
contrived to lap over the sides at their
juncture in the angle, and butt
against the wall, thus affording an
upright, into which the capping of the
rail may be mortised ; the end of
this, and of the pieces at the outer edge
of the sides, being finished as shown
in the illustration.
The sides being joined together,
and the shell of the structure, so to
speak, being completed, the shelves
must be dropped in and screwed in
their places from behind. This will
be found to give stability and stiffness
to the structure. The shelves are of
inch stuff, and to take away from the
too substantial appearance of wood of
this thickness, a groove from
i
in. to
J
in. in width is made along the edge
of each shelf as shown. Before each
shelf is placed in position and screwed
up, provision must be made bygrooving
or by nailing a fillet on to the under
side, close to the edge, for the recep-
tion of the rails or fillets, with, in two
cases, bracket-like ends which appear
in the illustration. These fillets may
be made according to taste, but the
lowest one will look well if neatly
scalloped and bored in each scallop.
The cupboard in the centre is 1 1 inches
high in the clear, and the doors are
9
1 in. by 11 in. The panels of the
doors may be of glass, but if so, the
styles and rails of the doors should be
considerably less in width than shown
in the illustration. A fret-work band
may be substituted for the rail at the top, but if
the cabinet be finished as shown in the illustration,
the upper ends of the sides should be grooved
into the slip which forms the lower member of
the rail, and the spindles should be dropped into
holes recessed for the purpose into this slip and the
capping above the spindles. The cabinet will look
well in any kind of wood, whether light or dark, but
the colour must depend upon the positionwhich it is
BOTTOM OF
CUPBOAED.
BOTTOM
SHELF.
FIG. 3. GRA-
DUATED ROD.
HOW TO CONSTRUCT A BAROMETER. 147
to occupy, the nature of its surroundings, and the
colour of the wall, or predominating tint of the wall-
paper against which it is placed.
Before commencing work the amateur is recom-
mended to set out the length of the cabinet from top
to bottom, as from A to B in the rod shown in Fig. 3.
This rod may be marked or graduated so as to show
the position of the rail and its members at the top, the
thickness of the shelves, and the relative distances
between them. The rod thus marked can be applied
to the inner surface of the sides along either edge,
and the position of the shelves determined with the
utmost accuracy. It is always safer to do this in such
cases than to trust to mere measurements with the rule.
HOW TO CONSTRUCT A BAROMETER.
By A. F. MILLER.
T the present time, when so much impor-
tance is attached to the science of
meteorology that its professors are to be
found in almost every land, the recognized
and valued agents of manygovernments or
of extensive and important private enterprises, a few
words will not be amiss as to the construction of that
most important instrument, the barometer ; the sound-
ing-line, so to speak, whereby the meteorologist
inquires into the ever-changing conditions of the great
aerial ocean which surrounds us on every hand, and
obtains an insight into the physical forces by which it
is actuated, and the laws by which it is controlled.
I propose as briefly as possible to give simple
instructions for the making of a barometer. The
instrument has been constructed in many forms, of
which I will describe threethe siphon barometer, the
portable cistern barometer, and the stationary cistern
barometer, leaving it to the reader's judgment to decide
which of these will best suit his purpose.
A few words must first be said regarding the
selection of the glass tube, as on its fitness for the
purpose the instrument's future excellence will very
much depend. Ordinary white, easily fusible glass
tube should not be used, as the mercury is apt to
attract its oxide of lead, and not only become impure,
but by adhesion to the inside of the bore hinder the free
oscillation of the barometric column. The proper kind
of tubing is that which shows a greenish tinge in the
glass when looked at endways. For either of the
instruments shown in Figs. 1 or 2, it should not be less
than
f
inch outside diameter and i inch bore ; and if
slightly larger may still be used with advantage.
For the siphon barometer, Fig. 1, a piece of tube
about 42 inches long is required. This is to be well
cleaned by running through it plenty of warm soft
water, while at the same time a little swab made from
a piece of soft, fine linen, tied in the middle of a cord,
is pulled through the bore from end to end. After the
water has drained out, alcohol, in which precipitated
chalk is suspended, should be applied to the inside by
means of the swab. A clean swab, moistened with
alcohol, will remove the particles of chalk, when the
cord being withdrawn, distilled water is to be poured
through, after which the tube must stand in an upright
position till it has drained perfectly diy, a little cap of
paper, meantime, being placed on its upper end to
exclude dust. The inner surface of the tube must
finally be polished with a small piece of soft wash-
leather fixed on the end of a clean, smooth brass wire.
The tube thus cleaned and dried is now to be
closed at one end by drawing it in two in a gas flame
a couple of inches from the extremity. Instructions
for sealing and bending glass tubes are given in so
many works on elementary chemistry and kindred
subjects, that it seems superfluous to repeat them here.
Suffice it to say that the narrow pointed end, which
forms when the tube is drawn asunder, should be
pressed and rotated in the flame till a substantial and
well-rounded closing has been obtained. Thirty-six
inches from the sealed extremity a
(J
-shaped bend is
to be made. Care must be taken to make the curve a
gradual one, as failure in this respect would not only
mar the appearance of the instrument, but might also
tend to narrow the bore and make the bend a weak
point. The arc of the curve is to be l inches. The
longer limb of the siphon is thus 36 inches long, and
the shorter one about three inches. The short limb is
not to be bent down quite parallel with the longer one,
but should make a slight angle with it, to render the
subsequent introduction of the mercury more easy.
The tube T T, is to have adapted to it a supporting
stand, A A, which may be a piece of dressed walnut,
38 inches long, 3! inches wide, and about & of an inch
thick, rounded off at the top and furnished with a brass
screw and ring for hanging up. A shallow groove,
curved to correspond with the bent tube, is made on
the wood. The three small brass clasps, c, c, c,
provided for attaching the tube to its support may
be readily cut from sheet-brass, polished, bent to
shape, and drilled with a hole in each end to
receive the appropriate small brass screws. The
sliding-scale support, S S, is a slip of cherry or
mahogany, 1 inch wide, -& thick, and 32 inches long,
having two longitudinal cuts, G, G, made therein,
through which pass the screws, D, D, which fasten
it to the walnut scale and allow of its motion
upward and downward. These screws may be of
brass with milled heads, or a cheap and excellent
HOW TO CONSTRUCT A
BAROMETER.
-31
-30
-29
M
substitute may be found in two of the brass buttons with screw-stems sold
for fastening carriage aprons. These are to have their stems passed through
the longitudinal cuts, G, G, and screwed into appropriate holes in the walnut
support till their projecting shoulders bind on the scale support and
prevent it from moving except when required. The bottom, B, of the
sliding scale support is a piece of sheet-brass cut to shape and attached
by two small rivets or screws. Its angle or corner, P, is used as an index,
as will afterward be explained. A scale, I, made of a piece of ivory
veneer,
4 inches long and about \\ inches wide, is required for the upper
end of the sliding support. This must be carefully and accurately divided
into inches and tenths, the lowest inch mark being numbered
"
29," the
next
"
30," and the upper one
"
31." It will be well to have the figures and
lines done by an engraver ; but, if economy be a consideration, the markings
can be very well ruled with a fine pen, and after the ink has dried a coat
of thin dammar varnish will protect the lines from injury by moisture.
The ivory scale is now to be fixed to the sliding support, with the upper end
of which its top exactly corresponds. If the measures have been correctly
made its 30 inch mark will now be situated exactly 30 inches from the bottom
of the brass index. An excellent cement for attaching the ivory to the wood
is made of a little isinglass dissolved by heat in equal parts of alcohol and
water. The walnut support, A A, should receive two or three coats of
copal varnish. The cherry wood slide, S S, may either be finished with
boiled linseed oil or varnish, according to taste.
All parts of the instrument being thus fitted, it only remains to
introduce the mercury. For this purpose the tube, T T, being detached
from the support is placed upon a level table and sustained by small pieces
of wire, so that the short limb is uppermost, the long limb lying flat upon the
table. The mercury used should be as pure as possible : though if freshly-
drstilled mercury cannot be had that of commerce may be used, provided
it has not become contaminated by lead or kindred metals. A fair test of the
goodness of mercury is made by dropping a little into a clean white plate
and causing it to run about. If bright round globules are formed, which
readily coalesce and leave no trails of discolouration on the china, the metal
is sufficiently pure. If, however, the drops become pear-shaped and soil
the plate with dull, metallic splotches, the metal must be rejected.
Before being used for filling, the mercury should in any case, be forced
through small pinholes in a piece of thin chamois skin to remove mechanical
impurities. It must then be caused to boil for a few moments in a thin
glass flask or large test tube, so as to expel moisture and air. While still
hot it is to be introduced by successive portions into the open end of the
short limb, through a small glass funnel, the stem of which has previously
been drawn to a rather fine orifice and bent in an L-shape. By slightly
agitating the tube, any bubbles of air adhering to its inner surface may be
dislodged and caused to pass upward through the bend, and so out.
When the metal has risen to within an inch of the orifice, this is to be loosely
closed with a small cork, and the tube being lifted up and sustained with
the sealed end a little downward, the contained mercury must be made to
boil inch by inch, beginning from the closed end throughout the entire
length of the longer limb and curved portion, by means of a large spirit
lamp flame, over (but not through) which it is made slowly to pass.
In the last mentioned operation some caution is necessary to avoid cracking
the tube : though with moderate care there is no danger of this casualty
happening. The boiling process effectually expels any particles of air adhering
to the mercury or the inside of the tube (a most essential element as regards
future accuracy in the barometer), and when the tube has cooled the metallic
fig. 2. CISTERN
BAROMETER.
FIG. I. SIPHON
BAROMETER. FIG. 3.CISTERN
HOW TO CONSTRUCT A
BAROMETER.
149
column will be found to present a surface per-
fectly bright and without speck or flaw. The
tube being now raised gently into a vertical
position, with its closed end uppermost, the
mercury will descend a few inches, showing
the Torricellian vacuum in the upper part of
the longer limb, while at the same time it
rises and overflows from the open orifice of
the short limb. From the latter enough of it
should be displaced, by inserting a small
round piece of wood into the bore, to leave
a couple of inches empty.
After this it
only remains to finish the instrument by
attaching the tube, T T, to its support with
the brass clasps, C, C, C, and screws. A
narrow strip of green surface paper,
4
or
5
inches long, slipped behind the upper part of
the tube where the vacuum appears, is an
improvement to the look of the instrument
and an assistance when taking the readings.
It will now be evident at a glance that by
bringing the corner, P, of the brass index, B,
level with the surface of the mercury in
the short limb, as often as an observation
is to be made, the height of the mercurial
column in inches and decimals will at once
be shown on the ivory scale.
A small thermometer, M, fixed beside the
sliding scale is at once a useful and orna-
mental addition to the barometer. A small
cap, L, of metal or wood must be loosely
fitted over the open end to exclude dust.
The style of barometer just described
while possessing many advantages as regards
simplicity of construction and uniformity
of working, has yet the drawback of not
being very portable. As some may require
an instrument which will admit of being
readily carried about from place to place, I
give a few particulars in regard to the
making of a cistern barometer. These
hints, in connection with the instructions
already given, will enable those who may so
prefer to construct an instrument of the
portable kind.
The tube must be cleaned as already
described, and closed at one end ; but
instead of being bent is left straight, and
cut off at a length of 36 inches. Fig. 3 shows
a section of the cistern, which is simply a
small wooden cup turned neatly out of hard
wood; its outside dimensions being i|
inches diameter and
2i
inches high, and the
inside cavity being i\ inches in diameter
and 2 inches deep. A cut made with a fine
-STATIONARY
[ BAROMETER.
saw along the line, S S, separates the under-
neath part of the cistern as a small wooden
ring, to the bottom of which must be glued
a piece of stout wash-leather, B, made
loosely convex so as to bulge readily inward
and outward, forming the cistern-bottom and
supplying a movable surface on which the
atmospheric pressure is to act. A hole, E, in
the closed top admits the pipe T, which
passes down into the cistern till its end is
level with the line of division, s s, and is se-
cured in place by being cemented where it
goes through the wood of the top. A small
hole, H, for adjusting the height of the mer-
cury is made half an inch below the closed
top of the cistern, and stopped for the time
with a little wooden plug.
The filling with pure warm mercury is to
be done as already described in the case of
the siphon, except that the tube may now be
placed in a nearly vertical position with its
closed end downward
; a small straight
funnel is to be used for pouring through. The
subsequent boiling in the tube must also be
performed as before directed ; but as the part
of the tube within the cistern cannot be
exposed to heat it will be best to leave the
last few inches empty till the boiling has
been finished, when this portion may be
carefully filled with hot mercury. The
cistern, which, of course owing to the
position of the tube, is being held top down-
ward, is also to receive as much mercury
as will fill it to the edge, S s, after which,
the ring-shaped piece, bearing the wash-
leather bottom, B, is coated with glue on
its sawn surface and pressed on in place, so
closing the cistern. As soon as the glued
joint is firm, the tube may be turned up
into proper position by placing the finger
on the wash-leather bottom, and pressing it
inward till the orifice of the tube is felt, when
the whole is quickly inverted. Thus no air
enters the tube during the moment of turn-
ing over ; and as an instant later its opening
is covered by the mercury of the cistern, the
vacuum is now secured. Care should be
taken, however, never again to turn the
cistern bottom upward. The tube being now
in a vertical position, the level of the mercury
is adjusted by removing the plug from the
hole, H, when the superfluous metal escapes
and the column in the tube descends, leaving
the vacuum above. The plug is then to be
reinserted and glued in place.
i5 HOW TO CONSTRUCT A BAROMETER.
The stand (which it is well to make and fit to the
tube before the latter is filled) is so plainly shown in
the figure (Fig. 2) that description is almost unneces-
sary. It may be of walnut, mahogany, or cherry, and
its general style and finish must depend on the taste
of the maker. A shallow groove down its centre
receives the tube, T T, and an oblong cavity at the
bottom admits the back of the cistern, while its front
may be covered with a hollow ornamental turning, F,
as represented. The scale, S S, which in this case
should be 5
inches long, may be ruled on ivory as
already suggested, though an instrument of this des-
cription is really deserving of a well-made engraved
scale, with a vernier giving readings to the hundredth
part of an inch. Such a vernier, V, is a narrow piece
of ivory i| inches long, provided with a groove to
receive the inner edge of the ivory scale along which
it slides next to the tube, a hollow being cut in the
wood of the stand behind the scale to admit of its
motion. It is divided into eleven equal parts by ten
horizontal lines numbered downward from one to ten,
each of the divisions measuring therefore
Tg + to
of
an inch. The method of reading with the vernier is
very simple, but space will not admit of its being
explained here. It can, however, be readily learned
from almost any work on meteorology. The 30 inch
line of the scale is to be placed exactly 30 inches above
the centre of the hole, H, which marks the level of the
mercury in the cistern. It is best to affix the scale to
the stand by little brass screws. A small thermometer,
M, opposite the barometer scale adds to the elegance
and efficiency of the instrument. A slip of green
surface paper should be pasted in the groove behind
the tube before the latter is fixed in place. The top
of the tube, T T, should be covered by a small turned
button, B, of bone or wood.
For the assistance of those who possess enough
mechanical skill to attempt the construction of a very
accurate barometer, such as is required in observa-
tions for meteorological records, a few hints may be
ventured upon. The tube for such an instrument
should be larger in internal diameter than the size
given for the simple barometer here before described;
as thus the correction for what is known as capillarity
will be reduced and greater accuracy insured. Much
care should be taken as to the quality of the glass, and
I need hardly say, as to its inward clearness. It is to
be closed at the end, and bent so that the long limb
shall measure
37
inches ; but its curve must be of much
smaller diameter than that of the siphon tube in Fig
1 ; in fact, the distance between the two limbs should
not exceed half an inch. The short limb is to be half
an inch in length. The object of this turned-up
portion which, as the figure (Fig.
4)
shows is immersed
n the mercury of the cistern, is to prevent the gradual
introduction of particles of air into the vacuum by the
oscillations of the mercurial column, a result likely to
happen in all straight tube barometers when used
during long periods of time. The cistern, c C, Fig.
4,
is made from a piece of stout tubular glass, 2 inches
in diameter and
4
inches long. Its top, M N M, and
bottom, O O, are of any firm dry wood, turned with
cavities to fit the ends of the glass body and firmly
cemented thereto. The top, M N M, has two holes, D
and E ; the more central one, D, admitting the
barometer tube, T T, while through the other passes
the stem of the attached thermometer, G, for giving
the temperature of the contained mercury. The pro-
jecting neck, N, of the cistern-top, M N M, enters and
sustains the brass tube, B B, 25 inches long and 1 inch
in diameter, which serves to protect the barometer
tube, T T, as well as to sustain at its upper end the
wooden piece, A, which steadies the vacuous part
of the glass tube, and supports the scale fastened on
by screws. The bottom turning, o O, of the cistern,
C C, is annular in form, its ring-like edges having glued
to it the concave wash-leather cistern-bottom, R.
The shoulder of the cistern rests in a stout brass
support, P P, screwed to the board which sustains the
instrument.
A surface or zero mark, L L, is made with a file on
the outside of the cistern glass, i inches below the top,
giving the standard to which from time to time, when
observations are being made, the height of the mercury
in the cistern may be adjusted by the milled screws.
The instructions for filling the siphon tube above, give
with sufficient accuracy the steps to be taken when
introducing the mercury in this case. Only recently
distilled pure mercury must be used, and the boiling
and other operations should be done with the utmost
care and attention to detail. The cistern, filled to a
little below the zero mark with mercury, receives the
curved end of the tube, T T, after the filling and boiling
have been accomplished. The top, M N M, is then
passed down over the tube and cemented in place, and
the other parts put together. The adjustment of the
position of the scale is made by measurement from the
zero mark, L L, on the cistern glass. An amateur
should not attempt to make the scale. This work
should be intrusted to a good engraver, or, better still,
a scale and its vernier purchased at the shop of an
instrument maker. The woodwork 01 the cistern and
scale support looks well blackened and polished. The
brass tube should be burnished and its surface polished
with suitable lacquer.
Either one of the instruments I have described
constitutes a useful and ornamental addition to the
furniture of a hall or sitting room, and if made the
subject of daily observation will afford its possessor
much pleasure and instruction combined.
HOUSEHOLD CLOCKS.
iSi
HOUSEHOLD CLOCKS:
HOW TO ADJUST, CLEAN, AND REPAIR THEM.
By PAUL A
T
. HASLJICK.
III.Varieties of Clocks ; Tools required
;
the
German Clock.
OUSEHOLD clocks are represented by
various types each possessing distinctive
peculiarities. England, France, Ger-
many, and America, each contribute to
furnish the large number of clocks distri-
buted through the households of our countrymen.
The same treatment is not applicable to all clocks, and
some particulars of the various varieties in common
use Trill be useful so that the amateur may distinguish
the nationality and some other important details be-
fore commencing operations. Commencing with Eng-
lish clocks and timepieces we have
:
SCREWDRIVER.
he clock, exposed together with the pendulum ; this
is a distinguishing feature.
Iffl American Clocks are distinct from
II
all others ; they are made in large quan-
||
tities by machinery, on the most eco-
nomical principles. Being very cheap,
III tolerably good-looking, and fair time-
keepers, American clocks are exceedingly
popular, and at least one specimen is
usually found in every household where
clocks are to be found at all. Some few
have weights, which are arranged to fall
the entire height of the case, but nearly
all have springs. Small timepieces for
the mantel, and large dials for the wall,
are made, and also every other variety
that is saleable. Some go for thirty hours,
and require winding daily
; some go for
eight days, and require winding weekly.
The cases of American clocks are generally of the
cheapest possible construction.
French Clocks differ from all those which
have been enumerated. They have movements
that are much more delicate and smaller ; in
fact, they almost suggest a grade between
clocks and watches. The plates of these clocks
are usually circular, and the pendulums are
short and heavy. Drum timepieces are perhaps
the most familiar specimens of French produc-
tions ;
they are a source of continual trouble to
the repairer. Being extremely portable, they
are frequently carried about the house, often
on a tray ; and being very unstable, it is no un-
usual occurrence, under such circumstances, to
find that the drum timepiece is precipitated
f'&
down a flight of stairs. The result may be
more or less serious :
"
a good
shake" is the usual remedy.
The better kinds give very
accurate results, and the
striking timepieces are so deli-
cate and fragile that amateurs
should be very chary of them
until some manipulative skill
has been acquired. The cases
of French clocks may be dis-
tinguished by their elaboration.
Marble, wood, and gilt zinc
are the materials most com-
monly employed for cases.
Those who adjust, clean,
and repair clocks are called
clock-jobbers; those who simi-
fig.
s-
pliers.
larly treat watci1 es are watch-
jobbers. The terms may appear somewhat discordant,
fig. 6. NIPPERS.
ably.
but they are strictly the colloquial technical appella-
tions. The amateur will require
some tools with which to do his
work, be it even of the most
simple kind. If he finds any
difficulty in procuring the neces-
sary appliances, it may be said
that tools of every kind necessary
for clockwork may be bought of
Messrs. Melhidsh and Sons,
Fetter Lane, E.C. When pur-
chasing tools I would strongly re-
commend inexperienced amateurs
to explain, as nearly as they can,
the purpose for which the par-
ticular tool they seek is required,
and leave the selection of it to
the seller, whose practical experi-
ence will avail them consider-
The tools necessary for the amateur in clock-
jobbing on a small scale are neither numerous
nor costly. A screw-driver, a pair of pliers,
and a knife will often suffice. A couple of
brushes will be wanted for cleaning with, pegs
of wood being used to clean out the pivot-holes.
A pair of nippers, a pin-vice, and a hand-vice,
generally complete the list of tools used in
clock-jobbing. A few files and a bench-vice
are frequently useful auxiliaries. Oil for lubri-
cation when the movement is finally put together
is of course indispensable.
With a view to further guiding the be-
ginner, illustrations of the various tools are
given, and some particulars of size and cost are
.
added. Fig.
4
is a screw-driver
; this should be
about four to six inches long, and will cost about
is. A good tool with a steel blade can be purchased
for that sum. For small work, such as French
timepieces, etc., the screw-
driver illustrated on page 48
is to be chosen. With four
changeable blades of various
sizes, the tool costs only is. 6d.
It frequently happens that a
small screw-driver, such as is
usually supplied with sewing-
machines, is available, and in
that case it is quite unneces-
sary to purchase a tool ex-
pressly for clock-jobbing.
A pair of ordinary pliers
are shown by Fig. 5. These
should be about five inches,
and will cost from is. 6d. to
2S. 6d., according to quality and finish.
FIG. 8. HAND-VICE.
Tools that
HOUSEHOLD CLOCKS.
153
are finished
"
all bright " are more costly, though
not necessarily more serviceable, than those left
"
black." The nippers (Fig. 6) should be about the
same size as the pliers ; they will cost from 2s. to
2s. 6d. These tools are used to cut off wire pins, etc.
A pin-vice is shown by Fig. 7. There are several
different designs for this tool. The one shown is the
ordinary English and Swiss pattern ; it will cost about
2s. Several American tools of a similar kind are
made. Fig. 8 is a hand-vice which is used for work
that is too clumsy for the small pin-vice. Hand-vices
are made in different styles of finish and varying
prices. A 3-inch vice is about the size most useful,
and it will cost about 2s. It maybe said that these
prices are rather over than under the mark.
The illustration, Fig.
9,
shows the interior of a
clock of the cheapest de-
scription ; it is a Dutch
clock though more popu-
larly known as the com-
mon kitchen clock. These
time-keepers are made in
the Schwarzwald (Ger-
many), where labour is
cheap, and the cost of
production has been di-
minished to such an
extent that some clocks
made there are sold in
London at the ridiculously
low price of fifteenpence.
The American pro-
ductions have in recent
years to a great extent
superseded the Dutch,
but statistics show that
ten years ago there were
in the Black Forest
nearly 1
500 manufacturers, who employed 13,500 work-
people, and produced nearly two millions of clocks
yearly. Various kinds of clocks are included in this
aggregate. One of the cheapest is shown in the
accompanying illustration, but "cuckoo" clocks and
regulators are also made in the Schwarzwald. One of
the most noticeable peculiarities in these clocks is
that they have lantern pinions. It is only for work of
the highest class and most costly description that
lantern pinions are used in English clocks. That they
are far superior in many ways, as compared with ordi-
nary leaved pinions, has been practically demonstrated.
Why makers of English clocks will not adopt lantern
pinions is a question that appears very difficult to
answer. It is out of place here to discuss the merits
of the two forms of pinion ;
but the observant amateur
FIG. 9.
A COMiMON DUTCH OR GERMAN CLOCK.
will not fail to notice how much better the gearing is
with lantern pinions, and also that the wheel teeth
need not be cut so accurately as when used to drive
ordinary leaved pinions.
Let us now glance at the illustration Fig. 9. It
shows the common Dutch clock that may be found
hanging in many kitchens, and which is a most trust-
worthy time-keeper. Each side of the movement of
clocks of this description is provided with a door, and
when one door is unhooked from its hinges, the move-
ment is disclosed, as shown in the illustration. By
means of the lettering the various parts may be des-
cribed. A, A show the top and bottom of the whole
movement, and into these the uprights B, B, which
form the bearings for the wheel axes, are mortised.
One of the pieces B,
usually the front one, is
easily removed, to take
out the wheel-work, by
being pressed outwards
C is a piece to which the
ends of a, a are fixed ; D is
the dial ; and E the back,
by which the clock is
hung on a nail. This nail
enters a hole in the upper
part, not shown, the legs
F, F serving to keep the
clock away from the wall
sufficiently to leave a
space for the pendulum,
G, to swing clear.
The wheel-work is
shown towards the left.
H is the axis of the great
wheel, which turns once
every hour. This axis
also carries the pulley on
which the weight-cord R
minute-wheel O, and the
explanations given in the
is wound
; also the
hour-wheel s. The
previous chapter will enable the amateur to under-
stand the working of these wheels O and S, which,
together with P, form the motion work. The great
wheel on H usually has 56
teeth, and it gears into the
pinion, having
7
trundles, I. On the same axis, or
arbor, is a wheel which drives the pinion
J,
and this
carries the escape-wheel. The escape-wheel, of course,
is entirely different from the others, its teeth being
formed to drive the pallets on k. The axis of the
pallets has a wire fixed in it, which protrudes at the
back of the clock, and forms the crutch L, with a
horizontal hook at the lower end, which embraces the
pendulum rod G.
The motion work consists of the minute-wheel O,
G 2
154
HOUSEHOLD CLOCKS.
which is fixed spring-tight on the arbor H. At its
outer end it carries the minute-hand n. The wheel S
rides loose on the socket of O, and carries the hour-
hand M. The small wheel P turns on a stud, and is
kept on its place by a small bent wire, as shown.
This wheel is driven by O, and in its turn drives S at
such a speed that every twelve revolutions of O pro-
duces one revolution of S.
In tracing the power to the regulator, we com-
mence with the cord R, on which the weight is hung.
This cord is frequently replaced by a chain, which is
more durable, but the effect is the same. A click and
ratchet-wheel allows the cord to be wound over in one
direction, but when the weight pulls in the other direc-
tion the power turns the great wheel, which drives the
next, and that one the next, till the teeth of the escape-
wheel act on the pallets. The power that reaches
this point is not sufficient to move the pendulum, but
when once this has been set in motion, the clock
movement, if in proper order, will keep the pendulum
swinging till the weight has exhausted its power. The
pendulum swings freely from the point of suspension,
and a very slight impulse given at each vibration is
all that is required to keep up the oscillation.
In order to use the slight impulse to the best
advantage, it must act on both sides of the pendulum
equally. The "drop" on the palletsthat is, the
amount that the escape-wheel revolves from the time
when a tooth is liberated from one pallet till another
tooth falls on the other palletis arranged to be equal
in manufacturing. It is seldom that an amateur will
have to interfere with this
"
drop." If the pendulum
when hanging still does not leave the pallets precisely
midway between escaping, the clock will be out of
beat ; that is to say, that the pendulum must swing
farther towards one side than is necessary on the
other, in order to allow the wheel-teeth to "escape"
from the pallets. If the amount of error is slight
the clock will frequently go all right, but in order
to promote accuracy, every clock should be carefully
adjusted to be "in beat."
The clock shown at Fig. 9
may be best set in beat
thus wise. Hang it on a nail approximately upright,
put the weight on the cord, and hang the pendulum on
the eye shown near the top F ; the rod of the pendu-
lum must of course be inside the hook on the lower
end of the crutch L. If the pendulum is now swung
sufficiently far, the pallets K will be moved enough to
allow the teeth of
J
to escape. If the clock is not
hanging with the crutch vertical, the pendulum will of
necessity continue to swing, on one side, after the tooth
has escaped ; this is an error. By drawing the pen-
dulum aside very gradually till a tooth is heard to
escape, and then allowing the pendulum to swing free,
it is easy to ascertain whether the arc through which
it swings is sufficient to allow the pallets to be lifted
on both sides the requisite amount. A practised ear
will detect by the
"
tick
"
whether a clock is properly
in beat, and by shifting the movement slightly the
crutch is got to hang vertically from the pallets. It
may happen that when the clock is in beat the dial is
not quite upright
; in that case, the crutch has to be
bent, or more properly straightened, so as to allow the
necessary adjustment to be made. Clocks that are
out of beat, if they go at all, do so at a great disad-
vantage, and probably more than half those household
clocks that are now useless as timekeepers would be
set right by any one putting them in beat. The
regular, synchronous "tick, tick," is necessary har-
mony from a good timekeeper
;
when the
"
ticks
"
are
alternately long and short, the clock is out of beat,
and should be at once adjusted.
A few instructions on cleaning the common kitchen
clock will conclude this chapter. Taking Fig.
9
from
its hook, first unhook the pendulum and the weights.
Open the doors on each side of the movement and
unhook them from their hinges. This will leave the
interior movement open to inspection ; it will be pro-
bably found to contain dust and flue. Often a vigorous
blast from the kitchen bellows suffices to remove the
obstructions, but such a process is not to be recom-
mended. Proper lubrication is essential to all
machinery. The hands are to be removed first, a
small screwed collet will probably be found on the
centre arbor, unscrew this and the hands may then be
lifted off, one at a time. The dial D is next removed
;
it is generally held by some pins which cannot be
easily indicated and which must be discovered by
searching for them. The motion wheels s, O, and P
are then taken off. The front upright B has next to be
taken out. It is usually fitted into a couple of mortise
holes in the lower A, and the top slides inwards
towards K till upright, the piece being secured by a
vertical pin through the top frame A passing into the
upright E. On removing this upright the whole
train of wheels will fall out, the pallets K are also
taken out, and the clock is in pieces. A brush and a
soft cloth will serve to clean all the pieces, the pinions
must be carefully attended to so as to remove all flue
and dust from the interior. The various holes in
which the pivots work are cleaned by means of a piece
of stick. It is cut pointed, thrust into the hole and
then twirled round ; the holes are thus cleaned,
several applications of the stick, which is each time
re-sharpened, being requisite. The whole being
cleaned, the movement is rehabilitated, a small drop
of fine oil applied to each bearing, and the clock is
ready to be hung on its hook with every probability of
going and keeping time for two or three years.
(
To be continued?)
MODELLING IN CLA Y.
155
MODELLING IN CLAY.
AN INTRODUCTION TO THE ART OF CARVING
IN WOOD.
IV.Treatment of Surfaees.Examples for Prac-
tice and Hints on Procedure.
JLMOST every branch of art has an exten-
sive literature, covering not only the
theoretical, but the practical side of the
subject. The teachers and masters have
left us abundant instructions to guide us
in composing in light and shade, for the disposing of
figures in pictures, for the arrangement of masses and
the theory of colour. In a word, for all that is neces-
sary in making a picture or producing a decorative
design, we have an abundance of rules and directions.
Indeed, the student's difficulty is one of selection and
of digestion. He usually finds more material than he
can master. When, however, he turns from his
brushes, and, taking up the clay and modelling tools
attempts to work in relief, he seeks in vain for a
master. Little or nothing has been given to the world
on the principles involved in decorations in the solid,
or in industrial modelling, as it may, perhaps, more
correctly be called. For this reason it is difficult to
write intelligent instructions, for the teacher to a great
extent finds himself upon an unknown sea, with only
his own experience as a guide. Principles have not
been established, and there is little to aid one in
deducing them from the works accessible. Until
copies of great decorative works in relief are available
it will be difficult perhaps to show, as has so often
been done in painting, how success may be obtained
by following recognized examples.
When sitting down with the pattern of a rosette or
a panel before one, the question is naturally asked :
"What are the principles by which we should be
guided in giving these forms relief?" The student
often asks :
"
How shall I proceed in order to obtain
an effective disposition of light and shade on a sur-
face?" To a certain extent he must answer himself.
WTien one is working in clay, the very material seems
frequently to suggest what is to be done. The student
is, therefore, not altogether without a teacher, and, as
it is easy to correct mistakes, it is a safe rule in model-
ling to follow any suggestion in regard to the disposi-
tion of surface or form, and see whether it be correct
or otherwise. In a design we first have our arrange-
ment of lines to make. This is obtained by following
some of the general principles that would guide the
designer in ornamenting a flat surface. One who has
studied decorations in the works of Colling or Dresser
will find that they give abundant assistance, but when
we ask how shall the relief be distributed, the case
becomes different, and the student is left without
guidance.
The first subjects likely to be attempted by the
beginner are probably such designs as will be appro-
priate for rosettes or panels. In modelling such work,
it is well to observe that the design ought not to pro-
ject above the rails or framework in which it is held,
nor above the mouldings which surround it. If this
is applicable to a rosette as to a panel, the reason for
the rule is found in the fact that projecting work is
continually liable to do injury and to receive it also.
Very high relief is offensive, as it makes the ornament
appear more like a separate work than a decoration.
Some of the best work that I have ever seen, although
on a large scale, has only 1 inch or i& inch projec-
tion from the background, and yet the panels are
4 feet
or
5
feet long, and perhaps 2 feet in height.
In a disposition of the lights and shadows, con-
sidered by themselves, we find in modelling that the
same rules may be observed that guide us in designing
in black and white upon a flat surface. The means
for obtaining lights and shades of graduation are
altogether different. For example, in Fig. 18 we roll
up a ball of clay in the hand and place it in the centre
of the rosette, and we obtain a small and very high
light, which will be graduated into a shade upon one
side, while upon the other side will be a strong, dark
shadow, and if there is a background on the side away
from the light, there will be a shadow darker upon
that surface than upon the ball itself. In this parti-
cular case, however, there is no flat background, and
consequently no opportunity for a shadow to be
thrown. The exact position of the light point will, oi
course, be determined by the direction in which the
light falls. If the light comes from directly overhead,
the shadow will probably be very strong and the effect
very bold. A great portion of our ornamental work is
modelled under a light which falls thus upon it, or at
an angle of perhaps 40 or
45
degrees. This is admir-
able for the artist, but the work suffers, because the
most of wood carvingand, in fact, most of the orna-
mental work in reliefis seen by side lights. Conse-
quently, if we make our first design to be seen from a
light coming from above, it suffers when seen in a side
light. If the student will model a rosette like that
shown in Fig. 18 or in Fig. 21, doing it with a light fall-
ing in one direction only upon his work, and without
turning it around, he can easily get a very pleasing
effect. If he now turns the work through
45
degrees
or 90 degrees, a very decided change in it will be seen,
and if he turns it still further he may be surprised to
find that its character is altogether different from that
which he supposed it had. One thing will certainly
be evidentthat many errors had been made which
were entirely invisible with the light falling as at first
iS6 MODELLING IN CLA Y.
Since most work is to be seen with side lights,
common sense dictates that the model should be made
with the light falling as nearly as possible like that in
which the finished work is to be seen. The light
which is found in ordinary-
rooms is more diffused and does
not usually permit of the same
striking effects to be obtained
by the overhead light, but the
general appearance of the work
modelled with a diffuse light
from the side will be greater
than that done in the usual way.
In the distribution of light
and shade we must study the
effects which the forms of sur-
faces have upon the reflected
light, and by properly handling
the forms we may obtain lights
or shadows in such forms, and
of any intensity that we may
wish to give our work effective-
ness. For designs which are to be seen at great
distances, as in the cornices of buildings, it often
happens that the only thing to which the artist's
attention is directed in the modelling is this formation
of surface as it modifies the light. When, however,
the object is to be seen within a few feet of the eye,
something further becomes necessary. We may intro-
duce absolute beauty of form in addition to the beauty
confined by light and shade, and what we may be per-
mitted to term
"
flat outline." A mass of light can be
produced by the use of a flat
surface turned toward the side
from which the light comes.
To graduate such a mass, a
portion of the surface may be
curved away from the light,
which will introduce a shadow
or a partial one, according to
the inclination. A similar gra-
duation may be obtained by
turning a surface sharply up
to catch the light, and then
allowing it to sink away rapidly
till it reaches a considerable
depth, so as to be out of reach
of the light. In Figs. 18, 20,
and 21, deep shadows are
obtained by carrying the work
down to great depths, so that in any ordinary light
they will appear almost black. Shadows of pro-
jecting parts may sometimes be used for the same
purpose. In the leaf on the right hand of Fig. 20 we
have an illustration of how twisted or winding surfaces
FIG. 17.STEM WITH LEAVES AND FLOWERS ON
CONCAVE OR CONVEX SURFACE.
FIG. 18. ROSETTE IN CLAY, THE FOUR
QUARTERS SHOVV.NJ DIFFERENT LEJREES
OF FINISH.
give modulated lights and shadows. Where fine lines
of light are wanted, they are obtained by means of
sharp raised edges. Lines of black, as in Fig. 18, can
be obtained by sunken lines, the depth or colour or
shade being in proportion to the
depth of the cut. In Fig. 20,
which was sketched from a
model made by a beginner, two
leaves are shown, illustrating
different kinds of work. The
one on the left-hand side is like
that employed in stone work,
and in that material is very easy
to produce. Such convex sur-
faces, however, are difficult in
wood, and the leaf on the right
shows more nearly the form
which would be used by wood
carvers.
The tongue which rises up
between these leaves is almost
flat, and rises sharply at the
edges. A section of it would be almost like a sled
runner, the curve only commencing within a very
short distance of the edge. The bunch of grapes
gives a roughness, and breaks up the light and shade
very effectively. The original design was intended
to form part of a bold decorated moulding, and this
pattern is repeated continuously. The edges of the
leaf in the original are left wide, and in the spaces
between the leaves several lines are cut to increase the
shadows. This is shown as solid black in the cut.
For architectural work, and that
which is seen at a distance, the
edges of the leaves are often
worked up an eighth or a
quarter of an inch wide. This
is very effective, as it outlines
the forms perfectly and prevents
them from having an appearance
like sheet metal. In small
carvings, to be seen near the
eye, this treatment is not ne-
cessary, and the leaf will be
finished more like that on the
right-hand side, the line of light
which the edge catches being
ample for the purpose of out-
lining.
Fig. 21 is a rosette, which
is very difficult for the beginner to model in clay,
yet in wood carving it would be comparatively easy
since the lines can all be drawn, and the work cut,
almost as well without a model as with one. This is
one of the few designs which appear almost as well
MODELLING IN CLA V.
157
when reversed as when positive. That is to say, if
instead of a cup in the centre we had made a ball,
with a cross cut into it, the design would have had
nearly the same appearance as at present. Each of
the cup-shaped leaves at the sides rolls upward, so
as to give a mass of graduated light on either side
the central depression. At the same time, the lines
forming the edges of these leaves are very graceful
when properly modelled in the solid, and are good
illustrations of the fact that we can often see beauty
in relief which does not appear when the same
subject is drawn in plan or elevation, or when
seen from any point of view with one eye. This is
particularly true of all lines which have widely different
curvatures when seen in profile and in front view.
Such lines give a wonderful grace and beauty to relief
work. Of course, when represented upon paper, only
one set of their curvatures can possibly be repre-
sented, and
much of their
beauty must
of necessity
be lost.
These illus-
trations are
all drawn
from the
work of a
beginner, and
are useful in
illustrating
the different
steps which
were taken,
and the mea-
sure of pro-
gress which may be expected. Fig.
19 is a style of work
once very fashionable, but now chiefly useful for show-
ing how surfaces may be treated, in order to carry out
a scheme of light and shade and of outlines at the same
time. If the plain bands at the top and bottom, by
which the scrolls are joined or held together, be set at
different angles, the amount of light which they will
catch will be greatly varied, and their effects empha-
sized or diminished. The main stems and branches
forming the scrolls are raised nearly their own width
from the background, and while nominally octagonal,
the lower sides are considerably higher or wider than
the others, and stand at an angle with the background,
so that upon examination it would seem as though the
stem had been pushed over sideways after being put
in position. This increases the shadow upon the one
side, and augments the amount of light reflected by
the other. The same is true of the stem, shown in
Fig.
17,
where the relief is greatly exaggerated, and
FIG. 19.SCROLL WORK FOR PANEL.
FIG. 20. PORTION OF CARVED MOULDING.
the pieces connecting them with the body of the work
are vertical on one side and greatly cut away upon the
other.
It will be profitable for every one who wishes
to learn
enough of ==;
the art to
j|
make it
~
useful as
an aid in
wood carv-
ing, to at-
tempt to
copy these
designs on
a large
scale. Fig.
18 should be made about 10 inches square, and
the ball in the centre given a projection of
about 1 inch. For speed of working, it is a great
advantage to have the work so large that the finger
will answer for tools. Fig. 21 should also be made
about 10 inches square. If convenient, this may
be cut in wood without attempting to make a clay
model. Fig. 20 should be about 20 inches wide. It
will be a very grand lesson if this design can be com-
pleted without the use of a tool. One-half of it may
be made as a model for wood, and the other, as shown,
for stone. It will be found that it is much easier in
clay to get the stone effect than that which imitates
wood. In this, as in most of the early work, the
beginner is constantly tempted to seek after too much
relief. He
wants to
get bold-
ness and
vigour by
leaving his
work stand
ing up
away from
the back-
ground. It
will be well,
therefore, ii
the highest
portion of
this work
be limited
to 2 inches. While not very pleasing on paper, it
becomes effective in the clay.
In Fig. 21, as in Fig. 18, it is well to try the effect
of finishing the different sides differently. Thus in
Fig. 18, three different methods of decorating the
leaves are shown. In one the ground is sunk leaving
FIG. 21. ROSETTE ON SMALL SUNK PANEL.
i58
THE
"
ALHAMBRA" FIVE O'CLOCK TEA-TABLE.
flat, raised ribs ; in another, deep lines give the effect
;
while the other two are ornamented with lines made
by a broad, round, pointed tool.
Fig. 19
was modelled, like the others, by a beginner,
from a very small sketch, and in copying it the student
will have one very good lesson in the preservation of
his outlines, while he is attending to relief also. This
design should be modelled on a large board, and
should not be less than 30 inches from top to bottom.
The highest relief need not be more than 2 inches.
In doing it, work rapidly, and do not attempt to finish
any
portion the first day. In fact, the clay should be
kept so soft that finishing is impossible. Get it right
as near as possible, and then at the next sitting begin
the finishing.
The focus of each of the stems, when
they are single, may be made slightly concave with
advantage,
instead of perfectly flat. Fig. 17 is made
upon a round and concave, or convex, bed of clay.
The relief need not be great. For a model for this
design the student may take a flower and buds of the
buttercup,
laurel, or, better yet, the common potato.
The leaves may be taken from the willow, while the
stems
should be from the apple. These are all good
to study if one aims at the character, and does not
attempt to make a "dead copy." The raised stem
through
the
middle of the leaf is difficult at first.
Model the leaf without it ;
then down the centre place
a
three-cornered
roll of clay, and cut and trim till it is
reduced to the right size. After modelling a leaf once
in this way, the difficulty will disappear, and other
similar leaves can be made at once without any stick-
ing on of the middle. Flower buds are especially
valuable
objects for copying. The bud, however,
should be very small, and the copy a foot long and
done entirely with the fingers. This will prevent an
imitation of details, and, at the same time, force
a bold and striking resemblance, a character greatly
to be desired, since it is the foundation of all good
work.
The readers for whom these instructions for model-
ling in clay have been prepared, are of two widely
different classesnamely, those who know nothing of
carving,
practically speaking, and who take up these
lessons as leading them to the threshold of this beau-
tiful art, and those, who, by association and long
experience,
thoroughly understand the use of wood-
working tools. For the benefit of both classes, and
especially the latter, it has been thought desirable to
continue the consideration of forms in clay, as in the
present paper, than to enter, as might have been dene,
at once into directions for cutting in wooda part of
the subject with which it may be fairly supposed that
some of our readers are already familiar, but which, for
the instruction of the inexperienced, will be fully and ex-
haustively treated in future papers. The disposition of
surfaces, the means of expression, the manner of
attaining certain desired effects, and especially the
broad subject of light and shade, early demand the
learner's attention. A familiarity with these matters is
more easily obtained by experiments in clay than in
any other way. Accordingly the student is recom-
mended to pursue his investigations in this direction
until considerable skill in manipulation is obtained.
From that point forward his progress in cutting wood
in ornamental forms, and in shapes to express ideas,
will be easy and rapid.
THE "ALHAMBRA" FIVE O'CLOCK
TEA-TABLE.
HOW TO MAKE IT AND FINISH IT.
By J. W. GLEESON-WBITB.
(For Illustrations, see the Supplement to this Part.)
HE tea-table shown in the Supplement
this month is the result of an attempt to
utilise the powers of amateur fret-cutters
in a larger and more enduring form than
the work usually obtains. At bazaars, at
amateur sale-rooms, displays of "the bride's presents,"
and other places where fret-work is most often seen,
one is vexed to observe so much honest work expended
on the most fragile and unsuitable objects. The sad
end of these dust-collectors, when, after the brief life
of the drawing-room and the not kindly old age of the
spare bpdroom, they vanish into the lumber-room, may
surely be avoided by a form wherein fret-work is the
most important point, but by its suitability of design
and plentiful structural support of solid wood-work, it
shall be enabled to last, with ordinary care, as long as
the other furniture of the house. The tea-table shown
is intended as an experiment in this direction
;
and if
done as it is proposed to explain, without unduly
taxing amateur powers, will repay working out.
First comes the choice of wood for working it in.
The designer prefers, on the whole, a dark, straight,
grained walnut, finished with oil only, not with
French polish, which is invariably fatal to a good
artistic effect in fret-work, the glitter of the surface
showing in very bad contrast with the rough and
unsightly saw-work of the cuttings, stained by the
excess of polish (if polished after cutting). If walnut
is not available, the next best would be any fairly hard
wood stained dead black, with a mere suspicion of
polish ;
or else natural unstained oak, always success-
ful, but a little ecclesiastical and crude for an ordinary
drawing-room. A good effect might be obtained by
using wood stained black for the structural parts,
THE " ALHAMBRA" FIVE O'CLOCK TEA-TABLE. r
59
while the actual fret-cutting was executed in satin
or other light yellow wood, or mahogany thoroughly
gilded (the inner saw-cut edge as well as the surface)
with Bessemer"s gold, or similar preparation.
The top should be of plain wood, in any of the
above ways of treatment, the same as the other struc-
tural parts. If it is wished to cover this with plush, or
any other material, with a fringe or edging of lace,
the plain rail at the top of the fret-arches (and,
of course, the legs) should be made at least two inches
higher, or the fret-work will be hidden, for the most
part, from an ordinary point of sight.
If needed, a shelf may be placed resting on or
fastened below the rails connecting the legs, but the
designer prefers the shape as shown in the Supple-
ment, without an under-shelf.
Should the mysteries of the hexagonal form strike
terror to a young amateur joiner, the table may be
made, and no less serviceable in its new form, as a
square four-sided table ; but in this case it would be
better with legs not less than 2 feet 6 inches high, and
with one under-shelf at least ; or it might be made
still higher with a second series of rails, fret-work
band, and under-shelf. In this case the topmost
shelf should nearly touch the spring of the fret-work
arches.
Before commencing to explain the construction, it
would be well to remember, as a very important detail,
that the angle of 6o'the angle of the equilateral
triangle, either singly, as of 6o, or doubled, so as to
form an angle of
120
is the angle that governs all
parts of the design, of which an hexagon, consisting
of six equilateral triangles, may be said to be the
motif. A perfect hexagon can be made to any size by
dividing the circumference of the circle in six parts,
and subtending these six arcs by straight lines, each
of which is exactly the size of or equal to the radius
or half-diameter
; or, in other words, by dividing the
circumference into six parts, and drawing straight lines
from each point to the one nearest it. If all of these
angles of 6cT or 120 are cut true, the whole will fit
well and easily ; but if cut by guess-work, or inaccu-
rately, the failure is a foregone conclusion.
The construction and composition of the hexagon
is shown in the annexed figure. With regard to the
construction, let us suppose that it is desired to set
out the plan of a regular hexagon, whose sides shall
be each equal to the straight line a b. From A and B
as centre, with the radius A B or B A, describe the
arcs c A, C B, and draw the straight lines C A, c B.
The triangle A c B thus formed is an equilateral
triangle, that is to say, its sides A b, b c, c A
are equal, and each of its angles A B c, B c A, and c a
B, is an angle of 6o. From the centre c, with the
radius C A or C B, describe the circle A B D E F G.
Draw the straight lines B D
CONSTRUCTION AND COMPOSI
TION OF THE HEXAGON.
From the points A and B, as centre, with the same
radius, describe short arcs calling the circumference of
the circle in G and D, and from the points G and d thus
obtained, describe other arcs, cutting the circumference
of the circle in F and E.
D E, E F, F G, G A. The
figure A B D e F G thus
inscribed in the circle is a
regular hexagon, having
its sides each equal to A B,
and each of its angles an
angle of 120 . By draw-
ing the straight lines D G,
C E, and c F, it is shown
that the hexagon is com-
posed of six equal and
similar equilateral tri-
angles on three equal and
similar rhombuses, each rhombus in this case being
composed of two equilateral triangles placed together
base to base.
Having decided on the variety of wood, it has to
be purchased by the foot. It will be necessary to
obtain for the fret-work six pieces a foot square, and
one about 12 by 16 inches, this should be \ to
i
inch
thick, about
9
square feet of inch stuff for the top, a
piece 24 by 12 inches of 2-inch stuff for the legs,
and a piece 17 inches long by 14 inches wide for the
top hexagon ; also a piece of inch stuff about 14
inches
square for the twelve rails, and some small pieces for
the brackets. Enough should come off the top to
make these, if planed down to
J
or
f
inch.
The table is shown with alternative half designs
for the fret-work. One should be chosen for the whole,
or, at least, for each of three sides, and will require
tracing to complete the design in the usual way.
The six arch-pieces should be cut with the grain of
the wood perpendicular (i.e., parallel with the legs),
and the grain of the fret-work bands running the same
way, as the weakness is more than balanced by the
rails into which it is grooved. The fret-cutting should
be done with a rather fine saw, to avoid much filing.
The brackets should be in wood at least \
inch thick.
If the design given is too elaborate for the saw used
a plain bracket, cut with keyhole saw, will be prefer-
able to using a thinner wood.
The designs being pasted on the wood for cutting,
they should be all fitted into the framework before any
part is cut. It is important that each is pasted on
exactly square with the edge of the wood, a danger
so easily overlooked, that it is worth specially guarding
against.
The top, ii left without covering, which is best in
this table, may be of wood, grooved and tongued to-
gether to requisite width, or put together in six perfect
i6o SIMPLE METHODS TO STAUNCH ACCIDENTAL HEMORRHAGE.
triangles, with the grain marking the hexagon ; or it
may be inlaid or painted with design as preferred
;
but
common-sense treatment of a table seems to
suggest a plain top, as its fair use is to hold things
and be hidden, not to be in itself decorative.
The six pieces of wood C c, \\ inch thick, for the
top frame, should be made first. These lap over each
other, as shown in sketch of c. This frame C C is
screwed for the last completing work underneath the
top by
thumb-holes with screws, as shown in plan of
top of table.
The legs, A A, themselves perfect hexagons, should
be cut with 22 inches clear, and peg above to fit into
hole in each angle of top frame C C as shown. A
round shape is chosen, instead of usual mortise and
tenon, to allow a little
"
easing" in the putting together.
The legs must be prepared with grooves at each side,
to admit the fret-work arches D D and fret-work band.
The rails B B for band E E mortises into these. It will
be seen that the grooves must be cut at an angle, to
allow the panels D D to enter. The brackets to sup-
port the top of the table mortise into the legs A A and
the frame c C. These should be put in last.
All being worked to instructions given, put the
band of fret-work E E between rails B B in their proper
grooves, place these into the legs standing upright,
slide the arches D D down into their places (the
groove for these should be just long enough to keep
them up in their right position), now insert the pegs of
the legs at top into the frame C C, screw into the legs
through c from top, peg the mortise of E rails to pre-
vent their giving way (all the fittings should be glued
as well, to insure stability), fit in the brackets as de-
scribed, and by screwing to the top frame C C, the
table will be finished ; and if made as above, will be
found as firm and lasting as at least the custom
from which it derives its use and name.
It has been assumed throughout this description
that the worker is familiar with fret-cutting, but it
may be better to note a few points not always insisted
upon. First, that, as a general rule, for work to be seen
on one side only. It has a better effect when finished
if worked with a somewhat slanting saw, so as to cut
the under side larger than the top, this allows each
piece as cut to drop freely out, and also clears the
design a little, especially in rather fine work. Again,
do not be too anxious for mechanical accuracy of each
part ; if a curve is likely to "flow" better (cutters will
know the feeling in hand-work of the saw going
naturally along a line) a little more or less than the
line drawn, so that it is only on a leaf or other some-
what fine form, the effect will be better if not exact
enough to cramp the natural free working of the saw.
For those who, liking the shape of the table, do not
like, or cannot undertake fret-work decoration, a plain
arch piece D D, with a simple horse-shoe or Gothic
arch and solid pieces for bands E c, will give a table
that would decorate well flowers painted on a dark
ground, or an arabesque ornament in bright colours
in style of the Alhambra work generally, would make a
novel if rather bizarre table. As a final word, if the
ornament be well or badly worked, the fitting neatly
or roughly done, try and secure firmness and stability,
or all the beauty it may have will be worse lhan
nothing, if a shaking and unsteady structure be the
final result.
SIMPLE METHODS TO STAUNCH ACCI-
DENTAL HEMORRHAGE.
HE following remarks on simple methods
of staunching accidental hemorrhage are
from the pen of a writer in the Indiana
Medical Reporter, a periodical publica-
tion, which, as its name implies, is pro-
duced chiefly for the use of members of the medical
profession. At first sight it may seem to be altogether
foreign to the purpose of this Magazine, but when it is
remembered what efforts are now being made in this
country to impart to all who are willing to take advan-
tage of it, an elementary knowledge of the structure of
the human frame, and to render them competent to
assist in cases of emergency, arising from accidents or
otherwise, this paper will not be considered to be out
of place, dealing as it does, with "amateur work" of a
very important character.
"At first sight," says the writer of this interesting
paper,
"
it seems almost superfluous to write or say a
word about any method of arresting hemorrhage from
wounds ; for the practitioner, as a rule, is well ac-
quainted with all the different manipulations and appli-
ances for the purpose, and enough may be obtained
from the text books. Nevertheless, to call attention to
some useful, or old, or apparently forgotten mattei
occasionally, seems not to be amiss, for it refreshes our
memory, stimulates us to think about and keep before
our eyes important subjects. A few hints on the above,
I hope, will therefore be well received.
"
The treatment of hemorrhage, viz., the arresting of
the same from open wounds, is not only important to
the surgeon as the basis of surgery, but it is also of
great importance to the laity, and especially to those
workmen who are perpetually in danger of being
injured. It is astonishing how unknowing the people
seem to be, with any method to check bleeding from a
wound temporarily ; even the most simple method
of pressure is in the majority of such accidents not
resorted to. The sight of a little blood does not alone
SIMPLE METHODS TO STAUNCH ACCIDENTAL HEMORRHAGE. 161
FIG. I. BLEEDING
FROM UPPER ARM.
upset a timid, nervous woman, but many times the
strongest of men ; and why
?
because it naturally
creates a feeling of awe and detestation. If a person
is wounded by a machine, or otherwise, a crowd of
all his fellow-workmen gather around him, and look
on the poor fellow bleeding ;
half a
dozen or more will start out on a
run in different directions to hunt a
doctor, or some old woman who has
a reputation for stopping bleeding
by sympathy, either of whom they
are likely to find
'
not at home.'
In the meantime the vital fluid
trickles away ; nobody knows what
to do ; everybody does something,
but none the right thing. Now, it
is true, it does not often happen
that any one bleeds to death, wise
mother nature, as a rule, coming
to their assistance, especially in lacerated wounds
;
but the anaemic condition produced by excessive loss
of blood is followed by severe consequences, and is to
be dreaded, for it retards recovery. To save all the
blood possible ought to be apprehended as an impor-
tant matter by every one.
"
Hardly a week passes that some unfortunate is not
brought to my office, who has been badly injured in
some way
; he has been bleeding, perhaps, the dis-
tance of several blocks, and arrives almost faint. In
the most of such cases they have something tied
around their wounds, but hardly ever in any manner
so as to be equal to stop the bleeding. In exceptional
cases you find a tourniquet or the Spanish windlass
applied. This, when applied by a surgeon, may answer
very well, but when applied by a non-professional
person it is invariably screwed up so tight that the
pain produced thereby is so great and intolerable that
the patient prefers rather to
bleed to death. This is a great
objection.
"
Therefore I will call atten-
tion to the method of forcible
flexion ; and though extreme
flexion has been practised by
surgeons in isolated cases, still
to Professor Adelman, of
Dorpat, is due the credit of
first having systematized the
following method :
"
i. Bleedingfrom the Upper Arm {Art.Brachialis).
Bring the elbows of the patient as near as possible
together upon the back, and fasten them with a ban-
dage. From this point let a doppelt bandage pass
down to and over the perineum
; separate the bandages
again in front, let one end run over the left, the other
FIG. 2. BLEEDING FROM
UPPER THIRD OF ARM.
FIG. 3. BLEEDING FROM
FRONT PART OF LEG.
over the right groin back again to the elbows (Fig. 1).
The illustrations will explain at a glance how to carry
out the instructions given here.
"2.
Bleedingfrom the Arteries in the Upper Third
of
the Arm).Acute flexion of the elbow, simple bend-
ing of the forearm upon
the upperarm, will suffice.
But if there is bleeding
from the arteries near
the joint of the hand, or
from any part of the
hand, then the hand must
also be brought into
flexion, and secured by a
bandage. (See Fig. 2.)
Thebandage must always
be wrapped around the
wound first.
"
3. Bleeding from
the Thigh {Art. Femoralis).It needs no other ex-
planation, as Fig. 3
shows the mode of stopping the
hemorrhage from that region temporarily.
"Bleeding from the front part of the leg {Art.
Tibialis Ant.), same as Fig. 3.
Bleeding from the posterior part of the leg {Art.
Tibialis Post, el Peronea) same as above, with the
addition of a tampon or compress under the knee
joint, or like Fig.
4.
"4. Bleeding from the Foot {Art. Planiaris et
Dorsalis Pedis).Flexion of the leg upon the thigh,
and flexion of the foot upon the front of the tibia.
"
Objections might also be raised to the above
method on account of the pain which it may produce
;
but the flexion never needs to be so forced as to be un-
endurable to the patient ; the position may be a little
uncomfortable to a very sensitive person, that is all.
Furthermore, it has been
proven that a limb can be
kept in a flexed position for
several days, ' nine by some
authors,' without any injury,
and with a complete closure
of the arteries. We do not
expect, however, that this
method of arresting hemor-
rhage will ever be adopted
as 'the' method in surgery,
neither will it be necessary
here to point out any cases where the practitioner
can have and under certain circumstances be obliged
to have to resort to this simple method. Military
surgeons may also profit by it, for it is certainly a
valuable and admirable mode, and so easily applied in
cases of emergency by any one, if the unfortunate
should be distant from surgical aid. I also believe
fig. 4.- -BLEEDING FROM
FOOT.
l62 BOOTS AND SHOES: HOW TO MAKE THEM AND MEND THEM.
that it would be advisable and certainly humane, to
instruct the people in general, by popular lectures or
through the press, the manner of stopping hemorrhage
temporarily.
"The simplest of all methods, however, to arrest
hemorrhage is the rubber bandage. It has displaced
in surgery the old tourniquet almost completely, which
required a certain skill and anatomical knowledge to
apply it ; not necessarily so with the rubber bandage.
Any one can apply it, for the amount of pressure
needed to arrest the hemorrhage from a wound suggests
itself. The rubber bandage produces but little pain
;
the patient is comparatively comfortable and out of
immediate danger and anxiety ; while in the mean-
time the proper attention can be secured.
"
I think it would be well if our health officers would
direct their attention a little to the accidental hemor-
rhages, and if they do not possess the power, to refer
the matter to the proper tribunal to enact a law that
would compel all owners and corporations of factories,
saw, planing, and rolling mills, and, in fact, every
establishment where the labourers are constantly in
danger of accidents, to keep on hand a certain number
of strong rubber bandages, according to the number
of men employed, and that at least several of the men,
if not all in every establishment of that kind, be in-
structed in the application of the bandage. Steam-
boats and other vessels should carry a supply, and
railroad companies should be obliged to furnish all
watchmen along their respective roads with rubber
bandages, and see that the men know how to use them
in case an accident should occur. Every train that
goes out should have some bandages on board, in care
of some employe who knows how to handle them
when needed. Many pounds of precious blood may
thus be saved, and danger to life from this cause be
averted."
BOOTS AND SHOES
:
HOW TO MAKE THEM AND MEND THEM.
By ABEL EAENSEAW.
IV.Riveted Boots and Pegged Boots (continued).
FinishingPutting in the Lasts- ParingRaspingColouring
Setting the EdgesFinishing the Bottom of the Soles
Withdrawing LastsCutting out PegsCompletion of
Riveted and Pegged Work.
HE amateur who has followed the instruc-
tions given in previous chapters will now
have learned how riveted and pegged
boots are constructed, and, if he has put
the information to practical use, will
doubtless be awaiting directions how to finish off his
first attempted pair. I will therefore defer the chapter
on hand-sewn boots, and devote the present one to
instructions upon finishing.
If the boots to be finished have been made by the
riveting process, they will need to be filled out by
wooden lasts while this work is being done. The
reason for this is, that if no lasts were used, the
uppers, the stiffenings, and, indeed, the boots alto-
gether, would be so bent and crushed out of shape
during this finishing process, that a great part of their
value, and certainly all their neatness and newness of
appearance, would be taken away. It is desirable that
the wooden lasts used in finishing should be copies of
the iron ones on which the boots have been, made
;
but if these are not easily procurable, others may be
made use of, if they will fairly fill the boots out. Of
course, in pegged work the lasts are allowed to remain
in until the boots are complete, but the iron ones
riveted boots are made upon are too heavy to allow
the work to be handled with the ease and freedom
required. There is, besides, the danger of damage to
the uppers caused by the worker losing his hold, and
allowing the boot with the iron last inside it to fall to
the ground. Accidents of this kind cannot always be
avoided, and the general result is to bruise, if not to
cut a hole through the upper leather ; while if the
same accident happens when the boot contains a
wooden last, no harm is usually done, or, at the worst,
an insignificant scratch is made.
Putting in the lasts is sometimes a work of dif-
ficulty to the inexperienced worker, particularly if they
are the same size as the boots. The block, or move-
able instep piece, must first be taken off the last and
laid aside
;
then the worker, holding the boot in his
left hand, must insert the toe of the last, and steadily
force it forwards until it completely fills the toe of the
boot. This operation may be assisted when the toe
of the last is nearly to the end of the boot, by giving
the heel of the last two or three smart blows with the
hammer. The back part of the upper is next to be
drawn over the heel of the last, and it may then be
pressed down into its place. After this has been
done, the block has to be pressed in, and the boot will
then be properly filled out ; but the worker must not
exert too much force in doing this, or he may tear
the boot-lining. If the block sticks, or seems dis-
posed to go any way other than that it should take,
the worker should withdraw it and make another trial,
when probably he will find it slide into its place
without difficulty.
The wooden lasts having been fitted in the boots,
they are now ready for finishing. I may here again
state that the process of finishing is from this point
identical for riveted, pegged, and, indeed, practically
for all other kinds of boots, there being but some
BOOTS AND SHOES: HOIV TO MAKE THEM AND MEND THEM. l6
3
small differences, which will be touched upon when
hand-sewn work is spoken of.
The sitting position is generally adopted in finish-
ing, and the seat occupied is as low as possible in
order that the worker may use his lap as a table to
rest his work upon. The first operation is paring.
This means cutting round the edges of the sole and
the heel so that an even edge is obtained. The
worker, when about to pare the fore-part, first places
the boot in such a position that the toe rests and is
held by the hollow part of the chest, the heel resting
upon his knees, the bottom of the sole being towards
the right hand. Then holding the knife perfectly
square with the sole, and not with the point inclining
towards the upper, he takes off a shaving of leather,
which may be thicker or thinner according to the
amount of superfluous leather which appears beyond
the edge.
"
But why," the reader may say,
"
is their
any leather to be taken away now, when the sole was
carefully' shaped before it was put on ?
"
The reason
is this, that while it is being worked the manipulation
and hammering it receives causes it to give or spread
slightly, and the variation in its texture at different
points may cause this spreading to be somewhat
irregular. Making the upper his guide, the worker
pares the sole evenly from joint to joint, reversing the
position of the boot as the toe is pared, and leaving the
edges about one-eighth wider than the upper part seems
to be. The distance and the squareness of the sole
edgewhich are very important matters to attend to
Bass.
Stopt
Diapason (wood).
Principal
(metal).
Treble.
Stopt Diapason (wood).
Dulciana(metal).
Principal
(metal). Flute (wood).
The organ complete will be 8 feet 2 inches high.
If this is loo high for the room it can be made lower
by planting
some of the largest pipes at the back of
organ off the sound-board, and conveying the wind to
them from their proper channels with
J
inch tubes.
For the benefit of
those who may not yet
have got so far as the
grooving for the pipes, I
may mention that, if the
four largest pipes are
placed two at each end,
and about eleven of the
next largest are arranged
in a line along the front,
it will have a very pretty
effect, and a case for the
upper part be rendered
unnecessary. The pipes
may then be stained and
varnished, or painted and
ornamented according to
taste. If it is required
to get at any of the pipes
at the back it will only
be necessary to lift out
one or two pipes where
required.
Before bringing this
paper to a close I must
point out an error in the
drawing of the bellows,
Fig. 6. Both folds are re-
presented as inside folds,
whereas the upper one
should be an outside fold.
If you look at the dia-
gram of the complete
organ you will see what
I mean. This is an im-
portant point, as it is the
only way to secure an
equal pressure of wind,
and constant equality in
the pitch of the instrument,
no matter what amount of
wind there may be
the bellows,
bellows has
FIG. 20. FRONT ELEVATION OF ORGAN WHEN COMPLETED.
Scale,
J
inch to the foot.
A B Sides and main
supports.
C C Cills.
D D Cross-rails.
E E Key-board.
FF Wind chest and
sound-board.
G Bellows.
H Wind-trunk.
in
Even if the
been com-
pleted, it is worth while
making the upper folds
afresh. The leather will
come off easily if damped,
and can be used again.
Having set this matter
right, I have only to suggest a method of finishing the
instrument, which I will do in my next.
(To be coJitinued.)
K K Wooden pipes.
L L Metnl pipes.
M Rack-board.
N N Stickers.
..,1..!,- ,,!,
: ..
Ill 1 II
ill
lilllllllll 1 ill
HI
Ml
[TBb
M\
WmmmmMA
ii Olii It,!Ill H
wM
I
1|"*
!
IM "
:
H>
Hi
|P
Ufl Ilt
;
^^iiilll K^h^jII1
r 'i
11
I-
1
ii=
-._
_
I
\
,|-
--"
-
-
Jm
91
m
||||||||1|
PP8B 111
illVI IlliPii'ili
'
IHfflli' 1
i i
1
IrH ['II
1' '
liii 1 hiii 1 i rl liNil
1
'
HI'
'
Pi i 'I''
1
II
||
Iwtrl l I
I
1
til
II
llilill 1 W|lil
I I ii
II
I
II
[jJfe^^
W*\ ijlr
iip
e=
""
BJI
1 11
1
1
"
Hf=^= 1
nnplj
Willi ill I'l'I'l'lBIIII'I'f"IH if
hi
i
'!!'
1 III'liHIIW
III
|!
ii'Hin
B 11
'iilipllflB
I 1 j
|ii
lilllllllll
I
IK
1 till
i
PPBIM1H|
in,- , Li "ii i i
illlinllll
_-
M
|K|lliii|i^iiiiiiiiiiiiiM 'I H1b:''i .
1
,,.......
J
ill''
'^Nll
1
lull
1
11111,1
Ii [,.
Wm
^
| If ill
,,:
"
H|H||HVCVInHI|S rSKPiiiillil
lllllllllllli
wm
I
1 ' 1
'
1 "
:!
'i!
W
l lill
'1 ^
'
r"^'' !
V^l''
''="
i
' i
'''^lll!Pipi^^yiMi!lilll
IlilllH
hi wmiii
TmBBBF
4
it
i^fflf
-
^m -mmtSlKKi
P
'
anda numberoj
H 2
178
A SKELETON HANGING WALL-CABINET.
uprights and rails, which are mortised together, and
notched into the shelves. And when he has said this, and
added, that two simple doors, with glass panels and
back and sides, of which the former may be dispensed
with if preferred, and the latter made of glass, framed
to correspond with the doors, and fitted in between
the uprights that form the corner-pieces of the cup-
board, as shown in the illustration or perspective
view, he has said all that he well can say on the sub-
ject. Taken as a whole, this hanging cabinet has
many features to recommend it to professional as well
as amateur wood-workers. The central feature con-
sists of the small cupboard with glass doors and
sides, and a back, if thought absolutely necessary, in
which may be placed such articles as it is specially
desirable to preserve from the dust and air of the
room in which the cabinet is hung. In addition to
this, the largest amount of shelf-room is provided for
the display of old china, glass, bric-a-brac, and odd
ornaments, the whole design forming a very pretty
piece of room decoration, and withal a useful article
of furniture.
As the general appearance of the cabinet can be
gathered from the perspective view, so its proportions
and general principles of construction can be gathered
from Figs. 1 and 2, which are drawn on a scale of
\\
inch to the foot. Of these, Fig. 1 presents the front
elevation of the cabinet, and Fig. 2 its side elevation.
This figure also serves to indicate what a sectional
view of the article would be. Having regard to the
scale on which these figures are drawn, and remem-
bering that in the finished article itself, or in a full-
sized working drawing of it, every line will be exactly
eight times as long as its corresponding line in Figs.
1 and 2, we find that the cabinet is 30 inches wide, 8
inches deep, and
44
inches in height, measuring from
the extreme end of the central ornament at the bottom
to a line drawn touching each of the two cone-shaped
ornaments at the top. It will be necessary then at
starting, to make three shelves of 1-inch stuff, 30 inches
long, and 8 inches broad, and two smaller shelves,
16 inches long and
4\
inches wide. When planed
down the thickness of the shelves will be reduced
to J-inch full, as shown in Fig.
3,
which represents a
full-size section through the shelves. The edges of
the shelves are formed in a simple yet effective man-
ner, by three beads of small size, worked on a surface
slightly sunk below the actual surface of the edge of
the shelf. This beading is carried along the ends, as
well as the front of each shelf. When this has been
done, the shelves may be considered as being com-
plete, as nothing remains to be done to them but to
notch them, or rather half notch them, for the recep-
tion of the uprights, and to make mortises in the
uppermost of the three larger shelves for the reception
of the tenoned ends of the central uprights that sup-
port the front of the topmost small shelves. Similar
mortises must be cut in the under part of the lower-
most of the larger shelves to receive the tenoned ends
of the uprights that support the front of the small
shelf at the bottom.
Passing on to the uprights, the whole of these, and
the cross-pieces or rails, and the diagonal pieces at the
sides at top, and behind at top and bottom, are made
out of i^-inch stuff, ripped into pieces \\ inch square,
planed on all sides, and reduced by planing to 1 inch
square. The amateur must be careful to make his
uprights and rails of exactly the same size throughout,
as any difference in size will detract from the symmetry
and beauty of the cabinet. For the back, five uprights
of different lengths will be required, including the
central upright, which need be carried only so high as
the lowest of the large shelves, though it would give
strength to the structure, and in no way detract from
the appearance of the cabinet, if it were carried to the
height of the two pieces, connected by the double rail
and spindles at top, and finished in the same way,
thus dividing the rail which has just been mentioned
into two parts. For the front, four uprights are re-
quired, and two shorter uprights are wanted between
the topmost and lowermost of the larger shelves, one
on either side. The rails that are necessary are six
in number, being two notched into the uprights just
mentioned at the sides, two at the back, just below the
level of the short topmost shelf, and two shorter ones
connecting the short uprights, that receive and support
the front of the small topmost shelf, with the uprights
in front that stand immediately in advance of them.
Eight diagonal pieces are required
; for these, for ob-
vious reasons, are fitted separately between the uprights
to which they are attached. It might be thought that
the diagonal pieces at the bottom might be of one
piece instead of two, and that they might be notched
into the uprights at the back ; a little consideration,
however, will serve to show that such a mode of pro-
cedure would only tend to weaken the structure. Thus,
to summarize what has been said, it is found that fif-
teen uprights of different lengths are required, with
six rails and eight short diagonal pieces, and that this
is all, although the cabinet at first sight appears to be
a perfect network of rails and uprights. The uprights
of the framework are finished at top and bottom with
a conical, or rather pyramidal, ornament, easily pro-
duced, which, with the spindles that form the rail at
top, are shown in detail in Fig. 4.
As soon as the shelves and the different parts of
the frame-work are finished, and the rail at top, and
its cappingwhich were not included in the enumera-
tion of the pieces, as given abovehas been prepared,
and mortises cut in the uprights of the back for their
BOAT-BUILDING MADE EASY.
*79
reception, [the amateur must proceed to notch the
shelves and uprights for the purpose of fitting them
together. In doing this great care is necessary ; and
it will be better to make the notches in the uprights
for the reception of the shelves only % inch deep,
while the notches in the shelves for the reception of
the uprights must be
f
inch deep, so that the edges of
the shelves may be flush with the outer sides of the
uprights in every case. The deeper the notches are
made in an upright or beam of any kind, the weaker it
is made, and therefore it is desirable to restrict the
depth of the notches in the uprights to inch : the
shelf, being broad and substantial, is in no essential
degree weakened by being notched to the extent of
f
inch. The short uprights at the sides are mortised
nto the shelves above and below them ; the rails that
cross them transversely are notched into them, and
mortised into the uprights between which they are
introduced. The diagonal pieces must be accurately
cut as regards length, and accurately bevelled and
bradded to the uprights when they have been fitted,
and dropped into their respective places. This must
be done last of all, when all the other parts of the
framework have been fitted together, dropped into
the notches made for them in the shelves, and glued
and bradded.
The central space has now to be enclosed, so as to
form a cupboard. As it has been said, there is no
absolute necessity to fit in a back unless it is desired.
If a back be thought requisite, all that need be done
is to nail a fillet, i inch wide and
J
inch thick, along
the inner edge of the uprights at the back, and cor-
responding fillets to the lower edge of the topmost
shelf and the upper edge of the middle shelf, so as to
form a rebate all round
f-
inch deep, into which boards
of this thickness may be dropped
;
or, if it be preferred,
the edges of these shelves may be recessed to the
depth of $ inch, either throughout their entire thick-
ness or partially so as to form a rebate in the shelf
itself for the reception of the back. Similarly, fillets
may be nailed round the uprights and the shelves, to
form a rebate on either side of the central space, into
which panes of glass may be dropped to form the sides
of the cupboard, the glass being held in place by slight
beads, corresponding in depth to the fillets within.
In the perspective view, however, and in Fig. 2, which
shows the side elevation of the cabinet, these sides are
shown as being made to correspond with the glazed
doors in front ; and if he prefer to do so, the amateur
may follow this plan. The doors consist of slight
frames I inch in width. They should be about inch
in thickness, and grooved along the inner edges or
rebated, as may be preferred, to receive the glass that
forms the panel.
The appearance of the work may be improved by
the judicious use of cabinet hardware, as shown in the
illustration by the hangers by which the cabinet is
suspended against the wall, and the hinge plates and
scutcheon on the doors. The design may be executed
in a variety of ways as far as the colour of the wood
is concerned. It may be made of pear-wood, or any
close-grained wood, or even deal carefully ebonised
;
and the mountings may be in brass or metal plated.
It would present a very handsome appearance if made
entirely of walnut-wood, polished ;
or, as shown in the
perspective view, the shelves may be made of light
wood, and the uprights, rails, and diagonals, with the
exception of the two at top, of dark or ebonised wood,
the ornaments at the ends of the uprights and the
spindles of the top rail being also made of light-
coloured wood, pegged and glued into holes sunk for
their reception. If the greatest contrast possible were
shown between the shelves and uprightsas, for
example, between satin-wood and ebonythe framing
of the doors might be made of wood of an inter-
mediate colour. Of whatever wood, however, the
cabinet be made, the amateur must remember that
much of its beauty will depend upon the care with
which it is finished.
With regard to the back, as seen through the glazed
sides and front of the central cupboard, it may be
covered with velvet ; but the colour, whether light or
dark, must be regulated by the colour of the articles
that are to be placed within the cupboard. Thus, for
white or light-coloured china, or for Indian cups and
salvers in brass embossed work, black or ruby velvet
would look well ; but for articles of a dark colour a
light background is desirable.
BOAT-BUILDING MADE EASY.
By M. La B. KENNEDY.
I. How to Copy any Boat.
F the many objects conducive to amuse-
ment in the country, and which are there-
fore coveted by country dwellers, there
are probably none more important than
boats. It is a very small piece of water
indeed which cannot be made to yield some pleasure
with a boat, while a sea is of little use without one.
The great obstacle to obtaining one of these ministers
to our enjoyment is, in most cases, the expense. Well,
I hope to show that the expense need only be very
small indeed, being little more than that of a few
boards and nails
;
and that any man, no matter how
rudimentary his carpentering knowledge, can, by a
little patience and perseverance, make as good a boat,
i8o BOAT-BUILDING MADE EASY.
for all practical purposes, as he would pay a long price
for to a professional builder. So now to work.
Firstly, you should have a model : a boat to copy.
You can, of course, vary the details, and I shall
endeavour to give all necessary measurements ;
but it
is much more satisfactory to have
something to work from, and I
think there are few persons who
cannot either get hold of a boat
like the one they wish to make,
for half an hour, or discover some-
one else who will do so for them,
and send them the needful parti-
culars.
Suppose the boat in question
is a canoethe kind on which I may say that I first
tried my measuring method, and the kind, moreover,
which in use probably yields more pleasure than any
other, for not more than two persons at a time.
Buy a few yards
of copper wire,
tolerably strong,
like that used for
bell wire : it will
cost about two-
pence. Provide
yourself with a red
pencil, anewspaper,
and a rule, or, better
still, a measuring tape. A canoe, of course, has both ends
alike. Find, by measurement, the exact centre in length.
Take a piece of wire long enough to go round the out-
side of the boat at this point. Place it round, and
draw it as tight as possible, getting some-
one to hold it so, or, if alone, twisting the
ends together. Now with your finger, or
the end of a penknife, force the wire per-
fectly flat across each board, and into the
joinings between the boards, or the bottom-
boards and keel. Be careful to keep the
general direction of the wire perpendicular
to that of the keel, that is, of the ground
on which the canoe is lying. When the
wire is exactly fitted to the form of the
sides and bottom of the boat, fit it in the
same way to the top, and fasten the ends
so that they cannot slip backward or
forward. Then get someone to hold up
one end of the boat, and slide the wire off very gently.
You will now, if you have performed the operation
neatly, have an exact outline of the broadest part of the
canoe, as in Fig. i
: such an outline, in fact, as would be
presented by the outside of the sideboards, were you
to saw the vessel across in the centre, and were the
boards not to start from their places. Lay your wire
I. OUTLINE OF SECTION OF
IN WIRE.
FIG. 2. STEM OF BOAT.
A
|
|
A
X I X
down on your newspaper, having spread the latter on
a fiat surface, and carefully and exactly trace out the
pattern with the pencil. Now find by measurement
the half-way point between the centre of the boat and
one end, and take another pattern at this place, in pre-
cisely the same way as before. In
the case of a canoe you will re-
quire no more sections, since it
tapers away evenly to both ends
from the centre.
Now take a piece of paper,
sufficient to cover one
"
nose
"
of
the boat, and to reach back on the
side to where the rounded stem or
stern-post ceases, and the appa-
rently level keel begins, i.e., for about two feet. Lay
this paper against the side of the boat, and trace on it
the size and shape of the stern-post, and the depth
and direction of the boards, so far as the paper reaches.
You can easily follow the
joinings of the boards through
the paper. (Fig 2.)
Lastly, find the length of
the canoe along the deck, from
tip to tip, and the length of the
keel proper to its junction with
the stem and stern-posts.
You have now all the
necessary measurements, but
it will be as well to ascertain also the depth inside
from the bottom to a stick laid across the top of the
open, the size of the ribs, etc. ; and, though I shall
endeavour to give all necessary description, to examine
carefully the general shape and lie of the
several parts of the vessel.
For an ordinary boat, differing from a
canoe in not being of the same shape at
both ends, wire measurements should be
taken in other places. The necessary
points are, of course, those of greatest
contraction and expansion, and will,
therefore, vary according to the shape of
the particular boat to be copied
;
gene-
rally round the bows, amidships, and at
the place near the stern where the bottom
begins to rise and fine away will suffice,
along with the "cheek" beside the stem-
post, and the actual face of the stern.
Having measured the shape of the boat at these points,
and as many more as may seem necessary, and found
the exact distance between them, we may set to work
with confidence.
Of course it is not necessary to follow one's model
in all particulars, provided relative accuracy be pre-
served. Nothing teaches one so well as past mistakes;
4. SECTION OF
KEEL.
3.
JOINING OF SIDE
BOARD.
BOAT-BUILDING MADE EASY.
and here I may mention a serious error I very nearly
fell into when making my first canoe. The boat I took
my measurements from was 15 feet long over all,
and I wished to make mine only 13. This being
so, I at first thought I should merely have to take one
foot off each end, as it were, so that
instead of leaving
3
feet 6 inches between
each end and the section next it, I should
leave only 2 feet 6 inches, still preserving
the length of 3 feet 6 inches between each
of the smaller sections and the one in
the middle. My mistake here is suffi-
ciently obvious, but somehow it did not
at first strike me, and possibly might
escape others also. In fact,
while I had in my measure-
ments considered the boat
I was copying from as
divided by sections into four
parts, each
3
feet 6 inches
long, I now forgot that each
part was to be a quarter of
the whole length, and was
about to make my divisions, 2 feet 6 inches, 3
feet
6 inches,
3
feet 6 inches, 2 feet 6 inches, instead of
four, each
3 feet 3 inches. I should thus have failed
to preserve the relative slope from the centre to each
end, and constructed a boat very much shorter in the
bows than my model. This will serve as an example
of the way proportion of parts must be preserved.
We have now to prepare wooden sections, round
which the canoe is to be built, from the paper patterns.
I said above that the latter, as traced out from the wire,
presented the appearance of the outside of the sides if
the boat were sawn in two. In other words, if we
draw a smaller figure within our pattern, leaving be-
tween the two all round a space equal to the thickness
of the side boards, we shall have a figure which would
exactly fit inside the canoe at the spot where we took
FIG. 5- SHAPE OF STERN AND
STERN-POST IN CANOE.
FIG. 6.
an operation
which, should the amateur be obliged to do for him-
self, though not taking long, it is difficult to believe
however enthusiastic a floriculturist he may be, he
would not greatly dislike. However, should any reader
decide, in spite of these objections, to adopt this form
of heating his house, it will be well to say that the
fire-place, which must be built about ten inches below
the level of the flue (and of course is horizontal where
it runs through the house), should be 20 in. long, 10 in.
high, and 95 in. wide, into which space must be built
the fire-bars. The flue should be about 8 inches square
inside, and be fitted with a damper to regulate the
draught and a small wrought-iron or brick chimney
at the other end to carry away the smoke.
With regard to the next system, that of heating by
hot air. It can only be said it seems both expensive
and generally unfit for a small house. The third
method now remains, which, as I said before, appears
best adapted for all sizes of greenhouses, and this
opinion is much strengthened by the numerous boilers
of so many shapes, sizes, and principles, which are to
be seen advertised in even- gardening paper of the
present day. In fact, there are so many good arrange-
ments of boilers, that it can only be said the most
popular seem to be the "horseshoe" and "saddle"
types ; but of the boilers which have come under my
notice of late, those made by Messrs. Franklin Hock-
ing, ofLiverpool, seem amongst the best, and to these I
shall again refer a little further on. However, in so small
a boiler, perhaps the best way will be for the amateur
to look through the advertisements in the gardening
papers, and fix on one which the makers will tell him
will do the work he requires, and is at a price he is
prepared to give. As is shown in the sketch, it will be
best for him to select some arrangement in which no
brick work setting is required, as it would be more
easily moved, and would occupy less room than it
would otherwise do. The fuel should be small coke
or gas, the latter has been found very convenient in
small houses, on account of the little attention which
is required in keeping the house at a uniform heat.
However, where this means of heating cannot be
used, as is generally the case in the country, small
coke is the most convenient.
This description of fuel, I should think, would burn
for a considerable time without attention in one of
Messrs. Franklin Hocking's small concentric tubular
boilers, in which the upper part is filled with a con-
siderable quantity of coke at a time, which works
down, and slowly takes the place of that which has
been already burnt.
In the sketches is shown a small circular boiler and
tank and piping
(p,
x, R;, which are heated by gas, the
fumes of which should be carried away as shown in
the drawings, by a piece of iron stove-pipe, capped by
a conical covering, raised a little distance above the
top of the pipe to prevent the sudden down-rush of
any gust of wind.
For a greenhouse of the size illustrated, the pipes
should be two, or two and a half, inches in diameter.
The stage marked K is 2 feet
5
inches wide, and 2 feet
9
inches or
3
feet high, as will be seen in the drawings.
The most important thing in its construction is that it
should be made that the plants may be as near the
glass as possible, which will prevent their being drawn
into those long, sickly-looking objects one so often sees
in conservatories and greenhouses in which the old-
fashioned step-stage is used. The centre of the house
may be laid with tiles, or thick slates, which will help
to make it more tidy and cleanly.
All minor details which have not been specially
described, will be sufficiently understood on referring
to the drawings, but there is yet one thing to which
the attention of the amateur must be drawn, and
that is the necessity of providing means for carry-
ing off the water that will fall from time to time on
the glass roof when "the clouds drop fatness," in order
to prevent the drip on the earth below, and the dis-
figurement that it causes if it be allowed either to
trickle down the front and back of the house or to fall
and splash against its base. As the house that has
been described has a span roof, and a door at each
end, zinc or iron guttering, supported on brackets,
must be placed immediately under the eaves along the
front and back, and two pipes must be provided to
admit of the exit of the water caught in the gutters.
Had one end of the house been permanently closed,
one exit pipe would have been sufficient, as the gutters
in front and back could have been connected by a
third piece running across the closed end. The next
thing to be considered is the provision of means for
the dispersion or absorption of the rainfall, or, what is
better, for its storage for use in the greenhouse. If it
is not to be saved, the pipes must have their lower
ends set in drain pipes leading to a pit dug in the
earth, and filled to about half or two-thirds its depth
with brickbats covered with brushwood to prevent the
entrance of the mould_ with which it is filled in. I f
the water is to be stored, a brick tank, well cemented
should be made under the potting shed, from which
receptacle the water can be raised when wanted by a
small pump in the shed itself. If the reader will refer
to the paper on
"
Filtering Cisterns for Rain-Water,"
in page
34,
he will find instructions for calculating the
size of the tank required in proportion to the super-
ficial area of the roof. A sliding panel in the partition
between the potting shed and the house, will be found
useful for passing in newly-potted plants, etc., without
carrying them round in the front of the house.
196 PRACTICAL GAS-FITTING.
PRACTICAL GAS-FITTING.
By E. IF. DENNISS.
I.Preliminary.How to Blow a Joint.Hanging
Gas-Brackets and Pendants.
LTHOUGH the gas-fitter's trade is by
many looked upon as one that is very
mysterious and complicated, still there is
no part of his ordinary work which
cannot be done, and done well, too, by
the amateur. But before attempting any of the prac-
tical work, let us first consider what operations in this
useful art come within his scope.
He will be able, then, to hang chandeliers, and
hall and kitchen pendants, as well as to put up gas-
brackets, and lay on all the necessary pipes, and
connect them with the gas supply of the house ; and
he will also be able to make gas fires, and do any
repairs which may be wanting. But he had better
leave the meter alone, as also the inlet-pipe : this
SPECIAL TOOLS FOR GAS-FITTING.FIG. I. CUP AND BALL
PLIERS. FIG. 2. COPPER BIT. FIG. 3. SHAVE-HOOK.
latter, indeed, he must not touch, it being the property
of the Gas Company.
Roughly speaking, there are two methods of gas-
fitting : one, in which iron pipes are used, and which
necessitates the insertion of an elbow or other fitting
at every bend, but in which no soldering is required,
as all the parts screw togetherthis is certainly the
better, though the more expensive method
; the
other, in which composition gas-tubing is usedthis
is less troublesome, the pipe being readily bent in the
desired direction : it is also the method almost in-
variably adopted in houses ; and as it is the one in
which the amateur will probably chiefly concern him-
self, it will be first explained.
A few words as to the calculation of sizes of pipes,
fittings, etc., may here not be out of place. The size
of brass tubes is their external diameter
; that of com-
position and iron tubes is their internal diameter. The
sizes are only approximate, and therefore must not be
taken as exact. The sizes of fittings for iron tubes
are the size of the tubes for which they are made.
Thus, a 4-inch socket is one made to unite two pieces
of -inch iron tubing.
The screw-threads for brass fittings are different
A B
FIG. 4.NOSE-PIECES.
A Elbow Nose-piece. B Straight
Nose-piece.
from those of iron, the latter being larger and bolder
than the former. Where brass fittings are made to
be connected with iron tubes, the brass is cut or
tapped, as it is technically termed, to correspond with
the iron.
Caution.Never, under
any circumstances what-
ever, search for a leakage
of gas with a light. Over
and over again, explosions
and fires are caused by
this reprehensible prac-
tice. It is easy enough to
trace out the leakage by
the peculiar smell of the escaped gas, and so be able
to rectify it.
The special tools required for gas-fitting are
neither numerous nor expensive. They are a pair of
cup-and-ball pliers (Fig. i), having two places for
gripping various-sized unions, etc. : they cost about
3s. A copper bit (Fig.
2),
costing is. 8d. ; a blow-
pipe, 8d. ; a shave-hook (Fig.
3),
which is a flat piece
of steel, with sharp edges, at the end of a short rod
set in a wooden handle, and used for scraping lead
pipes before soldering, costing is. ; and a small
plasterer's trowel, costing about is. 6d. If iron tubing
is to be employed, a pair of gas-tongs will be required
for each size of pipe and socket used. These vary in
price, from is. 6d. upwards, according to size. The
manner of using these tools will be described as
occasion for their use arises.
The materials neces-
sary are solder, of which
two kinds must be ob-
tained : one in thick
sticks, called tinman's,
for use with the copper
bit
; and one in thinner
sticks, called blow-pipe
solder, each costing is.
per lb.
; rushes, for use
with the blow-pipe, cost-
ing iod. per lb. ; resin,
4d. ; whitelead, 4d. per
lb.
; and some tallow
or
"
touch," as it is
always called by London
plumbers.
The first thing the would-be gas-fitter must learn
is how to blow a joint ; that is, to join two pieces of
tubing by means of a blow-pipe and rushes. The
copper bit is never to be used for this purpose, as it
does not give heat enough, and the joints so made are
very easily broken, and, from their untidy appearance,
it is difficult to tell whether they are tight or not.
FIG. 6.
T UNION.
A Screwed together. B Partly
unscrewed. C Part where white-
lead is necessary.
PRACTICAL GAS-FITTING.
197
A little practice is required to blow a continuous
stream of air through a blow-pipe, and to do so a
rather full breath must be taken, and the large end of
the blow-pipe placed between the lips and teeth. The
air must be expelled by means of the muscles of the
cheeks, and not by those of the chest, the supply being
kept up bybreathing through the nose. Alighted bunch
of the rushes, about three-quarters of an inch in diame-
ter, wrapped round with brown paper to within I \ inch
with tallow ; having placed the bright end of the latter
piece tightly inside the bell of the former, put some
powdered resin on the joint (this is to cause the solder
to flow easily), then, by means of the blow-'pipe, direct
a small flame against the resin, which will melt and
run round in the channel formed by the junction of
the tubes. The flame is to be directed all round the
pipe, to heat it and render it capable of melting the
solder, which, held in the right hand, must be rubbed
B
V
E
A
-
AT SUPPLY
* B
W
*
1
E
\
/
, ,.,
r
, j
wmmm \
D
... '
mm
D
FIG. II.MODE OF HANGING PENDANT.
A A, Joists in section ; B, Piece of wood fixed between A A ; C, Mahogany block ;DD, Ceiling
;
E E, Floor of room above.
\\
f
SUPPL.Y
FIG. 7.T UNION IN POSITION.
A, T Union; B B, Old
composition tubes ; C,
Pipe to new bracket.
FIG. 12.7-UNION.
A, External thread.
B, Internal thrfcad.
FIG. 8. FLANGE .FOR
WALL LIGHTS OR
HEAVY BRACKETS.
FIG. 9.KITCHEN PENDANT.
from the top, and a little spread out, so as to give a
flame about
3 inches high, is held in the left hand,
and the small end of the blow-pipe is placed in the
flame. The effect of the blowing is to drive a small
but very hot flame in the direction required.
To join two pieces of composition tube, open out
the end of one of them, so as to make it funnel-
shaped, and shave it inside, and on the edge of the
bell mouth, with the shave-hook ; one end of the other
piece is then to be scraped bright on the outside for
about half an inch, and well "touched," that is, smeared
FIG. 10.T PENDANT.
gently against the pipe, blowing softly the while, to
keep up the heat. The solder will now melt and run
round the joint, and adhere at every point it touches.
Continue blowing and moving the flame about, so as
to distribute the heat equally, and make the solder lie
even. Then cease blowing, and as soon as the solder
is set, which will be in a few seconds, and, before it is
cold, wipe it clean with a rag, and the joint will then
be complete. Care must be takea whilst blowing not
to melt the tube itself.
Should one of the parts to be jo -d be of brass,
/.;
{ 2
198
PRACTICAL GAS-FITTING.
the brass must be tinned before attempting to make
the joint. The tinning {i.e., thinly coating with solder)
is accomplished with the aid of the copper bit, which
itself must be tinned first. To do this the bit must be
heated, but not made red hot, and the tip, or nose,
rubbed on a piece of emery cloth to clean it, and im-
mediately placed in some powdered resin on a piece of
tin plate, and a stick of solder rubbed against it, the
effect being to coat the nose of the bit with tin.
To tin brass, file or rub it bright, put some touch
on it, and sprinkle it with resin. Then with the copper
bit well heated, melt some solder on to it and rub it
well on to the brass. The brass will then be tinned,
and ready to receive the solder when blowing the joint.
Being, now acquainted with the manner of making
joints, the aqiateur may proceed to actual gas-fitting;
and we shall commence by showing how to fix a gas-
bracket and connect it with the gas supply.
The first step is to decide upon its position, which
should not be too near the ceiling, nor be so placed
that doors or curtains may come in contact with it.
The next thing to consider is the place at which the
connection with the gas supply is to be made, and in
order to do this satisfactorily, the amateur should make
himself acquainted with the arrangement of the gas-
pipes already laid. It will generally be found that
\vhere;'gas has been laid on to a floor above the base-
ment/that, an iron pipe leads from the meter to the
outside of the back of the house, and thence upwards,
with short iron branches, to each floor to which gas
has been laid on. These branches will be found
between the floor of one room and the ceiling of the
room beneath, composition tubing being used to con-
nect them with the chandeliers, etc.
Should there then be a pipe beneath the floor or
above the ceiling of the room in which it is proposed
to fix the bracket, it is with this with which the con-
nection should usually be made. If, on the other hand,
there should be no such pipe, connection will have to
be made with the iron pipe which comes from the
meter.
For neatness, the pipe supplying the bracket should
be as much concealed as possible, the best way of
doing which being to lead the pipe along a shallow
channel cut in the wall, from the bracket to the floor
or ceiling, according as the connection is to be made
with a pipe above or below the room ; in the former
case passing it behind the skirting, in the other, through
a small hole made in the ceiling, the channel being
afterwards filled in with plaster, and that part of the
wall re-papered. But should there be any objection
to this plan, the pipe must be led upwards to the
ceiling, or upwards and along it and down an angle of
the wall, according as the connection is to be made,
above or beneath ne room.
A
Having procured a sufficiency of pipe (three-eighths
composition tubing being generally used), the next
thing is to open out one end of it, and to blow in {i.e.,
to solder in, as already described) an elbow nose-piece
(Fig.
4),
which is a small brass tube (three-eighths)
bent at right angles, having one end tinned, and a
screw-thread cut on the other. Having done this,
proceed to cut the channel in the wall, if that method
is to be adopted, and having laid the pipe in it and
taken it through a small hole chipped through the
ceiling or behind the skirting, as the case may be,
place the nose-piece so that the screwed end may pro-
ject from the wall in the centre of the part to be
covered by the bracket, and over it place a mahogany
block, as in Fig.
5,
which is a circular disc of
mahogany, about three-quarters of an inch thick, .
having a hole through the centre, letting the nose-piece
project through as in the cut (Fig.
5),
and nail it
to the wall. Then on to the nose-piece, smeared with
white lead, screw the bracket, through the flange of
which drive three
inch screws. Then lead the
pipe along the channel till it reaches the spot from
which gas is to be obtained, and cut it off where it
meets the old one, and into the end blow the side
branch of a T-union, of which an illustration is given
in Fig. 6. The side branch is the part marked a. The
nut must be unscrewed, and the part A blown on to
the pipe attached to the bracket. This done, unscrew
the part B and cut the old composition tube at the spot
where the connection is to be made. Then into one
end blow the part B, and into the other end the part C,
and having done so, put some white lead on the parts
of the union that meet, and screw them together with
the pliers. Fig. 7 shows the T-union in position.
A few words of explanation are here necessary
regarding the joining of the pipe and fittings. For a
nose-piece, the tube must be opened, etc., and the
nose-piece placed in it, and blown in. For a union, if
the pipe be smaller than the union, let it be pushed
into the latter, and blown on, the edge only of the
union being tinned. If the pipe should be larger, the
outside of the union must be tinned for about half an
inch from the end, and placed in the pipe which has
been opened out, and then blown in.
The connection is now complete, and it is only
necessary to fill up the channel cut in the wall. Hav-
ing procured some plaster, and wetted the wall well
where it is cut, mix up some plaster on a board to
the consistence of thick cream, and press it into the
channel, and level it with the trowel. It will be set
in a few minutes.
Should, as is very likely, the wall not bear nails, a
space smaller than the mahogany block must be cut
out about an inch deep, larger at the back than at the
face of the wall, wetted, and filled with plaster. Then,
LATHE-MAKING FOR AMA TEURS.
199
while the plaster is still soft (about the consistence of
cheese), put the block against it, and drive three thick
ij-inch screws into it, taking care that the heads of
the screws are level with the face of the block. In
this case, the bracket must not be screwed on for half
an hour after this is done.
If it should not be wished to have the pipe buried
in the wall, the mahogany block must have a groove
cut at the back from the centre to the circumference
for the nose-piece to lie in. It is then screwed against
the wall, and the rest of the procedure is the same as
in the other case.
In the case of wall-lights or very heavy brackets,
there is a slight variation from the mode described.
A flange (Fig. 8) is screwed on to the nose-piece, and
fastened by screws to the wall or block, and the bracket
is screwed on to the flange, the heavy bracket being
furnished with a larger screw-thread than the light
ones. This method is also adopted where the screws
in the flange are not to be seen.
Pendants.The hanging of pendants (Figs.
9, 10)
is very similar to the putting up of brackets, the only
difference being that the pendant hangs from the ceil-
ing, and not from the wall. The mahogany block must
be screwed to a joist if there be one over the spot
from which the pendant is to hang, having first cut
across the lower side of the joist a notch about three-
fourths of an inch deep, to allow room for the elbow-
nose-piece. If there is no joist at this place, a piece of
wood about two inches thick must be fixed between
the two nearest joists over the desired spot, and a
hole made through it over the centre of the block
(Fig. 11). In this case a straight nose-piece must be
soldered into the pipe, and passed through, so that it
may be grasped in the pliers while the pendant is
screwed on to it. The pipe must then be drawn back
again, and the pendant screwed on to the block, the
object of holding the nose-piece in the pliers being to
prevent it being twisted off in screwing on the pendant.
In case there should be no composition tube near
enough to connect it with the bracket, connection must
be made with the iron tube coming from the meter.
The pipe from the bracket or pendant will be taken by
the shortest way up to this iron pipe, into which a hole
slightly smaller than a nose-piece must be drilled with
a hand-brace and drill. In this, hole a screw-thread
must be cut, to correspond with that on the nose-
piece ; this is to be done with what is technically
called a three-eighth taper tap for brass. They cost
is. each. Then procure a union, as in Fig. 12, having
an external thread cut at one end, and ah internal
thread at the other. Unscrew it, and tin the edge of
the latter end, and blow it on to the tube from the
bracket. Then take the taper tap, and place it in the
hole drilled in the pipe, and put the hand-brace on to
it, and with a series of short jerks make the tap cut the
thread inside the hole. Then withdraw the tap, and
screw the external-threaded part of the union into the
hole in the iron pipe, not omitting white lead, taking
care not to injure the screw-threads on the union.
Then screw the parts of the union together, and the
connection will be complete.
The next chapter will treat of the use of gas-tongs,
and of iron tubes and fittings ; also of the hanging of
hall-lights and chandeliers.
(To be continued.)
_=>-=><=-=
LATHE-MAKING FOR AMATEURS.
By PATTL N. EASLUCK.
III.Mandrel Headstoeks.
ROM what has already been printed under
this heading, the amateur will have be-
come acquainted with the names by
which the various parts of the ordinary
foot-lathe are known. A substantial
framework, including the bed and two standards, is an
essential part of a serviceable lathe. Elaboration in
the finish of these parts is by no means necessary, but
absolute truththat is straightnessin the bed and
firmness in the standards, are necessary qualifications
for producing accurate work. A high-class tool is
requisite for producing high-class work. A tool strictly
adapted to the work it has to perform is most advan-
tageous in use.
Turnery that is made most accurately is produced
on lathes of the highest finish ; cheap work, in which
minute accuracy is not sought for, may be made on
lathes of inferior quality. The imperfections of any
machine generally show on the work it produces, and
for this reason perfection of mechanism is so desirable.
For plain turning the accuracy of the lathe mandrel
is the principal consideration. On this will depend
most of the results ; if the mandrel is faulty true work
cannot be turned on it. In complex turning many
other sources of error are introduced into the lathe,
but in plain work the mandrel is the part on which
nearly all the working qualities depend. Perfect
rigidity and freedom in revolving, combined, are the
essentials. I will therefore now consider the mandrel
headstock in its various forms.
Mandrels are made in several forms. An easy and
very broad distinction may be made between those
running in double bearings and those supported at
the tail end by a centre. The two methods are each
good ; fine quality lathes are made with mandrels fitted
both ways. For some purposes double bearings are
LATHE-MAKING FOR AMATEURS.
FIG. 7.-
necessary, but the single collar and centre are cheaper
to make. Traversing mandrels must have double
bearings. Lathes for screw cutting, and which have a
change-wheel on the tail end of the mandrel, also have
double bearings. For plain turning the single collar is
perhaps to be recom-
mended in preference, if
only for its cheapness,
for it is equally good.
Mandrel bearings
differ much, some are
parallel
; those that are
conical may have the cone
in either direction. When
double cones are used they
are sometimes both taper-
ing the same way, and
sometimes have the ends
reversed. The illustrations
accompanying this chapter
show various forms of
mandrels.
In the earliest man-
drels the bearings were
made cylindrical and parallel, and there was no control
of the mandrel endways. These mandrels were made
especially for cutting screws, and had a longitudinal
motion imparted to them by means of a guide screw,
which formed part of the tail end of the mandrel and
revolved in a fixed piece which served as a nut. This
nut could be lifted in or
lowered out of gear at
pleasure. The bearings
in which these traversing
mandrels worked were
usually made of metal, and
split in the middle hori-
zontally. The headstocks
were wooden, and notches
were cut to receive the
metal bearings. All the
early turning was done on
a centre-lathe, that is, one
having fixed centre-points
like the ordinary watch-
maker's turn-bench. The
mandrel has only com-
paratively recently super-
seded the centre-lathe.
A mandrel headstock
metal is shown by Figs.
7
-ELEVATION OF A BACK-GEAR HEADSTOCK AND
MANDREL.
FIG. 8. PLAN OF A BACK-GEAR HEADSTOCK AND SPINDLE.
suited for turning heavy
and 8. The first is a side
view, the second a top view of the same headstock.
The drawings were carefully copied from a lathe-head
manufactured by The Britannia Company, Colchester,
and may be considered as accurate. The dimensions
shown make a very strong headstock, one that would
be equal in strength to any work that could be put upon
it. Such a headstock is suited for an engineer's lathe.
At the top of Fig.
7
the mandrel is shown in elevation
apart from the headstock. The cone at the left-hand
end is put on to show its
position on the mandrel.
The screw thread on the
left takes the locking nuts
that confine the longitu-
dinal motion of the man-
drel, technically termed
the
"
end-play." The
plain part on the extreme
left is so left to receive a
small cog-wheel, if self-
acting screw-cutting mo-
tion is wanted. This cog-
wheel then serves to drive
the train that actuates the
leading screw.
Commencing at the
right-hand end we find
the nose-thread first. This
should always be cut to Whitworth's standard pitch.
Some of the old firms of lathe manufacturers do not
follow this rule, but perpetuate a thread which was
originated in the time when screw-cutting lathes were
not known, and probably the idea of cutting screws,
having an aloquoit number of threads, never occurred
to mechanics. Modern
makers now use Whit-
worth's standard pitches,
and they have many
qualities to recommend
them. One that will be
best appreciated by ama-
teurs, is that the bolts and
nuts fitting the threads
are commonly sold at iron-
mongers. The taps and
other screwing tackle can
also be purchased at all
tool warehouses.
The diameter of the
nose-thread will depend
on the size of the lathe,
that is, the height of
centre. A thread 1 inch in diameter, is correct for a
6 inch centre lathe, this size will be sufficiently strong
to carry any object that the lathe could reasonably be
expected to turn. By proportion,
J
inch nose-thread
is correct for a
3
inch lathe. This is sufficiently
strong for most purposes, but for a backgear lathe
a
I
thread would be better. Any intermediate sizes
LATHE-MAKING FOR AMATEURS.
may be proportionate to these. The length of
the nose-thread, that is the amount that it projects
from the collar against which the chucks are screwed,
should be precisely equal to the diameter of the
thread. A nose }
inch in diameter should be
j
inch long. A length equivalent to the diameter is
sufficient to give ample strength to ensure against
stripping the thread ; any extra length would only
cause the chucks to be at a correspondingly extra
distance from the bearing, and thus introduce a cause
of unsteadiness unnecessarilychucks should always
be as near to the mandrel bearing as possible. With
this object, chucks should be made as flat as is con-
sistent with their use.
Returning to Fig
7,
the illustration shows a
4^
inch headstock. The mandrel measures \i\ inches
from end to end. The
nose-thread is very large
in proportion to the size
of the head. This is to
afford the necessary
strength for carrying
work admitted in a gap
lathe. The nose is \\ in.
in diameter and length
;
for ordinary purposes a
3
inch nose would be
amply strong enough.
The mandrel illustrated
has a conical hole,
inch
diameter, bored in the
centre ;
this receives a
centre point. This hole
could not be allowed in a
small nose. The shoulder
behind the thread is i in.
in diameter ; it is the
largest part of the mandrel. This allows a bearing
surface
f%
of an inch broad all round the nose thread.
A good broad surface is always desirable, as affording
a firm basis for the chucks to screw against. The
surface should be perfectly flat and true, and all
chucks should fit it. The lasting truth of the chucks
will depend on their being carefully fitted to shoulder
up.
A cone bearing is immediately behind the shoulder.
This cone tapers from if inch to \\ inch in the
mandrel, from which the drawing is made
; the length
of the cone being if inch. This amount of taper is
very much more than that adopted in ornamental
lathes of the higest class. A cone tapering about l is
used in these latter.
The mandrel behind the cone is reduced to I inch
in diameter, and turned parallel for a length of 2 inches.
The wheel in front of the pulley has a boss projecting
FIG. 9. SINGLE-SPEED DOUBLE-BEARING HEADSTOCK.
in the front, and this is bored to fit the mandrel
tightly, so that it has to be driven on. A key is also
fitted to prevent the wheel and mandrel rotating
independently.
Behind the wheel the mandrel is slightly reduced
in diameter and turned parallel to the screwed part
shown behind the left-hand cone. The pulley and
the pinion, cast solid with it, are bored through to fit
on this part of the mandrel, so that they revolve freely
but without shake. In use the pulley is made to
revolve with the fixed wheel by means of a bolt
arrangement sliding radially on the wheel. The
length of the fixed wheel, excluding its boss, together
with the pulley and pinion, should be just enough to
fill the space between the collars in the headstock.
The boss of the wheel should not touch the front of
the headstock, but it may
run quite close.
The cone shown on
the left-hand end is quite
a separate piece. It is
bored to fit the parallel
part of the mandrel
tightly. A key is fitted in
the mandrel which com-
pels the cone to revolve
with the mandrel, but
does not impede the
independent longitudinal
motion of either. This
back cone is very like the
front one, except that it is
only i inches long.
The fine thread cut
on the mandrel, just
behind the collar, is to
receive two locking nuts,
with which the distance between the cones is regulated.
The thread must be cut true to allow the front nuts to
bear equally against the back collar, otherwise it might
push it slantways, and cause the mandrel to run un-
equally. A fine thread is desirable, as allowing more
nicety in the adjustment. The thread is about one inch
long, and the two nuts are of equal thickness, that is, half
an inch each. When the mandrel is put in position,
the back cone is brought forward till the mandrel runs
without shake, by screwing up the first nut. This
done the second nut is screwed up and jambed fast
against the first, which is thereby locked so that it will
not be screwed in either direction by the revolutions
of the mandrel.
The plain tail-piece is turned parallel to a diameter
just small enough to clear the thread in the lock nuts.
This tail-piece is useful to receive a wheel for driving
the train of change-wheels of a screw -cutting lathe.
ELECTRO-PLATING AT HOME.
The extreme end of the mandrel is turned true and
quite flat, always leaving the drilled centre on which
the mandrel was turned.
The form of the headstock casting and the various
other parts may be seen by inspecting Figs.
7 and 8,
which give two views of the same head. The chief
axis is the mandrel, and that has been minutely
described. The tail end of it is shown against a screw
tail-pin, shown most clearly in Fig. 8. This tail-pin is
intended solely to take the thrust when boring or
otherwise pressing the mandrel from the front end.
Force applied in that direction would cause the front
cone to jamb in the collar and so stop the mandrel.
A direct bearing for this thrust is necessary in all
lathe heads. The tail - pin shown is an effective
arrangement, but others are used. The tail-pin screw
is itself secured by a lock nut.
The lugs shown on Fig. 7
are to go between the
bearers of the bed. The holes in them are tapped to
receive bolts and then fit in the space between the
bearers. By screwing the bolts in or out the lathe
head may be shifted angularwise on the bed, and in
this way the line of centres is adjusted, so that the axis
of the mandrel is made to coincide precisely with the
centre of the poppit barrel.
The small disc in the centre of the casting is only
to add to the strength where the hole for the holding
down bolt is made. For small headstocks one bolt is
sufficient, but large ones generally have two. When a
headstock is fastened to the bed, care must be
exercised to guard against straining it. Frequently
mandrel headstocks are bent by being screwed down
to the bed, and in that case the mandrel cannot work
to advantage.
In Fig. 8 a top view is given. The form 'of the
bracket piece cast on to the backgear horn is here
shown. The spindle at the top represents the spindle
of the backgear wheel and pinion. This spindle is
1 inch in diameter and 10 inches long. It is a plain
parallel cylinder having keys to fix the wheel and
pinion. The two semicircular grooves near the right-
hand end are used to confine the end motion of the
mandrel. A pin passes vertically through the arm, the
hole to receive it being drilled on the diameter of the
bearing. Half the pin projects within the bearing, and
thus fits the semicircular grooves. Neither this pin
nor the hole for it are shown in the illustration. The
spindle moves lengthwise freely, and the semicircular
grooves are so placed that, when the pin is in one, the
wheels are out of gear, as shown. When the spindle
is moved along to the left till the other groove comes
under the pin-hole the wheels are then in gear. The
pin dropped in will keep the spindle in either position,
as required.
With the wheels out of gear, as illustrated, the
I
front wheel and the pulley are attached by means of a
sliding bolt and revolve together. In this way the
lathe is precisely like an ordinary single speed
mandrel. To put the backgear in action the front
wheel and the mandrel are disconnected. The back
spindle is slid along to the left to bring the wheels
into gear, then on turning the pulley the mandrel
revolves, slower proportionate to the reduction in the
gearing. In the lathe shown the wheels have
65
teeth and the pinions 20, so that the speed is reduced
to about one-tenth.
A plain double bearing mandrel headstock is
shown at Fig. 9. This is a more simple lathe head
than the one last described. The gear wheels are
absent, and much complication of detail is thereby
avoided. This single speed head is equal to nearly all
the requirements of an amateur turner, but to turn
heavy work of the largest size that the lathe would
carry, backgear is necessary.
The mandrel is shown in elevation in this illustra-
tion, as in Fig. 7. It will be noticed that the two
mandrels are very much alike, the second one, Fig.
9,
being proportionately much shorter. The nose-thread,
the shoulder, and the front cone are as described in
Fig. 7. The plain parallel part, to receive the
pulley, is provided with a key which prevents the
pulley turning without the mandrel ; it is also driven
on tight. The second cone is as described in former
headstock. The fine thread that takes the locking
nuts is also similar. This headstock is not intended
for a screw-cutting lathe, and consequently no mandrel
tail-piece for the necessary cog-wheel is provided.
The arm to take the screw tail-pin is cast on the
headstock, as shown. The tail-pin is screwed through
it, and a lock-nut on the inner side locks the screw at
any position desired. The mandrel is adjusted to run
in its bearings, freely and without shake, by means of
the front lock-nut, the second one is then screwed up
firmly against the first so as to lock each other.
The foregoing descriptions will have made the
construction of lathe headstocks clear to amateurs.
(To be continued.)
^=^=^
ELECTRO-PLATING AT HOME.
By GEORGE EDWINSON.
V. Electro-Plating Trinkets, etc.
ORD PALMERSTON is said to have
defined the word "dirt" as "matter in
the wrong place," and it will be an
advantage to the amateur plater to adopt
his lordship's definition instead of that
commonly received and understood, for he will find
ELECTRO-PLATING AT HOME. 203
that many failures in operations connected with the
practice of this art are due to the presence of dirt, or
"
matter in the wrong place." To get the best results
from a battery it is necessary that clean metal shall be
in close contact with clean metal in all parts of the
metallic circuit ; to get the best results from a battery
solution or a plating bath it is necessary' to have an
entire absence of all foreign matters and useless salts
;
and, to get the deposited metal to firmly adhere to the
article on which it is deposited, it is absolutely neces-
sary that clean metal shall touch perfectly clean metal.
When silver is properly deposited on a perfectiy clean
surface, say of brass, of German silver, or of copper,
it is afterwards impossible to separate the two metals,
by mechanical means, for the fine particles of the
deposited metal unite themselves to the clean metal of
the article in a manner similar to that of dovetailing.
But when some of the tiny pores of the metallic surface
are filled with some foreign matter, the silver is kept
out, and in some cases a gas is generated in those
pores under the influence of heat subsequently
engendered under the friction necessary for burnish-
ing, and this gas, as it expands, thrusts off the coat of
silver or causes it to rise in blisters. To illustrate the
delicate cleanliness necessary, I may say that even the
touch of an apparently clean dry finger on the prepared
surface will often cause the silver to strip off from that
part under the burnisher.
The plater will have to contend with dirt of two
kindsviz., animal dirt, such as grease, oil, sweat, etc.
;
and mineral dirt, such as rust, tarnish, stains, etc.
The first class are removable by boiling in the chemi-
cals known as alkalis, the second by immersion in
those known as acids, and by friction with proper
brushes. These brushes form an indispensable
adjunct to the plater's plant, for they are largely
required, both in preparing the articles for the deposit
and finishing them after the silver has been deposited
on them, I will therefore give a few directions for their
manufacture at home.
Scratch-brushes.The most simple form of these
brushes has been already illustrated and described in
my first article in p. 10. Sketches of other forms are
given here. The essential and common feature of all
may be described in the words of patent agents, as
follows : A bunch, or coil, or hank, or a combination
of bunches in the form of a brush, which may be
either small like a tooth-brush, large and long like a
plate-brush or a carriage-brush, or of a circular form,
of small brass, copper, iron, or any other wire, or of
spun glass, or of some coarse vegetable fibre. The
form and size of brush, and also the material of which
it is composed, are determined by the magnitude and
character of the work to be done with it. Rough,
coarse work may require large brushes of iron or steel
wire, and very delicate work may need brushes of fine
spun glass, but all work likely to be done by the
amateur may be easily performed with small brushes
made of brass wire of the first forms shown at A and B
in Fig. 23. Fine hard-drawn brass wire is the best
(20)
V 65
This being done, open the compasses to an extent
of
9
parts of the perpendicular, and describe the
two arcs a a from the point b. Then place the
compasses on the point 24, and opening them to b,
draw the curve aba.
Next set off 2 parts c, on each side of the perpen-
dicular, on the horizontal line c. Place the compasses
on the point c, and opening them to a, draw the
curves d d, from a to the horizontal line A.
Now set off one part*?, on each side of the perpen-
dicular on the line B. Place the compasses on these
points, and opening them to the line A, where the
curve d ends, draw the curves
f
from the line A to
that of D. This completes the draught of the upper
portion of the instrument.
For the middle or narrow portion proceed thus
:
(= ~) of an
inch throughout its entire length. Its width at the
edge glued to the belly is
T
3
5
inch broad, the other edge
is slightly rounded. This last round edge is quite
straight, so that the edge glued to the belly throughout
its entire length takes a concavity regulated by the
longitudinal arching of the belly. Its depth is also, of
course, similarly regulated, but is generally in the best
fiddles
f
inch in the centre or broadest part. It is set
quite at a right-angle with the belly (vide Fig. 28). The
purely mechanical influence of the bass-bar is interest-
ingly illustrated by the following experiment taken from
Mr. Davidson's work on the Violin. Having procured a
piece of well-seasoned and sonorous pine a belly was
formed out of it in the usual manner, adopting the
plan of thickness according to the method used by
Stradivarius. This plate, when thus finished, the
f
holes not as yet cut, gave the note C. Subsequently the
/holes were cut of the usual size and pattern, when the
sound was found to bp lowered half a tone, now being B.
A bass-bar having afterwards been glued on, of a some-
what larger size than commonly employed, the plate
gave the note D, but the bar having been reduced to its
properdimensions the sound was again lowered, and now
the belly gave the same tone as originally, C. We can
now easily perceive that the bar perfectly compensates
for the difference of tone, arising from the cutting of
the/" holes, but at the same time we can raise or lower
the tone very considerably by altering the dimensions
of the bar
;
for the stronger the bar the higher the
tone, the sound lowering as the bar is decreased in
dimensions.
And this brings us to the fact that the original
bass-bars put in by the Italian masters have all
become too weak for the modern high pitch, and
consequently a bar of the dimensions given above (10
inches) must now be substituted for the original one.
The functions of the bass-bar are to transmit to the
entire fiddle the vibrations produced in it by the left
foot of the bridge, and not, as has so often been laid
down, to strengthen the belly, as was unwittingly said
in error in the concluding paragraph of the last
chapter. As Otto justly remarks,
"
A properly con-
structed fiddle ought to be able to stand screwing
up to pitch without either bass-bar or sound-post,
without giving way." Care must be taken not to
make the bass-bar too long in proportion to the
instrument, or, instead of promoting it will check the
vibration, and render the tone of the fiddle dull. The
same care ought to be taken in the selection of the
wood of which the bar is made, as with the material
for the belly, and for the same reason, it should be
made of the pine, which yields the highest note when
struck or vibrated with a bow.
In answer to numerous inquiries, I have much
pleasure in saying that arrangements have been made
with Mr. Hill, of No. 72, Wardour Street, London,
W., to provide such of the readers of Amateur
Work, Illustrated, as want them, with good old
well-seasoned wood for Violin making, and those tools
which are peculiar to this art. Others, which are
common to all amateur work, can be procured of any
high-class tool manufacturer. As this is not a part of
Mr. Hill's profession of Violin making and repairing,
I beg here to accord him my best thanks, and those
of my readers, for thus far obliging me and them.
These particulars would more properly have belonged
to a later chapter, but the many applications that have
been made for this information have decided me to
insert it here The prices for which Mr. Hill has
undertaken to supply these wants of the amateur
fiddle-maker are as follows :
Wood. s. d. s.d. s. d. s. d.
Maple block for neck Iron for bending
and scroll, from.. 6 to 1 6 sides, etc .. 15
Do, with cut scroll. 2 6 6 Callipers, for gaug-
Maple for back ... 2 6 10 ing thicknesses... .. 60
Ditto for sides ... 6 2 Conical tool for
Swiss pine, for bel- cutting// holes.. .. 36
lies, bass - bar, Wooden screw vices
sound-post, and for fixing back
side linings (com- and belly (each).
3
too 6
plete) 1 6
5
Steel purfling tool. . 6 10
Purfling (made by Tool for clearing
Mr. Hill), per the purfling . . 20
yard
3
Tools for nipping
yyholes(perpair) . .. 10
Tools, etc. Salisbury glue, per
Sound-post setters 1 lb .. 1 6
All or any of the above will be sent, on receipt of
P.O.O. covering carriage, and made payable to
Mr. W. E. Hill,
72, Wardour Street, Leicester Square.
(To be continued).
WOOD-WORKING MACHINERY FOR AMATEURS.
Wood-Working Machinery for Amateurs.
! By A. J. W. TATLEB, C.E.
I.Hand-Power Sawing Machinery.
HE chief hard woods that are used in this
country are oak, ash, mahogany, teak,
and elm
; of resinous
woods, the most general
in use are, red pine from
Norway, Sweden, and Russia
; Memel,
Dantzig
and
Riga fir from
Russia and
Prussia
;
yellow
pine, pitch pine,
and cedar ;
nu-
merous other or-
namental
woods
are also used
for
decorative
purposes.
Though any
detailed account
of the early his-
tory of wood-
working
ma-
chinery would,
in the present
papers be im-
possible, it will
not, perhaps, be
out of place be-
fore endeavour-
ing to describe
the various
hand-power ma-
chines suitable
for amateurs for
the conversion
of the above,
to allude briefly
to Sir Samuel Bentham's patents of
1791 and 1793. The specifications of
his inventions indeed comprehend
nearly all that is now known of wood-
converting implements, with the exception of course of
subsequent improvement in their details
; and the
wording of the specifications might, with very slight
alteration, stand for many patents taken out during the
last few years, some of which have been considered a
novelty in this country, as the rolling-wedge in sawing
machines. Mention is also made in these remark-
able specifications, of planing machines with rotary
cutters, to cut on several sides of the wood at once
;
veneer cutting-machine, horizontal, stone saws, mould-
ing and recessing-machine, bevel sawing-machine,
saw-sharpening-machine, tenon-cutting by means of
circular saws, and many kinds of rotary and boring
tools. The band saw was invented in 1808, by
William Newberry, and though it failed at that time,
probably through the impossibility of obtaining blades
so tempered as to withstand the
strains to which they are subjected,
still Newberry's machine possessed
all the elements of practical utility.
From 1635 to
1 702, there lived
a celebrated me-
chanic, named
Doctor Hooke,
who carried out
various experi-
ments with cir-
cular saws, only,
however, for
very small ar-
ticles, such as
cutting the teeth
of clock wheels,
etc. Frame
saws, driven by
water or wind
power, were the
first sawing-
machines for
cutting timber.
In Rees's Cyclo-
paedia it is
stated that the
general use of
these machines
was prohibited
by Parliament,
for fear of
spoiling the
trade of sawyers.
Though thus standing in the way of
private enterprise,
Government was
not above using machinery for its own
benefit, for in 1807,
Isambard Brunei
and Henry Maudslay were called in to design ma-
chinery for the manufacture of ships' blocks. About
the year 1805, a circular saw for cutting disks, such
as the heads of casks and tubs, was invented by
John Trotter. This saw took the form of a segment
of a hollow sphere.
As the space at our disposal only allows us to
touch upon the most salient features in the early his-
tory of wood-converting machinery, we recommend
NEW HAND-POWER CIKCU
EAR SAW BENCH.
WOOD-WORKING
MACHINERY FOR AMATEURS. 213
any of our readers who are desirous of pursuing the
subject further, to read a most exhaustive work by M.
Powis-Bale, C.E., M. Inst. M.E., entitled "Wood-
Working Machinery : its Rise, Progress, and Con-
struction
; " in this work will be found not only the
history of wood-cutting machinery, traced from the
earliest period of recorded time through its incipient
stages of develop-
ment, but also an
elaborate and ex-
haustive descrip-
tion of the devices
which human inge-
nuity has contrived
for the superseding
of manual labour
with rollers. With this bench one man can cut
3
inches deep, at the rate of 10 feet in four minutes, or 2
inches deep, at the rate of 10 feet in two minutes,
this is effecting a saving of more than
1
50 per cent.
over what can be done with a hand saw.
The frame is 4 feet by 2 feet, cast in one piece, and
planed on the top to perfect truth. It is fitted with a
rising and falling
spindle mounted in
a cradle, and raised
or lowered by
means of the lever
shown on the right-
hand side of the
engraving, a self-
acting feed motion
in the conversion
of timber.
Of all the nu-
merous machines
in use for convert-
ing wood, the circu-
lar saw bench is
everywhere in the
most general de-
mand, for whether wood has to be mortised, moulded,
or planed, etc., it must always be first cut up at a
circular saw bench. It is of great importance there-
fore to a buyer, to see that he gets a machine which
will do his work well, not only for a few months, but
for years.
Our illustration, Fig. 1, represents a new improved
hand-power circular saw bench, suitable for amateurs,
it will cut \\
inches deep, and weighs 6cwt, complete
FIG. 2.HAND-POWER BAND SAWING MACHINE.
worked from the
toothed gearing
used to multiply the
speed of the saw
spindle, and a paral-
lel fence or guide
which is made to
cant, so as to cut
bevels, or it can
be instantly thrown over by merely slacking a
thumb-screw, thus leaving the table clear for cross
cutting, there is also a weight and roller working in a
slot on the table for keeping the timber to the fence.
The speed necessary is obtained, as will be readily
seen from the sketch, by the fly-wheel being arranged
as an internally toothed spur-gear and pinion. If of
the same strength of tooth, this gear is capable of
transmitting greater force, because more teeth are
214 WOOD-WORKING MACHINERY FOR AMATEURS.
engaged than in the ordinary spur-gears, a third spur
or toothed wheel on the spindle carrying the saw gives
the required number of revolutions per minute.
In working the above machine it must be re-
membered that in order to ensure easy working, one of
the first requisites is the employment of good oil. It
is also imperative that the saws should be properly
sharpened, and evenly set; if this should have been
performed carelessly it is impossible to cut either well
or straight. In sharpening and setting saws, great
care should be taken that the teeth on one side have
no more lead than on the other, as, where this is the
case, the timber will either bind [against or leave the
fence, and cut the timber crooked. The saw, when in
its place, should be topped on the teeth with a file, so
as to make it perfectly round. Great care should be
taken to see that the fence plate is perfectly parallel
with the saw, this is managed by four small set screws
which are fitted behind to regulate it.
For tenoning and grooving, it is necessary to take
off the nut from the end of the feed shaft and to
release the small set screw in the wheel, then the
shaft may be drawn out of the way, and tenons may
be cut by passing the timber perpendicularly to the
saw, keeping it close to the fence ; attention must be
paid, when replacing the feed shaft not to screw the nut
too tight, as it would in that case bind. In order to
afford greater facility for tenoning, there are four holes
in the fence plate, to which apiece of plain timber may
be screwed, standing higher than the fence, to place the
timber against while tenoning. For grooving, tenoning,
or rabbeting, the saw may be either raised or lowered
by means of the lever, and swing under the table of
the bench. When the saw is set for cutting, bring
down the feed-wheel on the timber, this is done by
means of the lever standing above the fly-wheel, fasten
the feed motion to its place by means of the wing-nut
and rod attached to the lever, it will then do for the
same thickness for any number of cuts.
With the bench are also supplied two double cog
change-wheels to be used for changing the rate of the
feed motion, according to the thickness of the timber
to be sawn, also six wood rollers and twelve brackets
to be fixed, three at each side of the bench, for the
purpose of running timber to and from the saw.
In the bench table there is a groove cut for the
purpose of guiding a cross-cutting and mitring fence,
with which that kind of work may be done with much
greater accuracy and expedition.
In sawing wood of irregular thickness the feeding
motion should not be screwed down too tightly upon
the wood, for if that should be done the gear may be
strained or broken.
In conclusion it may be remarked that should the
machine not cut evenly it may be attributed to one of
the following causes : the saw not being correctly set,
in which case the timber is certain to run to or from
the fence ; the fence plate not being set parallel to the
saw, on this much depends
; or the small roller in
front of the saw wearing out of truth.
This extremely useful little bench may be purchased
by amateurs in separate parts, and thus afford them
considerable amusement fitting up same, or complete,
in working order, without feed motion and rollers and
carriers for extending the bench, for ,12. If supplied
with six rollers and carriers for extending the bench,
and two extra change-wheels for feed motion, the price
would be
,14 10s. For an extra charge often shillings
this bench can be fitted with pulleys, so that it could
be worked either with a small steam or gas engine, or
by hand, as desired.
Fig. 2 illustrates a hand power band sawing-
machine suitable for amateurs, and well adapted for
every variety of work, circular, irregular, angular, and
straight. Band saw-machines are most useful, owing
to the great variety of sawing that can be done with
them ; they also waste very little of the wood, owing
to the small kerf made, which, when working the more
valuable kinds, is no slight advantage.
One of the chief difficulties encountered in band
saws is their frequent breakage, which must be guarded
against by keeping a steady tension on the saw ; this is
performed either by supporting the carriage of the top
wheel by a lever and weight, any desired amount of
tension being brought to bear upon the saw, by shifting
the weight in or out upon the lever, or by an arrange-
ment of a coach or spiral spring, which latter is the
more desirable method.
The machine depicted in the sketch is very strongly
built, the standard or column being one solid casting,
it is remarkably compact and complete in itself, it
occupies but little room, and works by hand with
greater ease than most other hand-machines of its
class, and is peculiarly strong, rigid, and steady in
work. It is fitted with a patent spring tension, an
arrangement in order to allow for the expansion or
contraction of the saw whilst working, and to enable
it to yield freely to any sudden strain to which it may
be subjected. The table is made to swing so that it
can be canted at any angle by means of the quadrant
and hand-screw partially shown underneath the table
in the sketch, for cutting work on the bevel ; it is also
fitted with an angle bracket, which is not shown in the
engraving, to be used when tenoning. The top and
bottom spindles for the saw wheels are bushed with
gun metal. The tension upon the saw blade is regu-
lated by means of the hand-wheel shown behind the
top saw wheel. This band saw is capable of admitting
work 1 1 inches deep.
In working the above machine besides the usual
MODELLING IN CLA Y. 215
attention to keeping the bearings well lubricated,
especial attention must be paid to the tension of the
saw blade, for to its expansion and contraction may
be traced a fruitful source of breakages. This can be
somewhat lessened by lubricating the blade well, and
keeping the leathers on the saw-wheels true, and
also in slackening the tension of the saw im-
mediately after finishing work. The bed plate and
column of the machine should be of sufficient section
and area, and fixed on a foundation of sufficient firm-
ness to prevent any jarr or vibration even when sawing
the heaviest timber, of which the machine is capable.
Saw blades also of a thin gauge will be found to stand
better than stout ones, as they should always bend
easily over the pulleys, for if the angle be too sharp
for the gauge or temper of the saw, they will
inevitably break ; the smaller the diameter of the saw
wheel, so should in ratio the gauge of the saw be re-
duced.
For cutting the harder and closer-grained woods
such as oak, beech, etc., the saw should be increased
one gauge, the teeth should be more upright, and
spaced finer, and the set also should be reduced. For
woods of a woolly fibre, such as English poplar, the
teeth of the saw should be of coarse space and set,
to effect a clearance and overcome its clinging pro-
perties.
The hand band saw-machine as depicted in illus-
tration can either be obtained in parts, or, complete
with angle bracket for tenoning and one
f
inch saw,
sharpened and set ready for use for ji2. It can be
fitted with a pair of 6-inch pulleys placed behind the
fly-wheel, so that it can be worked by a small gas or
steam engine, if desired.
{To be continued?)
=~H
MODELLING IN CLAY.
AX INTRODUCTION TO THE ART OF CARVING
IN WOOD.
V.Examples for Work in Wood and Clay.
O the modeller in clay, examples for prac-
tice other than those which he may
obtain from natural objects will doubt-
less be welcome, and the student in
wood carving who is seeking to acquire
facility and rapidity of execution, and, for this purpose,
has carefully followed the instructions that have
already been given, in all probability feels the need of
additional examples and suggestions suitable for his
requirements, which may serve to supplement those
that have been brought under his notice in previous
chapters. Having the interests and probable desires
of both classes of workers in view, the illustrations
that are now given, are engravings of wood carvings
made by the skilful hands of adepts in the work.
These illustrations, it may be said, are not only
remarkable for beauty and simplicity of treatment,
but they also serve in an especial manner to illustrate
leading features of carved work executed by the
cutting tools only. It will be found that the remarks
that follow assume the form of instructions to those
who can use chisel and gouge rather than directions
for the guidance of the modeller in clay
;
but at the
same time it must be urged that while that which is
said applies more particularly to the work of the wood
carver, the modeller may appropriate and apply to his
own case the lessons that it is sought to convey, as
they will tend to show him that what may be done
readily and easily in wood is not always so practicable
in clay, although facility in handling and working in
clay cannot fail to be most valuable to him when he
begins to work in wood, and will render his progress
far more sure and rapid than it would have been
had he begun with the gouge and chisel on the
harder materials by cutting away, instead of taking the
modelling stand and tools and studying the reverse
process of building-up.
In Fig. 22 a panel is shown which, in the original,
is about fourteen inches long and two inches wide.
These, it must be explained, are the dimensions of the
panel itself, and not of the surrounding surface by
which it is framed. It is drawn, therefore, on a scale
of 6 inches to a foot, or very nearly so. It is carved
in pine, and the greatest depth of the background is
scarcely three-eighths of an inch at the deepest point.
None of the work reaches the surface, that is to say,
no part of the pattern in the centre retains the original
height of the plain surface of the piece of wood which
has been thus treated. This surface is shown by that
part of the engraving which surrounds the central
depression, within the bounds of which the carved
work is contained. One excellent lesson that is to be
learnt from this example is that it is unnecessary, in
order to obtain strong contrast, to seek for very high
relief. The method of handling the surfaces, of bring-
ing projecting parts against deep hollows, and of
placing one part over another is sufficient to give all
the contrasts that are shown in the engraving, as well
as in the other illustrations that accompany this chap-
ter, without the need of cutting the wood away to great
depths, this shallow work being even more striking
in the panel itself than it is in the engraving.
With regard to the execution of the carving, all the
stems in this work were first cut rectangular in section,
and then finished with a gouge having a very small
sweep. This mode of cutting, while leaving the
2l6 MODELLING IN CLAY.
about 6 inches to the foot. Depth of
background, about \ inch.
corners sharp so as to catch the light and make strong shadows,
admirably imitates the general effect of the bark. This example,
drawn on a considerably larger scale, will be found to form an
admirable lesson in modelling, giving, as it does, a very pretty theme
for a panel, and at the same time allowing the student an ample
field for displaying his knowledge or his skill of hand. It is, of
course, impossible in an engraving printed in the ordinary way to
give an idea of the beautiful effects obtained by the cutting tool
in the soft wood, and that, too, in the simplest manner and with
little labour.
Fig. 25 represents a small panel in oak, in which the greatest
depth is only
\ inch. The panel in the original is of the same width
as that shown in Fig. 22 ; but it is not quite so long. The student
will notice that the lower half of the design is unfinished, showing the
work as it was blocked out. The upper half is complete. The
two little flowers at the bottom are scarcely more than buttons
;
yet they are in
the condition of
half - finished
work, and show
how results are
to be obtained.
All the stems
in the lower
portion are rec-
tangular, and
the forms of
the leaves are
given, and their
outline cor-
rected, but
there is no
attempt made
at the veining.
The stems of
the upper por-
tion are finish-
ed__by cutting a chamfer along their edges, and in the chamfer
making a score, so that the finished work, when closely examined,
appears as though a V-shaped tool had been run along so as to cut
out the corner. In finishing the leaves, one half is made higher
than the other at the centre line ; so that, according as the light
falls, we have the effect of a raised or sunken rib. The smaller ribs
are formed by sharp V-shaped cuts, and by raising the surface on
one side above that of the other. The workman was evidently a
master, for he has made his tool mark useful in indicating curves
on the surfaces. The light veins upon the leaves, and many other
skilful matters of this sort must be seen rather than described
; but
the carver will find out many of them for himself, after a little use of
his tools. One thing must be borne in mind : that in work of this
description sand-paper must not be used. Men are so accustomed
to see dead smooth surfaces on carved furniture, and other work of
the kind, that they have an instinctive tendency towards smoothing
up everything to which they can apply a piece of sand-paper. This
destroys the character of the work, and makes it appear as though
SMALL PANEL OR KOSETTE CARVED IN PINE.
MODELLING IN CLA 1.
217
it were of putty. In the best work the tool marks show, and show
to some purpose.
The original rosette from which Fig. 23 was taken is
5^
inches
square, and die projection of the centre above the background" on
which the smaller rosettes are carved is only & inch. On looking at
it, it is difficult to believe that so good an effect has been obtained
with so small a projection. The leaves radiating from the centre rise,
then, with a long sweep, slope outward, and finally rise again just
inside of the circle. This design, while very easy to make in wood,
would be unnecessarily difficult in clay ; and any attempt to execute
it in this material would probably end in failure, and thus lead to
disappointment. It can be laid out with compasses and lead pencil
upon the surface of the wood, and work commenced at once.
One of the great beauties of this ornament is its suggestiveness.
It is hardly possible to look at it without seeing in the mind each
of the leaves filled with a variety of complicated work, as illustrated
in Fig. 24. If
the student]
who has been
modelling in
clay, and has
not yet com-
menced to use
the cutting
tools, wishes
for some prac-
tice in wood-
carving, he can-
not do better,
after having
had the prac-
tice which has
been indicated
in the previous
papers, than to
take a block
of pine, and,
drawing any one of these designs upon it, attempt to carve it. In
doing this, let the design be first outlined with a narrow chisel, sharp-
ened like a knife blade from both sides. When the outline has
been incised to perhaps the depth of & inch or thereabouts, cutting
away may be begun.
The other steps need not be described here. To any one accus-
tomed to the use of tools, this would be superfluous ;
and it is
to those who are already familiar with the handling of wood and the
manipulation of carving tools, that the remarks made in this and the
preceding papers have been directed. The beginner, for whose
instruction they have been also written, may make his essay on
carving from what has been said on this part of the subject. He
may be successful beyond his expectations, but in all probability he
will find that he needs further instruction in the use and manage-
ment of the tools used in wood cutting. These he will gather from
the series of articles on wood carving which have been specially
written to follow these papers on
"
Modelling in Clay," and which will
be commenced in the next part of Amateur Work, Illustrated.
FIG. 24.ELABORATION OF LEAVES IN SMALL PANEL.
FIG. 25.SMALL PANEL CARVED IN OAK.
Scale, about 6 inches to the foot. Greatest
depth of background not more than
J
inch.
The lower part represents the work blocked
out and in an unfinished state.
2l8 SIMPLE VENEERING WITH THE HAMMER.
SIMPLE VENEERING WITH THE HAMMER.
HE following directions for veneering, if
strictly followed, will insure success in
this important branch of mechanicahvork.
The softest woods should be chosen.
Perhaps the best for the purpose are
those of perfectly straight grain and without a knot
;
of course no one ever veneers over a knot. Hard
wood can be veneered, boxwood with ivory for in-
stance, but wood that will warp and twist, such as
cross-grained mahogany, must be avoided. The veneer
and the wood on which it is to be laid must both be
carefully prepared, the former by taking out all marks
of the saw on both sides with a fine toothing plane,
the latter with a coarser toothing plane. If the veneer
happens to be broken in doing this, it maybe repaired
at once with a bit of stiff paper, glued upon it on the
upper side. The veneer should be cut rather larger
than the surface to be covered
;
if much twisted it
may be damped and placed under a board and weight
over night. This saves some trouble, but with veneers
that are cheap it is not worth while taking much
trouble about refractory pieces.
The wood to be veneered must now be sized with
glue. The ordinary glue-pot will supply this by
dipping the brush first into the glue, then into the
boiling water in the outer vessel. This size must be
allowed to dry before the veneer is laid on. We will
suppose now that the veneering process is about to
commence ; the glue in good condition and boiling
hot, the bench cleared, a basin of hot water with the
veneering hammer and a sponge in it, a cloth or two,
and everything in position that one will not interfere
with, or be in the way of another.
First damp with hot water that side of the veneer
which is not to be glued, then glue the other side.
Secondly, go over as quickly as possible the wood
itself, previously toothed and sized. Thirdly, bring the
veneer rapidly to it with the outspread hands, and
taking care that the edges of the veneer overlap a little
all round. Fourthly, grasp the veneering hammer
close to the pene (shaking off the hot water from it)
and the handle pointing away from you. Wriggle it
about, pressing the veneer down stoutly, and squeez-
ing the glue from the middle out at the edges.
If it is a large piece of stuff which is to be ve-
neered, the assistance of a hot iron will be wanted to
make the glue liquid again after it has set ; but do not
let it dry the wood underneath it, or it will burn the
glue and scorch the veneer, ruining the work. Fifthly,
having got out all the glue possible, search the surface
for blisters, which will at once be betrayed by the
sound they give when tapped with the handle of the
hammer : the hot iron must be applied, or the inner
vessel of the glue-pot itself, which often answers the
purpose, and the process with the hammer repeated.
When the hammer is not in the hand, it should be
in the hot water. The whole may now be sponged
over with hot water, and wiped as dry as can be.
And observe, throughout the above process, never
have any slop and wet about the work that you can
avoid. Whenever you use the sponge, squeeze it well
first. Damp and heat are wanted, not wet and heat.
It is a good thing to have the sponge in the left hand
nearly all the time, ready to take up any moisture or
squeezed out glue from the front of the hammer.
So much for laying veneers with the hammer,
which, though a valuable tool, is not much used in the
best cabinet-makers' shops, cauls being adopted in-
stead. Cauls are made of wood, the shape and size
of the surface to be veneered, or, better still, of rolled
zinc plate, and being made very hot before a good
blaze of shavings, they are clamped down on the work
when the veneer is got in its place. The cauls must
previously be soaped, to prevent them sticking to the
veneer. The whole is then left to dry together. The
hammer is quite sufficient, however, in small cabinet
shops, and for amateurs, who will not require to cover
surfaces of any great extent. Veneers
5
feet long and
18 inches wide can be laid with the hammer, without
assistance, and without leaving a blister. Cauls, how-
ever, are very necessary if a double-curved surface
has to be veneered, or a concave surface ; they need
not be used for a simple convex surface. By well
wetting one side of the veneer, it will curl up, and can
be easily laid on such a surface ; but it will be well to
bind the whole round with some soft string, to assist it
in keeping down while drying.
HOW TO BUILD A SMALL ORGAN.
V.Concluding Remarks.
HE drawing which forms the full-page illus-
tration of the present number, gives a
view of the organ with the pipes arranged
as suggested in page 176, and compares
very favourably with the view given in
Fig. 20, which arrangement would need a false front to
hide the pipes. Placing the larger pipes at the front
and sides involves little, if any, more labour in the
grooving, and no more outlay, as the upper case or
false front is dispensed with, and moreover you get
the full power of the pipes.
It does not matter where the holes are bored
through the sound-board, provided they are over the
proper channel, as in this organ there is only one set
HOW TO BUILD A SMALL ORGAN. 2l9
of pipes. The holes may, therefore, be over any part
of the channels that may be most convenient or
nearest to the place to which the pipes are grooved
off. I may also state that Figs. 16 and
17,
page 117,
not being to scale, must only be taken as showing the
mode in which pipes are grooved off ; the amateur can
place his pipes in any position that may be most
convenient for speaking.
The design now under consideration may be varied
by making the pipes level at the top, or descending in
very small steps by placing a board cut as in Fig. 21
over the panel above the key-board. If this is done it
is obvious that the pipe feet must be longer for each
pipe up to the centre one. This can be easily
managed by making the feet in the same manner as a
pipenamely, four sided, and rounded at the bottom
where it goes into the hole in the grooving board.
You can thus make the feet any length you like, and
without the necessity of boring them.
If either of these designs be adopted the cor-
responding pipes on each side should be exactly the
same length. This will not affect the note which they
should sound, as the stopper can be pushed down
until the proper note is obtained.
The decoration of the pipes can be accomplished
by painting in the ground tint and then stencilling in
the ornaments in their proper colours, or in gold size
for gilt work. The stencil-plates can be cut out of
thick cartridge paper.
A hint to those who may not have sufficient skill
to do this, and yet are desirous of decorating the
pipes. At any good paper-hanging warehouse you
can purchase some artistic wall-paper of suitable pat-
terns. This you can either paste on to the pipes as it
is, or you may cut out such portions as you require,
such as the fleur-de-liswhich is generally gilt
Drop in a plug of
cotton-wool, upon this
place 1 inch of sand,
boiled and washed as
previously directed,
then add
3
inches of
animal charcoal, pre-
viously ignited, and
allowed to cool out of
contact with air, press
224 BOAT-BUILDING MADE EASY.
the charcoal down with a moderate degree of firmness,
cover with another plug of cotton-wool, and replace
the cork. The filter is now complete, and has the
appearance shown in Fig.
1 5.
When required for use, the end A should be
dropped into the water, and the end B placed in the
mouth, the large tube itself being grasped in the
hand. On applying suction, the water will rise
through the apparatus to the mouth, being deprived
in transit of the greater proportion of its impurities.
6. Cask Filter for Ponds.
I now turn to my
country readers, and to such of them as are unfor-
tunately dependent, either continuously or occasion-
ally, for their water supply upon ponds, stagnant
streams, or such-like doubtful sources, I offer the
following filter, premising that no amount of mere
filtration will suffice to render their water free from all
suspicion.
Take a cask of any convenient size, and remove
its head. Through the bottom bore a number of
holes, each about an inch in diameter, to give the
water access to the interior. Supposing the cask
selected to be about three feet high (if any other size,
the following quantities must be altered in proportion),
cover the bottom to the depth of 2 inches with large
pebbles, then add 2 inches of small pebbles, then
2 inches of coarse sand, next 2 inches of animal
charcoal
European
Mail.
How to GET Rid OF Rats.A writer in the
Scientific American says that he cleared his premises
of these detestable vermin by making whitewash yellow
with copperas, and covering the stones and rafters in
the cellar with it. In every crevice in which a rat
might go, he put the crystals of the copperas, and
scattered in the corners of the floor. The result was a
complete disappearance of rats and mice. Since that
time not a rat or mouse has been seen near the house.
Every spring the cellar is coated with the yellow wash
as a purifier, and as a rat exterminator, and no typhoid,
dysentery, or fever attacks the family. Never allow
rats and mice to be poisoned in the house ; they are
apt to die between the walls, and produce much
annoyance.
Brilliant Red Ink for Draughtsmen.The
solubility of carmine lake in caustic aqua-ammonia is
attended with this disadvantage that in consequence
of the alkaline properties of ammonia, the cochineal
pigment will in time form a basic compound, which, in
contact with a steel pen, no longer produces the intense
Ted, but rather a blackish colour. To avoid this evil,
a German paper recommends the following as a good
means of preparing the ink : Triturate 1 gramme of
pure carmine with
15
grammes of acetate ammonia
solution, and an equal quantity of distilled water, in a
porcelain mortar, and allow the whole to stand for
some time. In this way a portion of the alumina
which is combined with the carmine dye is taken up
by the acetic acid of the ammonia salt and separates
as precipitate, while the pure pigment of the cochineal
remains dissolved in the half-saturated ammonia. It
is now filtered, and a few drops of pure white sugar
syrup added, to thicken it. In this way an excellent
red drawing ink is obtained, which holds its colour a
long time. A solution of gum arabic cannot be em-
ployed to thicken this ink, as it still contains some
acetic acid, which would coagulate the bassorine, one
of the natural constituents of gum-arabic.
Cutting Glass with a Hot Iron.The follow-
ing directions for the old process of cutting glass with
a red-hot iron, are sometimes sold to the unwary as a
great secret. The method is very simple, and to those
who have failed with the recipes usually published
(strings with turpentine and set on fire, friction with
strings, etc.), the results are rather surprising'. There
is no difficulty in cutting off broken flasks so as to
make dishes, or to carry a cut spirally round a long
bottle so as to cut it into the form of a corkscrew ;
and
when so cut, glass exhibits considerable elasticity, and
the spiral may be elongated like a ringlet. The pro-
cess, as it has been said, is very simple. The iron rod
(a common poker answers very well) should be some-
what pointed), and the line along which the cut is to
be made should be marked by chalk, or by pasting a
thin strip of paper alongside of it ; then make a file
mark to commence the cut ; apply the hot iron, and a
crack will start, and this crack will follow the iron
wherever the operator chooses to lead it. In this way,
jars are easily made out of old bottles, and broken
vessels of different kinds may be cut up into new
forms. Flat glass may also be cut into the most intri-
cate and elegant forms.
Fusibility of Soft Solders.The fusibility of
soft solders is increased by adding bismuth to the
composition. An alloy of lead
4
parts, tin
4
parts, and
bismuth 1 part, is easily melted ; but this alloy may
itself be soldered with an alloy of lead 2 parts, of bis-
muth 2 parts, and tin 1 part. By adding mercury, a
still more fusible solder can be made. Equal parts of
lead, bismuth, and mercury, with 2 parts of tin, will
make a composition that melts at 122 F., or an alloy
of tin
5
parts, lead
3
parts, and bismuth
3
parts, will
melt in boiling water. In mixing these solders, melt
the least fusible metal first in an iron ladle, then add
the others in accordance with their fusibility. To cast
strips of solder, pour the molten metal on a flat surface
of stone or metal, drawing the ladle along the while, to
leave a thread of metal of the desired substance.
WA YS AND MEANS.
237
A Cheap Disinfectant.Copperas, which is
Very cheap, is an effective disinfectant, and it is doubt-
ful if any of the inventions for disinfecting or deodoriz-
ing sewage have any more virtue. It is, in fact, so cheap
that every householder can afford to use it in liberal
measure. A pound to the gallon of water will dis-
infect any service drain in a short space of time. It
should be used in water-closets and in the kitchen, as
well as in sinks, not only in the hot season, but at all
times of the year.
Old Vulcanized India-rubber.The following
process has been introduced in Berlin for the recovery
of old vulcanized india-rubber, such as the discarded
buffer rings of railway cars, etc. These are heated in
the presence of steam, the sulphur distils off, and the
rubber melts and flows into hot water, where it collects
at the bottom of the vessel, the steam preventing the
rubber from burning. The effect of this operation is
to considerably alter the properties of the rubber, it
becoming a tolerably fluid, dark mass, which remains
liquid at common temperatures, but drying on expo-
sure to the air, and is impervious to water. Its elas-
ticity is lost, and it is chiefly valuable for preparing
waterproof covering cloths for outdoor service ; also as
a lacquer for various articles of hardware manu-
facture.
Cement for Leather Belts.
For making
cement for leather belts take of common glue and
American isinglass equal parts, and place in a glue-
pot. Add water to cover the whole. Soak 10 hours.
Then bring the mixture to boiling heat, and add pure
tannin, till the whole becomes ropy, or like the white
of eggs. Apply warm. Buff oft the grain of the
leather where it is to be cemented ; rub the joint sur-
faces solidly together ; let it dry a few hours, and it is
ready for use. If properly put together, no rivets will
be needed, as the cement is as strong as the leather.
Sheet Zinc for Ceilings.Sheet zinc is being
largely used in Germany for ceilings, especially where
the beams for the upper floor are made of iron. The
use of wood is entirely dispensed with, and excellent
decorative effects are produced by stamping, painting,
and gilding or bronzing a portion of the ornaments.
Decoration of Steel and Iron.The Revue
Polytechnique has recently described a new method of
decorating iron and steel by means of copper precipi-
tates, the method used being as follows
; 35
parts of
copper sulphate, or any other copper salt, are dissolved
and treated with an alkaline base, which precipitates
an oxyhydrate. To this precipitate is added a solution
of 150 parts of Rochelle salts, and finally 1000 parts of
water are introduced. When this solution has clarified,
about 60 parts of caustic soda are added. The article
to be coated with copper, is first immersed in an alka-
line bath, and thoroughly cleansed with a stiff brush,
after which it is immersed in the copper solution.
Great care must be exercised in this operation to pre-
vent a too rapid deposition of the copper. When the
solution loses its strength, an additional quantity of
hydrate of copper should be added, . the amount of
which must not, in any case, exceed the figure given
above. By properly regulating the deposit of the
copper, highly artistic effects may be produced, and
different shades of colours obtained, such as red, green,
blue, violet, etc. Such parts as are required without
any copper deposit, are simply covered with a layer of
paraffine or varnish, which is readily removed after
having taken the body from the copper bath.
Preservation of Iron.In a paper on iron
roofs, recently read before the Society of Engineers,
Mr. A. T. Walmisley described methods to be adopted
for the preservation of iron surfaces. He observed
that all iron exposed to the action of the air is more or
less sensitive to corrosion. Oiling is a much better
protection against the effects of the weather or the
action of steam than painting, but care is needed to
properly clean off the black scale or oxide formed
upon the iron by contact with the air immediately
after leaving the rolls. In Holland great attention is
paid to those details, the specifications of Dutch engi-
neers minutely describing how the iron is to be treated
before the oil and paint are applied. After being pro-
perly cut, punched, or otherwise finished off in the
shops, each piece, before being fastened to any other
piece, is made quite free from rust and scales by im-
mersion in a bath of dilute muriatic acid, and kept
there as long as the inspecting engineer thinks proper.
It is then lifted out by means of iron hooks and
brushed with water, which removes all the black scale.
Immediately afterwards, it is immersed in a bath of
fresh lime water, and then placed in a bath of boiling
water, where it remains until it is about as hot as the
water. The water is renewed directly any traces of
acid are discovered in the water bath. After being
thus washed the iron is removed from the hot-water
bath and allowed to dry, but before becoming quite
dry, and while still warm, it is besmeared abundantly
with hot linseed oil, and it then receives the first coat
of paint. All rivet heads are similarly coated with hot
linseed oil, and painted over after the plates or other
pieces are riveted up. A second coat of paint is given
to the iron before it is placed in contact with other
pieces of different material, and thus all parts are
reached by the painter's brush, care being taken that
the pieces of iron so painted are perfectly dry and that
the weather is dry at the time the second coat is
applied. The paint used consists of lead or iron
minium, well mixed with boiled linseed oil. The iron
minium is cheaper, and is more largely used than the
lead minium.
2
3
8 AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
[The Editor reserves It himself ihe right or re-
fusing a reply to any question that may be frivolous
or inappropriate, or devoid of general interest.
Correspondents are reqtie&ted to hear in mind toat
their queries will be answered only in the pages of
ihe Magazine, the information sioght being sup-
plied for the benefit of its readers generally an well
as for those who nave a special interestin ob^-aining
it. In no case can any reply be sent by post.]
The Human Figure in Fretwork.
A Practical Man writes, In Part III.
of Amateur Work, Illustrated, I
noticed a comment upon fretwork pat-
terns, denouncing the introduction of
figures of men or animals, unless of
Japanese design. May I be permitted to
express my disagreement upon this point,
as I have designed a great many patterns
for different articles of use and ornament,
both small and large, and have more often
than not been requested (by those who
had never previously had any drawings
from me) to send something in which a
bird or animal is introduced. Undoubtedly
there is a great deal of rubbish in the mar-
ket, representing no regularity or decision
of curve, no particular flowerin fact,
nothing but a series of misshapen points
or bulbs, which, when cut out, are not fit
to be seen ; but where the aspiration has
been greater, and the introduction of an
animal ventured, it is difficult to distin-
guish a pig from a bear; perhaps those
chosen were of some antediluvian order,
at least we can imagine so. My opinion
is that if a graceful but decided curve,
imitative of nature be represented, and
outletting leaves and sprigs arranged to
suit or fill up the design, an appropriate
animal or bird may be introduced without
spoiling the general good effect. For
example, if boughs of oak be chosen, a
squirrel, and, if necessary, a bird or two,
would be very appropriate. Much fret-
work is spoiled by the hurried and com-
paratively disinterested manner in which
it is done, and again by want of talent.
Natural artistic talent is the only medium
for producing high-class workmanship,
and if a pattern of the best design be
incorrectly cut out the effect cannot be
anything but poor. Fretwork is, as styled
in Part V. of "Eveiy Man His Own
Mechanic," "A study of outlinesthe
diversification of a flat surface with per-
forations, but flat and without relief,"
therefore the beauty of nature cannot be
obtained half so well by this means as by
carving, but at the same time a silhouettic
appearance of animals and birds is better
than a monopoly of leaves and scrolls.
The human face and figure ought not to
be introduced unless in a comic sketch, as
there cannot be any real expression given.
I cannot understand why the introduction
of figures of men, etc, should be confined
to Japanese designs, as talent is not
confined to any particular nation, and
everyone is privileged to attempt that
which he thinks his ability is able to sur-
mount.
Boot and Shoe Making
J.
W. V. B. (Battersea) will find most
of the information that he requires in the
article on
"
Finishing Boots and Shoes,"
in Part V. of Amateur Work, Illus-
trated, and will need no further answer
to his first four questions. Question
5
is
"
How is a raised toe made which will
prevent pressure on the great toenail?"
The boots have to be made on thick toed
lasts, puff toes, as they are termed in the
trade. If the toes of the lasts are not
high enough pieces of leather may be
pegged on the wooden, or cemented upon
the iron, lasts, and pared neatly to the
shape required. Then a small
p
;
ece of
leather, carefully skived, may be put
between the toe of the upper, and the
lining, and las'ed in, this will keep the toe
up when the boot is in wear. Question
6 is, "What is the cause of boots
squeaking, and how can the noise be
prevented?" The creaking arises from the
grating of the inner surfaces of the sole
and inner sole, shank, etc. , together. It may
be prevented by placing a strip of cloth
between the surfaces while the boot is
being made. There is no need to apolo-
gise for asking a number of questions; we
are very pleased to receive them and to
give the information whenever possible.
A. W. {Dalston), and
J. J.
(New-
castle), both enquire whether there is any
way of making boots and shoes on the
pegging system without the worker occu-
pying a sitting position. The question of
retaining the upright position in hand-
sewing, pegging, finishing, and repairing,
has been much discussed in the trade,
and many attempts have been made to
devise apparatus for the assistance of the
worker, but nearly all have been either
costly or faulty, frequently both. Latterly,
however, John Keats, the Edison of the
shoe trade, has brought out a little
machine for the purpose, which promises
to enable the shoemaker to stand while at
work, and is at the same time inexpensive.
It would be impossible in this column to
describe his invention, it may, however,
be sufficient to say that it bears no slight
resemblance to the human arm, wrist, and
hand, and its base being affixed to a
bench, it is capable of firmly holding the
boot in any position. The writer wit-
nessed its working some weeks since, and
noted that its action was all that could be
desired. It may be obtained through the
last makers or leather sellers, and costs 18s.
Galvanic Batteries.
A. Reeves, asks whether or not the
new storage battery, invented by Mr. H.
Sutton, of Ballarat, would be more con-
s'ant and powerful than the Daniell bat-
tery, and supersede it in the work of
electro-plaMng. You mistake the func-
tions and uses of the storage battery. It
is not a generator of electricity per se, but
a reservoir of chemical energy capable of
development in the form of electricity.
The energy with which it is stored, must
first be put into it by the agency of elec-
tricity from another battery or from a
dynamo-electric machine. Of course, it
is at present premature to say what kind
of work may, or may not, be done by the
current from a discharging "Sutton Stor-
age Battery,'' but it will be well to ask
ourselvesWill it pay to make a Bunsen
battery to charge a Sutton battery and
use the discharging current in electro-
plating ? I think not, and therefore advise
you to retain the well-proved, constant,
and cheaper Daniell battery.
H. W. L. (Battersea). The copper
cylinder for a Daniell battery must not be
soldered, nor have a bottom to it, but
merely "sprung" together, or rather bent
until the two edges nearly meet. The
term "carbon clamp" does not mean
that the "clamp" is to be made ofcarbon,
it merely specifies a kind of brass binding
screw used, principally, as a clamp for
carbons. The carbon used for battery
plates is obtained from gas works, where
it forms on the retorts during the distilla-
tion of coal; you will not require it for the
Daniell battery. The same battery will
serve your purpose for electro-gilding,
but you will require a vat of special con-
struction, this will receive consideration
when the articles on Electro-Plating are
concluded. Many thanks for your kind
interest, and offers of assistance.
E. L. O. C. (Norwood) asks, whether
or not he can use a powerful two-cell Smee
battery for electro-plating. You will
please understand that power or force in
the general acceptation of the term, i.e.,
such electric force as would be required to
ring a bell or work an induction coil, is not
required for the work of electro-plating.
It is therefore quite possible that one ot
your Smee cells will prove powerful enough
to do all your electro-plating work. The
main feature to be observed is to provide
an amount of zinc surface in the battery
equal to, or slightly in excess of, the total
surface of goods to be plated at once in
the bath. If there is not enough zinc in
one cell, connect the two cells thusthe
two silver plates to one wire, the zincs to
the other wire. See that the silver plates
are nicely platinised, and the zincs well
amalgamated, and do not use a very strong
battery acid.
Summer House.
W. B. R. {Forest Gate). A paper on
building a summer-house is in preparation,
and will be given shortly.
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
239
Sand in Filter.
F. A. B. {Hammersmith). Any kind
of coarse sand will do, so long as it is
well boiled, to remove soluble matter. As
to the charcoal, see more explicit di-
rections in Article II. in this Part.
Solutions for Plating-.
J.
H. Sawden.In making the double
cyanide of silver plating solution by
dissolving oxide of silver in a solution of
cyanide of potassium, it is necessary to
add rather more than one-fifth of the latter
to form "free cyanide," after all the silver
oxide has been dissolved. Such a solution
will require more cyanide of potassium to
form free cyanide than one made by
dissolving the cyanide of silver in a
solution of cyanide of potassium. But
the appearance of the anode whilst
working the solution does not by itself
indicate the quantity of free cyanide in
the plating bath. The film mentioned
by you may be due to deficient battery
power, or to stagnation of the plating
liquid, or to the class of goods being
plated, for the anode will sometimes coat
itself with a film when pewter is being
plated, and also when the solution is
undisturbed. If the goods plate all right
do not add more cyanide, but keep the
goods or the anode in motion.
Anode.The two recipes sent by you
are very old ones, and only a slight ad-
vance on the processes of simple plating.
When solutions are made direct from
chloride of silver, they contain chloride of
potash, and some become worked out,
but those made from cyanide of silver
will give good results for many years
with proper care. Gold or silver solu-
tions, made up with ammoniates of those
metals are liable to be a source of danger
to amateurs, from the possibility of a little
of the ammoniite (fulminate) drying on
the filter, or any of the vessels. As
nitrate of silver and ter-chloride of gold
can now be purchased at reasonable
prices from all chemists, we cannot advise
amateurs to make those salts themselves.
Tne old practice of immersing strips of
zinc in contact with the articles in the
plating solution was a very wasteful one,
since it tended to exhaust the solution of
precious metal, and soon rendered it unfit
for working, when it had to be thrown
away and a new one made. In answer to
your queries: (r.) One pint would only
serve the purpose of very small articles,
such as pins, studs, lockets, or up to a
teaspoon. If you intend to enter the
t-ade, you should get a bell-glass as
shown on page 97, to hold from ij
to 2 gallons of solution. Methods for
ascertaining the quantity of metal put on
the articles will be given. (2.) Those
are trade marks not constant to all
houses. (7.) This will receive attention
in articles on electro-gilding. (4.)
Esti-
mate the zinc surface in the battery to be
slightly in excess of that of the total
surface to be plated at once in the vat.
(5).
Instructions in electro-gilding, and
also in nickel-plating, will be given, but it
is not possible to promise them at any
certain date. Whilst endeavouring to give
readers interested in electrical work some-
thing on the subject in each part, the wants
of others must also be supplied. Thanks
for your
"
hearty commendation."
Repairing Clocks.
J.
F. B. W. H.It is difficult to under-
stand what you mean by the "balance
"
of your clock. When technical terms are
used they should be selected with the
greatest caution by inexperienced people.
Had you described the part minutely no
doubt it could have been identified, but
your clock has no balance, and theiefore
it is quite useless to give you advice on
such things. The thin steel spring at the
top end of the pendulum rod is called the
"suspension spring." It is generally
made from a piece of watch mainspring,
but in American clocks the pendulum rod
is rolled to a thin ribbon at the end, and
this forms the suspension spring. If your
clock is an American you had best
procure a pendulum rod from any dealer
in watch and clock materials. If an
English clock use a piece of a broken
mainspring as nearly the size of the
old suspension spring as you can get it.
Any watchmaker's shop will furnish you
with a broken mainspring, probably for
the mere asking for it. Break off a piece
the length of the old suspension, soften
the extreme ends by heating them to
redness, and punch a hole in each to
receive the pins. The old suspension
spring is taken out by withdrawing the
pins, the new spring put in its place and
secured by the same pins, which are
reinstated. This is the way in which a
new suspension spring is put in. If you
have not the necessary tools a better plan
would be to take the old pendulum and
the top piece of the broken spring to a
working watchmaker who would put in
a new suspension spring for about six-
pence. The pendulum then has only to
be hung in its place, and the clock set
going. If you do not fully understand
these directions and wish for more, please
state distinctly the kind of clock you have
to repair.
Jhotograpby.
T.
J.
(Aberdare).(1.) A tinted back-
ground may be made by tightly stretching
over a wooden frame apiece of calico and
laying on a coat of size and afterwards an
even tint of colour mixed with size. Melt
(say) two-pennyworth of size in an iron
pail and add to it whiting and burnt
umber previously mixed in water to the
consistency ofthick paste. Mixthoroughly.
Lay this down with a large broad brush
so that an even surface is secured. The
most satisfactory background you can
have, however, is one of brown cloth, as
supplied by the stock dealers.
( 2. ) Pro-
bably oce of Ross' Universal Lenses
will meet your requirements. Send to
them and to Messrs. Dalmeyer for cata
logues.from which you may make selection.
Reversing Leading Screw in Screw-
Cutting Lathe.
J.
M. (Daisy Bank).The arrangement
for reversing the leading screw of a screw-
cutting lathe, which is briefly mentioned
in
p. 66, can only be fully explained b)
an illustration. This may be given at a
future time; your suggestion that it n.igl.t
be used for the return motion in cutting
odd pitches, would not be practicable.
The whole principle of the reversing
consists in bringing an extra wheel into
gear. By introducing a wheel which can
be added to the train or taken out of gear,
the last wheel may be made to travel in
either direction at pleasure. This extra
wheel is fitted on to a swing plate, it is
always in gear, that is, it always turns
when the train is in motion, but sometimes
it runs idle, and sometimes, when going in
the contrary direction, it forms part of the
train. With respect to the question on
cutting a sunflower in the lathe, the sub-
ject must be deferred till a suitable oppor-
tunity presents itself for dealing with it at
greater length. This, I hope, will not be
long delayed.
Instruction in Carpentry, etc.
Amatore (i) will find explanations of
technical expressions commonly used in
carpentry and joinery, the description and
uses of the various tools and appliances,
and the method of making mortises and
tenons, and grooving wood, in "Every
Man His Own Mechanic," by the Editor
of this Magazine, published by Messrs.
Ward, Lock, & Co.
(2. ) The arcs of
wood forming the cappings for the spindles
of galleries at the sides of the wall-cabinet
should be cut out of a solid piece of wood.
Wood may be bent to this form, but it
must first be steamed. The holes for the
reception of the spindles are not large
enough to weaken the wood ; the diameter
of the piece inserted should be less than
that of the thickest part of the spindle
itself.
(3. ) Instructions for making a car-
penter's bench will be found in "Every
Man His Own Mechanic."
Doll's House.
J.
H. (Blackpool). Your request for
instructions in building a doll's house has
not been forgotten. A paper will shortly
be given, showing how to do this in such
a manner as to present a handsome ex.
tenor and an interior that can be got at
with ease.
240 AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
Fret-sawing Machine.
G. W. B. Your interesting descrip-
tion of a machine for fret-sawing shall
find a place in Part VI. Kindly describe
the means you adopt for preventing fret
saws from running, as it may be useful to
many readers of this Magazine.
D.
J.
B. writes in reference to the
''Simple Fret-Sawing Machine" described
in Part I. "I do not agree with the
wooden spring that raises the saw after
being lowered by the treadle. I propose
the following method : Fasten a cord to
the top of the inner frame to pass over
the top of the outer frame (where a wheel
might be placed that it may work more
freely), and then down to the treadle. By
this means the saw would work with more
regularity. It is also much more simple,
as the spring is liable to be made too
powerful. With mine the inner frame is
raised by the treadle, and brought down
by its own weight, or by weights that may
be added." This suggestion deserves the
attention of amateurs who are making a
fret - sawing machine on the lines laid
down in the article alluded to above.
Embossing Glass.
F. V. H. (Buxted).Your essay in
embossing glass has failed apparently
through your having neglected to protect
the portions of the glass that were to be
left clear from the action of the fluoric
acid, or liquid for etching on glass. The
parts to be left clear must be protected by
Brunswick black, before the glass is sub-
jected to the action of the acid. If you
desire to give a frosted appearance to the
clear parts, rub them with a flat piece of
marble moistened with fine emery and
water. The only other methods of putting
patterns on glass are those followed by
glass-cutters and engravers on glass, and
this is done by the action of sand, and by
wheels of different kinds.
Newton's Grinding Rest.
R. A. L. should write to Messrs.
Churchill & Co., 28, Wilson Street,
Finsbury, about this American tool. I
know that this firm intends to keep it in
stock for the benefit of English amateurs,
but I do not know whether or not it is on
sale there yet.
G. C. (Leigh). Your letter has been
read witii much interest. Any informa-
tion you may require on any branch of
amateur work shall be supplied, if pos-
sible, and I shall be glad to have any
papers from you on subjects of general
interest.
Purchase of Tools.
O. D. C. (Newbury). I well know
from experience how difficult it is to pro-
cure exactly the kind of tool that one may
require in small country towns. You can
gain all the information you require with
respect to the sizes and prices of tools
in the catalogues sent out by Messrs.
Churchill & Co., and Messrs. R. Melhuish
& Sons, many of whose specialities are
mentioned from time to time in
"
Notes
on Novelties." The description of a
pneumatic air call-bell, and how to make
it, shall be given shortly.
G. W. (North Marston), and W. F.
(Wisbech), are informed that the cheap
Bow-saw (not Fret-saw) called "The
Holborn," can be procured at the price
named, of Messrs. R. Melhuish & Sons,
85 and 87, Fetter Lane, E. C who keep
them in stock.
House Building.
Nemo.There is no reason whatever
why you should not make your doors, and
sash frames, and sashes, before you begin
to build your house; but before beginning,
have complete working drawings of your
house made to scale in plan, elevation,
and section. The size of your doors and
windows will then be settled, and you can
then go to work on them. I shall be
happy to supply you with any information
you may require on the construction of
staircases, from a general point of view.
Interior Decoration.
Pharmaceutist asks advice respect-
ing the decoration of a chemist's shop.
It is difficult to prescribe in such a case as
this without seeing the patient, or in other
words, without knowing the extent of
surface to be covered, and the amount of
light that comes through the window,
whether strong or otherwise. If you paint
the pillars in shades of chocolate, or warm
and light red tints, let the wall be of a
light neutral tint or French grey, relieved
with a little chocolate or red stencilling.
Let the under partof the shelves be of the
same tint, and relieve the mahogany
cornice with gold beading. There is no
objection to the inscription on the maho-
gany cornice in gold with a little relief.
Do not have too many colours, but deal
rather with shades of one or two colours
in order to procure an agreeable variety.
Manipulation of Coloured Glass.
B. E. A. (Dei izes) .If you read the
article entitled
"
A New Style ot Stained
Glass Window" a second time, you will
see that the writer, like yourself, said that
it would not be possible for amateurs to
follow out the method proposed in the
American publication that was quoted, and
suggested an easier method of making
coloured windows in which they would
find no difficulty. Your suggestions with
regard to Electrotyping, etc., shall be
given in Part VI .
Exchanges.
G. C. (Liverpool) wishes to offer a
good Microscope in exchange for W. R.'s
portable Photographic Apparatus men-
tioned in Part II., page
93.
Will W. R.
write if he is willing to entertain the offer?
Making Liquid Glue.
W. O. P. (Swansea), in reference to
this subject says : "I have found the
following mode of preparation far simpler
'
than those given by you. Ordinary glue
is heated with just sufficient water to form
a viscid paste, which is then transferred
to a wide-mouthed bottle, and treated
with strong acetic acid until the solution
becomes sufficiently limpid to flow easily.
It is then ready for use, and it is only
necessary to bind the cemented pieces
with cord overnight to have a firm and
sound joint. I have in my possession a
gold pin to which I fastened a stone with
this glue seven years ago, and it is still as
firm as a rock, though only attached to
the plain surface, and not supported by
any setting whatever.'' W. O. P. is
thanked for his valuable communication.
Filtering Rain-Water.
M. P. R. The writer of the papers
on the Construction and Management of
Filters will attend to your request for
instructions on the mode of filtering rain-
water. It does not seem practicable,
however, to filter rain-water and render
it ready for use in its short and speedy
transit from the down-pipe to the cisttrn
or water-barrel, in which it is stored.
Cleaning Marble.
M. P. R. Marble may be cleaned by
adding quicklime to very strong soap lees
until the mixture is of the consistency of
new milk or thin cream. Smear the
marble thickly with this, and wipe it off
after a lapse of twenty-four hours ; after
which the marble should be rubbed with
a mixture of fine putty powder and olive
oil.
Boat Building.
Q J.
H. (Keswick) will have seen from
the first of a series of articles that appear-
ed in Part IV. that his wishes in this
direction have been anticipated.
Liquid Cement.
J.
M. (Portland) writes to say that
the liquid cement made from isinglass and
whiskey will not do to join leather that
will have to stand pressure.
Small Printing Press.
W. F. (Wisbech) is recommended to
apply to Mr. Squintani, whose advertise-
ment will be found on the wrapper of this
Magazine.
Second-hand Lathe.
W. H. R. wishes to purchase a good
second-hand Lathe, with
%\
inch or
4 inch
centre, on which he can spend about
7
10s. Can any amateur or maker offer
him one that is worth having for tlis
amount ?
Bookbinding.
W. C. (Alfreton). A series of articles
on Bookbinding will be commenced in an
early Part, perhaps in Part VI.
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL. 241
Sharpening Surgical Instruments.
H. D. G. ^Xorivich) writes : In answer
to E. P. C.'s question, I am in the habit of
using scalpels, knives, and razors for
microscopic sections and other fine work.
I sharpen them on a hone, a dark green
Welsh stone, with water, and finish on a
strop. A fair test of sharpness is to split
a hair, held on the thumb nail of the left
hand, for a short distance without tearing.
The instruments are always cleaned with
spirits of wine and stropped before they
are put away, should they become rusty
(from dissecting marine animals) or
gapped (from cutting sections of very hard
or gritty tissues), I then send them to be
ground.
R. B. W. gives the following informa-
tion on this subject for the benefit of
E. P. C. : The sharpening of surgical
instruments by that I mean the grinding,
polishing, etc., is a job such as few
amateurs would attempt. It requires a
very experienced workman to do them
properly. The principal difficulty is the
liability of the blade to become heated on
some of the many wheels, and so lose its
temper, and therefore becoming useless.
There is also very great manual dexterity
required to keep the proper outline of the
edge during grinding. Setting them on
an oil-stone may, however, be done, by
using a little care. Any stone with a very
fine cut may be used, many workmen use
a German hone (used also for razors),
others use a Grecian. Curved blades are
set on a half-round stone. The ordinary
test for sharpness is to try if it will raise
the skin on the side of the hand, by which
you can instantly tell whether the edge is
correct or not.
Repairing Bottle Jack.
T. C. B. Probably you are wrong in
supposing that a spiral spring is missing
from your bottle jack. These machines
are not usually so provided. See the
answer to T. Worth, and if you do not
get from it the information you seek write
again.
T. Worth.All the pieces of thread
in the bottle jack should be precisely equal
in length so that the weight suspended is
equally distributed amongst them. The
impetus of the turning joint causes it to
rotate for a considerable number of
turns after the mechanism has ceased to
act. These extra turns of the joint twist
the threads which again untwist when the
reverse motion is set up. A careful in-
spection ofyour jack would probably show
that the part which should revolve with
the joint is stopped by friction. The
threads alone should bear the weight
though the hook to which they are at-
tached may appear to an inexperienced
eye to have a bearing in the case of the
jack.
Making Musical Instruments.
J.
L. B. R. asks for instructions for
making a harp. I fear this is altogether
out of the province of amateur work.
C. S. W. (Sunderland).AX present
we are dealing with Organ-building and
Violin-making. Papers will shortly be
given on building a harmonium. It re-
mains to be seen how far it is practicable
to give instructions for making a piano
;
but if it can be done, it shall be done at
some future time.
H. W. C. (Glasgow) wishes for instruc-
tions on making a dulcimer. Can any of
my readers handle this subject ?
Organ-Building.
C.
J.
H. (Keswick) must be content to
wait until the second series of papers on
Organ-building is commenced.
W. C. (Al/reton).The entire cost of
materials required for building the small
organ shall, if possible, be given in
Part VI.
W. F.Your inquiry with regard to
the size of the organ described in the
papers on this subject has been practi-
cally answered in the articles themselves.
Papers on building a harmonium will be
commenced in Part VI. or VII.
F. C. N. (Sydenham Hill). You are
quite right as to the tables and bearers.
Organ- Grinder (Carn/orth) .
The
scale for widths and depths of the pipes
must be strictly adhered to, but if you
have only made one or two of the largest
pipes they will do. The length of the
block is not so material, provided it is
long enoughsay
4
inches for C C, and
3
inches for Tenor C. Brads or sprigs
may be used to secure the joints in the
larger pipes, but be very careful not to
split the wood. The cap should fit per-
fectly at the sides without requiring
leather, as you say was needed to make
yours air-tight.
G. B. (Helensburgh).The cause of
your trouble is bad wood or inferior
glue, perhaps both. I may say, once for
all, that every material used in organ
building must be the best of its kind. It
is worse than useless trying to make pipes,
etc.,' of unseasoned or inferior wood.
Grooving the pipes together is not neces-
sary. A few brads may be used in the
larger ones. The method given is the
one in general use, and answers well if
properly done.
C. A. H. (Camberwell).Harmonium
reeds will not keep in tune with organ-
pipes. What sharpens the reeds flattens
the pipes, and vice versa.
J.
P. L. (Tenby).Don't be disheart-
ened. The length of the blocks is not a
material point. If your pipes sound all
right, let them be ; if not, then cut the
throat a little larger with a chisel. You
must not expect to get the same fulness
of tone from a stopped pipe as you get
from an open one, the fact is they are not
half so loud. This is the reason the
treble must be made of small scale and
voiced very softly.
MusiCUS (Northampton). See replies
to others. The pipes would speak quite
readily as the grooving is very short.
Blowhard.You will find it very
expensive to buy all metal pipes for your
organ. It is not usual for the stopt
diapason to go below Tenor C in metal.
Write to some organ-builder for a price
list of pipes. You can arrange your pipes
chromatically in two rows as you propose,
but you will need a sound-board about
five feet long to do it. Just set it out full
size, on a board, after you have obtained
your pipes, and then you will see how
much room they will take.
P. O. (Corry). The best French or
Scotch glue should be used both for the
leather and the wood. Avoid cheap dark
glue. It should be light and clear, and
not .used too thick. Melt it in the
ordinary way in a glue-pot, and use it
fresh. Add more glue and water w
r
hen
you put it away, and it will .be ready for
use when required.
Asbestos in Laboratories, etc.
H. B. (Dorchester). You will doubt-
less obtain the information you require on
this subject by writing to Messrs. Witty
and Wyatt, 9,
Fenchurch Street, London,
E.C., agents for H. W.Johns' Asbestos
materials, manufactured in New York.
Construction of Facetisescope.
I. M. (Sligo). Facetiaescopes, with
all the necessary appliances, are sold at
is. each If you had the instruction in
making this toyit is nothing better that
you ask for, it would cost you much more
than the amount charged for it to make
it, and, in addition to this, there are cer-
tain appliances that you could not possibly
prepare unless you are a photographer,
amateur or professional.
Apiarian Appliances,
Scotus.Your wishes on this point
have been anticipated in some degree by
the description of a model hive in Part
III, Any information that may be
gathered from time to time on improve-
ments in these appliances shall be given, if
possible.
Preparation of Floor for Dancing.
H. G. K. (Belsize Square).
Rope
dancers chalk their shoes to keep them
from slipping, and by analogy it might
be desirable to chalk the floor of a room
in order to render it fit for dancing.
Forty or fifty years ago, ball-rooms in the
country were sometimes adorned in this
manner, a pattern being traced on the
floor in white, black, and coloured
chalks. Of course, it was soon damaged
by the feet and skirts of the dancers.
242 AMATEURS IN COUNCIL,
Straightening Warped Boards.
Willing to Help says that the best
way he has found of straightening a
warped board is to water the earthen
floor of an out-building, and then lay the
board on it, concave side downwards.
The damp fills the pores again, and
brings it perfectly straight. He has tried
this out-of-doors, but it will not answer,
owing, he believes, to the dew falling
on the upper side.
Floor Staining.
W. G. {Richmond) kindly corrects an
error in the article on this subject, in page
106. The text says, "The sizing takes
rather longer than the varnish to dry ;
"
it should read, "rather longer than the
staining to dry." He further says: "I
find it a good plan to size the work twice,
as it makes the vamish hold out so much
more."
Aquariums.
S. G.
(
Woodhouse).You will find the
date of issue on each Part of this Maga-
zine, instructions for makingan Aquarium
will be given in due course.
Information Wanted.
R. A. L. writes: "I have bought a
shooting-board similar to the one described
in 'Notes on Novelties,' in Part III.,
but I am at a loss how to use it for
bevelling four square
;
perhaps some one
who has used it will help me out of the
difficulty.
"
Snaresbrook wishes to know what
kind of glue is used by carriage makers to
fasten cloth to the frames of the windows.
C. de H. {Preston) wishes to meet with
a work which treats on working in tortoise
(turtle) shell. Can any of the readers of
this Magazine supply the information
asked for ?
P. I. B.
(
Hanley) has
"
taken transfers
on satin, and other materials, and they
look very nice until they are dry, when
they peel off." He wishes to be informed
of some method for preventing this.
A. Jack asks : Can any of the readers
of Amateur Work, Illustrated,
kindly oblige with a good idea how to
make and fix a secret spring on a clothes
box, so that it will not open without
touching the spring, although it has been
unlocked ? The touch-spring must not be
discernible from the outside, and as little
as possible on the inside.
T. B. B. wishes to have a recipe for a
paste for mounting tracings on cartridge-
paper and calico, and to be informed of
the best method of doing this.
D. K. (Liverpool) wishes to gather
from our readers some information re-
specting the way in which the American
Rogers' Fret Machine does its work. He
finds the oscillation very great, and ex-
periences much difficulty in turning the
saw in the work.
Mounts for Drawings.
Amateur.Instructions on cutting
mounts for drawings shall be given in due
course of time as opportunity offers. On
writing again at any time, kindly adopt a
more distinctive nom-de-plume than that
you have now taken. We are all
'
' ama-
teurs.
"
Wooden Tool Holder.
T. H. H. writes
:
The tool-holder
figured on page 21 of Amateur Work,
Illustrated, is so similar to one I have
in use, that I take the liberty of sending
you a rough sketch of it. The holder is
constructed entirely of oak, 1 inch by ij
inches, screwed firmly together, extreme
length 12 inches, length of opening,
3
inches. This I find a very convenient
y
w
WOODEN tool-holder.
size; but, of course, the amateur can
make it to suit his own requirements. It
answers admirably, and has saved me a
very great amount of labour.
Miscellaneous.
P. I. B. (Hanley).The author of the
papers on Photography is prevented by
serious illness from continuing his papers
at present, and answering your query
respecting varnish for photo-negatives.
H. C. E. K. {Gallon Krynell).See
"Notes on Novelties," Part IV., in which
mention is made of Stephens' stains, and
how to apply them to finishing fretwork.
A. A. (Bristol.)Information on the
manufacture of sparrow-nets, clap-nets,
and trammels, will not be out of place in
this magazine. A paper or two on the
subject shall be given in due time. Can
any reader supply them, with the neces-
sary diagrams?
A. Jack (Leitk). Papers on up-
holstery suitable for amateurs will be
given in the pages of this Magazine, but
the demands on our space are so great
that it is difficult to assign any certain
time at present for their appearance.
R. H.
(
Wandsworth).I fear it will
be difficult to give information on the
subject you mention, more elementary in
its character than that which is supplied
in
"
Every Man His Own Mechanic,"
but if you will mention any difficulty that
you meet with in any practical work, the
special instruction you are in need of
shall be supplied if possible.
E. W. W. (Leeds).If it be possible to
do so, an article shall be given shortly
on the method of making rubber stamps.
Your first query relating to the method of
cleaning a certain article of dress is one
which cannot be conveniently answered
in the pages of this Magazine.
C.
J.
D. (Hornsey).See the preceding
reply to E. W. W. on this subject.
Inceptor."
The Illustrated Archi-
tectural Engineering and Mechanical
Drawing Book," published at 2s. by
Messrs. Ward, Lock, & Co., will, I think,
be just the book you require. Papers on
the application of electricity to produce
motive power will be given in due course.
W. (Shepherd's Bush).When oppor-
tunity offers, instructions and suggestions
on building ferneries in gardens and
conservatories will be given.
Dew. Special papers on "Frame
Making," including Oxford frames, with
particulars respecting tools and ap-
pliances and cost of materials, will be
given, but when, it is not possible to say.
A. E. W. (Ogmore Vale). Papers on
"
Brazing and Soldering
"
will be given
in the present volume, and an endeavour
shall be made to supply information on
the other subjects you mention, as soon as
possible. The second series of papers on
"
Organ Building" will appear in Vol. II.
F. E. K. (Grosvenor Road). See the
preceding answer. The organ to be de-
scribed will be a larger and more powerful
instrument in every way.
C. A. S. (Dover).See reply to A. E.
W. just above for your query with re-
ference to
"
Brazing and Soldering."
The construction of a telephone may be
described in a future Part.
I. H. S. (Bridlington Quay).The
Auto-Pneumatic Fountain is expensive, it
is true, and beyond the reach of many.
To make a founlain, the reservoir, which
is the source of supply, must be consider-
ably higher than the mouth of the pipe
from which the jet issues. Instructions
for making aquariums will be given in
future numbers. All suggestions of this
nature are noted in order that the desired
information may be supplied when it is
possible to do so.
** Replies to and communications
from the following correspondents are
unavoidably held over to appear in Part
VI. Although the utmost has been done
in the present part to deal with as many
queries as possible, the pressure on our
space is so great that, in spite of an
addition offourpages to the present part,
it has been found impossible to satisfy all.
E. B. (Dublin), B. E. A. (Devizes),
G. W. B. (St. Malo), W. M. (Blackburn),
A Practical Tinplate Worker,
G. I. W. (Plymouth), A. N. (Uckfield),
and many others, for whose initials, etc.,
there is no room.
PRESENTED WITH PART VI. OF
:k w8bi
6
illbstba
1
v,tt
t>'
'
.**
^,
nnr
T
O
1
JJ
"1
Fio. Bi.DETAILS OF ETAQERE (* Fin. 8 at A B 0).
i. 6.MINIATURE BCBEEH FOB HEABTH.
Sail. 1 iuku V> /tot.
S
Fio. 10.FEAMEWOBK Of WOOD FOB
CHIMNEY BOABD, PANELLED FOE
RECEPTION OF PICTURES.
Fie. 9.DESIGN FOR OHIMNET BOABD.
\ivV-^- \
STv
mm
4JSBL
&
Fio. 8.ETAGBBE-TO STAND IN FRONT OF GRATE.
^-i^^cj^
fA FA
1.FAN SCREEN FOR GRATE
Fio. 6.SUPPORTS OF FAS I
LENGTHENED AND H.
8UPPOBT A CURTAIN.
vl^'A'Mli
LOCK. * CO.. WARWICK HOUBC. flAUBBURT
Fio. 4.OBOSfl
PLEOES FOB
SUPPOBT6
Fio. 7.-FLOWEB STAND TO FIT OPENING OF GRATE.
w......
SUGG
EST10NS F0R THE EMBELLISHMENT OF THE FIRE GRATE IN SUMMER, b, j, w. oLEcm-wmn.
Fio. 8.STANDARD FOR FAN.
hh
.
;%.
A SIMPLE SYSTEM OF FLOOR DECORATION.
243
A SIMPLE SYSTEM OF FLOOR DECORATION.
By MARK MALLETT.
T page 106 were given some useful hints
on staining and polishing floors. For
those who desire a uniform colour and
glossy surface, no better directions could
be desired. Under certain circumstances
as, for instance, when skins and rugs can be freely
scattered about ita floor so treated is admirable.
But there are other circumstances, under which some-
thing more could be wished, and when such a floor
will be foimd to lie open to two objections : firstly,
My first plan was simply to enlarge the strip all
round to a uniform width of 2 feet 6 inches. The
former work had been done by brushing-in hot boiled
oil, and afterwards polishing with beeswax and tur-
pentine. I did mine in the same manner.
To a certain extent, what I had done was satis-
factory. The dark edging made a good ground on
which to range my old oak furniture ; but the sharp
straight line dividing the dark from the light parts of
the floor was not pleasing. Something more was
needed to satisfy the eye.
Within the dark edging, I now marked out the
ornamental border, 14 inches wide, shown in Fig. 1.
But to make this dark enough, and durable enough to
FIG. I. FIG. 2.
TWO DESIGNS FOR SIMPLE BORDERS IN THE STYLE OF PARQUETRY FOR FLOOR DECORATION.
. forr
had
that it is too slippery to be walked on with comfort
;
and secondly, that the, uniform dark colour is not
sufficiently pleasing to the eye. My present object is
to show how, without destroying a firm foothold, an
effect somewhat akin to that of expensive parquetry
may be obtained by means of staining, at the cost of a
few hours' labour and a few pence.
The circumstances under which the idea ot this
mode of decoration forced itself upon me, so to speak,
were these : Some eight years since, I wished to con-
vert to my own particular uses a room in which a
former tenant had laid down a square of carpet, and
had polished the surrounding strip of bare floor. The
for was oak, and I had no intention of hiding it by a
sScond carpet ; but the polished strip, wider on two
sides than on the others, was most unsightly.
resist the scrubbing-brush and soap which it would
have to bear, in common with the unpolished middle
of the room, I knew that something more would be
needed than mere oil and polish. I remembered that
iron, acting on the tannin contained in oak, will turn
that material to a dark colour, which wears away only
with the grain of the wood. A handful of rusty nails,
left for a few days in a pint of vinegar, gave me the
required solution of iron. With this, and a small
brush, I went over the pattern, and could thus get as
deep a shade as I desired. My one difficulty in
applying it arose from the fluid having a tendency to
"
run
"
in the direction of the grain, and thus to cause
a blurred edge ; but this I soon overcame by keeping
a piece of blotting-paper beside me, with which to
take off any superfluous mois'. ..re. When the stain
244
AMATEUR BOOKBINDING.
had had time to dry, I finished by going over the
pattern with varnish.
The effect of this border, simply as leading the
eye gradually from the dark to the light parts of the
floor, was very good. More than this, it added in a
striking manner to the general effect of the room.
After the wear of eight years, it still looks as well as
ever.
The floor thus treated was, as I have said, made
of oak ; floors formed of other woods will require
somewhat different treatment. Rarely in town, but
not unfrequently in the country, we find elm floors.
The grain of elm is often of great beauty, if properly
brought out. I find that a strong decoction of log-
wood, applied hot, will do this, if the wood is after-
wards rubbed with boiled oil, and finally polished or
varnished. For colouring the pattern on elm, as this
needs to be darker than the broad edging, a very little
of the iron solution may be mixed with the logwood
stain. Much must not be added, or a jet black will
be the result.
In far the greater number of modern houses, how-
ever, the floors are of deal ; and for this material the
amateur cannot do better than buy some one of the
prepared wood-stains sold by the colourman. He can
get whatever depth of shade he requires, but he will
do well to remember that it is advisable to keep the
ornamental border somewhat darker than the broad
stained surface outside it.
For general directions as to applying stains, and
also as to finishing stained work, the article above
referred to (see p. 106) may be read with advantage.
It will be well to bear in mind that between the pro-
cesses of staining, oiling, and polishing, sufficient time
for drying must be allowed, and that oil takes much
longer to dry than stain. Varnish will not lie evenly,
or set properly over imperfectly dried oil. My advice
is, however, not to varnish on those woods which
require oiling, viz., oak and elm, but to polish them
with beeswax and turpentine. This remark does not
apply to the ornamental border on these woods ; this
must always be varnished, and not oiled.
No absolute rule for the width of the stained
edging with its ornamental border can be laid down.
It must be more or less as the room is larger or
smaller, and to some extent it must be influenced by
the width of the boards ; for, as shown in the illustra-
tions, it will be well as far as possible to accommodate
the decoration to the lines of the floor. A good
medium width is 2 ft.
3 in. for the dark edging, and
1 ft. 2 in. for the ornamental border. It is well to have
the stained part wide enough to receive such articles
of furniture as are usually ranged round the walls, and
not so wide as to make those parts of the room slip-
per)' on which people require to walk much.
In the illustration, two designs for this work are
given. Both are very simple, and by no means impos-
ing on paper. But it must be remembered that with
the materials before us, intricate patterns would not
be practicable, and, moreover, that the floor is not the
place for elaborate ornament. As a part of the room
on which the eye frequently rests without effort, the
floor ought not to be left undecorated by those who
study good taste, but to tread excessive and delicate
ornament under foot does not suit our sense of the
fitness of things. These designs are such as can easily
be set out with the compasses and straight- edge, and
no great artistic skill will be required to invent others
equally applicable.
In conclusion, I may observe that as this kind of
floor decoration extends but little to those parts of the
room where the traffic is greatest, it is not so liable to
grow shabby from wearing away in places as the stain-
ing which extends over the whole apartment. If,
however, the work should become a little dulled here
and there, it may be freshened-up by rubbing over
with a little linseed oil ; or, if necessary, it may be
re-varnished or re-polished, as the case may be. At
a doorway, or a much-frequented window, it will of
course be well to protect the work with, say, a piece
of harmoniously-coloured Indian matting, or some
similar covering.
AMATEUR BOOKBINDING.
By the Author of "Art of Bookbinding."
I.The History of the Art.
OOKBINDING is the art of connecting
together in a durable form and conve-
nient manner the several parts of a book.
If one thinks for a moment, the word
"bookbinding" has great depth of mean-
ing. It is older than that of printing. It carries us
back into past centuries, long, long before Christ,
when booksif I may so call themwere only pieces
of baked clay, with cuneiform characters, and the
bindings or coverings of the same substance, enclosed
in yet another, each covering having the same sym-
bols, so that if the one got broken, there was still
another to protect the enclosed book. A specimen of
such a so-called binding may be seen in the Assyrian
Collection at the British Museum. Leaden tablets,
with inscribed hieroglyphics, were fastened together
with ringsthe tablets answering for the books, the
rings for the bindings.
A glance at the continuous roll epoch. We find
these mostly among the Greeks and Romans, after
AMATEUR BOOKBINDING. 245
the Christian era, who gained their knowledge from
the Egyptians. Such a roll (Egyptian) is now in the
British Museum : it was discovered at Memphis, and
is said to be some two thousand years old. I believe
the first mention of glue in regard to bookbinding is
in the Greek tradition that the Athenians erected a
statue to a certain Phillatius, who invented a particu-
lar kind of glue for fastening the leaves of papyrus
together. We have every reason to believe that the
first paper for the purpose of writing upon is the
papyrus of the Egyptians. The stems of the P. anti-
quontm, which are often 8 to 10 feet long, are soft and
green, externally like the common rush
;
the interior
consisting of a compact cellular tissue or pith. At
the bottom of each stem the portion immersed in the
FIG. I. BIBLE CHAINED TO LECTERN.
mud and water is whiter and more compact, and
under the outer skin a number of thin pellicles lie one
above the other. These were removed, and laid side-
by-side, with their edges overlapping each other, and
crossways upon these was placed one or more similar
layers, until the sheet was sufficiently thick
;
pressure
was then applied for a time, and afterwards the sheets
were dried in the sun. The width of such sheets, of
course, depended upon the length of the portion of
papyrus, but they could be made any length by joining
a number of the material. The scapus, or roll, usu-
ally consisted of about twenty of them.
Some very interesting papyri are those found in
Pompeii and Herculaneum, showing the condition
and arrangement of a Roman library. They are from
8 to I2f inches wide, rolled up in a cylindrical roll
upon a stick, or inner roll, having a stud at the end.
They had their titles written on a strip, in red letters.
Books prized for their rarity, sacred character, or
costliness, would be kept in a round box or case, so
that the appearance of a library or bookseller's shop
seemed to be a collection of canisters.
About the twelfth century books were no longer
used as rolls, but cut into square pages, thus making
a back, and covering the whole as a protection, in a
most simple form ; the only object being to keep the
several leaves in connected sequence. I believe the
most ancient form of books, formed of separate leaves,
will be found in the sacred books of Ceylon, which
were formed of palm-leaves, written on with a metal
style, and the binding was merely a silken string, tied
through one end so loosely as to admit of each leaf
being laid down flat when turned over. When the
mode of preserving MSS. on animal membrane or
vellum, in separate leaves, came into use, the binding
was at first only a simple piece of leather, wrapped
round the book, and tied with a thong. These books
were not kept on their edges, but were laid down flat
.
on the shelves, and had small cedar tablets hanging
from them, upon which their titles were inscribed.
The next step one may notice is the parchment
books, bound, or rather fastened strongly at their
backs, with heavy wooden boards for the sides, and
simply a piece of leather up the back, leaving the
boards exposed, and, for a further protection, or rather
prevention of the leather coming away, nailed on the
board at the edge.
Parchment, one of the oldest inventions of writing
material, was known at least as early as 500 years
B.C. The manufactory rose to a great importance
in Rome about a century B.C., and soon became the
chief material for writing on ; its use spread all over
Europe, and retained its pre-eminence until the in-
vention of paper from rags. The earliest date I can
find mentioned of paper made artificially is from a
manuscript on cotton paper, written during the ninth
century. A manuscript on cotton paper, bearing the
date 1050, is in the National Library in Paris ; and
another in the Emperor's Library in Vienna, date
1095.
The
"
Byzantine coatings
"
first placed bookbind-
ing as an art, in the sixth century (Figs.
2, 3, 4, 5).
They are of metal, gold, silver, or copper gilt, and
sometimes enriched with precious stones. We find,
however, that the binder could not claim his work as
art work, for he only had the fastening of the leaves
and the adjusting of the wooden boards as his portion
of the work, the goldsmith being called upon to beautify
the external ornamentation, as the artist was to adorn
the interior. These valuable bindings had necessarily
a second coat, to protect the first from injury, it being
either of soft leather, silk, or other material : these
246 AMATEUR BOOKBINDING.
were made by the bookbinder after the goldsmith had
finished his work. The monks, during this century,
took advantage of the immense thickness of the
wooden boards, and frequently hollowed them out to
secrete their relics in the cavities. Bookbinding was
then confined entirely to the
monks, who were the literati
of the period. Then the art
was neglected for some cen-
turies, owing to the plunder and
pillage that overran Europe, and
books were destroyed to get at
the jewels that were supposed
to be hidden, and were hidden,
in many cases, in the different
parts of the covering, so that
few now remain to show how
bookbinding was then accom-
plished, and to what extent.
The Middle Age now asks
our attention for a moment. It
is scarcely possible for us to
form a correct idea of the value
put upon books, even of the
common order, or of the pro-
digious care which was taken of
them during this epoch. Books
were frequently chained to the reading-desk or shelves
(Fig. 1), to preserve them from embezzlement. Such
a chained book may be seen at the present moment,
I believe, in the church at Minster, Kent.
We also find that samples of binding, brought from
the East by the Crusaders, were of the finest finish
;
and the monks, who still held the art of bookbinding
in their hands, improved by these Eastern specimens.
Each one devoted himself to a different branch : one
planed and cut the oaken boards to a proper size
;
another stretched, prepared, and coloured the leather,
dividing the work into branches, as it is now. When
we think how rude the implements then in use were,
FIG. IO. EXAMPLES OF ROGER PAYNE'S DESIGNS
We next notice that the art of printing gave new
life to our trade. As books increased, so bookbinding
had more attention paid to it. The printer, who was
generally the binder, had to discard the binding to
give more time to the printing. So bookbinding
became a separate branch.
We notice, too, that about
this time the oaken boards
diminishing, and millboards in-
troduced in their stead. These
millboards, or, more properly
speaking, pasteboards, were
made by the binder, who pasted
sheet upon sheet, until he had
the required thickness. We have
every reason to regret that this
was ever done, as a great many
books, after they had served
their purpose, were destroyed
to use the paper for the purpose
of making such boards.
The art improved so much,
that in the sixteenth century
some of the finest samples of
bookbinding were executed.
The most delicate tools were
used, the art encouraged by
noble families, who directed the binder in any
special manner. The names of Maioli and Grolier
may be mentioned as instances. The former used
bold designs, which the latter improved upon. His
designs consisted of bold gold lines, arranged
geometrically with great accuracy, crossing one
another, and intermixed with small leaves or sprays.
These were in outline, or filled up with closely-worked
lines. Not, however, satisfied with these traceries,
he embellished them still more by staining and
painting them black, green, and white, so that
they formed bands interlacing each other in a
most graceful manner. Figs. 7 and 8 are Grolier
FIG. 9. EXAMPLE OF BORDER IN BINDINGS IN HARLEIAN LIBRARY.
it is surprising how well the work was done, the task
being one of great difficulty.
The general bindings of the day, however, were
quite plain ; with, perhaps, some heavy design (Fig.
6)
on the sides, stamped on the leather, generally in
keeping with the contents of the book, and in many
instances using the blocks that embellished the text.
blocks : it will be seen how these lines entwine
and how the small tools are shaded with lines. Book-
binding has never had, not even at the present day,
better samples of work done as during the sixteenth
century : it is true we are more accurate in our finish-
ing, by reason that we correct our designs on paper
first, and then work through the paper on to the
AMATEUR BOOKBINDING.
247
leather ; but there is every reason to believe that, in
the sixteenth century, the work was done entirely free
hand, if I may so call it ; a line being worked or
marked down ^ .
.
, ,
the board, and
the whole of the
tools worked
from the line or
guide, judging
the distance and
exact spot to be
worked by the
aid of the eye.
All books, it must be understood,
were not bound in so costly a manner,
for we find pigskin, vellum, calf, and
embroidery in use. Calf was especially
preferred, on account of its peculiar
FIGS. 2, 3.EXAMPLES OF ORNAMENTS IN ANCIENT MONASTIC BINDING.
was very fond of such worked covers, frequently
working them herself. Such a worked covered book
by her is now to be seen in the Bodleian Library.
, The seven-
teenth century
gave us some
very good men,
who executed
some very fine
samples of bind-
ing. The names
of Du Sveil
(1673) and Le
Gascon (1620)
are known for the delicacy and extreme
minuteness of finishing. Taking new
ideas from the Italian school, their work
more resembled fine lace-work of intricate
design, with harmonizing flowers and
FIG. 7. ORNAMENT USED BY GROLIER.
softness, smooth surface, and great apti-
tude for receiving impressions from all
kinds of tools. I might call the amateur's
attention to embroidery, and, if he so
chooses, bind any special book, and cover
it with a worked fig. 6.
is the
usual one. A casual glance by one unused to such
matters would probably fail to see any similarity in the
edges of the two tools named, simply because one of
them cuts at the end and the other at the sides
;
yet
for all that, the cutting edges are precisely alike, and to
be effectual, must be similarly presented to the work.
The turning required, if on the outside of the piece
of metal, is for the most part face work, i.e., the tool is so
held as to attack the face or end of the piece, and not
the cylindrical surface, which is the chief difference
between turning wood and metal. A shallow shoulder
is formed by the first touch of the tool, which shoulder is
cut gradually away as the graver is carried towards the
left hand. Figs. 1 and 2 illustrate this, as effected by
the graver and triangular tool respectively. The proper
work of the latter is to face up flat surfaces, or to
hollow out work, and the graver is the orthodox and
best tool for work outside a cylinder. Nothing sur-
prises a novice more than the slight exertion necessary
to keep a graver or triangular tool in cut if it is once
held exactly as it ought to be. Accustomed to con-
sider metal, especially iron or steel, as an intractable
substance to deal with, it is a pleasant surprise to find
it so amenable to the action of a sharp tool, and that,
A FE W WORDS ON THE USE OFHAND-LURNING TOOLS FOR METAL. 251
in spite of its work, the latter retains its edge unim-
paired so long. But this arises solely from the fact
that, if held as it should be, a metal-turning tool has a
very strong edge well supported ; but if held badly, so
as to scrape, this edge has no support, and is soon
ground down or broken off.
As the action of the tool is to cut the face of the
little shoulder which it forms, it is evident that only
the extreme point of the graver touches the cylinder,
which remains as the new surface, and that this will
not, therefore, be left smooth, but covered from end to
end with minute grooves, each representing a section
of the shaving which has been removed. The graver
has then to be used more in chisel fashion, the full
breadth of its edge being now in contact with the
high enough to bring the tool, if held horizontally, a
little above the level of centres, so that the handle is
the highest part when the edge is brought down to its
proper position. One angle of the tool will rest upon
and take a firm bearing upon the T, slightly indenting
it, and as this becomes the fulcrum, and the hand is
grasping the long end of the lever, the strain produced
by the cut will not be much felt, The graver is not
slid along the rest, like a gouge or chisel, but made to
turn on the rest as on a pivot, taking a semicircular
sweep, or nearly so ; and when it is out of cut, it is
advanced to a new position, and this movement
repeated till the whole has been gone over, and a
tolerably level surface obtained.
Suppose the tool nicely ground, all depends on the
EXAMPLES OF THE USE OF HAND-TURNING TOOLS FOR METALS.
cylinder, so as to remove the ridges, and bring the
work to something like a finished surface. The final
touch is, however, generally given with a file, applied
while the work revolves. Such is the general action
of the two tools mentioned. Now let us examine the
difficulties which an unpractised hand will probably
meet with. These were thus spoken of by a friend of
the writer's, who proposed to do a little work of the
kind: "Oh, I must use a slide-rest; hand-tools slip
about so, they tire one to death, and never seem to
cut." Lay the graver on the T-rest, holding the handle
(which ought to be of fair size, and preferably not of
hard wood) in the right hand, with a good grip.
Then, with the fingers of the left hand, grip the
pedestal of the rest and bring the thumb over the tool,
and it will be as firm as a rock, yet capable of the
motion necessary. The rest is generally placed
angle made by the face of the graver with the surface
to which it is applied. The proper way is to place its
sloping face flat against the end of the bar to be
turned, and then just ease it off so as not to rub when
the edge begins to cut. Thus held, it is in position to
take off a very thin shaving, which it will do easily
and cleanly. A few experiments made by varying the
angle at which the edge meets the work, will soon teach
the learner how to get the best effects, and how to
obtain at pleasure thick or thin shavings. One fact
he will soon learn to appreciate, namely, the advantage
of a small clearance angle
QUICK TOOLS.
ME TV USES FOR OLD TIN CANS.
277
* H
V +
Y
*
4-
FIG. IO. PUNCHES.
enough. Under these circumstances his only resource
is to make them for himself, which can easily be done.
Anything in the shape of steel, such as old darning
or knitting needles, will
furnish the material ; this
heated to a white heat in the
gas, hammered into the ne-
cessary shape, and tempered
either by 'plunging into oil,
or into a stick of sealing wax, makes a most useful
tool.
Punches of various sizes and patterns, as in Fig.
10, can also be made by the amateur : a small three-
cornered file, and a few French nails of different sizes
being all that is required. These punches are very
useful for making a pattern on the ground-work of
panels, etc., and tend to hide all inequalities of sur-
face,
, thereby giving a more finished appearance to
the work. A small hard brush is required for brush-
ing out small particles of wood from the carving. A
nail-brush is frequently used for this purpose, and
answers the purpose. Various other
tools will be found of great service, and
should be obtained. An ordinary small
marking and cutting gauge, a small
cabinet, or wood rasp, and a file, a pair
of medium-sized egg-shaped callipers,
a pair of spring dividers, and a small
wooden mallet, are among the most use-
ful. The mallet should be made of
either beech or box-wood, and should not be too
large. Fig. 1 1 will be found the most handy shape.
Mallets, in fact, are seldom used except in heavy
work, the palm of the hand acting as a substitute.
A wood-carver's screw (Fig. 12), is a most useful
contrivance for fixing the wood, intended to be carved,
securely to the bench. Holes just large enough to
admit the screw should be bored through the bench
at various places, for convenience of working. The
end of the screw A is inserted into the back of the
panel, or other work, and firmly screwed in. B is
passed through the hole in the bench, then by screw-
FIG, 12. WOOD CARVER S SCREW.
ing C until it rests close to the bench, the piece of
work is strongly and firmly fixed, and can easily be
shifted by simply loosening C. Another useful con-
trivance can easily be made by any carpenter, or by
the amateur himself. It consists of a piece of hard
woodbeech is the bestabout ii in. wide, 1 in.
thick, and
4
or
5
in. long, with a slot cut through the
centre to admit a piece of strong sharp steel, shaped
like a chisel, and a wedge to hold the cutter in its
place, as in Fig. 13.
This little instrument, called a
"
router," is especi-
ally useful for regulating the depth of the groundwork
of panels, etc. It can be made of various sizes, but
the most useful will be of the size mentioned above to
admit a steel cutter of | in. in width. In using the
"router" the groundwork of the panel is first cut out
to some extent by
\lb.
FIG. 13.
(A) ROUTER
;
(b) CUTTER.
a quick bent tool
;
the cutter is set to
the depth required,
and by working
sharply backwards
and forwards, a per-
fectly flat surface is obtained. The stones required
for sharpening carving-tools can be obtained at
almost any cutler's. Arkansas stones are generally
used, and may be had in slips, the edgesor
at least the top and bottom edges of whichrequire
to be ground, so as to fit the inside of the various
tools. The backs of the tools are sharpened on
the sides of the stones which soon get worn into
hollows to fit the sweeps of the quick tools. In gene-
ral a quick-cutting" stone is the best for large tools,
and a fine-grained slow-cutting stone puts on the best
edge for small tools. With small veiners and parting-
tools a piece of deal is cutacross the grainso as to
fit the inside of the tool to be sharpened, and emery-
powder and oil is then used to rub out the inside of
the tool. Other tools and contrivances, such as small
files of various sizes, scrapers of different shapes, etc.,
the amateur will soon learn to make for himself.
In the next article, I intend giving further instruc-
tions as to the proper method of sharpening the tools,
the best kinds of wood to be used for carving purposes,
and the various methods adopted in preparing the
wood and impressing or drawing on it the design to
be carved.
NEW USES FOR OLD TIN CANS.
By A. W. ROBERTS.
GIVE below the result of an extended
experience in the utilisation of old tin cans,
such as are used by the million by
packers of fruits and other articles.
These cans, after serving their original
purpose, are usually thrown into obscure corners,
battered and rusty, a nuisance to every one.
By the method given below these troublesome
2
7
8 NEW USES FOR OLD TIN CANS.
articles are made useful and even
ornamental, such articles as flower-
pots, hanging baskets, bird-houses,
etc., being made from them with
little trouble or expense.
The cans were prepared in the
following manner: Having procured
a large dishpan, as much asphalt was
melted in it as it would hold with
safety. Into the boiling asphalt
the cans were dipped ; as each can
was taken out it was rolled in dry
sand, to give it a natural ground
colour ;
without the sand the effect
of the black asphalt coating would
FIG. 6.HANGING FLOWER POT.
small piece of metal, it was bent
down so as to form a rest for the
birds when feeding their young,
or a porch or rain screen over the
entrance. All these little points
when carried out gave character,
variety of form, and complete-
ness. The different ways of fasten-
ing and suspending the bird-houses
are shown in Fig. I. I sometimes
fastened branches of creepers over
the bird-houses to screen them from
view as much as possible.
A glue-pot, a bailer, a fruit
gatherer, and a grater are shown
FIG. I.BIRD HOUSES MADE FROM OLD CANS.
FIG. 3.BAILER.
be sombre and out of keeping with
the colour of the surroundings. To
give some of these bird-houses a
still more picturesque effect, they
were rolled in the ordinary dry
packing moss used by florists, and
wood mosses; short dry twigs, small
cones, and burrs were also fas-
tened on the cans. In this way
very nice effects of colour were pro-
duced. It is a well known fact that
birds avoid brilliant or artificial
colours
; for this reason greens,
greys, browns, and neutral tints
are best for bird-houses. Where
cans had been opened so that the
top piece was still attached by a
FIG. 5.BREAD GRATER.
HANGING LOC.
respectively in Figs.
2, 3, 4,
and
5.
The glue-pot, Fig. 2, was made in
the following manner : Selecting
an empty two pound can, enough
tin was cut away to admit of an
empty one pound can. This inner
can, projected one inch above the
top of the two pound can and was
held in position byfour wooden pegs,
which were slightly tapering so as
to bind. Holes were made in the
shoulders of the cans, through
which wire handles were fastened.
Fig.
3
shows a liquid measure or
a water bailer. A hole is made in a
can two inches below the edge;
through this hole a handle is
NE IV USES FOR OLD TIN CANS.
279
inserted, which presses against the
opposite side, and is secured with
a nail or screw.
Fig.
4,
a fruit gatherer, was
made by attaching a circular piece
of board to the end of a long pole
and fastening to this a can. Inside
of the can there was a bag to receive
the fruit without bruising. The bag
was sewn inside of the can through
a circle of small perforations. The
rim of the tin was sharpened, so
that when pressed against the stem
of the fruit it would cut through it.
Fig.
5, a bread grater, is so
FIG. 8. PLANT STANDARD EMPTY.
FIG. 10.ROCKERY.
simple that it hardly needs describ-
ing. Out of a piece of one inch
board a holder was shaped on which
a perforated piece of tin was fasten-
ed. This piece of tin consists of a
side of a fruit-can flattened out.
Lines were then drawn diagonally
over it for guides when punching
in the holes. The tin was laid on
a piece of wood, in which a hole
had been made of the exact depth
required for the uniform projection
of the burred cutters of the grater.
The tin was then nailed to one side
of the holder and bent over in as
perfect a curve as possible to the
other side, when it was again
fastened.
A fruit-can is very easily con-
verted into a respectable looking
flower-pot. The can to be ope-
rated on is first dipped in hot
asphalt. A piece of well seasoned
white birch bark is cut out of the
same height as the can, and suffici-
ently long to reach round it. This
piece of bark is cut large enough
for the can to be dropped into it,
leaving considerable space between
the can and the bark. This space
is filled in with hot asphalt. For
ornamentation of the pots, burrs of
different kinds, small pine cones
FIG. 9.PLANT STANDARD FILLED.
FIG. II. ORNAMENTAL VASE.
and acorns are used. A hole
must always be made in the bot-
tom of the pots for the drainage
of surplus water.
Fig. 6 is a hanging pot, planted
with ferns. This was also covered
with white birch bark, fastened on
the straight sides of the can with
asphalt. Three wires, by which it
was suspended, were fastened to the
rim of the can. In using cans for
flower-pots or hanging-baskets care
should be taken to thoroughly coat
the insides and outsides with the
asphalt ; this secures the tin from
rusting.
Fig.
7,
a hanging log, was made
280 HINTS FOR BICYCLISTS IN TROUBLE.
by partially telescoping two cans together, after the
opened ends had been entirely removed. A section of
the side of each can was cut out, to leave an opening
for the reception of the soil and plants. The cans
were then heavily coated with asphalt, particularly
where the cans joined, so as to strengthen the joint.
Bark of chestnut or oak was used for covering the
cans.
Fig. 8 is a standard for plants and flowering bulbs.
Having secured an old centre-table, two cheese-boxes
of different sizes were placed one on top of the other,
the smaller one on top. Around the side of the lower
box fruit-can flower-pots were ranged, above these
ranged another circle of pots, which stood on the
top of the largest cheese-box and against the side
of the smaller one. On top of the smallest box more
pots are placed, so that but little of the cheese-boxes
could be seen. All the pots were ornamented with
burrs, cones, lichens, or barks. The spaces left between
the boxes were filled in with wood mosses. Around
the rim of the table was nailed hooping from a flour
barrel. The inner angle formed by the hooping and
the top of the table, was patched with putty. Over
the entire top of the table, the hooping, and the putty,
hot asphalt was applied with a brush. This rendered
the top of the table water-tight, so that when watering
the plants water could not run on to the floor. A hole
bored through the top of the table afforded an escape
for surplus water. The cheese-boxes were coated
inside and outside with asphalt, to prevent them from
warping. The open space between the first circle of
pots and the rim of the table was filled in with earth,
on top of which moss was built up to the first circle of
pots. The plants used were tradescantia, common
and variegated ivy, vincas, saxifrages, hyacinths,
stonecrop, ferns, and calla lily.
Fig. 9
shows the complete plant standard. In
hanging baskets, pots, and standards, where the
plants are planted closely together and in a compara-
tively small bulk of soil, they require frequent watering
and occasional applications of liquid manure. Our
fowls provide us with a very fair article of
"
domestic
guano," from which we make good liquid manure of
sufficient strength by mixing one shovelful to a barrel
of water. Still there is danger in a too generous use
of liquid manure ; if too strong or too frequently used
the tender roots of the plants are injured and the
leaves begin to fall.
Fig. 10 is a fern rockery for table or Wardian case.
For the rockwork the most picturesque of rocks in
form and colour were selected. The rocks were
fastened together with plaster of Paris, which was
mixed with dry colours, greys and browns predomin-
ating. As fast as the plaster was applied sand was
thrown on it. The effect of the colouring and sanding
of the plaster was to destroy its whity glaring look,
and to harmonize it with the general colours of the
rockwork. The cans used for the flower-pots were
first wrapped in wet paper, to increase them in size,
before applying the plaster against them when building
the rockwork. In a few hours the paper wrappings
had so dried that the pots were easily withdrawn, after
which the paper was removed and the pots put back
in their places.
Fig. 1 1 is a vase for dried grasses and autumn
leaves, which was constructed as follows : To the top
of a broken lamp-standard of glass was fastened a
fruit-can that had been previously dipped in asphalt.
The outside of the can was then carefully covered
with selected lichens and tufts of
"
sealing-wax moss.'
Shells and parts of pine cones were used for orna-
mentation.
HINTS FOR BICYCLISTS IN TROUBLE.
By T. H". FITTON, Hon. Sec. E.C.B.C.
EEING in your third part a query from a
bicyclist respecting cycles, I have
written the following brief remarks on
the easiest method of remedying common
accidents. These, I hope, will prove
useful to many readers of Amateur Work, Illus-
trated.
Bent Handle Bar.This is one of the most
common accidents which happens to a bicyclist, and
is also one of the most easily remedied. If the
handle bar is badly bent, turn the machine upside
down, so that it rests on the saddle and centre-pin
head, get something to fasten the straight end of the
handle bar firmly to the floor, then take hold of the
pedal, and standing with one foot on the bent end,
press it gradually down until it is straight.
Bent Crank.Another of the many troubles of a"
touring cyclist, who if he is in a lonely part of the
country and has a spill, finds on picking his machine
up that the crank has bent sufficiently to stop the
front wheel from going round, the best way to remedy
this is to lean the machine against a wall or post with
the bent crank inside, i.e., between the wall and the
wheel ; then turn the wheel until the crank is at the
highest point, and, standing on the pedal, push it
slowly down so that you do not bend the pedal pin
instead of the crank.
Buckled Wheel.This is what is known amongst
mechanics as a burst wheel. Most bicycle wheels
will, if properly managed, spring back when pulled
;
this, however, is beyond the power of one alone, and
is most easily accomplished by about four sitting on
the ground with the wheel laid flat between them,
WA YS AND MEANS. 281
and taking hold round the rim pulling steadily until
the wheel springs, when in most cases it may be
ridden many miles without any further bother.
Bent Backbone.Although cyclists sometimes have
the misfortune to come a cropper, which is so violent
as to bend the backbone until it overlaps the front
wheel, yet it is by no means so common an occurrence
as the accidents before mentioned ; however, it is as
well to know what to do in the worst cases as in the
more trivial ones. Sometimes a backbone is so far
bent as to make it practically impossible for anyone
but a skilled workman to bend it back to its proper
shape, but there are many instances when with a little
perseverance and a good deal of physical strength,
one may so straighten it that it can be ridden without
fear of further mischief.
To straighten one then, take the backbone out of
the head and put it (the head) under a heavy weight,
or if you have a companion get him to stand on it,
then put a stone or a block of wood under the place
where it is bent and press down slowly, because if you
jerk it you will most likely snap the backbone, which
would leave you in a worse plight than before.
WAYS AND MEANS.
[The Receipts brought together under this title are gathered
from various sources. They are given here because they are each
and all apparently possessed of value, and likely to he useful to the
A mateur. It is manifestly impossihle for the Editor to test them,
or to have them tested, and he therefore disclaims all responsibility
for their accuracy or otherwise. Amateurs -who may try them are
requested to communicate the results arrived at.]
Effect of Coloured Bottles on Liquids.
Delta,
Barnard Castle.
Salt in Diphtheria.In a paper read at the
Medical Society of Victoria, Australia, Dr. Day stated
that, having for many yeais regarded diphtheria, in its
early stage, as a purely local affection, characterized
by a marked tendency to take on putrefactive decom-
position, he has trusted most to the free and constant
application of antiseptics, and when their employment
has been adopted from the first, and been combined
with judicious alimentation, he has seldom seen blood-
poisoning ensue. In consequence of the great power
which salt possesses in preventing the putrefactive de-
composition of meat and other organic matter, Dr.
Day has often prescribed for diphtheritic patients living
far away from medical aid, the frequent use of a gargle
composed of a tablespoonful or more of salt dissolved
in a tumbler of water, giving children who cannot
gargle a teaspoonful or two to drink occasionally.
Adults to use the gargle as a prophylactic or preven-
tive, three or four times a day.
How to tell Good from Bad Gilding. It
may be ascertained whether gilding is genuine or not
by the fact, that, on the latter a weak solution of pro-
tochloride of copper produces a black precipitate,
which it does not on the former. In the case of gilt
paper, the simplest method consists in slowly burning
the paper in a bright flame that gives out no smoke
;
in the incinerated remains of good gilt paper there are
traces of the gold left behind, which are quite percep-
tible to the naked eye, in the shape of glittering spots,
while base metal on paper oxidizes in burning, and leaves
nothing but a lot of red spots behind. This method,
however, is scarcely accurate enough ; a very much
safer test is to be found in the use of mercury, either
in metallic shape or in solution of salts of mercury.
The former test is performed by putting a few drops
of pure quicksilver on the gilt article, and either
rubbing it in or slightly heating it. If the gilding be
genuine, though ever so thin, the mercury combines it-
self with it, producing white spots on the surface. This
does not occur in the case of sham gilding, and in
rubbing mercury in no change of colour whatever can
be noticed. Another test consists in the application of
a watery solution of nitrate of mercury. In this case
the exact opposite takes places as in the former, for
genuine gilding remains intact, while a
"
duffer " at
once takes a white colour when brought in contact
with the precipitate of mercury.
To Prevent Wood from Shrinking.Care-
fully conducted experiments have shown that wood,
well saturated with oil, when put together, will not
shrink in the driest weather. Wheels have been
known to run for many years, even to wearing out the
tyres. Much money might be saved annually if this
practice was adopted. Boiled linseed oil is the best
for general use, although it is now known that
crude petroleum, on even old wheels, is of great
benefit.
Varnish for Imitating Gilding.A very
perfect imitation of gilding on brass and bronze
articles, it is said, may be made by means of a varnish
composed of 160 grains ofgum-lac, 40 grains of dragon's
blood, 10 grains of turmeric, and 3320 grains of alcohol.
The metal should be brushed with the varnish in all
directions, by means of a sponge, and then immediate-
ly warmed over a gentle charcoal fire. The surface at
first will appear dead, but will soon resemble the
finest gilding. The varnish should be kept in well
corked bottles.
NOTES ON NOVELTIES. 283
A Simple Paint Remover.The following re-
ceipt is very simple, cheap, and effective
: Take of
soft soap, one pound ;
common washing soda, two
pounds ; and water, three pints. Boil together for a
short time till approaching a thin jelly, and apply
either hot or cold with a brush to the article from
which the paint has to be removed. Allow it to
remain on a few minutes before peeling off.Delta,
Barnai d Castle.
Tests for Water.One of the readiest and sim-
plest tests for ascertaining if water is free from organic
pollution, is to cork up a small bottle nearly full of it,
in which a piece of lump-sugar has been put. If by
thus excluding the air, and letting it stand in the light
for two or three days, there is not a milky cloud seen,
but the water remains clear, it may be considered free
from the phosphates with which sewage-water is im-
pregnated. To ascertain if water contains iron, take a
glass of water and add to it a few drops of the infusion
of nutgalls, or suspend a nutgall in it by means of a
thread for twenty-four hours. If the iron be present,
the water will become of a dark brown or black colour.
Prussiate of potash is a still more delicate test for
detecting iron. If a crystal, or drop of it, when dis-
solved, be added to a glass of water containing iron,
it will immediately become of a blue colour. To ascer-
tain if water contains magnesia, take a quantity of the
water, and boil down to a twentieth part of its bulk,
then drop a few grains of carbonate of ammonia into
a small glass of water. No magnesia will yet be pre-
cipitated ; but on adding a small quantity of phos-
phate of soda, if any magnesia be present it will then
make its appearance and fall to the bottom of the
glass. In this experiment it is necessary that the car-
bonate of ammonia be in a neutral state.
Cement Floors.A good cement floor may be
made by mixing together, just like ordinary morta^
one bushel of cement, five bushels of clean sand, and
two bushels of fine gravel, broken bricks, or foundry
slag. Cover the floor with this preparation to a thick-
ness of from three to six inches ;
leave it a week or ten
days to harden, when it will be found that the floor is
as hard as a rock.
Stains on Glass.These may be removed by
laying on the stains with a stick a mixture of three
parts of American potash and one part of unslacked
lime. The mixture, which will remove either tar or
paint, should be allowed to remain on the glass for
some time before it is removed.
Dead Finish for Black Walnut.The most
soft and perfect dead finish is made as follows :
" Respect-
ing electrotyping I would suggest pre-
pared gutta percha as being the best for
taking the impressions of coins, etc. I
have taken many scores with it, and much
prefer it to either wax or plaster for the
following reasons : it can be readily dis-
solved in hot water, is very clean, does
not crack in cooling, becomes cold in
about ten minutes, so that the result can
be soon ascertained, is not liable to injury,
any number of impressions can be taken
from it, and air bubbles are easily expelled
from its surface. In taking an impression,
I cut a strip off a tin canister, about half
an inch wide, bend it round, securing it
with a piece of fine wire to prevent its
expanding, leaving a margin of a quarter
of an inch round the coin so that its edge
may be moulded at the same time, the
coin having been laid on a piece of thick
glass surrounded by the circle of tin. I
then take a piece of softened gutla percha,
roll it into a ball with the palms of my
hands, and press it on to the coin, putting
extra pressure on it by squeezing it in a
vice or by putting a weight on it. I never
solder the obverse and reverse together,
but leave the two halves quite separate so
that they may be both shown in the cabi
net at the same time, otherwise they would
have to be handled when one wanted to
examine them, and the whole arrangement
disturbed. I think the advantage of the
former will at once recommend itself to
all collectors. Impressions of leaves, lace,
etc., etc., may be taken with the gutta
percha, as it is capable of retaining the
faintest lines. In making my battery I
impregnate the zinc with mercury when
the former is in a molten state and just
as it is being run into a bar, one ounce of
mercury to a pound of zinc being suffi-
cient to prevent all local action, and pre-
vent it from requiring all further amalga-
mation, thus saving an infinite amount of
unpleasant trouble and time.
"
Silvering Glass.
F. G. P. (Norwich).Aseries of articles
on Painting on China will be commenced
shortly. Looking-glasses are silvered
with an amalgam of mercury and tinfoil,
but the process is a difficult one and
beyond the powers of an amateur.
Working Drawings of Lathe.
G.
J.
C. (Rochdale).It it be found
possible eventually to give full-sized work-
ing drawings of lathes and other machines,
it will be done, but drawings of this kind
require far more careful treatment than
the class of patterns you mention.
Practical Model Engineering.
I. W. (Nuneaton).This subject will
be treated as fully as possible when op-
portunity offers, but just at present it is
not possible to comply with your request.
Electrotyping on a Large Scale.
A. N. (Uckfield) wishes to meet with
some one who can help him over a diffi-
culty which he explains as follows : Some
of your expressions in the introduction to
Amateur Work, Illustrated, lead me
to think that you may be able and willing to
assist me in a matter about which I am in
some difficulty. I have some rather large
(3
feet by r foot 6 inches) models which I wish
to reproduce in electrotype, and find
much difficulty in getting them done on
anything like reasonable terms in London,
and have therefore been thinking of doing
the electrotyping here, but I require the
assistance of a thoroughly experienced
electrotyper. It occurred to me that you
may perhaps know of some one who
would be competent and would undertake
the job. He should be able to advise as
to the kind of battery to be procured, and
thoroughly understand the making of
moulds; all vats for depositing and the
like I can have made here. I trust you
will excuse me for asking you to take this
trouble, but it may be the means of
putting some pounds into the pocket of
some ingenious and deserving artisan. It
may perhaps interest some of your readers
to know that the Romans in the time of
the Empire, used a method of forming
pictures in glass, identical in principle
with that suggested at page
54,
of
Amateur Work, Illustrated, but
with the difference that they employed
not transparent but opaque coloured glass.
This was broken into small fragments
which were arranged so as to form the
required design, and a mass of hot glass
pressed upon them which held them firmly
together, as by this process the bits were
softened and in some degree blended, the
result was to produce a picture less hard
in effect than a mosaic and more resemb-
ling a painting.
Simple Silvering.
R.
J.
C. (Plymouth) will find the
following recipes taken from Gore's
Electro Deposition useful to him : r. Take
equal parts of chloride of silver, and
bitartrate of potash. 2. Take chloride of
silver 1 part, alum 2 parts, common salt
8 parts, tatar 8 parts. 3. Take chloride
of silver 1 part, prepared chalk 1 part,
common salt i parts, and pearlash
3
parts. 4.
"
A Novargent
"
solution for
resilvering old plated goods : hyposul-
phite of soda 100 parts, chloride or any
other salt of silver
15
parts. The solutions
in the proportions named, are used by
adding a small quantity of water, suffi-
cient to form the ingredients into a pasty
liquid of the consistency of cream, stirring
the articles thoroughly about in it or rub-
bing them over with it until they have
acquired the desired degree of white-
ness.
290 AMATEURS IK COUNCIL.
Turnery.
H.
J.
{London).The cost of lathes
varies very much, the machines may be
bought at all prices from a few shillings
up to several hundreds of pounds. Any
of the lathes that have been illustrated
maybe purchased from the manufacturers
whose names are given, and who would
furnish prices and any other further par-
ticulars. The price of Fig. 1 on page
4
is given on page 5, as reference will show.
The handbook mentioned in the reply to
"J.
D." contains illustrations, descrip-
tions and prices of about two dozen foot
lathes. If you contemplate purchasing a
lathe you would do well to invest a
shilling and learn the peculiarities of
various machines.
E. H. A. (Sporle).A very useful fret
saw suited for use on a lathe, is made by
the Britannia Company, Colchester. Full
instructions for making a division plate are
given in
"
Lathe-Work." These hints may
help you to get the information you seek.
Lathe.A wooden fly wheel is not
suited for a lathe. A cast-iron wheel
would suit your purpose much better, and
a plain one would cost about 4s. That is
for the castings which need not be turned
true. If you determine to make a wooden
wheel it will require to be weighted with
metal, lead is very suitable, near the
periphery.
J.
D. Llanelly. Any suggestions
will be
appreciated by the writer of the
articles. The paragraph on page 64
refers to the lathe (Fig. 6) on page 65.
This is
particularly a good machine for
the work usually done by amateur en-
gineers. To letter every part of an illus-
tration would involve much more than
you appear to surmise. The plan has
been adopted in many instances, especi-
ally in the sectional views of clocks. A
shilling
handbook on
" Metal Turning,"
written by the author of the articles on
"
Lathe-making for Amateurs," and pub-
lished by Messrs. Lockwood & Co.,
Stationers' Hall Court, London, contains
much information that would interest you,
including
illustrations of 10 or 1 2 slide-rests.
Injector Gas Furnace.
The instructions for the use of this
furnace are given in full in the lists of
the maker T. Fletcher, Museum Street,
Warrington. It is, of course, impossible
to melt iron or brass in a ladle, and
practically nothing but a plumbago
crucible can be used, as the heat is so
rapid and intense that except with the
greatest care a clay crucible flies to bits
in a few seconds if thick enough to carry
a full charge of melted metal. Thin clay
crucibles may be used for any purpose
except carrying heavy weights of metal,
and if sufficiently thin will stand sudden
heat. A wrought-iron ladle or crucible
would most probably melt before its con-
tents could be poured.
Photographic Transparencies.
B. E. A. {Devizes) writes :
" I send
you a method of making photographic
transparencies. Prepare a plate with
collodion in the usual way, sensitise it,
and whilst wet place the film side against
that of a negative, and expose for about ten
seconds to the rays of a candle, develope
slightly and fix ; this can be done during
the dark winter evenings, and be the
means of affording a fund of amusement
and profit. I may mention that the
unevenness of the surfaces prevent their
sticking together, and that the result will
not be quite so good as when taken in the
camera, still, good enough for ordinary
purposes, especially for magic-lantern
slides, and such like. If agreeable to
yourself I shall be pleased to send you
occasionally some well-tried recipes for
different things, which I think many of
your readers will find useful.
''
B. E. A.
is thanked for his contribution ; his offer
of more recipes, etc., is gladly accepted.
Gas-Heating Apparatus.
Your correspondents A. B. and A. S. S.
ask for complete instructions for the manu-
facture of gas-heating apparatus. To
give these in full, as desired, would take
a special book. If whole numbers of
Amateur Work, Illustrated, could
be devoted to this one question, there
would be no difficulty, but still, with a
large proportion of the things, the cost of
patterns and speeal apparatus required
for manufacture would be so great that
no amateur would attempt the manufac-
ture. Further than this, several of the
things described are patented, and could
not be made for this reason. So far as
the others are concerned, they can be
seen in thousands of places, and those who
have the wits and do not mind expense,
could easily see and copy them. If an
amateur were to attempt to make a glass
bottle which he would buy for a shilling,
he would find his tools which were neces-
sary, would probably cost 20 or
^30,
and he would perhaps spoil a hundred
before he made one fit to use. The same
remarks apply more or less to gas- heating
apparatus which, with a few exceptions,
can only be made with special tools and
appliances, which would be not only
expensive but would be useless for any-
thing else.
Cheap lathes Wanted.
W. H. R. is requested to send his name
and address, as offers have been received
from two or three correspondents to sup-
ply him with the article he requires.
W. F. (Wisbeack). A communication
from I. H. M. {Sheffield) has been
received for W. F. , who is desired to
forward his name and address.
Tailoring-.
L. T. B. is thanked for his long and
able letter. His suggestions shall receive
attention, and articles on most of the
subjects that he asks for shall be given in
due course. Tailoring cannot be touched
on. It is necessary to draw the line some-
where. I do not think any amateur
would run the risk of appearing in public
in a suit of clothes cut out and made by
himself. Tailoring done at home is
essentially women's work, and is sufficiently
treated in fashion magazines. This is a
magazine for men, and is sought to touch
only on such work as men may, can, and
ought to do.
Sculpture and Plaster Casts.
S. A. {Rothesay). Arrangements are in
progress for articles on these subjects. At
some future time a paper shall be given
on
"
Medallion Portraits in Wax."
Information Wanted.
A. M. A. asks for "some instructions
as to making an ^Eolian harp."
W. M. {Blackburn) wishes to know
how and from what to make gelatine
suitable for taking moulds from deeply
under-cut models.
W. M. (Manningham) has in his
possession a coin on one side of which
he can distinguish the letters "penny"
forming part of the word "half-penny,'*
and on the other a large ship. It is an
English coin, and he would "very much
like to know to what age it belongs." It
is probably what is called a "token."
Can any collector help W. M. ?
Electric Lighting.
Eli-xtric wishes to know whether
we are likely to give any articles on
Electric Lighting ; states, that he pro-
poses to use an incandescent lamp sup-
plied by a Bunsen battery ; and asks
whether or not the carbons of the
batteries should be immersed in water
when not in use. Articles on Electric
Lighting will be forthcoming when we
are satisfied that a system can be adopted
and maintained by an amateur ; but at
present all systems of electric lighting are
far too costly and troublesome. We will
not discourage your attempt, since you
have determined to try the experiment,
but for our own part should shrink from
the trouble, cost, and nuisance of main-
taining an electric light with the current
from a Bunsen battery. The carbons
should be taken out of the nitric acid
(this should be poured into a jug for
future use} and both carbon and cells
well washed in clean water and allowed
to drain dry. But the zinc cylinder or
platec will give most trouble to keep in
order. They must be well brushed in
clean water, and will probably require to
be re-amalgamated with mercury after
each time of using them.
{'
,
PRESENTED WITi PART VII. OF
IP'
bS-i
DBSCBIFTION OF ILLUSTBATIONS
:
Figs. 1, 3, 3, 4.Designs for Corners, forming Centres when quadrupled. 5, 6, 7, 8,Panels and Centres of Panels. 9, 10.Ornamental Centres In form of Orchids. 11, 13, 13, 14Borders 15 -Corner for Large Panel
la-Ornament for Comer or Centre of PaneL 17, 18.-Oentre and Small Panele or Ornaments for Diaper Work. 20, 21, 32, 23.-Oentres of Small Panels. 24Section of Circular Border. 25.-Ornament for Panel or Frieze. 26, 27.-Oorners of Panola
28-64.Corners suitable for Panels, Ceilings, etc., and appropriate for the Decoration of Panels of Doors.
DESIGNS 'N STENCILLING EOR PANELS, BORDERS, CENTRES, CORNERS, ETC., FOR DECORATION OF WALLS AND CEILINGS.
WiHWICK HOUSE. 9AL19BUHI SQUIRE
I
FILTERS: THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND MAINTENANCE.
291
FILTERS :
THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND MAINTENANCE.
By ALFEED W. SOWAED.
IllMaintenance of Charcoal Filters.
|AVING in my two preceding articles de-
scribed the method of construction of
various forms of simple filtering appara-
tus, employing charcoal as the filtering
medium, I shall now, before proceeding
to consider those complex airangements, wherein more
powerful agents are used, devote a short time to the
exposition and discussion of the subject of the main-
tenance of charcoal filters in proper working order.
It is a fallacy,
very widely dif-
fused, to suppose
that a filter, once
fitted up, will re-
tain, for ever, its
power of separating
impurities from the
wa t e r passed
through it. We see,
in shop-windows,
filters made up in
neat stoneware
cases, with an open-
ing at the top for
water to go in, and
an opening at the
bottom for it to
come out, but the
filtering material it-
self is out of sight,
and out of reach.
Cistern filters, too,
we see, which, by the aid of the plumber, we fix in
our cisterns, and then, year after year, draw water from
them by special taps, fondly believing that to all the
impurities of the water our filters act as impassable
barriers. Never was there a more mischievous fallacy.
In the first few months of their existence, doubtless
they exercise a beneficial influence upon the water
submitted to their action ; but there is soon an end to
that : day by day they become less and less useful, as
the impurities taken from the water collect and clog
the charcoal ; soon they become useless, and then
even worse than useless. So far from purifying the
water sent to them, they actually vitiate it.
If anyone should doubt this, let him take one of
these filters that has been in use, uncleansed, for years.
Let him examine the interior (by breaking open the
case with a hammer, if necessary, for the filter is of no
FIG. 20. IRON
CRUCIBLE AND
COVER COM-
PLETE.
FIG. 19.PIECE OF THIN SHEET-
IRON FOR LID OF CRUCIBLE,
SHOWING NICKS CUT IN EDGE
TO FACILITATE BENDING INTO
SHAPE.
value). The whole inside of the stoneware case, the
surface of the filter, everything in fact, will be found
coated with a slimy deposit, a mass of t'lick mud
having a most disgusting odour. Examined under the
microscope this filth will be found to swarm with
minute life, not with animalcules alone, which are to be
found in the purest water, but with vegetable organisms
of a higher type. Not only with living matter, which
in general, is perhaps harmless, but with dead and
decaying matter also.
The necessity, then, of periodically examining and
cleaning out our filter is evident.
But before we enter into practical details, let us
briefly consider what the usual impurities of water are,
and how it is that a filter possesses the power of re-
moving those im-
purities. We shall
then be better able
to determine what
steps to take to
preserve our filters
in proper working
condition.
First then, water
as ordinarily sup-
plied to our houses
contains solid mat-
ter floating in it
;
dust and dirt of all
sorts, rust from
the iron mains, and
various otherthings
too numerous to
mention.
To these sub-
stances, the filter
acts as a mere me-
chanical strainer
;
and it is apparent that, after a time, the fine pores
of sand and charcoal must become clogged. The
filter, instead of being a porous mass, will be more
or less solid.
In the second place, we have various substances
dissolved in the water. Thus the hard water from the
Kentish wells is laden with chalk. And water drawn
from other localities contains, dissolved in it, in greater
or less quantities, those substances which form the soil
of the district.
For the most part, these dissolved matters pass
through an ordinary charcoal filter, as indeed through
most filters, without being very sensibly acted upon
;
but, in a way that is not altogether easy to understand
and therefore difficult to explain, a small portion of
them is withdrawn
;
and this portion goes to help to-
wards the clogging of the pores of the charcoal.
N
FIG. 18. PIECE
OF THIN SHEET-
IRON FOR BODY OF
CRUCIBLE, SHOW-
ING HOLES IN
EDGES FOR IRON
WIRE LACING.
292
FILTERS: THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND MAINTENANCE.
In the third place, and most important of all, there
is organic matter, living and dead. The living we do
not so much object to. Under ordinary circumstances
none but the small animalcules can reach us, and these,
as before stated, are harmless ; but with dead organic
matter it is another thing. Matter in that period of
decay when it is passing from the organised state of
the living creatures, plant, or animal to the unorganised,
inorganic state of the bodies, carbonic acid, water, and
ammonia, into which all living matter is ultimately
resolved, may be, and often is, highly injurious, nay,
poisonous. Worse even than this decaying matter are
those invisible germs of disease which too frequently
accompany it. Diluted sewage, although not pleasant
may be harmless, but when that sewage is drawn from
a district where typhoid fever or Asiatic cholera is
raging, the chances are very much in favour of the
persons drinking it, drinking germs of the disease at
the same time.
It is in the removal of such dangerous impurities
as these that a charcoal filter ceases to be a mere
strainer. No mere strainer would be of the slightest
avail.
In nature, when life ceases, the process of destruc-
tion immediately begins, and is effected by the action
of the air, or rather of the oxygen contained in the
air.
Charcoal has the power of condensing within its
pores enormous quantities of air, and this condensed
air acts by virtue of its concentration in a more rapid
manner than air under ordinary conditions. It is to
this condensed air, and not to the charcoal itself, that
a charcoal filter owes its power of destroying organic
matter.
We see then that a charcoal filter acts, firstly, as a
strainer, and secondly, as a condenser of air, to be used
in oxydising organic matter. How are we to treat our
filter so that it may retain its powers ?
It is evident that however great its store of con-
densed air may be at starting, that store will not
last for ever. We must then give it the oppor-
tunity from time to time of laying in a fresh supply.
This we do by permitting the filter, occasionally, once
a day perhaps, to run dry ; and further by leaving it as
much as possible open, and exposed to currents of
fresh air.
But organic matter of a coarser nature frequently
lodges in the filter, and is removed, in fact, very much as
dust would be, more by the mechanical action than the
chemical action of the filter.
To destroy this a more powerful oxidising agent
than air is required. We find it in a substance called
"
permanganate of potash." Some of this should be
taken, and dissolved in water until the latter has as-
sumed the colour of port wine. A very little of the
permanganate will colour a great deal of water. Or-
ganic matter, when brought into contact with this red
solution is destroyed, the colour of the permanganate
being at the same time discharged.
About once a week the filter should be allowed to
run dry, and a quantity of the red liquid poured in.
Issuing from the bottom, it will, in all probability, be
found to be colourless. If so, a further supply should
be added, and, if necessary, still a further supply, until
the liquid running from the filter retains its colour.
Then water should be run through in quantity to
thoroughly cleanse the filter from the products of the
operation.
Permanganate of potash may be purchased at any
of the chemical dealers, whose names have been given,
for about sixpence per ounce. Those of my readers
who may not chance to live in the neighbourhood of
an operative chemist, and who do not care to pay the
fancy price of an ordinary chemist and druggist, would
do well to go to the nearest oil-shop for a bottle of
Condy's Patent Fluid (red). It is the substance they
require.
But the two operations already described are not
alone sufficient to preserve a filter pure and wholesome.
At intervals of a few months, say once a quarter, the
whole filter should be pulled to pieces, the charcoal,
sand, and pebbles separated from one another. The
sand and pebbles should be well boiled, as when first
preparing them for use, then baked, and finally washed.
The charcoal should be placed in the crucible, covered
up, and ignited, and allowed to cool. When cold, if
caked together, it should be broken up.
When the filter is a large one, and the quantity of
charcoal used is consequently great, the operation of
igniting it in a small crucible is rather tedious. Re-
course may then be had to an iron vessel, formed by
rolling a piece of thin sheet iron into the shape of a
cone, very much in the way that a grocer forms a
sugar-bag of paper. It may be fastened in position by
means of iron wire. The iron crucible thus made
should be provided with a piece of sheet iron as a lid.
The flower-pot, or other containing vessel should
be thoroughly scrubbed and cleaned. In the case of
the flower-pot it would be better to use a fresh one
Everything being perfectly clean, the materials may
be repacked in their case, as when first making the
filter.
At still longer intervals, say once a year, the whole
of the filtering materials should be thrown away, and
their place supplied by fresh pebbles, sand, and char-
coal.
If these precautions are taken, the filter so treated
will be as efficient as it is possible for any charcoal
filter to be.
I have entered in this article somewhat more fully
PRACTICAL GAS-FITTING.
293
into theory than is usual in the pages of Amateur
Work, Illustrated ; but the general misunder-
standing as to what a filter is, and why it purifies water,
which prevails among those who have not the advan-
tage of chemical knowledge, together with the great
practical importance of the subject, must be my excuse.
In my next article I shall consider the question of
the collection and filtration of rain-water.
If any of my country readers intend making a
cask filter, as described in my last article, and do not
care to go to the expense of buying the large quantity
of animal charcoal required for it, they should collect
all the family meat-bones, break them up into small
pieces, place them in the iron crucible described above,
cover them up, and ignite them. When vapour ceases
to be emitted, the crucible should be removed from the
fire, allowed to cool, and its contents turned out and
pounded up. The experiment should not be attempted
by anyone whose olfactory nerves are delicately con-
stituted.
{To be continued.)
=4-=
PRACTICAL GAS-FITTING.
By B. W. BBNNISS.
II.Iron Tubes and Fittings, Chandeliers, Gas Fires.
(/-\
^vT
1
S chandeliers are hung from iron tubes
)
SKSft&igr
and on an entirely different plan from
that adopted for pendants, it will be best
to begin by giving some information con-
cerning iron tubes, their size, and method
of use. They are made in the following sizes (internal
diameter in fractions of an inch) :
\, %, f, J, ,
and
upwards
; but it is only with the sizes mentioned that
an amateur would probably have anything to do.
Each piece of tubing is joined to another by a
socket, which is a short tube, having an internal screw-
thread, corresponding with an external thread cut on
each end of the pieces of barrel to be joined. These
sockets are "made either "equal" (Fig. 13)that is,
made for joining two pieces of barrel of the same
sizeor "diminished (Fig.
14),
for joining tubes of
different sizes. Thus a
f
equal socket will join two
pieces of
f
barrel, whilst a $ socket diminished to
i
will
join a piece of \ and a piece of 3-inch tubing. When
the pipe has to be bent sharply at a right angle, an
"elbow" (Fig. 15) is used; this is a fitting like two
sockets joined together at a right angle. If one tube
has to branch out of another, a T-piece (Fig. 16) is
used ;
this is like one socket with another attached to
one side in the shape of a T. For uniting four pieces
of tube, a
"
cross
"
(Fig. 17) is employed, which is like
a socket with a branch on each side.
All the above fittings are made
"
equal " or
"
diminished
"
to any size.
When the end of a pipe has to be stopped up, a
"
cap " is screwed on ; this is a socket closed at one
end. If, however, a socket elbow, T-piece, or cross
has to be stopped, a "plug" (Fig. 18) is used, which is
a solid piece of wrought-iron, of the same size as the
pipe for which the fitting is made, having at one end a
cubical projection for holding it when screwing up.
A nipple (Fig. 19) is a short piece of barrel, having
an external thread cut on its whole length, and is used
for joining two sockets or other fittings having internal
screw-threads. A bend (Fig. 20) is a piece of iron
barrel, bent round till the ends are at right angles, and
is joined to other pieces of barrel with sockets in the
ordinary way.
We may now pass on to the use of the gas-tongs,
of which a sketch is given in Fig. 21. They vary
entirely in principle and action from the cup and ball
pliers, and are also much more powerful. Each pair
fits one size of pipe and the socket of the one a size
smaller. Thus, to screw a
f
socket on to a 1- pipe, a
pair of & tongs will be required for holding the tube,
and a pair of j-inch tongs for the socket. In Fig. 21
a is called the hook and B the tongue, and it is the
latter which moves the pipe or fitting held in the tongs.
The hook and tongue are faced with hardened steel,
to prevent their wearing away. The power of moving
the pipe is not the pressure of the two parts together,
as is the case with the cup and ball pliers, but by the
tongue making a slight dent in the pipe, thus getting a
hold and pushing it forward ; for which reason, when
once the tongs have been pressed together, the hold on
the handles may be slightly relaxed, and the simple
pushing against the one marked C will be sufficient.
The tongs must always be moved in the direction of
the arrow in the sketch ; that is, the hook goes first,
the tongue following after, from which it is evident
that, in screwing a socket on to or off a pipe, the tongs
must be put one way on to the pipe, and the reverse
on to the socket. (See Fig. 22.)
As $ iron barrel is chiefly employed in hanging
chandeliers, a pair of | and a pair of i-inch tongs will
be required, costing at Buck's is. c;d. and 2s. respec-
tively.
Chandeliers.This name is now improperly em-
ployed to designate an ornamental pendant, having
two or more burners for gas. It, of course, used to
mean any contrivance hung from the ceiling holding
candles, and the name has been kept on and applied
to those for gas. Gaselier has partly come into use,
but it curiously seems only applied to plain kitchen
pendants, or those which can be pushed up and down
without weights or counterpoise.
Chandeliers, then, so called, consist of a tube end*
294 PRACTICAL GAS-FITTING.
ing at the lower end in two or more branches, and
almost always at the other or upper end in a fitting
called a
"
cup and ball
"
(Fig.
23) ; hence the name of
the pliers mentioned in Chapter I., which are used for
screwing the cup and ball on to the iron tubes. The
cup and ball is to allow the chandelier to move round
or from side to side. It consists of three partsA the
cup, which is a hollow hemispherical piece of brass,
having a hole in the centre of the lower part, through
which is passed the stem or tail-piece of the ball B,
which swings in the cup, the surfaces which touch
being
"
ground in," that is, ground together with sand
to fit closely together. The part c is screwed into A,
and the complete fitting is screwed on to the top of
the chandelier by the tail-piece P..
Fig. 24 shows a section of a hydraulic chandelier
;
that is, one that slides up and down with a counter-
poise, and in which water is used to prevent leakage
of gas. A A is a small tube, terminating in a globular
vessel B, from which issue the branches with the
burners. This tube slides inside a larger one C c,
which is screwed into the cup and ball, and which is
surrounded by the bell-mouthed tube D D, which is
brazed on to the globe B. Now as the gas comes down
through the cup and ball, it will enter the tube A, and
pass into the vessel B, and thence to the burners ; but
as the three tubes slide loosely in one another, gas
would escape between A and c, and would issue from
the bell mouth, for which reason water is poured into
the external tube, so as to nearly fill it, thus covering
the lower end of the pipe c, when the chandelier is
pulled down as far as it will go
;
and as gas is lighter
than water, it cannot pass downwards through the
latter, and therefore cannot escape.
The mode of hanging a chandelier can be seen in
Fig. 25. a is a
I
"equal" T-piece, into the ends
of which are screwed pieces of i barrel, B and C
which rest in notches cut across the joists E E. F is
another piece of
f
barrel, screwed into the side of the
T-piece, and projecting about an inch and a-half be-
low the ceiling, and to this the chandelier is screwed.
On the tube b, a cap D is screwed, and the tube c is
connected with the gas supply. In the event of the
f
tube not fitting the cup and ball, a nipple (Fig.
19)
must be screwed half its length into the latter with
the fingers, and a socket, diminished from that size to
f,
must be screwed on to it, and tightened up with
the tongs, and the chandelier must then be screwed
on to the
f
tube with the cup-and-ball pliers, taking
hold of the top of the cup and ball and not the socket.
The chandelier is to be connected with the gas
supply by means of composition tubing, as in the case
of a pendant described in the last article, page
199,
the difference being that a union (Fig. 12), is used
instead of a nose-piece, the part B being blown into
the tube, and the nut screwed on to the tube c (Fig.
25),
the part A of the union not being used.
Hall lights, it may be said, are hung in a precisely
similar manner.
We shall now pass from lighting to heating, and
shall proceed to describe the best and most usual
methods of employing gas in ordinary grates for heat-
giving purposes.
The system of Messrs. Verity, of Regent Street, is
one of the best, and is also the easiest for an amateur
to fit up. It consists of an atmospheric burner, made
of fire-clay, which is supplied with gas by a tube fitted
with an air-bulb, passing into it from underneath.
This burner, when in the grate, is covered over with
pieces of patent indestructible fuel, which, when
heated by the gas, has the appearance of an ordinary
coal fire.
In order to fit up one of these burners in an
ordinary grate, it will first be necessary to remove to
the centre fire bar at the bottom, to allow for the air-
bulb to enter. This can be best done by filing it
half through at each end, and giving it a sharp tap
with a hammer. The nut of the air-bulb (B in
Fig. 26) supplied with the burner must then be un-
screwed, and one of the iron rings taken off, and the
top of the bulb placed between the fire-bars, the ring
dropped on to it, and the nut screwed up, letting the
other end of the air-bulb point towards the side from
which gas is to be obtained. A J-in.
"
equal " elbow
C must be screwed on to the air-bulb pointing down-
wards, and a piece of |-in. barrel D,
2i
in. longer
than the distance from the elbow to the hearth must
be screwed into this, a channel
3 in. deep having been
previously cut in the hearth towards the gas supply.
Then screw another ^-in. elbow E on to the tube,
letting it point along the channel, and into this screw
a piece of barrel F about 6 in. longer than the
distance between the elbow E, and the edge of the
hearth, measured along the channel. To this must be
screwed a valve G, and the tubing must be continued
from this towards a pipe coming direct fiom the
meter, the connection being made as follows : The
pipe from the meter will generally be found outside
the back of the house. This must be unscrewed, and
a T-piece, with a J-in. side, must be inserted, so as to
point between the floor of the room in which the gas-
fire is made and the ceiling of the room below, a piece
of ^-in. barrel must be screwed into it, and brought
through the wall, so as to meet the pipe from the gas-
fire. The piece of barrel which meets the latter piece
must have a
"
connecting-thread
"
cut on it, that is a
screw-thread half as long again as the socket, and a
back-nut (Fig. 27) must be screwed on to this long
thread before the socket, which must be screwed so
far on as to be
"
flush," or level with the end of the
PRACTICAL GAS-FITJING. 2
95
H E A R T h
FIG. 26.VERITY'S ATMO-
SPHERIC BURNER FOR Ef
GAS FIRE.
296
HOW TO JOIN
A LEAD PIPE.
pipe. The socket is then to be screwed off the long
thread on to the tube from the gas-fire, thus connect-
ing the gas-fire and the meter, and the back-nut must
then be screwed up to the socket, with a little painted
tow between the two. The socket alone would
connect the tubes, but the back-nut is to prevent
leakage.
Some putty and whitelead must now be mixed
together, and pressed into the wider part of the hole
at the bottom of the burner, which must then be
dropped on to the top of the air-bulb, and pressed
firmly down, and covered with patent fuel. A brass
trap-door must then be placed in the floor, over the
thumb-screw of the valve, having first cut a hole
through the board.
It now only remains to fill up the channel cut in
the hearth, which must be filled up as described in
the last chapter for a channel cut in the plastering of
a wall ; but the amateur must bear in mind that for
filling up the hearth he must use Portland cement
instead of plaster.
The object of using a valve instead of an ordinary
gas-cock, is to prevent whistling in the burner when
the gas is turned down low.
All the fittings can be obtained of Messrs. Verity,
of Regent Street, at the following prices :
previously
squared in the block (Fig. 4)near the edge of the
bench, then glue the two ends to be jointed and place
against the wood, then you have a very firm support.
To saw the key cuts, when perfectly set, smooth down
the frame with the smoothing plane.
Now measure the lengths and breadths for the
shutter (as shown in Fig.
7,
which is
i
size), to be
made out of (full
\
in.) baywood. Allow about I in.
all round larger than required, in order to leave
plenty of margin for making the tongues, saw cuts, etc.
Tongue and groove together, as shown by the cut
(Fig. 7). I find the cutting gauge most useful for
cutting lengths of wood up to
in. thick, as you can
cut it in much less time than by the saw. When set
smooth down, do not plane it down to its proper thick-
ness till fitted in the slide, as then you have a gauge
all round to work by.
Shoot up in the block (Fig. 4) and measure the
exact depth of grooves. Mark with the marker the
exact size of tongue, and plane the rabbet with the
rabbeting plane. Be very careful in making this
rabbet, for if you take the least shaving more than
necessary, it will spoil the appearance of your slide.
Now mark the shutter about
if
in. from the bottom,
where the cut has to be made in order to hinge, shoot
up in the block, then make a rabbethalf the
thickness of the wood, and about
5
in. deepon oppo-
site sides, so when the shutter is closed one will over-
lap the other, and entirely shut out all light. Bevel
the front edges, so that when the shutter is drawn the
hinges will fall back. Mark the place for hinges and
hinge.
Now glue the corner pieces on top of slide, as
shown in Fig.
7,
to be made out of the same grooving,
mitred in block (Fig.
5). Now key the frames, as
shown at A, Fig.
7,
which gives strength, and, if the
slides should get damp, will prevent them from
opening. There are no such keys at the top. Now
glue the tongue in the groove, as shown at B, in
section (Fig. 10), which must be mitred, in order to
make a perfect joint when set, and all glue removed,
it should fit easily in the groove, as shown in the
section of the other half of slide.
Now glue the corner pieces inside the slide, as
shown in Fig. 10. Cut one piece of glass, -j\ by
4J
in.
and
6J
by
4^
in. The former should fit easily on the
top and bottom rabbets
; the latter on the two side
rabbets ; and the corner pieces will keep the plates
from getting out of their proper positions. If you
have gone according to my instructions, the corner
pieces should be exactly $ by \ in., as shown in Fig. 10,
which are drawn half size. Always allow a little extra
room, so that the plate will slip easily in its proper
place, as sometimes the plates vary a little in size.
I have known them vary as much as ^ in. in one
particular make of plate.
Now place the two frames together. Plane true in
block (Fig.
4)
all slides of exactly equal size. Next
make the rabbets to slide in the frame of the camera.
Now put the top pieces on the shutter, to draw it up
by; to be tongued and grooved together (top piece
tongued).
Now cut a piece of moderately-strong tin, to fit
very close on the rabbet A, Fig. 10, then solder a piece
of flexible clock spring, lengthways of the tin, on one
side only. By bending the tin a little, the other plate
will be kept in its place without the aid of a spring.
The small brass button, as shown in Fig. 10, will keep
it in its proper position. There are two such buttons
about lh in. from the top.
Now scrape with a wood scraper, and make per-
fectly smooth with the finest sand-paper.
All that remains now will be the fittings, which are
very few in the dark slides. You will require for three
slides : six clips, as Fig. 8 ;
six pieces of brass wire, as
Fig. 9. I prefer the clips fastened on the side of the
slide, about two inches from the top. The brass
buttons (Fig.
9)
are screwed into the top piece,
and keep the shutters from falling out. Hinge the
slides together with inch brass hinges. The hinges
for the shutter are made specially for that pur-
pose, and may be bought at most dealers in photo-
graphic apparatus. I shall give, in my next article,
HINTS ON THE RESTORATION OF ANTIQUE FURNITURE.
305
price, and where they can be purchased, of a complete
set of brass fittings for camera, etc.of course, just
what is beyond an amateur's power to make.
For the benefit of my more fortunate readers who
possess a small circular saw, I describe an improved
method of hingeing the shutters. Saw the slide in two,
same as described for ordinary hingeing ; set the gauge
so that the saw-cut will be exactly in the centre ;
saw
both pieces
f-
in. deep and insert a piece of good strong
parchment. This method will be found very much
superior to the ordinary' hinges, and perfectly light-
tight. The saw-cut must be made with a very fine
saw.
{To be continued.)
HINTS ON THE RESTORATION
ANTIQUE FURNITURE.
OF
By MASK MALLETT.
I.Characteristic Features of Ancient Furniture.
N dealing with the present subject, the
object of the writer is purely practical.
Having had much experience in these
matters, he proposes to give to the ama-
teur workman, who wishes to restore
dilapidated examples of antique furniture to use and
beauty, such hints as may be of service to him. But
as restorations cannot properly be effected without
some knowledge of the period and style to which the
article to be restored belongs, it will be desirable to
give some slight outline of the history of our old
English furniture as a preliminary step.
Such of our old English furniture as is of sufficient
antiquity and merit to be prized by the collector or
artist, is commonly made of oak, and more or less
decorated with carving. As art, it belongs, with few
exceptions, to the great Renaissance school. Its
production was not extended over a long period ; for,
roughly speaking, we owe the whole of it to the seven-
teenth century. Occasionally, indeed, the collector
will meet with articles and fragments of carving be-
longing to the earlier, or Gothic school ; but these, in
this country, will be exceedingly rare. Of those so
found, the greater number will prove, earlier or later,
to have belonged to churches ; some few will be relics
of our former conventual establishments, the rest will
have been brought from the Continent by the purvey-
ors for our London dealers in such wares. Of genuine
English domestic furniture, earlier in date than 1550
(which may roughly be set down as the close of the
Gothic period in this country), examples are so few
and far between, that, for the purposes of the ordinary
collector, they may be looked upon as not existing.
The cause of this scarcity is chiefly to be attri-
buted to the rudeness of the domestic arrangements
of our forefathers, till towards the close of the six-
teenth century. As an illustration, let me adduce a
MS. inventory of the year
1574,
now lying before me.
The person whose household goods are minutely
particularized in it, was a member of the Shakspeare
familya wealthy Warwickshire yeoman, whose per-
sonal chattels included
"
boots, spurs, and sword,"
and in whose dwelling were such stores of linen, meal,
malt, and salted provisions, as a modern housewife
could only hope to look upon in dreams. Yet in the
only sitting-room of this house there were but two
chairs ; and its other furniture consisted merely of a
" table-board "
JOINT-STOOL
FIG. 4. EICHT-LEGGED TABLE.
tiquity, things altogether new
are palmed otf on the unwary
buyer. The making of such
forgeries is said to be a regular
branch of industry. In most
purchases, paying a fair price
gives the buyer a reasonable
chance of getting an honest
article
; but in buying things
of this nature, the reverse holds
good. Security lies rather in
the price being so low as to
make it evident that no modern
craftsman could have done the
work for the money.
Most of these forgeries are,
however, so clumsy as to be
easily detected by an experi-
enced collector. The power to
judge in such matters must
chiefly be the result of practice,
yet some hints can be thrown out which may be
found of use. A quality prized in old oak is the
dark colour which it acquires by absorbing ammonia
from the atmosphere, through a long course of years.
The forger commonly uses new wood, which is most
readily available, and stains it with an artificial
colour. He makes it even darker than the old, but
at the same time he fails to give the rich, mellow
hue which comes from age. His work has, if I may
so express it, a sort of metallic appearance, which
suggests the blacklead
brush, and may be
detected without much
difficulty.
Again, a want of
antiquarian accuracy
often exposes the imi-
tation. He does not
observe, or believes
that he can improve
upon, the rules of con-
struction followed by
the old workman. If
the reader will glance
at the four illustrations
already given, he will
see that in the tables,
chairs, and such like
articles, of the seven-
teenth century, the
legs are al ways
strengthened and held
together by cross-bars
near the floor. In
38 HINTS ON THE RESTORATION OF ANTIQUE FURNITURE.
later days, these ties have commonly been dis-
pensed with, as inconvenient and unsightly ; and each
leg has, so to speak, been left to stand alone in the
world. The forger frequently does not remember
this ; and I have seen many elaborately-caned and
deeply-coloured tables, the independent character of
whose legs at once marked them as not genuine
antiques, but as
"
Wardour Street."
At other times we may see articles professing to
be old, of a kind on which old carvers were never
accustomed to spend their skill. Passing lately by a
London shop, I was attracted by a fine carved bureau.
That it was not modern I could see at once by its
general outline. The style of the carving and the
colour of the wood were such as at a superficial
glance might have passed for genuine Stuart work
;
but to see such carving on so late an object as a
bureau, roused my suspicions, and made me examine
FIG. 5.
THE DROP HANDLE.
closely. I soon saw that the thing, in its then state,
was a forgery. The bureau had been a plain oak
article of the earlier part of last century, and the
dealer, in order to enhance its value, had had it
carved in the style of the middle of the seventeenth
century. The fact of the oak being old had permitted
it to take a fine colour.
For dealings in Wardour Street, a well-filled purse
and much caution will be needed
;
yet in the back
streets of London there are humble shops in which
genuine bargains may still be picked up. In the
slums of Marylebone, and at the shop of a broker of
the humblest kind, I have got treasures at prices
which I should have considered low in any part of the
country.
The rural districts are, however, undoubtedly the
best field for the collector. In farm-houses, old oak
work has indeed long since been banished from the
better rooms, yet much remains in garrets and
kitchens. Carved chests are especially abundant in
such houses. In the old period, chests were favourite
articles of furniture, and were made in great numbers.
As they are little liable to breakage, and are always
useful for purposes of stowage, most of them still re-
main
; and it is in farm-houses that the largest, the
most finely-carved, and the best preserved are to be
found. At farm-house auctions, a well-carved chest,
for which a London dealer would ask three or four
pounds, commonly sells for about a sovereign.
Large Jacobean tables, of the kind shown in
Fig. 2, are still not unfrequent in farm-house kitchens
;
especially in such houses as have been the mansions
of the smaller gentry, in Stuart times. Occasionally,
too, fine bedsteads and buffets in good preservation
are to be met with in farm-houses, but such treasures
are now rare.
Cottages do not, as a rule, supply large or im-
portant things, but otherwise they form the collector's
most useful hunting-grounds. They are readily
entered, and the cottager is glad to sell on reasonable
terms ; in this differing from the farmer, whose pride
forbids him to sell, unless he is tempted by high
offers ; hence it is that the treasures of farm-houses
are rarely available except at auction sales.
Chests abound in cottages, but they are generally
smaller, and less finely carved than those in farm-
houses. So do joint-stools (see Fig.
3). But more
abundant than either, in the homes of the peasantry,
are the eight-legged tables of the type shown in
Fig. 4. In cottages, also, and rarely elsewhere, we
meet with small boxes, commonly about 9 inches high,
by 2 feet long ; and richly carved. Antique chairs, of
any of the styles mentioned above, are now unfrequent.
They have been more zealously collected than other
things. But the smaller square framed tables of
James I. and Charles I. are occasionally to be seen in
cottages.
In these humble homes, also, we may often find
odds and ends of old carving, nailed up in partitions,
or otherwise, serving simply as so much old board;
and such fragments the amateur restorer will be able
to turn to good account. In search for such relics,
even the shed and pig- stye of the cottager should not
be neglected. So abundant and so little regarded was
old carved work at the close of last century, that in
pulling down or altering houses of that time, fine
carving is often discovered nailed face inwards, and
covered with plaster or whitewash. A country builder
who, in the course of his business, will frequently come
across such matters, is no bad ally of the collector,
and any one who is on the look-out for old carving
in order to work it up into furniture, will find it useful,
and profitable, too, to visit building-yards both in
towns and the country, when making inquisition for
material of this kind.
{To be continued).
VIOLIN.MAKING: AS IT WAS, AND IS.
39
VIOLIN-MAKING: AS IT WAS, AND IS.
By EDWARD 3. ALLEN.
VI.The Varnish.
E have now reached the point at which
our fiddle is completed,
"
in the white ;
"
there only remains, therefore, before pro-
ceeding to fit it up and string it, to dis-
cuss the question of varnish. So much
has been written on the subject of the
"
Lost Cremona
Varnish," with such infinitesimal result, that it would
be worse than useless to start a new theory to solve
an apparently insoluble difficulty. Mr. C. Reade, in
a letter in the Pall Mall Gazette, of August 31st, 1872,
has shortly epitomised all that is known of this lost
but glorious compound, and his remarks on the sub-
ject are, in the abstract, as follows :
"
It comes to this, then," says he,
"
that the varnish
of Cremona, as acted on by time and usage, has an
inimitable beauty; and we pay a high price for it in
second-class makers, and an enormous price for it in a
fine Stradiuarius or Joseph Guarnerius. No wonder,
then, that many violin-makers have tried hard to dis-
cover the secret of this varnish, many chemists have
.given days and nights of anxious study to it. More than
once, even in my time, hopes have run high, but only
to fall again. Some have even cried, 'Eureka
!'
to the
public; but the moment others looked at their discovery,
and compared it with the real thing,
'
inextinguishable
laughter shook the skies.' At last, despair has suc-
ceeded to all that energetic study, and the varnish of
Cremona is sullenly given up as a lost art. I have
heard and read a great deal about it, and I think I
can state the principal theories briefly but intelligibly.
"
1. It used to be stoutly maintained that the basis
was amber
; that these old Italians had the art of
fusing amber without impairing its transparency : once
fused by dry heat, it could be boiled into a varnish
with oil and spirit of turpentine, and combined with
transparent yet lasting colours. To convince me, they
used to rub the worn part of a Cremona with their
sleeves, and then put the fiddle to their noses, and
smell amber. Then I, burning with the love of know-
ledge, used to rub the fiddle very hard, and whip it to
my nose, and not smell amber. But that might arise,
in some measure, from there not being any amber
there to smell. (N.B. These amber-seeking worthies
never rubbed the coloured varnish on an old violin.
Yet their theory had placed amber there.)
"
2. That time does it all ; that the violins of Stradi-
vari were raw, crude things at starting, and the varnish
rather opaque.
"
3. Two or three had the courage to say it was
spirit-varnish, and alleged in proof that if you drop a
drop of alcohol on a Stradivari, it tears the varnish off
as it runs.
"
4. The far more prevalent notion was, that it is
an oil varnish, in support of which they pointed to the
rich appearance of what they call the bare wood, and
contrasted the miserable, hungry appearance of the
wood in all old violins known to be spirit varnished
(for instance, Nicholas Gagliano, of Naples, and Jean
Baptiste Guadagnini, of Piacenza, Italian makers con-
temporary with Joseph du Jesu).
"
5. That the secret has been lost by adulteration.
The old Cremonese and Venetians got pure and
sovereign gums that have retired from commerce.
"
Now as to theory No. 1. Surely amber is too
dear a gum and too impracticable for two hundred
fiddle-makers to have used in Italy.* Till fused by
dry heat, it is no more soluble in varnish than quartz
is
;
and who can fuse it ? Copal is inclined to melt,
but amber to burn, catch fire, do anything but melt.
Put the two gums to a lighted candle, you will then
appreciate the difference. I have tried more than one
chemist in the fusing of amber ; it came out of their
hands a dark brown, opaque substance, rather burnt
than fused. When really fused, it is a dark olive-green,
as clear as crystal. Yet I never knew but one man
who could bring it to this, and he had special ma-
chinery invented by himself for it
; in spite of which,
he nearly burnt down his house at it one day.f I
believe the whole amber theory comes out of a verbal
equivoque. The varnish of the Amati was called
amber to mark its rich colour, and your a p7-iori
reasoners went off on that, forgetting that amber must
be an inch thick to exhibit the colour amber. By such,
reasoning as this, Mr. Davidson, in a book of greaf
general merit, is misled so far as to put down powdered
glass for an ingredient in Cremona varnish. Mark the
logic. Glass in a sheet is transparent ; so if you re-
duce it to powder, it will add transparency to varnish.
Imposed on by this chimera, he actually puts powdered
glass, an opaque and insoluble sediment, into four
receipts for Cremona varnish. But the theories,
2, 3,
4, 5,
have all a good deal of truth in them ; their fault
is that they are too narrow, and too blind to the truth
of each other. In this, as in every scientific inquiry,
the true solution is that which reconciles all the truths
that seem at variance.
"
The way to discover a lost art, once practised
with variations by a hundred people, is to examine
very closely the most brilliant specimen, the most
characteristic specimen, and, indeed, the most extrava-
gant specimenif you can find one. I took that way,
*
It must be bome in mind that amber is much cheaper and
commoner in Italy and the Tyrol than in the northern countries
of Europe.(E. H. A.)
f
This was the late John Lott (vide Chap. II.).
3'o VIOLIN-MAKING : AS IT WAS, AND IS
and I found in the chippiest varnish of Stradiuarius,
viz., his dark red varnish, the key to all the varnish of
Cremona, red or yellow. (N.B. The yellow varnish
always beat me dead, till I got to it by this detour?)
Look at this dark red varnish, and use your eyes.
What do you see ? A red varnish, which chips very
readily off what people call the bare wood. But never
mind what these echoes of echoes call it. What is it ?
It is not bare wood. Bare wood turns a dirty brown
with age ; this is a rich and lovely yellow. By its
colour, and by its glassy gloss, and by disbelieving
what echoes say, and trusting only to our own eyes,
we may see at a glance that it is not bare wood, but
highly-varnished wood. This varnish is evidently oil,
and contains a gum. Allowing for the tendency of oil
to run into the wood, I should say four coats
of
oil
varnish; and this they call the bare wood. We have
now discovered the first processa clear oil varnish,
laid on the white wood with some transparent gum,
not high-coloured. Now proceed a step further. The
red and chippy varnish, what is that ?
'
Oh ! that is
a varnish of the same quality, but another colour,' say
the theorists No. 4.
'
How do you know?' say I.
'
It
is self-evident ; would a man begin with oil varnish,
and then go into spirit varnish ?
'
is their reply. Now
observe, this is not humble observation, only rational
preconception. But if discovery has an enemy in the
human mind, that enemy is preconception. Let us,
then, trust only to humble observation. Here is clear
varnish, without the ghost of a chip in its nature ; and
upon it is another, a red varnish, which is all chip.
Does that look as if the two varnishes were homo-
geneous ? Is chip precisely the same thing as no chip ?
If homogeneous, there would be chemical affinity be-
tween the two. But this extreme readiness of the red
varnish to chip away from the clear marks a defect of
chemical affinity between the two. Why, if you were
to put your thumb-nail against that red varnish, a
small piece would come away directly. This is not so
in any known case of oil upon oil. Take old Forster,
for instance : he begins with clear oil varnish ; then
on that he puts a distinct oil varnish, with the colour
and transparency of pea-soup. You will not get his
pea-soup to chip off his clear varnish in a hurry, ex-
cept where the top varnish must go in a played bass-
Everywhere else his pea-soup sticks tight to his clear
varnish, being oil upon oil.
"
Now take a perfectly distinct line of observation.
In varnishes, oil is a diluent of colour. It is not in the
power of man to charge an oil varnish with colour so
highly as this top red varnish is charged. And it must
be remembered that the clear varnish below has filled
all the pores of the wood ; therefore the diluent cannot
escape into the wood, and so leave the colour undi-
uted. If that red varnish was ever oil varnish, every
particle of the oil must still be there. But this is
impossible, when you consider the extreme thinness of
the film which constitutes the upper or red layer. This,
then, is how Anthony Stradivari varnished the instru-
ments such as the one we are considering. He began
with three or four coats of oil varnish, containing some
common gum. He then laid on several coats of red
varnish, made by simply dissolving some fine red
unadulterated gum in spirit ; the spirit evaporated,
and left pure gum lying on a rich oil varnish, from
which it chips by its dry nature and its utter want of
chemical affinity to the substratum. This solution of
the process will apply to almost every Cremona var-
nish. The beauty, therefore, of varnish lies in the
facts that it is a pure glossy oil varnish, which serves
as a foil to a divine, unadulterated gum, which is left
as a pure film on it by the evaporation of the spirit in
which it was dissolved. The first is a colourless oil
varnish, which sinks into and shows up the figure of
the wood ; the second is a heterogeneous spirit var-
nish, which serves to give the glory of colour, with its
light and shade, which is the great and transcendent
beauty of a Cremona violin. Gum-lac, which for forty
years has been the mainstay of violin-makers, must
never be used, not one atom of it. That vile flinty
gum killed varnish at Naples and Piacenza a hundred
and forty years ago, as it kills varnish now. Old
Cremona shunned it, and whoever employs a grain of
it commits wilful suicide as a Cremonese varnisher.
It will not wear ; it will not chip ; it is in every
respect the opposite of the Cremona gums. Avoid it
utterly, or fail hopelessly, as all varnishers have failed
since that fatal gum came in. The deep red varnish
of Cremona is pure dragon's blood ; not the cake, the
stick, the filthy trash, which, in this sinful and adulte-
rating generation, is retailed under that name, but the
tear of dragon's blood, little lumps, deeper in colour
than a carbuncle, clear as crystal, and fiery as a ruby.
The yellow varnish is the unadulterated tear of another
gum, retailed in a cake like dragon's blood, and as
great a fraud as presented to you in commerce
;
for
the yellow and for the red gum, grope the City far
eastwards. The orange varnish of Peter Guarnerius
and Stradivarius is only a mixture of these two genuine
gums."
For this long extract from Mr. C. Reade's letter,
copied practically verbatim, I must crave the reader's
pardon ; but as it is, perhaps (to my mind certainly),
the most intelligent, practical, and scientific solution
of the fiddle-builder's greatest difficulty, presented to
a limited number of people by a great connoisseur,
and one eminently qualified to give an opinion, it is
far more honest and satisfactory to give the writer's
own words, than to adapt it (as so many "book-
makers" unblushingly do) to my own phraseology,
VIOLIN-MAKING : AS IT WAS, AND IS. 311
and call It original observation. " Pa/mam qui meruit,
feratP
So much therefore for the modus operandi of the old
Cremona varnishers so far as we can say, what were
the component parts of their material, it were very
difficult, nay, impossible to determine, for it must be
borne in mind that a period of close upon 200 years
has elapsed since it was last applied as we see it
a
time quite long enough to oxydise the gums, resins,
and their diluents beyond the reach of the most care-
ful quantitative or qualitative analysis, besides which,
the costliness of the operation of depriving a Cremona
masterpiece of its greatest beauty, would place it far
beyond the reach of the most enthusiastic experimen-
talist. This closely guarded secret had an existence ex-
tending only from about 1550 to about 1750, at the end
of which time it would seem to have vanished as com-
pletely and mysteriously as it appeared. All the data
we have to go upon are the printed works of some
few individuals, who have written pamphlets on the
various varnishes in common use for various purposes,
and it is not unreasonable to suppose that the varnish
used by the Luthiers or fiddle-makers, was to a certain
extent similar to them ; again, the reading and proper
construction of these formulas is rendered more diffi-
cult that many of the gums, resins, and solvents
mentioned no longer exist under the names by which
they were then known, and some would seem almost
entirely to have disappeared.
I will now recapitulate a few of the most likely
formulas enumerated in these ancient brochures. The
first I have been able to obtain is a treatise called,
"Secrets of the Arts," published in
1550, by one
Alexis, a Piedmontese. He gives the following
receipts
:
1. Linseed oil
4
parts, spirits of turpentine 2 pts.,
aloes 1 pt., juniper gum 1 pt.
2. Powder, benzoin, juniper gum, and gum-mastic,
and dissolve in spirits of wine. This varnish dries a1
once.
3. Linseed oil 1 pt., white resin
3
pts., boil together
and colour as you will.
4. Linseed oil 1 pt., resin 2 pts., pine resin
\
pt.
boil till it thickens. Juniper gum must never be added
to the linseed oil till it boils or else it will be burnt.
The oil should be boiled till it scorches a feather
dipped into it.
He gives the same directions as to colours, and the
solvent powers of linseed oil.
Beyond these two authors formulae become rather
scarce, being chiefly brought from China. All these
last, and the coming, formulas are not to be taken as
invented at the dates given, for they are from works
in the nature of Encyclopaedias, and consequently con-
siderably post dated.
A priest of the name of Anda, in a pamphlet
entitled
"
Recueil abre'ge' des Secrets Merveilleux,"
published in 1663, gives the following receipt
:
Oil
of turpentine 2 oz., turpentine 1 oz., juniper gum
\ dram ; to be mixed over a slow fire.
One, Zahn, in 1685, in
"
Oculus Artificialis,'
Vol. III., p. 166, gives two receipts :
" Used
as a decorative process, stencilling has a character
of its own, and an interest in proportion as it is
characteristic. The ignorant or timid decorator is
ashamed or half afraid of the stencilled look, and
seeks to obliterate the traces of the process. The
experienced artist values the character that comes of
stencilling, and would rather accentuate than blur it.
He prides himself upon the aptness of his design to
the method of its execution, and is best pleased with
it when he feels he has invented something that could
not have been so satisfactorily reproduced by any
other process."
ELECTRIC BELLS.
By GEORGE EDWINSON.
I.Making an Electric Bell.
S I sit in my study, the sound of the
church bells is borne to me on the evening
breeze as they merrily chime in response
to the vigorous pulls of their ringers,
and, to a certain extent, attune my mind
to the subject I have in hand. The regular clang,
clang, of a great bell at a factory near, followed
by the far-distant tinkling of the tradesman's bell at a
neighbouring mansion, tells me plainly that we owe
many of the comforts of life to bells, and (may we add)
to belles also. What an immense amount of muscular
energy is expended every day in pulling bells ! What
a quantity of bell-wire and bell-metal also is yearly
converted into dust ! "And, after all," says paler,
"
what costly, noisy things those house-bells are !
Can't you men of science devise some better method
of summoning our servants and making them ac-
quainted with the fact that some person desires their
presence?"
"
Certainly, my dear sir, we can mitigate the
nuisance and provide, at least, a more musical sound
coupled with a less expenditure of strength, time,
and money, if you desire it."
"
Well, I do desire it ; for I made my arm ache
this morning in ringing the bell to wake Mary, and
then had to get out of bed to do it, for I had broken
one of the wires.''
"
Your troubles in this direction will all vanish if you
replace your present system of bells by those of an
electric system ; for you will then only have to press a
button by the side of your bed to ring a bell in the
servants' bedroom, which will go on ringing until she
waits on you, and you stop it. The system can also
be connected with the front-door or the side-gate, and
will instantly give notice when a visitor lifts the latch
or the knocker ; or it may be connected with every
door and window in the house at night, and will give
warning at once if a burglar attempts to open a win-
dow or a door. A fire-alarm may also be fixed in
every room, which will instantly ring a bell if the
temperature rises above what it ought to be. At pre-
sent, the servant has to distinguish each bell by
its tone, and this is no easy matter when, perhaps,
the tradesman's and the study bell ring together
;
but in the electric bell system an indicator tells truly
the room from whence the bell was rung, even if she
should be out of the kitchen at the time. You may
also adopt a system of pre-arranged signals, and
thus save time by signalling a message to the kitchen,
telling an intelligent sen-ant to bring what you require.
There are no bell-pulls, and, consequently, no broken
ELECTRIC BELLS. 321
wires, cranks, etc., from violent ringing ;
and as all the
connecting-wires may be buried in the walls, or behind
the wainscoting, all unsightly appearances may be
done away with."
"
But such a system must be costly to construct
and maintain, for it could only be put up by a skilled
workman, or repaired by an electrician."
"
Far from it. I hope to show you how you may
make, fix, and repair all the system yourself, or in-
struct an average intelligent workman to do it for you.
All the various parts may now be bought at a low
price, and I will tell you where you may get them,
and the price you will have to pay for them."
There are several kinds of electric bells in the
market, each suited to as many requirements. There
are also various makes and qualities of bells, from the
cheap French bells to the best English-made bells of
well-known makers
; but it will not be fair to condemn
all bells of foreign make, since many of them are
superior to much of the cheap English rubbish passed
off on ignorant purchasers by unscrupulous dealers.
A good French bell is better than a badly made
English one, even though the latter may be sold at a
higher price.
The various kinds of electric bells may be classed
as1. Trembling or Vibrating Bells. 2. Continuous-
ringing Bells. 3. Single-stroke or Clapper Bells.
4. Electro-magnetic, or Electro-pneumatic Bells.
5.
Magnetic Bells. 6. Electric Gongs.
1. Trembling or Vibrating Bells.These are so
constructed, as to give a rapid vibratory action to the
bell-clapper, and so produce a sharp ringing sound as
it rapidly strikes the bell. This sound is continued as
long as the electric circuit is kept closed, and is heard
as a series of strokes, corresponding in length to the
time the press-button is held down. It may, therefore,
be used to give the well-known
"
longs
"
and
"
shorts
"
of the telegraphic system of signalling, and thus mes-
sages may be sent by it. The sound is not like the
clear voice of the single-stroke bell, but may be repre-
sented by ter-r-r-r-it trit trit ter-r-r-r-it. The prices
quoted by dealers for this class of bell varies with its
size and quality. In some lists, 2i-inch bells are
quoted as low as 4s. 6d. ; whilst in other lists bells of
the same size are priced at 10s. 6d. each. This variety
in prices is sometimes caused by some peculiarity in
the construction, and does not always indicate an
inferior or a superior article. Some dealers include
wire, push, and battery for the sum of 10s. 6d.; whilst
others merely sacrifice portability and a few conveni-
ences in the lower-priced bells, and allow the purchaser
to provide his own battery and wires. For instance,
Messrs. Archbutt, 8, Bridge Street, Westminster, offer
to supply a set, including a 2^-inch bell, a battery, and
twenty-five yards of wire, with the necessary push, for
10s. 6d. Mr. Dale,
4,
Little Britain, London, sells a
really good 2j-inch bell alone for 8s. 6d., but supplies
bells of foreign make at a lower price, if required.
Mr. Mayfield,
41,
Queen Victoria Street, E.C., supplies
cheap bells at 4s. 6d., another grade from 7s. 6d.,
whilst best English-made 2i-inch bells are sold by him
for 10s. Messrs. Gent and Co., Leicester, supply a
cheap
"
toy-bell " at 3s., another quality from 4s., and
a small 2-inch bell of best make at 6s. 6d. The prices
for parts of bells also vary ; but it must be understood
that I merely state prices and names of vendors to
enable amateurs to compare the prices, not as a direc-
tory to the best makers. It will be seen that a fair
price for a really good English-made bell of ih
inches in diameter is about 10s. ; but the amateur may
be able to procure the various parts, and, by the aid of
directions given him here, make up a bell at about
half this sum. And here I may suggest to vendors of
electric bell apparatus and materials that it would
prove advantageous for them to arrange with the pub-
lishers of Amateur Work, Illustrated, for the
establishment of a directory in the advertisement she( t
of this Magazine. Such an arrangement would be of
great advantage to all, and provincial readers would
then know to whom they could apply for wires and
other materials required in the home manufacture of
electric bells.
How to make the Bell.The old method of doing
this was to take a piece of round iron, bend it into the
form of a horse-shoe, anneal it, wind on the wire, and
fix it as a magnet on a stout board of beech or of
mahogany
; a bell was then screwed to another part
of the board, and a piece of brass holding the hammer
and spring fastened to another part. Many bells
made upon this plan are now offered for sale and
exchange, but their performance is always liable to
variation and interruption, from the following causes :
To ensure a steady uniform vibratory stroke on the
bell, its hammer must be very nicely adjusted to move
within a strictly defined and limited space ; the least
fractional departure of this adjustment from its proper
position results in an unsatisfactory performance of
the hammer, and often a total failure of the magnet to
move it. In bells constructed on the old plan, the
wooden base is liable to expansion and contraction,
varying with the change of weather and the humidity,
temperature, etc., of the room in which the bells are
placed. Thus, a damp, foggy night may cause the
wood to swell and place the hammer out of range of
the bell, or a dry, hot day may alter the adjustment in
the opposite direction. Such failures as these, from
the above cause alone, has often brought electric bells
into disrepute. Best made bells are, therefore, now
made with metallic (practically unexpansible) bases,
and it is this kind I recommend to my readers.
322 ELECTRIC BELLS.
The Base, to which all the other parts are fastened,
is made of f-inch mahogany or teak, 6 inches by
4
inches, shaped as shown at Fig. I, with a smooth
surface, and French-polished. To this is attached the
metallic base-plate, which may be cut out of sheet
iron or sheet brass, and shaped as shown Fig. 2
;
or it may be made of cast iron, or cast in brass ; or a
substitute for it maybe made in wrought iron or brass,
as shown Fig. 12, I present these various forms to
and adjusting the parts. A tinplate- worker may even
cut his base-plate out of block tin, and get as good
results from his bell as the engineer does from his. In
some makes, the base-plate is cut or stamped out of
thick sheet iron, in the form shown by the dotted lines
on Fig. 2 ; and when thus made, the part A is turned
up at right angles to form a bracket for the magnet
cores, the opposite projection is cut off, and a turned
brass pillar inserted at B to hold the contact screw.
viii
^
TO CAR BOM rt)
S
m*<*~>9?-
FIG 3. BRACKET MAGNET
(MODERN FORM).
FIG. 4- HORSE-SHOE MAG
NET (OLD FORM).
i-x-sts"
ro zinc
FIG. 2. FORM OF METALLIC BASE-
PLATE ATTACHED TO WOODEN
BASE AS SHOWN IN FIG. I.
FIG. 5.ARMATURE FOR ELECTRIC BELLS.
FIG. T. PLAN OF COMMON TREMBLING
BELL.
A, Armature ; B, Bells ; C, Contact
and Regulating Screw; H, Ham-
mer ; S + , Positive Binding Screw
;
S, Negative Binding Screw. Ar-
rows and dotted lines show direc-
tion of wires and currents.
FIG. 6. ANOTHER FORM OF ARMATURE.
FIG. 7.
(A), CORE OF
MAGNET
;
(B), CORES
RIVETED TO BRACKET.
suit the varied handicrafts of my readers ; for instance,
a worker in sheet metal may find it more convenient
to manufacture his bell out of the parts sketched in
1, 2, 3, 5, 7, 8, and
9 ;
but, on the other hand, a smith
or an engineer might prefer the improved form Fig.
16, and select the parts numbered
4, 6, and 12,
choosing either to forge the horse-shoe magnet
4,
or turn up the two cores 7(a), to screw into the metal
base Fig. 12, or to be fastened by nuts, as shown. The
result will be the same in the end, if good workman-
ship is employed, and the proper care taken in fixing
The Magnet may be formed as shown at Fig. 3 or
4,
or Fig. 12. The essential parts are1. Two soft
iron cores. 2. A base to hold the cores. 3. Two
bobbins wound with insulated wire ; and 5. A soft
iron armature.
The old form of magnet is shown at Fig. 4. The
cores and base in this form are made out of one piece
of metal. A length of round Swedish iron is bent in
the form of a horse-shoe ;
this is made soft by anneal-
ing, as explained further on. Two bobbins of insu-
lated wire are fitted on the cores, and the magnet is
ELECTRIC BELLS.
323
held in its place by a transverse strip of brass or iron
secured by a wood screw passing between the two
bobbins. The size of the iron, the wire, the bobbins,
and the method of winding them, is the same as in
other forms. We will now consider the construction of
Fig. 3. To make the cores ofa magnet to ring a 23-inch
bell, get two 2-inch lengths of five-sixteenths round
iron of best quality (Swedish, if practicable), straighten
them, smooth them in a lathe, and reduce
\ inch of
fire to a red heat, then burying it in hot ashes, and
allowing it to gradually cool for a period of from twelve
to twenty-four hours ; or perhaps a better guide to the
process will be to say: bury the iron in hot ashes, and
leave it there until both them and the iron are quite
cold. Iron is rendered hard by hammering and by
being rapidly cooled, either in cold air or in water, and
hard iron retains magnetism for a longer time than
soft iron. As we wish to have a magnet that will only
FIG IO.BINDING STUD. FULL SIZE
IN ELEVATION |A), AND SECTION (E).
FIG. 8.CONTACT SCREW.
FIG. 9. CONTACT SPRING. SHOWING
SPECK OF PLATINUM. HALF SIZE.
iSUX)
FIG. II.DIAGRAM SHOWING METHOD OF
CROSSING WIRES ON MAGNET.
FIG. 16. IMPROVED TREMBLING
OR CHATTERING ELECTRIC
BELL, SHOWING ALL ITS PARTS
WHEN PUT TOGETHER.
12.ALTERNATIVE FORM OF BASE
PLATE FOR BELL.
one end to four-sixteenths of an inch, leaving a sharp
shoulder, as shown at Fig. 7(A). Next get a 2-inch length
of angle iron, drill two holes i| inches apart, of the
exact diameter of the turned ends of the cores, and
rivet these securely in their places ; this may be
done by fastening the cores or legs in a vice whilst
they are being riveted. Two holes should also be
bored in the other flange to receive two screws, as
shown Fig. 7(b). The magnet is now equal to the
horse-shoe form, and must be made quite soft by
annealing. This is done by heating it in a clean coal
act as such when a current of electricity is passing
around it, and return to a simple piece of unmag-
netised iron when the current is broken, we take the
precaution of having it of soft iron. Many bells have
failed to act properly because this precaution has been
neglected, the residual magnetism holding clown the
armature after contact has been broken. When the
magnet has been annealed, its legs should be polished
with a piece of emery cloth, and their ends filed level
and smooth. If it is intended to fasten the cores into
the base-plate, this should also be annealed, unless it
o 2
3
2
4
ELECTRIC BELLS.
is made of brass, when, in this case, a thin strip of soft
iron should connect the two legs before they are at-
tached to the brass base. It will also be readily under-
stood and conceded that the cores should be cut longer
when they are to be fastened by nuts, to allow a suffi-
cient length for screwing the ends to receive the nuts.
The length and size of the legs given above is only
suitable for a 2
!
-inch bell; for larger bells the size
increases one-sixteenth, and the length a quarter of
an inch for every half inch of the bell's diameter.
The Bobbins may be made out of boxwood, ebony,
ebonite, or any hard wood strong enough and dense
enough to allow of being turned down thin in the
body, a necessary requirement to bring the convolu-
tions of wire as near the core as possible without
touching it. Some amateurs use the turned ends of
cotton-reels or spools, and glue them on to a tube of
paper formed on the core. If this tube is well covered
with melted paraffin wax, the plan answers admirably,
but of course the bobbins become fixtures, and porta-
bility is sacrificed. There are persons who will defy
me on this latter point, and who are clever enough to
make good portable bobbins out of paper tubes and
reel-ends. To these I would say
By
all means at
your command, do so if you can.
The size of the bobbins for a 2*-inch bell should be
length, I A inch, diameter of ends, J inch ; the
length increasing a quarter of an inch, and the diameter
an eighth of an inch, for every additional half inch
of diameter of bell. The holes should be bored to
exactly fit the cores, and these should project an
eighth of an inch above the end of the bobbins when
they are fitted on.
The Wire to be wound on the bobbins is sold by
all dealers in electrical apparatus. It is copper wire,
covered with cotton or with silk, to ensure insulation.
A few words here respecting the meaning of insulation
may not be deemed out of place. The verb
"
to
insulate," as understood by electricians, means to pro-
tect from leakage of the electric current by interposing
a bad conductor of electricity between two good con-
ductors, thus insulating or detaching them from elec-
tric contact. The following list will enable my readers
to see at a glance the value of the substances men-
tioned here as conductors or as insulators, the best
conductors being arranged from the top downwards,
and the bad conductors opposed to them in a similar
order.
GOOD CONDUCTORS. BAD CONDUCTORS.
Silver. Paraffin wax.
Copper. Gutta-percha.
Iron. India-rubber.
Brass. Shellac.
Platinum. Varnishes.
All other metals. Sealing-wax.
Metallic solutions.
Metallic salts.
Wet stone.
Wet wood.
Silk and cotton.
Dry clothing.
Dry wood.
Rust, dirt, and oil.
It will be seen on reference to this list that copper
is a good conductor, being only superseded by silvei
,
and that silk and cotton are bad conductors. When,
therefore, a copper wire is bound round with silk or
cotton, and this covered wire is wound around a
bobbin, the bad conductor insulates one convolution
of the copper wire from the next. If the convolutions
were laid naked side by side, and touching each other,
the current would not circle round the core through
the length of the wire, but it would leap across from
one coil to another, and thus the desired effect would
be lost. A similar disaster follows the use of a badly-
insulated wire, i.e., a wire from which the insulating
material has been worn in patches, or badly wound
on, thus exposing naked copper wire. If the insula-
tion of a wire is suspected, it should be run through
hot paraffin wax, and thus made perfect ; the merest
film will suffice. The size of wire for a 23-inch bell
should be No. 28, the sizes falling two numbers for
each half-inch increase in diameter of the bell. The
highest numbers represent the finest size, and the price
per pound or ounce increases with the fineness of the
wire in the ratio of 6d. to is. per lb. from Nos. 18 to
28, and from 3s. to 5s. per lb. from 28 to 40 ; the
usual retail price of No. 28 cotton-covered being 5s.,
and silk-covered 8s. per lb. Silk-covered wire has
this advantage over the other, the convolutions lie
closer together, and thus insure better effects in small
bells, and the magnets admit of a better finish with
the silk-covered wire ; but for most purposes the
cotton-covered will give good satisfaction. This wire
must be wound on the bobbins from end to end regu-
larly, with the coils side by side, as a reel of cotton is
wound. This may be done in a lathe, but a little
practice will be necessary before the inexperienced
hand can guide the wire on in a regular manner. If,
however, the bobbin of wire be held on a piece of wire
in the hand, at a distance of a foot or more from the
running bobbin, the wire will almost guide itself on,
provided the guiding hand is allowed to follow its
course. With a slight care, the wire for those little
magnets may be wound by hand. To wind the wire,
first measure off 8 inches of it, and coil this length
around a pencil, but do not cut it off, on with-
drawing the pencil, a small coil will be formed, this
is termed a helix. This free end is destined to con-
nect the wire with one of the points of contact. At-
tach this free end to the end of one of the bobbins
by a small slit in them, as cotton is fastened off, and
wind one layer, then wind another over this regularly,
then a third, and fasten off the wire at the other end
BOAT-BUILDING MADE EASY.
325
by securing it in a slit with a bit of sealing-wax. The
wire must not be cut off, but wound on the neighbour-
ing bobbin in the reverse direction ; i.e., supposing the
first has been wound from left to right, the second
must be wound by crossing over the wire in the form
of the letter S, and winding it from right to left. This
is graphically shown at Fig. II. A free end must like-
wise be left on the second bobbin ; but this must be
longer than the first, for it has to lead from M to S +.
Make all free ends secure on the bobbins with a bit of
sealing-wax, then carefully press the bobbins on the
magnet-legs, and fix them in the positions shown at
Fig.
3
or 4. If it is found impracticable to continue
the length unbroken from one bobbin to the other, each
bobbin may be wound with its own length of wire, and
the two ends soldered together ; but in this case they
must be joined up after the manner shown at Fig. 11.
Mr. Dale supplies magnets fitted with bobbins, and
wound with silk-covered wire, at prices from 4s. to 6s.
each, according to size.
The next part for consideration is the armature,
with its fittings. This is made out of
-f^
square bar
i.-on, of best quality, well annealed, and filed up smooth
and true. The proportionate length is shown at Figs.
5 and 6 ; and the size of iron for other bells is regu-
lated in the same ratio as that of the cores. Two
methods of making and attaching the springs and
hammers are shown. Fig. 5 shows the section of
an armature, fitted with a back and contact-spring in
two parts. Two strips of hard sheet-brass, as wide
as the armature, are cut off, and the edges filed. A
slot is then cut in the back end of the armature to
receive the two brass strips, and they are soldered
into it ; the top strip is then bent back over the arma-
ture to form the contact-spring, and the other strip is
soldered to a small bracket of angle-brass. At the
other end of the armature a hole is drilled to receive
a piece of stout brass wire, to form the hammer-shaft.
This is soldered in position, and a brass bead soldered
to the other end to form the hammer. Fig. 6 shows
the section of an armature fitted with a back and con-
tact-spring in one piece. This may be soldered to the
r.rmature and to the bracket, or it may be riveted with
f mall brass or copper rivets, or fastened with small
screws. The hammer-shaft is attached by drilling a
vertical hole in the end of the armature, and riveting
the end of the stout brass wire into it. This I con-
sider a better form of armature than the preceding
one.
The next part is shown at Fig. 8. It consists of
a brass bracket as shown, or a part of the base-plate
turned up to form a bracket, as Fig. 1 ; or a small
brass block attached by screws, as shown Fig. 16; or
a small brass pillar, through which a hole is bored, and
screwed to receive a small brass screw known as the
contact-screw. A small nut must also be made, to
act as a lock-nut on the back of screw ; for this is the
part of the apparatus before referred to as needing
nice adjustment. The size of this screw is immaterial
(a {-inch thread is a convenient one) ; but it must be
long enough to pass through the bracket, touch the
contact-spring, and have a few threads to spare behind
the lock-nut. Both the tip of this screw and the point
of contact with it on the contact-spring must be tipped
with platinum, to prevent the electric spark from
burning the brass, which it will do if not protected,
and thus soon spoil the contact. This may be done
by soldering a speck of platinum leaf, half the size of
a threepenny piece, on the point of the screw and on
the spring, or by drilling a tiny hole in the end of the
screw, and another in the contact- spring, and riveting
in a short bit of platinum wire in each hole. Which-
ever method is adopted, Ave must be sure to have the
platinum on the screw adjusted to touch the centre of
the speck of platinum on the spring, shown as a black
speck on Fig. 9. Armatures and hammers, ready for
mounting, cost from is. to 2s. 6d.
;
pillars and contact-
screws from is. 3d. to 2S. The bell, and pillar for it,
as shown at Figs.
13, 14, will cost from 2s. 3d. to 4s.,
according to size and finish. The method of putting
the parts together is shown in the sketches, and
further details will be forthcoming in the next article.
(
To be continued?)
=*-=
BOAT-BUILDING MADE EASY.
By MERVYN KENNEDY.
III.
My
Little Life-Boat.
Y last sketch was of one of the most deli-
cate and elegant kinds of boat made, and
one calling for more exact workmanship
than most others. I now, on the con-
trary, proceed to give directions for the
construction of as simple, easily made, cheap, and
withal serviceable a craft as any one can desire. Any
boy can make it, and no man need be ashamed to use
it. I shall first describe the method I once followed
in building such a boat, and then suggest whatever
improvements on this plan I now see to be feasible.
I first got an old box which had originally con-
tained Australian tinned meats. Its dimensions were,
length
,
2 feet 10 inches ; breadth, 1 foot
9 inches
;
depth, 10 inches ; thickness of side boards, about
I inch, and of bottom boards, about half an inch.
When sitting on a board laid as a seat across one end,
I found that I had just comfortable room for my legs
326 BOAT-BUILDING MADE EASY.
within. I tarred the outside of the bottom and comers,
to keep out any water that might make its way in to
them. I then got a quarter-inch 12-foot board,
9
inches broad, and another 7 inches, and, without
planing them, cut them each in half. One of the
9-inch halves I screwed to a corner of the box,
so that about an inch and a half projected behind the
latter ; while the remainder, running up alongside,
could be screwed to the forward corner also, and
doubled round in front to meet the second 9- inch
half board coming from the other side, where it was
similarly secured. The two were joined in front by
inserting between them a small straight triangular
ash stem-post, and screwing them to it.
The boat then, when viewed from
above, appeared as denoted by the
black lines in the accompanying
figure (Fig. 16). The 7-inch boards
were next put on all round on the top
of the others ; while, to secure their
upper edges to, four posts, M, M, M, M
were fastened to the four corners of
the box, outside it but inside the
outer boards. P is the stem-post,
and the dotted line across the stern
represents the top of the outside end-
boarding, the same height as the
sides, and sloping in to join the box
at the bottom, while the lower part of
the side boards is here sloped away
to match ; S S are the seats ; X x
smaller side-pieces, to conceal the
openings between the inner box and
the outer sides ; o is a brace across
the prow, to fasten the bottom to, and
itself secured to the sides.
Next came the bottom, quite flat,
and extending alike over the open
.and the bottom of the box. Be sure to nail the
bottom on outside the edges of the boards, and then
round it off. I foolishly rounded it off first, and then
fitted it inside
j
the consequence
being that I had to
expend a small fortune on cement before I could
render these joinings water-tight.
It will also be
found expedient to nail it on through a strip of flannel
or similar substance, which will thus act as caulking
for the bottom seam all round, while all precautions
here taken should also be observed with the outside
stern-boarding described above.
So narrow a boat will, of course, require outrigger
rowlocks, since it is to be propelled not by a paddle,
but by oars. The first necessary step is to discover
the proper length and bend for these appendages. To
do this, seat yourself in the boat on the ground, just as
if you were going to row, and work backward and
forward two sticks, the length the oars are to be, on
the top of two other sticks, forked at the end, and
stuck in the ground, one at each side of you, till you
find the exact spot for the rowlock. Then take a
piece of wire, and find the size arid bend of connect-
ing rod, which will reach from that spot to the side of
the boat, and extend down the latter inside to the bolt-
holes. Any country blacksmith can make a good pair
of outriggers, if you show him how
;
or, if disposed
to do a little hammering, you may easily construct
them for yourself. To do this, get a bar of iron an
inch broad, an eighth of an inch thick, and abcut a
foot and a half more than twice the length of the wire,
which you found enough for one rowlock and connect-
ing rod. Cut this bar in half, split
one end of each piece exactly' down
the centre for about
4
inches, open
out the two claws, and either leave
them in a slightly rounded shape,
or, what is better, form with them
three sides of a square, A in Fig.
17. Then make in each piece the
bend e, according to the pattern
which you found suitable, and weld
on to the bottom of each a small
cross-piece c C. Make three bolt-
holes, one in either end of C C, and
one a little distance up the main
stem, at D. Next, with a rasp, round
off the inner edges of A, that they
may not cut the oars. You have
now a pair of outriggers, light and
neat-looking, and fit to stand any-
thing.
To fasten them on, pass each
through an aperture cut in the outer
board, at the spot which you have
found suitable, taking care that these
outer boards do not, from their bent form, split further
than you intended. Lay the T-shaped end against
the outside of the inner box, in which you make holes
corresponding to the bolt-holes in the irons, and pass
three bolts through both iron and wood on either
side, screwing on the necessary nuts inside the boat.
I have described these outriggers so particularly,
because, if thus made, they will suit any kind of boat
which requires them, as well as our little tub, provided
it has a side strong enough for them to be fastened to.
To suit a weaker side, the stem of the iron can be
split like the head, so as to form a two-legged support
for the oar, more resembling the ordinary outriggers
on a builder's boat, and thus distribute the strain over
a larger surface ; or two smaller bars may be crossed
and welded together at the rowlock.
Between 6 feet 6 inches and 7 feet 6 inches will be
DIAGRAM SHOWING PLAN
OF LIFE-BOAT.
BOAT-BUILDING MADE EASY. 327
found to be sufficient for the length of a pair of oars
suitable for this boat.
When I had got my boat finished, as above
described, I tried it in the water, but after some
fourteen upsets I felt it would not do. Had it been a
canoe, indeed, the beam would have been quite suffi-
cient for steadiness ; but it was, in fact a boat, to be
propelled by oars, and it makes a vast difference in
the stability of any small craft whether you
sit on the bottom, or on a seat a foot high.
There was nothing for it but to add some
floating power outside. Accordingly, I made
two wooden wings (w, w in Fig. 16), each
about
5
inches across in the broadest part,
and for three shillings purchased a piece of
cork large enough, when divided, to cover
the under-side of these, to which I proceeded
to nail it. I then secured the wings to the
sides of the boat, 8 inches from top and
bottom, by two L-shaped iron braces a
piece.
With two long bolts I then put on a false keel,
weighted with iron, and, to my delight, not only found
my boat quite steady, allowing me to sit or stand in it
comfortably, but discovered that it was, to all intents
and purposes, a life-boat. Not merely was it impos-
sible to upset it from within, as I proved by falling
overboard in the endeavour, but when forcibly upset
from without it at once righted itself. I also found it
easy to swim up to it, and get in over the stern. As,
however, its life-boat capabilities were not likely to be
required, and the false keel made it draw more water
than was always convenient, I took off this appen-
dage, and found it still perfectly steady.
I should be afraid to say how many good fish,
especially pike, I have killed out of this boat. It is
also specially useful for shooting, as while, from its
small size and quiet
colour, green, birds
are not afraid of it, it
allows one to stand up
readily, or can be
turned completely
round by a simulta-
neous forward stroke
of one oar and backward one of the other,can
be kept, indeed, spinning round at pleasure, so as to
command any quarter.
And now for suggestions of improvements on this
model. I have carried a small boy with me in my
original tub, but would rather not do so again. It
follows that, to carry two comfortably, the beam must
be increased
;
and as this alone would render the boat
too round, it would be well to construct it with stem
and stem alike pointed. It could thus move either
FIG. 17.OUTRIGGER
ROWLOCK.
way, and the rowlocks should be exactly in the centre
of the sides. The fore and aft compartments cannot,
of course, be stood in, the bottom not being strong
enough, but they are most useful for keeping fish in,
or carrying a dog, and, being quite distinct from the
centre, can always contain several inches of water, if
desired. If wings are objected to, the beam should be
increased by 6 or 7 inches ; and a boat of this size,
pointed at both ends, could be finished in
two or three days, would carry two, and
could move at a very fair speed.
All these directions are on the assumption
that the craft is to be, not a canoe, but a
boat propelled by oars, and with raised
seats. Yet a canoe made on the same plan
would be, in many respects, a simpler, and,
in some, a much superior article. Any in-
crease on the beam of the original boat
would now, as we have seen, be quite super-
fluous, even without wings, and the craft
would thus be considerably faster. For
fishing, indeed, it would be inferior, as it would not
give so great a command of the water when sitting,
while it could not be stood in. But as an easily-made
canoe, to paddle about in, it would be unrivalled. For
such a purpose the dimensions might be as follows :
inner box, 3 feet by 2 feet, and outer boards 12 feet
long ; or for two people, 4
feet by 3
feet, and outer
boards 14 feet or 15 feet long. Both ends alike in
either case. As a shooting boat, this model would be
inferior for flying shots, but would conceal much more
of the person ;
and, after all, long pot-shots are the
usual style in canoes. It would now be found con-
venient to have a couple of hooks placed along the
top of the inner box, by the right shoulder, to keep a
gun on ;
and, for a heavy weapon, a similar support
might be placed in the centre of the front of the box,
admitting of being
i
turned in any direc-
tion, and perhaps of
being raised and
lowered. This could
sustain the muzzle
when the gun was to
be fired. If the stock
needed support also, it could be supplied as follows :
Fasten an iron bar, forming a slight hoop, across the
boat in front of the body, with a rest for the stock
attached to it, and running freely in either direction
on it. The ends of this cross-bar could be made to
slide up and down in grooves on the sides of the boat
;
or, for a heavy flock-gun, they could be secured to
each side by a pivot, on which they would turn, and
below which their ends would hang, fitted with springs
or weights to check the recoil. For flock-shooting,
ELEVATION OF SIDE OF CARRIAGE FOR BOAT.
328
HOUSEHOLD CLOCKS.
the sportsman could then lie on his back, working his
vessel within range with a small paddle. A heavy
gun, with a short round butt, secured to the slide on
the bow-shaped cross-bar, and its muzzle lying on an
easily-turned support in front, could, by simply shifting
the butt-rest, be arranged to any required elevation or
direction, while the eye, by a slight turning of the
head, could, without trouble, be placed in the position
necessary for aiming. The use of heavy weights, or,
what would be much better, strong springs, like those
on a hay-tedder, fastened as proposed above, would
suffice to check a very severe recoil, so that a stock to
the gun would be unnecessary, and the gunner would
be spared the trouble of shifting into the position
necessary for applying a stock to the shoulder. The
sliding butt-rest could be at once secured in any
desired spot by a turn of a screw.
For a boat such as I have described, which it
might often be desired to transport from place to
place, a simple carriage would be useful. The easiest
plan would be merely to nail two slight iron axles
across the flat bottom, which they would serve to
strengthen, each projecting on either side only far
enough to hold a wheel, to be secured by a linch-pin
;
or to secure two pieces of railway line reversed longi-
tudinally on the bottom, so that the boat could be
drawn along on them without wheels, while they would
serve as a double and heavy keel. If wheels be used,
and four iron ones cannot be bagged from a sheep-
rack or similar article, serviceable wooden ones can
easily be made by simply cutting sections of any large
log, rounding them exactly, and shoeing them with
hoop-iron. For a clipper-built canoe or other delicate
boat, a more elaborate carriage may be made as fol-
lows : Get some "quarter planks" boards, that is,
3
inches by i^ inch. Take two pieces, each a little
longer than the boat, and two about a yard and a
half shorter, lay a short and a long piece on the
ground parallel to each other, and some 3 feet
apart, connect them by three supportsone in the
centre perpendicular, and one at each end necessarily
slanting, from one bar being shorter than the other.
The result will be one side of the carriage, presenting
the following appearance (Fig. 18).
Now prepare the other side in the same manner,
and join the two bottom bars by stout cross-pieces, well
secured, and slightly wider than the beam of the boat.
To the under-side of these cross-pieces fasten the
axles, and put on the wheels. Then fasten three
pieces of girth-web or similar stuff, from one top bar
to the other, loosely, and let the boat lie in these,
between the sides. To keep the latter from being
drawn together, secure a cross-stick by a hinge to the
centre of one top bar, and when the boat is in, shut it
down into a rest cut in the other. It will be advisable
to use screws, not nails, for all fastenings. Now round
the handles A A at one end, and perhaps fasten a bar
across the points at the other. Nothing remains but
to tackle a donkey, four-legged or two-legged, to your
carriage, walking behind yourself, ready to grasp the
handles on rough ground or when turning corners.
With a light carriage the whole affair may even be
pushed along like a wheelbarrow.
{To be continued.')
^f=
HOUSEHOLD CLOCKS:
HOW TO ADJUST, CLEAN, AND REPAIR THEM.
|By PAUL N. HASLUCK.
IV.French Timepieces.
HE English market has been so flooded
with French timepieces, manufactured
in every style of ornamentation, and sold
at exceedingly low prices, that in a house
where more than one clock is to be found,
there is almost sure to be a specimen of the horologi-
cal productions of our continental neighbours. On
page 152 will be found a brief description of French
clocks, and we will now proceed with some further
particulars of their construction and adjustment.
The movements of French timepieces, as the
clocks are most generally called, are small, the
mechanism approaching that of the largest watch-
work. In striking movements there is a complication
of parts that render the task of taking entirely apart
and rehabilitating an undertaking not to be attempted
by the inexperienced amateur without due considera-
tion. A plain watch, of large calibre, is perhaps a less
delicate piece of mechanism to handle than a small
size French striking movement. The large number of
a^res, their small diameter, and the corresponding fra-
gility of the pivots, render extreme care absolutely
necessary in putting the plates together, or broken
pivots will inevitably result.
French timepieces are fairly easy to distinguish by
a cursory inspection, and when the movement can be
seen they may be identified at a glance. The Yan-
kees, however, not content with supplying an immense
number of their legitimate productions, send over
spurious imitations of the Gallic. The French move-
ments are used in those elaborately gilt ornamental
cases, usually kept under glass shades, that are seen
in drawing-rooms. These cases, very gaudy, albeit
substantial-looking are cheaply manufactured, being
made of zinc cast in moulds of the design required,
and subsequently gilt. Marble cases of every pattern
HOUSEHOLD CLOCKS.
329
suited for the mantel have French movements as a
rule, and the well-known
"
drum
"
timepiece is essen-
tially French.
The pendulums ofdrums are always short so as to be
contained in the case. The same movements are often
put in cheap cases ofmore elaborate shape. The escape-
ment of these movements is a recoil which receives im-
pulse on one pallet only. The other pallet has its face
concentric with the axis of oscillation, and consequently
receives no impulse. The object of this arrangement
appears to be that the power of the mainspring when
fully wound up and exerting an extra force on the im-
pulse pallet, at the same time exerts the same extra
force as a drag on the other pallet. The long fric-
tional rest of the tooth against the face of the pallet
exercises a retarding influence on the vibration of the
pendulum proportionate to the force of the main-
spring. This compensates for the extra force of the
impulse when the going barrel is fully wound. When
the spring is nearly down the clock may stop from
insufficiency of power, and when fully wound the
pressure of the tooth on the resting-pallet may be
more than the weight, or active force, of the bob can
overcome, and stoppage will result in this case also.
Dead-beat and Brocot escapements are used in the
better kinds of French timepieces and produce much
better results. Long pendulums and heavy bobs being
then used.
The dials of French timepieces are generally
enamelled on copper, though white cardboard is used
for
"
drums
"
and the cheapest movements. A bezel,
encircling the dial, is fixed to the pillar plate, some-
times by three screws put in radially, and at other
times by dogs and a set screw. From this bezel two
arms extend nearly to the back of the case, being
riveted near the XI. and III. respectively. Another
bezel, or ring, is put at the back of the case through
which two screws pass and screw into these arms.
By screwing up these screws the two bezels are made
to clip the case firmly between them. This is all the
fixing the movement has ; the case always having a
round hole the right size to contain the movement. It
may be mentioned incidentally that all movements are
made to certain sizes and are consequently inter-
changeable.
This method of securing the movement in its
case allows both to be made independently, as they
always are, and the mere fitting, if simply screwing in
deserves to be so described, is the work of a minute or
so only. The movement is placed in the case with the
XII. on the dial uppermost ; the two screws are put
through the ring at the back and tightened up, and
thus the movement is fixed in the case. Through
being dependent on this fixing alone to prevent any
twisting round, the movement very often gets shifted
in the winding, and as a result the escapement is
thrown out of beat, and the clock stops. To this
insecure method of fixing the movement in the case,
French timepieces owe the greater portion of their
failures to perform accurately. It is by no means a
rare occurrence to see a movement twisted consider-
ably out of its proper position, and sometimes it is
impossible to fix the movement tightly by the means
provided. A small pin fixed in the case and project-
ing to fit in a notch in the movement will often
suffice to remedy this defect.
The importers in this country sell the new time-
pieces packed as they come from the continent; 1
manufactories. There the movements are seldom set
going in their cases. Some timepieces that reach the
retail shopkeepers possess evidence that the move-
ments never have gone since put together. A pin
driven through the plate and projecting far enough to
prevent the rotation of a wheel is not an unknown
occurrence. It may be assumed then, as a rule, the
movements of French timepieces, as supplied to the
retailer, require to be taken apart and properly
"
examined." This is a technical term, which is used
to describe the process of carefully examining the
various component parts of a movement, to see that
each is suited to every other. When all the parts are
collected together and put into position to form a com-
plete movement, this is, or rather should be, examined.
The examiner has to see that each moving part has
sufficient freedom, and that all the bearings fit ; for
though the parts are all perfect as parts, yet as a
whole they may fail to act together perfectly. Many
sellers of horological instruments are glad to shirk the
requisite examination and adjustment providing the
timepiece will go.
Some of the more easily understood and glaring
faults of a new clock may be set right by a careful
amateur of ordinary skill. For the purely technical and
less conspicuous defects the movement of a French
timepiece will require to go through the hands of an
experienced man. Sometimes the pendulums are,
figuratively speaking, too large for the case. May be
there is not sufficient room for the bob to swing, or it
may touch the bottom, or some projecting piece.
Though it may appear scarcely credible to the inex-
perienced, yet movements having pendulums alto-
gether too long for the particular sized case are
occasionally sent out. When this occurs the clock
jobber will put a new escape-wheel pinion, having an
extra leaf in it. By this means a pendulum much
shorter than the original may be used. When the
error is but slight, the bob is sometimes made oval by
filing from the bottom edges ; this allows the bob to
be lowered. By filing from the top edge the centre of
gravity is lowered still further. The case should be
33
HOUSEHOLD CLOCKS.
cut away to allow the pendulum freedom if this is
practicable.
The crutch, that is the piece which is fixed to the
pallet staff, and in which the pendulum rod acts, is
generally put on the staff
"
spring-tight
"
only. The
object being that the clock may be set in beat by
giving it a good shake. The plan is perhaps to be
commended for clocks that are continually moved
and often stood on unlevel places. Yet it is by no
means desirable in a clock that is practically a fixture.
Unless fixed tightly, the crutch is liable to be shifted,
thereby causing many casualties, which result in an
unaccountable variation in the going qualities.
The suspension, by which the pendulum is hung,
is most generally that known as the Breguet ; which
is a thin steel spring. To regulate the timepiece a
sliding piece, firmly clasping the spring and moved
vertically by a screw, is used. This screw is actuated
by an arbor with a square end coming out close above
the XII. on the dial. A silk suspension is found in
some French timepieces, but this arrangement is now
very little used. It consists of a loop of silk thread by
which the pendulum is hung.
The regulation of these timepieces is often a very
perplexing process, on account of the large amount of
play, or backlash as engineers call it, between the
square that is turned by the key and the sliding piece
that confines the suspension spring. There is one pair
of wheels which transmit the motion at right angles, but
the teeth of the wheels are not cut on the bevel, hence
there is often considerable play here. The screw itself
is fitted in a bearing, and generally has more or less
end play, besides any slackness in the fit of the thread
in the sliding nut which also causes a loss of time in
transmitting the motion. The combined effect of all
these slacknesses is to quite baffle any estimation of
the actual result produced by a certain amount of
movement imparted to the front end of the regulating
axis.
Suppose the pendulum has been shortened till the
timepiece eventually gains slightly. Perhaps by mov-
ing the nut a distance equal to half a turn of the screw
would suffice to lengthen the pendulum the correct
amount. It is, however, quite possible that as much as
two whole turns of the axis will be necessary before
the screw itself commences to move the sliding nut.
Under these circumstances half a turn of the regulat-
ing axis in one direction will produce as much effect
on the going of the clock as two and a half turns in
the reverse direction. For this reason it is always
advisable to have a mark on the regulator itself, that
is on the sliding nut, and this will enable the operator
to observe the exact amount of the alteration he
makes.
The movements of marble timepieces are generally
protected from dust, etc., by a piece of sheet zinc bent
round to a cylindrical form, and having a piece cut
away to allow the pendulum rod to swing free. The
rings or bezels at both back and front are made to
open. They are fitted with glasses so that the works
are shut in fairly close. The gilt-case timepieces
under glass shades have no glass doors, and depend on
the shade only to keep out all dust, etc. When the
clock-jobber has to repair one of these French time-
pieces, he nearly always takes the movement out of
the case for convenience in carrying. The case he
leaves at the owner's house whilst the movement is put
in order, this is then tested in an adjustable frame or
horse. It is easy to understand from this that any of
the causes of stoppage that exist in the case only, may
be quite overlooked by the workman who has put the
movement in repair.
The striking mechanism of French timepieces is
generally arranged to strike one blow at the half hour
in addition to striking the hours. There are two forms
of striking work in common use. One is called the
rack and snail, and it allows the hands to be turned
forward to any extent, and the striking will not become
disarranged so long as the clock is allowed to strike at
twelve o'clock. The other form is known as the lock-
ing plate, and with this it is necessary to allow the
mechanism to act at each hour and half hour or the
clock will strike incorrectly. The snail is driven by
the motion wheels of the clock, and consequently
its position always corresponds with that of the hands.
The locking-plate travels with the striking train and it
only serves to regulate the successive number of blows,
and is in no way governed by the position of the
hands.
Considerable misapprehension exists with respect to
turning the hands of a clock backwards. Unless the
clock is a striker, or one that chimes, there is no harm
done by setting it back. When a striker, it may be set
back as much as twenty minutes or so, if done at the
right time, that is when the minute hand points to
about five minutes before striking time. Then it may
be put back to the point at which the last striking
occurred. The long hand, showing the minutes, is the
one always to be moved, and if it is particularly fine
extra care must be exercised so as not to break it. In
ordinary cases ordinary caution is all that is necessary
to guard against accidental breakage.
When the striking is wrong, that is if the clock
strikes a different number to the time to which the
hands point, the way to set matters right is simply to
turn the hour hand to the figure representing the hour
last struck. The hand is fitted spring-tight to allow it
to be moved for this purpose. If very tight be care-
ful not to break it. See that it is quite tight after
having altered its position on the minute wheel.
HOUSEHOLD CLOCKS. 33i
The escapements of these timepieces have been
already briefly alluded to. It is interesting to notice
that those escapements which are
"
dead-beat "
are
made to gain by increasing the weight of the pendulum
bob and by diminishing the motive force. The recoil
escapements are affected in the opposite manner.
This peculiar property is of course only very slight, the
effect produced being totally inadequate to the cause.
Practically there is no use made of the peculiarity.
The pendulums of French timepieces have solid
brass bobs always proportionately much heavier than
the pendulum bobs of English clocks. The rod is a
plain steel wire, which from motives of economy and
in the practical results, is much preferable to the flat
rod used in English clocks. The very small and
ridiculously cheap "tic-tac" drum timepieces are of
course excepted. They have a spherical bob screwed
on to a wire rod, itself fixed to the pallet staff and acting
without the intervention of a crutch. The performance
of these timepieces are excellent considering their low
price, and if the pallet holes are kept in good order,
that is to fit the pivots which wear very rapidly, the
"
tic-tacs " will go and keep fair time till they are
literally cut to pieces by wear.
The process of cleaning the movements of a French
timepiece is one involving some amount of care. In
the early part of this chapter the delicate nature of the
mechanism has been mentioned. To dismount the
movement from the case, first open the bezels and see
how the movement is secured. Remove the pendulum
;
if a striking clock the bell must be removed first in
order to get at the pendulum. Unscrew the screws
which fix the movement and draw this out from the
front. In order to take it apart a small screwdriver
and a pair of pliers, such as have been already illus-
trated in a previous chapter, are wanted. Take the
dial off first ; this is done by withdrawing the pins,
which are put through the feet of the dial plate. The
hands must be taken off previously ; to effect this it is
only necessary to push out the small pin which is
driven in the hole diametrically across the centre
arbor. The hands will then lift off. Take notice of
the position of every pin, and recollect as it is removed,
so that it may be replaced correctly.
When the dial is off, remove those wheels that are
loose beneath it. If the clock is a non-striker there
will be only three motion wheels to remove, but if a
striking movement it will have numerous pieces of
mechanism beneath the dial. When these are off,
take off the pallet cock, remove the pallets carefully,
and the movement will run down if there is any
power left in the spring. See that the train has
thoroughly run down before attempting to separate
the plates, or breakage of a more or less serious nature
is inevitable.
Separate the plates by withdrawing the pins in the
pillars
;
generally there are four pillars, and the pin of
each one must be removed before the plates can be
separated. Lift the upper plate off gently, leaving
all the wheels and pinions in their proper positions on
the pillar plate. Take out each axis separately, and
endeavour to fix the position of each in the memory
till the time comes for putting together again. A
striking movement contains a double quantity of wheels,
etc., and is very much more difficult to put together
than a plain movement, that is, to an inexperienced
hand. Until proficiency has been attained in manipu-
lating a plain movement, the treatment of a striker
should not be attempted.
Each part of the movement is carefully cleaned by
brushing with whiting, a soft cloth being used to hold
the parts. The pivot holes in the plates must be care-
fully cleaned out by means of a piece of stick cut to a
point and twirled round in the hole. Professional
clock jobbers use "peg-wood," which is wild cornel.
An amateur will find a skewer answer his purpose.
The spaces between the pinion leaves must all be
cleaned out carefully by the aid of a pointed stick.
The barrels which contain the mainsprings must
be opened by prizing the lid with a lever. A small
notch in the edge of the barrel lid is cut for this pur-
pose. The position of the barrel lid must be marked,
so that it will be replaced correctly. When the lid is
off, the barrel arbor may be taken out. Be very care-
ful not to disturb the mainspring. Beginners should
not attempt to take mainsprings out of barrels as
there is considerable difficulty in getting them back
if the operator is inexperienced. The holes in the
barrel itself, and in the cover, must be cleaned with
the wood. The arbor, which forms the axis of the
barrel, must also be cleaned, and these bearings oiled
when the barrel is put together. It may not be super-
fluous information to the beginner to mention that the
barrel rotates on its arbor when the movement is going,
consequently the holes in the barrel require to be
lubricated. The barrel arbor does not revolve in the
plate except during the process of winding. The
mainspring itself should have a little oil applied to it.
A drop or two on the upper edge of the coils will
amply suffice, it will distribute itself on the coils of
the spring when that is wound up. The oil must be
applied before the barrel cover is replaced.
The movement is put together after being cleaned
by carefully and exactly replacing the pieces precisely
in the inverse order to that in which they were
separated. It is scarcely possible to enumerate the
order in which the reconstruction is effected, as it
may differ in various movements. The pillar plate is
usually laid down as a foundation, the centre wheel is
the first to be put in its place. The plate being rested
332
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
on a small box or hollow structure, so that the arbor
may project as it should. The barrel, or two barrels,
are next put in, and the various smaller wheels are
subsequently placed in their respective positions in
the order that may best suit the workman. When all
are in, the upper plate is laid on. The longest pivots
are got into holes first, and this is continued till one
of the pillars project sufficiently to allow the pin to be
put in. As soon as a pin is put in the plates are to an
extent secured. It is easy to see which axis prevents
the plates closing, and it is then shifted till the pivot
comes under the hole, and so allows the plate to
close slightly, and another axis binds. This is moved
carefully to the hole its pivot should go in, and the
process continued till the whole of the axes are in posi-
tion. The pins are then all put through the pillars, and
by applying a little pressure to the edge of the barrel
the freedom of the train is ascertained. The whole
series of wheels should revolve freely, and continue
to spin round even when the propelling pressure is
withdrawn.
All the pivot bearings are carefully oiled. The
amateur clock-jobber should purchase a bottle of the
oil specially prepared for clock work. The various
parts of the movement that were removed previous to
separating the plates are next put in their respective
positions. Each bearing is oiled as the work pro-
ceeds, or some may be covered over by some parts
subsequently. The pallets, or the points of the escape
wheel teeth, should be oiled. When the movement is
put together complete it is replaced in its case, wound
up, set going, and after some slight regulation will
probably go well for two or three years without further
attention.
Any reader who may be interested in any particu-
lar branch of the subject of these papers is invited to
query on any point on which information is wanted.
{To be continued.)
o* .-
-=
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
HAVE received from Messrs Crosby
Lockwood and Co., of
7,
Stationers
Hail Court, E.C., two volumes, strongly
bound in cloth, which form Nos. 226
and 227 of Weale's Rudimentary Series.
These books, the price of each of which is 3s., are
"
A
Practical Treatise on the Joints Made and Used by
Builders, in the Construction of various kinds of
Engineering and Architectural Works, with Special
Reference to those Wrought by Artificers in Erecting
and Furnishing Habitable Structures," by Wyvill
J.
Christy, Architect and Surveyor, and
"
A Treatise on
Mathematics, as applied to the Constructive Arts,
illustrating the Various Processes of Mathematical
Investigation, by Means of Arithmetical and Simple
Algebraical Equations and Practical Examples, also
the Methods of Analysing Principles and Deducing
Rules and Formulas, Applicable to the Requirements
of Practice," by Francis Campin, C.E.
The first of these books is strictly practical, the
second as strictly theoretical, and though both
are most useful and deserve a place on the book-
shelves of amateur workmen, the practical work is
undoubtedly that which will prove most interesting
and most eagerly sought after and read by those who
are of a practical turn of mind, and are seeking for
information on the practices of skilled artisans in the
various branches of the building trades. To make a
good joint as strong as it can possibly be, having
regard to the material of which it is made, the circum-
stances under which it is made and the requirements
it is bound to satisfy, is one of the best proofs that a
man can adduce to show that he is a good workman,
and under the tutelage of Mr. Christy, backed by a
necessary amount of practice, no careful and pains-
taking amateur can fail in accomplishing whatever he
may desire to effect in this line. The joints peculiar
to each trade are arranged alphabetically in separate
sections, and the sections are sixteen in number,
devoted severally, and in order, to joints used in drain-
age, and those used by bricklayers, masons, tilers,
slaters, carpenters, smiths, joiners, plasterers, plumbers,
zinc-workers, coppersmiths, glaziers, gas-fitters, paper-
hangers, and paviors. The book has a capital index,
and is illustrated with one hundred and sixty-five
diagrams which admirably elucidate the text and
render its meaning perfectly clear. Mr. Campin's
work, which has reached a second edition, covers the
whole field of mathematics, and being concise and
tersely written is superior to many received text-books
of far greater bulk.
If any amateur has anything that he wishes to
bronze, let him write to Messrs. B. F. Brown and Co.,
18 and 19,
Norman's Buildings, St. Luke's, London,
for a sample bottle of
"
American Magic Bronze,"
which can be sent by post, as it is supplied in a tightly
corked, wide-mouthed bottle, which is enclosed in a
neat case, on which are the necessary directions for
using the fluid. On testing it, I find that it can be
used with good effect on ornaments of all kinds,
picture-frames, and iron and fancy work generally, as
well as on leather. Attached to the cork in each
bottle is a brush with which the bronze is applied.
All that is necessary in using it is to have the article
to be bronzed perfectly dry and warm. A light coat of
the fluid must be applied, and the article must not be
touched until the coating of bronze has thoroughly
hardened. The smell is not pleasant, being very much
ANOTHER SCALE FOR POLYGONS.
333
like that of naphtha, but this soon goes oft". When
first put on, the bronzing liquid has a dark purple
colour, which gradually changes to an excellent bronze
tint as it dries, having a fine metallic lustre. 1 tested
it on a piece of iron, on the end grain of a piece of
beechwood, and on paper. The effect on the iron and
wood was excellent, but not so good on the paper, owing,
I believe, to my having rubbed the brush up and
down over the surface of the paper too much, instead of
giving it a light coat, as directed. It can be obtained of
most chemists in the United Kingdom, and it ought
to be found at the oil and colour houses. I am unable
to state the price per bottle, which I regret, as the
preparation is clearly a most useful one ; but a post-
card to Messrs. B. F. Brown and Co., whose address
I have given, will soon elicit the desired information.
Mr. A. S. Lunt, Saw, Plane, Tool, and Cutlery
Manufacturer, 297,
Hackney Road, London, ., sends
for notice a small handy mitre box or mitreing block,
similar to that which is shown on page
303,
in Fig.
3
of the illustrations to Mr. Parkinson's paper on
making a double dark slide. This mitre box is sold
at a shilling ; and as the saw-kerfs in the specimen
before me are true, it is cheap at the money, and will
serve the purpose of a more expensive apparatus. It
is made of beech, and is
9
inches long by 24 inches in
width, and about the same in depth ; it is rabbeted to
the depth of
1
J inch each way, and has two saw-kerfs
to act as guides in mitreing the ends of a piece of wood
at an angle of
45
degrees, in opposite directions, and
another in the centre for squaring off the end of a
piece of wood, if necessary. It is chiefly serviceable
for dealing with pieces of wood not wider than the
rabbet or rebatethat is to say, 1
\
inches. To make
it available for pieces wider than this, it will be better
to screw down to the bench top a piece of hard wood
exactly equal in height, to the depth of the rabbeted
portion of the mitre box, and then bring this part of
the box tightly against the stop thus screwed on to the
top of the bench when using the box. The stop will
act as a support for the wood that is to be mitred, and
the operator need only hold the wood firmly down on
the combined surface of the rabbet end stop, pressing
it tightly against the side of that part of the mitre box
which projects upwards, and through which the saw-
kerfs are made.
From Messrs. R. Melhuish and Sons, 85 and
87,
Fetter Lane, London, E.C, I have received two
novelties in the form of fasteners for cupboard doors
and other light doors. Both are of bronze, neatly
finished, but as each has some special peculiarity in
its constructional must describe them separately.
The smaller catch, which is admirably suited for
cupboards in kitchens, bed-rooms, etc., consists of two
bronze shells, one of which is to be fastened to one
valve of the cupboard door, and the other to the other,
if there be double doors ; or one to the door and the
other to that part of the frame against which the door
falls and closes. Let us suppose that the two pieces
are fixed exactly opposite to each other, and close to
the edge of the door and the frame ; suppose, further,
that the door is open. In the part on the door frame
there is a projection in the shape of a quadrant of a
circle, hollow, and having the mouth outwards. In
the part that is screwed on to the door there is a catch
held in position by a spring made of coiled wire and
attached to the interior. The projecting part of the
catch is bevelled downwards and inwards. When the
door is thrown to, the bevelled catch strikes against
the projection on the other piece, and is pressed back
by it, the spring y ielding to the pressure. As soon as
the catch has passed the edge of the projection, the
pressure on the spring is withdrawn, and the catch
drops into the hollow within the projection, thus
closing and fastenin
g
the door until it is pressed back
by anyone who desires to open the cupboard. In the
larger catch the principle is the same, the catch being
acted on by a coiled spring, but in this the catch,
whose outer end is bevelled so as to be pressed back
by the hollow projection against which it falls, and
into which it enters, assumes the form of a bolt,
which moves backwards and forwards instead of
moving on a pin as in the smaller latch. It is fitted
with a knob by which the bolt can be drawn back
when it is desired to open the door. This larger catch
will be found useful as a latch for trellis doors, for it
may be opened from the other side by means of a
piece of copper wire having one end attached to the
knob of the bolt, and the other to a brass ring. If the
trellis be too small to permit the hand to pass through
it, the wire should be passed to the outside and be
left without a ring. The price of each catch is 3d.
ANOTHER SCALE FOR POLYGONS.
N the April part of this Magazine there
appeared a paper describing some scales
for polygons, by which the length of a
side, the diameter across corners (that is,
the diameter of the circumscribing cir-
cle), and various other dimensions of regular polygons
may be obtained by use of a pair of dividers or a
pocket rule. The diagrams illustrated are very good
in their way, and doubtless were of interest to those
who read them. In the accompanying diagram is
a similar device, which certainly possesses some
advantages over those which have already appeared.
It combines in one diagram what in the preceding
334
ANOTHER SCALE FOR POL YGONS.
description is obtained from
two, and as it represents the
full half of any given poly-
gon, it admits of the length
of a side being obtained by
one operation. In the dia-
grams already given only the
half of a side is shown, and
it is necessary to double
this in order to get the full
length.
Referring to the drawing,
a common centre line
marked C S, as it shows the
centre of the side of any polj
-
gon included in the figureex-
tends horizontally across the
scale, and is divided into
eighths of an inch. The ver-
tical line bounding the scale
at the left is similarly divided,
and the spaces are numbered
each way from the horizontal
centre line. Through the
points of division in each
of these, lines are drawn
horizontally and vertically
across the scale. From the
assumed centre Omarked
thus with the letter that most
resembles the sign which
denotes zero, or nothing in
arithmetic, because the
spaces are numbered up-
wards and downwards from
this as a starting-point
"Take half a
bushel of good unslaked lime
; slake it
with boiling water, covering it during the
process to keep in the steam. Strain the
liquor through a fine sieve or strainer, and
add to it a peck of clean salt, previously
dissolved in warm water, three pounds of
good rice, ground to a thin paste, and
stirred in while boiling hot, half a pound
of powdered Spanish whiting, and a pound
of clean glue, which has been previously
dissolved by first soaking it well, and then
hanging it over a slow fire, in a small kettle,
or pot, within a large one filled with water.
Add five gallons of hot water to the mix-
ture, stir it well, and let it stand for a few
days, covered from dirt. It should be put
on quite hot, and for this purpose it can
be kept in a kettle on a portable furnace.
It is said that one pint of this mixture
will cover a square yard upon the outside
of a house, if properly applied. It re-
tains its brilliancy for years."
Bla:k Fluid for Ebonislng.
D. H. G. (Bath).The iron rust should
be added to the fluid before it is used.
It will be sufficient to throw as many nails
as will fill, say quarter pint, into the half
pint of vinegar. There are no exact pro-
portions fur this mixture.
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
337
Papers from Amateurs.
H. E. H. (S&utkport).Papers by
amateurs are gladly received and inserted.
Indeed, one of the chief objects of this
magazine is to furnish a means of inter-
communication for amateurs, by which
they may help one another with accounts
of their various experiences. Any ama-
teur may send recipes for insertion in
"
Ways and Means." Questions to be
answered by amateurs themselves are
inserted. With regard to your queries :
(i and 2.) The manufacture of an
aquarium and an air-tight cabinet for
butterflies must be treated in papers
specially written on these subjects. (3.)
See the remarks on staining and ebonising
wood in
"
Notes on Novelties'' in Parts
V. and VI. (4.) Articles on fret-sawing
machines have been promised and will
appear in due course.
(5.)
The probable
cost of the lathe, being described in
"Lathe-Making for Amateurs" will be
stated by Mr. Hasluck when he brings
his papers to a completion.
Bse-Keeping-.
Inquirer.The roof slips over the top
of the hive like the lid of a biscuit box
does, only instead of the sides being
equal all round they are made sloping
like a writing desk, this gives a slope to
the flat top in order to shed the rain off,
as shown in Fig. 2. A block of wood L,
Fig. 2, nailed to the inside of the roof
sides, keeps it from slipping down too
id.x. The diagrams are correct, the depth
of the hive being shown the same in both
;
study them, as well as the instructions
carefully again. A stock or swarm of
Italian bees could be had from Abbott
Brothers, Fairlawn, Southall, but the best
way would be to buy an Italian Queen
and introduce ; see "Modern Bee-Keep-
jng,*' 6d. , or "British Bee-Keepers' Guide
Book," is. 6d. , for instructions.
W. C. S. [Staines). Full instructions
how to hive a swarm in a bar-frame hive
have been given to another correspon-
dent. See also last paragraph of answer
to Inquirer.
Badly-Built House, etc.
DELTA {Barnard Castle) is thanked
for his recipes, which appear in
'
' Ways
and Means.'
1
(1.) The house he occu-
pies, and which was run up by contract,
was in all probability thrown together
by a
"
jerry builder. " The bricks
are no doubt as bad as the mortar.
There are two ways of mitigating the evil,
one is to cover the walls with a coating of
cement, the other to rake out the mortar
between the bricks, and point the walls,
using some solution, such as Silicate
Zopissa, to make the bricks impervious to
rain. (2.) A good brown stain for wood
may be made of boiling 1 part of catechu
in 30 parts of water with a little soda.
The wood must be painted with this mix-
ture and allowed to dry in the air, after
which it must be washed with a solution
of 1 part of bichromate of potash and 30
parts of water.
(3.)
Send a drawing to
scale and description of your fret-sawing
machine.
Cleaning Brass, etc.
S. B. Y. asks no less than five questions,
and this gives me an opportunity of saying
that correspondents should not, ifpossible,
put more than one question at a time, and
to avoid asking such things as can only
be explainedin long and elaborate papers,
(r.) Brass may be polished with a little
rot'en stone and oil applied with chamois
leather.
(2.) Marble may be cleaned by
mixing soap lees with quick lime, until it
assumes the consistence of thin cream, lay
it on the marble and let it remain for
twenty-four hours, when it may be re-
moved and the work completed by rubbing
the marble with a mixture of fine putty
powder and olive oil.
(3.)
Steel goods
may be cleaned with unslacked lime or
with finely powdered brick-dust and olive
oil.
(4.
) For the tools necessary for wood-
carving, see "Wood - carving for
Amateurs
"
in this part.
(5.) Everything
interesting to amateurs will be treated
as opportunity offers, in .the pages of
this magazine.
Whitewashing Ceilings, etc.
Zero.It is not possible to answer
queries by post. Every answer is and must
be given pro bono publico. First, wash
every particle of dirt from your ceiling
with water applied freely with a broad
brush used in whitewashing. To make
whitewash : mix whiting with cold water
sufficient to produce a stiff paste. To
this add some size which has been dis-
solved in hot water, and a small quantity
of blue black ground to a fine powder.
Add sufficient warm water to bring the
mixture to the consistency of thick cream,
and let it stand until cold before using it.
Full instructions for preparing walls for
painting will be given in due course, but
it is utterly impossible to supply all the
information for which you ask in the
compass of a reply here, which must of
necessity be as brief as possible. You
will have learnt how to stain and varnish
your floors from articles that have already
appeared in this magazine.
Lathe for Sale.
R. R. (Taunton) has a lathe for sale,
which he will dispose of for ^3. He des-
cribes it as a 3-feet lathe, on an iron
frame, with a three-grooved bell metal
pulley, and three-grooved driving-wheel,
for slow and fast work. Headstocks
slide on an iron bar, face-plates, centres,
and drills in gocd condition. The con-
ditions of our Exchange Column will
appear shortly.
Picture-frames, etc.
J.
H. (Brigkto?/). A paper on the con-
struction of picture-frames will be given
shortly. Articles from your pen. giving
your experience in different kinds of
work that can be done by amateurs
will be inserted, if they are up to the
mark. If Judson's Gold Paint will not
serve your purpose, you must gild your
work with leaf-gold, judson s Gold Paint
and Artists' Black look well in contrast.
When opportunity offers, a paper will be
given on mounting maps, prints, etc., and
cleaning and remounting old prints.
Looking-Glass for Cabinets.
Bric-a-brac. The quickest and easiest
mode of procuring small pieces of silvered
glass for brackets would be to purchase a
small looking-glass, which maybe bought
for is. or is. 6d., and have it cut to size
by any oilman who supplies glass.
Bevelled panels for cabinets may be pro-
cured through an upholsterer, or of
Messrs. A. and F. Ponzini and Co.,
22, Hatton Garden, of whom looking-
glass may be bought by the foot super.
House-painting.
J.
S. (Hanley). Papers on this impor-
tant and interesting subject, will be given
at the earliest possible opportunity.
Making Casts from Clay Models.
G. I. W. (Plymouth) and W. M.
(Blackburn). An article is in preparation
on the subject of making plaster casts
from models in clay, which will form a
suitable pendant to the papers on
"
Modelling in Clay" that have already
appeared. There is no other material
that can be used as clay is used for
making models.
Compound Stain and Varnish.
AMATEUR (Openshaw) sends the
following recipe for a preparation that
will act as a stain and varnish combined :
\
gill distilled spirits of naphtha,
\
gill of
finish, 1 oz. benzine, ^oz. gum thrush
(?),
2 oz. shell-lac,
\ oz. dragon's blood
; this
last ingredient to be added after the
shell-lac is dissolved. The mixture is
to be applied with a camel hair brush.
Will our correspondent explain what he^
means by "gum thrush?" A grooving
plane is required for grooving and tongu-
ing, stop chamfering may be done with
a plane and chisel, the latter being used
to make the incision at each end of the
chamfered edge.
Model Gas Engines.
L. W. E. (Market Harborovgh).
Papers will be given on this subject as
well as on the use of gas for setting
machinery in motion.
Polishing Wood.
J.
CROOK (Fairfield) will find that in
order to procure a smooth surface, in
polished wood, it is necessary to stop the
pores, etc., with some kind of wocd-filler.
.3 33
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
Sun-Dlal.
Tempus Fugit asks for directions for
making a horizontal sun-dial. A paper
on this subject shall be given.
Home-made Refrigerator.
R. S. V. (Hampstead).The following
description of an ice-box or refrigerator
may be of service to you. It is taken
from an American pap-r. The writer
says: "I made a rough box of inch
board about 28 in. long, 14 in. wide, and
16 in. deep. I then covered the outside
with about six or eight la\ers of news-
paper, and nailed an outside casing tight
over the paper all round. Less room is
taken up this way than by packing with
sawdust or chare >al, which require 3 or
4
inches between the box and the outer
casing. The mare the layers of paper
that are put on the better non-conductor
of heat will the box be, and the longer
A
A
HOME-MADE REFRIGERATOR.
will the ice keep. I put feet to it about
6 in. or 8 in. high, so as to give plenty
of space to get the drip-pan under it.
This done, I lined the box with zinc,
which, if kept clean, will not oxidise, so
poison the food. I admit tin is cleaner
if it would not rust so quick. In the
centre of the inner box I hung a zinc pan
for ice, with a waste-pipe in the centre,
running through the bottom of the box,
arranged with a trap applied at the ex-
treme end of the tube. This pan I made
14 in. long, 10 in. wide, and 10 in. deep.
On each side of the pan I put wire
gratings, upon which the food can be
placed, as the space below can be used
for those things which ought to be the
coldest. I had two holes, 1 in. in diame-
ter, cut through the ends of the box
;
these are lined with zinc tubes, and
covered on the outside with perforated
tin, in order to keep any insects from
getting into the box. The lid is made in
the same manner as the box, and can be
attached to it by hinges. This box of
mine, which is constructed as described
above, has been in use about eight years,
and, to judge from its appearance, is
good for many years to come. With
8 lbs. of ice per day, through the hottest
days of summer, we never had anything
spoiled yet, and there is always a lump
of ice in the ice-box in the morning when
tha ice-man comes." The construction
of the box is clearly shown in the annexed
diagram, in which the line a a a A round
the edge of the box represents the paper
linuig ; F, the ice box, or tray ; c C, the
wire gratings, one on each side of the
tray; D D, openings in the sides for
ventilation ; E, the drain-pipe from the
ice-box ; and f, the trap at the bottom of
the drain-pipe. A portion of th^ front
is supposed to be removed to show the
interior of the box and its fittings. The
cuver is not shown, but it is hinged to
the back of the box. It would be an
improvement if the zinc-lined caver were
made with a ledge all round, so that the
inner projecting portion were thicker
than the edge, and entered about & inch
into the box. In order to do this the
zinc pan B must not be flush with the
edge of the box, but be dropped h inch
below it.
Soap Manufacture.
Subscriber {Holton). The caustic
soda mentioned in the. article on this sub-
ject, to which you refer, is manufactured
by an American firm. If it is not made
in this country, the American article will
soon find its way here. In the meantime
I will endeavour to find out for you how
and where it can be obtained.
Cutting Edges of Books
B. B. {Oakham).Everyone to his
taste of course, but when serials are sent
out with cut edges they are spoiled for
binding, as the binder will take off some
more and thus reduce the margin of each
page to too great an extent.
Bevelling Edges of Boards, etc.
E. B. {Dublin) puts the following query :
"
Suppose I want to make a drawing of
anything,
3
feet
5
inches long by 1 foot
7 inches high or wide. I take a scale of
3
inches to the foot. By that scale a line
(on paper)
9
inches long would represent
3 feet, though in actual work it must be
36 inches long. What part of the 3 inch
scale represents the
5
additional inches in
length, of the 7 inches in height or width?
As the foot is divided into 12 inches, you
must divide the 3 inches which represent
1 foot on your scale into 12 equal parts.
These parts which in the case in question
are quarters of inches wide will represent
inches, and
5
of these parts will represent
the 5 additional inches in length and
7
the 7
inches in height or width. Thus
according to your scale of
3 inches to the
foot, the measurements
3
feet
5 inches
and 1 foot 7 inches in actual work will be
represented on paper by lines measuring
io inches and
4J
inches. With regard
to the mode of bevelling the sides and
bottom of a hexagonal card tray so that
they may be fitted accurately together,
X
C
A D
/
it
F C. I.JUNCTION OF
BOARDS AT RIGHT
ANGLES.
the operation is less difficult than it
appears to be. It is not possible, however,
to go fully into the matter here, but a
paper on this subject shall be given to
meet the difficulty experienced by your-
self and, doubtless, many others. All that
can be done now is to give you a broad idea
of the method of procedure. Suppose that
x and Y (Fig.
1) represent in
section two
boards whose
edges you with
to join by bevel-
ling away the
angles so thai,
they may be
accurately
fitted together
at right angles-
The boards are
assumed to be
of the same thickness, and this beiiv* the
case, A B = B D. On the side of
X mark off B c
= A B and on ihe side
of Y mark off B E =B r>, and do this at each
end of the side of the piece of wood to
be bevelled. Dr*w a line, joining the
points thus obtained, and then with a
plane remove the edge B in each board,
continuing the operation until you have
planed away the wood down to the line
A c in X, and D E in Y. When the edges
of the boards are brought together A C
will fit accurately against D E, and the
boards will be right angles to one another.
This is the broad principle on which you
must proceed. Of course, the greater the
angle of inclination that the boards must
have one to the other, the less will be the
substance that must be removed with ihe
plane. To find tie bevtl in any case,
FIG, 2. BEVELLING EDGES OF BOARDS
FOR JUNCTION AT AN ANGLE OTHER
THAN A RIGHT ANGLE.
having laid down on paper the angle at
which the boards are to be joined, as at
A B c in Fig. 2, make A B = B c, jo
;
n
A c and divide it into two equal parts in
the point D. Join B D, producing it at the
end D. The edges of the boards to be
joined must therefore be bevelled by plan-
ing until sufficient has been taken away,
to bring the rectangular edges of the
boards to be joined to the angle A B D
in one case, and the angle c B a in the
other.
V
PRESENTED Wlfll^fiART VIII. OF
AMAt M$
;"
IkMSfMfSB.
n
ELEVATION OF LEFT HAND END ELEVATION OF RIGHT HAND END
OR UPRIGHT OF SIDEBOARD.
'
OR UPRIGHT OF SIDEBOARD.
ELEVATION OF UPRIGHT
TO LEFT OF LARGE UPPER
SHELVES.
PANELS OF DCORS CARVED IN LOW RELIEF. FULL SIZE.
>
B.
"1
/
\
ELEVATION OF UPRKHT TO LEFT OF SMALL SHELVES AND LOCKERS
ON RIOHT OF SIDEBOARD.
PB NEO-JAPANESE STYLE.
) WHITE.
^CTPt
HOW TO BUILD A SMALL HARMONIUM.
339
HOW TO BUILD A SMALL HARMONIUM.
By TSOHAS MAIN.
I. The Case and its Interior: the Feeders, Valve
Boards, Wind-Trunks, and Reservoir.
ipSjSJTHE
great interest that has been created by
f:Js? the papers on the construction of the
organ, by another writer, leads me to
think that there are many amateurs who,
though unable to avail themselves of
those instructions, on account of the skill required,
thick at the other. You cannot be too particular as to
the quality and soundness of the wood, and it is far
better to pay a few. pence more fc(r it than to use
cheaper but inferior material. This wood must be
thoroughly well seasoned.; and in order to insure its
being thoroughly dry, keep it in a warm roombut
not too near a fire for some weeks/before proceeding
to work it.
While the wood is drying you may purchase the
vibrators, or reeds, which can be obtained at most
harmonium-builders. Buy a good set of
54
notes, C C
in the bass to F in the treble, being a\ octaves. I
Fig. 4
(Scale, 2in.
to loot).
Fig. 2.
(Scali,
f
inch to foot)
Fig. 1.
(Scale,
-J
in. to foot).
(1.
I.edge ; 3.
Bottom Block; 4. Groove for Front Panel).
.RDS TO CARRY F !RS. FlG. 3.VALVE BOARDS FOR FEEDERS. FlG. 4.
- SHAPE OF
PECEsToRSlDEfOF FEEDER
FIG. S--SHAPE OF PIECES FOR ENDS OF FEEDER FlG 6.-PA R OF RS (Black
:
line at
PIECES FOR i'DES OF^ti-u . 3
Arrangement of ]NTER r R r, i. Feeders; z. Reservoirs
; 3. Wind-chest
;
1
P
, In ll Sprfn's
"
< Supports for Crank ; 6, 6. Cranks
; 7, 7
. Cords for Connecting Ends of dank Levers to Foot-
boards
P
; 8 S.Wmd-'tmnks ; 9,
9- Blocks or Cheeks ; 10. Safety Valve
;
11. Peg to open Valve).
and the bulk of the instrument, would be very glad to
receive instructions for making a musical instrument
of less pretensions. I therefore propose in this series
of papers to give such instructions as will enable any
amateur possessing a little skill in the use of car-
penters tools to construct a small harmonium.
The harmonium, as most of my readers are, no
doubt, aware, differs from the organ in having reeds
or vibrato*, as they are termedinstead of pipes,
and as the. reeds take but little room, the instrument
is much more portable.
The first thing to be done will be to purchase
about 1 aft. of f-in. pine, about a foot wide, and a plank
of^good' sound beech, 3
feet long, 7
inches wide, 2
inches thick at one end, and running off to
J
inch
may remark that the reeds run from 12s. 6d. to 25s. a
set, according to quality, and can be purchased,
together with leather for the bellows, and all other re-
quisites, at Mr. Willis's, 29,
Minories, London. At the
same time, you had better purchase the screws (about
1 5 dozen being required), for screwing the reeds to the
sound-board. See that the reeds are well riveted, or
they will soon get slack, and become the source of
much trouble.
Now you may see about the case, which it is neces-
sary to get ready first, as the bellows and other parts
are fitted to and supported by it. The wood may be
any sort you like; pine, oak, mahogany, walnut, or
rosewood being equally suitable. First make the ends,
which are 2 feet 7
inches high, and about 12 inches
UsD
340
HOW TO BUILD A SMALL HARMONIUM.
wide in the narrowest part, and i inch thick. The
top portion, to a depth of 7 inches, projects about 2
inches at the front. This wider portion must be
thickened by glueing and screwing a prepared block,
2 inches thick, on to the inside. The bottom part
should also be blocked out to the same thickness, and
3
inches in depth. These blocks need not be solid,
but may be made of f-inch stuff, and then veneered
over where they will be in sight. An ornamental truss
may be placed under the front of the top block, or
cheek, or a turned pillar may run from the under-side
of the top block to the top of the bottom one, which
will form a base for it. Now glue and screw a ledge
of wood,
f
inch wide and
3
inches deep, to each end,
to support the bellows. These ledges, and likewise
the cheeks, should not extend right across the end,
but to within half an inch of the back, so as to allow
the dust panel, or back, to be fitted in. A glance at
Figs. I and 7 will explain these operations.
Now prepare a panel of f-inch stuff for the front,
3 feet 3
inches long, and 2 feet high, with an opening
cut in the bottom part, 1 foot 8 inches long, and 8 inches
high, to allow the feet to be placed on the foot-boards.
This panel is let into the under-side of the cheeks,
or blocks, about \ inch.
Prepare a board
4 inches wide, 3 feet 4 inches long,
and I inch thick, and screw it at the bottom of the
lower blocks, so that it may come right to the front,
and lay flat on the floor. This is the foundation-
board, on which the foot-boards for blqwing will be
hinged.
Now take two boards,
3 feet 3
inches long, and fix
one to the top cheeks at the back, and one at the
bottom.
We now proceed to fit up the interior of the case.
First prepare two boards, 3 feet 2 inches long, 1
1
inches wide, and at least \ inch thick, to carry the
feeders and reservoir. Plane them very true and
smooth, then cut two holes in each, 6 inches long and
I inch wide, at a distance of
3
inches from each end.
Fig. 2 shows the under-side of the board to carry the
feeders, with two spiral springs fitted to it, and the
holes cut in it for the wind-trunks. The springs are
to cause the feeder to open when released from the
pressure of the foot, and are termed
"
gape-springs."
They may be made by cutting an ordinary spiral chair-
spring in half, and placing each half in the position
shown.
The feeders next claim our attention. The under
or valve boards are each 1 foot 4 inches long, loj
inches wide, and
f
inch thick. Bore four holes 1 \
inch
diameter through them, as shown in Fig. 3. These
holes are to be covered by valves, which must be made
as follows :
Glue two thicknesses of leather together
soft side outwards), leaving one thickness an inch
wider than the other
;
place them between two flat
boards to dry, and then cut them to size, and glue the
single thickness down to the valve-board, thus forming
a hinge to the valve. The valves may each be made
to cover two holes, so that only two valves will be
needed for each feeder. They should be \ inch larger
all round than the holes which they cover.
The valve-boards should now be hinged on to the
feeder-board, and for this purpose a strip of '-inch
wood, 1 1 inch wide, is to be glued and screwed on to
the under-side of the feeder-board, and a similar strip
on to the inside end of the valve-board. The valve-
board may be hinged either with brass butt-hinges, or
a strip of leather inside and out. Many prefer the latter
mode, as there is no liability to squeak.
The folds of the feeder may now be got out of
!-inch board. You will require eight pieces like Fig.
4
for the sides, and four pieces like Fig.
5
for the ends.
The ends of each fold are cut to an angle of about 40 .
I have set these out very carefully in the sketches, and
figured the sizes on them, as it is very important that
they should be accurately made, or the feeders will be
the source of constant annoyance and trouble. Pro-
cure some very soft, supple, white sheepskin, and cut
it into strips (lengthways from the neck), about \\ inch
wide. Cut some strips of linen, about \\ inch wide
;
these should be cut across the stuff. Stand each pair
of ribs side by side, with their short edges about
T
3
5
inch apart, which you may secure by placing a strip of
stout cardboard between them, and glue a strip of
linen over the edges, as shown in Fig. 6. The linen
will thus be on the inside when the folds are attached
to the feeders. Let this dry, and then glue a strip of
leather on the other side of the joint, grain side out-
wards. Then glue similar strips on the outside of the
top and bottom edges, so that half the width of the
leather overhangs all round. Fasten the spiral springs
in their proper position on the valve-board, and then
glue the overhanging leather of the folds on to the
valve-board and feeder-board. The inside must also
have strips of linen on the joints, which you will be
able to rub down with a strip of wood inserted through
the corner holes where the gussets will be put on.
When you have attached all the folds to the feeder
and feeder-board, and well rubbed down all the leather,
to make it adhere perfectly all over, let it dry tho-
roughly. Now open the feeder to its full width, and
cut a paper pattern of the gussets ;
then cut them out
in leather, and, after paring all the edges with a sharp
knife, glue the gussets on, and rub them down well.
A small triangular gusset-piece will be required for
each corner where the valve-boards are hinged ; and
if brass hinges are used, a strip of leather 'must be
glued all along the joint, to make it perfectly air-tigiit.
When all this is done, clean off the leather with a
HO W I MADE MY TELEPHONES. 34i
sponge dipped in hot water, and then cover all the
wood-work of the feeders with coloured or ornamental
paper, and they will then look very neat.
Now make the two wind-trunks of thin wood; they
are 65 inches high, and slightly larger internally than
the wind-holes.
The reservoir should now be made, and as it is
merely a rectangular bellows, with each fold 2 s inches
wide, I need not give directions in detail for construct-
ing it. Cut the ends of each fold to an angle of 40', the
same as the ends of the feeders. The bottom boird of
the bellows will be
f
or
f
inch thick, and a safety-valve
must be made in it in the position shown in Fig. 7.
This may be about 25 inches square, and covered by a
valve of thin wood, lined with soft leather (soft side out-
wards), one end of which overhangs about an inch, and
is glued down to form a hinge. The valve is kept closed
by a spring fastened through a little staple on the
valve. A peg of wood, about 23 inches high, is fixed
in the feeder-board immediately under the valve
; so
that as the bellows descends, the peg presses the valve
open, and allows a little wind to escape, thus prevent-
ing undue pressure on the reservoir. A spiral spring
is fixed to the centre of the under-side of the reser-
voir, and to the top of the feeder-board. This spring
exerts a constant pressure on the reservoir, and gives
the force of wind necessary to cause the reeds to sound.
A careful study of the foregoing instructions and
the sketches will enable the amateur to fully compre-
hend the construction thus far. In my next paper I
will explain how the wind-chest, pallets, etc., are made.
(To be continued?)
HOW I MADE MY TELEPHONES, AND GOT
THEM TO WORK IN MY HOUSE.
By a. S. SATER.
*>
I.Making the Parts of the Telephone, and putting
them together.
Y the above title my readers will under-
stand that it is not my intention to enter
into any deep scientific description of
the telephone, as that would be out of
place in AmateurWork, I llustrated
;
but, at the same time, feeling sure that no real ama-
teur would wish to make anything without understand-
ing a little of the principle and theory of the work he
has in hand, I will in a few words endeavour to explain
the action of the telephone so far as I can, without
using technical or obtuse terms, referring those who
wish to have a complete theoretical description to
any of the numerous text-books upon magnetism and
electricity.
The articulating telephone was brought to its pre-
sent state of perfection in 1876, by Professor Graham
Bell, of Boston ; and Fig. 2 gives a correct view of
his telephone, both as regards size and shape, the
magnet alone excepted, which, instead of being a plain
round bar of magnetised steel, as I have shown, is, in
the Bell Telephone, a sort of compound one.
Thanks chiefly to the immortal Faraday, we now
know that magnetism and electricity, if not exactly
one and the same thing, are very closely related to
each other
;
for by electricity we can produce mag-
netism, and by magnetism we can obtain electricity,
the telephone coming under this latter head.
All magnets affect the atmosphere around them,
creating a kind of magnetic influence or power, which
is easily seen by their effect on needles or small bits
of iron placed near them, it not being at all necessary
for the magnet to toicch the needle to exhibit this force;
and, inversely, a piece of iron brought near a magnet
will affect it, or alter its magnetic power. Now the
voice, thrown on to the small iron disc, causes, by the
waves of sound, this disc to vibrate ; and as it vibrates,
it goes nearer and farther from the end of the magnet,
thereby altering the magnetic power or atmosphere
surrounding it. This alteration of power causes minute
currents of electricity to flow through the coil of fine
wire around the magnet, the currents varying in exact
proportion to the vibrations of the disc ; and as they
flow along the wire to the telephone at the other end,
they in the same manner alter the power of the mag-
net there. This magnet, becoming thus made stronger
or weaker, attracts and repels the iron disc near it, or,
in other words, sets it vibrating ; and these vibrations
create small waves of sound, which strike on the ear
of the person listening, giving a complete and perfect
phonetic copy of the person's voice at the first
telephone.
From the above description it will be seen that the
telephone consists of six principal parts :
1. The Magnet.
2. The Case, or Holder.
3.
The Box.
4. The Reel of Silk-covered Wire.
5. The Disc.
6. The Mouthpiece, or Cover of Box.
I will now take each in its order, and describe how
I obtained or made them; and in doing so, I wish it
to be understood that I endeavoured to do it all as
simply and cheaply as possible, consistent with the
actual working of the instrument, leaving it to my
readers to make any improvements they may like
;
and those who have lathes will soon find ample scope
for their ingenuity when once they have mastered the
principle of this most wonderful invention.
First and foremost comes the magnet. This I
34*
HO W I MADE MY TELEPHONES.
purchased at an optician's for 9a
1
., and it consisted of
a round bar of well magnetised steel,
4
inches long,
and
inch in diameter.
Some of my readers may CX-
_
' "
'
-\\
prefer making their own
;
but as they must purchase
the steel, and possess a
powerful magnet to mag-
netise it with, I do not
advise them to do so,
especially as they can
obtain one ready made
for so small a sum.
The case, or holder,
can be made with No.
3
(the box,), all in one piece
who have a lathe will find it best to do
so, turning the whole up as shown in
Fig. 2. But I made them separately
as follows :
For the case I obtained
a good piece of hard wood, about
4 J
inches long, and sufficiently thick to
plane up to 1 1 inches square, which
I did, taking off the sharp corners.
Right through the centre of this,
lengthways, I bored with my brace
and bit a hole large enough for my
magnet to fit into. As it is better to
have the magnet fit tightly into the
hole, should you not have a bit the
exact size, use one the next size
smaller, and then enlarge the hole
with a rat-tail file. Care should be
taken that the hole is right through
the centre of the wood
; and should
your bit be rather short, bore from
each end half-way, and then clean out
the hole with the round file, or a small
gouge.
Now put your case on one side
for a short time, and pro-
ceed to make the box.
This I obtained from a
chemist's, and was one
that had had tooth-pow-
der in it. It was made
of turned wood, and
measured
3 inches in
diameter, and ij inches
deep, cover and all, and,
being thick and strong,
Droved iu-t tl
fig. 3.section of top of wooden box, before adaptation.
article. In the bottom of the box I cut a hole, 1 inch ] made article. I obtained
FIG. I. THE AMATEUR S
A.
B.
C.
The Magnet.
The Case.
The Box.
D. The Ree'.
E. The Disc.
F. The Mouth.piece.
square, and in the cover I cut a large circular hole,
leaving only a ledge all round, about
J-
inch wide. I
will afterwards show how I made this cover into the
mouthpiece; but before doing so, let us finish the case,
,. which I will now return
to. When laid aside, it
was a piece of wood,
45
inches long and ii inches
square, in section, with
a inch hole right through
its centre from end to end.
Measure the thickness of
wood in the bottom of
the box, where you made
the 1 -inch square hole,
and mark it off from one
end of the case by a
pencil line on each of the four sides,
but allowing about
tV inch over. Then
on the square end of the case mark
around the hole a square of I inch.
Now with your tenon saw cut through
your marks, till those on the end meet
those on the sides
; or, in other words,
reduce the end of the case to 1 inch
square for a distance of rk inch more
than the thickness of wood in the
bottom of the box. It will now fit into
the bottom of the box, and project
inside tV inch, and the two together
will appear as in Fig. 1.
The next thing is the reel, or
bobbin, with its coil of fine silk-covered
wire. I found in my wife's work-box
a small reel, which was the very thing
wanted. It had had red cotton or
silk on it, and was about half the
length of the ordinary thread-reels,
being
5 inch long over all, and the
flanges were
inch in diameter. The
hole through it I enlarged to exactly
the same size as the one through the
case, so that the magnet
fitted tightly into it.
Around this reel must
now be wound the wire,
or coil, as it is called.
This wire must be
purchased, as few, if any,
amateurs could make it,
and even if they could it
would not be worth their
while, as it would cost
them more than the ready
some at the same shop
bought the magnet. About forty or fifty
TELEPHONE. FULL
VIEW.
SIZZ SECTIONAL
G. Plug of Wood
H. India-rubber
Ring.
where I
yards is amply sufficient for one telephone, and this
HO W I MADE MY TELEPHONES.
343
costs about jd. or 6d. It is so exceedingly light that
they sell it by weight, at about is. per ounce, and
I found that one ounce contained
about ninety yards. The copper wire
j
is No. 36, Birmingham Wire Gauge.
To wind it around the reel, first of all
bore a small hole with a bradawl
through one flange of the reel, as close
to the body as you can, and pass the
end of the wire through it from the
inside. Leave about six or seven
inches through, and then wind the rest
around as neatly as you can.
So long as you wind in one direc-
tion only, it does not matter about the
layers not being quite even, but it looks
better to keep them straight, and you
will be able to wind more around than
if you place them anyhow. Be careful
not to handle the wire roughly, nor to
fray the silk, as it would prove fatal to
success if the wire became exposed in
two or three places, so as to allow
these parts to form contact, or copper
to touch copper, as then the electric
current would take a short road
through this contact instead of going
round and round the reel by the whole
coil.
When you have wound round as
much as the reel will takethat is
level with its flangesfinish off at the
same end or flange as you began,
leaving about six or seven inches over,
and the coil is complete.
How ic Make the Disc.This is
usually made of a peculiar
sort of iron called
"
ferro-
type," plates of which are
used in special form of
photograph known as a
ferrotype. It can be
purchased at any shop
selling photographic che-
micals and apparatus,
generally a druggist's. A
plate 45 inches by
3}
inches is large enough
for your purpose, and
costs about 2d. Should,
however, any of my
readers find a difficulty
in obtaining this special kind of iron plate, they will
find a sheet of thin tin answer quite as well.
Measure the inside
diameter of the box, and mark
FIG. 2. THE BELL TELEPHONE. FULL SIZE SECTIONAL VIEW.
on a piece of ordinary writing paper with a pair of
compasses a circle about
J
inch larger. Cut this out
neatly with a pair of scissors and gum
it on to the iron or tin plate, and then
with the same scissors, if they are
strong enough, cut the plate out
round the paper. Some may exclaim,
"
Why not mark out the circle on the
plate direct
?
" To this I answer, that
it is best to avoid scratching or indent-
ing the disc in any way, especially the
central part ; and, moreover, the paper
keeps the disc clean whilst you round
off" and smooth up the edge with a
fine file.
I now come to the cover of the
box, which forms the
"
mouth-piece,"
or as it is sometimes called, the
"speaking trumpet.'' This cover,
when placed on the box, should tightly
jam the edge of the disc all round
;
and at the same time the inside bottom
of the cover should be about
f
inch
clear of the centre part of disc to allow
the latter to vibrate. A glance at the
drawing will show what I mean. The
cover of my tooth-powder box, how-
ever, bothered me a little, for I found
that the centre of it was thicker than
the edge, and so the inside as well as
the outside was convex, just the
opposite to what I required (see Fig
3).
I did not observe this at first,
and so I thought that all I should
have to do would be to cut a circular
hole about
or
J
inch in diameter in
the centre, through
which the voice would
reach the centre of the
disc. When, however, I
had got my hole cut, and
the cover put on over the
disc, instead of touching
the edge of the latter all
round, it was pressing on
the centre, and the edge
of the disc was left free
(1) Steep
100 gr. of sandalwood (or 80 of dragon's blood)
powdered in 1 litre of alcohol, set it in the sun or
some warm place ten days, shaking it periodically.
Then filter through a cloth, and repeat the
with another 100 (or 80) grs., in the sar
alcohol. To lighten the colour use a
solution of gamboge, to darken it n
asphalte. Always use deep, large
'
fill them more than half full
"
r
.348
HINTS ON THE RESTORATION OF ANTIQUE FURNITURE.
this is cold add your resins, shaking periodically as
before described. Leave the liquid to settle for a
fortnight, then filter through paper and preserve.
Thus far it has seemed necessary to enter into the
ninutias of the rather distinct art of varnishing, and
I hope that these notes, gathered from the most
reliable sources and personal experiences may,'at any
rate, serve as guides for the experiments of the would-
be Cremona varnisher.
(
To be continued?)
HINTS ON THE RESTORATION OF
ANTIQUE FURNITURE.
By HARK HALLETT.
II. -Modes of Renovating, Repairing
1
, and Re-
modelling' Furniture.
ROM the situations in which so many of
these things are found, it is no wonder
that antique furniture and fragments
should most commonly come to hand
in a neglected conditionbroken, grub-
eaten, sometimes smeared over with paint ; or at the
best, coated and choked with long accumulations of
dirt and beeswax.
For simple cleaning, nothing is better than warm
water, in which a moderate quantity of soda has been
dissolved, a scrubbing-brush, and careful scraping
with a knife or chisel where necessary. The cleaning
process should be continued till the grain of the wood
has fairly been reached. The fine dark colour will
apparently disappear under this treatment, and the
oak assume a whitish look. But this matters little
;
everything can be put right again afterwards.
When the oak has been painted, a different pro-
cess must be resorted to. In a quart of boiling water
dissolve a handful of American potash, and stir into
the solution as much sawdust as will bring it to a
kind of paste. Lay this mixture half-an-inch thick
over the painted surface, and leave it for a night.
Next day the paint will be so much softened that
most of it will admit of washing off with a sponge
and cold water
;
but in hollows of the carving, and in
the pores of the wood, some of the pigment will pro-
bably still remain. If this does not yield to scrubbing
or scraping, cover it again with the compound for a
f
w hours. The use of the sawdust is merely to hold
e agentthe potashto the paint. Varnish
oved in the same manner,
has taken possession of the wood, the
-"e serious. This pest first attacks the
- f
the timber, and next any portions
of the oak which may have been exposed to damp.
The wood-grub most to be dreaded, is the larva of a
small brown beetle, about the eighth of an inch in
length. Its work of destruction is done whilst in the
imperfect state, and it emerges from the hole it has
bored, a perfect insect, about the month of July.
At this season the collector should keep his eyes
open, and kill every one of these, his worst enemies,
that he can see. They are sluggish little creatures,
and sit motionless on walls and ceilings, making little
effort to escape. Such of these as are not killed be-
come the parents of a new generation of destroyers.
Going over the wood with hot size has been re-
commended for killing grub. I have tried this remedy,
and believe it to be quite worthless. A more effectual
method is to go over the part attacked with parafnne
not merely to rub it on, but to lay it on in good
quantity with a brush. This oil penetrates far into
the wood, and is destructive to all insect life that it
reaches.
A frequent defect in such things as chairs, tables,
and joint-stools, is found in their feet. Their legs
commonly terminate more or less in a ball, much in
the manner indicated in Fig. 6. After standing, as has
many times been the case, for years on the damp
floors of cottages and kitchens, these ball-feet are
often decayed, whilst the legs themselves may be
sound. This evil is easily remedied. The feet may
be sawn off at the line marked A B in the cut, and new
feet turned, having round shanks to fit into holes
bored in the legs to receive them, as indicated by the
dotted lines at C. If the amateur restorer has no
lathe, any turner will make them from the old pattern,
at 2d. or 3d. each. If well-fitted and glued, they will
be in little danger of working loose, as the weight of
the articles resting on them, will serve to hold them
in place.
Sometimes the mortised joints will have become
so loose as to make the whole article rickety. If the
wood be sound throughout, a little wedging and glue-
ing will put this right, but sometimes, from remaining
damp, the tenons will have become tender. Even
then, the wood just outside the mortises, which has
dried more quickly, will, in most cases, be sound.
Under these circumstances complete firmness may be
restored by the use of small iron angles, as shown at
D in Fig. 7. These angles should of course be
screwed where they will show least, as on the under
sides of the cross-bars.
The twist shown in the legs of the table (Fig.
4)
is
a frequent and effective feature in antique furniture.
To replace a twist when broken or decayed is no very
difficult matter, even without the help of a lathe.
Indeed, in old work, hand-cut twists are very frequent,
and are most capable of artistic effect. The following
HINTS ON THE RESTORATION OF ANTIQUE FURNITURE.
349
is the method of proceeding
:
Square a piece of
timber to the required size, and in the part to be
twisted, bevel off the angles, so as to make it octagonal.
The old twist consists of two spiral fillets running side
by side. To set out the work, cut four long strips of
paper, each half the width of one of the fillets from
hollow to hollow. Twist these strips side by side
round the wood, in the same direction as in the old
work, and fasten them in their places with pins or
tacks. They will seem to fall into their proper posi-
tions naturally, and with very little trouble ; and the
alternate strips will indicate the future ridges and hol-
lows of the work. When all the strips have been pro-
perly adjusted, take off the two which represent the
ridges, paste them, and fix them securely in their
places again. The other two strips may now be re-
moved
; they will not be wanted again. The places
they have filled, now left bare, represent the hollows
;
and here the wood may be cut away and hollowed out
with mallet and gouge, till a sufficient and regular
depth has been reached. This done, the angles of
the ridges, at present covered with paper, can be
worked off and shaped with the chisel, and the whole
finished by the use of a half-round file and sand-paper.
When he has once carried out these directions, the
amateur restorer will be surprised to find how easily
so apparently difficult a work as making a twist is to
be effected.
Whenever any portion of an article has to be re-
placed, it is desirable that, in doing so, old wood
should be used. Old oak owes, as has already been
said, its deep rich colour to ammonia absorbed from
the air through a long course of years. Now, by
exposing new oak to powerful ammoniacal fumes, as
in a stable, for a comparatively short time, much the
same effect may be produced ; but the change is too
slow for the knowledge of this fact to be of much
value in practice. Few will have patience to leave
their work unfinished for months, that the new parts
may have time to colour. It is better, therefore, to use
old wood.
There need not be much difficulty in getting a
sufficient supply of such as has had a seasoning of a
couple of centuries. Articles broken past repair, or
too poor in character to be worth preserving, will fre-
quently fall in the way of the collector, and may be
bought for a mere trifle
;
whilst the re-seating of
churches, and pulling down of old houses, will also
afford opportunities of acquiring panelling and other
useful old oak-work, at a nominal cost.
It is true that old wood, when worked, will by no
means show the same dark colour within, which it
carried on its original surface. The more you cut
away, the lighter it will appear
; but still in its chemical
nature it will yet differ widely from new wood
; and
when touched with stain, it may readily be brought to
the true old colour.
The stain to be used for this purpose may be made
by putting scraps of iron, such as old nails, in a bottle
with vinegar, and leaving them for a few days, that a
portion of the iron may be dissolved. If this solution
be applied to new oak, it will turn it to a purplish
black. Oiling and polishing will remove the purple
tinge, but the dark colour which will remain will want
the richness and beauty of that given by age. When,
however, the solution is applied to old oak newly
worked, it restores to it just the proper hue. This
stain does its work most effectually when applied hot
;
and in matching old colour, it is well to weaken it with
water, and touch again and again, till the exact shade
is reached.
The new work, when stained, as well as the old
either saw round the two outer front panels, put hinges to them, and fit up
the interior as cupboards
; or leave our chest to do the office of a chest
still, and get at the inside by sawing the lid through the middle from end
to end. This being furnished with fresh hinges, will allow the front half
of the lid to be opened, without interfering with the back half and the
superstructure raised upon it.
Let us suppose that a second chest, of much the same size, is at the
9.STANDING DESK, MADE OF BOX AND
REMAINS OF TABLE.
HINTS ON THE RESTORATION OF ANTIQUE FURNITURE.
3Si
worker's disposal. Its back will serve as a back for
our open space D, in the lower compartment. The
bottom of this c can be made from its lid. The
supports D may be made from the debris of a broken-
up table, or if none such are at hand, new ones may
be made.
In the higher compartment E I have placed a
central recess, and two small lockers, surmounted by
a shelf. The back of this compartment is formed of
the front of the second chest, one of whose carved
panels shows at the back of the recess. The lids of
the lockers are small panels from the ends of the
chest, originally plain,
but now carved to
resemble those of the
chest No. i. I may
here mention that in
copying the flat sur-
face decoration of
panels, an easy method
of transferring the pat-
terns may be made
use of, viz., by laying
a piece of paper over
the original, rubbing it
over with shoemaker's
heel ball, which will
give the raised surfaces
in black, and then
pasting the paper over
the new panel to be
carved. The four pi-
lasters which flank the
lockers are supposed
to be two joint-stool
legs, sawn through
their centres. Some
odd scraps of carving
fill the space above
the shelf. This piece
of furniture might be
made more simply by omitting the lockers in the
upper compartments
; but in any case, very little be-
yond the component parts of the two chests would
be required to form it.
I have mentioned that in cottages it is not a rare
thing to meet with small square boxes, richly carved.
In Fig.
9
I have tried to show how such a box may be
converted into a standing writing-desk. The box,
with a small addition to its back and sides, forms the
body of the desk. The top may be covered with
leather or American leather-cloth, secured by a strip
of caning round the edge. The frame on which it
stands is wholly composed of the dibris of an eight-
legged table ; excepting the strips which run round
FIG. 8.SIDEBOARD MADE OF TWO CHESTS.
said,
the central shelf, which are new, and have been
carved to match the style of the box. Such a piece
of furniture is a valuable addition to a study. All
who write much, know how greatly a standing-desk
conduces to health and comfort ; and for the benefit
of any amateur who may care to build one, I may
mention that I have been informed by one of our
most eminent oculists, that the proper height, so far
as regards the all- important question of eyesight,
is that the top should be exactly on a level with the
elbow of the person for whose use it is intended, when
that person is in an upright position. The present
paper has been written
at a desk made up of
fragments like that
before us. A what-
not might be con-
structed on somewhat
the same lines.
Illustrations like the
two given might be
multiplied to any ex-
tent, but these will
suffice to show how
easily, with a little
skill and contrivance,
old articles may be
/\ adapted to modern
uses. These sketches
may also furnish some
hints as to how scraps
of old carving, and
odds and ends of
broken antique furni-
turethings which in
themselves are little
better than lumber
may be so worked up
as to become decora-
tive and useful. There
is no part, it may be
of an old carved table or chair or chest, however
small it may be, and valueless as it may appear, that
cannot be turned to good account by any amateur who
is acquainted with the mere rudiments of the cabinet-
maker's art. Therefore, I cannot urge too strongly on
all who may have a taste and liking for this kind of
furniture, and the work of turning it to good account,
the desirability of storing up for future use every scrap
that can be got hold of by hook or by crook, as the old
saying runs. There must be few who by ta'
'
of something that is apparently worthless
realized the truth of the saying that "Everyl
useful once in seven years." And this is
"
of old carving as for any other kind r>*
352
VELOCIPEDES: THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND USE.
VELOCIPEDES
:
THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND USE.
By A. STEPHENSON.
I.The Origin and History of the Velocipede.
IT is proposed, in this and the papers to
follow, to give a fully detailed account,
aided by a copious use of figures and
diagrams, of the materials and construc-
tion of this now well-known means of
locomotion, with reference particularly to that form of
Velocipede nowknown as the Tricycle, or three-wheeler.
By way of introduction it may be allowable to say
a few words regarding the earliest efforts to construct
light wheel carriages, upon which the rider could propel
himself along, now known as Velocipedes.
The word
"
velocipede
"
is derived from the Latin
velox (gen. velocis), swift, and pes (gen. -pedis), foot
;
and may, therefore, be defined to meanvelocity by
means of pedal motion, that is to say, motion pro-
duced by the power of the legs or feet
; so that
strictly speaking, a machine driven otherwise than
by the feet is not a velocipede. However that
may be, the term velocipede is now accepted as the
comprehensive name of the whole family of self-
propelling machines ; their distinctive or individual
names arising from the number of their wheels, such
as Bicycle, Tricycle, Quadricycle, etc.
"Walker," in his Dictionary says,
"
Velocipede, a
carriage for one person, who propels it by striking the
tips of his toes against the ground." He evidently
refers to the bicycle in its primitive form, as it was then
so propelled.
In
"
Haydn's Dictionary of Dates," I find under
the head "Velocipedes," that as early as
1779,
an
aeronaut, named M. Blanchard, invented a machine
of the velocipede type, but no account of its appear-
ance or construction is there given, although he says
it was described in ihe Journal de Paris at the time.
Then in 1S1S, a velocipede was invented by the
Baron von Drais, in Baden. It was called the
"
Dandy-horse," and was patented in Paris and Lon-
don. This machine was propelled by striking the toes
against the ground, and was in fact a bicycle minus
the cranks. It was called the
"
Pedestrian's Accele-
rator," and the
"
Speed-maker." It was introduced
into London by a Mr. Johnson, and was eagerly
inspected by the curious. Like most novelties upon
their introduction, its capabilities and advantages
"ready exaggerated ; for example, it was said that
of eight or ten miles an hour could be attained
"ho had learnt to manage it. Fancy digging
~ito the ground at the rate of ten miles an
'
'
think that a mile or two of that sort of
tisfied the most enthusiastic, that
if with the
"
Dandy-horse," speed was accelerated, it
was at the cost of great fatigue, and at a greatly in-
creased autlay for shoe leather. Certain it is that this
mode of locomotion soon sunk into oblivion, and we
hear no more of it for over forty years.
It was in i860 or 1S61 that a revival took place
in the creation of the
"
Bone-shaker," which is, or was
a machine very similar to the "Dandy-horse" of
Baron von Drais, but furnished with the very decided
improvement of cranks to the fore wheel.
The idea of balancing and driving a machine with
two wheels in one track, i.e., a Bicycle, and that by
means of cranks and pedals, must have been stirring
the minds of more than one amateur mechanic prior
to i860 ; for I recollect, perfectly, being an eye-witness
in 1857 to the efforts of a young man in a town in the
west of Scotland, to ride a bicycle constructed by him-
self. I can recollect that it had two wooden wheels,
nearly, if not quite equal in size, running in line,
the fore wheel furnished with cranks and wooden
pedals. The wheels were enclosed down to the axles
by the upper portion or body of a horse made of paste-
board, or some such material, and on this horse was
placed a saddle. I cannot now remember what means
he had for steering, if any, but I recollect that his
appearance on his hobby-horse excited the wonder
and the curiosity of the whole locality, and he was
literally hemmed in by a crowd of all ages. His
early efforts to propel the machine resulted in a
few tumbles, but these were not serious as the machine
was low, the wheels being about 30 ins. in diameter.
When I witnessed the performance, the rider had
attained some degree of proficiency, as he could run
several hundred yards without a mishap. The thing
was really and truly a bicycle, and was very little im-
proved upon in the first
"
Bone-shaker
"
I saw ridden
by a Mr. Coats, of Paisley, in 1S63 or 1864.
The transition from the clumsy wooden wheels
with iron tyres to the light and airy wire spokes and
india-rubber, was a great and important one. Another
notable change in form was the gradual increase in
diameter of the leading wheel, and a corresponding
decrease in diameter of its follower, till we now find
them as in racing machines of a relative diameter of
about
5
to I.
It would be safe to conclude that many attempts
were made by amateur mechanics to construct self-
propelling machines having three or more wheels, long
prior to, and quite apart from the bold idea of balanc-
ing upon two wheels running in line. I can recollect
when a boy seeing a four-wheeler propelled by four
riders, at a mining village near Kilmarnock. The idea
seemed to have been taken from the wheel work of a
cab, and was about as heavy. It was propelled by each
rider having a pair of upright hand levers in the form
VELOCIPEDES: THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND USE.
353
of round poles, and cumbrous as the machine was, it
was driven at a good speed by the combined strength
of its occupants. How it was guided I cannot say, but
they must have had some means of doing so, for they
took the windings of the roads at a speed that soon left
all the small boys
"
on mischief bent," far in the rear.
When the bicycle began to make its appearance
in our streets and roads nearly twenty years ago, the
sage and the timid viewed it as a machine to be
mounted by the reckless and foolhardy ; they looked
upon the young man on the top of the wheel, as court-
ing broken limbs, or possibly a broken neck. The
machine itself, among other things, was likened to a
grinder's wheel. We have all heard of the woman
who, when a bicyclist halted before her door, went
out with the scissors, asking his price to grind them.
By 1S69 and 1870, the velocipede had established
itself as a means of locomotion, though used mostly
for recreative purposes, and that mostly by young
men and youths ; and makers confined themselves
almost exclusively to the manufacture of the two-
wheeler, notwithstanding the fact that the great
majority of the public regarded it as a machine
requiring too much practice to manage, and at least
fraught with dangers only to be faced by reckless
young men. They conceived, and that rightly, that
they could sit more comfortably and more safely on a
machine having wheels on either sidea machine
requiring no careful balancing, and in which they
would be free to devote their whole attention and
energy to its propulsion. Such a machine not being
forthcoming by bicycle-makers, very many set about
contriving three and four-wheelers. These persons
were chiefly blacksmiths and wheelwrights. I could
name six or seven in my native town who, during the
bone-shaker period, constructed machines, three and
four-wheelers, all of them with clumsy wooden wheels,
and clumsier framework and driving gear. These
machines were finished after a fashion, taken out and
tried, and the first trial was generally the lastthey
were too fatiguing to drive. They had iron tyres and
were destitute of springs, so the sensations of the
rider may be imagined ; they were taken in to undergo
certain improvemeiits, which improvements have yet
to be effected. I know one blacksmith who made a
four-wheeler, he got a wheelwright to make the
wheels, then used up about two hundredweight of iron,
at last it was finished, and he took it out at midnight
to try, somehow there was
"
no go
"
in it, although the
street was level. At last about a dozen persons sur-
rounded him, ar.d some one proposed to give him a
"
shove," he resented interference, and declared he
thought it would go if he could get the wheels to go
round. This was kept up as a standing joke at his
expense for many a day.
All these rude attempts at velocipede construction
are now destroyed, or possibly remnants of them may
still linger in out-of-the-way lumber corners, for the
era of steel wire spokes set in and drove out of sight
the clumsy wooden wheels and their clumsier ad-
juncts.
Makers soon began to realise the fact, that if their
trade was to be developed, they must contrive
machines for other than young men, machines that
may be used by the aged and infirm, as well as the
young and lithe of limb, not forgetting ladies, and the
result is that the bicycle-makers, are now turning out
machines to carry one, two, three, and even four
persons, known as Tricycles and Quadricycles.
The tricycle, which will be the machine chiefly
under consideration in these papers, compared with
the bicycle, has its advantages and disadvantages.
It has the advantage of being easier to ride on
account of its stability
;
you may stop when an im-
pediment is in the way, or to speak to a friend with-
out dismounting. It has the advantage also of
accommodating two or more persons as a sociable,
and of carrying more luggage, and is in consequence
of the latter advantage, more in use by letter-carriers,
etc. Another advantage over the bicycle is, that
upon ice, or very slippery roads, it will run safely, and
take the sharpest turns without a tumble, because its
three wheels, although turning, are still at right angles
with the surface of the icy roads. One of its dis-
advantages is said to be its inability to keep up with
the bicycle in speed, by reason of the increased weight
and more friction. This is certainly true of the
earlier types of tricycles, but this drawback is being
rapidly removed. The machine admits of an infinity
of methods of driving.
The bicycle is a wheel with two cranks, and there
it is as near perfection as it ever can come
;
you
cannot adapt the thousand and one methods of pro-
pulsion to it that may be applied to a tricycle, though
some of them may be, and are being applied to it.
Makers are now giving a large share of their
ingenuity and skill to the means of propelling tricycles,
and tricycles are now made that will mount a hill with
the best bicycle. The tricycle has not arrived at any-
thing like perfection, and I see no reason why it
should not be constructed to run along side of and
mount a hill, leaving the bicycle at the bottom.
There are doubtless many readers of Amateur
Work, Illustrated, possessed of a mechanical turn
of mind, and possessed also of the facilities for its
gratification in the way of tools and means. To .
I will endeavour to make these papers intelligibl
instructive, leaving nothing unsaid that may be
'
to them in the building of their own velocipedf
(To be continued.')
354
THE DOMESTIC ELECTRIC LIGHT.
THE DOMESTIC ELECTRIC LIGHT.
B\j GEORGE EDWINSON.
[HE grand collection of electric lights ex-
hibited at the Crystal Palace has naturally
awakened in the minds of many persons,
in both town and country, the desire to
possess the means of enjoying the light
from an electric lamp in their own homes. Hitherto
the means to gratify such a desire have been so costly
and troublesome as to practically render its attainment
impossible to all except those who are wealthy. But
at last the coveted treasure is placed within the reach
of my readers, and
I feel free to give
them a first article on
the subject.
I will not stay to
examine the claims of
rival makers ofelectric
lamps, nor to compare
the respective merits
of the many various
lamps before the pub-
lic. It is now gene-
rally understood that
these lamps are divided
into three classes
(
I
) Arc lamps
; (2)
Semi-incandescent
lamps
; (3)
Incandes-
cent lamps. In the arc
lamps the carbon
candles are consumed
in air by a kind of
fretting of the
"
two
points by the force of
the electric current,
the fretted and highly luminous particles being con-
sumed between the two carbon points in the form
of a double arc of light. The best known types
of this lamp are those of Siemen's, the Brush Com-
pany's, and the Jablochkoff lamps. This kind of
lamp requires a current of great force, only available
from those large generators of electricity known
as dynamo-electric machines. They are, there-
fore, inadmissible here, except to claim a passing
notice in comparing them with others. In the semi-
30 Bunsen cells, at
4 6
1 Lamp and fittings
(> 1;
7 5
o
50 Bunsen cells, at 46 1 1 50
5
Lamps 5; fittings, at 10/- 2 10 o
fig. 6.-
13 15
Added to this is the cost and
trouble of charging and cleaning
the cells, and an intolerable
nuisance arising from battery
fumes, enough in itself,
independent of cost, to dis-
suade an amateur from undertaking such a task.
Clearly, then, we may not think of lighting our homes
with the Swan lamp by current derived from batter)'
power, and must await the time, not very far off, when
they may be lit from mains of current generated by
little lamps are being sold by the Electric Novelty
Company, 60, Strand, London, at 10s. 6d. each lamp,
or an outfit of one lamp and its battery for 40s. The
form of this lamp is shown in the subjoined sketch, its
construction is as follows :
A thread or filament of
some carbonised material is bent
into the form of a loop, the two
ends of which are attached to
two thin wires of platinum, and
these are embedded in the glass
stem of the lamp globe, this globe
is then placed in connection with
an air pump and all the air is
sucked from its interior, then the
orifice is hermetically sealed by
fusing the glass closely around the
conducting wires. The two loops
of the conducting wires are con-
nected with the terminal poles of
the battery, and the current from
six quart cells of Bunsen's battery
heats the carbon filament to an
incandescent condition, giving a
light said to be equal to that from
eight sperm candles.
It will be easily understood that
SECTION" OF PLATINUM INCANDESCENT
ELECTRIC LAMP.
A, Lever to short-circuit current when the pla-
tinum wire is overheated; B, Pillar to support .
lever; c, Foot of standard holding platinum
this form of lamp cannot be manu-
factured at home, hence we have
not entered into the minutia? of its construction ; but a
few words respecting the battery may be acceptable.
The Bunsen cell, Fig. 2, is composed ofan outer contain-
ing cell of stoneware, into which loosely fits a cylinder
of zinc, and a cell of porous earthenware within this in
which is placed a square rod of carbon. The porous
(<KHKHi)
l'IG. j. METHOD 01' CONNECTING EATTEKY AND LAMP IN CIRCUIT.
dynamo-electric machines maintained by electric
light companies. As the other incandescent lamps
above mentioned, require similar conditions to work
them, we will dismiss them altogether.
But we are not entirely left in the dark. We can
now get little lamps giving a light of eight-candle
power with a current from six Bunsen cells. Those
cell is charged with strong nitric acid, and the outer
pot or cell with a mixture of one part sulphuric acid
(oil of vitriol) in eight parts of water. The zinc cylinder
must be well amalgamated with mercury, and this
should be done as follows :
First clean the zinc by
immersing it for a short time in the battery mixture
above mentioned, and brushing with a hard brn-'
'-
35
6 THE DOMESTIC ELECTRIC LIGHT.
coachman's carriage or spoke brush is a handy tool for
this purpose) ; when it has been thus cleaned, roll the
cylinder in a baking dish in which has been placed an
ounce or two of mercury (quicksilver). If the zinc is
clean it will be quickly covered with mercury on the
outer surface, brush this well over and sweep some of
the mercury into the inside of the cylinder with the
brush, continue sweeping it in and brushing it until all
the zinc has been made bright with mercury, then
brush off all superfluous drops, and place the amalga-
mated cylinder in its place in the outer cell. Now put
the carbon block in the porous cell, and take care in
charging it with the nitric acid, not to spill any of the
acid on the outside of the cell nor fill it above the
intended line of the acid mixture of the outer cell.
Put this cell in its place, and then charge the outer
cell with the acid mixture, then clean and fix the
binding screws to carbon and zinc ready for work.
There are two distinct methods of making up a
battery of cells : one being known as coupling them in
"
series," the other as joining up in
"
multiple arc," or
"
parallel circuit." To couple them in
"
series
"
(Fig.
3)
we connect the zinc of one cell with the carbon of the
next, and so on through the long string of cells form-
ing the battery
;
joining them in "multiple arc" is the
converse of this arrangement, all the zincs being con-
nected to one line wire and all the carbons to another.
This is graphically shown in Fig. 4. By the first
arrangement the battery is given
"
pushing power," or
the ability so to speak of overcoming resistance in the
circuit, a property nearly analogous to high pressure
in water and steam ; by the second we increase the
volume or quantity of electricity generated in a given
time, and it finds its analogy in a large boiler filled
with steam at a low pressure. In connecting up a
battery of cells for the electric light, we invariably
couple them in series to overcome the resistance of
the lamp carbons ;
but it is best to adopt the converse
arrangement in the lamps if more than one lamp is
required to be worked from one battery. The arrange-
ment of lamps is shown in Fig. 5.
The Bunsen battery will supply a vigorous current
for four hours continuously, after this its force
diminishes during the next four hours, and on such
work as this we cannot hope to get effective work for
a longer period than six hours. At the end of this
time the cells must be taken to pieces, the zinc
cylinders washed, brushed, and reamalgamated, the
binding screws, clamps, and wires cleaned with emery
cloth, and the carbon blocks, cells, etc , rinsed with
water. It is best to dip the brush in the battery mix-
ture and brush the zincs with it before they are amal-
gamated, this will use up a part of the mixture. Before
recharging the cells this deficiency must be made up
K
v pouring fresh acid and water into the pitcher with
the old mixture and thus refresh it. The nitric acid
should be poured from the cells into a jug, and be used
again if it is not exhausted of its properties ; if it pours
out from the cells green and fuming, it is all right ;
if
it pours out nearly black, it is almost exhausted ;
but
if it has changed from this latter tint to a yellowish
liquid or one free from colour, it is exhausted, and
fresh acid must be put in the cell with the carbon.
The process of cleaning must be gone through imme-
diately after each time of using the battery, and this
must be made up afresh each night just before the
light is required. Whilst the battery is at work it
gives off dense brown nitrous fumes from the inner
cell, which have an offensive odour, and are deleterious
to health. Various expedients have been adopted to
nullify the effects of those fumes. The cells have been
put in a box, and a sheet of blotting-paper saturated with
ammonia has been spread over them, or little boxes of
ammonia carbonate put in with the cells, but the best
plan is to put the box and its contents in an out-house
or shed, and lead the wires from the battery into the
house, in this case the line wires should be large and
offer as little resistance as possible to the current.
The nuisance arising from the noxious fumes of
this and the Grove battery has led many persons to
devise other forms of electric generators which should
be free from the objectionable features above men-
tioned, and yet be powerful enough to produce the
electric light. The quiet and inoffensive batteries
used in electro-deposition, and in doing such work as
ringing electric bells, are altogether ineffective for
this work. We have therefore to turn our attention
elsewhere, and in doing so find that those batteries in
which bichromate of potash does duty instead of nitric
acid, promise to fulfil the first requirement : they are
also powerful, but, like many other fickle jades, they
are inconstant and liable to fail within at most an
hour after being set up. Many methods have been
devised by electricians and chemists to overcome this
defect, hence we have the constant battery of Mr.
Fuller, where the position of the elements are reversed,
a rod of amalgamated zinc going in the porous cell
with a little mercury, and a plate or carbon in the
outer cell, the first being charged with the acid
mixture, and the other with a saturated solution of
bichromate of potash acidulated with one-fifth of
sulphuric acid. This battery has been used with
some success, but to be efficient the outer cells must
be large, two carbon plates must be used, and two
plates of rolled zinc instead of a rod of cast zinc. Mr.
Dale's constant bichromate battery may also be used
for this purpose under similar conditions to that given
for the Fuller cell. Mr. Urquhart has also described
a constant bichromate cell in
"
Design and Work," of
August 20, 1881, which has been said to be most
THE DOMESTIC ELECTRIC LIGHT
357
effective for the electric light, but as I have not tried
it I cannot say anything about its effectiveness.
The following modification of a plan for making a
cheap batter)' may be found useful in making up a
battery for the electric light. Put an ordinary porous
pot in the centre of a quart stoneware cell, and pack
the space around with a mixture of equal parts by
weight of iron turnings or borings and peroxide of
manganese, using a strip of iron hoop instead of a
zinc plate for the positive element. This cell is
to be charged with bichromate solution as prepared
for the Fuller cell. Now get a thin strip of carbon to
go in the porous cell, and charge this cell with a
mixture of one part nitric acid to ten parts of water,
cut a barrel bung in two and fit them in the top of the
porous cell, and on each side of the carbon so as to
seal it -in the cell and prevent any fumes from rising,
or a wooden cover may be made for the purpose. In
the original plan (with platinised silver in the porous
cell) a batter)- of six cells has been said to light up an
incandescent lamp, and work for eight days without
renewal.
Nearly all early experimenters with the incandescent
electric lamp have tested the efficiency of a thin wire of
platinum, relying upon its known infusibility, even
when kept at a white heat by ordinary methods of
heating. But platinum wire has failed when heated
by a current of electricity, and the thin spiral or loop
has frequently suffered disruption from the current
when the light has been at its best. Not a month
since I saw a 5s. lamp prove a dead loss to its owner
by the fusing of die platinum loop under the current
of four Bunsen cells of quart size, weakly charged, and
I hear that this is not a solitary case. If this
material could be safely used it would prove a boon to
the amateur lamp-maker, since the fine platinum wire
is within his reach, but the carbon filaments are
unnattainable by him. The following method of
making a platinum incandescent lamp (published in a
letter to The Mechatiical World') promises to be a
good one, within the means and skill of almost every
person. The necessary materials are a disc of wood,
\ inch thick, and 2 inches diameter, 6 inches of
No. 10 B. W. G. copper wire, 3 inches of No. 40
platinum wire, and a large test tube. The form of
lamp and its construction is shown in the sketches,
Fig. 6, which have been altered a little in detail from
the original sketch to suit less skilful persons than its
designer. The base may be neatly turned up out of a
piece of hard wood and hollowed as shown, or made
out of any odd bit of wood and left flat.
The standard of bent copper wire may be fixed to
the base by a foot C, made by flattening one end of the
wire, boring a hole to receive a small screw, and
turning up a small contact piece
;
or it may be brazed
to a small brass stud made to screw into the base.
The bent part must be slit with a file or hack-saw to
clip the lupper end of the platinum wire P, and the
lower end of this wire must be held in a corresponding
slit made in the lever A. This lever may be made out
of a piece of the copper wire (as used in the construc-
tion of the standard), bent to the form shown in sketch,
or it may be made of brass. The pillar to support this
lever may also be made out of a bit of the wire shaped
as shown at B, or it may be made from a small brass
screw. The contact parts of A and C must be tipped
with a bit of platinum foil soldered on, and it will be
well to solder the leading wires to the pillar B and the
foot of the standard C, afterwards passing them
through holes in the base and attaching them to the
binding screws on each side. A large test tube* inverted
over the working parts of the lamp and held in a
circular groove at the bottom, forms a neat shade and
protection to the light. The working of this lamp is
as follows : Connect the two binding screws with the
two poles of a powerful battery ; if the current is
strong enough, it will heat the platinum wire white hot,
and it will then give out dazzling white rays of light,
whilst the wire will expand and lengthen. If the lever A
is free to move, and has been properly adjusted, it will
drop slowly, and nearly touch the foot c. A little
more current, such as would fuse the platinum wire,
will cause it to lengthen still further ; A will then touch
C, and short- circuit the current until P has cooled
enough to draw A away from C, when p will again get
white hot. If the current is not strong enough, the
platinum will only get red or yellow, and emit a feeble
light, and if it then short-circuits the lamp, the wire
must be shortened. It will thus be seen that the
platinum wire may be adjusted to bear any current
short of that necessary to fuse the wire, and this acci-
dent may be prevented by adjusting the wire to short-
circuit through A and c when the wire gets dangerously
hot. The light from this lamp will not be equal to
that from a carbon lamp, but it has the merit of being
cheap, easy of construction, and easily repaired ; it
may also be worked with a few Fuller or Dale cells.
Much attention is now being given to the subject
by interested vendors of the lamps, and also by
amateurs wishing to have a specimen of the new light.
It is, therefore, probable that several new forms of
lamps will be brought out this season, together with
new forms of batteries to work them. I shall endea-
vour to make myself acquainted with them, and give
papers on the subject from time to time, as occasion
may require, if the subject finds favour with my
readers. {To be continued.)
*
Test tubes, 1^ inches in diameter, may be obtained of
J. J.
Griffin & Son, 22, Garrick Street, W. , at is. iod. per
dozen.
358
WOOD-CARVING FOR AMATEURS.
WOOD-CARVING FOR AMATEURS.
By LEO PARSET.
II. How to Sharpen Carving Tools.What Woods
to Use, etc
AVING described in my last article some
of the principal tools at first required for
wood-carving, I will now proceed to give
the necessary instructions as to the best
methods of sharpening them. As I before
stated, the success of the amateur wood-carver de-
pends greatly upon his tools being properly sharpened,
for if this is not the case the tools do not work freely,
and carving, instead of being a pleasure, becomes a
laborious and unsatisfactory performance.
It should therefore be borne in mind by the
student that the more time and labour bestowed upon
getting his tools into proper working order at first, the
more satisfactory will his work appear when finished.
I am tempted to write thus strongly on this point, as I
am well aware that the necessary labour required is of
an extremely uninteresting nature, and is therefore apt
to be carelessly and hurriedly performed, the beginner
being anxious to commence the practical work at
once.
New tools of course require far more time and
attention to bring them into working order than tools
that have been previously used, and are simply dull
and blunt. In the latter case five minutes' rubbing on
the oil-stone, with a few finishing touches on the strap,
will bring on a keen edge. New tools require, first of
all, to be ground on a slow-cutting grindstone, care
being taken to use plenty of water during the process,
otherwise there is a danger of the tool becoming so
heated as to draw or affect the temper. It is some-
what difficult to state exactly how far back from the
edge of the tool the grinding should extend, as if taken
too far back, it leaves the edge too thin, but in mosj
cases from inch to of an inch will be sufficient.
After the tools have been ground, they require to
be well rubbed out from the inside with a fast-cutting
oil-stone. Arkansas or Washita stone is about the
best for this purpose, and slips, in assorted sizes, can
be purchased at prices ranging from one shilling to
four shillings per pound, from most tool-dealers, or
from Churchill and Co., Cross Street, Finsbury, E.C.
Eight or nine slips will be quite sufficient for
sharpening all the tools at first required, as both the
top and bottom edges of the stones are available. In
addition to the tools previously described, a "firmer"
will be required. The best size will be about fths of an
inch in width (Fig.
14),
and in sharpening this tool both
sides are ground equally, and afterwards finished off
on a perfectly flat stone.
The other flat tools are all more or less hollowed
out on the inside by using stones that are slightly
convex. I mentioned in the previous article how the
insides of the parting tool and veiner were sharpened,
but I may add that a medium-sized parting-tool and a
very small veiner will be found the most useful to the
amateur.
After the inside of a tool has been thoroughly
rubbed out, and there is but little danger of sharpening
it too much from the inside, the outside edge should
be finished off by sharpening on the side of one of the
slips, the sides of the slips will soon become concave,
so as to fit the backs of the tools for which they are
used. Care should be taken to keep the edge of the
tools perfectly even and square.
Fig. 15 illustrates tools properly sharpened, and
Fig. 16 a couple of the same tools improperly sharp-
ened. In rubbing out tools it will be better to fix the
slip of stone in a vice, placing it between two pieces
of cork to prevent breakage, where more pressure can
be brought to bear on it, both hands being used to
hold the tool firmly.
In sharpening the outsides of tools the tool is held
in the left hand, and the stone is moved sharply up
and down the edge by the right hand, except in the
case of very flat tools, when the stone can be placed
on the bench, and both hands used to grasp the tool.
Ordinary machine oil, or in some cases paraffin, is
used as a lubricant, and to increase the cutting power
of the stones, emery powder is sometimes added. To
put a finishing clean-cutting edge on the tools, a strap
is used, and this can easily be made by the amateur.
It consists simply of a strip of buff-leathera piece of
a soldier's cast-off belt is bestabout ten inches long
and four inches wide, plentifully saturated with tallow
and crocus powder, which should be well rubbed into
the leather before a fire. When properly made, this
strap will be found to give a keen edge to the tools,
and by slightly doubling it the inside of the tool can
be finished off as well as the outside.
A good way of testing the keenness of edge on a
tool is to try it on a piece of soft deal, cutting aa-oss
the grain, when, if the tool is properly sharpened, a
clean cut, without any tearing of the grain, will be the
result.
Before commencing a piece of carving, I should
recommend the student to spend an hour or so in
getting in order those tools likely to be required, and
unless the work is of an intricate character, a dozen or
eighteen will be sufficient. When in use, the tools are
placed on the bench, with the blades pointing towards
the worker, and owing to the slight difference in the
size and sweep of many of them, it is advisable to
know the tools by the handles, so as to be able to at
once pick up the tool required. Professional carvers
WOOD-CARVING FOR AMATEURS.
359
have for this reason the handles of their tools made of
various woods and of different shapessome turned,
others octagonal, etc.; in fact, seldom having two
handles alike.
Many different kinds of wood are used for carving
purposes, some being more suitable than others ; but
freedom from knots, straight grain, and compactness
are desirable qualities. For a beginner, I think either
stave-oak or American walnut-wood is the best to
commence with. Of course the kind of wood to be
used is in a great measure determined by the style of
work intended to be executed, and the purpose for
which the caning is required. For brackets, picture-
frames, and work of a similar nature, I should cer-
tainly give the preference to stave-oak or walnut,
unless very fine and delicate work is required, when
either boxwood or lime-tree-wood would be pre-
ferable.
In general it will be better to leave the wood
unstained, simply brushing the surface of the work
with boiled linseed oil. Stave-oak, in addition to
being a free-cutting wood, takes a good polish, can be
gilded so as to show the grain of the wood through
the gold, or it can be darkened so as to look like old
FIG. 14. FIRMER CHISEL FOR CARVERS.
oak. A very good and cheap stain for this purpose
can be made by dissolving half-an-ounce of bichromate
of potash in about six ounces of water, the stain being
then applied to the wood in the usual manner. A
deeper or lighter shade of colour, as required, can
easily be obtained by either diminishing or increasing
the amount of water used. This stain, however, has
the same disadvantage as all other stains when ap-
plied to carved surfaces, as it slightly raises the grain
of the wood, giving the work a rough appearance, and
necessitating the use of sand-paper ; it therefore
answers best when applied to mouldings or plain
caned surfaces. Boiled linseed oil should be used
over the stain unless a bright polish is required
; but
oak generally looks best if left dull.
It may here be stated that sand-paper should on
no account be applied to carved work, as it destroys
the sharpness and effect ; any inequalities of the
surface or roughness should be rectified with the
tools, and not smoothed down with sand-paper, as
is sometimes the case with badly-executed work.
In many, if not in all, cases the absence of sand-
paper affords a pretty sure test of the excellence of
the work and the skill of the carver. The only pur-
poses for which sand-paper is particularly useful is
for mouldings and uncarv surfaces. English oak is
not so useful for carving purposes as the stave-oak, it
being much tougher, and frequently cross-grained,
and although a first-class wood where strength and
endurance are required, these qualities are not so
much looked for as freedom in working. Next to
FIG. 15.TOOLS PROPERLY SHARPENED.
stave-oak, which is not always easily obtained of a
greater width than six or seven inches and three or
four inches thick, may be ranked American walnut-
wood. It is a free-cutting,
straight-grained wood,
generally free from knots, takes a stain well, and
is easily polished.
Lime-tree-wood is also a splendid
wood for carving purposes, being easily worked, and
without much grain
; and it is perhaps the best of
all woods to use where the work is intended to le
either stained or gilded.
Boxwood is mostly used for the finest and most
delicate description of work, for which it is peculiarly
suited, being a hard, compact wood ; it is also exten-
sively used for
wood-engraving.
Ebony
possesses nearly the same qualities as box-
wood, and being naturally of a rich black colour, i's
frequently used for fine carvings
; it is, however,
slightly brittle. Carved work in ebony looks better,
if left of a dull colour instead of being brightly
polished, especially if it be well brushed with a hard
brush, the plain surfaces only, such as the mouldings,
etc., in panels being brightly polished, thus affording
a good contrast with the dead colour of the carving
Ebony is frequently used instead of bog-oak, and I
believe the majority of the elegant, tasteful articles of
FIG. 16.TOOLS IMPROPERLY SHARPENED.
jewellery, such as shamrock bracelets and harp-shaped
brooches, exposed for sale in most Irish towns are far
more frequently made of ebony than of bog-oak, as
represented. Bog-oak is in most cases far too coarse
in the grain for delicate carving, whereas ebony has
all the requisite qualities.
As an example of this, I remember on one occa-
360
AMATEUR BOOKBINDING.
sion, when in Dublin, endeavouring to obtain some
bog-oak, out of which to carve a few souvenirs of my
visit. I called at several shops where ornaments of
bog-oak were exposed for sale, but failed to obtain
either the wood I required or information as to where
it could be obtained. At last I called at a small
shop in an obscure part of the city, where the pro-
prietor evidently manufactured the articles he exposed
for sale, as he was at the time engaged in carving a
brooch. Upon making my wants known, he stated
his stock of wood was very small, but he gave me the
address of a firm where the wood could be procured.
I applied at the address given, which I found was an
ironmongery warehouse, and was shown a quantity of
wood, cut up into lengths of various sizes, which, upon
examination, I found to be ebony, and not bog-oak
;
but upon calling attention to this, I was informed that
the wood I saw was extensively used by the manu-
facturers of the so-called bog-oak ornaments. I
should therefore advise the amateur carver who may
be ambitious to produce articles of jewellery to use
ebony, which he will find well adapted for the
purpose.
Other woods, such as satinwood, sycamore, pear-
tree-wood, mahogany, and rosewood, are frequently
used for carving, and can all be easily procured
through most tool dealeis, who supply amateur
requisites. Of late years black and gold has come
greatly into fashion, the carved work generally being
left either dull black or gilded, the rest of the sur.
face receiving a bright polish, the woods generally
used for this description of work being either American
walnut-wood or lime-tree-wood.
If the carved work is intended to be in relief, then
the carving is done first, the wood being afterwards
stained and gilded ; but where incised work is intended,
the wood is both stained and polished before the in-
cising is done, the incised work being afterwards
gilded. This style of work looks remarkably well
when the design is good, and the incising carefully
done
; it however requires the carver to have perfect
command over the tools, as the slightest irregularity
in the lines or scroll-work is at once seen, and spoils
the whole effect, as the mistake cannot well be recti-
fied. I shall in a future paper devote some space to
incised work, giving designs and explaining the
method of treatment.
Several plans are adopted for transferring a design
to the wood, the best way being, when no working
drawing is given, to simply chalk the surface of the
wood, and draw upon it the design in outline.
Another plan is to oil a piece of what is termed
''printing demy paper," and trace upon it the
pattern. The paper should then be reversed, and the
lines traced over with a soft lead pencil ; then by
simply placing the oiled paper on the wood, and
tracing over the original lines, the design is impressed
on the wood ready for carving.
In the case of a frame, etc., where both sides or
halves of the design are alike, it will only be neces-
sary to trace one half, the other being impressed on
the wood by simply reversing the oiled paper, and
using it as above described. Only the principal out-
lines require to be shown roughly on the wood, merely
to serve as a guide in the roughing or blocking-out of
the work, the finishing being done by continual
reference to the design, the outlines being rectified
during the progress of the work.
In many cases it is advisable to preserve copies of
small carved objects for future use, and this is easily
done by taking a plaster cast of the work. To take
an impression of the object of which a cast is desired,
a substance known as squeeze-wax is used, and this is
made of the following ingredients, viz. : 2 lbs. flour,
\
lb. best beeswax, -\ lb. linseed oil, and a small
quantity of rouge
; these should be thoroughly mixed
together, and then exposed to the air. Should the
squeeze-wax become hard at any time, it may easily
be softened by slightly warming and well kneading.
In taking a cast, the wax should be well pressed
into every portion of the work, and then gently with-
drawn, the mould thus formed being filled with plaster
of Paris, the plaster having been mixed with water
until it is of the consistence of cream. After standing
for a few hours, the squeeze-wax can be taken off,
leaving a copy of the carving in plaster. Care should
be taken to obtain the plaster fresh, as after being
exposed to the air it loses some of its properties, and
does not harden well.
These remarks on taking plaster-casts apply only
to small objects that are not deeply undercut ; larger
casts, and casts of subjects carved on more than one
side, are taken in sections.
In my next paper I shall refer briefly to the various
styles of ornament, and then describe the practical
method of carving in wood.
{To be continued.)
AMATEUR BOOKBINDING.
JBy the Author of
"
The Art of Bookbinding."
II.Folding, Pulling to Pieces, and Collating.
ONCE read a paper on Bookbinding
which showed, or pretended to show,
how to bind books without tools. I need
hardly remark that such is impossible.
A book may certainly be put together
and covered by such helps or means as one may find
AMATEUR BOOKBINDING. 361
in an ordinary house ;
but as I wish my reader to bind
his books in a manner creditable to himself, I shall
call his attention from time to time to such tools as he
may require, at the same time not mentioning any-
thing that is not absolutely necessary.
The first requisition is a laying-press. Such a
press is used for pressing, backing, cutting, and other
manipulations, and, although the heaviest item, is also
the most necessary, for without it bookbinding cannot
be done. I have inquired from several pressmakers,
and the following is the most suitable for the amateur,
and the best he can get for the money. The press
complete, with plough, plough-knife, press-pin, three
pairs of backing-boards, three pairs of cutting-boards,
each pair a different size, to suit the different sizes of
books he may have to bind ; an enclosed tub, as shown
in Fig. 1 1, to hold the shavings cut from the books, the
top made to support the laying-press ; a drawer in the
tub for small articles, and a wooden cover for the
whole, useable as a work-board when the press is not
being used. The sum asked for the whole is
2
15s.,
which can be seen at any time at Messrs. Meager and
Co.,
37,
Endell Street, Bloomsbury, W.C. The tub
is 3
feet high, 2 feet 9 inches long, and 2 feet in width
Folding.After the printer has printed his sheets,
the first thing done is to fold them. A great deal of
the beauty of a book when bound is to have the sheets
properly folded. When I use the word properly, I
mean in the double sense that they be folded evenly,
so that the margins of the different pages be uniform,
and that the pages follow consecutively. Every book,
or rather the sheets of a book, are not all folded alike
;
and, as a rule, the size of a book is known by the
number of folds each sheet hasa folio two folds, a
quarto four, an octavo eight, a i2mo twelve, a i6mo
sixteen folds, and so on. But this rule has of late
years been ignored, and a book is now more strictly
known by its size in inches. It will not be necessary
to give all the different sizes, but subjoined is an
extract of those most in use
:
INCHES.
Demy i2mo ....
7b
by
4!
Crown 8vo .
1\ by
5
Demy 8vo .
9 by
5*
Royal 8vo . 10 by 6\
Crown 4to . 10 by
1\
Super royal 8vo io| by
6
J
Imperial 8vo 1 1 by
i\
Demy 4to . 11 by
9
Royal 4to .
I2-?r by 10
Super royal 4to
13J
by ioi
Imperial 4to 15 by 11
Crown folio 15 by 10
Demy folio 18 by 11
Royal folio 20 by
12J
Super royal folio
.
Imperial folio
21 by 13^
inches.
22 by 15
This work, Amateur Work, Illustrated, is
a crown 4to, and each sheet is a sheet and a half
Bell Pillar.
Fig. 19.
4IM..MJ
HIS somewhat formidable looking appa-
f!jy?k ratus, illustrated in Fig.
3,
is in reality
exceedingly simple in construction, while
it affords at once a healthy exercise and
a continual fund of amusement, alike to
youthful gymnasts and to men of mature growth. In
fact, no gymnasium can be considered complete with-
out its Giant Stride. In the public gymnasium, and in
the school ground during the hours of recreation, the
Giant Stride is never allowed to be idle. In the
gymnasium at the Crystal and Alexandra Palaces, and
the other public gymnasia throughout the country,
everyone must have observed stalwart men, flushed
with the exercise, running and swinging round and
round this aptly-named apparatus, with as much
energy and vigour as though their very life depended
upon the exercise, which indeed imparts so much of
health and vigour to the jaded frame of one too
long employed in sedentary occupations, that its popu-
larity is as explicable as it is wide-spread.
I am sure, therefore, that no apology is needed for
offering the following instructions upon the method of
making these excellent machines.
The Giant Stride consists of an upright piece of
timber, the butt end of a Norway spar or any fir
timber rounded. Its dimensions should not be less
than about 7 in. at the top and 12 in. at the bottom,
and about 20 feet in length, of which about 4
feet
are sunk into the ground. It is framed at the bottom
with sole-pieces A A, placed crossways, of
7
by i\ in.
battens 5
feet in length, and four
3
by 3
in. struts
bibb, notched and spiked on. The sole-pieces are
halved together, and secured to the bottom of the up-
right by a \ in. bolt and nut C, the nut being let or
mortised into the upright, and a hole being bored
with an auger through the sole-piece and into the
bottom of the upright until it reaches the nut. The
bottom of the spar, or upright, should be slightly
mortised into the sole-piece about an inch deep. The
top, or revolving cap Fig. 4
consists of a wrought-
iron jurnal, or spindle A, which is let into the top of
the spar. An iron ferule B must also be fitted into
the top of the spar to prevent the timber from splitting.
That part of the jurnal which is to be inserted into
the wood is ij in. square, 8 in. in length, and the
upper part is turned or forged round, to admit the
revolving cap C, whose construction is fully described
below.
Before proceeding, however, it is necessary that
you should settle how many pendant ropes you desire
to have, as of course the dimensions of the materials
vary with the number of ropes to be fitted. For that
I am at present describing, four ropes will be suffi-
cient. If to be made capable of accommodating six
or eight persons, as is done in some cases, the
apparatus would have to be proportionately increased
in strength. This is simply a matter for calculation,
and I will therefore continue on the assumption that
a Giant Stride for four adults is what you require.
The portion at the top c represents a cast-iron cir-
cular plate with four wrought-iron hooks d,d, bolted
through. This is at once the simplest and best form
made, and possesses the additional advantage of being
adaptable to any number of ropes, in case at any
time it be desired to have a larger apparatus, as you
may add as many ropes as you please by drilling as
many holes through the plate, and inserting hooks
;
and it also acts as a shield for protecting the ropes
from the weather.
It is constructed in the following manner : The
revolving plate is made of cast iron, therefore you
will have to make a pattern in wood to be sent to the
foundry to be cast from. .The illustration Fig.
4
represents a sectional view, and assuming that the
top of the spar is 7 inches in diameter, the dimensions
should be as follows : the flange c should overlap
the top 3
inches, making the whole 13 inches in
diameter, and the holes to receive the shanks E E
GYMNASTIC APPARATUS, AND HOW TO MAKE IT.
should be drilled or cast in the
plate i inch from the edge.
The pattern, which should
be of pine, may be either cut
by hand, or (which is preferable)
it may be turned in a lathe. The
flange should be I inch thick at
the boss, D, tapering to
an
inch at the edge, bevelled on
the top to allow the rain to drip
off, and fiat on the under side.
In making the pattern to be
sent to the founder, it must be
observed that, when holes are
required to be put through any
portion, you must place what is
called a core plinth over the
spot, where the hole is to be
made. In other words, when
a hole is to be cast, you must
fasten upon the pattern a piece
of wood of nearly the size and the same shape
of the hole required, with the word
"
core
"
written
upon it. This is one of the technicalities of their
trade which foundrymen understand, and which must
not be neglected. Moreover, it must be borne in
mind that, in pattern-making, the pattern for cast iron
should always be made slightly larger than what is
required, say & inch to the
foot. Thus in the core
plinth, if the hole be re-
quired to take a
f
hook,
make your plinth
-j-J
dia-
meter. Castings of this
description generally cost
about 16s. per cwt., though
of course in the iron dis-
tricts the expense would be
less.
In the pattern you are
now making, you will
require five core plinths :
one for each of the four
hooks,
diameter, and
one in the centre I inch in
diameter, to receive the end
F of the spindle or jurnal,
A. A couple of good
stout washers, G G, should
be placed over the spindle
before the cap is dropped
on, to keep it clear from
the top of the spar, and also
to resist the friction caused
by the working. It is a very
FIG. 4. SECTION OF TOP OF GIANT STRIDE
''c!
1
\
/;,r 1 'm v
good plan to have one of these
washers of brass, or gun-metal,
as those metals against iron,
work much sweeter (as the
term is), and should the oiling
be neglected and rust ensue,
gun
- metal prevents it from
setting, which will frequently
occur when a Giant Stride has
not been used for a consider-
able time. The hooks will have
to be made by a smith out
of |- in. round iron, flanged at
H H and screwed with nuts 1 1.
The ferule B should be of 2 by
i
in. flat iron welded. The
pendant ropes should be made
of 2^ in. best Manillas. A gal-
vanized thimble, spliced at one
end into the rope, should be at
the top end, and a turned handle
with a groove in the centre, tapering off at each end,
spliced on the other end. The handle should be 15 in.
in diameter and
9
in. in length.
You will observe that I have above given you the
circumference of the rope, and it is necessary to bear
in mind that in ordering any description of rope it is
the circumference which is quoted, whereas in wire
rope, and all metals, the
diameter is given.
The handles should hang
about two feet from the
ground, and the whole
should be well painted with
two coats of lead colour,
while the part which goes
underground must be well
covered with Stockholm
tar if procurable, otherwise
with gas tar ; or it may be
charred all over, though I
cannot recommend this
latter process after the
work has been fitted, as the
bolts, etc., are liable to be
loosened. The best oil to
use for the top is sperm oil,
which is a good lubricator,
and does not corrode in
cold weather.
With these instructions
I may leave you in safety
to the construction and
enjoyment of your Giant
Stride.
X^
A
'-^-^
3. ELEVATION OF GIANT STRIDE,
CASTING IN PLASTER OF PARIS. 37i
CASTING IN PLASTER OF PARIS.
By 2IARK MALLET T.
I.The Material and its Preparation.The Moulds
and How to Make Them.
iOME knowledge of the art of casting in
plaster is essential to those who model,
since without it they have no means of
giving permanence to their work. There
are also other purposes for which it may
be both useful and interesting ; for casts may be
made from various objects, natural or otherwise, and
applied, as I propose to show, to practical and deco-
rative ends.
Plaster, commonly termed
"
plaster of Paris," from
having in the first instance been brought to this
country from the quarries and works of Montmartre,
near that capital, is made from alabaster or gypsum.
This mineral, more scientifically known as sulphate of
lime, consists of sulphuric acid, pure lime, and water,
in the proportions of 46 of the first, 32 of the second,
and 22 of the third. It is found in many parts of the
British Isles, our chief supply coming from Derby-
shire. To make it into plaster, the stone is calcined
and ground in a mill. We get it in three qualities
Furniture Gazette.
Metallic Designs on Glass.An ingenious
method of obtaining mirror-like designs on glass, has
been devised by Leclerc. The glass having been
silvered by the chemical process, is coated with a
thin and uniform layer of sensitive bitumen, and this
is exposed under a transparency, the next step being
to wash away the unaltered bitumen with oil of tur-
pentine, so as to leave the bituminous design on the
silvered glass. The application of moderately strong
nitric acid removes the silver, excepting where it has
been protected by the bitumen, so that the metallic
design shows like a mirror from the reverse side of
the glass. The plate may be backed by paint or any
other suitable material.
Empty Milk Tins.These are generally con-
signed to the dust-bin, yet in the amateur's workshop
they are invaluable. Leave the smooth end, and
always open them by the other, passing the knife close
to the edge and making the cut as neat as possible.
About an inch should be left uncut, to serve as a
hinge to the flap cover. When the tin is empty, break
off the flap, wash clean, and put it on the workshop
shelf, bottom upwards to keep out the dust. These
tins will come in useful in a variety of ways : to hold
nails in out-door jobs, such as shed building, or to
hold odd screws, or scraps. As paint pots, or varnish
pots, or to keep the paint brushes in oil. For white
lead or red lead. To boil water over the gas-heater.
A small tin put into a larger (taking care to lay two
nails across the bottom to raise the inner tin), with
water in the outer one, will do excellently well to melt
glue or size, especially as an amateur generally wants
only small quantities at a time. Then the tins will cut
up most usefully, for all manner of small tin plate jobs,
such as toy-making or mending ; rather thin, and not
very large, but very clean as a rule, and therefore
easy to solder. Anyhow, the amateur ought to keep
an eye on the tins that are now so common in most
households.E. P. C.
Red Staining for Wood.The wood must first
be plunged into a solution of i oz. of curd-soap in
35
fluid ounces of water, or else be well rubbed with the
solution. Then magenta is applied in a state of suffi-
cient dilution to produce the tone required. All the
aniline colours afford efficient stains for wood when
applied in this manner.
To Imitate Ground Glass.
Put a piece of
putty in muslin, twist the fabric tight, and tie it into
the shape of a pad. Well clean the glass first, and
then apply the putty by dabbing it equally all over the
glass. The putty will exude sufficiently through the
muslin to render the glass opaque. Let it dry hard
and then varnish. If a pattern is required, cut it out
on paper as a stencil plate, and fix it on the glass
before applying the putty, then proceed as above, and
remove the stencil when the dabbing is completed.
If there should be any objection to the appearance of
clear spaces, cover them with slightly opaque varnish.
Violet Stain for Wood.The wood is treated
in a bath made up with 4} ounces of olive oil, the
same weight of soda ash, and ih pints of boiling
water. It is then dyed with magenta, to which a
corresponding quantity of tin crystals have been
added
Cement for Fastening Wood to Stone.
Melt together
4
pints of pitch and 1 of wax, and add
4
parts of pounded brick dust or chalk. It must be
warmed before using, and applied thinly tothe sur-
faces to be joined.
Damp Walls.It is said that moisture may be
kept from penetrating a brick wall by dissolving
f
lb.
of mottled soap in 1 gallon of boiling water, and
spreading the hot solution steadily with a large flat
brush over the surface of the brickwork, taking care
that it does not lather. This is to be allowed to dry
for twenty-four hours, when a solution formed of \ lb.
of alum dissolved in 2 gallons of water is to be applied
in a similar manner over the coating of soap. The
soap and alum mutually decompose each other and
form an insoluble varnish which the rain is unable to
penetrate. The operation should be performed in dry
settled weather.
Mordants for Staining Wood.Sulphuric
acid, more or less diluted, according to the intensity
of the colour to be produced, is applied with a brush
to the wood previously cleaned and dried. A lighter
or darker brown stain is obtained according to the
strength of the acid. When the acid has acted suffi-
ciently its further action is arrested by the application
of ammonia. Tincture of iodine yields a fine brown
colour, but this, however, is not permanent, unless
the air is excluded by a thick coating of polish.
Nitric acid gives a fine permanent yellow, which is
converted into brown by the subsequent application of
tincture of iodine.
Cement for Making Joints, etc.Asbestos
powder made into a thick paste with liquid silicate of
soda is used with great advantage for making joints,
fitting taps, connecting pipes, filling cracks, etc. It
hardens very quickly, stands any heat, and is steam
tight.
3
8o
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
ESSRS. CHARLES CHURCHILL & Co.,
American merchants and importers of
American machinery and tools, ask me
to announce their approaching removal,
on August I, from their present premises,
28, Wilson Street, to their new and commodious ware-
house, close to the old place, at No. 21, Cross Street,
Finsbury, where, in the spacious show-rooms at their
command, they will be able to exhibit a greatly in-
creased stock of wood-working machinery and ap-
pliances. Messrs. Churchill and Co. have heralded
their coming flitting by the issue of a new Catalogue,
extended from
1 36 to
1
56 pages, and all the more con-
venient to handle from being printed on stouter toned
paper, which shows up the engravings and letter-press
with far better effect than the thin and cold-looking
blue paper for which the firm have cherished for many
years so marked a. penchant. As may be supposed from
the greatly increased number of pages, many new
and useful articles have lately been added to Messrs.
Churchill's stock, including Murphy's Bench Clamp
and Newton's Tool Grinding Rest, to which attention
has been already called in the pages of this Magazine.
I shall have occasion to return to the pages of this Cata-
logue, for the purpose of noting those novelties which
appear most likely to be of service to my readers.
Meanwhile, it may be useful to amateurs interested in
fret-sawing, to say that Messrs. Churchill and Co. now
supply several kinds of clock movements for fret de-
signs. These movements include one and eight-day lever
timepieces, with dials ranging from 3 to
5
inches, and
varying in price from 8s. to 16s., and one, eight, and
fifteen-day pendulum clocks, mostly striking the hours,
and in some cases the half-hours too, ranging in price
from 8s. to 68s., and in diameter of dial plates from
3 to 6 inches. The prices, in every case, include dials,
hands, keys, and pendulums. Among the clocks com-
plete in case are several one-day timepieces, notably
the "Vale Gem,"
3
inches in height without base, or
4 inches with base of bronze metal heavily plated, sold
at 6s. and 7s. 3d. respectively. The Yale Gem pos-
sesses the merits of being a good time-keeper, and the
smallest pendulum clock manufactured. More attrac-
tive clocks, to my mind, will be found in tl e "Carlisle"
lever timepiece, which stands y\
inches in height in a
black ebonized case, and runs for 30 hours, sold at 13s.
and the
"
Yale Extra," a one-day timepiece,
9 inches
high, with engraved ebonized front and top, and French
dial, warranted, as the others are, to keep good time,
and sold at 6s. gd. A useful eight-day timekeeper for
the sitting-room, hall, or office, silent or striking, as
preferred, is offered at 46s. 6d. in the
"
Parlour Calen-
dar Clock," which possesses two dials, in the lower of
which the changes of the months, the days of the
month, and the days of the week are shown correctly
for Leap Year as well as for the ordinary year, the
weekly winding of the clock being all that is required
to produce all the changes that have been enumerated
as well as to keep the works in motion.
In page
94
I quoted from the Building News an
account of a trial of "The Patent Electric Paint
Remover," a speciality for the removal of old paint,
varnish, tar, smoke, stains, grease, wall-paper, etc.,
from wood, stone, iron, marble, etc., manufactured
only by the patentees, Messrs. Rendle Brothers,
8,
Westmifister Chambers, Victoria Street, London, S. W.
I had not then had an opportunity of testing this pre-
paration, as I said, and could not bear direct testimony
to its value. By the courtesy, however, of Messrs.
Rendle Brothers, who have sent me a sample tin, I
am enabled to confirm all that the representatives of
the Building News say in praise of this paint-remover,
which is certainly the best thing of its kind that has
yet been produced for the purpose for which it is
used. Its advantages are numerous. It is cheap,
being supplied in tins from
5
lbs. to 20 lbs. at the rate
of 6d. per lb., and presumably in larger quantities at
even a lower rate, as the patentees offer to make
special quotations for large quantities. Seconc'ly, it is
of a creamy consistency, devoid of smell, and does its
work of softening the old paint, and reducing it to a
condition in which the bulk can be scraped off, and the
remainder wiped or washed away without in any way
affecting the wood below, whose grain is in no way
raised or otherwise affected by its action, as it will gene-
rally be when the surface is left exposed to the action of
air and rain. Thirdly, it never fails in its effect, and
obviates any necessity of resorting to the troublesome
expedient of removing old paint by the action of heat, a
process which is known among painters as
"
devilling,"
and which often slightlychars and discolours the surface
of the wood that is subjected to it. For the removal
of paint from old oak, it is simply invaluable to the
collector of carved furniture, and especially panels and
ornamental work in this material, on account of the
special property it possesses of leaving the surface of
the wood below unharmed, and in the same condition
in which it appeared before the paint was applied to
it. It will remove the varnish from floors so treated,
and japanning, paint, etc., from all kinds of metal
work ; it will also remove grease and stains from
wood and marble when applied thinly to the part
affected with a brush, and a thin coat will cause the
complete and speedy removal of wall-paper from
papered walls, without the trouble, dirt, and delay
involved in first damping the paper with water, and
then clearing it away with a steel scraper. The
directions for use, which are very simple, are as
NOTES ON NO VELTIES. 381
follows :
1
'
Recently there has come under my
observation a very remarkable soap made
by a Belfast firm, which is said to possess
curative properties in a high degree ; it is
a most excellent article for ordinary use,
and well worth its cost. It is preferred
by bleachers at 10s. per cwt. more than
the cost of soaps hardened with soda.
This soap is called
'
Barilla Ash Soap,'
and, as its name implies, is made of Barilla
ash, in which it is said there is something
which makes it astonishingly curative and
most agreeable to the skin." Barilla is a
native soda generally imported from Spain
and the Levant, and there is no difficulty
in procuring it, but
'
Barilla ash
'
implies
a product obtained by incineration.
Please send name and address of the
Dublin firm alluded to above.
Polishing Floors.
T. S. (
Twickenham) is referred to the
articles on Floor Decoration, in Parts III.
and VI.
Self-Acting Fountain.
R. N. (Horncastle) writes,
"Seeing
one or two notices of self-acting fountains
in your excellent guide, I bug to give you
particulars of one invented by T. H.
Rushton, of Horncastle. Fig. 1 is from a
f
:
~
FIG. I.RUSHTON S SELF-ACTING
FOUNTAIN.
photograph, showing the fountain deco-
rated and playing ; it will play forty
minutes, and can be started again in half
a minute. Fig. 2 shows a basin A, and
two cisterns B and c ; to start the foun-
tain, water is poured into basin, and runs
4
~--_-
n
B
D
j
1
H
L
C
F-1
u J
FIG. 2.INTERNAL CONSTRUCTION OF
FOUNTAIN.
through pipe D, filling cistern C, and
leaving basin half full, the tap in pipe E
is then turned, shutting off the only
escape for the air, leaving only the way
in through pipe D, and the way out
through pipe F ; now take the small bent
tube H, placing one end in pipe D in basin,
and blow for half a minute, this will drive
the water out of cistern c, through pipe
F into cistern B. While the water is
passing into cistern B, the air is escaping
through pipe E (replacing the water in c)
by the tap, which acts as a vent as well
as a shut off from cistern. Cistern c is
now empty, and cistern B full, and the
fountain ready for playingturn the tap,
the water will then pass from the basin,
through pipe D into cistern c, driving
the air through E, and pressing on the
water in B, drives it through the jet G.
When done playing, turn off the tap, place
the bent tube H into pipe, and blow as
before, turn the tap and the fountain will
re-commence. This simple and efficient
fountain is sold for the small sum of
15s. 6d."
Painting Passage, etc.
X. Y. B. wishes to mention that he has
used the solution of the Indestructible
Paint Company (Cannon Street, E.C.) for
keeping the wet out of exposed brick w alls,
and that it has answered completely. He
has used the Enamel Paint, made and
supplied by this Company, for the walls
of the passage and staircase of his house,
and finds it to stand washing with soap
and even soda. This information will
doubtless prove useful to many of our
readers. The colours chosen, for the
walls of the entrance hall or passage
" I
have made (and did it in three days) the
Japanese Cabinet given with Part I., and
I like it very much. I put looking glass
at the back of it and velvet on each shelf
;
the looking-glass, six pieces, cost me
only od. I mention this as others who
are making it may like to know. I found
the parts fit well together and easy to
make. I did not put hinges to
I
the doors but just a small brass
Z. screw at the top and bottom
- of each door thus, and cut
; off the heads of the screws, and
before I put the case together I
made holes for the projecting parts
- of the screws. This I find much
the best way for all small doors.
;
Wire will do as well as screws. I
I
turned little bone knobs for the
handles of the doors out of an old
pen handle. I made the cabinet of oak
\
inch thick.'
1
Amateur Dentistry.
A Paper Stainer.It is not in my
power to give you information on making
artificial teeth, and I am afraid it is a task
on which an amateur would come utterly
to grief. Your suggestions shall have
attention. You will have seen from
"
Amateurs in Council
"
that very many
amateurs do really care about Organ-
Building and work with a will at it.
Fret-Sawing Machine, etc.
J.
T. F. (Brixton). Send a description
of the improvements you are making in
your fret-sawing machine, it will be useful
to many. Papers on fret-work will
appear at no very distant time. I am
glad you agree with my remarks on the
introduction of the human figure, animals,
etc., in designs for fret-work.
J.
T. F.
recommends the designs sold by Mr.
J.
Mercier, High Street, Slough ; Messrs.
Booth, Bros., Duhlin ; and Messrs. Bern-
rose and Sons, Old Bailey, as the best he
has seen. The only way to renovate worn
and rusty leather on dining-room chairs
is to re-cover them.
Instantaneous Grip Parallel-Vice.
E. W. H. (Chippenham) is thanked for
his communication which shall receive
attention. Entwistle and Kenyon's In-
stantaneous Grip Parallel Vice is described,
with another somewhat similar to it, in
"Every Man his Own Mechanic."
Double Dark Slide.
C. S. (Galway).See Mr. Parkinson's
article on this subject in Part VII,
Concrete Paving.
R.
C.J.
(Brixton).The floor to which
you allude is called in Devon a
'
' lime
ash" floor. It is made of lime, finely
sifted ashes, and sand in equal proportions
or thereabouts, spread over the surface
and beaten down. Quick lime should be
used. For your concrete paving, takeout
the earth to the depth of 8 or 9 inches.
For the first layer, mix coarse gravel with
sand and fresh burned lime or cement.
On this foundation spread a second layer
of finer gravel, sand, and cement, and
over this spread a surface layer of sand
and cement worked together in equal
proportions. Smooth over with a float, and
take care that no one steps on it before it is
set.
(2)
Your grindstone ought to work
with a treadle. If you call on Messrs.
R. Melhuish and Sons, and point out your
difficulty to them, they will show you how
to overcome it.
Carving in Ivory.
G. F. P. (Halifax). Some notes and
instructions on this branch of carving will
follow the present series of papers on
"
Wood Carving for Amateurs."
How to Clean Brass.
W. M. B.
( Walthamstow).Practical
papers and suggestions from you will be
gladly received. W. M. B. writes : "The
mixture of nitric and sulphuric acids used
for cleaning brass can be bought of any
druggist by asking for
'
dipping,' the best
is ad. per lb., a pint to the pound. The
process of
'
dipping
'
may be thus de-
scribed. The articles must be very clean
;
they must be dipped in the acid, then into
clean water, and then into lukewarm
water. They must then be dried in saw
dust, that from mahogany or box being
preferable to deal sawdust. The warm
water dries off more quickly and prevents
tarnishing. Hot water will tarnish."
Kindly contribute a paper on the subjects
you mention, namely Dipping, Dead
Dipping, Bright Dipping, and Burnishing
Brass ; Lacquering, Florentine Bronzing,
Green Bronzing, etc.
Amateur Bookbinding.
R. B. (Bedale). Kindly send a paper
describing your "set out" of working
materials for bookbinding, with sketches.
It will not interfere in any way with the
articles now appearing on this subject,
and the cheapness of the tools will ren.
der the paper a boon to many an amateur
who has not much to lay out on appli-
ances for his work. You need not put
your real name to the article if you do
not care to do so.
Lapidary Work.
J.
C. (Stoke Newington).This subject
has been entered on the list of those
which our readers have suggested, but it
is not possible to name any fixed time for
its commencement.
3
36
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
Making Wiped Joint.
B. F. W. {Forest Lane, E.).Open
out end of one pipe with a turnpin, and
soil that end and that of the other pipe
with lamp-black and thin glue. Then
when dry, shave the soiled end of opened
pipe inside and out for about one inch
(for
%
or J-inch joint), and also the out-
side of the other pipe for ij inch, and
well "touch
"
the shaved parts, put them
together, and with a small ladle pour
plenty of hot metal into the soiled parts
to heat the pipe, and then a small, drib-
bling stream on to the shaved parts. Then
with a
"
cloth
"
about three inches square,
well touched, wipe the metal round the
joint, making it large in the middle.
Continue pouring metal and wiping till
the joint looks neat and symmetrical.
Then with a dull red-hot plumber's iron
{\\ lb.) melt off any metal that may be on
the soiled parts, and wipe smooth.
Finish by rubbing touch on joint. All
details will be given in a set of papers on
plumbing, etc., which will appear when
those on gas-fitting are finished.
Sharpening Tools.
C. E. S. {Camden 1 own). Try olive
oil as a lubricant. You hold the plane
iron seemingly in too upright a position
and unconsciously vary the angle of incli-
nation when rubbing it on the hone. Any
jobbing carpenter in your neighbourhood
will show you how to do it for a small fee,
and a little showing is worth more than a
great deal of telling.
Red Paint for Houses.
St. E.The dark red paint with which
many houses in the neighbourhood of the
South Kensington Museum is painted is
known as
"
terra cotta colour." I am not
aware that it possessed any peculiar protec
-
tive properties,or that its composition differs
from ordinary oil colour. Can any reader
supply information respecting this paint ?
Amateur Printing.
E. W. C. {Stoke Newington). A series
of articles on this subject will be com-
menced in Part XII., when the information
you ask for will be given. Meanwhile,
apply to M. Squintani & Co., 3,
Ludgate
Circus Buildings, E.C., for their pamphlet,
"How to Print," post-free for 7d.
Carpenters' Bench.
G. P. W. {Fleetwood).The construc-
tion of various kinds of carpenters'
benches is given in
*'
Every Man his Own
Mechanic." Whenever anything of this
kind is suggested that is possessed of
novelty and utility, it will be described and
illustrated in the pages of this Magazine.
microscopes.
W. H. E. {Tandragee).
You are
thanked for your good wishes. The con-
struction of microscopes, magic-lanterns,
and magic-lantern slides will be treated
in time.
Callipers with Adjusting Screw.
A. B. ( Whiiland). I am not aware
that callipers are made on the principle you
suggest, that is to say, with an adjusting
screw by which the distance between the
jaws can be easily regulated, but any tool
maker will make you a pair.
Catch to Box.
Inceptor advises A. Jack to put a
rectangular brass (or wooden) plate over
the keyhole of his box. It should be held
in three of the corners by semicircular
headed screw nails. In the fourth corner
the hole in the plate should be enlarged,
so as to allow the nail to be pushed in, so
that it may move the catch. Part of the
wood behind the brass plate H must be
hollowed out where it is left white in the
sketch. In the space must be put the
FIG. 1.CATCH OF BOX CLOSED BY SPRING.
FIG. 2.BRASS PLATE CONCEALING CATCH.
FIG. 3.MODE OF RELEASING CATCH.
catch A B G, turning on an axis at G. The
bent part A is pushed forward through a
hole above the brass plate H, into a hole
formed in the strip of wood M (which is
nailed to the lid) by a spring B, and thus
secures the lid. When the box is to be
opened the knob K is to be pushed in-
wards, this will cause A B G to turn on G,
and leave the hole in M, and the lid may
now be lifted.
Photographic Apparatus.
Amateur.A series of papers on
making a set of photographic apparatus
by Mr. James Parkinson is now appearing.
Venetian Blinds.
I. D. (Llanelly).A paper on this sub-
ject, with working drawings, is in prepara-
tion, and will appear shortly.
Model Engines.
Engine Driver. Papers on the con-
struction and working of model engines
will be given in due course. Indeed, it
will be sought to touch on every subject
of interest in turn.
Polishing Ebony.
Fretwork. Instructions for prepar-
ing and polishing ebonised wood have
been given already in the pages of this
Magazine, both in
"
Ways and Means,"
"
Notes on Novelties,' and in a special
paper on "French Polishing and Spirit
Varnishing." If you are using ebony try
linseed oil or any good furniture paste.
This will heighten the natural colour of
the wood without coating it with an arti-
ficial gloss or surface.
Harmonium Reeds for Sale.
C.
J.
C. {Haverstoek Hill) writes,
"
I believe you will shortly commence
papers on
'
How to Make a Harmonium,'
this being the case, I beg to inform you
that I have thirty large harmonium reeds,
the largest of which (bottom C) 4J inches
long and
.J
inch wide. These would do
excellently for forming a good ground
bass for a harmouium. To an amateur
who is about to build his harmonium, I
would sell them for 10s. I have also a
good set of organ pedals, thirty notes,
which would suit an organ, which I would
sell fori."
Information Wanted.
J.
T. F. {Brixton) wishes to know how
to remove the marble slab of a small
chamber cupboard which is cemented on.
It is grey marble, and only
f
inches thick.
Can any reader help him ?
Miscellaneous.
J.
F. [Norton Canes). (1) Nitric acid,
popularly called aquafortis, is commonly
of a reddish colour, unless pure, when it
is colourless. It is an intensely acid and
corrosive liquid, and is a powerful solvent
of the metals, and decomposes all vege-
table substances. (2) State what kind of
engraving you wish to effect, andthenatuie
of the material.
(3)
Messrs. R. Melhuish
& Sons, of 85 and 87, Fetter Lane, E.C.;
Mr. A. S. Lunt, 297, Hackney Road, E.
;
or Messrs. C. Churchill & Co. , 28, Wilson
Street, Finsbury, E.G., will supply you
with fret-saw blades if you cannot obtain
them nearer home.
H. S. {Reddings).Vol. II. of AMA-
TEUR Work, Illustrated, will be
commenced with Part XII., dated Nov.
1882.
I. G. W. {Finsbury Park).A design
for a couch in what may be termed coarse
fret work, in imitation of the form of the
Austrian bent-wood furniture, shall be
given. Instructions for all musical instru
ments that it is possible for amateurs
make will be given in due course, as
opportunity offers.
be
u-
to
\
CASTING IN PLASTER OF PARIS.
38/
CASTING IN PLASTER OF PARIS.
By MARK MALLETT.
r
II. Tools used in CastingWax MouldingPiece
MouldingElastic MouldsCasting from
Natural Objects.
B!HE tools required for casting are few and
simple, a basin and spoon being the
chief. Yet for backing up both mould and
cast, a mason's trowel of small size will be
found useful, and a "drag" will be required
for smoothing the backs of casts,
grounds, etc. A drag some three
inches long, such as that shown in
Fig. 1, can be cut with a file from
any piece of flat steel ; an old steel
stay-bone, for instance, makes capital
drags. For use in mending, and for
various purposes, a small steel spatula
will be indispensable. This instrument
is shown in Fig. 2. It costs oxl. at
the tool-shop. One end forms the spatula, the
other is a notched blade for scraping plaster.
Those commonly sold have serrated teeth, but an
improved form has square teeth like those of the
drag. These give a far better surface to the plaster.
For working on the plaster cast, small gouges of various
degrees of curvature (Fig.
3)
are sold, also
"
riffles,"
which are diminutive rasps
; but these things may well
be done without by the beginner.
Indeed, good and experienced modellers, as a rule,
avoid working on the plaster cast as much as possible,
choosing rather to finish their work carefully in the
clay. A far better
surface, whether for
delicacy or effect, is
to be given in the
latter material. It
is ratWer the young
modeller, who is in
undue haste to cast
his work, who will
find himself obliged
DRAG FOR SMOOTHING BACKS
OF CASTS, ETC.
FIG. 2. COMBINED SPATULA AND SCRAPER.
FIG. 3. GOUGE FOR PLASTER CASTING.
to give much time to touching-up his plaster. The
tyro will see defects in the cast which had escaped
him in the clay. More especially he will be sure
to find that it has a "lumpy" appearancethat
there are hills and hollows where there ought to be
fiat surfaces or regular curves, and this he will have
to remedy. Sand paper, if used firmly, will do this.
The right sizes are middle and fine No. 2, coarser
will scratch the work, and finer will become choked
directly.
It should be remembered that it is whilst fresh from
the mould that the cast is in the best state to be worked
upon. There are cases in which the mould may be
worked upon with advantage. For instance, suppose
the model to be a relief, and that in course of the work
the background on which it is formed has lost its
original truth and evenness. The projections of the
model may render it difficult to get at and correct this.
But in the mould, where everything is reversed, the
ground becomes the most prominent and easily reached
part, and by the use of the drag we can in a few
minutes make our ground perfectly true and smooth.
Again, we may wish to put a name or other inscrip-
tion on some part of our model in
raised letters. To model raised letters
in the clay would be a work of con-
siderable time ; by incising them, in
reverse, in the mould, which will be
quickly done, we shall secure precisely
the same result, as the letters will
appear raised in the cast.
Some persons object to the brilliant
whiteness of plaster, and like it better
"toned down." It must be admitted that the effect of
toned plaster is more artistic. Yellow ochre imparts a
pleasing tone. To give a uniform tint take as much
water as there is any possibility of your requiring for
mixing the fine plaster used in facing your cast, and
stir in ochre. A slight tinge will sufficemuch does
not look well, and moreover softens the plaster, and
then, as there will be a sediment, pour off your
coloured water for use into another vessel. It is im-
portant to mix enough, as it would be difficult to
make a second quantity of exactly the same shade.
The directions given above, so far as they treat
generally of the
mixing and man-
agement of plaster,
will equally apply
to casting models
of other shapes. I
have taken a
"
re-
lief" as an example,
because it is the
most simple form,
and can be cast in a single piece. Such additional
instructions as may be required to enable the amateur
to waste-mould a model in the
"
round," can be quickly
given.
Instead of a panel, let us suppose that a vase
has been modelled. This may serve as an illus-
tration of a simple object in the "round." If we
tried to mould this at a single operation, we should
find it impossible either to extract the clay or to clean
the mould. The mould must therefore be made in
two pieces.
To prepare this model for moulding, as shown in
R
3
88 CASTING IN PLASTER OF PARIS.
Fig.
S,
we must make a strip of clay, the sixth of an
inch thick, and about two inches wide, and stick it
edgewise round the vase, so as to divide the latter into
two equal portions. This collar can be supported by
wire pins, as shown at a, a, a. One side of the vase
can now be moulded, for the collar of clay will pre-
vent the plaster from reaching the other side. When
the first half of the mould is set, the collar must be
removed, and conical holes made at intervals, with
the end of the scraper in the edge of the mould thus
left bare. These are
"
key
"
holes, and as when the
other half of the mould is cast, corresponding "keys"
will be formed to fit them, they will enable the two
halves to be put together with the nicest precision.
Some clay-water must be brushed over the edges, to
prevent the two halves adhering too closely, and the
remaining part of the mould can then be cast. When
a model has to be cast in an upright position, as is
the case with a bust, or with this vase, plaster cannot
be poured upon it ; it must be thrown on with the
spoon.
The mould being finished, its two halves will
easily be forced apart by the mallet and chisel. The
clay can then be removed, the mould cleaned, and
fitted together again. The keys will ensure the pieces
fitting accurately. They then have to be tied together
as tightly as is possible. Perfect tightness is to be
secured by tying a piece of string or cord, according
to the size of the work, loosely round the mould,
passing a piece of stick through it, and twisting the
stick round and round. When you can screw it no
farther, secure the stick from untwisting by tying it
fast. You can then pour in the plaster gradually,
and well shaking and turning the mould about whilst
you do so. When the mould has been chipped off,
a little seam will appear on the cast where the two
pieces of the mould met, which will have to be
cleaned off.
A bust might be moulded in the above manner
;
but if so, the seam would necessarily pass down the
ears and along the neck and shoulders, where it
would be highly unsightly. The method shown in
Fig.
4 is therefore generally preferred instead. By
thus making a "pot-lid," the seam is formed only
on the hair, in a part where it will be little noticed,
and the opening thus made will allow of every purpose
of emptying and cleaning the mould of the head.
Sometimes a portion of the model may project
from the general mass of the work so far, that it
would be a difficult matter to mould it in situ. If so,
it may be cut off with a fine piece of wire, and moulded
separately, and afterwards refixed in its place.
As a cast becomes dry, a disagreeable yellow tinge,
the result of some impurity in the plaster, will some-
times come to the surface. To obviate this, the cast
should be placed with its back to a fire, and so dried.
As the water evaporates, it will bring out the dis-
colouration on the side by which it escapes, and the
front of the cast will thus be uninjured.
Wax- Moulding.The above is the ordinary and
most useful method of waste-moulding ; but there is
another, which is sometimes applied to delicate models,
which will not bear the use of mallet and chisel. This
is practised by pouring melted wax over the model, to
form an inner mould, and then backing, as usual, with
plaster. This wax mould can be pulled away from the
cast, with a little warming, without danger to the
finest work.
It is by one or other of these processes that the
clay model has always to be transformed into a plas-
ter cast. But if it is required to multiply copies of such
casts, or of other suitable objects, other means than
waste-moulding will have to be resorted to. This must
be done either by an elastic mould, or by a piece mould.
Elastic Moulds.First, as to the- elastic mould,
which is recommended
by
its simplicity, and the
ease with which it can be madefor those purposes
to which it is suited. Its value may readily be per-
ceived. Fig. 6 may be supposed to represent one
quarry of a diaper, which has been modelled, and of
which a number will be required. Fig. 7
shows the
same in section.
It is plain that no mould formed in a single piece
from any rigid material, could leave this panel without
breakage ; but we get over the difficulty if we make
our mould of some substance so yielding as to allow it
to be drawn over the projecting points seen in the
section, and so elastic as, when drawn off, to recover
its former shape. From such a mould we may take
as many casts, in moderation, as we can require.
Various substances have been used for making
such moulds, but that most approved by the best
moulders is gelatine. Having first made a single cast
by the waste-moulding process, take best sheet gela-
tine lib., beeswax 4 oz., water
J
of a pint. Boil
them in a glue-pot till they form a thick syrup ; rub a
little oil (or what is better, hog's lard) over your cast,
and then pour on the mixture. It should be used warm,
but not boiling. The best and purest gelatine, at about
2s. per pound, should be used. Some use glue, or
cheap gelatine ; but these cannot be recommended.
When the mould comes to be filled, the plaster grows
warm in setting, and the heat thus generated is apt to
melt an inferior mould.
Piece Moulding.By this method objects in the
round, objects in relief if they are large, and indeed
most objects from which a casting mould is required,
are moulded. It is by this method that the cheap
plaster images, and almost all the plaster casts sold
in the shops, are produced.
CASTING IN PIASTER OF PARIS.
339
Piece moulds are made of plaster, but in a number
of sections, so arranged that each piece can be pulled,
without obstruction, from the cast. That they may
thus "leave" freely, often necessitates that these sec-
tions should be very small and numerous. In making
a piece mould from a face, for instance, a dozen pieces
or more will often have to be made.
A piece mould cannot be taken direct from the
clay model. A cast must first be made by means of a
waste mould. This cast must, as a first step, be rubbed
over with a little hog's lard. Lard, on account of its
whiteness, is better than oil or any kind of grease,
which might discolour the work. This is to keep cast
and mould from sticking together. A little plaster
must then be mixed, and the first section of the mould
built up with the spatula on the cast. It will have to
be made some three-quarters of an inch thick, or more,
according to circumstances.
When this piece has set, it can be pulled from the
cast, its sides trimmed round with a knife, and lard
must be rubbed over them. It must then be re-
placed, and two more pieces can be cast on two of its
opposite sides ; the outer edges of which will in their
turns require paring and greasing ; and the work can
thus be carried on till the whole cast has been mapped
out and covered with pieces larger or smaller, as the
necessity for making them "leave" the surface freely
may demand.
Lastly, an outer mould or shell, in two or more
large pieces, to envelope and bind all the small pieces
together, has to be made. Before the mould is filled,
these have in their turn to be tied and bound together
with string. When this has been done so closely will
all the different pieces, which have been cast one
upon another, necessarily fit togetherthe mould will
seem almost as firm and compact as if formed of a
single piece.
When such a mould is filled, a much thinner cast
may be made than in a waste mould. A defect be-
longing to the piece mould is that a little seam will
show upon the cast wherever two pieces meet, and
require cleaning away. A mould of this kind may be
kept for any length of time, and filled repeatedly; but
the seams will grow wider and more unsightly with use.
Piece moulding is a delicate and tedious operation,
and one which demands both skill and patience. Its
practice can scarcely be recommended to the ama-
teur, till he has had some practice in the manipulation
of plaster by simpler methods.
Moulding from Marble.For reproducing marble
statuary in plaster, piece moulding is usually em-
p'oyed, nor is there any material from which a piece
mould can be more readily taken. Instead of lard or
oil, however, white curd soap, only, must be used on
marble.
Casting from Nature.Among the applications of
the art of casting, none is more generally interesting
than this. It is within the reach of the most idle
amateur, and will well repay him for bestowing a few
odd hours upon it. To model a piece of good orna-
ment, or still more, faithfully to pourtray the form or
features of a friend, demands study and aptitude; but
by means of casting, results somewhat similar may
be borrowed direct from nature by any one. Let us
begin with the human figure.
Though of course inferior in those qualities to the
face, the human hand is full of character and expres-
sion. It is easy to recognise the hand of one with
whom we are familiar. A cast of the hand is a
pleasant memento, and few things can be easier than
to make such a cast.
The sleeve of the person to be operated on should
be rolled up, and a towel twisted round it at the point
at which the cast is to terminate. A little oil should
be rubbed over the skin. As a cast showing one side
of the hand will generally be all that is required, the
mould can be made in a single piece. A soft pillow
should be provided, a towel spread over it, and on
that a newspaper. With a little arrangement, the
pillow can so far be made to accommodate itself to
the form of the hand, and will so rise round it as to
leave no openings beneath ; for if openings are left,
the plaster will run into them, and there will then be
a difficulty in getting the mould away. The mould
can then be made in the usual manner. The hand
must of course be kept -perfectly still till the plaster
has set, or the work will be spoiled ; after it has set, it
will be still of necessity till the mould has been
removed. When the mould is finished the hand can
be lifted from the pillow, the paper will prevent the
plaster from sticking to the towel. Any little tongues
of plaster which may have found their way under the
fingers can be cut away with the scraper, and the
hand will be released without difficulty. When all is
finished, and the mould clipped away, the operator
can scarcely fail to be pleased with the result of his
labours. Every fold of skin, and line, and marking,
will be seen reproduced with the most microscopic
fidelity.
Both sides may be moulded if desired, and the
hand reproduced in the round instead of in relief, by
making a second half to the mould, according to the
methods already described.
Not so easy is it to mould the face or "mask," as
a cast of the face is called ; though this when taken is
a thing of far higher value, for in no other way is so
faithful a copy of the features to be obtained. The
person whose face is to be operated upon should lie
on his back, or sit with his head thrown backwards on
a cushion. Towels should be placed over the hair
39
CASTING IN PLASTER OP PARIS.
and round the throat, to prevent
the plaster running where it is
not wanted. Whatever hair will
necessarily come in contact with
the plaster, as round the forehead,
the eyebrows, moustache, beard,
and whiskers, must be well plas-
tered down with soap. Casting
a male mask is a matter of far
greater difficulty in these days
than it was in those of our fathers
and grandfathers, when men went
clean shaven. The hair and eye-
brows are easily disposed of, but
the beard and moustaehe are less
tractable ; and the novice is father
advised to try his skill in the first
place on a boy or a woman. A
little soap or oil should be rubbed
over the skin, and as the mouth
will have to be kept close shut
throughout the operation, quills
or straws must be provided for
insertion in the nostrils, that
respiration may not be stopped.
The plaster should
be mixed with warm water.
The sensation when
liquid plaster is poured over the face is by no means
an agreeable one, and this
precaution will tend to the
comfort of the patient
; besides,
as it will lessen the
shock it will lessen the danger of any involuntary
movement of the muscles of the face, and that these
should remain rigid till the plaster has set, is essential
to success.
During the ten minutes or
so which must elapse before
the mould is hard enough to
be removed, the time will
pass tediously for the person
operated upon, and though
there will be no real difficulty
in taking it off, if the instruc-
tions given be carefully fol-
lowed, some little pain may
be occasioned
; for any stray
hairs which have become im-
bedded in the plaster, will
probably be pulled out, and
will come off with it.
In a cast thus taken, the
eyes will of course be closed,
and the expression will be
one of sleep. This is some-
times altered afterwards, if
the person who takes the
cast has somj little skill in
FIG. 4. POT-LID IN MOULD FOR BUST.
FIG. 5.METHOD OF MAKING MODEL FOR VASE.
modelling, the eyes can be carved
and made to appear open ; and
the remainder of the head and
bust can be modelled to the mask
from nature. But a work so
treated is rarely satisfactory. It
is really better and more valuable
as a memento when kept as
taken, and looks well if mounted
on a slab of wood, covered with
dark velvet.
Taking a mask in this manner
after death, though a melancholy,
is a much easier task. Under
such circumstances no danger of
failure is to be dreaded. That
impatience on the one hand, and
hurry on the other, which act as
disturbing influences in casting
from life, have not now to be
taken into account. A mask
taken after death forms a sad,
but precious memorial, and is an
invaluable help to the modeller if
a posthumous bust should ever be required.
Such small animals as are cased in fur or feathers
are difficult subjects for the caster, but fishes and rep-
tiles are well adapted for his purposes. These lower
organisations can, with little trouble, be arranged in
life-like positions and moulded, a little oil being first
brushed over them. Sand can either be packed
beneath them, so as to allow the mould to be taken in
one piece, or they can be half buried in that material,
and their upper halves first
moulded. They can then be
carefully lifted up, the sand
cleaned away, the edge of
the mould keyed and clay-
watered, and the second half
of the mould cast. By this
means casts in the round
will be obtained, and the plan
is admirable for reproducing
fishes or snakes, though not
so easily applied to reptiles
with feet, such as lizards.
Casts from animal life are
often of scientific value for
preserving the forms of re-
markable specimens. They
are frequently most useful,
for reference, to the designer
and carver in wood, stone,
etc., or they may be made
of service to those who work
CASTING IN PLASTER OF PARIS.
39-
FIG. 7.
in metal or electrotype. A prettier,
if not a more interesting depart-
ment in the "art of casting, is that
which deals with vegetable forms,
and chiefly with foliage. Leaves
are admirable subjects, and easily
dealt with.
If we take a single leaf and lay
it on a table or flat board with a
new to moulding, we shall at once
see that it does not lie flat. It will
touch only in two or three places.
It is not the custom of nature to
model her leaves in a single plane
;
she has so designed them, that
from whatever point of view we
may regard them, they will present
variety and beauty of curve. If
therefore we desire to reproduce the
leaf as nature has formed it, we
must not flatten it, or allow it to
be flattened by the weight of the
plaster. We must find means of
supporting it in its natural attitude. There are
different methods of so fixing leaves, but none is
simpler than to take sand, as advised in casting small
animals. Spread a level surface of this on your table
or board, and lay the leaf upon it. With the spatula
it is easy so to pack sand beneath the leaf as to support
it in every part. Leaves do not require preparing for
moulding by either damping or oiling.
When the mould has set, it may be lifted from the
sand, and the leaf will then be seen sticking to its
under surface. Probably the plaster will in places
have run in a little, and overlapped it. If so, such
superfluous plaster may be carefully cut away with a
pen-knife, after which the
leaf can be peeled from the
mould without difficulty
;
and the sand which adheres
to the outer surface of the
mould can also be brushed
away.
As the mould is chipped
off, the operator will indeed
be hard to please if he is
not both delighted and
astonished with the effect
of his work. He will see
every serration, every vein
and marking traced out
with the most perfect deli-
cacy in the pure white
plaster, and will be struck
with beauties of form and
FIG. 6.
QUARRY OF A DIAPER.
SECTION OF QUARRY
FROM A TO B.
arrangement, which, when ac-
companied by their natural colour,
had wholly escaped his notice. By
exercising a little judicious pack-
ing, fruits and berries can also be
cast.
For the wood and stone carver,
and indeed for all who practise the
arts of decorative design, the im-
portance of possessing casts from
foliage cannot be over-rated: in no
other way can the designer so well
have nature at hand for permanent
reference. Such casts may also be
applied direct to the purposes of
decoration. For indoor uses, where
plaster can be safely employed,
casts from leaves and fruits, taste-
fully arranged, may be used for
capitals, cornices, diapers, etc. In
Fig. 8 a rough attempt has been
made to show how such familiar
leaves as those of the strawberry
and gooseberry might in this manner be utilised in
diaper as a wall decoration.
In this diagram only a simple arrangement of
detached leaves has been shown, each enclosed in a
sunk panel which may be struck with the compasses,
and cut out in plaster in a few minutes. But it is
possible so to combine different leaves and fruits as to
form most elaborate designs. In this latter case it
will generally be better to cast each leaf, etc., sepa-
rately, and afterwards to fit them in their places. If,
however, the design when thus put together has to be
repeated again and again in course of the decoration,
a gelatine mould should of course be taken of the
"
repeat," copies of which
will thus be quickly multi-
plied. In Fig. 8 two gela-
tine moulds are supposed
to be employed.
It will thus be seen that
casting from nature may
by itself, and for its own
sake, be considered an in-
teresting art, and one
worthy the attention of the
amateur. The directions
given for carrying out work
of this kind for decorative
purposes will, it is hoped, be
of service to many to whom
the utilisation of natural ob-
jects in this manner has not
fig. 8.
The Watch-
7>iakers' Handbook
by
the same author and trans-
lator, was noticed in Part VI. of this Magazine.
Escapements used for clocks of various kinds are
usually comprised under three varieties. , Recoil
escapements, in which the supplementary swing of
the pendulum
/
x
^
^
N
after a tooth has
E
/
N
.
\ p-
escaped causes
a backward mo-
tion to the es-
cape- wheel.
Dead-beat es-
capements, in
which the tooth
of the escape-
wheel falls on a
pallet face form-
ing an arc of a
circle struck
from the centre of motion of the pallets
; in this the
escape-wheel remains stopped "dead" during the
supplementary swing of the pendulum. Detached
escapements, in which the escape-wheel does not act
directly on the pallets, excepting during a very brief
period; this form of escapement is used mostly for
turret clocks, and others where the motive power is
variable. All these varieties of escapement have
peculiar characteristics, and each is advantageous for
M.
c-
^mmh
FIG. IO.RECOIL CLOCK ESCAPEMENT.
FIG. II. RECOIL CLOCK ESCAPEMENT.
certain purposes, it will therefore be useful to give a
description of each one.
Recoil escapements are most frequently used in
ordinary household clocks. Eight-day English clocks
usually have recoil escapements. Robert Hook is
credited with the invention of the recoil or anchor
escapement in
the latter half of
the seventeenth
century. Reid,
in his Treatise
on Clock and
Watchmaking,
published in
1S26, thus points
out the proper-
ties of the recoil
escapement.
When the teeth
of the escape-
wheel drop or
fall on either of
the pallets, these, from their form, cause all the
wheels to have a retrograde motion, opposing, at
the same time, the pendulum in its ascent, the
descent being equally promoted from the same cause.
This recoil, or retrograde motion of the wheels,
which is imposed on them by the reaction of the
pendulum, is sometimes nearly a third, sometimes
nearly a half or more of the previous advancement of
the movement. This is perhaps the greatest or the
only defect that can properly be imputed to the recoil
escapement. It is the cause of the greater wearing in
the holes, pivots, or pinions, than that which takes
place in a clock having the dead-beat escapement.
This defect may partly be removed by making the
recoil small, or a little more than merely a dead-beat.
After a clock with a recoil escapement has been
brought to time, any additional motive force that is put
to it will not greatly increase the arc of vibration, yet
the clock will be found to go considerably faster. It
is known that where the arc of vibration is increased
even but very slightly, the clock ought to go slower.
The force of the recoil pallets tends to accelerate and
multiply the number of vibrations according to the
increase of the motive force impressed upon them,
and hence the clock will gain on the time to which it
was before regulated. Professor Ludlam, of Cam-
bridge, who had four clocks in his house, three of them
with dead-beat escapements and the other with recoil,
said,
"
That none of them kept time, fair or foul, like
the last ; this kind of escapement gauges the pen-
dulum, the dead-beat leaves it at liberty." The reader
must recollect that this was written upwards of fifty
years ago. In the last handbook on watches and
44 HOUSEHOLD CLOCKS.
clocks published, da'ed six months ago, we read of the
recoil escapement that, when well made, it gives very
fair results, but ihe pallets are oflen very improperly
formed, although none of the escapements are easier
to set out correctly. There are still people who
believe the recoil to be a better escapement than
the dead-beat, mainly because the former requires a
greater variation of the driving power to affect the
extent of the vibration of the pendulum than the
latter does. But the matter is beyond argument ; the
recoil escapement can be cheaply made, and is a useful
escapement, but beyond question it is inferior to the
dead-bent for time-keeping.
The instructions for setting out a recoil escape-
ment given by Mr. T.
J.
Britten, in his Watch and
Clockmakers' Handbook, are as follows : Draw a
circle representing the escape-wheel which we assume
to have thirty teeth, of which number, the anchor
embraces eight. Mark off the position of the fourth
tooth on each side of a vertical line drawn through the
centre of the wheel
; draw radial lines, which will
represent the backs of the teeth. The position of
the teeth is easily ascertained by a protractor thus :
the space between the teeth is equal to 360 divided
by the number of teeth, that is
s
f
= I2 -
There are
seven spaces between eight teeth, so that the space to
be marked off between the teeth is equal to 12
-f- 7,
that is 84
;
half of this on each side of the vertical
line will be 42" from the
90
line on the protractor.
The centre of the motion for the pallets is at a point, on
the vertical line, fourteen-tenths of the radius of the
escape-wheel from the centre of it ; that is to say,
measure the radius of the escape-wheel, add four-
tenths of the distance, and mark a point on the vertical
line which will show the centre of the pallets. From
the centre of the pallets draw a circle through the
points, of the teeth marked on the circumference of the
escape-wheel. The arc of this circle will be found to
bisect the vertical line midway between the centre of
the pallets and the centre cf the escape-wheel. From
this circle, struck from the centre of the pallets, draw
tangents through the points of the teeth that are
marked. These tangent lines show the positions for
the faces upon the pallets, but these faces are always
rounded somewhat in practice. The pallets are cut
off at those points which allow half the impulse to each,
that is, when one tooth drops off one pallet, the point
of the other pallet is just midway between two
teeth. The illustrations of the recoil escapement show
this. The form of teeth shown in the escape-wheel
isadopted, so that if the pendulum is swung excessively,
the points of the pallets butt against the thick roots of
the teeth, and do no injury as they would if the teeth
were nearly straight, and the motion of the pendulum
arrested by the face of the pallet butting on the tops.
The diagrams, Figs. 10 and 1
T,
show how to draw
a recoil escapement. These illustrations are lettered
to facilitate the description ; and if any reader has a
clock provided with this form of escapement, which he
suspects to be faulty, it will be very easy to draw a
diagram showing accurately the proper form, and then
compare it with the actual dimensions and shapes
of the various parts.
A piece of thin sheet metal is the best material to
draw such a diagram upon ; sheet zinc is convenient.
First drill a hole to represent the centre of the escape-
wheel, and enlarge this to allow the axis of the escape-
wheel to go through, andy?/ where the wheel lies in
contact with the plate. Draw the various lines, by
means of a scriber, so as to get the position of the
pallet-centre and then gauge the position of the actual
pivot holes in the clock. Of course the hole must be
drilled in the metal plate to correspond with the pivot
hole in the clock. The hole is enlarged to fit the
pallet axis, and the escape-wheel and pallets may be
tried on the plate. Having due regard to any pecu-
liarities of the especial escapement being examined,
proceed to draw the various lines as indicated in the
accompanying diagram, and any error in the form of
the pallets will be shown by comparison. It may
possibly appear somewhat erratic to suggest that an
amateur may correct errors in escapements produced
by professedly skilled clockmakers. If the workman
really worked on correct principles, no doubt the
suggestion would be erratic. In practice, however,
many clocks are made by men who work alone, with-
out any knowledge of theoretical principles, and who
idolatrously worship the
"
rule-of-thumb." These
workmen by practice attain considerable skill, and are
able to produce 'good-looking work at a low price.
They seldom have any opportunity of seeing the
practical result of their labour, and hence have no
knowledge of any defects that may exist.
The diagram, Fig. 10, is lettered as follows:A is
the centre of the escape-wheel, B the centre of the
pallets, C, D, is a horizontal line drawn through the
points of the escape-wheel teeth ; E, A, is a line drawn
from the centre of the escape-wheel through the point
of a tooth on the left, and F, A, a corresponding line on
the right, G, B, is a line from the centre of the pallets
through the point of the escape-wheel tooth on the
left, and h, b, a corresponding line on the right. With
B as centre a circle is drawn through the points where
the lines F, A, and G, B, intersect each other, and also
C, D, on the left, and the lines F, a, and H, B, intersect
C, D, on the right. From the point of intersection on
the right, divide the half-circle into six equal parts, and
five-sixths of the semi-diameter of the circle will give
the point I. 'Ihe line from I to the point of the tooth
gives the face of the pallet on the right, and the line
HOUSEHOLD CLOCKS.
405
C, D, gives the face of the pallet on the left. The
length of this pallet is determined by the line drawn
from the centre B, and distant from it precisely half
of the space between the wheel-teeth. By these
means the various dimensions are obtained. The
shape of the pallets may be made to suit the fancy so
long as the faces against which the escape-wheel teeth
impinge are kept to the form indicated. In the
drawing, the tooth on the right is shown just free of
the pallet. The arrow indicates the direction that the
wheel travels, the tooth on the left impinging on the
pallet forces it upwards, the tooth sliding along its
face till it reaches the end, and the pallet on the left
will then be in the position to receive the tooth shown
inside the circle. Practically the pendulum continues
to swing some distance after the tooth has escaped,
and the non-acting sides of the pallets must be so
formed that they are quite clear of the backs of the
tee:h. These parts of the pallets are shown drawn
from the centre P., and will therefore be correct.
The diagram, Fig. 11, is lettered in precisely the
same manner, the proportions being, however, dif-
ferent. The diagram of the escape-wheel is drawn,
and the radial lines E, F, are drawn through the
points of two teeth, as shown. The lines G and H are
drawn and their intersection at B gives centre of the
pallets. The faces of the pallets are determined in
much the same manner as previously described. The
point 1 being five-sevenths of a semi diameter from
the point of the tooth. These illustrations are merely
intended to show the extended application of the
principles that have been explained.
Dead-beat escapements are an improvement on
the recoil. Regulators and the better class of house-
hold clocks have dead- beat escapements. George
Graham invented this form of escapement about the
beginning of the eighteenth century. The term dead-
beat is in contradistinction to recoil. The faces of the
pallets in a dead-beat escapement are concentric
with the centre of oscillation, so that during the
supplementary swing of the pendulum the train re-
mains perfectly stationary. The impulse is given to
the pendulum through another face of the pallet which
is inclined to the axis of oscillation in the same as a
recoil escapement pallet. Dead-beat clocks, having a
seconds hand, and watches also, remain perfectly
dead during the greater portion of time. The
seconds hand jumps from one division to another,
and remains. With recoil escapements, the seconds
hand wiil be observed to jump from one division to
another, but instead of remaining dead it goes back-
wards till the pendulum, or balance, has completed its
supplementary vibration, then the hand goes forward
gradually till the tooth escapes, then it jumps, and
then the retrograde motion is repeated.
Reid says of the dead-beat escapement :
"
On an
additional motive force being put to it, we find that the
arc of vibration is considerably increased, and in con-
sequence of this the clock goes very slow. There are
two causes which produce this : the one is, the greater
pressure by the escape-wheel teeth on the circular
part of the pallets during the time of rest ; the other
is, the increase of the arc of vibration. With regard to
the recoil, it was observed that an additional force
would make the clock go fast, and with a dead-beat,
the same cause produces the opposite effect." These
facts were pointed out in the earlier chapters of these
articles. When the same cause produces diametrically
opposite effects on the two forms of escapement, the
means of adjustment are obvious. It is necessary to
modify the two forms, and this is now done successfully.
Pallets should be so formed that they have but very
little recoil, and then a variation in the motive force
or in the arc of vibration of the pendulum will produce
hardly any appreciable variation in the time-keeping.
Reid says that clockmakers in general have an
idea that in an escapement the pallets ought to take in
seven, nine, or eleven teeth, thinking that an even
number could not answer. This is by no means
essential. The distance from the centre of the pallets
to the centre of the escape-wheel also is not determined
by any rule. The nearer the centres less will be the
number of teeth that are required to be taken in by
the pallets. When the arms of the pallets are long,
the influence of the motive power on the pendulum
will be greater than when they are short. The depth
that the pallets engage in the wheel teeth will determine
the angular motion of the pendulum necessary for the
teeth to escape.
The instructions for drawing a dead-beat escape-
ment, I will quote from Mr. Britten's modern Hand-
book.
"
Draw a circle representing the escape-wheel,
assuming it to have thirty teeth, and the pallets to
embrace eight of them, set off on each side of a centre
line the points as described with the recoil escapement.
The position for the centre of the pallets will be the
point where tangents drawn from the points of the
teeth intersect. The width of each pallet is equal to
half the distance between one tooth and the next, less
the amount of the drop, this need be very little. The
escaping arc, is 2, being 1 30' for impulse, and 30' for
repose. The width of the pallets may be got by
diawing radial lines barely
3
on each side of the
points of the teeth, then from the intersection of those
radial lines with the circumference of the wheel, draw
arcs from the centre of the pallets, and these arcs wi.l
be the faces of the pallets. From the centre of the
pallets draw lines through the points where the faces
of the pallets intersect the circumference. (These
lines will be the same as those drawn to find the centre
406
A FEW WORDS ABOUT PIANOS.
of the pallets.) Mark off i3o', above this line on the
right, and the same amount below it on the left, where
those lines intersect the faces of the pallets these
terminate. A line from the intersection of the right to
the outer face of the pallet, where it intersects the
circumference, will give the impulse plane of that
pallet. The other is got by the same method, re-
membering to make the plane I 3o' long. The escape-
wheel should be very light, made of hard brass well
hammered ; it is usually about one inch and a half in
diameter. The pallets are frequently jewelled. . A
heavy pendulum is necessary to unlock the escapement
from the pressure of the wheel teeth on the locking
faces of the pallets. This is more frequently the case
when heavy weights are used, and these are necessary
when the trains are not perfectly accurate."
Detached escapements are seldom used for house-
hold clocks. The gravity escapement, invented by
Mr. Denison, and used for the great clock in the
Houses of Parliament, Westminster, is perhaps the
most useful form of detached escapement. Some
forms of
"
remontoir" as that used in the South Ken-
sington Museum, were formerly used extensively for
turret clocks, and others where the driving power is
subject to considerable variation. The" remontoir"
consists of a contrivance, a spring or a weight, which
acts direct on the escapement, the contrivance being
wound up by means of the ordinary train, at short
intervals. Any irregularities in the wheel work would
thus have no influence on the escapement, and any
power might be added or withdrawn without in the
least affecting the time-keeping; providing always
that there was sufficient power to act on the "remon-
toir." Regulators and expensive clocks, having pen-
dulums beating seconds, are sometimes made with a
double three-legged gravity escapement. The escape-
wheel having but six teeth renders the employment
of very high numbered wheels, or else an extra wheel
and pinion, necessary, in the going train. Considering
the extreme accuracy that can be got from a Graham
dead-beat, the extra cost of a gravity escapement is
hardly ever incurred. With a turret clock of large
dimensions the extra wheel in the train is an advan-
tage, as it assists to equalise the power transmitted to
the escapement.
There are many other forms of escapement, but
most of them are seen but rarely ; it is therefore un-
necessary to allude to them. A form of escapement,
frequently seen in French time-pieces that have the
escape-wheel exposed in front of the dial, is the
"Brocot," named from the inventor. The visible
escapement is generally provided with semi-circular
ruby pallets. Those pallets are fixed into a brass
anchor. The impulse is given by the action of the
teeth of the wheel on the curved face of the pallets.
Great care is necessary in oiling these escapements,
because it generally happens that oil applied to the
pallets runs towards the anchor and there adheres, so
that it is practically useless. With good jewels the
want of oil is not productive of serious inconvenience,
but steel pallets sometimes found in the Brocot
escapement soon suffer.
The pin-wheel escapement, invented by Lepante,
about the middle of the last century, is used for
regulators and some turret clocks. The escape-wheel
is peculiar from having the teeth projecting parallel to
the axis. The pins are made of brass, and in some
clocks they are round, but in that case their diameter
is very small. Semicircular pins acting on their
curved faces are much stronger, and recently an im-
provement has been affected by cutting a piece from
the curved part of the semicircular pins. The pallets
for this escapement are made of steel, and are very
near together, the pins acting successively, so that
the pallets embrace but one tooth. The pin-wheel
escapement has this advantage over the Graham, that
it need not be made so accurately, and that it will act
when the pivot holes of both wheel and pallet axes are
worn, better than Graham's under similar conditions.
{To be continued.)
A FEW WORDS ABOUT PIANOS.
By W. W. C.
OME little time since, a friend of mine
wrote to me, saying that he had pur-
chased a piano which he had seen adver-
tised in the list of those for the disposal
of which the reasons given are usually
more plausible than reliable. He was convinced he
had got a bargain, a trichord cottage of well-known
make, nearly new, for
^25,
from a "lady giving up
her establishment." The only drawback was a buzz,
only audible occasionally, and not heard before pur-
chase. Would I oblige by trying the instrument, and
finding out what was wrong. I tried it one evening
through corrosion
of the connecting
wires, disruption of
the porous cells,
and intrusion of
the copper salt into
the zinc compart-
ment. Some forms
of this battery are
used in such con-
stant work as controlling clocks and working con-
tinuous electric and telegraph signals, but better
batteries have been found to work electric bells. The
nitric acid batteries invented by Professors Grove
and Bunsen, are not available for this work, because
of the noxious fumes given off whilst at work, the
corrosive action of those fumes on all connections,
the consequent trouble to keep them in order, and
the too powerful character of their current. A similar
objection cuts off the single fluid bichromate batteries
in addition to their known inconstancy, whilst this
latter feature condemns the use of the Smee and
Walker cells for this purpose.
We want a cell or battery, then, that will be al-
ways ready to sup-
ply current to our
bells in such a form
as to ring them
effectually, without
burning the contact
points of the ap-
paratus or corrod-
ing the connections.
We want to set up
this battery, and
feel sure that it will
be in order, ready
for use at any time
within the next
three or six months,
without daily or
even weekly atten-
tion. Such a bat-
tery has been found,
and is represented
by the various
forms in which
m
a
g a n e s e sur-
rounds the negative
element, the lead-
ing type being the
Ldclanche' cell,
shown at Fig. 23.
This cell is com-
posed of an outer
containing glass
vessel, two-thirds
filled with a half-
saturated solution
of sal-ammoniac, in
which dips a rod of
zinc to form the
positive element,
and a pot of porous
white earthenware
containing a strip of carbon packed in position with
a mixture of broken carbon and peroxide of manga-
nese. This form is patented, and the manufacture
of the cells is undertaken in England by a telegraph
company at Silvertown in Essex.
The cells may be bought of most dealers in elec-
trical apparatus at the following prices:-
MOULD TIED WITH STRING OR WIRE, READY FOR USE. FIG. 31. PLAN OF
CONNECTING CELLS IN SERIES TO FORM BATTERY.
416
ELECTRIC BELLS.
No. 2, 2 pint cells, 4s. 6d. to 6s. 6d., complete.
No.
3, 3
pint cells, 6s. to 8s. 6d.
-
,
away. It is now ready to be
immersed in the bath (see
page 56). Close the dark
room door, as this and any
subsequent operation must
be conducted in non-actinic
light.
To excite the film, known as
sensitising the plate, remove . 17-preserver for
the bath cover (page
57),
and
raise the dipper from the bath with the right hand.
Place the plate on the ledge or prongs, and gently
lower with one even steady movement
; the least
pause will cause a straight line to appear on the
finished negative. I need hardly say the uncoated
side of the plate rests against the dipper (Fig.
14).
S 2
OF COATING GLASS
COLLODION.
420 PHOTOGRAPHY: ITS PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE.
Now replace the bath cover, and if not done before,
cork the collodion, as this substance, being composed
of ether, alcohol, etc., evaporates if left uncorked.
The time the plate is left in the bath varies. With a
new bath, and at this season of the year, two to
three minutes is sufficient. If the collodion gets thick
do not immerse so quickly as if thin, and in damp or
cold weather the plate takes longer to set ; so it takes
longer to excite the film.
After the plate has been in the bath one minute, it
is gently moved up and down ; do not take it out of
the nitrate of silver solution until the moving has been
continued some few seconds. Now raise the plate up,
still retaining it on the dipper, and just glance at it.
The plate will be sure to look what is known as
"greasy," i.e., the silver solution will be in patches and
drops, return plate and dipper at once to the bath, and
at the end of one or two minutes look again. If now the
film is perfectly smooth and a nice cream colour, it is
ready for use
;
if not smooth, but still oily-looking, let
it remain a little longer, say another thirty seconds.
Then gently raise the plate, letting the surplus bath
solution drain back. Take the plate off the dipper,
and stand it upside down (that is, No.
3 and
4
corners
at the top) on a filter paper against the wall. Take
the dark slide, and at the four angles of which small
pieces of filter or blotting-paper have been placed, to
receive any moisture, gently lay it face downwards
;
cover the back of the glass with blotting-paper
; shut
the door or shutter of the dark slide, and the plate is
ready for the next operation of receiving the image, as
seen on the ground-glass of the camera.
To Expose the Film.The subject or sitter having
been placed in position (see page
31),
previous to
coating the plate, and a final adjustment made whilst
the plate was sensitising, all being now ready, the
cap is placed on the lens
; then the focussing screen,
known as the ground-glass, removed, and the dark
slide inserted in its place. If you have a live sitter,
it is as well to just see all is right before removing the
ground-glass. Previous to drawing up the shutter of
the dark slide, cover it well over with the focussing
cloth (see page
34),
otherwise light will get to the film.
Now uncap the lens, and with a watch take the
seconds. After the exposure is over, re-cap the lens,
and shut down very gently the sliding shutter of the
dark slide, or the drainings of the plate may splash up.
Remove from the camera into dark room, and replace
the focussing screen in its place.
Time
of
Exposure.There is nothing in the whole
range of photographic manipulations more important
nor anything that goes to make or unmake a perfect
picture, than the correct time the plate is exposed to
the light passing through the lens. With a portrait
combination (see page
33), a half-length or bust
picture taken out of doors, would require about three
to five seconds with the second or third sized stop or
diaphragms inserted in the lens, counting from the
largest : but if an animal, say a cat or dog, is to be
the subject, place them in sunlight, and it is probable
the mere taking the cap on and off will be sufficient.
Again, suppose a landscape is attempted and a small
stop used, it will depend then if an open subject, or
not, be chosen ; suppose we suggest a view from one
of the bed-room windows, taking care the window is
open and the sun at our back, or at least at the side,
so as not to shine into the lens, but on to the view,
about twenty to twenty-five seconds ought to suffice,
unless a very open view, then less. By practice, a
sort of instinct grows on the photographer, and so,
according to the light, he gives twenty or thirty
seconds. The brightness or vice versli of the image
on the ground-glass is a very fair guide, supposing
the light is constant. After rain the light is very
actinic. More will be said on this subject later on.
To Develop the Image.A small quantity, say one
ounce, of developing solution (seepage
57)
is poured
into a small glass measure, known as developing cups,
the plate is withdrawn from the dark slide and held
in the left hand by No.
4
corner (see Fig.
13),
over the
sink or basin, carefully pour over the plate some of
the developing solution,* starting at the left hand
bottom edge, and with a rapid motion pass the cup
along that edge, not touching it, however, and at the
same time make the solution flow over the plate in
one even wave, spilling as little as possible of the
solution off the plate. In a few seconds, supposing
the sitter to have been a lady or gentleman, the cuff,
collar, and other white portions will appear. Then the
face, hands, and so on till the whole of the subject is
well out on the plate. It is advisable to gently rock
the liquid on the plate to and fro, as it helps to prevent
stains and increases the density of the deposit. If a
positive is aimed at, use the first developer mentioned
at page
57,
and reduce the exposure at least one-third
to what has been mentioned, and stop the develop-
ment by pouring water upon the plate, before you see
all the details come out, or come up, as the profession
calls it. Should a negative be desired, then use the
second-named developer and take care to develop ivell
out, remembering it is the commixture of the solution
on and in the film with the developer that produces the
picture, and not the developing solution alone. It is
the free silver on and in the plate that builds up the
image. When all the details are developed out, the
*
Methylated spirit is now sufficiently pure for photographic
use. That sold by grocers as "burning spirit"
Ed.
LATHE-MAKING FOR AMATEURS.
By PAUL N. HASLUCK.
IV.The Poppit-head ; How to Bore Headstoeks.
HE last chapter contained a description of
a back-gear headstock, which was illus-
trated by Figs. 7 and 8. The poppit-
head belonging to the headstock before
described, is shown in Fig. 10. It is
4J
inch centre, and drawn to the same scale as Fig.
7
on page 200. It is scarcely necessary to repeat that
these lathe heads are manufactured by The Britannia
Company, Colchester, and that particulars as to prices
may be obtained by direct application, enclosing a
stamp for reply. By the way, this payment for the
postage of a reply is a system that amateurs should
adopt more generally. I say advisedly more generally,
because I believe that when asking for information,
frequently purely for their own benefit, people enclose
a stamp for reply only in exceptional cases. To any
one wanting certain information, a penny is not a
severe tax ; but to be called upon to give information
gratuitously, and in addition to find stationery and
pay postage, is an unwarrantable imposition on any-
one's good nature. With a publication, the answering
of queries forms part of its existence, and no charge is
made for the information afforded, beyond the price
of the issue. With a private individual, the matter is
quite different ; and judging from personal experience,
which is amply confirmed by inquiry of others, I am
induced to bring the subject thus prominently before
my readers, though I do not claim for it a place under
"
Lathe-making for Amateurs." Let this hint suffice
to explain why in some cases queries are unanswered.
Now to return to our subject.
The poppit-head shown at Fig. 10 is a necessary
part of any lathe, on which work is to be turned be-
tween centres. It is also used when drilling, to force
the work against the drill. The barrel, a small piece
of which is shown projecting at the right hand end, is
actuated by the leading screw to which the hand-
wheel is fixed. The projecting end of the barrel is
bored out to hold centres of various forms, adapted
for different purposes. In some poppit barrels the
hole is screwed to take the centres, but the screwing
has no point to recommend it, and is in many ways
less desirable than a coned hole. In times gone by
the lathe-makers probably considered that centres
would be held more firmly by being screwed in, but
now the fallacy of the idea is established. A plain
cone fitting is excellent for many purposes, and I have
seen lathes having only a plain cone for the nose on
which the chucks fitted, and on which they were fixed
by a gentle pressure.
422
LATHE-MAKING FOR AMATEURS.
A few dimensions of the poppit illustrated will be
useful. The extreme length of the base is
5!
inches,
that is the part that rests on the lathe bed
;
the width
is
3j
inches. The cylindrical part, which is bored
out to receive the barrel, measures 6^ inches long and
is 1 1 inches in diameter. The cap on the end is
\
inch long and if inch in diameter ; this cap is held
by four small screws put in radially. The cap is to
confine the lateral motion of the leading screw, of
which more later on. The upright pieces from the
base to support the cylinder are fully half an inch
f
hick, the space between them is 4
inches. The
angles are filled in with corner pieces to strengthen
the casting. The base has two small lugs projecting
in the centre, which are fitted between the ways of the
bed ;
these lugs are half an inch deep, and are planed
or filed to the width of the bed. The small boss in
the centre is to strengthen the part around the hold-
ing down bolt. The hand-wheel on the end of the
screw is \\ inches in diameter, the rim is circular.
Five arms radiate from the central boss. The small
handle shown projecting from the rim is about 2
inches long, and frequently is not used in engineers'
'
lathes.
The hole through the centre of the cylindrical part
is bored out parallel and smooth about 1 inch in
diameter, and it is essential for executing accurate
turning that this hole be bored true with the base.
That is so that when the poppit-head is fixed on the bed,
it shall have the barrel quite parallel, both vertically and
horizontally, with the surface of the bed. In practice
the hole is frequently bored first, so as to get it central
in the cylindrical part of the casting, and the base is
afterwards made true with the boring. This is the
method best suited to amateur lathe-makers. The
poppit is bored first, then the base is filed to fit the
lathe bed, and at the same time adjusted to make the
boring true with the bed. This accomplished, a boring
bar is fitted into the poppit-head and used to bore the
holes in the mandrel headstock, the base of which has
been previously fitted to the bed. For boring the hole
for the front collar, the poppit is placed in its usual
position, that is on the right of the headstock. The
'
positions of the headstocks are reversed for boring the
hole for the back collar. The poppit is fixed on the
left of the headstock, and the boring bar is used from
the front end of the poppit.
This method of boring the mandrel headstock
ensures parallelism in the mandrel bearings, providing
the boring of the poppit-head has first been accurately
adjusted. This adjustment is done by filing the base
of the poppit so as to bring the boring level with the
bed. The lugs fitting between the beds are also filed
so as to bring the boring in a straight line with the
bed. A straight parallel bar, say two or three feet long,
fitted in the boring, will show the adjustment that is
necessary. A very slight error in the length of the
poppit will appear greatly magnified when the bar is
inserted. The eye alone will show any error that is
appreciable in practice. Viewed from above, the bar
should appear in a straight line with the central space
along the bed. Viewed horizontally both ends of the
bar should appear equidistant from the top of the
lathe bed ; this distance may be gauged by measure-
ment, but the practised eye will show any appreciable
error.
Perfect truth in the line of centres, that is absolute
coincidence of the axis of rotation of the work with
the bed along which the headstocks slide, is essential
for good and true work when done with the slide-rest
The subject, therefore, is of great importance. Lathes
that are cheaply or carelessly made, frequently have
the axis of the mandrel and the axis of the poppit
barrels not in a straight line with each other, and,
moreover, sometimes neither axis is parallel with the
bed. These defects seriously interfere with the pro-
duction of good work. If true work is required, time
spent in correcting fundamental errors will be well
employed. Some manufacturers bore the two head-
stocks of a lathe quite independently of each other,
and though each may be correct when considered
alone, yet they do not necessarily correspond. The
method of boring the mandrel head by the aid of the
poppit-head which is previously got true by gauging,
answers very well for the requirements of an amateur.
Manufacturers of quantities of lathes use a more
expeditious and equally good method. Some dummy
headstocks are prepared to serve as bearings for a
boring bar fitted to them, so that it revolves perfectly
true with the lathe bed. The headstocks to be bored,
are first drilled roughly to allow the boring bar to pass
through, they are then bolted to the bed, the bearings
for the bar are also fixed, and the bar is put through
the whole. The bar has various mortised holes in it
into which small cutters, adapted to bore the various
holes required in the castings are fitted The bar is
made to revolve by a crank handle, or more frequently
by steam power, and it is then fed through the castings.
By this plan, the various holes for poppit barrel, front
collar, and back collar, are bored perfectly true to each
other, and to the bed on which they are fixed. It is
only when several lathes of uniform size are to be
made, that the expense of a boring bar, and the
necessary paraphernalia belonging to it can be
judiciously incurred. Consequently, this method of
boring out the headstocks, is not the one to be
practised by amateurs.
With every appliance within reach the fallowing
method would be the one that I shoulc adopt for
boring a single pair of headstocks, working as an
LATHE-MAKING FOR AMATEURS. 42
amateur. I make this distinction because an amateur
has for his chief aim the production of good work, the
time and trouble spent on the production are of
secondary importance. A professional has for his
chief aim getting money, and economy of time means
a larger margin of profit. For this reason principally
things are manufactured in large numbers. Anyone
making, say, a dozen lathes alike, should produce
them much more cheaply, proportionately, than one
making only a single lathe. For boring a pair of
headstocks, as an amateur, I should commence opera-
tions on the poppit-head I should make an ex-
amination of the casting generally with a view to
seeing that it was sound and fairly true. If seriously
defective in either respect, I should consider any
labour spent upon it as waste of time. Having a good
casting, the hole for the barrel has to be bored first.
In some castings the hole is cored out, but in others
the cylindrical part is solid. If the hypothetical
casting that we have in hand is solid, the two ends o
the cylindrical part are carefully
centred and a hole bored completely
through. About
f
or
J
inch dia-
meter will be a suitable size for a
headstock from
4 to 6 inch centre,
but we will now confine ourselves to
4
inch lathe heads. A hole being
bored or cored through the poppit
mount it on a lathe between centres,
chucked by the boring. The poppit
will swing on a
5j
inch lathe. Set
the machine going, and observe if the
cylindrical part of the poppit runs
true, taking a general average of the whole length, it
will be easy to adjust the truth by merely chamfering
the edge of the hole at either end as may be wanted.
When the cylindrical part of the poppit-head runs
true, oil the centres, and with a tool in the slide-
rest turn the two ends true on the circumference and
on the face, rounding off the extreme corner slightly.
This operation must be done carefully so that the
turned parts are really true with the casting regarding
this as a whole. The lathe may then be cleared for
the next operation.
Chuck the poppit-head by the turned part of the
back end either in a self-centring chuck or in a wood
chuck turned out to fit. So long as the chucking is
quite true it need not be particularly firm, as the front
end of the casting will be supported in a collar plate.
Mounted on the lathe in this manner the hole through
the casting may be bored out perfectly true with the
chucking, that is with the outside of the cylindrical
part, by tools in the slide-rest. A deep hole, such as
the one now under treatment, will require special tools,
and the best way to bore it is with a half round or
FIG. 10.THE POPPIT-HEAD.
D bit. If a bit of this form is carefully started in a
truly bored hole it will continue to bore truly, and will
finish the hole fairly smooth and parallel. A hole
f-
inch in diameter having been bored, the poppit
is unchucked and the lathe cleared for the next
operation.
The poppit-head is to be chucked between centres
by the hole just bored. Unless very large cone points
are fitted to the lathe on which the work is done, it
will be necessary to fit centre-pieces into the ends of
the hole. These centre-pieces are merely discs of
metal having a central hole chamfered to fit the cone
point, and turned true on the edge to fit the hole
tightly, a slight fillet being left to prevent the disc
being pressed into the hole by the wedging action of
the back centre. Chucked by these centre-pieces the
poppit will revolve freely and true with the boring.
A tool is fixed in the slide - rest and a cut taken
completely over the surface of the front (left hand)
upright, shown in Fig. 10. Perhaps two or three cuts
will be necessary to reduce the sur-
face of the rough casting to a truly
turned surface which will be exactly
at right angles to the boring, both
vertically and horizontally. The
right hand end of the base may
also be turned true in a similar
manner. There is no necessity for
doing this work except that it im-
proves the appearance of the casting.
Low-priced machinery would be left
in the rough.
The base of the headstock has
now to be made to fit on the bed. It may be
filed, but planing is a better method. I have sup-
posed every appliance to be within reach, so in-
clude a planing-machine. A pair of V blocks are
wanted to chuck the poppit headstock for planing.
It may be well to explain here in passing, that
chucking is the operation of fixing the work to be
operated upon either on the lathe or the planing-
machine. The appliances used to effect the chucking
are called chucks. A straight parallel bar of round
steel, which will pass through the hole in the poppit,
either freely or fitting tightly, is put through the hole,
and its ends are supported in the V blocks. This bar
is fixed on the bed of the planing-machine perfectly
parallel with the travel of the bed. The bar is
clamped down in the V blocks, these being placed
near to the casting, and securely fixed. The casting
is then placed with its base uppermost, and by means
of a couple of clamps it is fixed on to the bar. A stop
is arranged on each side of the base to prevent the
casting turning on the rod, and a stop to resist the cut
of the tool is also provided. In this way it will be
4
2
4
LATHE-MAKING FOR AMATEURS.
noticed the position of the poppit-head on the planing-
machine is regulated entirely by the boring. First, a
cylindrical bar is chucked true on the planer, then the
poppit is chucked true on the bar. The base is then
planed flat, leaving the lugs precisely the right width
to fit in the space between the beds. These lugs
need not be exactly vertical with the hole for the
barrel, because the line of centres are not required to
be precisely in the centre of the bed. By careful
gauging the lugs are made to the correct size, and the
casting is taken off the planer. It should then fit the
bed.
The planing will generally be found to be a trifle
out of true, and the fitting will require adjustment
with a file. The first operation after planing is to
carefully test the truth of the work so far as it has
progressed. The headstock is placed upon the lathe
bed, for which it is intended, and with a carefully fitted
bar projecting from the boring, the height at both
ends is gauged. The parallelism vertically is also
gauged, and if any error can be detected, the base of
the poppit is filed to remedy it.
If the planing is done on a perfectly true machine,
and the work has been chucked properly without
springing it, the casting should not require any ad-
justment with a file, but unfortunately machines are
not always perfect, and chucking is often done care-
lessly, hence subsequent adjustment is generally need-
ful. In days gone by when surfaces were chipped
and filed, the process of getting them level was a
continual succession of testing and improving. The
machinery now in use ought to produce work that
is practically perfect, and it will do so if properly
constructed and properly used. Many people who
make lathes send the beds to be planed, and fondly
imagine that they are true when returned, but
this is seldom the case. Sometimes the fault re-
sults from the inefficiency of the workman, some-
times from that of the machine, and sometimes
because the money paid for the work will not pay for
making it true. Work gets chucked without proper
packing, and is thus warped when fixed. Machines
are used with some of the various slides too loose.
Work that is planed true on one part and which is
subsequently planed on another part will warp, and
the first planing should be done over again. Suppos-
ing an ordinary double flat lathe bed is planed abso-
lutely true on the bottom surface, and then turned
over on the planing-machine, clamped down securely
and planed on the top.
As soon as the skin of the casting is removed, the
tension on the metal is relaxed, and it will probably
warp. The top side may be planed perfectly true, and
if the work is bolted sufficiently firmly to the bed of
the planer, it may correspond with the bottom surface
first planed ; but directly the work is released it
assumes a new form, and neither top nor bottom are
true. When we are dealing with metal that is per-
fectly homogeneous, this warping does not occur. The
skin of cast-iron which is cooled somewhat suddenly,
however, exercises a powerful tension on the inner
part. When planing or turning castings, recollect
this, and rough out the article all over before finishing
any one part. Taking a lathe bed as an example, it
should first be planed roughly on its lower surface,
edges, etc., then turned over and planed on its upper
surface and edges. The ends of the bed should then
be centred, and turned true on a lathe. These pro-
cesses will have removed the skin from all the parts
that are to be planed. The bed is then laid carefully
on its top surface, the end butting against a fixed stop,
and carefully fixed with clamps, every care being
taken to prevent warping it. The bottom is then
planed all over with a finishing tool. The bed is re-
versed, and the top similarly treated. This will pro-
duce a true bed, if the casting has not been sprung by
the chucking.
Returning to the poppit headstock, these extra-
neous observations on planing do not apply to it. The
truth of the boring made through the cylindrical part
will not be influenced to any appreciable extent by
planing the base. The hole will be all the better for
carefully broaching out with a reamer, if the boring
tool has left it rough. A reamer or broach will regu-
late the diameter and remove any asperities. We will
suppose this done, and the poppit-head fitted on the
bed, so that the boring is in every way, vertically and
horizontally, parallel with the lathe bed. The bed
itself must be true, which may be tested by sliding the
poppit-head along it, and observing that it fits equally
well at all parts. The straightness of the bed may be
tested with a good straight-edge, and winding strips
will show whether it is in-winding. A true bed is, of
course, the foundation of a true lathe, and if the bed
is untrue it will not avail much to make the head-
stocks true.
The mandrel headstock should next claim atten-
tion ; it must be fitted on to the bed. The casting
should first be inspected to see that it is sound and
passably shapely. It has then to be lined out for
planing. The positions of the front and back bearings
are carefully gauged and marked with a fine centre
punch. Lines are drawn from these dots vertical to
the base, and the base line is then marked on both
ends precisely equidistant from the centre marks.
This process of lining out offers a good scope for
the exercise of judgment. Castings are all more
or less misshapen, and in lining out the general
average should be considered, so that when finished
the casting may appear fairly true all over. Where
LATHE-MAKING FOR AMATEURS. 425
bosses are cast in which holes are to be drilled, centre
the bosses as nearly as possible. If there is a thin
place in a casting, sacrifice some thick place to bring
the scant part up, and so on. Do not start with an
idea that some part of a casting is intended for a base,
and that the other parts must be squared up to it. If
such a course is pursued, the result will be most inele-
gant. Bearing in mind these hints, line out the man-
drel headstock to the best advantage, so that the
centre points indicating the positions of the mandrel
bearings are in the best position that the particular
casting allows.
Chuck the headstock on the planing machine so as
to plane the base to the lines that have been marked.
The method of chucking will depend entirely on the
form of the casting, and it is therefore not possible
to indicate any special precautions. Suffice it to say,
that the base is to be planed true and fitted on to the
lathe bed ; the execution of the work must be left to
whoever has it in hand. A headstock having a fiat
front head is frequently conveniently chucked on a
right angle chuck, that is a bracket-shaped chuck used
on the planing machine. The headstock is bolted
against the chuck, and the overhanging end is
supported by packing, and an additional clamp may
be used to it if the shape offers a place for a clip to
hold. When the base has been planed so that it fits
the bed, the front of the casting may be planed flat,
and at right angles to the base, if a first-rate job
is intended. The headstock being finally bolted on to
the bed.
Boring the holes for the bearings is the next
operation. The positions of the centre punch dots
may be verified by placing the poppit against the
headstock, and if found to be correct, holes are bored
with drills nearly to the diameter required. When the
boring is to be finally finished, a bar is fitted into the
poppit barrel to turn freely. This bar may be about
2 feet long, and must be provided with a winch handle
at one end. The other end of the bar has a mortise
hole through it to take the cutters required for boring
.
the holes in the headstock. The diameter of the bar
must be reduced at this end sufficiently to pass through
the holes that have been drilled. The size of these
holes will depend on the style of mandrel to be used;
if one having double bearings, as illustrated by Figs.
7
and
9,
the holes will be about \\ to i inch in
diameter. If a mandrel with a front collar bearing,
and a tail-pin at the back is used, the back hole will
be only
% inch. The diameter of the bar fitting the
hole will be
inch, consequently in the case last
instanced, it must be reduced, but not if the holes are
over 1 inch in diameter. It would be unwise to reduce
the diameter of the bar any more than absolutely
necessary, because by so doing, the mortise hole
which holds the cutter would be made shorter, and
the cutter would have a greater length projecting un-
supported, and more likely to bend under a heavy cut.
The cutter itself is merely a plain piece of steel, fitted
into the mortise hole, and secured by a wedge ; the
cutting end is ground to a sharp edge, and the amount
that it projects regulates the diameter of the hole
bored. If the holes to be bored vary much in size, one
cutter will perhaps not do for both. In that case two
cutters, each specially adapted to the hole it is to bore,
should be made. The boring bar and cutter being
ready, I will proceed to describe the use of it.
Fix the poppit-head on the lathe bed near to the
right hand end, also fix the mandrel head close to the
poppit, say within a quarter of an inch. Pass the
boring bar through the hole in the poppit, till the end
projects through the front upright of the mandrel
headstock. Now place the cutter in the mortise hole,
and wedge it tight, projecting sufficient to cut the
correct diameter of the hole for the front collar. With
the winch handle on the other end of the bar proceed
to turn it round, and observe the progress of the cutter.
Of course the interior of the boring in the poppit must
be well lubricated before commencing. The work will
not proceed satisfactorily till some contrivance is
arranged to feed the cutter into its work. Rather
powerful pressure will be necessary. A good plan is
to use a bolt with a nut on it, the nut to press against
the other side of the mandrel headstock, and the point
of the bolt against the end of the boring bar, by
screwing the bolt it will be made to press on the end
of the bar. This direct pressure will have the desired
effect, and the boring may be proceeded with rapidly.
Almost any makeshift contrivance will do for feeding
the cutter into its work, and the one that is most
easily adopted will depend on the appliances which are
most easily got at. A smooth hole of the diameter
required having been bored completely through, that
end of the headstock is finished.
To bore the tail or back end of the headstock,
remove the poppit to the extreme left hand end of the
bed, and fix it there in the position usually occupied
by the fast headstock. Then slide the mandrel head
along the bed till it nearly touches the poppit, and fix
it. The boring bar which must be removed before the
poppit is shifted, is placed in the barrel hole from the
front end, and left projecting over the left hand end of
the bed. A cutter is fixed in the mortise hole as
before, the contrivance for feeding into cut is rigged
up ; the bar is revolved by means of the winch handle,
and thus the back hole is bored. It is obvious that
both the holes bored in this manner must be exactly
true with the hole bored in the poppit ; if this has to
be got perfectly true with the bed, then the line of
centres of the complete lathe will be true.
4*6 LATHE-MAKING FOR AMATEURS.
When making a lathe, bear in mind that the truth
of the whole machine depends on the truth of every
component part. Unless the bed is true, it is useless
to trouble about extreme accuracy in the headstocks.
It is of course quite easy to improve a defective lathe
by correcting the headstocks, but unless the bed on
which they slide is absolutely true, it is impossible to
get absolute truth in the entire machine. There are
many ways of testing a lathe, and I think many people
would be astonished at the result of carefully testing
the lathes at which they work. One of the few makers
of first-rate lathes, machines which cost hundreds of
pounds, considers the especial care that I have taken
to instruct amateurs how to test the accuracy of their
lathes, superfluous matter in
"
Lathe Work." It is no
doubt wasteful and ridiculous excess, akin to gilding
refined gold, painting the lily, smoothing ice, etc., of
which Shakespeare speaks, to attempt to apply tests to
such high-class work; but low-priced machines are
generally more or less defective, and I deem a know-
ledge of the defects of a machine at which I work most
valuable knowledge. Those who are at times puzzled
to understand the cause of some peculiarities in the
work produced by their lathes, should test the machine
itself, by some of the methods that are described in
"Lathe Work," and no doubt the result would explain
many peculiarities that had been incomprehensible.
The barrel and leading screw of the poppit-head
illustrated in this article, require some description.
The barrel itself is made from a piece of plain bar
steel sufficiently large in diameter after being turned
true to fit the hole ; the length should be the same as
the cylindrical part of the poppit casting. This bar of
steel is carefully centred and bored completely through
with a hole about
Ts
inch in diameter. The exact size
for this hole is the tapping size of the thread to be
used for the leading screw, this should be a
J
inch
square thread. The hole must be bored out the whole
distance to within about
f
inch of one end, large
enough to clear the thread of the screw,
T
% inch will
suit. The boring must be straight, and this is easily
ensured by first boring from both ends, and then
mounting the work in the cone plate, and boring with a
D bit,
ys
> ncn diameter, to within
f
inch of the inner
end. The ends of the hole are chamfered for 'turning
between centres, and the diameter of the bar is reduced
to fit the hole in the poppit. It must be turned
smooth, and when very nearly to size, a smooth file
will finally finish the surface. I am fully aware that
the use of a file on turned work should be dis-
couraged as much as possible, and that a slide-rest
tool properly applied would cut clean, and leave a
smooth surface. Despite all this, I know a smooth file
is generally used to finally finish such apiece of work,
and that it answers very well the purpose intended.
When the barrel has been made to fit, a groove
has to be cut along it to take the head of a pin, which
prevents it turning round under the influence of the
leading screw. This groove is best milled out with a
circular cutter, or slotted with a flat pointed drill, or
planed out with a parting tool. Either method is
equally good in effect, and the one adopted will be
governed by the appliance which is most easily used.
An amateur who has none of the machines required
for the methods mentioned above must adopt another.
He may file out the grooves or chisel it out, according
to the bent of his abilities, or he may combine the
two methods advantageously. The groove should be
about one-eighth of an inch broad, and nearly as deep,
and should extend from the back end to within an
inch of the front.
The front end of the barrel has to be mouthed out
conically, so that the various centre points may fit it.
The barrel is mounted in the cone plate for boring,
and the slide-rest set over about one degree. The
hole is carefully turned true and smooth, the exact
angular adjustment of the slide-rest being noted, so
that when centres are wanted they may be fitted to
the same angle without trouble. The back end of the
barrel requires tapping, to fit the thread of the leading
screw. The tap must be put in quite straight, and if
sufficiently long, the tap is best put in from the front
end ; the boring then keeps the tap perfectly straight.
In order to correct any little irregularity that there
might be in the thread, the tap should be screwed
through in the way that the screw is to go, and the
barrel will be finished.
The leading screw is made from a solid rod of
5-inch steel; or a piece fully
J
inch in diameter, with
a collar welded on it, may be used. The total length
of the screw is 7 inches, the collar being placed to
leave
5
inches of screwed part. The collar may be
about 5- inch thick. The screw is turned true and
parallel, and the thread, preferably a square one,
J
inch in diameter, is cut. A left-handed thread is
generally preferred, but the use of left or right-handed
threads is purely a matter of habit. The top screw in
a slide-rest and the screw in the poppit-head should
always be alike, and beyond that it matters little
whether they be left or right. The tail end of the
screw is turned true, and has about i inch of thread
on the end. This takes a hexagon nut, which secures
the hand-wheel.
The cap on the right-hand end of the poppit,
which confines the lateral motion of the screw, is
made of cast iron or gun-metal, which looks rather
better. It is bored to fit the tail end of the screw, and
fits on the end of the poppit casting, to which it is
secured by three or four screws put in radially. The
leading screw is put in the hole in the casting, the
WA YS AND MEANS.
427
cap put over the tail end, leaving the collar inside,
and secured by the screws. The hand-wheel is put
on the projecting tail, and the hexagon nut screwed
on till the boss of the hand-wheel is brought against
the cap, and thus the lateral motion is confined.
For clamping the poppit barrel when in use, a
plain set screw from the top is as effective as anything.
A wedge bolt, which is tightened by a lever on the
off side, is adapted by the Britannia Company, and is
preferable for many reasons. It does not damage the
barrel itself, and the handle is out of the way ; these
two points suffice to commend the wedge bolt. The
pin which projects inside the boring, and which, by
fitting the groove in the poppit barrel, prevents this
turning round, is dropped into a hole generally bored
through the lower part of the cylindrical part of the
casting. The pin should be made like the letter T in
shape. It should first be turned like a cheese-headed
bolt, the shank
i
inch diameter, and the head
5
inch.
The head is then filed off on two opposite sides, to
leave a strip s inch wide ; the strip fits the groove in
the barrel.
The poppit headstock and the method of boring
the collar holes have been fully dealt with in this
chapter. I have only to recommend intending pur-
chasers to the firm I have named for any of the
articles described. The next chapter will treat of the
framework and its construction.
(To be continued?)
WAYS AND MEANS.
[The Receipts brought together under this title are gathered
from various sources. They are given here because they are each
and all apparently possessed of value, and likely to be useful to the
Amateur. It is manifestly impossible for the Editor to test them,
or to have them tested, and he therefore disclaims all responsibility
for their accuracy or otherwise. Amateurs who may try them are
requested to communicate the results arrived at.]
To Stain Wood Black.The receipt given in
Part I. of Amateur Work, Illustrated, for a
black fluid for ebonizing, is no doubt a good one ; but
one in common use among joiners is made more
easily. Here it is
:
Put iron filings, or the scales
from a smith's forge, in a bottle, so as to fill it, say a
quarter full. Fill up with strong vinegar. Shake this
up a couple of times a day for three or four days.
Now boil some ground logwood in water so as to
make a strong decoction. Put this while hot on the
wood ; and before it is quite dry put on the vinegar
and iron. When the wood is allowed to dry quite
before the iron is put on, the inner grain of the wood
remains red in places. Oil to get a good black.A. B.
Wash for Outbuildings.Professor Kedzie,
of the Agricultural College of Michigan, an expert
chemist, recently said that a paint or wash made of
skim-milk, thoroughly skimmed, and water brine, will
render wood uninflammable, and he proved it by
experiment. He said this paint, or whitewash, is
durable, very cheap, impervious to water, of agreeable
colour, and, as it will prevent wood from taking fire,
he urges its use, particularly on roofs, outbuildings,
barns, etc.
Distempering Ceilings.Give the ceilings a
coat composed of soft soap, lime, putty, and size.
The quantities to be used of each ingredient entirely
depend on the finish of the ceiling ; some are much
more absorbent than others. The soft soap prevents
the dry plaster absorbing the colour too quickly, so
that a clean, even surface may be obtained with the
finishing coat. If the workman is not a practised
hand, he may be successful in laying an even coat of
distemper; and even if he should succeed, if his
ceiling is grey-finished, the sand will probably spoil
the distemper. A remedy for this would be to cover
the ceiling with lining paper and distemper on the
paper, but experience is here also required in hang-
ing the paper. Very little size is required for dis-
temper
4 inches thick, 6o
inches long, and i6f inches wide. To this portion all
the surrounding parts are added bit by bit. In the first
place, it is lengthened by two pieces ^lamped on, one
at each'end, A and B, as may be seen in the illustra-
tion. These pieces are also 4 inches thick, and
3f
inches wide, thus bringing up the length of the bench
to 68 inches. The three parts are securely bolted
together by an iron bar, at the left end of which there
is a nut by which they are screwed up as closely as
possible. The piece on the'right is i8f inches long,
and that on the left
33
inches long. They project
beyond the central piece at the back to the distance of
7g
inches, and by inserting a board between the ends
A and B i inches in thickness, and another at the
bottom, a trough 6 inches wide and extending the
whole length of the bench is formed, which makes a
useful receptacle for all kinds of tools when not in
actual use. One end, namely that at B, is fitted with
a slanting board, so that small tools may be easily
drawn up the incline, and dust and shavings cleared
out without the chance of any portion remaining
behind. The shoulder to the left is then added to the
bench ; this is formed of a solid piece, also 4 inches
thick, and 8 inches wide at its widest part, and
2J
inches wide at the narrowest part in which the bench-
screw works, leaving an opening of
55
inches between
the edge of the front of the bench and the inner sur-
face of the narrow part of the shoulder. When it is
desired to plane the edge of any board, the screw is
turned out to a sufficient depth to admit of its inser-
tion and that of a cheek piece supplied with the bench,
and which is intended to receive the pressure of the
end of the screw, and so prevent it from doing any
injury to the piece of wood to be planed. The
advantage of this arrangement is manifest, for the
pressure of the screw acts directly on the wood to be
planed through the cheek that intervenes, bringing it
directly against the edge of the bench, and holding it
there immovably. The pressure, the reader will notice,
is thus applied equally, because directly, on every part
of the wood that is touched by the intervening cheek,
which is not the case with the ordinary bench-screw
with a loose cheek, which is drawn against the wood
placed between it and the bench by the screw which
43 NOTES ONNOVELTIES.
works in a block fitted to the front of the bench,
with a great deal of creaking and groaning, which
tells tales of an undesirable amount of friction and
inequality of pressure. To the bottom of the bench is
appended a drawer 18 inches square, which works
by means of cleats in grooved timbers of the shape
of the letter L screwed to the under surface of the
bench. When this drawer is pulled out a little way
it acts as a support for the timber whose edge is being
planed, thus doing away with the necessity of a front
board pierced with holes at various intervals to receive
pegs on which the lower edge of the board under treat-
ment may rest.
firmly by turning the screw in order to bring the bench-
stop in the movable bench-vice up to the end of the
board to the left. The bench-stops can be adjusted
to any height required, or rather likely to be required.
The movable bench-vice has a projecting fillet on its
inner face, which works in a groove of corresponding
size cut in the central part of the bench. As will be
seen from the illustration, this vice, which is 22 inches
long in its longest part and 6f inches wide in its
narrowest part, is so contrived as to present intervals
of different width between the ends of its two parts
and the end of the bench at D and E. These openings
afford the means of gripping pieces of wood in the most
FIG. 21.GERMAN CARPENTER S BENCH IN ISOMETRICAL PERSPECTIVE.
Along the front of the central portion of the bench,
and about \\ inches from its edge, runs a row of ten
holes, rectangular in shape, and \\ inches long by
i
inch in width. These holes serve as receptacles for
bench-stops, rectangular pieces of iron that fit closely
into these sockets, and are further held in place by a
slightly curved steel spring, indicated in the illustration
by the roundness on the right side of each stop. Nowi
the utility of these holes lies in this. An eleventh
hole is made in the movable piece to the right of the
illustration, and when it is desired to plane the surface
of a piece of board, all that is necessary to be done in
order to fix it is to insert the bench-stop to the left, at
a suitable distance, according to the length of the
board from the bench-stop in the movable piece, lay
the board between the two stops, and then grip it
convenient manner for cutting tenons and dovetails,
and for performing other operations in carpentry in
which it is desirable that the wood should be tightly
held.
In conclusion, it may be said that these benches
are cheap, and put the buyer in possession of good
value for his money. They are likely, I think, to be
in great demand in this country. I can recommend
them with the utmost confidence to all amateurs who
may want a bench that will do them good service.
The most suitable for general purposes after the
"
Carpenter's," which is by a long way the best, is the
"Trade" bench, which although it is of the same
height and length as the
"
Amateur's
"
bench, has the
advantage over it by being 8 inches longer, at an
additional cost of only 3s.
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL,
431
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
[The Editor reserves to himself the right or re-
fosreg a rep'y to any question that may be frivolous
or inappropriate, or devoid of general interest.
Correspondents are requested to bear in mind that
their queries will be answered only in the pages of
the Magazine, the information sought being sup-
plied for the benefit of its readers generally as well
as for those who have a special interestin obtaining
it. In no case can any reply be sent by post.]
Organ Building.
S. X.Apply to any of the makers of
whom mention has been made in the
papers on building a small organ and a
harmonium. Articles on the method of
making keys for organs, etc, and for
making magic-lanterns, will appearshortly.
ORGAN Pi?e. The second series o^
papers on " Organ Building" will be
commenced in Part XII. The cheap
pipes to be described will supersede metal
pipes, and the organ described will be on
a far larger scale. Your requests with
regard to a wardrobe and Fitzroy baro-
meter shall not be forgotten.
T. H. (Bilston). Your queries on this
subject and on
"
Bookbinding
"
have been
already answered in replies to other
correspondents.
C.
J.
C. (Haverstock Hill) inquires
how such full tones are produced by the
small pipes of a street organ. The pipes
are not so small as he thinks, as the
larger ones are mitred so as to run round
the bottom of the organ, and they are
voiced very loud. But surely C.
J.
C. is
not satisfied with the musical (?) tones
produced? The pallets for a iostop
sound board should not be less than 10
inches long ; and they are all one length.
The channels should be
3^
inches deep,
and as wide as you have room to make
them. The space behind the pallets is
generally covered with stout cartridge
paper, but thin wood filled in between
the channels is stronger, and not so liable
to be damaged.
MUSICUS (Northampton). The best
way for you to make the C C C pipe
would be to double it, as shown in page
287. This would be much more satis-
factory than the way you suggest, and
less room would be required. Mitreing
the pipes does not injure the tone, indeed,
some people think it improves it.
G. P. (Northampton). The sizes of the
holes through the feet of the pipes are
given in answer to S. S., in page 191.
The stopt pipes should have the mouths
cut up a fourth of the diameter, and the
open pipes a fifth. This allows for cut-
ting a little higher when tuning them.
The windway of the cap should be made
at the top with a flat file, not a chisel.
It is about A
inch for a C C stopt pipe,
and slightly smaller for each successive
one. The only way to know when it is
right, is by trying the pipe. Just bind the
cap on with a piece of tape, and blow
through the pipe. If it is all right, the
cap may be fastened on with screws or
French nails. If it does not answer, file
the windway a trifle larger, but be careful
not to overdo it, or you will have to take
a shaving off the inside face with a fine-
set plane. The lips should be thin, but
not cut to a sharp edge. Stopt pipes
should have thicker lips than open ones.
Pulsator Organorum.The flute
pipes described are intended to be open
pipes, with a tin or zinc lid on the top for
tuning. The stop action is as follows
inner 030 =
lower 031
:
Neck, from chin of scroll to 1
13q
.
base of button $
Length of finger-board 260 =
:14
ift
ii'i
ij
K S
101
Leslie Thair. The "maps" of
fiddles which have already appeared, are
merely outlines drawn for the purposes of
the letterpress, and are not any particular
maker's form. A full-size working out-
line, including thicknesses, elevations,
and other particulars, will appear as a
supplement to Am\teur Work, Illus-
trated, with the first chapter on the
Practical Manual Operations of Fiddle-
making, which will be in about four parts
from the present one.
T. H. F. (Old Whittington).FuK-
sized working drawings for making a
violin are in preparation and will be given
in an early Part in Vol. II.
J.
G. (Lammas) will find that his ques-
tions have been fully answered in the
chapters on "Varnish" which appeared
in Parts VII. and VIII. of this magazine.
L. T. (Abergavenny). The wood and
tools which you require you will get to
perfection from Mr. W. E. Hill,
72,
Wardour Street, London, W.
Henry Dryerre,The gums, oils,
etc., required for varnishing violins, are
usually found in commerce, not adulte-
rated, but unpicked, i.e., to obtain an
ounce of pure gum, resin, etc., you
might want a pound of the raw drossy
material. I have, however, made arrange-
ments with Mr. G. Pestell, of 41, Great
Queen Street, Long Acre, London, that
any readers of Amateur Work, Illus-
trated, writing to him expressing their
wants, and mentioning these articles, will
receive at reasonable prices the purest
specimens of the materials they require.
E.
J.
V. (Guildford).If your instru-
ment is a valuable one I should recom-
mend you to send it to a good maker as
the adjusting of the head requires certain
special considerations and processes. If
not, minute directions on the point will be
given in a future number of Amateur
Work, Illustrated.
* Measurements taken from
"
The
Vuillaume," or
"
La Meseie," Stradi-
uarius
2.VIOLA.f
Milli-
metres, in.
410 = 10&
.. 185 =
7ft
240=
9H
.. 130=
5&
. 095 =
3J
.. 220 =
8JJ
.. 038=
m
.. 038 =
m
. 039= 1,-3
t
Measurements taken
from Stradiuarius Viola,
date 1723, in the pos-
session of M. le Vi-
comte de Janze\
3VIOLONCELLO,
t
Milli-
metres, ft. in.
750 = 2
Sii
340= 1
440 = 1
240= ...
170 = ...
400 = 1
118= ...
118 = ...
119= ...
1ft
Hi
m
nl
X
Measurements taken
from Stradiuarius
'Cello, belonging to M
Franchomme, the cele-
brated violoncellist.
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
433
'
Bootmaking.
Dr. G. would have no difficulty ill find-
ing a person qualified to teach bootmaking
to amateurs provided a sufficient remune-
ration were offered. The writer of the
articles on "Boots and Shoes, How to
Make Them and Mend Them," will be
pleased to put him in communication
with such a person if Dr. G. will address
through the Editor.
J. J.
Kilroy
(
IVutport, Mayo) wishes
for further instructions on fitting-up lasts
for bootmaking. As a general rule the lasts
used by either bootmaker or amateur
workman should correspond with the foot
and require no fitting-up. This is not
however, always possible, and conse-
quently the last, which we will presume
to be smaller than the foot either across
the toes, at the joints, oron the instep, has
to be made up with pieces of leather bent
to its shape, and if the last be a wooden
one, pegged onif an iron last, caused
to adhere by a solution or left loose to be
placed in position previous to lasting.
For stout boots the width measurements
of the last should be the same as those of
the foot, for light boots \ inch under the
measure will produce a fit. Bunions or
corns may be relieved from pressure by
placing on the last, at its corresponding
points, pieces of leather of similar shape.
On the wooden lasts it is best to peg on
as many thicknesses of leather as will be
necessary to represent the bunion or
callosity, afterwards paring them to the
required shape. The upper being lasted
over this, is to an extent blocked to fit the
bunion, consequently pressure is after-
wards avoided. It seems somewhat
invidious to select one last-nnker from
the number of excellent ones there are in
business
;
probably our correspondent
would do as well as anywhere else by
applying to Mr. Henry Davey, of the
Steam Last Works, Cumberland Street,
Leicester, or to Mr. Alden, Ber Street,
Norwich, both of whom are clever last-
makers.
Storm Glass.
P. D. wishes to know how to m ake a
good storm glass. Can any of our
readers supply a paper on this subject ?
Our Supplements.
J.
\V. B. (Bradford).Your suggestion
with reference to the supplements shall be
carefully considered, but they involve
considerable cost in their production, and
the cost of Part and Supplement together
is only 5d. Your inquiries as to printing
and india-rubber stamp making have been
already answered in replies to other cor-
respondents.
Small Gymnasium.
B. M.
J.
(Enfield). See articles now
appearing on
"
Gymnastic Apparatus, and
How to Make It."
Boat-Building'.
J.J.
R. (Dundee). Very possible Mr.
Kennedy will give instructions on build-
ing a yawl 20 feet in length. If any
improved method of constructing rabbit
hutches is produced or suggested by any
correspondent or contributor it shall be
given. Re Exchange Column, see reply
to
J.
R. (Nottingham).
S. V. P. The length ofkeelof ai3-foot
canoe, viz., 10 feet ; and the length of stem
and stern-posts round the curve, viz. , 1 foot
10 inches to 2 feet, are given in answer to
"
Would-be-Canoeist,"
p. 336. The
two pieces of a side-board are bevelled
off so as to overlap like a splice, and
fastened with copper nails. Of course,
they need not be bevelled off, but it is
much neater. As to the pressing of the
side-boards? Suppose you take two
pieces of paste-board, each 6 inches by
1 inch, lay one flat on the table and the
other exacdy on top of it ; sew them to-
gether at one end ; then put them on their
edge, and lay a book across the unsewn
ends, so as to press the boards flat on
the table (while the sewn ends stand up
on it) the lower edges together in the
inside, the upper edges apart outside. Is
this clear?
Soap-Making.
J.
C. (Halifax). The articles on this
subject were resumed in Part VIII. Every
endeavour shall be made to comply with
your request, and the desired information
given as soon as it is obtained.
W. C. (Alfrelon) writes : The makers
of the
"
Barilla Ash Soap
"
referred to in
my former communication, are Messrs.
McLinton and Thomson,
53,
Academy
Street, Belfast. "Barilla is a plant
growing abundantly in Sicily, Teneriffe,
and also in some parts of Spain. It is
burned over large holes in the earth, and
is then secured and purified afterwards.
There is something in the composition of
this Barilla Ash, which makes it astonish-
ingly curative, and most agreeable on the
skin. Lather made from it, instead of
drying, and so far burning the hands
and arms of those using it in clothes
washing, has the most soothing and
delightful effect." The above is a quo-
tation from a work entitled
"
Papers on
Health," by Professor Kirk, Edinburgh,
and from personal experience, both for
curative and general purposes, we can
endorse the statement. My wife would
use nothing else if she could obtain this
soap, made by the Belfast firm. Other
firms advertise as makers of Barilla Soap,
but it is not anything like the article
made by McLinton and Thomson.
Model Locomotives.
J.
M. (Sligo).The wish you express
for papers on this subject shall be satisfied
in due course.
Amateur Bookbinding.
W. C. (Alfreton) writes:
"I have a
large number of periodicals and other
books waiting to be bound, and have
been anticipating your papers on this
subject with much interest. But I am
afraid if the necessary tools cost
3
15s.
before an amateur can commence work,
there will be a good many like myself that
will have to put his ideas of bookbinding
on one side. Is it not possible for some
modification of the laying press, and its
accompaniments to be made, or to be
obtained at much less money than the
above? It would also be an advantage
to know where to obtain the materials
used in binding, at a reasonable price."
A correspondent has promised an ac-
count of a cheap apparatus for book-
binding that he has contrived for his
own use. This will appear shortly. The
writer of the articles on "Amateur Book-
binding" will supply the information
you require respecting materials, in due
course.
]. N. (Hammersmith Road). Full in-
structions on repairing, as well as binding
books, will be given in Amateur Work,
Illustrated, which is a magazine, and
not a serial work to be completed in a
given number of parts.
T. L. (Newcastle-on-Ty?ie). Thename
and address of a firm supplying book-
binders' tools has been given in "Amateur
Bookbinding."
Giant Stride.
J.
B. (Tetsworth) writes:Some time
since I had occasion to inspect a
"
Giant
Stride," in the course of erection, and it
resembled in most particulars the descrip-
tion in Amateur Work, Illustrated,
but in place of the washers placed over
the spindle, we had two castings made
of the same shape as the washers, but with
grooves in their faces, in the bottom one
of which were placed four brass balls,
and then the other fitted on the top so as
to make a smooth and even action, with
no tendency to set, which I think rather
an improvement on the description given.
Filtration of Water.
W. C. (Alfre'on) is thanked for the
prospectus of Maignen's Patent
"
Filtre
Rapide
*'
that he has sent. The method
adopted appears to be an excellent one.
Amateurs wishing for information respect-
ing Maignen's Filter and Filtering
Medium, should write to Mr. John Bell,
Asbestos Works, 118, Southwark Street,
London, S.E.
Waterproofing Cloth.
R. W. G. (Rathkeale) wishes to know
how to make the solution that must be
put on clothes to give them the appearance
of the black waterproof sold in the gutta-
percha and india-rubber houses. Can any
reader supply the required information ?
434
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
Comparative Value of Batteries.
G. L. Gibson (Southall) wishes to be
informed respecting the comparative value
of the Daniell and the Walker batteries,
as follows : (i) Which is the stronger, a
Daniell or Walker battery ? The strength
of the Daniell may be represented by 108,
the strength of the Walker by 50. But,
owing to the high internal resistance of
the Daniell and the low internal resistance
of the Walker, we get more work out of
the Walker than from the Daniell for the
first half hour from the time of charging
them. After the first hour the Daniell
shows itself superior in every way.
(2)
Which is the most adapted for an induction
coil ? Neither are suitable for the purpose,
but if a sudden and sharp rush of current
is alone required for a few minutes the
Walker should be preferred. The plates
of this battery may be used in a saturated
solution of bichromate of potash acidu-
lated with one-fifth part sulphuric acid,
and should be thus used for an induction
coil.
(3)
Can a Daniell be coupled for
intensity with a Walker? A Daniell
should not be thus coupled. Nothing is
gained by mixing the cells of various
systems of batteries. The effectiveness
of a battery is governed by its weakest
cell, and the conductivity of an electric
circuit by that part which offers most
resistance.
Cabinet Hardware.
W. M. (Lynn).For brass fittings for
your coal vases write to Messrs. R. Mel-
huish and Sons, 85 and 87, Fetter Lane,
London, E.C. , describing what you want.
If they cannot send you what you require
at once, they will doubtless procure it for
you.
Painting In Oils.
Artist.We have no intention of
giving detailed instructions on this sub-
ject at present; but if any new process is
introduced it will be described.
Commendatory.
T. G. L. M. (Peckham) writes
:
" I
take this opportunity to express my best
thanks for the effort you have made in
producing a really useful work for
'
we
amateurs.' I devoured
'
Every Man his
Own Mechanic
'
with more than common
interest, but Amateur W
t
ork, Illus-
trated is to me as a bun is to Jumbo,
simply delicious. I hold my trunk further
extended every issue."
Rubber-Stamp Making.
]. H. (Middle Alion),An article on
this subject will be given shortly.
Cabinet Making.
T. W. H. (Lower Sydenham).1 am
sorry that a mistake was made in your
first initial. Some easy pieces of cabinet
work for less experienced amateurs shall
be given. Articles from your pen are
always welcome.
Iron Rust.
H. N. (Somerset House).To make this
put as many old nails or small pieces of
iron as the hand can conveniently hold in
half-a-pint of vinegar.
Boiler for Model Steamer.
H. W. (Cupar).Your engines appear
to be just the size for the boat. Complete
instructions for building a model steam-
boat will be given as soon as possible.
For bronzing try the "American Magic
Bronze," sold by Messrs. B. F. Brown &
Co., 18 and 19, Norman's Buildings, St.
Luke's, London.
Taxidermy.
R. H. M. (Nenagh). Anything new
on this subject will find a place in our
pages, and if it be practicable and gene-
rally desired, detailed instructions will be
given for the benefit of those who wish to
practise the art.
Fan for Fire-Grate.
T. B. (Carrick-on-Suir). To thread
the fan screen, take a narrow tape or
ribbon, pass it through the three slits
shown in design in regular order, fixing
METHOD OF THREADING LEAVES OF
FAN SCREEN FOR FIRE-GRATE.
either of the two portions between the
slits with a touch of glue. The order
should be, lay the fan open with the top-
most spoke on the left, pass the tape from
above, down through the left slit, up
through the middle, and down again
through the right, turn over ends as first
and last leaf, and secure with gum.
Reeds in Wood-work.
C. E. L. (Taunton) andW. M. (Lynn).
The reeds on beading on the edges of
the shelves of the Skeleton Hanging Wall
Cabinets and pieces of furniture similarly
adorned, are made by an instrument
called a
"
reed plane." These planes are
constructed to cut from one to five reeds,
and are sold at from 3s. ^d. to 6s. 6d.,
according to the number of reeds. Dove-
tailed boxed planes of this description are
made, but is. extra is charged on the
plane for each dovetail.
Couch with Spring Seat, etc.
R. B. (Bo/ton).Kindly explain what
you mean by a ''stalked tea-table?"
Working drawings of an admirable chair,
that any amateur may make, will be given
in an early part.
Walking Sticks.
K. R. (Ipswich) wishes for information
on the best methods of straightening,
varnishing, andotherwise preparing sticks,
with or without bark, to serve as walking
sticks. Will any of our readers send
short article on this subject?
Mounts for Pictures.
Amateur Picture-Framer.Articles
on cutting mounts and on picture-framing
generally, are in preparation.
Soldering and Brazing.
R. W. G. (Rathkeale).Articles on
these subjects will be commenced shortly.
Artificial Limbs.
W. R. (Kendal).It would be useless
to treat on the manufacture of artificial
limbs, because there is not one amateur
in ten thousand who would take up the
work in the first place, or could carry it
out successfully in the second. For any
information you may require, apply to Mr.
J.
Gillingham, Surgeon Mechanist, Pros-
pect House, Chard, a man of the highest
ability who has wrought wonders in this
way, and who commenced work as an
amateur in the field in which he has
attained such eminent success. He is aj
thoroughly practical man, who follows
the teachings and suggestions of nature,
and is literally one in a million.
Second Hand Tools, etc.
W. Beauchamp wishes (i.) for facili-
ties to be given for the advertisement of
second-hand tools, etc., in this magazine.
It shall be considered, as it might usefully
take the place of the contemplated Ex-
change and Sale Column, (ii.) Designs
for chairs and furniture to be made in the
lathe will be given as opportunity offers,
(iii.) A lathe with a bed about 4 feet in
length would be required, (iv.) Articles
on painting and glazing pottery will b^ .
commenced in Part XII.
Exchange and Sale Column.
J.
R. (Nottingham).You are too late
in the field with regard to the article men-
tioned in your letter. Owing to the ex-*
treme fewness of the articles that have been
proposed for sale or exchange, it has been
thought better to defer the appearance of
an
'
' Exchange and Sale Column
"
till Part
XII., for November, 1882. Letters re-
specting articles to be mentioned in this*
special column must not reach us later-i'
than October 1, forinsertion in Part XII.,'
j
which will be published in advance of its
date. See also answer to W. Beau-
champ re Second-hand Tools.
Miscellaneous.
CAPT. K. (Kirby Lonsdale). Your I
letter has been sent to the firm named
therein. The non-receipt of their cata-
logue is owing, perhaps, to its having
miscarried in transit through the post.
Without doubt, a satisfactory explSia-
tion of the delay will be giveni
r
Fig. 7-Half-panel F F
PANEL D
1
PANEL E
D PANEL D
Framework of
Looking-glass, ail Eabbetted
like a Picture Frame.
GLASS
F PANEL F
XJ
TT
K PLAN K
XE
xxxxxx
Fig. 8-Railing 1
1
GLASS
PANEL E
V Fig. 9Buttress L L.
Fig. 4^Half-Panel E.
Fig. 2 -Plan and Framework of Overmantel. Pig. 1Sketch, of Glaas lin. to 1ft.
THE "LILY" MIRROR, A DESIGN FOR AN OVERMANTEL IN FRETWORK, WITH LOOKING-GLASS PANELS,
hoube bhubbuhy 8QUABE londom ec
Comprising Plan, Skfitoh, and Fall-Sized Detatle.
" BfJ. W. GLEE&OH-WHITE.
-
il
fc
V^'
^
h
m
I
VELOCIPEDES: THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND USE.
435
VELOCIPEDES
:
THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND USE.
By A. STEPHENSON.
II.Machines and Novelties of Present Season.
TRICYCLE (as the term is now under-
stood and accepted among us) is a light
carriage or machine, having, as the term
implies, three wheels furnished with tyres
to run upon the ground, for whatever
number or combination of wheels there may be in the
|
seme of the leading machines of the present season
(1882) as well as some of the novelties that have
\z tely made their appearance.
In a tricycle the essential qualities wanted are
speed, ease of propulsion, comfort, and safety ; and
we find the makers, almost without exception, putting
their own particular make of machine forth as
possessing all of these qualities, but it is left to the
user to find out very soon that his machine possesses
few, if any of them, notwithstanding the assurances
given him by the maker or dealer.
Now our present task is to find out which machine
FIG. 3.CRANKED PEDAL-
ROD OR SHAFT.
FIG. 5.
DIAGRAM
niUSTBATIVE
OF
PEOPEB
METHOD
OF
PEDALLING.
=CE^
FIG. I. DIAGRAM [)
ILLUSTRATIVE OF
ROTARY MOTION.
FIG
- 2-DIAGRAM
ILLUSTRATIVE OF LEVER MOTION.
ing or
FIG. 4.DIAGRAM
SHOWING ROTARY
ACTION ON DEAD
CENTRE.
drivin^'or other mechanism of the machine, only the
carrying wheels are reckoned in its designation.
There are now very many different types or makes
of tricycles, for the three wheeler, as compared with
the Mfcycle, admits of quite a variety of methods of
distribfction of the wheels, as also a great variety of
methods of applying propelling mechanism
; some of
the new introductions being of a very ingenious
description, and having very marked advantages over
the ordinary crank motion.
Befcre entering upon a detailed description of the
construction of any particular machine, it will be pro-
fitable, in the way of information, to notice shortly
is the speediest, easiest to drive, most comfortable,
and most safe ; and to confer the like knowledge on
all those who choose to read and study these papers
with a view to the building of their own tricycle. If
the amateur mechanically inclined is content to copy,
let him copy the best by all means
;
but if he has
brains to give to the world something original, let it
be better, and if having tried hard to give out some-
thing better, and having failed, has to fall back upon
copying, let him copy the best.
The essential parts of a tricycle may be reckoned
as at six ; namely, wheels, frame, driving apparatus,
steering apparatus, brake, and seat ;
now it is upon
T
'
436
VELOCIPEDES: THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND USE.
the true mechanical construction, arrangement, and
proportion of these parts that the excellence of a
tricycle depends, and the mechanic must possess an
extensive knowledge of mechanical powers and move-
ments, in order to apply them to the best advantage
in the construction of a tricycle.
Doubtless many of those interested in velocipede
matters, are aware that there is a book called the
Tricyclist's Indispensable Annua/, published by Iliffe
and Son, Coventry. In this book is a short descrip-
tion of about two hundred tricycles, as well as a
description of the various parts common to all tri-
cycles. It is altogether a very useful handbook on
the subject, showing as it does the peculiarities of the
various makes of machines, with illustrations of many
of them, and pointing out their excellences or defects,
as the case may be.
Now as to the distribution of the carrying wheels
of a tricycle. The most common form has two equal
wheels, facing each other (that is, one on either side
of the machine, either attached to a through axle, or
on short pins, or axle ends projecting from the sides
of the frame and placed in line) and one small wheel
placed either in front, or in the rear opposite the
centre of the frame. When this small wheel is placed
behind, the machine is called a rear steerer and open
front ; of this class may be mentioned the Cheyles-
more, Rapid, Caroche, Centaur, Coventry Favourite,
Zephyr, Express, Meteor, and many others.
The Caroche, double driver, Challenge No.
6,
Coventry Phcenix, Meteor No. 2, Premier, Royal
Salvo, Special Centaur, and a number of others, have
the steering-wheel in front. All the above machines
are three-track. A few are converted into two-track,
by having the small wheel placed either before
or behind one of the large wheels, and in line
with it, such as the National Special, Queen, Swing
Lever, etc.
Then we have machines with one large wheel as a
central driver, and two small equal wheels as steerers.
The Challenge No. 1, Dublin Lever, and Bi-tricycle are
of this type. In the two former the small wheels run
first, and are both steered. In the bi-tricycle the
small wheels run behind, the large wheel steering.
Indeed, the machine is in all respects a bicycle, ex-
cepting that there are two small wheels mounted on
one cross axle behind, instead of one as in the ordinary
bicycle.
Another class of machine has one large wheel and
two small, the large wheel occupying one side and
acting as the driver, the two small wheels occupying
the other side and acting as rudders or steerers. The
"
Coventry Rotary" is a machine of this class, and in
some respects it is superior to many of the ordinary
make of tricycles. The rider sits immediately over
the axle of large wheel, which is on his left, then he
has on the right side a small wheel about a yard
behind the centre, and the other small wheel a like
distance in front, and both acted upon by a steering
rod. It will be seen from this that the machine cannot
readily upset, either backwards or forwards, and stand-
ing upon the pedals for power does not alter the
equilibrium. The two small wheels carry equally
between them half the full load ; consequently, they
have always a good grip of the ground for steering,
and the machine steers steadily, and turns with the
greatest facility.
Another type of machine has all three wheels of
unequal size, the steering-wheel may be either behind
or before, in the centre track or in line with the next
larger wheel. They are made thus for lightness, but
this, it must be said, is about the only advantage they
possess.
One machine deserves special mention, both from
its novel construction and its performances as a
racing tricycle. This machine is called the "Humber,"
it has two equal driving-wheels and a small wheel
behind, but, unlike other tricycles, the small wheel is
not the rudder but simply the follower, as in a bicycle.
The
"
Humber" has the large wheels mounted on a
through axle, with the driving gear consisting of
wheel and chain, on the centre of that axle. From
this point a backbone with a pivoted head like a
bicycle runs backwards to the trailing wheel. On the
backbone is a saddle, and in front a handle bar
with which the machine is steered exactly bicycle
fashion.
Tricycles are distinguished as single and double
drivers. In a single driver one of the large side wheels
only has the driving power applied to it. It may be
the right hand wheel or the left, it makes no difference
which. The opposite wheel runs loose on its axle,
while the small wheel either behind or in front as the
case may be, acts as rudder.
Now a single driving tricycle is faulty in theory,
inasmuch as the driving wheel has to take along with
it the opposite wheel which is as large as itself, and
that in an awkward sidelong fashion, as well'as the
rudder-wheel, which is in the centre track ; but in
practice it has been found to answer remarkably well
upon good smooth roads, and the facility with which
it can be steered and turned in any direction by
reason of its loose wheel, as well as the simplicity of
its construction and consequent cheapness, have made
it a favourite type of machine during the last few years.
It is true that many machines are now being made
double drivers, as the advantages of double driving
cannot be disputed, but the single driver has. still a
good hold upon the market and is likely to keep
it for some time. The two classes, single and double
VELOCIPEDES : THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND USE.
437
drivers, are at present about equally divided as to
numbers.
A word now as to the source of driving power, as
applied to a tricycle. One machine, the
"
Baronet,''
has steam power as an auxiliary to the foot power.
Electricity has been tried, and may yet do great things,
but in the "meantime the prevailing sources of power
are the rider's own legs and arms, the legs rotating a
cranked shaft or moving a pair of levers, and the arms
aiding the legs by clutching a pair of fixed purchase
handles, or working, as in the case of some half-dozen
different machines, a pair of hand levers.
The pedal motion, hence the term velocipede or
velocipedal machine, assisted by the purchase handles
b^ing that most commonly in use, we will look at it in
its two systems of application, rotary and lever,
although the term lever may be applied to all tricycles,
as all are driven by leverage, without exception,
whether by feet, hands, steam, or by any other means
of force.
So the rotary motion is simply a lever having a
rotary or circular motion, the two pedals being
actuated by the feet, and describing a circle of about
12 inches in diameter (see diagram, Fig. i), whereas
the lever motion, as distinguished from the rotary, has
a sort of vertical, or up and down motion, the pedals
only travel for about 12 inches in the arc of a very
much larger circle (see Fig. 2.)
The mechanism of the rotary action consists of a
cranked pedal rod or shaft, Fig.
3,
which turns in
bearings at a a. The two ends are in line, and from
the centre of a a to the centre of the pedals, which move
freely on the parts B B, the distance is 6 inches ; con-
sequently, it is a 6 inch lever with the fulcrum at A a.
On one end a, or on each end a a, if for two chains,
a wheel is keyed, having cogs or teeth to fit a chain
made especially for this purpose. A similar wheel is
keyed on to the main driving shaft, or if the machine
is an open front single driver, this wheel is fixed to
the hub on the driving side, the whole turning freely
on a stud or axle end, fixed to the side of the frame.
The chain is made of a length to encircle the upper
and lower cog-wheels, and united, thus forming an
endless chain. The pedals, Fig.
1, put in motion by
the feet, drive the machine in the same direction.
Now, if the two cog-wheels are the same size, the
machine is said to be geared level, that is to say, a
complete turn of the pedals is a complete turn of
the large driving wheel, and if that wheel be 48
inches, then a complete revolution will be a fraction
over 12 feet.
To gear down a machine of this size, would be to
reduce the speed, and increase the power, thereby
making the machine a better hill climber, this would
be effected by increasing the size of the upper cog-
wheel, or reducing the size of that on the pedal rod,
and the difference in the power of the machine would
be in proportion to the difference made in these cog-
wheels. Supposing you had on two cog-wheels of 6
inch diameter, the machine would be running level,
but substitute an 8 inch wheel on the main shaft, and
a 4 inch on the pedal rod, the machine is now geared
down from a 48 inch to a 24 inch. You have now
double power, with only half the former speed.
Unfortunately, this change of speed to power, and vice
versa, cannot be effected at the will of the rider on
the road, unless he carries a small mechanic's shop
along with him. Consequently, a variety of very
clever methods of accomplishing this desirable change
have been devised, which will be noticed in due
course. Those readers who possess the Tricycle
Annual, or Handbook, may meantime take a look at
the "Arrow," "Rapid," "Dual," and
"
Omnicycle," hill
climbing gear. For the three former, the chain is
dispensed with, its place being taken by a series of
cog or bevel wheels, made to gear for speed or power at
the will of the rider. A number of machines are driven
by three cog-wheels geared into each other, or rather
two cog-wheels gearing into a third, having small
revolving rollers similar to these in the chain. One
machine the
"
Sterling," has but two wheelsone on
the main shaft, and one on pedal rod
gearing into
each other. To drive this machine, you have to pedal
backwards, this at first sight looks rather ridiculous,
but it is only in look; and this method has some
advantages over the ordinary forward pedalling which
could be readily shown, one being that in ascending a
hill the back instead of the front pedal receives the full
power of the thrust, and that at a point 12 inches
nearer the rear steering-wheel, so there is less danger
of lifting that wheel off the ground.
The rotary motion is preferred by many on account
of its being analogous to that of the bicycle, and some
makers have thrown aside both chains and gear-
wheels of all kinds, and have applied cranks and
connecting rods to the rotary pedal shaft. The cranks
on the ends of the pedal rod are set at right angles to
each other, and similar cranks set in the same way are
on the main shaft, the connecting rods join the two,
and the objectionable dead centre is in a sense over-
come, and the rotary action of the feet is still retained.
Of this class of machine, may be mentioned the
"
Magnet" and
"
Special Zephyr."
Lever motion is recognized as that in which hori-
zontal or other levers having pedals fitted to one end
for the feet, are made to turn cranks or other appli-
ances on the main driving shaft. The ordinary crank
shaft has two cranks in the same plane, but set in
opposite directions. The lever is a rod or bar, some
two feet or so in length ; one end is hinged to some
4j8
VIOLIN-MAKING : AS IT WAS, AND IS.
part of the frams, forming the fulcrum, the other
carries the pedal, and at a suitable part of the lever
between these two points, the connecting rods are
attache!, as at c c, Fig. 2, in the centre. The throw
of the crank would determine the place to attach rods
to levers.
To my mind the lever motion has a slight advan-
tage over the rotary, inasmuch as the power is applied
in a direct downward thrust, and the feet have not to
travel backwards and forwards as in the rotary. It
will be seen that both motions are crank motions, and
both have the serious drawback of getting on the
dead centres, and thus bringing the rider to a stand
still in ascending steep hills. To a lider this does
not require to be explained, he knows it well enough
;
but to those uninitiated the following diagrams will be
of use.
In Fig.
4 is shown the rotary action on the dead
centre. Suppose the power to be applied in the
direction of the line A A, the pedals being at B B, it
is evident that no force that could be applied would
move the machine, and in order to start you would have
to move the wheels by hand till the pedals got over
the centre towards c, when the foot being applied, the
maximum of power is attained till the pedal reaches
D, from which point it begins to get less, till it is lost
altogether at E, nor is there any power whatever got
from that pedal till it has come round to c again, so
that it will be seen the maximum of power is only
obtainable for something like one-fourth of a revolution
for each pedal, and that no power is obtainable what-
ever for more than half the revolution. An expe-
rienced rider can, in a great measure, overcome this
difficulty, however, by his method of pedalling, wherein
a novice would utterly fail. This he accomplishes by
bending the front of the foot on the lower pedal
downwards, thereby drawing that pedal back or to-
wards him, and at the same time elevating the front
of the other foot, and by the two actions bring the
second pedal over the centre. This will be readily
seen from the diagram, Fig.
5,
assuming the thrust to
be on the vertical line A a.
On level ground the momentum of the machine
will take it over these dead points, and they are not
much felt ; but upon ascending a stiff hill the difficulty
becomes a still more serious one, especially if the
machine is not fitted with means of increasing the
power.
The dead point difficulty has been overcome by
several makers in a very ingenious fashion, as in the
"
Omnicycle,"
"
Overman,"
"
Dutton," and others
; but
as this paper is sufficiently long, a description of
these must be reserved for the third of this series of
articles.
{To be continued
.)
VIOLIN-MAKING : AS IT WAS, AND IS.
By EDWARD HERON-ALLEN.
IX.The Strings.
AVING finally adjusted all the fittings of
the violin, and got together the miscellanea
of the fiddler's art, there remains but one
particular to be attended to before pro-
ceeding from the consideration of the
Bow to the actual manual operations necessary for
the carrying out of the scientific principles which have
been the subject of the preceding chapters. This
matter, which, though left till the last, is almost as
important as the existence of the fiddle itself, is the
consideration, selection, and manufacture of the strings.
It is not an uncommon thing to see an amateur enter
a violin-dealer's shop and say
"
Give me two firsts, and
a second, please," and walk off with the first three
given him by the individual in charge, without even
examining them. The chances are a hundred to one
that the result of that amateur's expenditure of capital
will be a source of considerable ghastliness, of thought
to himself, and sound to his sorrowing family or
neighbours. It cannot be too strongly borne in mind
that not only must the size, quality, and substance of
the strings be perfect, but that the individual strings
chosen must suit the instrument to which they are to
be applied, for a string that would produce a mellow
and full tone on one fiddle might very probably be
harsh and "criard" on another. This care in choosing
particularly applies to the first string, or chanterelle,
and proportionately to the others.
The appliance known as a string-gauge is well
known, and has before been referred to ; but each
violinist ought to have one to his own fiddle, i.e., he
should get one quite plain, and as he gets good, sweet,
and true strings on to his fiddle, which suit the instru-
ment, he should mark it for himself, by them, and as
nearly as possible always choose strings the same size
by its aid.
As to the strings themselves, besides being suited
to the fiddle to which they are fixed, they must also
possess certain qualities which are absolutely indis-
pensable to tone, and which are technically summed
up in four words : They must be true. True, not only
individually, but true to one another ; and this truth is
only to be obtained, in the first case, by being properly
constructed and chosen, and in the second case by
being accurately proportioned, or gauged to each other.
It is absolutely necessary that a string be of even
thickness throughout, i.e., one end must not be thinner
than another or else the production of perfect fifths
and harmonic octaves will be rendered impossible.
,
VIOLIN-MAKING : AS IT WAS, AND IS.
439
As the sounding of these two combinations is the best,
and absolutely certain test for falseness in a string, it
may be advisable here to consider the conditions
necessary for their perfect production. When a string
is divided into two equal halves by a light pressure of
the little finger, in the fourth position, the well-known
sound of the harmonic octave is produced by the two
halves of the string vibrating simultaneously and
consonantly, as in Fig. 58. If re-divided at a quarter of
its length from the nut by the first finger, in the third
position, a second octave (higher) is produced by the
four quarters of the string vibrating simultaneously
and consonantly, as in Fig.
59,
and it is immaterial
whether the little finger be removed or not (though in
many instances it is advisable that it be kept in position
as in the figure) ; now if the thickness of the string be
not uniform, and the string be divided by a firm
pressure, as in Fig. 60, and the two halves thus isolated
obvious, for if one string is finer at one end than at the
other, the two equal halves will have a different intona-
tion, and the fifth produced by vibrating such a string
simultaneously with another true one will not be per-
fect, but harsh and disonant. Therefore, if a string
will render two perfect harmonic octaves, and if another
vibrated simultaneously with it gives perfect fifths when
stopped at an identical point, those two strings are true,
in themselves, and to one another. It has been sug-
gested that when strings are thus falsified by want of
similarity throughout their breadth, the defect may be
to a certain extent remedied by passing a moist finger
along the finer portion of the string, and by thus
swelling it an approach to equality of thickness pro-
duces somewhat the desired result, but it will always
be found best to take another string at once, rather
than try to remedy a false one. It will be said that
this is a lengthy mode of judging of a false string, and
a.
~
U
SB
FIG. 60.
Figs.
58, 59,
60.Diagrams illustrating Tests of Strings.References to Letters : A, Bridge
;
B, Nut
;
C, Little Finger
(fourth position) ; D, First Finger (third position). In Fig. 58 the string is shown divided into two halves, a,b, by light
pressure at C. In Fig. 59
the string is divided into four quarters at c, d. e,f,
by light pressure at Dpressure at C optional.
In Fig. 60 the string is divided into two halves, a', 6', by firm pressure at C.
be struck with the bow, the thinner end of the string
will give a higher note than the thicker, and, conse-
quently, if to such a string a light pressure be applied,
as in Fig.
58, the two halves vibrating simultaneously
but not consonantly, a false, squeaky note will be pro-
duced in place of the clear flute tone of a true
harmonic octave. The higher harmonic octave, as in
Fig-
59,
constitutes in similar manner a yet finer test
for the truth of an individual string.
The next test for the truth of a string, both
individually and to its neighbour, is the production of
perfect fifths. By this is meant that if two strings are
stopped by the finger both together at any given point,
a fifth will be produced the same as it was when the
two open strings gave a perfect fifth when sounded
together. If the harmonic octaves of both open strings
are sounded together by one light pressure, as in Fig.
58, they will (if the two strings are true) produce a per-
fect harmonic fifth, an octave above the perfect fifth
produced by the open strings. The reason for this is
that a string once mounted and removed, is useless
alike to the buyer and seller, the only chance therefore
is to be guided by the eye in choosing strings in the
shop, and a very short acquaintance with the exterior
signs of a good string will effectually guard the fiddler
from ever investing in a false one. A string, as seen in
the coil or bundle at a shop, ought to be transparent,
and without spots or blotches throughout its entire
length. It should be pliant and elastic, returning to
its former shape without breaking when pressed or
pulled out ; it should not be too white, for this betokens
improper materials or excessive bleaching, both of
which render a string brittle and false. A good string
must not lose its transparency, and become cloudy and
yellow when bent. Seconds and thirds may be with-
out harm much whiter than firsts, but otherwise the
same rules apply. It is often laid down that the truth
of a string may be determined by vibrating it between
the fingers, and that if it present only two even lines
it is true, and if more, false. It is certain that if it
440
VIOLIN MAKING : AS IT WAS, AND IS.
produce an irregular or multiplied figure it is false, but
it does not follow that if the lines be clear and distinct
it is true ; and again, a string which may seem true at
a slight tension, may quite possibly be false at the
higher tension to which it is subjected when applied to
a fiddle, though as a rule a string may be false at a low
ension whilst it is true at a higher. The reader will
appreciate this if he has ever been forced as a. pis allct
to mount an E string as an A. It remains, therefore
that the only way to ensure choosing good strings is to
go as far as possible by the appearances before
mentioned, and, above all, to deal only with the best
goods of the best dealers. It is a mistake, to my mind,
for amateurs to think they can save money by buying
a bundle of fifteen or thirty coils at once ; they are
almost sure to go wrong before they are all used,
unless the greatest care is taken of them. Some
people wrap their spare strings in bladder or flannel
moistened with oil, a process which, even if the oil
does not go rancid, as it generally does, can only be
characterized as horrid. The mess involved in putting
on a new greasy string is enough, if you are not of a
seraphic disposition (I am not) to make you touchy for
the rest of the performance. I never buy more than
two strings at a time, and always keep just one set
handy. I use Mr. Hill's gut strings and Mr. Hart's
covered ones, and never have had a bad one since
I
started this arrangement.
The different strings now in the market are de-
scribed by Mr. Hart in his work "TheViolin: its Makers
and Imitators," as follows :
"
Musical strings are
manufactured in Italy, Germany, France, and England.
The Italians rank first in this manufacture, their pro-
ficiency being evident in the three chief requisites for
strings, viz., high finish, great durability, purity of
sound. There are manufactories at Rome, Naples,
Padua, and Verona, the separate characteristics of
which are definitely marked in their produce. Those
strings which are manufactured at Rome are exceed-
ingly hard and brilliant, and exhibit a slight roughness
of finish. The Neapolitan samples are smooth and
softer than the Roman, and also whiter in appearance.
Those of Padua are highly polished and durable, but
frequently false. The German strings now rank next
to the Italian, Saxony being the seat of manufacture.
They may be described as very white and smooth, the
better kinds being very durable. Their chief fault
arises from their being over bleached, and hence
faulty in sound. The French take the third place in
the manufacture. Their strings are carefully made,
and those of the larger sizes answer well, but the
smaller strings are wanting in durability. The English
manufacture all qualities, but chiefly the cheaper kinds,
they are durable, but unevenly made, and have a dark
appearance."
The cause of variation in quality of the several
kinds arises simply from the difference of climate.
In Italy an important part of the process of manu-
facture is carried on in the open air, and the beautiful
climate is made to effect that which has to be done
artificially in other countries. Hence the Italian
superiority. Southern Germany adopts, to some ex-
tent, similar means in making strings ; France to a
less degree ; while England is obliged to rely solely
on artificial processes. It therefore amounts to this
result, the further from Italy the more inferior the
string.
It is a matter of everyday occurrence to hear
people talk of fiddle strings as
"
catgut ;
"
indeed, one
great writer has alluded to a violinist as a man who
stretches the bowels of a cat over a wooden box and
rubs them with the tail of a horse. However this may
be, it is one of those carefully-persisted-in errors made
on the Incus a non lucendo principle. Setting aside
for future consideration the silk, metal, and acribelle
strings, we will turn our attention to the manufacture
of the ordinary strings, which are all similarly com-
posed, the only difference being that the fourth (or G)
string is covered with a layer of fine wire, whose com-
position and object will be hereafter noticed. Strings
for the violin, and nearly all other string instruments,
are composed of the small intestines of sheep, the
best are those of Iambs which have lived on dry
mountainous pastures ; and it is said that the best lambs
are those from the province of Berry, and other parts
of Germany, and they are at their best for the purpose
of string-making in the month of September, which is
consequently the string-making month in each year.
The intestine used is that one which is composed
of the duodenum, the jejunum, and the ilion ; it is
composed of three membranes, the external, or peri-
toneal, and the mucous membranes, which are removed
as useless, but which enclose between them a third,
the muscular or fibrous membrane, which is used in
the manufacture of fiddle strings. The intestines are
fetched direct from the butchers, whilst the carcases
are still warm, and from which they are detached by
workmen who are specially employed for the purpose,
by whom they are at once stretched upon an inclined
plane and scraped with a knife blade, to clean and
empty them of all foreign substances, grease, etc.
This must be done quickly and whilst the intestines
are yet warm, or the cooling matters would hopelessly
colour the intestines ; after this operation the intes-
tines are tied up in bundles and placed in vessels to
carry them to the manufactory, where they are tied in
bundles of ten, and placed in cold water from twelve
to fifteen hours ; this may be done in a running stream
or in a vat of spring water, slightly corrected with
carbonate of soda. After this they are immersed four
VIOLIN-MAKING : AS IT WAS, AND IS. 441
or five hours in tepid running water. These soakings
produce a slight fermentation, which aids the separa-
tion of the fibrous from the mucous and peritoneal
membranes, which is done by women scraping the
intestines with a split cane on a slightly inclined slab,
down which a current of water constantly runs ;
the
internal membranes run off into a trough and are used
as manure, the external are used for raquets, whips,
and other rougher articles composed of gut. The
fibrous membranes separated in bundles of about
ten, are now placed in stone jars to soak for three or
four hours in potassa lye (or ammoniacal solution,
which is preferable), whose strength must be most
carefully apportioned to the work to be done. At the
end of this time they are carefully rubbed through the
first finger, protected by a gutta percha glove, and the
thumb armed with a copper thimble, of the left hand
;
by this means are removed any of the fragments of
the two superfluous membranes which may have
escaped the first scraping. This operation is gene-
rally repeated at two hours' interval three times during
the day, after each of which they are put into a similar
stone jar of solution of permanganate of potassa.
The fourth time this is repeated they are not replaced
into solution, but are merely dipped into a weak
solution of sulphuric acid. These operations are re-
peated for two or three days, morning and evening,
always similarly increasing the strength of the solution.
The guts are now sufficiently cleaned to be sorted,
and, if necessary, split. They are sorted by expe-
rienced workmen into qualities, lengths, thicknesses,
and strengths, so that each may be devoted to its
proper uses and tones. As the guts, in their natural
state, are not sufficiently uniform in diameter to obtain
that cylindricity and parallelness that is the great aim
of the string-maker, they often require to be split into
long threads by means of a knife specially prepared
for the purpose, which threads are then placed in a
jar with their thick and thin ends set alternately. The
next operation is the spinning, which is performed on
a frame about three times as long as a fiddle. It is
done as follows : two, three, or more fibres (accord-
ing to the string required to be made) are taken and
set alternately ; that is, the thick end of one opposite
the thin end of another. The usual number appor-
tioned to the four strings of a violin are as follows :
for the first, or E string, 3-4 fine threads
; for the
second, or A, 3-4 strong ones ; for the third, or D, 6-7
strong ones. Beyond this double bass strings reach
as many as 85 fibres, but this is a branch of the
manufacture which does not concern us at present.
At one end of the frame is a little wheel which
bears two hooks, at the other end are little fixed pegs.
The guts selected are fixed to a peg which is set in one
hook of the wheel, and carried to the other end of the
frame, twisted round a fixed peg, brought back to
the other end and fixed to the other hook of the wheel
by another peg; this wheel is rapidly revolved by a
multiplying fly-wheel, and the guts are twisted up into
a fiddle-string, the fingers being passed along it mean-
while to prevent the formation of inequalities in its
length. The pegs are then removed from the hooks
and set into holes opposite the fixed pegs at the other
end of the frame (in the same way as tuning pegs are
set into the scroll of a fiddle), and the work proceeds in
the same way with a new bundle of guts from another
fixed peg and the hooked wheel, until the frame is full.
The strings are then sulphured to whiten them in a sul-
phuring chamber, into which the frames are placed, and
flowers of sulphur ignited in the centre. The chamber
is then hermetically sealed and left for the night, during
which time the strings become bleached by the action of
the sulphurous acid gas evolved by the combustion of
the sulphur. They are next morning exposed to air (but
not rain) till nearly dry, when they are again moistened,
twisted on the frame, and replaced in the sulphur bath,
this operation lasts from two to eight days according
to the size of the string being made. The strings are
then thoroughly polished and rubbed to get rid of all
inequalities, grease, or other foreign particles ; this is
done whilst they are still on the frame by means of a
set of hair cushions, which enveloping the strings, by a
lateral movement submits them to a rapid and forcible
friction, they being from time to time during the ope-
ration moistened with a sponge soaked in an alkaline
solution of potassa. The strings are then wiped to get
rid of all impurities, moistened with pure water, and
replaced for the night in the sulphur bath, after which
they are again twisted and dried. When dry they are
polished, an operation which first, orE strings are fre-
quently allowed to go without, but which for the others
takes place as follows : The frames are laid flat upon
trestles or other supports, and the strings are polished
by hand or machinery by means of little gutta percha
cushions, olive oil and pounce, or whitening, being
used for the purpose. These polishers are run from
end to end of the strings till the requisite polish has
been obtained. The strings are then carefully wiped
and lightly moistened with olive oil, after which they
are thoroughly dried, which is when on loosening the
pegs they do not contract. The strings are now cut
from the frames close to the pegs, and rolled into
circles as we see them in commerce, after which they
are made up into bundles of fifteen or thirty.
It remains to us now before noticing patent strings
to turn to the consideration of covered strings. On the
violin only one such is used, the fourth, or G string
; but
going a step farther to the tenor, or viola, we get another
covered string, the C, which balances the absence of the
E. For violins it is generally gut which is covered with
442
HOW TO BUILD
A PERAMBULATOR.
copper (plated or pure) or silver. Silk is also used, but
it is difficult to tune accurately, and will not remain
in tune when once screwed up ;
undoubtedly the best
are the copper plated gut ones. I always obtain my
covered strings for viola from Mr. G. Hart, who
covers them with alternate spirals of gun-metal and
plated copper. The best (recommended by Herr
Strauss) are wrapped over close to the knot with red
silk. The gut of which these strings are formed is
not sulphured, nor is it oiled. The string is fixed at
one end to a hook set on a wheel, and at the other to
a turning swivel which holds the string stretched by
means of a weight. The turning of the wheel turns
the strings and the swivel, and the workman carefully
wraps the wire on to the string as it revolves, taking
the greatest care to preserve its regularity and close
winding. The gut used must be perfectly uniform in
diameter throughout its length, and incapable of fur-
ther stretching. Consequently it is strongly stretched
before the wire is wound on, or else by subsequent
stretching the core would recede from the helix, and the
effect can only be described by those who have suf-
fered it. All violin players are familiar with the now-
common acribelle, or silk, strings, which are composed
of an infinity of filaments of silk so twisted together
and polished as to exceed in uniformity and transpa-
rency the finest gut strings. For players troubled
with oerspiring hands, and for hot or damp climates,
they are without doubt invaluable, for they are but
little affected by damp, and they make up in conve-
nience in these respects what they certainly lack in
tone. They are apt also to fray and get ragged, and
though it has been recommended when this is the
case to draw the string quickly through the flame of
a spirit lamp, to remove the frayed fibres, an acribelle
once gone wrong acquires an accession of infinite
ghastliness more easily imagined than described.
(To be continued.')
:>-
1-
=-
HOW TO BUILD A PERAMBULATOR.
By J. B. WOOLFITT.
MONG inferior or lesser means of locomo-
tion in these days, the domestic peram-
bulator plays a part, the importance of
which cannot be over-estimated ; then
distinct from utility, were beauty the sole
quality desired, nothing, apparently, may be added to
the elegance of its form. Had the poet, ere he con-
ceived Queen Mab's conveyance, seen the perfection
baby's coach now displays, we may opine that
11
Wagon spokes maie of long spinner's legs,
And cover of the wings of grasshoppers,"
would have given place to parts fashioned of grosser
material ; but, beyond all frivolous laudation, it
is a healthy and comfortable means whereby the
younger members of the household may take the air,
and this fact must commend its adoption to Pater-
familias.
The acquisition of such a desideratum will dis-
cover many advantages wherein infantile locomotion
is concerned
; of these an immunity from fatigue will
not be the least that the nurse will experience; further-
more, by bringing improved wheels into application,
an easy and noiseless progression is attained, con-
ducive to an enjoyment of quiet slumber by the occu-
pant, andat the same time such facility is afforded for
propulsion and direction that must lessen the liability
to obstruction that hitherto branded as a nuisance this
small vehicle when driven upon the footway. It is,
therefore, a matter for congratulation that time has
abated this bad quality, and saved the expression of
many anathemas by crusty pedestrians.
Notwithstanding the fact that so useful an article
may be bought at a comparatively low price, there are
those who have a wish, and in the light of a little
instruction may be induced, to try their hands upon
its manufacture. An inspection of the body will
prove its construction to be a very simple work, and a
task the amateur may attempt with little fear as to
ultimate successthat is, if he is possessed of ordi-
nary capabilities, and is desirous to save the outlay
attendant upon professional labour. The other por-
tions, however, do not admit of like arguments being
advanced in favour of their manufacture at home, for
there is much in them to call for skill, in a degree,
greater than wherewith the inexperienced are usually
endowed. The requisite implements must also be
taken into consideration, as, for instance, the spindle
of the front wheel, the handle, and the boxes of the
side wheelsall of these must be turned. Then a
forge will be necessary for the springs and other iron-
work; or if it be decided to employ metal wheels, the
compulsory element of truth they will demand will not
be obtained without the use of an engineer's lathe.
Possibly there are amateurs who have access to the
usual adjuncts of a forge and the necessary lathes, but
for the assistance of less fortunate ones, it may be men-
tioned that there are many makers who will gladly
supply the set of fittings, together with wheels of either
kind. Some will, no doubt, avail themselves of this
latter information, which having imparted, we will
postpone the complexity of iron-work, wheels, etc.,
and proceed to the straightforward cutting out and
fitting together of the body, which requires a material
less intractable in the hands of the amateur.
There are various designs extant for the sides,
many of which display good proportion and tasteful
outline ; and the amateur's own judgment may be em-
HOW TO BUILD A PERAMBULATOR.
443
ployed to select from these, or he may invent a shape
that will best suit his requirements, bearing always in
mind that elaboration must not be so obtrusive that
the quality of strength is put aside and lost sight of.
Either of the shapes shown in Figs. I, 2, and 3
might
would be irreparable, or to be remedied only by taking
apart and putting on an entire new side.
Having decided upon the design, and set it out for
right and left upon % inch pine boards, planed one side
and free from knots, cut upon the pencil marks with
FIG. 9. THE HANDLE AND ITS ENDS.
Scale, 2 inches to the foot.
-NAVE OF WOODEN WHEEL.BLACK LINE
AT A SHOWS METHOD OF BOXING.
FIG. 3.ALTERNATIVE DESIGN FOR SIDE, WITH HOOD.
be chosen, although it were wise, in some degree, to
ey.cept Fig. 2, or at least, before adopting it, to ponder
well upon the kind of treatment the perambulator is
likely to receive in use. A scroll is not always calcu-
lated to withstand rough usage, and nothing looks
more ridiculous than mutilation of ornament that is
not extraneous, and when, as in this case, damage
FIG. I.THE PERAMBULATOR WHEN FINISHED.
the bow-saw, carefully preserving the flowing freedom
of the various curves. When you have done this
properly, and cleaned away with a fine file all evidence
of the saw, the two sides will be ready to join to the
other parts. Of course, it has been determined whether
to make a double or a single perambulator, for this
regulates the sizes that the back, the seat, the foot, and
T 2
444
HOW TO BUILD A PERAMBULATOR.
bottom-boards are to be. The sketches are drawn
to a scale of I inch to the foot, and the dimensions
may be obtained therefrom ; but before going further,
it may be pointed out that in this case there should
be no difficulty in the way of making full-size working
drawings. The amateur will then see his work clearly
before him, and he is strongly advised to avail himself
of this plan, to his advantage. As will be seen, a
single perambulator of the Fig. I style is described,
the extreme width of which is I foot 2 inches ; in a
double one there would be a slight narrowing from the
back to the foot-board, and the widest part would be
I foot 8 inches
; the side-pieces also would be propor-
tionately extended.
The back-piece, the seat, and the bottom-boards,
indicated by dotted lines in Figs. 2 and
3,
are of
J
inch
deal ; the sides are fastened to these by 2-inch nails,
not too many, but just sufficiently numerous to hold
the parts firmly together. In order that the plane, in
dressing up, may not suffer damage, do not omit to
imbed thoroughly the heads of all nails. The piece
for the seat having been cut wide enough to project
about ii inches, its front corners must be neatly rounded
off. Fig.
4
shows the shape of the back-piece, and
how it is joined to the sides; the back is covered from
a point that will include and hide this joining, thence
down to the seat with inch board of sufficient width,
bent to follow the curve, and fastened on with }
inch
French brads. Then to strengthen this thin board,
and to preserve its convexity, glue on the inside thereof
three or four slips of the same thin wood, to lie length-
wise the grain. It will also be well to glue two similar
slips on to the inside of the back piece across the
grain. The space from the seat to the bottom-board
is filled by a piece of
J
inch board.
The foregoing instructions, though describing Fig.
I, may also be applied to the making of Fig. 2. In
Fig.
3,
the thin boarding is continued the full distance
down to the bottom-board, with which it lies flush, and
the side-pieces are cut down to effect this. To ensure
the rigidity of this thin board, it is bradded to a slip of
wood
\
inch square that is fixed from side to side
next the bottom-board, thin slips in sufficient number
being also glued on the inside, to preserve its con-
vexity without strain.
If it be desired to make a rounded back, curved
stays of hard wood must be screwed on to the side-
pieces from the inside. Some of the aforesaid thin
stuff is then bent round the outside, bradded on, and
strengthened in the manner as already directed. This
must lie flush with the sides, in a rebate provided for
its reception.
All that has been done must now be dressed up
with the plane, and finished with glass paper. Then
nail on curved arm-pieces of hard wood, and the body
will be ready to pass to the next stagethat of
painting.
A dark chocolate ground with lines of yellow, or a
very dark green ground with a line of vermilion be-
tween two lines of blue, are suggested as pleasing
combinations. The colours should be ground in turps,
with a small quantity of varnish, and rapidly worked,
as they will soon dry, but without the lustre that will
be produced hereafter. Having first stopped all nail-
holes and imperfections with putty, apply two coats of
paint, allow the first to dry thoroughly before putting
on the second, and rub down after each application
with fine glass paper. Only a practised hand can do the
striping with freedom, although with care the amateur
will get along fairly well ; but he should obtain a brush
called a
"
striper," this is a pencil with very long hair,
and the proper tool for the work; his disability will be
further lessened if he transfer lines for his guidance by
means of stencil plates made of stout paper. All having
been done as directed, apply a coat of oil copal varnish
and put aside where no particles of dust or insect may
sully the even gloss required. The progress of drying
should not be tested by touching with the finger
;
simply breathe upon the surface, and if ready to
handle a film will settle there for a second or two, if
still wet it will remain bright.
Before beginning the trimming, arrange square-
necked rivet-headed bolts with the heads inside, two
through the back for the irons that are to hold the
handle, and four for the springs that will in this way
be fastened to the bottom.
The stuffing is done by a layer of wool waste, with
a layer of cotton waste at top to bind the looser stuff
together. For the trimming, obtain some dark serge
cloth, the colour of which harmonises or agrees with
the painting. The back being quilted, renders neces-
sary an arrangement and completion of the padding
and covering for that part before putting on, then the
seat, the sides, and the arms should all be well padded, so
that no hard corners make their presence evident, and
plenty of small tacks must be used to fasten on the cloth
covering. A piece of cloth hemmed, and then bound
with gimp, is tacked on to the front of the seat in
gathers, to hang as a curtain; gimp is also tacked
upon all edges, to give a neat finish. Cover the foot
and bottom-boards with a piece of oil-cloth beating an
unobtrusive pattern.
It has been inferred that iron-work and wheels can
scarcely be considered under the head of amateur
work, nor will the compass of this article permit of
more than a brief description. First are two bent
pieces of \ inch round iron, each 46 inches long, that
will be attached when the body is mounted upon the
wheels ; their shape is seen in Fig. 1. They are each
provided with a stay, welded on, turned up, and
HOW TO BUILD A PERAMBULATOR.
445
pierced, that they may be fixed to the back by the
bolts provided there for them. The upper ends of
these irons are dressed out to I inch flat, and are bent
in a curl to hold the ends of the handle. The lower
ends are also dressed out flat, and, by means of holes
punched in them, screw on to the bottom-board be-
tween the springs. The springs are of I inch spring
steel, and may be made with shackles, as Fig.
5,
or in
an entire piece, as Fig. 6. As a guide in bending
them, a piece of hoop iron is shaped to the required
curves, and is then called a
"
template." Each spring
is bent in a curl for the spindle of the front wheel to
turn in, and holes are punched for the bolts that pro-
trude from the bottom-board, and in fixing the spring
to the axle a square hole will be necessary for the
neck of the bolt. The axle for wooden wheels need
simply be wrought, and afterwards filed smooth at the
parts the wheels will revolve upon. It must be
furnished with holes for bolting to the springs, and
at the extreme ends for lynch-pins.
A wooden wheel should be made from sound, well-
seasoned ash. The outer rim, or "felly," is divided into
segments which are cut from the solid, and tongued
together by slips of wood to keep them in position.
These segments may be in number half as many as
there are to be spokes ; this follows that in the com-
plete wheel each segment will have two spokes to
support it. The spokes are shaped with the spoke-
shave, and shouldered, to insert into the nave and
felly respectively. The nave, Fig.
7,
is turned and
bored. The wheel must first be exactly arranged
upon a surface, where the spokes and felly may lie
flatly ; then, whilst the heat of the iron is shown by a
good blood-red, the tyre should be put on, this being
quickly cooled by running through water, contracts,
and drives all the parts tightly into position. Before
the wheel is fit for use it must be
"
boxed," which con-
sists of a piece of iron bent to form a cylinder fixed
and adjusted in the nave to ensure the wheel running
truly upon the axle, this boxing completely lines the
bore, and to secure it therein, a piece is bent outward
at one end to knock into the nave (see Fig.
7) ; thus
the friction is provided for that otherwise would
quickly wear away the wood A wooden wheel revolves
upon the axle between two washers ; the lynch-pin
then being inserted to hold all secure, neat brass caps
are nailed on the nave to guard any rough projection
of the axle or lynch-pin.
A metal wheel consists of the nave or "hub"
(Fig.
8), the spokes, the rim, and a hexagonal cap,
which screws on the outer side of the hub, and serves
for lubricating purposes. The hub is cast in gun-
metal, and turned up in the lathe ; there are two rims
upon it, in both of which holes are drilled and tapped
to receive the two series of spokes, and at an angle to
suit their convergence to the outer rim. The spokes
being made with a thread at one end and a head at
the other, are passed through the grooved rim, which
is drilled with a sufficient number of holes to accom-
modate them ; they are then screwed into the hub,
and adjusted by a hand-vice or pliers. Rubber tyres
should be bought smaller than the circumference of
the wheels they are intended for ; they are procurable
in various qualities, and sold by weight. To fix them
on, the groove is smeared with a tenacious composi-
tion supplied by the rubber dealer ; this sets imme-
diately, but that is of no consequence, for when the
tyre is stretched upon the wheel, hot irons are applied
to the rim betwixt the spokes. In this way the cement
is remelted, and the necessary firm settlement of the
tyre within the groove achieved. The axle for metal
wheels must be turned. The medium for painting
iron-work should be chiefly varnish, to dry quickly.
Little now remains to be done than to construct
the hood, shown in Fig. 3. The frame of this is in
three parts. These may be of inch round iron, or
very stout wire, and will each be 3 feet 8 inches long,
with a curl at both ends, and bent to the proper height
and width, then fastened to the body by thumb-screws
passing through the curls into the arm-piece. The
detachment of the hood thus becomes an easy matter.
The covering of this frame, and making of the
apron, are matters for the display of womanly taste.
They may be of holland trimmed with bright-coloured
braid, or if for rough weather, of American cloth lined
with holland. Buttonholes must be worked in them,
whereby they may be attached to the body, and to the
same end, the body must be furnished with small
brass knobs. A strap from the foot-board to the front
rib of the frame-work will keep the hood in position.
A knob on either side of the body, and a strap from
the one to the other, must be provided, to keep the
child from tumbling out.
The handle, of hard wood, should be turned and
varnished, and the iron supports for it may now be
attached to the body. The curled portions of these sup-
ports are held by turned knobs, that are glued into
the ends of the handle (see Fig.
9).
There are other kinds of perambulators employed,
notably the
"
double up
"
and the
''
bassinette
"
forms
;
but the simplest kind and the one in more general use
has been chosen as the subject of this paper, as pre-
senting fewer difficulties of construction to the amateur.
In conclusion, it is hoped the amateur may not be
deterred, by a faithful presentment of technical points,
from exercising his capabilities to the utmost, for it
requires but little thought to demonstrate that jobs
contingent to home requirements will more profitably
engage the leisure too often abandoned to trifling or
ennui.
446
FILTERS: THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND MAINTENANCE.
FILTERS:
THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND MAINTENANCE.
By ALFRED W. SOWABD.
IV.The Collection, Storing', and Filtration of
Rain-Water.
|
ANY of my readers must have looked with
regret upon the enormous waste of water
which occurs in our large cities, thanks
to the custom which prevails of permitting
rain-water to escape to the sewers. Many,
when paying their quarterly water-rate, must have
thought longingly of that water which, coming to them
gratuitously, they were nevertheless forced, through
lack of means to collect and store it, to allow to go as
it came. It is the object of the present article to
show these regretful ones, and others too, whose
attention may be drawn to the subject for the first
time, how they may utilise the rain-water which falls
upon their houses, and thus render themselves partly
(in some cases entirely) independent of the exactions
of the Water Companies, and at the same time ensure
for themselves a constant supply of almost pure
water.
But, for the benefit of those of my readers who have
not previously thought upon the subject, it is desirable
that I should first devote a few lines to a brief state-
ment of the respective advantages and disadvantages
of rain and river-water, for household use.
In considering the question of the relative purity
of the two kinds of water, it will be well to trace the
water in its course from the ocean, through its various
journeyings back to the ocean again, noticing the
impurities which it picks up and deposits on its way.
Starting then with the ocean as the great
reservoir from which our rain and river-water is
drawn, we find huge masses of water vapour sucked
up by the sun's heat, and wafted inland by the wind.
Passing presently into a colder region, the capacity of
the air to hold water vapour in suspension is lowered
and some of the vapour becomes
condensed into
"water dust" or cloud; these minute
particles of
water agglomerate into drops, which fall to the earth
in the form of rain, washing and purifying
the
air in their passage, and becoming by the very
act
themselves impure. If this rain falls through the pure
air of the open country, it will be almost
absolutely
pure. If it falls through the air of an ordinary
town
it will be laden with soot from the chimneys,
with
carbonic acid gas produced in the processes of
breathing and of burning, with sulphuric acid derived
from the combustion of coal gas, and with various
putrescent matters discharged from the lungs of the
inhabitants, and rising from the sewers, and from the
dust-bins and muck-heaps which abound, even under
the most vigilant sanitary supervision. If the rain
falls through the air of a manufacturing district, it will
be charged, in addition, with the volatile products of
the manufacturing operations carried on in that dis-
trict. On reaching the earth, the water is absorbed,
and gradually soaks its way, in a direction determined
by the geological formation of the surface at that
particular place, until it rises again as a spring, or is
drawn up from a well. During its progress, if the
strata through which it passes are unpoisoned, it
undergoes a process of natural filtration and purifi-
cation, becoming at the same time charged with
mineral ingredients derived from the soil. (In this
way the peculiar medicinal properties of many natural
waters are accounted for.) The little brooklet formed
by the spring, unites with other brooklets into a stream,
this with other streams until a river is formed, which
flows on to the sea, becoming by the addition of
sewage and other deleterious matters, more and more
contaminated as it goes.
It is plain, then, to see that the purest natural
water is that obtained in the form of rain in a country
district ; that next in order of excellence comes spring,
or (deep) well-water ; next rain-water collected in
towns ; and last and worst of all river-water.
As to hardness, rain-water being obtained by
distillation is, like all water so obtained, soft ; whilst
water which has soaked through the earth is, by virtue
of the solid matter it has dissolved, more or less hard.
Remembering that for household purposes soft water
is (as every housewife knows) to be preferred to hard,
it is obvious that rain-water, purified by filtration, is
to be preferred to river-water. It only remains then
to point out how the water falling upon a house may
be collected and purified, and to consider whether the
amount so caught, is sufficient for the use of the
inmates of that house.
To consider the latter question first. The effective
roof-area of an ordinary dwelling-house may be taken
at about 500 square feet. The average rainfall in
London is about 24 inches. That is, if all rain lay
where it fell, the surface of London would be 2 feet
under water at the expiration of a twelvemonth. The
average amount of water falling upon the roof of an
ordinary house in London is, therefore, 1,000 cubic feet
per year. A cubic foot of water contains friyz im-
perial gallons
; or a thousand cubic feet contains 6,232
imperial gallons. The daily allowance would, there-
fore, be about 17
gallons In Lincoln, where the rain-
fall is only 20 inches per year, the daily supply would
be about 14 gallons ; in a place called the Stye, where
the rain-fall is 165 inches, the supply would be about
120 gallons. The former amount, although not an ex-
cessive supply, is certainly enough for t le cooking and
FILTERS: THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND MAINTENANCE.
447
washing of an ordinary small
household, whilst the latter
amount is more than sufficient
for all its wants.
To turn now to the collec-
tion, storing, and filtration of
rain-water. For the roofing
of our house, where that roof
is used as a water-shed, slates
Buck's patent percolator is to
be placed, the object of which
instrument is to collect in a
separate tank, for rough pur-
poses, the first washings of
the roof, the latter being gene-
rally, and more especially in
dry weather, covered with
dust, and objectionable matters
FIG. 21.
DIAGRAM
SHOWING METHOD OF
JOINING STACK-PIPE TO PER.
COLATOR, AND PERCOLATOR
RAIN-WATER TANKS.
FIG. 22. LUCK S PATENT
PERCOLATOR IN SECTION.
are to be preferred to
tiles, they being less
porous, 2nd more easily
cleansed. The gutters
should have a continuous
fall, without any depres-
sions where water might
lodge and stagnate ; and
the stack-pipes should, if
possible, be brought to-
gether, as shown in Fig.
21. At the junction a
A, Tank for Rough Water
B, Tank for Pure Water.
C, Percolator.
D, D, D, Stack Pipes.
References to Letters in Pig. 23.A, Strainer with Perforated
Plate ; B, Outlet for Water ; C, Percolator on Pivot ; D, Compart-
nunt into which Water first falls; E, Hole with Washer propor-
tioned to size of roof; F, Larger hole to prevent too rapid filling
of D ; G, Overflow Pipe for storm ; H, Hole at back of Q-, through
which Water passes from D to I ; I, Large Compartment ; J
f
Spout
of Percolator; K, Pure Water Storage Pipe; K', Rough Water
Storage Pipe ; L, Small hole at bottom of compartment I ; M, Auxi-
liary Pipe for catching last drop of rain ; N, Cover for
Pure Water Pipe ; 0, Iron] Frame by which Apparatus
fastened to Wall.
FIG. 24.ARRANGEMENT OF TANKS FOR COLLECTING AND STORING
RAIN-WATER. RECOMMENDED BY MR. SHIRLEY HIBBERD.
A, Tank into which Water first passes ; B, Pipe with Ball-cock ; C, Rough
Water Tank ; D, E, Pure Water Tanks.
FIG. 23. BUCK S PATENT
PERCOLATOR IN ELEVATION
of many kinds. The
percolator (represented
in section in Fig. 22
and in elevation in Fig.
23)
is a kind of double-
chambered box, sus-
pended on a pivot below
the stack-pipe. It is so
arranged that a slight
fall of rain does not
affect it, the water run-
ning through it from the
448
FILTERS: THEIR CONSTRUCTION AND MAINTENANCE.
roof into the rough water-tank. But if the fall is of
some duration, the apparatus is brought into play. The
first fall of water passes through, as before ; but after
about a quarter of an hour the larger of the two com-
partments into which the box is divided becomes filled
with water, the weight of which causes the whole
apparatus to turn on its pivot, and the outflow then
takes a new direction into a pipe which conveys the
water to the pure-water tank. This water, collected
from a clean roof and a pure atmosphere, requires
merely to be passed through an ordinary charcoal
filter (such as one of those already described), to be
perfectly fit for domestic use.
To render the action of the percolator more clear,
I give a detailed description. The swinging body of
the instrument is divided into two compartments (D
and I, Fig. 22). The first, into which the water falls,
has a small hole E, at the bottom, proportioned in size
to the area of the roof, through which the water passes
into the discharge pipe, and thence into the rough
water tank. When the rain-fall exceeds the discharge
through this hole, the water rises in this compartment
till it reaches a small hole H (at back of G), through
which it flows into the second compartment I. This
compartment fills very slowly, because the water
escapes therefrom almost as fast through a hole L,
at the bottom. When the second compartment has
filled to a certain level, the percolator is overbalanced,
so that the discharge is directed by the pipe K to the
pure-water tank.
Should the rain increase to a storm, which would
scour the roof, and bring down impurities not moved
by a gentle rain, the first compartment D is rapidly
filled up, and the percolator returns to its original
position, the water passing for a time to the rough-
water tank. When the second compartment I has
filled to a corresponding level, the percolator is again
overbalanced, and the water once more directed to the
pure-water tank.
If the rain commences with a storm, the first com-
partment is filled to the top, and the second fills
rapidly, so that the percolator acts sooner in a heavy
downpour than in a moderate rain. When the rain is
leaving off, the second compartment is kept full by
an auxiliary pipe M, so that the percolator remains
canted after the water has ceased to pass from the
first into the second compartment ;
by this means the
last drop of rain is saved. When the compartment I
is empty, the percolator returns to its normal position.
The box A is divided obliquely by a perforated plate,
the object of which is to prevent rubbish passing into the
percolator ; above this is fixed a second non-perforated
plate, to break the fall of the water.
The percolator is manufactured by Messrs. Saxby
and Farmer of Kilburn, London, N.W., and the price
of one of the smallest size (suitable for a roof of not
more than 1,000 feet area) is 2 10s.
A second method of collecting and storing rain-
water is represented in Fig, 24. I am indebted for it
to a little pamphlet* by Mr. Shirley Hibberd, which
pamphlet I would take this opportunity of recom-
mending for perusal by all who take an interest in the
question of the utilisation of rain-water.
A is a tank into which the rainfall is first con-
ducted. It is provided with a screen (of slate or any
suitable material) obliquely placed ; the object of
which is to prevent the stirring up of any sediment
which may collect at the bottom of the tank. Below this
tank, and connected with it by means of the pipe b
furnished with a ball-cock, is the tank C. Connected
with tank A by means of a syphon in the deep tank D,
and connected with this, by another syphon, is the
second deep tank E. The first and dirtiest portion of
the water passes through A into C, where it accumu-
lates, and whence it may be drawn for garden or other
rough purposes. When the tank c is full, the ball-
cock shuts off communication with the tank A, in
which the water consequently rises, and presently
syphons over into D, and ultimately into E. From
this last tank (or from tank D, should E be empty)
the water may be drawn and passed through a filter
for ordinary domestic use. Each tank is provided
with a tap as shown.
The tanks D and E (as indeed all tanks for the
storage of water) should be deep and narrow, rather
than broad and shallow ; for, if the materials of the
tanks are good, impurities can only find entrance to
the water at its surface, which should therefore be as
small as possible. Dust must of course be excluded,
as also light and heat, for if these latter are admitted
the water will soon swarm with life. If a dark cool
place cannot be found for the tanks, they, together
with their covers, should be thickly whitewashed.
Currents of fresh air help to preserve the water
sweet, and means of ventilation should therefore
be provided. It is almost needless to say that from
time to time all water tanks should be thoroughly
cleansed.
As to materials for building the tanks with, slate,
or brick and cement, may be used, or, if preferred,
galvanized iron tanks may be bought ready-made. I
do not enter here into the mechanical details of the
building of the tanks, because I assume that each one
of my readers has a copy of
"
Every Man His Own
Mechanic
"
upon his shelves, and has diligently studied
the directions for bricklaying, cement-mixing, etc.,
therein given.
*
"Water for Nothing. Every House its own Water
Supply." By Shirley Hibberd. London: Effingham Wison,
1879, PP-
26- Price One Shilling.
ELECTRIC BELLS.
449
With respect to the size of tanks no particular
directions can be given. Every one must make the
calculation for himself. By multiplying the effective
roof-area (that is to say, the area the roof would have if
the house were built with a flat roof, after the oriental
style, not the actual superficial area of the ridge
and furrow roof), by the annual average rainfall for
the district, the number of cubic feet of water fall-
ing upon the house in an average year is readily ascer-
tained. If the tanks are constructed to have a total
capacity of about one-third of this amount, they will,
in general, be sufficiently large. Where the rainfall is
so great that only a portion of the water need be
collected, allowance must necessarily be made in
determining the size of the tanks.
If any one has any difficulty- in discovering the
rainfall of his district, I shall be happy, if he will
write to me, care of the Editor, to fumish him with the
required information, through the medium of the
pages for
"
Amateurs in Council."
In my next article I shall treat of two of the best
of the many patent filters, and, if space will permit,
shall conclude this series by a description of the method
of preparing pure water, and with directions for test-
ing water as to its purity.
[To be continued.)
ELECTRIC BELLS.
B<j GEOBGE EDWINSON.
IV.- The Line Wires.
F all the devices invented by ancient
magicians and cunning priests to inspire
feelings of awe and reverence in the
minds of the common people, and foster
superstition to enshroud with its dark
mantle the ignorant minds of their devotees ; of all
the inventions of modern conjurors to pleasantly
mystify their gullible audiences, none will compare
with the effects produced by electricity, and not the
least mysterious part of it lies in the now known fact
that it may be conveyed for hundreds
ay,
thousands
of miles through a small wire. Persons can under-
stand the conveyance of force in the form of moving
air, steam, and water, for if they cut the pipes through
which these are being conveyed, some evidence of
their existence in the pipes becomes apparent to one
or other of the senses of observation
; but if we cut the
wires of an electrical circuit, we cannot perceive any
rush of the enormous force being conveyed through
the wires
;
no fluid exudes, no gas issues from the cut
endsnose, eyes, and ears are alike at a loss to detect
anything. True, if we are foolhardy enough to try the
experiment with the leading wires of those enormous
generators which supply the electric arc lights, we
should then perceive a spark, and probably receive a
dangerous shock ; but I do not speak of those high
tension currents here, except to warn my readers not
to meddle with the wires and connections of the appa-
ratus.
The current from the battery of an electric bell or
from that of a telegraphic battery can be neither felt,
seen, nor heard, but, strange to say, it may be tasted.
Place the two freshly-cut ends of the wires on your
tongue, and cause them to lightly touch each other on
the tongue ; if a current is passing, you will be
sensible of a slight acid taste, which will vary in
strength with the strength of the battery and the ten-
sion of the current : a strong and intense current will
fairly sting the tongue as it passes. Persons working
without the aid of the instrument known as a current
detector (an instrument which I will describe further
on) often resort to the tasting test to detect the current
of a battery.
I have already given some good hints for the
guidance of the amateur in the selection of his line
wires, and have shown that long, thin line wires offer
a resistance to the passage of the electrical current,
and that the inefficient resistance thus offered must be
overcome by additional pushing power of the battery.
This power is known as the electro-motive force of the
battery, and is shown by the abbreviation E.M.F., its
measurement being expressed by the term
"
Volts."
I will now go more fully into the subject, and show
that faults in the construction of the line will add to
the resistance, and may exist to such an extent as to
ruin the battery and stop the bell from working.
First, as to size and quality of wire. If the line is
made up of scraps of naked copper wire, merely
twisted together and secured by tin tacks to the walls
or wainscoting, we introduce a state of things which
invite failure. Each twisted joint adds to the resistance
of the wire, each scrap of wire probably differs from
the rest in conductivity, whilst the naked wires in con-
tact with bare walls and painted wood form innumer-
able short circuits for the passage of the current,
causing' leakage. For indoor work, the line wires
should be of No. 20 or No. 22 copper wire, well insu-
,
lated by a covering of cotton, gutta-percha, or india-
rubber. Excellent wires are now sold by dealers for
, this purpose at lid. and 2d. per yard, or from 16s. to
i 25s. per two hundred yards. These are first tinned,
; then covered with a thin layer of rubber, and then
further protected by a coat of cotton wound over the
rubber ;
this coat can be had of any colour desired, to
match the paint-work or wall-papers of the rooms. It
will be seen from the list of bad conductors on page
45
ELECTRIC BELLS.
324,
that gutta-percha is superior as an insulator to
india-rubber, but gutta-percha is more liable to crack
than rubber when placed in a dry situation ; on the
other hand, gutta-percha is the more suitable for use
out-of-doors and in damp cellars. Cotton by itself is
liable to contract dust and moisture, but it protects
rubber from accidental injury when used as an outer
coating. If we wish to convey the wires underground,
it will be advisable to have a copper wire of No. 16
size, covered with gutta-percha, and then further pro-
ne.
33.
-ENDS OF LINE WIRES BARED
AND SCARFED.
distances, because of the extra expense entailed in
insulation and in additional battery power. But if
any of my readers wish to put up a line of iron wire, I
shall be pleased to advise them in "Amateurs in
Council."
When we wish to connect one building with
another across a garden, road, or street, it is not
necessary to use two wires, although consideration
of battery power will advise the employment of a
double line. The current may be conveyed by one
FIG. 34. SCARFED ENDS OF WIRES BOUND
TOGETHER FOR SOLDERING.
FIG. 35. TWISTED JOINT FOR BRANCH
WIRES.
References to Letters in Fig. 32 :
A, Push-Button.
B, Battery on Shelf in Cellar.
C, Double Underground Line.
D, Bell over Stable Door.
E, E, Earth Plates sunk beneath
floors of Cellar and Stable.
*
#
*
Arrows show direction of
current.
FIG. 32. SKETCH SHOWING METHOD OF CONNECTING ELECTRIC BELL IN STABLE WITH PUSH-BUTTON AND BATTERY IN
HOUSE BY DOUBLE UNDERGROUND LINE, OR SINGLE LINE AND EARTH PLATES.
tected by a coat of tape soaked in tar. If the line
must cross roads, paths, or through cultivated ground,
it must be further protected by laying the wires in gas-
pipes or wood troughs well-tarred. The tarred and
taped insulated wires are sold at 4d. per yard, or about
21 guineas per mile. Iron wires, as used by telegraph
companies, can only be used for outdoor work on
poles, supported on insulators, with special precautions
to prevent accidental contact and leakage. Although
the first cost of iron wire itself is much less than that
of copper wire, being less than id. per yard, it does
not pay to use iron wire for electric bells on short
wire to the distant building, and made to return
through the earth to the battery. This is done by
soldering the wire from one stud of the bell to the gas
or water-pipe at one end of the line, and similarly
attaching the wire from one of the battery terminals
to the gas or water-pipe at the other end of the line
Where there are no gas nor water-pipes available, we
must carry the short lines to earth below the cellar
floor, or in the garden, and there solder them to a
copper plate, buried about two feet in moist earth, or
to an iron rod driven into a bed of cl.iy, three or four
feet deep. The earth around the plate must be kept
ELECTRIC BELLS. 45
1
moist to ensure contact, and the wire must be soldered
to the earth plate. To ensure a perfect understanding
of this method, I have sketched a plan (Fig.
32),
showing the arrangement. The dotted lines show the
connection with earth plate in the absence of gas or
water-pipes. Magnets of bells for this purpose should
be wound with finer wire than those
for indoor work.
But, to return to the house and the
interior arrangement of wires. The
battery may be placed in a box near
the bell, or in the bottom of a cup-
board, or on a shelf, or in a cellarit
matters but verylittle where the battery
is placed, with two exceptions : it
should not be exposed to the weather,
nor to the heat from a fire or stove.
The wires may be led from the
battery to
-I
PUSH
the bell, any-
where, and
in any direc-
tion which
fancy or con-
veni e n ce
may suggest.
The current
will pass
equally well
by a zig-
zag course
around cor-
ners as in a
straight line,
and will tra-
vel quite as
readily under
the floor, or
behind the
wainscoting,
as over the
room near
the ceiling.
Economical
considera-
tions alone
will deter-
mine that the circuit shall be as short as it can
be made. This being understood, I will now state
the restrictions, the limits in which a workman may
labour, and the rules to guide him. The first of
PAR LOUR
PUSH
FIG. 40.
FIG. 36. BLOCK OF WOOD TO
HOLD PUSH ENDS OF WIRES.
FIG. 37.PRESS BUTTON OR
PUSH, EXTERNAL VIEW.
FIG. 38. INTERIOR OF
PRESS BUTTON.,
FIG. 39. SECTIONAL VIEW
OF PRESS BUTTON.
clean metal must touch clean metal in all parts of the
line and apparatus, when we press the contact button to
ring the bell, and only at that time. Well-insulated wires
may be run along side by side, but it is not necessary
to thus place them ; one of the wires may return to the
battery by a totally different route. They should be
secured by tinned wire staples placed
at distances of about four feet apart,
but the staples must not be driven
into the insulating coating, nor driven
in so far as to cut through the coating,
nor may two wires be fixed by one
staple. In passing the wire from one
room to another over-head, the wires
may be carried through the ceiling by
a hole made with a bradawl, or through
the woodwork, or behind the door
posts. A careful workman will so
arrange his
line as to
cause no dis-
figurement of
the decora-
tions
; whilst
he places it
out of danger
of injury by
servants and
children, he
will therefore
lay it and
hide it in any
convenient
cranny, using
paper and
paint to hide
the wires
only when
necessitated
to do so. He
must bear in
mind that all
joints of wire
must be sol-
dered, and
this can be
done as fol-
40 AND 41. ARRANGEMENT OF PUSHES AND BELLS FOR FOUR ROOMS OF A HOUSE.
lows
:
Strip off the cotton and rubber covering from
the ends of the wires, slightly flatten the two ends, and
file them as shown in Fig.
33,
bind them together with
a bit of fine wire, as in Fig.
34,
flux the joint with
a little powdered resin, and either apply a drop of
solder from the point of a soldering iron, or put a frag-
ment of solder on the joint, and direct the flame from a
blow-pipe on the wire until the solder melts. Then
these is the law of the circuit, that is, there must be a
perfect circuit of conductors from the negative plate
of the battery, through the bell, and back to the
positive plate of the battery. To ensure this, perfectly
452
ELECTRIC BELLS.
wrap a few bits of gutta-percha tissue around the joint
whilst it is still warm, and bind it around with cotton, to
form a neat joint. If the joint is not warm enough to
melt the tissue, heat must be applied from a spirit lamp,
and the warm plastic gutta-percha neatly moulded
with wet fingers. If the joint is in an underground line,
it must be soldered and covered with extra care, for
failure may result from a little corrosion between the
metallic surfaces, or a pin-hole left in the insulating
material. The same caution is necessary in laying
wires against damp walls, for the damp will act as a
conductor of electricity, and ruin the battery by per-
petual leakage. In planning a system of electric bell
wires for a new house, it will be advisable to have the
main lines laid in zinc tubes, and these placed in
position before the plastering is done, blocks of wocd
should be bedded in the walls at those spots where
pushes are likely to be placed, or where the bells are
likely to be hung ; the zinc tubes should terminate in
those blocks, in cavities scooped out of the block as
shown in Fig. 36. In Fig.
35
is shown the twisted
joints used for the connection of branch wires.
Well insulated and perfectly jointed wires may be
run two in one tube, or the two tubes may meet in
one block ; when two wires are thus run side by side,
it is convenient to have them covered in two different
colours for the purpose of identification. When wires
are thus run through tubes, they should be looped in
the blocks to allow of a little slack for convenience of
jointing ; or when the wires terminate in the block, a
few inches of the ends should be left coiled up in the
cavity : this must then be stopped with a close fitting
plug of wood, and a large-headed nail driven in the
centre, to mark the spot after the walls have been
plastered. When this has been done and it is not
advisable to put up the bell-fittings until all such dirty
work has been donewe have only to take out the
wood plugs, fit the pushes over the cavities, and make
the connections securely. One word of caution : do
not lay your zinc tubes nor bell wires side by side with
plumber's or gasfitter's work, nor cross these or hot-
water pipes, except where necessary, and then through
a wood casing. In replacing the old system by the
new in houres where the wires have been run through
pipes, we have merely to draw out the old wires, and
run the new insulated wires through the same tubes.
This can be done by tying the new wires to the ends
of the old ones, and draw those in, whilst these are
being drawn out ; or, when the tubes are empty,
running some stout straightened wire through the
tubes to act as a needle, and draw the insulated wires
into them, taking care not to damage the insulating
material whilst drawing the wires through the tubes
and holes. All the old cranks and levers should be
removed and the holes neatly repaired.
In connecting wires to the water or gas systems, it
must be distinctly understood that two such pipes
cannot be used instead of the two wires of one circuit,
although such pipes are placed in two distant parts of
the same building ; but two such pipes may be used
as the return wires of two separate circuits, unless the
wires themselves cross the pipes. Wires must be
soldered to pipes ; this can be done with little diffi-
culty to brass, compo, or lead pipes, but the task is
not so easy when they have to be soldered to iron
pipes, unless the workman is possessed of the follow-
ing little wrinkle : File and scrape the iron pipe
bright and smooth, get a crystal of blue vitriol, blue-
stone, or sulphate of copper, dip it in water, rub it well
on the spot where the wire is to be soldered, rub the
wet spot with the steel scraper, and it will be instantly
covered with a film of copper ; wrap the clean copper
wire around this spot, then apply the solder and a
pinch of powdered resin as a flux, and the soldering
to iron can be easily done. To connect a wire to a
gas bracket, the gas must be first turned off at the
meter, the bracket removed, and branch wire soldered
to the back of the flange, which must then be re-
placed, and the branch wire carried to the main line,
to which it must be also soldered, and then covered
with gutta-percha.
I have known timid and nervous old ladies and
gentlemen object to have electric wires connected to
the gas-pipes, because they imagine that the electricity
might cause an explosion of gas in the pipes. Al-
though their fears concerning this are groundless,
when weak currents only are passed through the wires,
I feel bound to respect their wishes, for I prefer having
electric lines independent of gas-pipes.
In laying the line wires leading from the bell and
the battery, we keep them entirely apart, and they are
destined to be thus kept apart until made to com-
municate by the person who wishes to ring the bell.
The part of the system which is made to hold the lines
apart, so to speak, is called a push, a touch, a com-
municator, a pressel, a press-button, a key, or a switch.
The two last alone indicate a special instrument, all
the others being synonymous. The most simple form
of press-button or push is that shown in Fig.
37.
Fig. 38 shows the plan of interior arrangement, and
this, together with the sectional sketch of the same,
Fig.
39,
will enable my readers to understand how to
connect the wires to this part of the apparatus. In
my next. I propose giving full instructions and illus-
trations showing how to make those press-buttons, so
will merely say here that they consist of a kind of box
made out of some hard wood, and fitted with a cover
made to screw into the top of the box. In this cover
is drilled a hole, in which a stud of bone or ivory is
made to fit loosely. When the lid is screwed down
THE "LILY" OVERMANTEL MIRROR. 4'3
in its place, this stud is kept up in its proper position
by a spiral spring in the box, and this spring is kept
in position by a spring of hard brass fastened to the
interior of the box. Beneath this spring, and fastened
to the opposite side of the box, is another strip of
brass. To this strip of brass we fasten one of the
branch wires, whilst the other wire is fastened to the
brass spring before mentioned. Referring to the plan,
Fig. 32,
having secured one end of the branch to the
main line, we take the other end to the push, bare and
clean half an inch of the end, pass it through the hole B
from the back, loosen the screws which hold down the
brass plate, press the clean end of wire under the
plate, and screw down tight. Now bring the other
end of the branch to the push, strip and clean the
wire, pass it through hole A, loosen the screws which
hold the brass spring, place the clean end of wire
under it, and screw down tight. Then fasten the push
in its place by screws passed through the two remain-
ing holes, put in the spiral spring, then put the stud in
its place, and screw on the cover or lid. If we now
press the stud, it will in turn press down the brass
spring upon the plate beneath, and thus place the two
lines of the circuit in contact to ring the bell
; but
when we remove our fingers from the stud, the spring
rises and breaks contact, stopping the ringing of the
bell. If we keep the stud pressed down, the bell will
continue to ring, but it ceases the moment we release
the stud ; we can, therefore, signal long strokes by
long-ccntinued pressure, or short strokes by jerky
touches with the stud. Common pushes for this pur-
pose can be bought for is., is. 6d., and 2s., or more
elaborate pushes up to 10s. 6d. each.
Figs. 40 and 41 represent the arrangement of pushes
and bells for four rooms of ahouse. In Fig. 40 we have
an electric bell and battery in the kitchen, and three
pushes in three different rooms of the house. By this
arrangement we are able to signal messages to the
kitchen by pressing any one of the pushes, but the
servant will not be able to reply except in person, and
cannot distinguish the room from whence the bell was
rung unless some preconcerted signal for each room
has been agreed upon, or an indicator attached to the
bell. I shall have something to say about indicators
further on.
In Fig. 41 a useful arrangement is shown for
signalling to the kitchen and receiving a reply
therefrom. For this purpose we require a third line
wire, or a branch soldered to the gas-pipe from each
bell, and a bell in each room. Provision must also be
made for throwing the bells out of circuit when they
are not required, and this can be done by a switch. If
this is not done, the three bells will answer to the
signals from the kitchen, if they are properly adjusted
and the battery is strong enough, or the nearest bell
will ring, whilst all the others are useless. When all
are required to ring at once, the magnet of the nearest
must be wound with finer and longer wire than the last
in the circuit.
{To be continued?)
THE
"
LILY
"
OVERMANTEL MIRROR.
HOW TO MAKE AND DECORATE IT.
By J. W. GLEESON-WHITE.
(For Illustrations, see the Supplement to this Part?)
N a recent part of Amateur Work,
Illustrated, appeared a design for a
Five o'Clock Tea Table, being the first
of a series of designs for larger articles
to be cut in fret-work, the result of an
attempt to utilise the art for larger and more enduring
pieces of furniture than the published patterns have
yet supplied The drawings for making the mirror,
given as the Supplement to this Part, form the second
set of the series, and while the work exhibits even less
of joinery, and more of fret-cutting, pure and simple,
the actual labour to cut it will be but little, if any, in
excess of the first design, as the flat shape of the pre-
sent piece shows off every part at once, while the very
simple woodwork necessary to support the cut-out
portions and give strength to the whole, is so easily
made, that it need not deter the least skilful of
amateurs from attempting and succeeding with it.
Before describing the working out of the design in
the exact manner shown in the various drawings, it
might be as well to explain that, although the design
was specially made to be fret-cut for its ornamental
portions, yet, on the other hand, it might be con-
structed with entire absence of saw work, and still
prove as effective a piece of furniture, while possibly
more in accordance with the taste of some, and the
talent for art work of others.
If fret-cutting is undesirable, the design as given
may be painted on the panels and brackets. A
simple way to secure a good effect would be to
trace (with carbonic paper below the drawings) the
necessary parts on to wood of a light colour, or wood
already painted a stone or light colour, and rubbed
down with sand-paper, so as to get a good flat surface.
The outline might then be filled up with oil colours,
similar to the filling in'ofan outline for illuminating,
while the background would be best painted yellow,
and then gilded with Bessemer gold paint, or gold
leaf. If this method seems somewhat too ornate, and
not a sufficiently neat decoration for so prominent an
article, another plan, and one I should personally
prefer, would be to trace the outline on to plain ligh
454
THE "Z/ZY" OVERMANTEZ MZRROR.
coloured wood, oak or light walnut, and fill in with
oak stain all the parts that in fret-work would be cut
away, the whole giving the appearance of inlaid wood-
work. This, when varnished, would have a fairly good
effect. If either of these methods be adopted, the
bracket, G, should be used instead of the cut-out one,
and decorated in keeping with the panels ; the rail-
ings in fret-work being replaced by the well-known
little balustrade of turned wood, so familiar in nearly
all the so-called "Early English" and "Queen
Anne
"
furniture of the shops. A combination of the
above modes, but not imitative of inlay, would be
effected by using satin wood of a rich colour, and
gilding the background, and then to let the design
stand out in the natural wood.
The Papyrotile, that most useful and cheap deco-
rative panel, or plaques of terra cotta, or painted
china, or low relief carving, might take the place of
the panels of fret-work, but as these are all in fixed
sizes, the design would have to be altered to suit
each one, as from the unyielding nature of all these,
the framework must fit the panels, and not the more
usual order of construction.
Having suggested the alternative treatment in
several ways, we will follow out the working of the
printed designs. First trace the fret patterns, if for
hand work, sufficient for the whole number of pieces
wanted ; but if for machine cutting, the four panels
of thin wood might be screwed together and cut at
one operation, so that it would be needless to make
more than two tracings of each of the panels, E and F.
The railing is only shown of sufficient length for the
ends of the shelves, and must be repeated to the
length required for the top rails. It saves much need-
less labour in tracing fret patterns if carbonic paper,
black on both sides, is placed between layers of thin
paper : first a layer of white thin paper, then a sheet
of carbonic, then two layers of white paper and
another sheet of carbonic paper, with a layer of white
paper, and the'printed design last. If these are fixed
and laid on a hard firm surface, such as a sheet of
glass or tin, and traced with a fine style, or very hard
pencil, four clear copies can be traced at one working.
The structural framework of the glass should be
made of wood, i in. wide and I to ii in. thick,
and mortised together in the ordinary way, the lower
rail being 2i to 3
in. deep. When this is fitted as
shown, a piece of wood, K, K, should be cut, about
4
inches wide, and screwed underneath the whole. The
buttress pieces, L, L, give solidity to the uprights, by
being fixed to this piece K, K ; and to the standards :
these buttresses would be best cut in solid wood, 1 i
in. wide, or else formed with two thicknesses fixed
about half inch apart.
The whole of the framework must be rabbeted to
admit the panels, as an ordinary picture frame ;
the
panels themselves being backed with their work and
fixed like a picture.
The fret-work patterns should be pasted on panels
previously fitted into the frame before cutting, and
great care taken that the patterns are pasted on exactly
parallel with the lines of the framework.
At the top of the framework a groove should be
left, either worked in the frame or formed by nailing
on two heads of wood, to admit of the fret railing being
securely fixed. If grooves were cut in the uprights
to let the pieces slide down to their places, no fixing,
save glue, would be necessary.
The bracket pieces should be fitted or mortised
in their places before cutting ; in fact, for every part
it is best tto do all the fitting first, the decoration then
gets less handled, and is not nearly so liable to injury
as it would be if it had to be fitted to its place after it
was ornamented.
J
For the shelves, take wood of to \ in. thick, with
either moulded or bevelled edges : these should be
simply square, or slightly rounded, at the outside
angles. If gilding is used on the mirror anywhere, a
hollow along the edges of the shelves should be worked
and gilded. This reduces the heavy look of the
shelves, and yet keeps the horizontal lines marked
sufficiently distinct.
The fret-work would be best lined at the back with
coloured silk, gilded wood, or some distinct colour to
throw up the pattern.
With regard to the glass, it would look best with
bevelled edges, but that would be very much more
costly, as it entails a thicker glass, as well as the
expense of bevelling. It would be better for showing
off Venetian glass, or china, in some lights, if the
side panels were filled with stamped plush, in place of
glass ; in that case the middle panel might be fitted
with a glass some 5
inches smaller each way than the
full opening, the margin being filled with the plush, as
in the sides. The glass, if used in this way, must, of
course, have bevelled edges, and might have rounded
or clipped corners.
When complete, the whole mirror would look better
if a wooden simple mantelpiece replaced the ordinary
one; but if that is not practicable, a mantel-board, with
cloth of the colour used for backing the fret-work, will
sufficiently break the sudden change from stone to
wood ; and, if filled with a few pieces of cheap quasi-
Venetian glass, or good Japanese china, bits of Gris
de Flandre potter}', or the well-known Doulton, Lin-
thorpe, Vallery, and other self-coloured wares, the
whole would have a good effect, while the cost of the
whole work, and the bits of bright china to put on it,
would be about one-fourth of the cost of a gilt-framed
looking-glass of similar size.
STRONG AND SIMPLE HOME-MADE FURNITURE.
455
STRONG AND SIMPLE HOME-MADE
FURNITURE.
B
3
iHEK MALLETT.
|jHE group of designs for home-made fur-
niture which I am about to offer are, I
am free to confess, in
most respects far in-
ferior to many which
have already appeared in these
pages. I have, however, reasons
for thinking that they will prove
of use and value.
Most of the designs already
/
1
<-'.
J>
l,
a gimlet, and a bradawl or two, a chisel, and a
screw-driver, are all that are indispensable
;
nor is a
carpenter's bench essential. I need hardly say, how-
ever, that a bench, and a few additional tools, more
especially a smoothing-plane, a frame-saw, and a
f-inch gouge would be found useful.
The materials required will be little beyond deal
boards, which may be got at the
timber yard ready planed for a
trifling additional cost. If the
workman has neither bench nor
bench planes, it will be necessary
for him to have them so prepared.
From these, fastened together
with screws only, and without
FIG. I.OCCASIONAL TABLE.
FIG. 14. PLAN
-
SHOWING CONSTRUC-
TION OF LOWER DOOR OF
BOOKSHELF.
given demand very considerable
skill on the part of the amateur,
and the aid of elaborate tools and
appliances. This will not be the
case with mine. Many of those
who look for guidance to Ama-
teur Work, Illustrated, will
be glad of something that is
simple, and that can be carried out with simple means.
I venture to saythat the system of construction which I
have to lay before them, will be found the soul of
simplicity. I can also assure them that the articles so
constructed will be strong
; nor is there any reason
why things thus made should not, in the hands of an
amateur carpenter of good taste, become artistic.
1
A few only of the most common tools will be
necessary for making these things : a saw, a hammer,
s "s
v..
1
1
1 1
i 1
1 1
1 !
1 ;
l !
1 l
1 !
1 1
1 !
I
1 !
1
1
1 1
1
1 V v' 1
! ! M
FIG. 17.
PLAN OF UPPER DOOR
OF BOOKSHELF.
TOP OF TABLE SEEN FROM BELOW.
nails, glue, or anything which
can properly be called a mortise
and tenon joint, useful and even
decorative furniture may be put
together. My methods of con-
struction I shall best explain in
connection with my examples.
Fig.
-
1 is a small occasional
table, of convenient height and size to stand beside
an easy -chair, and to hold a lady's work-box, a book,
a coffee-cup, or any light matter. It is 2 feet high,
and the greatest width of its hexagonal top from angle
to angle is 18 inches.
For its construction, we shall require three strips
of f-inch board, 2 feet long and
3
inches broad, to
form the legs. The curvature shown in the cut, which
makes them more pleasin to the eye, may be given
456 STRONG AND SIMPLE HOME-MADE FURNITURE.
in a few minutes with a chisel, or even better with a
good sharp pocket knife, and the edges can then be
smoothed, and rubbed down with glass-paper. A good
supply of glass-paper of medium coarseness, will, I may
observe, be found invaluable in this kind of carpentry.
The hexagonal top will require to be cut from a
J-inch board, 15 inches widethat being its width
from side to sidefor we have not the appliances
which will enable us to join two or more narrower
pieces with sufficient neatness. The edges must be
trimmed and neatly rounded off with sand-paper. In
Fig. 2 we have this top, as seen from below, and this
diagram also explains generally the manner in which
the table is fixed together. It shows the method in
which the cross-pieces (also of -inch stuff) are
bevelled at the ends and screwed to the legs. It also
shows the under portion of the top, marked A
a
square piece of jj-inch board. This board strengthens
the real top, and prevents it from warping ; and serves
as a means by which to fasten top and frame-work
together. Six screws are driven through it from above,
as at B B, into the cross-pieces. These must be flat-
headed screws, and holes must be counter-sunk, so as
to let them in flush with the upper surface of the
board The board A, being thus secured to the frame
of the table, it has itself to be fixed to the hexagonal
top, which is done by driving six screws from below,
as shown in the diagram. These must be flat-headed,
1 -inch screws, which will go far enough into the top to
hold it safely, without penetrating to its upper surface,
which would be unsightly.
The screws which fasten the cross-pieces to the
legs, some of which are indicated at C C, Fig. 2, are
round-headed screws, like that shown in Fig. 3.
These screws are to be bought laquered black, and are
in this style of furniture, to be used whenever they
appear in sight. The projecting studs formed by their
heads, far from being unsightly, will be seen to form a
distinctly decorative feature in the work.
With little alteration, the plan of Fig. I might be
adapted to a round table of larger dimensions, or a
stool might be made after the same design. In this
latter case, instead of the two thicknesses of board
forming the top, one round piece of inch stuff should
be substituted. Through this the screws may be
driven into the frame-work without any regard to
appearances, as they will afterwards be completely
hidden. Stuffing can then be added, and a covering
put on, and secured round the edge with ornamental
brass studs.
In Fig.
4 we have a second table, but of larger
dimensions. This is supposed to measure 4 feet 6
inches long, 2 feet 6 inches broad, and 2 feet 4
inches
high. The legs and the whole of the frame-work are
of inch board,
4 inches wide ; thus a board a foot wide
cut into three strips by the steam saw at the timber
yard, will serve for every part of it. The leg pieces
are each 3 feet long. Where t'.iey cross, half the
thickness of each is cut away, but the cross piece
above which supports the end of the table, is merely
screwed upon the legs, as shown in Fig. 5. The piece
A, in this diagram, which runs from end to end, is let
through the intersection of the legs by a mortise, and
secured by a peg, as shown at B. A second lengthwise
bar, c, is let through and screwed to the cross-bars,
as shown at D.
The top of this table is framed of A-inch match-
boardingthat is to say, boarding which is to be
bought ready prepared for matching together, a groove
being struck on one of its edges, and a tongue on the
other. This will have to be screwed down to the cross-
pieces at the ends, and also to the ledger E, which, to
give additional strength, is introduced at the centre,
and let through the longitudinal bar. Of course, the
screws used for fixing on the top of the table must be
flat-headed, and the holes counter-sunk, so as to let
them in flush with the surface.
The top being fixed on, a piece of American
leather-cloth of suitable size should be stretched
tightly over it, and tacked neatly down on the under
side. For such a table this material makes the best,
firmest, cleanest, and most enduring covering ; it is
cheap, and may be had in many colours: but if oil-cloth
is objected to, baize, or some other material, can be
employed.
To secure the covering, and give a finish to the
work, strips of ^-inch wood, an inch wide, should
lastly be screwed along the edges, as shown in section
at F. We suppose the corners of the top to have been
sawn off, as shown in Fig.
4,
so that four long and
four short strips will be required. The long strips
should be screwed on first, and the short ones being
then fixed across the corners, each with two screws, the
longer pieces will be firmly held in place. Whenever
the covering becomes worn or torn, the strips can
easily be unscrewed and new cloth substituted for the
old. It is advisable to keep these strips of wood
slightlysay the twentieth part of an inchabove the
level of the table top, and they will then prevent small
round articles, such as pencils, from rolling off.
The effect of such a table as the above, when
neatly made, is decidedly ornamental, which is perhaps
more than can be said for the Spanish washstand,
Fig. 6. This latter article has, however, simplicity,
quaintness, and strength to recommend it. It stands
firmly
; it occupies the minimum of space, and may
be made in the length of a single winter evening, at an
infinitesimally small cost in material.
Strips of 1 inch, or \
inch stuff, 2 feet 6 inches by
4 inches, form the legs (I have shown the thickness as
STRONG AND SIMPLE HOME-MADE FURNITURE.
457
an inch, this would give extra strength, but
J
would
generally suffice for the purposes to which such an
article could be applied). The three cross-piece
s
round the top would each take a strip of
\
board 1
2
inches by 3. These cross-pieces are screwed on in
the same manner as those in the table, Fig. 1. In
Figs. 7 and 8 I give the legs enlarged in front view
and profile. To do away with the air of absolute
baldness, a little notched decoration has been given
to them ; and something of this same very simple
ornament has been shown on the lower edge of the
shelfintended to hold the soap-dish or tooth glass. This
portion of the washstand, with its lower side upwards,
is shown on a larger scale in Fig. 9. In this last
diagram- the manner in which the shelf is fitted to the
legs and screwed in place is clearly shown. For this
part a foot square of j-inch board will be needed.
On the principle of the Spanish washstand it will
probably occur to the amateur of taste that a far more^
decorative article might be modelled. I have mysel
made several of these things of more or less elaborate
design. In one I gave the heads of three heraldic
monsters as supports for the basin, their bodies formed
the central portion of the stand, and their claws its
feet. But as this involved an amount of fret-cutting
and carving, an illustration of it would scarcely be to
our present purpose.
Scarcely more complicated than the washstand is
the chair, Fig 10, but its construction will involve the
cost of more labour and more material. The four
chief pieces of which it is framed, in consequence of
their eccentric shapes, must be cut from board
9
inches
wide. The piece forming front legs and back is
3
feet
long, that forming hind legs and seat, 2 feet long; they
should be made of J-inch stuff. The construction of
this chair is clearly shown in the illustration, except
perhaps as regards the cross-piece at back of the seat
of which only the end, let by a mortise through the
intersection of the side-pieces, and there secured by a
peg, is visible. This piece, as it has to bear most of
the weight, and to bind the whole chair together, is of
inch board 3
inches wide, and it is placed diagonally,
as shown in section in Fig. 1 1. This position brings its
upper edge level with the cross-bar at front of the seat,
and a piece of carpet to form the seat is stretched over
the two and tacked beneath. As great strength is
required at the intersection, four stout screws are used
there in addition to the mortise. The cross spars at
back of the chair may be of J-inch stuff. The seat of
this chair, which is 14 inches from the ground, is 16
inches square. The effect may be improved by
nailing woollen fringe, with brass studs, round its sides
and front. Chairs on this model, being strong, com-
fortable, and costing little, may well be made by the
amateur for garden purposes.
Our next undertaking will be a more ambitious one.
Fig. 12 is a bookcase, of which the lids of the upper
portion are glazed. The lower part is not made with
glass, and if not wanted for books, may be used for
the ordinary purposes of a cupboard. Total height
6 feet 6 inches, width of upper part 3
feet, lower
part 3 feet 3 inches
;
projection of upper part,
9
inches, of lower part 12 inches. The two parts are, for
convenience of moving, made separately.
Three-quarter inch board is employed for this
article, in the sides, shelves, tops, and bottoms, strips
round base, and in the ornamental crest-boards which
surmount it. The back and doors are half inch.
In the section, Fig. 13, the main features and most
of the details of construction are indicated. The
boards, which form the top and bottom of the upper
portion are, it will be seen, dovetailed into the sides.
The side-pieces are 8 inches wide, the top and bottom
7\
only, as though all four come flush in front, the two
latter must be kept in i an inch behind, to leave space
for screwing in the -inch boards, which will form
the back. The shelves are to be supported, as shown,
on ledges screwed within, by small screws. The
crest-boards, A A, round top are simply screwed on
outside, after the rest of the work has been put
together.
In the lower portion, instead of the top being
dovetailed into the sides, two cross bars, B B, are let
in, as the top, which projects at front and ends, will
have to be screwed on afterwards. These bars serve
respectively for the doors to close against, and for the
boards of the back to be screwed to. The strips round
the bottom C, are screwed on after the frame is made,
in the same manner as the crest-board.
Match-boarding should be used for the backs of
both compartments, as its groove and tongue joints
will effectually exclude dust.
Little difficulty will be found in understanding or
in putting together the main parts of this piece of
furniture ; it is by the panelled lids that the little-
skilled amateur is most likely to be puzzled and
alarmed.
To make a panelled door by the ordinary method
of mortise and tenon joints requires special tools
and considerable skill. We credit our amateur with
neither of these, and must show him how to do with-
out them. Our method of getting over the difficulty
is by using two thicknesses of board, and clamping
them together with screws. How this is done is
shown in the diagrams, Figs. 14 to 19. In Fig. 14 we
have a plan of the lower door. The inner thickness,
made of three lengths of match-boarding, is shown by
ruled lines ; whilst dotted lines indicate the outer
or front thickness. The cross-pieces of the latter,
when secured with screws, will be seen completely
458
STRONG AND SIMPLE HOME-MADE FURNITURE.
....,
FIG. 8.PROFILE FIG.
J.
OF LEG OF FRONT VIEW
WASHSTAND. OF LEG OF
WASHSTAND.
FIG. 6. SPANISH WASHSTAND.
FIG. 3.- ROUND- FIG. II. END OF CROSS-PIECE
HEADED SCREW. AT BACK OF SEAT, SECURED
BY PEG.
f^tJ-P
FIG.
S-
ELEVATION OF LARGER
OCCASIONAL TABLE.
FIG. IO.HOME-MADE CHAIR.
STRONG AND SIMPLE HOME-MADE PURNlTURE'.
459
-^- -
-^
': ^- .-. - ; r
- -t ; ;- r -
BZ
s* A
h
bI
' ;--
S
-
!
: ; ^
1
|C
FIG. 13.SECTION OF
BOOKCASE.
FIG. 15. TRANSVERSE SECTION OF LOWER DOOR THROUGH CENTRE.
S
IZZZZ^
FIG. 18.TRANSVERSE SECTION OF UPPER GLAZED DOOR
THROUGH CENTRE.
1 RACKS
^E
FOR SHELVES.
p
3\
FIG. 16.-
VER TICAL
c
SECTION
OF LOWER
DOOR
THROUGH
CENTRE.
FIG. 19.
VERTICAL SEC-
TION OF UPPER
DOOR.
FIG. 12.HOME-MADE BOOKCASE.
FIG. 21.END OF
SHELF CUT TO
FIT INTO RACK.
U
460 STRONG AND SIMPLE HOME-MADE FURNITURE.
to bind and hold the former together, and the grain of
the wood running in the opposite direction to that of
the inner layer, warping will be prevented. The side
strips of the outer layer in this door, serve no con-
structive purpose, and are for appearance only. The
door represented is that to the left hand, and the inner
layer is therefore made to project half an inch beyond
the outer, at the meeting line of the two doors, that
the right hand door may fold against it, with a cor-
responding rebate formed in the same simple manner-
In the example before us, it is supposed that a
piece of French wall-paper, in imitation of embossed
leather, with a raised gold pattern on a dark ground
has been stretched over the inner layer of wood, before
the outer one was fixed in its place. A highly deco-
rative panel has thus been formed.
And here I may observe that other materials may
be used for this purpose with good effect, as pieces of
embroidery, brocaded silks, or even pieces of our now
really artistic cretonnes
; or a satisfactory use may
be found for those large coloured prints, occasionally
issued with the illustrated newspapers. These have
often too much merit to be destroyed, yet are not of
sufficient value to be framed as pictures. Applied,
however, as panels in lids or screens of our simple
home-made furniture, and varnished over, they look
exceedingly well
; especially if a little brown pigment
be added to the varnish, to tone down their too
frequent garishness of colour.
The construction of this door is further explained
by the transverse (Fig.
15),
and the longitudinal
(Fig. 16) sections through its centre, which are given
at double scale.
As the upper door, shown in plan at Fig. 17, is to
be glazed, a somewhat different arrangement of wood
work will be necessary. Comparatively speaking, this
will be a mere skeleton, yet by disposing our strips of
wood as shown in the cut, we shall gain sufficient
strength. In this it will be seen that the strips of the
outer layer overlap those of the inner, towards the
centre, byi of an inch. This is to provide a rebate in
which to place the glass, which can be secured in its
place by eight or ten small brads, and puttied in.
: Sections through the centre of this door are given in
J
Figs. 18 and 19.
In fitting this book-case I have introduced fixed
shelves, as being simplest, and as giving greatest
strength. But should the workman think, as many
do, that shelves which admit of being raised or
1 nvered are essential, the arrangement shown in Fig.
20 will be that best adapted for his purpose, of any
with which I am acquainted. The racks are cut from
\ inch stuff, and fixed at each end of the case.
The slip A, by which the shelf is carried, can be moved
from notch to notch at pleasure. The end of the
shelf must of course be cut to the form shown in
Fig. zi. It should be borne in mind that such thin
deal, when thus cut into notches, is not safe against
splitting off, and that therefore slips of oak, or some
other tough wood, are better for the purpose.
The examples given will show that this simple
style of furniture-making may be applied to a great
variety of articles. Other uses than those which I
have adduced will suggest themselves to the mind of
the ingenious reader. I have myself used it for many
other things. For instance, that now fashionable
article of comfort and decorationa folding screen
474
GYMNASTIC APPARATUS, AND HOW TO MAKE IT.
I was engaged as
judge for certain
athletic and gymnas-
tic sports which were
to be held in a park
just outside one of
the large midland
towns. Permission
had been obtained
from the owner, and
it had been arranged
that the sports should
take place on a mag-
nificent lawn in front
of the mansion. On
arriving at the town
on the morning of
the day in question,
I found the secretary
and stewards in great
trouble, as they had
just received a mes-
sage from the great
man's head-gardener
to the effect that it
was forbidden to dig
any holes into the
lawn, so that it would
be impossible to let
into the ground the
heavy supports for
the trapeze,
etc.,
which
performances
formed one of the
principal features in
the programme.
Here was the di-
lemma in which the
managers of the fete
were suddenly
placed, and from
which it became my
duty if possible to
extricate them.
There being very
little time for con-
sideration, I at once
despatched a mes-
senger to a builder's
yard for three small
scaffold poles, two of
them 20 feet long,
and the other
7 feet.
The latter I had
lashed on to the top
FIG. 6. PORTABLE SWING-STAND WITH WOODEN UPRIGHTS.
FIG. 7.PORTABLE SWING-STAND WITH IRON UPRIGHTS.
of the other two, and
stayed off with four
ropes to be made
fast to stakes driven
into the ground in
the manner shown
in the illustration
(Fig. 6) : this answer-
ing the purpose satis-
factorily, the sports
came off without any
injury to the lawn,
and to the gratifica-
tion alike of per-
formers and spec-
tators. I have since
adopted a similar
arrangement for a
children's fete, in
which the support
for the swing, etc.,
was composed of
two clothes poles, a
broomstick, and a
clothes line.
Having demon-
strated its usefulness,
let us proceed to the
construction of this
apparatus upon a
sound and proper
basis. In making a
portable stand, I
would recommend
you to construct it
of two Norway spars
(Fig. 6, a, A), say 20
feet long, which will
make a very high
swing. I may here
add that in this ap-
paratus, unlike the
preceding, where the
strain is upon the
underground portion,
the entire strain is
upon the top, where
all the strength of
the apparatus is con-
centrated by the use
of the four guys or
stays, the bottoms of
the poles standing
on the ground with-
out being let in. Nor-
WA YS AND MEANS,
475
way spars may be had of builders, as they are
used for scaffold poles, etc. They are also used
by ladder-makers, cut in two to form the sides of
ladders, the price being about 3s. each. The top
should be about
3 inches, and the bottom 4-5 inches
diameter. They are generally sold with the bark on,
which is easily removed with a chisel or draw knife.
The top, that is to say the part to which the swing is
attached, consists of a 2-inch gas barrel (b), all tubes
or barrels being measured by the calibre, or inside
diameter, so that your barrel will be 25- inch diameter
outside, the metal being about
J
inch thick. You will
next require two 2-inch elbows, of which there are two
sorts, one being made to a sharp angle and the other
being round. The latter is the better for
this purpose, as it has a neater appear-
ance ; 2-inch barrels cost 8id. per foot
run, 2-inch elbows are is. 4d. each. The
gas barrels and elbows are sold the
length required ready screwed, so all
you have to do is to screw on the elbow,
cut the top of the spar, and screw it
into the same, in fact, there is scarcely
any actual manufacturing to be done,
the work consisting mainly in purchasing
the parts and putting them together.
There will be a little smith's work, viz.,
two hooks (c, C) off inch round iron,-
forged and riveted through the barrel
in the centre, 20 inches apart, and also
2 staples of
inch round iron (b, b)
drilled and riveted through the elbows
to secure the guys, which consist of four
lengths of wire rope (E, E, E, e) 30 feet
long. The ordinary galvanised 7 wires
twisted, the same as that used for fencing
or staying, will answer the purpose. It
can be obtained from Newall & Co.,
Strand, and costs 22s. 6d. per 100 yards.
The stakes (d) to which the guys are attached should
be made of any kind of fir,
3
in. by 3
in., and
3
feet in
length, with an iron ferule at one end and pointed at
the other, as in Fig. 8. The ferule prevents the
wood from splitting while it is being driven into the
ground. There should be a screw eye (a)
5
inches
long, made of \
inch iron. These are often called
stage screws, being much used in theatres for attach-
ing the stays which support the scenery. After you
have driven the stakes into the ground flush (i.e., as
far as they can be driven), bore a hole with the f-inch
gimlet, and screw the screws into the stake, as shown
in the illustration.
Before finally quitting this subject, I must add one
more illustration (Fig.
7),
by means of which I can
explain how, should you require an apparatus such as
7
FIG. 8.-STAKE
TO HOLD
GL'Y.
that above described for the purpose of conveyance
to one place after another, such an arrangement may
be made without difficulty. The method I have my-
self adopted under such circumstances is as follows :
Instead of the uprights, or supports, being made of
spars, use iron tubing (Fig.
7,
A, A) similar to that of
which the top is formed. These uprights may consist
of three tubes, 6 feet in length each, screwed together
by the aid of the sockets which are supplied with the
tube when purchased. By using such uprights, and
by the introduction of T-piece (b, b), you can fix a
horizontal bar, and the whole apparatus is of course
less cumbrous than that made by spars. TheT-pieces
can always be added to by removing the sockets and
substituting the T-piece. Other apparatus can be
added to the above construction, as in the case of the
lawn gymnasium. With which brief instructions you
will be able to construct your poitable gymnasium
without difficulty.
WAYS AND MEANS.
[The Receipts brought together under this title are gathered
from various sources. They are given here because they are each
and all apparently possessed of value, and likely to be useful to the
Amateur. It is manifestly impossible for the Editor to test them,
or to have them tested, and he therefore disclaims all responsibility
for their accuracy or otherwise. Amateurs who may try them are
requested to communicate the results arrived at.]
Solid Emery Paper.Emery paper is frequently
found lacking in retaining an equal efficiency, the
fresh parts biting too much, and the paper getting
soon worn through in many places. Emery has been
tried on linen, but with little success. A paper or
board has been recommended in which emery enters
as a constituent part. It is advised to employ fine
and uniform cardboard pulp, with from one-third to
half its weight of emery powder thoroughly mixed
with it, so that the emery may be equally distributed.
The mass should be poured out into cakes of from 1
to 10 inches in thickness. They must not be pressed
hard. Such a paper, it is said, will adapt itself to the
form of the articles, and will serve until completely
worn out.
Protecting Brass from Tarnish.To keep
brass from tarnishing, after thoroughly cleaning and
removing the last traces of grease by the use of potash
and water, the cage or other brasswork must be care-
fully rinsed with water and dried, but in doing it care
must be taken not to handle any portion with the
bare hand, nor anything else that is greasy. The
preservative varnish may be shellac, much diluted
with alcohol, or it may be hard oil finish. In either
case, the brass should be made pretty warm, and the
varnish or shellac put on with a brush in as thin a
476 NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
coat as possible. The proportion of shellac to alcohol
is about two ounces of the former to nine ounces of
the latter. Sometimes gamboge is used for a colour-
ing matter to make the varnish more yellow, and some-
times dragon's blood.
Silvering Mirrors.Looking-glasses used to
be made by covering the plate with an amalgam of
tin and mercury
; but this has been superseded by
depositing a coat of real silver upon the glass, thrown
down in a smooth film by adding oil of cloves or other
organic substances to a solution of ammonia-nitrate
of silver, retained upon the plate by a raised rim of
wax. The trouble with the process has been that)
though cheaper, the plates are inferior in lustre, and
lack the "black" colour which silversmiths regard as
indicating perfection of polish. The long-looked-for
process of imparting the brilliancy of the mercurial
coating to the cheap and durable film has at last been
accomplished by chemical reaction. After the silver-
plating is complete, the film is flooded with a weak,
aqueous solution of the double cyanide of mercury
and potassium ; slow decomposition takes place, and
the mercury is precipitated, which immediately amal-
gamates with the silver film. The result is said to
be thoroughly satisfactory, the amalgam of silver
being quite as bright as that of tin and less subject to
change, while the new process has the advantage of
being readily applicable to the largest plates, which,
by the old method, could be treated only with great
difficulty, if at all.
How to Render Wood Fire-proof.P. Fol-
barry, of New York, has devised a method of making
wood incombustible without, in any way, altering its
outward appearance. Wood prepared in accordance
with his process may possibly be charred just at the
surface, but the heat to which it is exposed, though
ever so intense, can never penetrate right into the
wood, and touch its fibres. Timber petrified in this
way is particularly suitable to staii cases that are to
resist a conflagration. The composition devised by
the inventor is as follows :
55
pounds of sulphate of
zinc, 22 pounds of potash,
44
pounds of alum, 22
pounds of sesquioxide of manganese, 22 pounds of
sulphuric acid at 6o, and
45
pounds of water. The
whole of the solid substances are put in an iron vessel,
containing the water at a temperature of 113 Fahr.
When all this solid matter is dissolved, the sulphuric
acid is poured in slowly until the whole is saturated
with it. The solution is now ready, and in order to
prepare timber with it the pieces must be put on an
iron grate in a suitable recipient, in accordance with
the size of the pieces and the object for which they are
intended, care being taken to leave half an inch be-
tween any two pieces. The composition is pumped
into the recipient, and after the whole of the spaces
have been filled up it is left there in a boiling state for
three hours. The wood is then taken out and placed
on a grate-like wooden stand in the open air, to make it
dry and firm. When thus prepared the impregnated
wood may be used for shipbuilding and building in
general, for railway carriages, scaffoldings, posts,
wooden pavements, and generally for all purposes,
while it is desirable that the material should be able
to resist fire.
=*=
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
D
FIG. 22. ILLUSTRATION OF TERM
CHAMFERING.
HE operation in carpentry known as cham-
fering has been frequently mentioned in
the pages of this magazine in connection
with the construction of various articles,
useful and ornamental. It consists in
taking off the sharp rectangular edge of a piece of
wood, formed by the intersection or line of meeting
of two plane surfaces at right angles to one another,
so as to leave a third surface inclined in most cases at
at an angle of 135
^ e
b
to each of their sur-
faces. The annexed
diagram (Fig. 22) will
help to make this per-
fectly clear to anyone
who may not exactly
u n derstand what
chamfering means.
Suppose the figure to represent in section a piece of
planed board
f
inch thick, of which A B is the upper
surface, B c the front or face of the board, and c D
the under surface. The planes A B, B c intersect or
meet in a line represented in the diagram by the point
B. It is desired to take off the sharp edge at B to the
extent off inch each way along B A and B c, until a
third surface E f is produced, which makes with A B
and B c the angles a e f, e f c, each equal to
135
.
To take off the edge B is easy enough, and it may be
done with an ordinary plane if the chamfer be carried
along the whole length of the board, but it is unlikely
that one amateur out of ten, or even more, will be
able to do this so nicely as to insure the inclination of
E F to A E and F C at equal angles, or in other words
to take off the edge in such a manner that the depth
of the piece removed from b to E and from B to F
shall be equal.
The difficulty, however, may be overcome by the
most unskilled of amateurs by the use of an ingenious
little tool which has been sent to me by Mr. A. S.
Lunt, Saw, Plane, Tool, and Cutlery Manufacturer,
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
All
297, Hackney Road, E., and which from its appearance
is of American origin. This tool, which is called the
"
Improved Chamfering Shave," and which is sold at
2S. 3d., is shown in Fig. 23, the back part of the
tool being represented. It consists of four parts,
namely, the stock, the cutting iron, and two fences,
which are adjustable from ^ in. to ii in., and there-
fore capable of being removed or brought together at
pleasure, so as to cut any sized chamfer that the
amateur will require to make in all ordinary work
from the largest to the smallest. The stock, which is
FIG. 23.IMPROVED CHAMFERING SHAVE.
of iron, is very similar to that of a spokeshave, and
the tool is used in precisely the same way. It is
pierced at either end or handle in order to reduce its
weight as much as possible. Between the perfora-
tions runs a groove, in which the fences slide, being
loosened or tightened at pleasure by two screws which
enter the stock. The cutting iron, which is 2'\ inches
long and if inches wide, is inserted in a groove cut to
receive it in the front of the stock. The extent of the
cutting edge exposed is regulated by a screw, which
works through a slot in the cutting iron and enters the
stock. I can thoroughly recommend this useful tool
to the notice of my readers, both for chamfering as in
the case of
V
jointed boards, for example, and for stop
chamfering, an operation in which the chamfer is not
carried out along the whole length of the edge, but is
terminated at a set distance from either end. Stop-
chamfering is much used in making pieces of furniture,
ornamental gates, etc. Among carpenters a shave of
this description is generally known as a canting tool.
It is possible to make one with the aid of an old chisel
or plane iron as the cutting iron, but few will be
inclined to do so when the cost of one all ready to
hand is no more than 2s. 3d.
A short time ago a correspondent was making
inquiry for a portable set of tools in a roll, which
would go into small compass and be easily carried
about by the owner. His want was mentioned to
Messrs. R. Melhuish and Sons, Carpenters, Iron-
mongers, and Tool Manufacturers,
of 85 and
87,
Fetter Lane, E.C., who have added to their stock a
variety of sets of tools of this kind, and now have
them on sale. I think it so desirable that every
amateur who maybe inclined to furnish himself with
one of these cases may be able to suit his individual
requirements as nearly as possible, that I have ap-
pended in exlenso below a summary of these cases
and the various tools contained in each, with the
description of envelope, p-ice, etc.
No. 1.
"
You don't pay whether the box is round
or square. Would a square box and a
square disc do?" I said that "the box
was made of turned wood, and measured
3
inches in diameter" and surely that
was explicit enough as regards shape
;
and if not. the marking off of the disc
with a pxir
of
comprises was distinctly
and clearly described. A square box
and a squarewell, certainly not disc,
but diaphragm
might be made to
answer ; but surely in a large city like
Glasgow, a small round wooden box
suiiable enough for the purpose can be
obtained, and it is not absolutely neces-
sary, as my correspondent taking me
"
au
pied de let/re
"
implies, that it should
have contained tooth-powder.
Lex evidently thinks that he is cross-
examining an obstinate witness, judging
by the number and amplitude of his ques-
tions. He surely must be joking when
he puts his fifth question as follows :-r-
"
Please explain the theory and practice
of 'telephone transmitter*,
5
with a sketqh
if possible" ! Even if such theoretical
discourses were not, as I distinctly said
in my article they were, out of place
in Amateur Work, Illustrated, it
would keep the amateurs sitting in coun-
cil as long as the proverbial Tichb>rne
trial before I could get through half the
number. I will try and answer his other
seven questions j but in future must beg
of him and other like correspondents not
to put too great a stress on our Editor's
good nature, nor the elasticity of our
Magazine.
(ij No definite rule.
(2)
A regulating screw at one end of the
magnet serves, as its name implies, to
regulate the distance between the disc
and pole of the magnet ; it also tends to
hold firmly the magnet in the iase.
(3}
'Ihe "Bell,"
"
Gower-Bell," and
"Edison" telephones mainly differ in
the arrangement, being di:?tinct for re-
ceiver and transmitter in the last two,
together with additions of carbon con-
tacts induction-coils ; and ihe
"
Edison"
must have a battery attached. But it is
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL. 481
impossible for me to give in this limited
spice full details, and Lex really must
consult some technical book on the sub-
ject, such as the one by Du Moncel,
entitled "The Telephone, Microphone,
and Phonograph."
(4)
The drawing of bobbin in the Bell
telephone (page
343)
is practically correct.
The flanges are shown a httle too thick
;
they should be .^ inch, allowing ^ inch
width between them. I certainly thought
that I had given "the most convenient
and easiest method of boring the holes
for the wires through the case." I can-
not give an easier, unless they are drilled
with the help of a lathe.
(6) The above-named book gives a good
deal of information ; but I do not know
of any that I could say was
'
' the best book
on the construction of telephones," unless
I were egotistic enough to refer to my own
article in Amateur Work, Illus-
trated ! Few, if any, books enter
into details of construction, although
here are several that give good de-
scriptions of the various telephones.
(7)
The phonograph, in its simpler
form, might be made by an amateur.
The price of one varies with its size and
mechanism. A small one, worked by
hand, might be obtained for
^5
; but a
good one, with clockwork movement,
would cost from ,12 to 15, if not
more, and I believe Mr. Edison puts
certain restrictions on its sale and use.
The date of bis patent is July 31, 1877.
F. A. E. (Newtown-Hutler). \i by
"the strength of the telephone" you
mean its power to reproduce the voice,
then the power of the magnet, as well as
the number of the coils on the reel, tend
to clearness , but it also depends greatly
on the voice of the speakersome persons
making themselves most distinctly heard
where others entirely fail. The intonation
must be clear and musical for shouting
produces the worst results. Like every-
thing else, practice makes perfect.
Messrs. Dale or Archbutt, both of whom
advertise in Amateuk Work, Illus-
trated, would. I am sure, tend you any
articles such as magnets, wires, etc., you
may require.
J.
M. H. (Slratlon). Thanks for your
description of the regulating sere//. It
certainly may be termed an improve-
ment ; but I cannot, without condemning
mjself, agree with you that,
"
It is, we
may say, absolutely necessary that there
sh mid be some means of regulating the
distance between magnet and metal
diaphragm ;" for when once the magnet
is fixed as near to the disc as possible,
allowing room for the latter to vibrate
without touching the pole of magnet,
ro regulating is requisite, and I found
no difficulty in fixing mine without the
aid of the screw. Fitting the magnet
into its case with the help of corks,
might make the operation easier, but it
would not regulate the distance any bet-
ter than the simp'e pushing of the mag-
net up until you get the correct place,
as I did.
Neptune (Salisbury). (1) See answer
above to F. A. E. (2) About No. 24
or No. 26 B. W. G. is the usual sue for
insulated connecting or "line" wire ; but
lor long distances out of doors, the galva-
nized iron three-strand wire, similar to
that used in telegraphy, is cheaper and
more durable ; it must, however, be insu-
lated at its supports. When purchasing
}
wire, it is best to state the purpose for
which you require it, and the vendors will
then supply the most suitable kind.
(3)
See answer to F. S. (Reigate) in Part IX.
of Amateur Work, Illustrated.
Storm Glass.
C. Clark writes
" To prepare this in-
strument, take 2 drachms of camphor,
\
drachm of pure nitrate of potash (nitre or
saltpetre), and h drachm of muriate of am-
monia (salammoniac), and triturate them
together until thoroughly pulverized. The
operation may be assisted by adding a
few drops of alcohol. When well tritu-
rated, the mixture is to be dissolved in
about two ounces of alcohol, and put
into a tall phial, as an eau-de-Cologne
bottle, or into a glass tube, of about ten
inches in height, and three-fourths of an
inch in diameter, the mouth of which is
to be covered with a bit of bladder or the
like, perforated with a pin. The instru-
ment is then complete.
The indications are as follows :If the
atmosphere be dry and the weather pro-
mising to be fine, all the sohd part of the
composition which appears in the glass
will be closely collected at the bottom,
ani the liquor above will be quite clear
;
but on the approach of a change to rain,
the solid matter will appear gradually to
rise, and small crystalline stars will be
observed to float about in the liquid,
which, however, will remain otherwise
pellucid. On the approach of winds,
flocks of the composition, apparently in
the form of a leaf, will appear on the
surface of the liquid, which in this case
will seem thick and in a state of fermenta-
tion. Tnese indications often begin to
exhibit themselves twenty-four
hours
before the actual breaking forth of the
storm, and after a short experience in
observing the changes of appearances of
the materials in the glass, not only the
magnitude of the coming storm will
readily be estimated, but likewise its
direction
; for the quarter of the compass
from which the wind blows will alwnys be
indicated by the circumstance of the solid
particles lying more closely to the side of
the glass opposite to that whence the
tempest comes. During the winter, the
composition is rendered white by the
multitude of small white stars which are
constantly floating about in the liquid.
This is particularly remarkable during
white frost and snow. In summer, on
the contrary, when the weather is warm
and serene, the liquid is clear, and the
solid matter lies at the bottom of the
glass.
W.J.
R. Eads (Moullon, Northampton)
writes
Balsam of capivi,
9 ounces ; lampblack,
3
ounces
; indigo and Prussian blue, of
each, i ounce ; Indian red,
j
ounce
;
yellow turpentine soap, dry, 3 ounces.
The making of printer's ink in the usual
way involves boiling oil and afterwards
setting it alight, a difficult and dangerous
operation for an amateur to undertake.
Preventing Doors from Falling Open.
W.
J.
K. (South Kensington) writes
thus : It may interest some of the nume-
rous readers of your useful and interesting
Journal if I describe a simple expedient
which I devised some years ago for pre-
venting the glass and other doors of book-
cases and cabinets from falling open,
owing to uneven floors, bad fitting, or
other causes, and where the key is not
available or is inconvenient. It is to
bore a hole with a centre bit of suiiable
size, about a quarter of an inch deep,
either on the bottom or top edge of the
door at about one inch from the free end,
and then insert a tight-fitting cork, pro-
jecting sufficiently to occasion enough
friction to keep the door in place, and
yet to allow of its being opened without
difficulty. If the cork be neatly rounded
off with a piece of sand-paper, it acts per-
fectly, and although capable of readjust-
ment, I have rarely found it necessary to
do so, and it has the additional advantage
of being out of sight if the position be
judiciously chosen.
"Graph Composition."
M. B. (Southport) wishes for a recipe
for making the "Graph" composition
used in copying machines, and another
for black ink suitable for use in such
machines. He also desires to know the
names of tradesmen in Manchester and
Liverpool where he could see specimens
of tools, lathes, fret-sawing machines,
etc., before buying. Will any of our
readers supply the desired information ?
Making Camera.
J.
S. Rochond.To give instructions
how to make a Camera you anticipate
constructing, would take up too much
valuable space in
'
' Amateurs in Council.'
You will find that the grooving, as de-
scribed by Mi. Parkinson, will answer
your purpose admirably ; hinge with three
brass hinges to each shutter. If you
follow his articles as they appear, you
will have no difficulty in constructing a
camera any size you may desire.
Stencilling.
W.
J.
N. (Fordingbridge) and A. H. L.
/
(Croydon). A good variety of stencil
patterns is kept, and plates are cut to
order by Mr. Warwick, Holywell Street,
Strand, W.C.
Bench Stop.
E. W. (Richmond). Morrill's Perfect
Bench Stop is fully illustrated and ex-
plained in Messrs. Churchill's catalogue.
PRESENTED WITH PART XI. OF
1 WflM, I1LBST
I
c
-
a i OB B
Fig. 3.Proscenium
. 1.Arrangement of Front Fig. 2.Arrangement of Long Room
~
Back Drawing-room.
Fig. 4 - Curtain to draw apart.
Fig. 9.FootlightB.
Fig. 10.-Footlight Lamps. Fig. H. Fig. 12_Footlight Candle. Fig. 13. -Suspension of Fig. 14.-Beam of Curtain Fig. 15.-Top and Side
Curtains. (both ends), Lights.
THE AM.JEUR ACTORS' PORTABLE THEATRE: ITS PRACTICAL CONSTRUCTION AND MANAGEMENT,
b/ EDWAHD HEROH-tUEH.
iaooT'^aiwsxQ. ifcusS; has
I
BOAT-BUILDING MADE EASY.
483
BOAT-BUILDING MADE EASY.
IV.The Norwegian Fishing-Boat.
N these papers I have hitherto confined
myself to small boats, suited for carrying
one person, or at most two. I now pro-
pose to fly at larger game, and choose
for my first big boat a kind almost, I
believe, unknown in this country, but which only
requires to be introduced to secure a hearty welcome
everywhere ; if, at least, it be granted such a reception
as its merits deserve. Shortly put, those merits are
as follows : Firstly, It can be built with, probably,
half the expenditure of time and trouble necessary for
any other kind of similar size. Secondly, It is very
fast. Thirdly, It draws almost no water. On the
other hand, it has defects : an apparent want of steadi-
nessI say appa-
rent, for the boat
is really steady
and a tendency
to turn round on
very slight pro-
vocation from the
oars ; both these
faults, of course,
being the neces-
sary results of the
very light draught
of water, men-
tioned as a merit
above, and both
admitting of easy
FIG. 19.NORWEGIAN'jFISHtNG BOAT,
remedy, by putting on a very simple false keel.
This build of craft is in great request among the
Boyne salmon-fishers, being, indeed, the commonest
kind of boat to be found iri the vicinity of Drogheda.
The model was originallygor, I believe, from the
boats of a Norwegian ship, and is regarded with
favour both from being so eisy to build,every
fisherman makes his own.and also from being
specially adapted, owing t<>-?ts roundness of bottom, to
run over the nets without catching in or tearing them.
I took the few measurements necessary from a Drog-
heda boat, and have just finished a very satisfactory
copy, the result of two or three hours' work daily for a
fortnight. Fig. 19 is an exact representation of this
boat, being taken from a photograph.
The main differences of this build from others are
two : it has no keel, and it has no stem or stern-posts.
A section of the boat at any point will form an exactly
similar figure, being always something very near a
semicircle ; the length of radius differing according to
the position of the section in question. The section
of greatest radius will be found at about one-third of
the total length from the stem. Corresponding to the
stem-post in other boats is a small semicircular, or
nearly semicircular, piece of board, say an inch and a
half thick, straight edge, of course, up ;
while the
stern, equally thick, but about six times as large other-
wise, is of similar figure. I say semicircular, or nearly
semicircular; because the shape of the stem and stern-
pieces will be the shape of the boat throughout, and it
will be found to improve the appearance of the whole
to shorten the diameter, the top edge of the semi-
circle, by, say, an inch on each side of the larger
sections. Indeed, I believe these boats are generally
built less semicircular than I built mine, more flat
bottomed and flat sided, something like Fig. 20, and
consequently, in all probability, steadier in the water.
The gunwales are flat, parallel, that is, to the
water, with one man in the boat ; and the distance
of the lowest
points of the stem
and stern-pieces
from the water
will accordingly
equal the differ-
ence in radius of
these pieces from
that of the larger
section placed at
one-third of the
total length from
the bow.
For a boat to
carry seven or
eight people com-
fortably, the following measurements will be found
suitable, and at the same time about the simplest
possible. Total length, 1 5 feet ; radius of stem-piece,
6 inches ; of large section, 2 feet ; of stern-piece, 18
inches. It will also be found a great help in building,
to have another section, about a third of the boat's
length from the stern. A good way of arranging the
framework is as follows : Get two pieces of wood, 1
inch or
1
J inches thick, and 15 feet long, or whatever
length the boat is to be. The slips that are to form
the gunwales will answer very well. Place these side
by side, and a few inches apart, on the ground. -Place
across them, and nail to them at one end, the stem-
piece, and at the other end the stern-piece, both
inverted, or flat side down, and in their respective
places the intermediate sections. Be careful that
these are all placed exactly parallel. The side-boards
should be about a quarter of an inch in thickness.
Seven on each side will be found the best number, and-
before fastening the end-pieces and cross sections
x
484
BOAT-BUILDING MADE EASY.
to the gunwales or other supports on the ground, the
space to be occupied on their edges by each board,
when in its place, should be carefully marked.
It is plain that to find the amount of the circum-
ference of each section necessary for each individual
board all we now have to do is to subtract from the
whole circumference, amounting, of course, to half the
circumference of a circle of equal radius, the few
inches to be occupied on the bottom by the board
which supplies the place of keel, and divide the
remainder by the total number of boards, fourteen,if
those at each side amount to seven. All the boards
should be equal in depth at any one point, and the
immense advantage of the semicircular form of the
stem and stern-pieces will now appear, in that it allows
each board to be a single piece, from stem to stern,
instead of being composed of two parts, the arranging
of which we saw to be one of the chief difficulties in
building a canoe. In Fig. 21, then, the distances
from A to H, and again from I to
Q,
are all equal. In
the stem-piece, of 6 inch radius, each will be \\
inches, in the section at one-third of the length, of
2 foot radius,
5
inches, and in the stern-piece, of 18
inches radius,
3!
inches. It must be borne in
mind, however, that this breadth will not be sufficient
for the several boards, since they must overlap, in the
manner described at length in page 181. Allowing an
inch for overlapping on the large section, about
\
in-
at the stern, and about \
in. at the stem,the rough
boards necessary for the sides will be fourteen, each 6
inches wide, and what is called five to the plank in
thickness, since a plank is 3
inches thick, and one
board is consumed in sawing. We now come to the
bottom-board, which supplies the place of the keel.
It will be seen that there are about 2 inches left for it
on the stem-piece, 4 on the large section, and
3
on the
stern-piece. Remember, however, that it has to be
overlapped by the lowest board on either side, and
accordingly leave it wider on both edges, to fit in
under these.
Let us now return to the three sections, fixed to
the gunwales that are to be, which should themselves
be fastened firmly to the ground. Of these sections,
the stem and stern-pieces should be made of board
about an inch and a half thick, and bevelled off so as
to make the circumference on the outside smaller
than that on the inside, since the boards that are to be
secured to their edges come to them from the larger
section in the interior of the boat. The bevel, too,
should be sharper on the stem-piece, as this is nearer
to the large section in question. The stem semi-
circle can, of course, be made of a single piece of
wood, but it will be hard to procure one board wide
enough for the stern. This, however, can easily be
made of two pieces, firmly fastened by the help of a
rabbet-plane, or common moulding plane, some glue,
and a couple of strong nails, with the heads knocked
off". The bottom-board should not merely be fastened
to the edge of the sections, like the side-boards, but
sunk in them, till the outside edge of its centre occu-
pies the exact position of the old outside edge of the
centre of the section. Its two inner edges should be
bevelled off all along. The large section should be
placed perpendicular to the laths that support it, and
the ground they rest on. The end-pieces, on the con-
trary, should slope in slightly from what is to be the
top of the boat, to what is to be the bottom ; about
one inch in six is the proper amount of inclination, and
this will be found to have considerably diminished
when the boat is finished. Remember with reference
to this inclination that, if your boards are 15 feet long,
the top, that is to be, of the end-pieces must be only
about 14 feet
9
inches apart, to allow for the
round of the boat. The bottom-board must be
shortened even more in proportion, since it is the
lower round edge of the end-pieces which must be
bent in, not the top flat edge which must be bent out.
Now nail the bottom-board in the place cut for it
in each section. Fasten the fore end first. It will be
found on trying to bend down the board over the
large section, so as to rest on the s'em, that it will
swell up in a circular form about the middle of the
boat. This rise must be checked by putting some
heavy stones or other weights on the board, or tying
it to the floor. The greatest depth must be at the large
section, placed at one-third of the length of the boat,
or a little way more, from the bow. I have given no
measurements for the corresponding section at the
other end of the boat. This is because, in building
my boat, I did not consider such a section necessary,
and the consequence of omitting it is an ugly straight-
ness, instead of gradual decrease in girth, in the five or
six feet next the stern. Once the bottom-board is on
and properly bent, it is easy to form a section for any
particular point by measuring the distance from this
board to the height off- the ground at which the other
sections are supported, and making a semicircular
figure of this radius. It is of course unnecessary for
the sections, which are to i>e knocked out when the
boat is finished, to be all of one piece
; only be care-
ful that, if made of slips of wood, the centre, which
has to bear the weight, be strongly supported. The
resting places for the several boards A B, B c, etc., Fig.
21, may be flattened on the large section, though this
is hardly necessary, and quite superfluous on the
smaller pieces.
All is now ready for the first pair of side-boards.
"
Five to the plank," as we have seen, is amply suffi-
cient thickness for these. The fastenings are best
made of copper, as recommended for canoes in these
BOAT-BUILDING MADE EASY.
485
papers ; but, as the expense of these for so large a
boat would be a considerable item in the total, per-
haps iron may be preferred. If so, get some
"
Cana-
dians." Those wonderful nails, which can be had of
all lengths, while scarcely stiff enough for ash, or
other hard woods, are unequalled for deal. They can
be bent, as an enthusiastic carpenter assured me,
"
into a pig's ring," will never break, and once they
bite the wood, hold it. For the side-boards they
should be about an inch and a half long, and be
clinched securely by a blow from a hammer on the bent
point, while holding a heavy iron against the head,
previously driven home. This will be found a better
plan than the simultaneous blow from two hammers,
recommended in page 226. One every foot, will be
found about the proper number ; and screws should
be used to secure the boards to the stem and stem-
pieces. They should be fastened temporarily by
larger nails, half-driven into the temporary sections
amidships.
All ought to be plain sailing till about half theboards
are on. Ascertain, by bending it roughly to its place,
the exact part of each board which is to touch the
large section ; stick an awl or nail into it here
;
put
another to fasten it to the stern
;
get some one to hold
it to the stem-piece, and mark the amount to be cut
off the breadth of the ends to make them fit. The
best way will be to mark off half the necessary
amount, from each edge, say three-quarters of an inch
at the stern and a larger amount at the stem, accord-
ing to the total breadths at these places previously
settled. Draw lines from the extreme outside edges at
the large section to these marks, then saw and plane
to the lines, and bevel off the upper one. It will be
found well, in a boat of this size, not to bevel these
edges so fine as in a canoe or small skiff; and at all
events, when marking the amount to be cut off, never
forget the bevel, to be afterwards overlapped by the
next board. I have already said that I omitted, in
building my boat, to put in a second temporary sec-
tion until too late, and had cause to regret the
omission. If such a section is used, of course the
boards should always, during measurement and mark-
ing, be carefully secured to it also.
When about four boards of the seven are secured
in their places on each side, remembering that no two
boards should be put consecutively on the same side,
you will probably begin to find it harder to make the
fresh edge meet the old one evenly all along. The best
way will then be to fasten the new board on the centre
section as before ; fasten each end temporarily in
whatever way seems to suit best, allowing, that is, for
all the cutting to be done on the top, or all on the
bottom, if one of these seem preferable to the top
and bottom plan recommended above ; then pencil a
line on the new board by the old edge, now pressed
upon it, draw a parallel line outside this, allowing for
the bevel, and cut by it. Do, in fact, as previously
described in these papers, in treating of the canoe.
Another inconvenience will now make itself felt in
nailing on the side-boards,the decreasing distance
between them and the floor. As a matter of fact, a
boy, or small man, may get under the edge to clinch
the nails till all the boards are on but one at each side;
but the simplest solution of the difficulty would doubt-
less be to fasten the sections, etc., at starting, on
higher supports than the gunwales. It must also_be
remembered that, unless these supports are very stiff,
or firmly fastened to the ground, the efforts of the
boards, continuing that of the backbone, as we may
call it, to spring up from their bent position, will
infallibly raise the stem and stern-pieces from the
ground, till the very top-boards are on, which will then
hold everything in its place.
Boat ribs may be divided into two kinds : sawn
ribs, to keep the sides in a particular shape, stiff and
immovable, the kind formerly recommended for
canoes ; and bent ribs, straight slips bent under the
influence of steam, and calculated to hold the sides
together. The former are chiefly used in boats liable
from their shape to contractj thelatter in those liable
to expand. Now, on consideration, it will be seen that
in the boat we have been describing the tendency will
be to contract, and thus let down the elevated head, or
rather the head which appears elevated from its having
no support below it ; the gunwales are really, as we
have seen, level all along. But bent ribs, binding all
together, are undoubtedly useful in any boat, and the
plan I therefore adopted, and found to answer well,
was to use ribs of both kinds. The sawn ones were
of ash. three pairs, precisely similar to those described
in page 226 for canoes. The others were formed of
the hoops of some of those small, light barrels
commonly used to pack groceries and such things in,
and made, staves and hoops, of some kind of poplar or
willow. Each one of these hoops does duty for a
pair of bent ribs, reaching as it does from gunwale to
gunwale. I put a pair of sawn ribs, ash,
3 feet
7 inches
from the stern ; the next, 3 feet 2 inches further on
;
the third pair 2 feet 10 inches away from these, leaving
about
5
feet
5
inches to the stem. In this
5
foot 10
inches space are three hoop ribs, and between each of
the other pairs of sawn ribs, and behind the last, two
;
the ribs, taking both kinds, being thus about a foot
apart. Now fasten in the gunwales,2 inches deep,
and 1 inch, or ij inch thick will do,and you may
then dispense with the sections.
Next take two pairs of laths, each an inch by halt
an inch, or thereabouts, Fasten one pair round the
inside, 7
inches below the top of the gunwales, for the
4
86 BOAT-BUILDING MADE EASY.
seats to rest on, securing it to the cut-ribs. Fasten
the other pair parallel to the keel, or where the keel
of a boat generally is, iS inches apart, to support the
inside bottom-boards. Places should be cut for the last
pair of laths, or indeed for both, in the cut-ribs, and
this should be done before the latter are screwed in.
Now turn the boat bot-
tom up to fasten on the
outside bottom - board. It
will be remembered that the
first pair of side-boards was
nailed on outside the keel-
board. A hollow is con-
sequently left all along
between the edges of this
pair, and this hollow you
cannot do better than fill
completely with tar, or the
same compound of tar and
pitch, and some soap, resin, and cart-grease, with
which you should afterwards plenteously anoint
the three or four lowest boards all round, except
towards the prow. Then nail on the outside board,
bevelling off its edges to make it fit neatly down
on the first pair of side-boards.
Next come the seats. Make these of boards
9
inches broad and 1 inch thick. Place them about
3
feet 5
inches apart, and put the usual side seats be-
tween the hindmost one and the next. There will
thus be four cross seats,
and these two side ones,
and, as the laths they rest
on are 7 inches below the
gunwales, the rowers will
sit 6 inches below these.
Drive long nails through
the sides into the ends of
the seats. Two small tri-
angular pieces of wood
fastened between the top
of the stern-piece and the
gunwales will be useful.
As the bare raised prow does not look well from
inside, it will be a good plan to cover in about
3
feet of it, nailing light boards across, and sawing them
even with the gunwales; then finish them with the
spokeshave. Put a small piece across, at right angles
to the others, as a curtain where they come to an end.
For the rowlocks, take a couple of harrow-pins to a
blacksmith, and make him split them up for half their
length, round the shank, and form one side of the
split portion into a C, to catch the oar ; leave the
other side somewhat straighter. To hold the row-
locks, take three pieces of wood, 6 or 7 inches long,
and the same depth and breadth as the gunwales.
FIG. 20. TRANSVERSE SECTION OF BOAT.
FIG. ZI.-AKKANGEMEXr OF BOARDS OF BOAT IN SECTION.
Screw them firmly to the latter, one pair for single-
handed rowing, a foot before the amidships seat, the
second seat from the prow. Fix the third in a similar
position with regard to the right hand side, as one
sits, on the front seat. Now get three little pieces of
stout sheet or hoop iron, each with a large hole nearly
in the centre to hold the
shank of the rowlock, and
four small screw holes in
the corners, a pair for the
gunwale and a pair for
the inside piece. Bore or
burn a hole down through
the wood, from the large
opening in the iron, and
this will hold your rowlock.
I said make the hole nearly
in the centre of the iron
because thus you need not
do much harm to the gunwale, which would be
hard to restore ; the hole will be mainly in the
small piece within, which can be easily replaced if
necessary.
Next come the oars. About
9 feet will be long
enough, with blades
3
inches broad.
Lastly, put in the loose bottom-boards
; two, each
9
inches broad except towards the prow, hinged
together by pieces of leather, and fastened down by
staples driven into the ribs, with pins through them.
,
These boards need not run
quite up to the prow, only
far enough for the front
boarding across the gun-
wales to conceal their ends.
If a false keel be thought
necessary, it should be
about 10 feet long, begin-
ning with nothing, at the
point of greatest depth ir
the boat, and running bacl<
to 6 inches deep at the
stern. This will render the
total depth of the boat equal, for this distance.
Make it an inch thick, and fasten it with two pairs
of L-shaped irons, screwed to the keel and the
bottom ; or, if there is an objection to having it
immovable, fasten it with hinges so as to lift up, and
put a bolt on the stern to catch the end when let
down, and keep all steady.
This completes our Norwegian fishing boat, the
most striking feature of which is its symmetry, not
only on either side of a central plane dividing the boat
into two parts lengthwise from stem to stern in common
with all other boats, but in similarity of its sections
taken in any part transversely from stem to stern.
A QUEEN ANNE TIMEPIECE.
487
A QUEEN ANNE TIMEPIECE.
By W. MJSTIX.
4 to
6 oz. wide bottle to hold the nitrate of silver
; 4 oz.
nitrate silver, 3s. 4d. to 3s. 6d. the ounce ; flat dish,
2s. 6d., and 12 American pegs, id. each ; 20-oz. bottle,
1 funnel, is. 6d.
;
packet filter papers, is.
PHOTOGRAPHY: ITS PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE.
489
To Print.The paper cut to size, a trifle larger
than is required, as the exact size the finished print
is to be, is regulated afterwards. For carte-de-visite
prints take a sheet of paper, cut it in quarters, and
each quarter cuts again into eight pieces, for the
\
plate,
or carte-de-visite negative. Take the printing, or
pressure frame, remove the back, dust out the frame,
place the negative, face up on the rebate, then the
piece of sensitised paper, the glossy side next the face
of the negative, replace the back, close all springs,
and place out in the light, not sunshine ; a pad is
required between the paper and the back of the
framea piece of cloth, or flannel, makes a good pad,
or even a few pieces of old newspaper. The back of
the frame is hinged, one half can thus be opened and
looked at, whilst the other half remains firm, thus
keeping the print in its place, or register. After the
frame has been out for five minutes just peep at
tbe print, by removing the spring, and gently lifting
the part of the back now open. An extraordinary
change will be apparent ; on the paper you will be
able to see an outline of the negative reproduced.
This printing is continued until the print is some
shades darker than the finished picture is desired
to bein fact, the high lights, that is the whitest
parts in the print, should be slightly darkened, or, as
an artist would say, degraded. For the subsequent
operations bleach the image down ; remove the print
in the darkened room you first fitted the frame in, and
insert a fresh piece of paper ; many people use an old
magazine, or large cover, to keep the sensitised paper
and the printed proofs in ; anything will do that pre-
vents their curling. Very dense or opaque negatives
should be printed in the sun. When the day's printing
is done, the prints are cut round, that is, to a rectangle
;
the carte-de-visite cutting glass and the print are
held in the left hand, the glass is adjusted, and with a
pair of scissors, the print is cut to the size required.
Remember after the negative is removed from the
printing frame, to place a piece of glass in its place,
it keeps the pad clean and flat.
Toning.The most important article here is the
toning bath, which is made as follows : The tube of
gold, having previously removed the label, is inserted
in the 15-oz. bottle
; this is shaken so that the tube
is broken, then fill up with tap-water, and label the
bottle
Slock Gold Solution.
Tubeofgold
15
gr.
|
Water 15 oz.
Each oz. of solution now contains 1 gr. chloride of
gold. In the 40-oz. bottle, previously covered with
brown paper to keep out the light put
Plan.
=@=
FIG. 13.END ELEVATION OF
c in fig. 11. Half size.
FIG. 14. SIDE ELEVATION OF D>
FIG. 10. Half size.
FIG. 9.WIRE FOR BELL AND BATTERY
SWITCH. Half size.
FIG. 12.WOOD ACROSS TOP OF BOBBINS. Half size. FIG. 8.DIAGRAM SHOWING HOW TO FIX SWITCH.
Full size.
49
s HO IV I MADE MY TELEPHONES.
plane as the eye, and so at right angles to the two
arms. When complete, the length over A D is about
4 inches, and the width over the two arms B, c about
if inches. To the eye A, I fastened a small spiral
spring of brass wirea piece of clock spring will do,
or even an india-rubber band, only the latter will not
of course last longand then the whole forms the
"telephone" switch. About 6 inches of the same
sized wire, bent into the shape shown in Fig.
g,
will
do for the
"
bell and battery
"
switch.
To fix them in working order, take a piece of deal
wood 8 inches long, 6 inches wide,
f
inch thick, nicely
squared and planed up. At a distance of 2 inches
from the left-hand side, and parallel to it, make a pencil
line down the whole length, upon which you place the
"
telephone
"
switch, fastening it there by two brass
wood screws through the brass guide. Now, under
the arm C, screw into the wood a mushroom-headed
No.
5
brass wood screw, about
5 inch long, leaving
J
inch of the shank out, as shown in Fig. 8 ; and over
the arm B screw a brass eye, Fig. 10, allowing about
-J
inch play for the switch, that is to say, allowing
room for Fig. 6 to slide up and down about
i
of an
inch, (he arms alternately touching the screw and eye.
Then fix the little spiral spring to the board by a
screw directly above the switch, and at a distance
sufficient to keep the arm b touching the screw eye.
Now take your telephone and hang it on to the hook
D (Fig.
6),
when its weight will pull against the spiral
spring and bring the switch down, so that the arm c
rests on the screw beneath it. You may find the
spring too strong, or what amounts to the same thing,
the telephone not heavy enough for this
;
you must
then weaken the spring a little by stretching, or else
by bringing the screw which fastens it to the board a
little nearer the switch.
This arrangement can be better seen by referring
to No. 1 station, Fig. 15.
Now fix the
"
bell and battery
"
switch to the board
by a screw through its eye, the screw being about
1 inch from the right edge, and about ii inches from
the bottom edge of the board; and allowing the switch
to swing freely. At an equal distance from the central
screw, put two mushroom-headed screws, so that the
one is above, and the other below the straight arm of
switch, the upper one keeping it from hanging vertical
as it would do, if free, owing to the heavier bent end.
About
inch is ample distance between these two
screws, which are marked c and d in Fig. 15. In a
parallel line with the eye which you placed on left-
hand arm of "telephone" switch, and at a distance
of
J
inch from it screw another eye in, precisely
similar, so that the two appear as at G and H, Fig. 15.
The eye G together with the screw under right
arm, and the three screws of
"
bell and battery
"
switch
should all be fixed as shown in Figs. 8 and 10; the hole
being enlarged on the back of board by a rose bit, to
allow room for twisting the wire around the screw.
Now with a narrow gouge cut a channel a |
inch deep
in the wood at the back of the board, between c and
right hand screw of brass slide mark E, which screw
should be shorter than the others, as it must not pro-
ject in front or it will not fasten the slide securely.
From the screw F cut a channel vertically upwards
to edge of wood ; from the centre screw A cut one
horizontally to right hand edge, from the screw G cut
out one to the left hand edge, and from screw D cut
one vertically down to the edge. Now take five short
pieces of the same insulated wire as you use for your
"
line," and with your knife scrape off ii inches of the
cotton or gutta-percha from each end. Lay one in the
channel between c and E, and twist the ends around
the shanks of the screws two or three times, as shown in
Fig. 8. A little solder will make the joints more secure.
In the same way fasten a wire to A, f, D and G, leaving
the other ends sticking out beyond the edge of wood.
Fill in the channels all arornd the wires with a melted
paraffin candle, and then glue a piece of paper over
the whole back of the wood. To the eyes of G and H
must now be fastened the two telephone wires, and as
these should be long and pliable enough to allow the
telephone to be freely handled and held to the mouth
or ear without breaking the connections, they are
generally made of a special kind, the two wires being
woven together with fine silk, although kept insulated
from each other. This special wire can be purchased
for 2d. a yard, and 1 yard is sufficient for each tele-
phone. At each end separate the two wires and fasten
them one to each of the telephone terminals as I
described in my first paper, and the other two ends to
G and H by twisting one around each eye, and fixing
them with a little solder. (See Fig. 10.) Hang the
telephone on the hook of switch, by a small picture-
ring screwed into the end of the telephone, clear of
the magnet and terminals, and the switch board is
complete.
You will observe that the whole of Fig. 1 5 is merely
a diagram, and not therefore made to any scale. The
two stations are made respectively right and left
handed, to show distinctly all the connecting lines, but
you will of course make both your switch-boards alike
as described and shown in No. 1 station. The hook
of the "telephone" switch is for the same reason shown
on one side, but it really faces you as in Fig. 6.
Bells.Now let us see how to make the bells
; for
I presume you would like to make them for yourself
rather than purchase the ready-made article, which
would cost, at the very least, 4s. 6d. or 5s. An electric
bell consists of an electro-magnet, which, by alter-
nately attracting and releasing a hammer, causes it to
HOW I MADE MY TELEPHONES.
497
strike agairjst and ring a bell. But some will ask,
"
'What is an electro-magnet ?
"
and as this is one of
the most important things in the practical application
of electricity, I will in a few words explain it. If a
coil of insulated wire be wound around a piece of soft
ironand by
"
soft," I mean common iron, which has
not been hardened or tempered in any wayand then
an electric current is sent from a battery through the
wire, the soft iron instantaneously becomes converted
into a strong magnet, remaining so as long as the
electric current flows around it ; but the moment the
current ceases, then the iron as instantaneously loses
its magnetism. Thus you see an electro-magnet differs
from the telephone, for there the permanent magnet
creates an electric current, and so magnetism pro-
duces electricity ; here the electric current makes the
magnet, and so electricity produces magnetism. The
first thing, therefore, for the bell is an electro-magnet.
To make this, get a piece of round iron \
inch in
diameter and about
5
inches long, and heating it
blood-red in the fire, bend it round to the shape of a
horse-shoe, with the ends about 1 inch apart centre to
centre, and then let it cool gradually.by leaving it in
the ashes. Now take two wooden reels or bobbins,
each about if inches longordinary cotton reels will
doand enlarge the holes until they will allow the
ends of the iron to fit tightly into them. At the same
place from which you obtained the fine wire for your
telephones, purchase some No. 28 B. W.'G. wire, also
covered with cotton or silk ; its price is about 6d. per
ounce, and two ounces will suffice for one bell. Wind
half of it neatly around one of the bobbins, and then,
in the contrary direction, wind the remainder around
the other bobbin. I have shown the direction clearly
in Fig. 11. It is most important that you should do
this correctly, for when the iron becomes transformed
into a magnet, its north and south poles are also deter-
mined by the direction of the current.
To find out which is north, Ampere's rule, which is
easily remembered, is this. Supposing a man to be
swimming in the wire along with the current, and that
he is looking down on the piece of iron which lays at
right angles beneath him, then the north pole of the
iron would be at his left hand, and the south pole at
his right hand. Applying this rule to the horse-shoe,
you will see that if the wire is not wound around it
properly, you would not obtain the two requisite poles
to form the magnet. This will appear clearer if you
consider the horse-shoe as straightened out, with the
bobbins on it end to end, as if they were united into
one ;
then the wire should appear wound around both
continuously, and in the same direction. When the
wire is thus wound properly, it is immaterial to which
end you apply the current, for as your horse-shoe has
its two poles brought together, even if you reverse the
direction of the current, you would certainly change
the poles, but they would still act together in attracting
the armature. Leave about 6 inches of the ends of
the wire free, as you did with the telephone coil, and
your electro-magnet is complete.
For a board, take a piece of dry and well-seasoned
wood 6 inches long,
4 inches wide, and
J
inch thick,
and fasten the electro-magnet to it by placing a small
piece of wood across the top of the two bobbins, and
screwing it down with two wood screws, as shown in
Fig. 12. The position of magnet on the board is
shown at a in Fig. 11, where I have omitted the bit
of wood and screws, so that the direction of the wire
coil might appear distinct.
For the armature E, take a piece of soft iron
ii inches long,
| inch wide, and
J
inch thick, and to
one end of it fasten by small rivets a piece of springy
sheet brass F, about 2^ inches long, leaving one end
of it clear for about an inch, and bending out the
other end a little, as shown.
About s inch from this end must also be drilled a
minute hole to rivet on a bit of platinum, or else the
electric current which passes from the screw in D to
the spring F at this point would burn the brass. At
the end of the straight part of this spring make two
holes about
J
inch apart. Should you find it difficult
to make these holes and to fasten the spring to the
armature, any working watchmaker would soon do it
for a trifle. To the other end of E must be fastened
in the same manner a piece of brass wire G, about
if inches long, which at its far end is screwed into or
soldered on to a little brass knob about i inch in
diameter, to form the hammer. Now out of a piece
of hard woodbeech is the bestwith your tenon-saw
cut one piece, as shown at C, an end elevation of which
is given at Fig. 13, and one piece, as shown at D, a
side elevation of which is shown at Fig. 14.
To C must be screwed the straight end of the spring
F by two small brass wood screws through the holes
at a height equal to the distance which the centre of
the electro-magnet is above the board. Then fasten c
by two wood screws on to the board, so as to bring
the armature parallel across the poles of the electro-
magnet, and about I inch off from them.
Through the centre of D, at the same height, screw
a thin mushroom-headed brass wood screw long
enough to project beyond the wood at each side for
about i inch. If you make D about
-J
inch thick, then
the screw would be
f
inch long. Now fasten D to the
board, so that the screw points towards the centre of
the magnet and touches the bent end of f, where the
bit of platinum is riveted.
For the bell B, you might for a few pence purchase
an old gong out of an alarum clock, or a little brass
hand-bell will do nicely if you take out its inside
498
HO W I MADE MY TELEPHONES.
clapper, and fasten it, mouth upwards, by sticking the
handle into a hole in the board, so that the edge is
about i inch off the knob G, the wire of which you can
bend a little, to bring it level with the striking edge of
the bell.
Now, for terminals, screw two large brass screws
into the board at H and I. Around H twist one end of
the bobbin wire, and connect I to the screw of D by
twisting the ends of a short piece of wire around them.
Finally, fasten the other end of the bobbin coil to the
head of one of the brass wood screws which holds the
spring F to C, and your electric bell is complete.
To ring it, you must connect up one terminal to the
"
copper
"
of your battery, and the other terminal to
"
earth." Let us suppose you have done this, and that
the terminal I, in Fig.
15, is joined by wire up to
your battery, and H to "earth." Then the current
would flow from I along the wire to the screw in D,
passing to the end of which, it reaches at the platinum
point the spring F
;
then it runs along f to the screw
in C, around which is twisted the end of the bobbin
coil, and so it finds its way through the whole of the
coil around the horse-shoe to H, and loses itself in
"
earth." But the moment it flows through the coil, it
converts the horse-shoe into a strong magnet, which
attracts the armature E towards it, causing the hammer
G to strike the bell b. But when the armature E is
thus attracted towards the magnet, it at the same time
draws the spring f away from the end of the screw in
D, and thereby breaks the connection, stopping the
flow of the electric current. The horse-shoe then loses
its magnetism, and can no longer attract towards it
the armature E, which, therefore, is pulled back by the
spring F to its original position, when the platinum
point again touches the screw in D
; connection is then
made, the electric current flows again, and, as musi-
cians would say, da capo.
Should a bell prove too loud for a room, a toy
tambourine or small drum can be substiiuted for it.
The screw in D will have to be adjusted so as to make
and break the contact nicely. Also, should any of my
readers prefer a single-stroke bell or gong in prefer-
ence to the repeated and continuous ring, it can be
easily done by screwing the screw in D up so as to
keep its end always touching the platinum on F, and
making the wire of G to spring slightly. Then, when
the current is started, the electro-magnet draws the
armature so sharply towards it that the wire G will
spring the knob sufficiently to strike the bell once. It
is a little fidgety to get the screw properly adjusted
for this, and you may have to slightly alter the bend
of the wire G.
The bell should be fixed vertically on the wall, in
the position shown in the sketch, with the hammer
hanging down
; and it is better to cover it over with a
casing of thin wood or cardboard to keep out the
dust.
All that is now left for me is to describe how
to finally connect up and set in working order. First
of all then, at a height of about 5
feet from the
floor, fasten by two screws the switch-board in a
vertical position against the woodwork of the shutter
recess, or against the wall in any other part of the
room that you may deem more suitable or convenient,
and having your battery in good order, place it near.
The bell will go nicely over the switch-board, and of
course the closer you keep all three together the shorter
your connecting wires will be, and the less trouble you
will have in fixing them.
In Fig.
15
(No. 1 station) I have shown distinctly
all these wires. The end of your "line" wire must
be joined to the wire which is twisted around the
central screw of the "bell-battery" switch at A. The
carbon of your battery must be joined to the lower
screw D of the same switch ; the upper screw C
you have already connected to the brass guide at E.
The screw-eye H has no wire attached to its shank,
but only one of the pliable telephone wires twisted
around its eye ; the other telephone wire being
fastened in the same way to the eye of G. The wire
from F must be connected to one of the terminals
of the bell at I, and finally the other terminal of
the bell, the wire twisted around the shank of G
and the wire of the amalgamated zinc rod of the
battery, must all three be connected to "earth"
perfect. If you
will turn to page 167 you will find the following para-
graph :
"
Let us look at the tout-ensemble of a fiddle.
What is it? It is a hollow box, from 13 to 14 inches
in length ; at the widest part, 8 inches, and at the
narrowest
4!
inches, broad. It is about 2j inches
deep at the deepest part, and weighs about 8j ounces.
Beyond this we have a neck terminating in a scroll,
which, with pegs, finger-board, and tail-piece of ebony,
bring the weight up to about twenty ounces. The
wondrous capabilities and wonderful equilibrium of
all the parts may be summed up in one short sentence
it supports a weight on the bridge of from 88 to
92
pounds' pressure."
VIOLIN-MAKING: AS IT WAS, AND IS.
55
This exquisite machine, standing apart in its
mysterious simplicity from the vulgar herd of instru-
ments of melody and harmony, is capable of expressing
more by its unaided voice than all the rest put to-
gether
; and when this has been said, are we not
perfectly justified in ascribing to it the attribute of
perfection ? and is it extraordinary that any attempted
improvement only proves to be a deterioration, and
that to this day we can say to the fiddle in the words
of Cardinal Wolsey :
'
'
I charge thee, fling away ambition,
By that sin fell the angels ?
"
In the year 1804, Ernst, the celebrated violinist
and concert director to the Prince of Saxe-Coburg-
Gotha, . who was also a practical fiddle-maker*
and experimentalist, wrote as followsf :
"
After the
numerous and repeated essays which I have made in
the construction of the violin for more than twenty
years, I have come to the conclusion that its form and
manufacture as they have come down to us from the
best Italian masters, are not susceptible of any im-
provement, especially as regards the body of the in-
strume.v." It has very justly been remarked, Phira
faciutit homines e consaetiidine quam e ratione, and
as though to contradict this statement, and from a
feeling of independence, many daring innovations have
been made (or rather attempted), many of them the
results of carefully-applied science, and of the labours
of intelligent and learned men ; as such, they become
most interesting to the violin-maker, and as such, it is
the intention of the present chapter to consider them.
Crimine ab tino disce omnes. First comes the list of
instruments which have been made of various and
wildly unsuitable materials, beginning with
Earthenware Violins.There is a specimen of this
vagary in the Musee des Antiques, at Rouen, and
another in Delft faience in the Muse'e of the Conser-
vatoire at Paris, which has been played on (with a
result easily anticipated) by Mons.G. Choquet, the com-
piler of the catalogue of the museum, who describes it
as
"
neither powerful nor pleasant."
Metal Violins.Copper, brass, and silver have all
been used for making fiddles, the tones of which may
easily be imagined. A notice of these may be found
in the "Allgemeine Musikalische Zeitung," Vol. vii.,
1804, page 50. The silver violin which has been on
view in Mr. Davis's window in Green Street, Leicester
Square, longer than any living man can remember; is
doubtless a familiar object to many of my readers.
Leather Violins.There is one such to be seen in
the museum of the Conservatoire de Musique, in
* He was the master in fiddle-making of
J.
A. Otto, to whose
"
Treatise on the Construction of the Violin," reference has been
made in these pages.
t
"
Allgemeine Musikalische Zeitung," vol. vii., 1804, p.
49.''
Paris, of the date of 1776 ; and in the
"
Gentleman's
Magazine," Vol. Ixxxiii., for the year 1813, at page 312,
we find mention of one Gavin Wilson, a bootmaker of
Edinburgh, who, having invented a process for har-
dening leather for the construction of artificial limbs,
etc., made therefrom a German flute and a violin,
which are described as
"
not inferior to any con-
structed of wood."
Next in order come the various eccentricities of
shape, the application of various complications to the
beautiful simplicity of the violin, and the various in-
struments which have from time to time been intro-
duced, bearing eccentric arrangements and numbers
of strings.
Trumpet Violin.This was patented in 1854, in
Germany, by Ferdinand Hell, and in England by
W. E. Newton
(1854, Jan. 25 ; No. 186), and con-
sisted in adapting a horn or a trumpet to a violin, the
mouthpiece opening into the body of the instrument at
the point where the neck joins it, the tube running
down the neck under the finger-board, and the bell,
or mouth, taking the place of the scroll. It is said
not to have very much damaged the tone of the violin,
but it was very hideous, as may be supposed.
The Pear-shaped Violin, of A. Engleder, was
exhibited at Munich in the same year
(1854).
The
corners were abolished, the upper bouts contracted,
and the lower bouts expanded, to produce the desired
result. They were, it need hardly be said, a failure.
In 1862, at the London International Exhibition,
one Hulskamp, a German resident in New York,
exhibited a fiddle, the tables of which could, by a
mechanism inside the instrument, worked by a key,
be submitted to a regular tension to suit that of the
strings. The back and belly were quite flat, which
was considered an improvement on the score of
expense in construction. Instead of
ff
holes, this
fiddle had a round hole between the bridge and finger-
board. One foot of the bridge rested on the belly,
the other on a post set upon a rib glued to the back of
the fiddle, through a hole cut in the belly, so that the
latter was not touched by bridge or post. This last
arrangement seems to be based on the experiments of
Savart, referred to on page 210 ; the whole contrivance
received good opinions from some high authorities
(including Joachim, Laub, and Becker), but did not
last longer than the generality of such vagaries.
Five-stringed Violins, or rather combinations of
the violin and viola (i.e., tenors with a high E string
added, or violins with a low C string added), are
frequently to be found among the curiosities on a
fiddle-dealer's walls. M. Chanot made many of his
guitar-shaped violins (those compendia of curious
contrivances !) to mount with five strings, the size
being between that of a tenor and a fiddle. About
5
o6
VIOLIN-MAKING : AS IT WAS, AND IS.
the year 1840, a German, named Hillmer, introduced
such a
combination, and called it the
"
Violalin," it
was noticed in the "Allgemeine Musikalische Zeitung,"
1840, p. 245.
He had the audacity to call it an in-
vention, but of course, even if such a thing had not
been made over and over again already, it was only
reverting to the arrangement of the old violas, or viols>
which
were
mounted
with
five or six
strings.
One Prinz, in
a work written
in 1649,
tells us
that Lord So-
merset invented
a violin with
eight strings, to
which he attri-
buted extraor-
dinary advant-
ages. A M.
Urhan played
on such a fiddle
at a concert at
the Parisian
Conservatoire in
1830.
A rather curi-
ous instrument
must have been
the
"
Violon-
Gdneral," in-
vented by M.
Vincenti, a Flo-
rentine lute-
master, during
the first half of
this century. It
had eighteen
strings, and was
played on with
two bows, and
derived its name
from the fact
michael henry collins's echolin
(1879).
that, according to M. Vincenti, it combined the effects
of the violin, viola, violoncello, and violono.
A violin was presented to the Academie des
Sciences (also in the first half of this century) by
M. Isoard, the strings of which passed through two
blades. Instead of being played on with a bow, the
strings were vibrated at one end by means of a current
of air, whilst they were stopped by the fingers at the
other. Its tones were said to resemble the French
horn and the bassoon !
Wettengel (in his
"
Lehrbuch der Geigen und
Bogenmacherkunst," Weimar, 1869), mentions the
Violon-leiwr, invented by the elder Dubois (a Parisian
amateur), the four strings of which were tuned an
octave below those of a violin. The raison d'etre of
this instrument it is difficult to imagine, but as an idea
it is about as original as the Violalin of Herr Hillmer.
It was intended
to supersede
the viola, or act
as an interme-
diary between it
and the violon-
cello.
J.B.Vuillaume
introduced, in
1855,
a new
model for the
tenor, which was
much broader
and deeper, and
consequently
more difficult
to play than
that in ordinary
use. These in-
struments were
constructed on
scientific prin-
ciples, so that
the mass of
contained air
should give a
note of
341
"33
vibrations to
the second, giv-
ing the note F,
which is the
right scientific
proportion ac-
cording to the
discoveries of
Felix Savart.
They were tried
at the Brussels
Conservatoire, and their tone was found to be more
like that of a violin, and twice as powerful as that
of an ordinary viola, but they did not come into
universal use for the reasons given above.
Violins with the tipper and lower bouts of
the same
size, have been constructed by more than one experi-
mentalist. In 1808, we find a record of such a one,
with the bridge set in the centre; and in 181
1,
one
Jean Antoine Hoensel, luthier and chamber
musician
to M. le Due de Schcenburg, claimed attention for a
VIOLIN-MAKING : AS IT WAS, AND IS.
57
similar one, which he asserted to have been invented
by him in 1801.
In the year 1S00,
J. J.
Hawkins took out a patent
(No. 2446) for a violin, which had no sides or back,
but only a strong rib running beneath the belly, on
which was set the sound-post, which pressed up on the
belly by means of a spring. We are told that the
the century, produced various triangular fiddles with
arrangements of sympathetic strings for increasing the
sonority of the bowed strings by consonant vibration,
and also a structure with two sets of strings one above
the other, and so far distant as to allow either set to be
played upon by passing the bow between them. Of a
similar nature are the productions of other makers,
FIG. 6l.WILDE'S NAIL VIOLIN (1740).
PIG. 65. THE CHANOT VIOLIN (1817). FIG. 62.THOMAS HOWELL'S VIOLIN
(1833)
mere loudness of a fiddle was little impaired by this
ruinous proceeding, though even this is a matter for
considerable doubt ; at any rate, it is acknowledged
that the quality of tone was absolutely destroyed. I(
is said that he committed the vandalism of ruining a
valuable Stradiuarius by the application of his ridi-
culous contrivance. Fiat experimenlum in corpore
vilz, but spare the masterpieces of Cremona.
Mr. Davidson refers to the inventions of one Sin-
clair, a Scotch maker, who, at the commencement of
FIG. 67. THE CHANOT VIOLIN
(1819).
who, having time to experimentalize, have constructed
violins with double strings (like a mandoline), tuned
either in unison or octaves. A few years after the
above was born, another Scottish vagary, which was
a double violin, having one back, belly, and sides, but
two necks, bridges, tail-pieces, and sets of strings; it
has been described as a loud, harsh-toned instrument,
of little or no value, excepting as a curiosity.
In the year 1740, a German musician, named
Johann Wilde, living in St. Petersburg, invented
a
y
5
o8 VIOLIN-MAKING: AS IT WAS, AND IS.
curious instrument called a Nail-violin (in German,
Nagel-geige, nagel-harmonika, eisenvioline). Its in-
vention seems to have been accidental, for it is
thus described by Mr. Carl Engel :
"
One evening,
after returning home from a concert, Wilde, in hang-
ing his violin bow on a nail accidentally produced a
tone by drawing the hair of the bow over the metal,
whereupon he conceived the idea of constructing a
musical instrument of nails. And that he has suc-
ceeded in producing a fine-toned, if not a practically
recommendable instrument, will probably be granted
by all who draw the large black-haired bow over the
iron pins. The bow is best made with black hair, for
white hair is softer, and does not
'
bite ' so well for
such an iron fiddle. It must also be plentifully sup-
plied with resin to make it bite well." It was held in
the left hand by a hole underneath. Mr. Engel gives
a figure of it, which I reproduce, Fig. 61. In 1780 it
was improved by the addition of sympathetic strings,
when Senal, an artist of Vienna, excelled upon it.
The nails diminish in length as the notes get higher,
and the chromatic nails are slightly bent. In 1791,
one Trager produced an arrangement of it, worked by
keys, called nagel clavier. It is interesting as a
curiosity in the way of bow instruments.
In the South Kensington Museum, and figured and
fully described in the catalogue thereof, is a most
curious violin, made of boxwood, dated 1578. It is of
a queer and cumbrous shape, being in the form of a
wedge, which narrows at the thick end to a sort of
neck, which is formed by a round hole to admit the
hand, the shift being thus rendered impossible. It is
carved all over with various rural and allegorical
scenes, and, as may be supposed, the tone is very poor.
It is described by Hawkins and Burney in their
Histories of Music; the latter describes it as having
no more tone than a mute or violin with a sordine.
"
It is said to have been given to the Earl of Leicester
by Queen Elizabeth, and has both their coats of arms
in silver on the finger-board. It is, perhaps, one of the
most interesting fiddles (if it can be so called) in
existence.
In 1835,
Thomas Howell took out a patent (No.
694)
for a new form of violin, which is represented at
Fig. 62. Its object was, by shortening the upper bouts
and lengthening the finger-board, to facilitate playing in
the upper shifts, and obviating
"
that inelegance of ac-
tion which is so much complained of, even in the most
expert performers." The back and belly were flat, the
tail-piece glued to the instrument, to be
"
out of the
way of the chin," and the sound holes reverted to
the form in vogue in the fifteenth century.
In 1S56 a clergyman (the Rev. George Jacque)
took out a patent (No. 1684) for adapting to the violin,
and enclosing within it a series of sympathetic strings,
set obliquely across the interior of the instrument.
They could be taken out, tuned, and replaced by an
opening in the lower bouts. He thought in this way
to increase the sonority of the instrument.
In 1858, one Henry Bell patented a design (No.
2823) for applying a flattened glass cylinder to the
interior of a violin with the same object.
In the same year (No.
2587) John Robertson
patented a device for increasing the tone of violins by
grooving out the soft part of the pine of the belly,
so as to leave only the fibres standing out. He thought
that in this way the vibratory surface would be in-
creased, and the fiddle thereby improved.
In 1866, Henry Bell, the patentee of the last con-
trivance but one, took out another patent (No. 2071)
for increasing and improving the tone of fiddles by
placing in them a sheet of crystal or glass, with a hole
through it to admit the sound-post. It was about as
successful as his first contrivance.
In the year 1879, Michael Henry Collins, an
American, took out an English patent (No. 2118) for
a fiddle, which he termed an Echolin. The body was
quite circular, and inclosed inside a domed case A,
which had a circular hole b in the middle to admit the
bridge, which rested on the circular belly, and was
formed like a violoncello bridge. Space forbids my
going into the theory of this instrument here ; it is
represented in plan by Fig.
63,
and in elevation and
in section in Fig. 64. The bass bar was curved
as at C, and the sound-post was replaced by a
heavy mechanism which hung to the left side of the
belly as at D. The neck had a protuberance E corre-
sponding to the shoulder in the ordinary form, and
another opening F for the high shifts. It was held by a
chin rest G, and was fitted with patent pegs, which
are represented in Fig. 65. The diagram explains
itself. The string is tuned by turning A, an ordinary
thumb-piece ; when the string is tuned, the screw c
is turned by the milled head, B presses the plate D
against the cheek of the scroll E, and prevents the peg
from slipping.
Two years later
(1879,
No. 3022) one Howell
patented a most curious instrument, the strings of
which were set along the side, the neck being formed
by a long hole in the side to admit the hand ; in its
way it was interesting, and especially so to acousti-
cians, who could thus test the results of the vibrations
of the strings being transmitted longitudinally to the
fibres of the wood, instead of vertically. He patented
several modifications of the instrument on the same
principle.
Still more lately (1881, No. 621) E. R. Mollen-
hauer, of New York, obtained protection for a design
for dividing the inside of the fiddle into two chambers,
by means of a fiddle-shaped plank resting on a sup-
VIOLIN-MAKING : AS IT WAS, AND IS.
59
plementary side-lining, set round the centre of the
ribs. He claimed by this means to increase the
sonority of the instrument. Comment is needless.
Enough of these minor vagaries. If necessary, I
could fill a thick quarto with them. Such as they are,
they are interesting and beneficial as warnings ; it re-
mains only to notice two intelligent and scientific experi-
ments (I will not insult them by calling them vagaries).
I allude to the guitar-shaped violin of Mr. Francois
Chanot, and the trapezoid violin of M. le Docteur
Felix Savart, to whom the world of violins owes so
much for his valuable and devoted scientific researches
into the forms and qualities of the Cremonese and
other violins.
Guitar-shaped Fiddles have been made in all
countries and all ages, since the invention of the fiddle
proper in the sixteenth century. M. Gallay in his
"
Luthiers Italiens," mentions the interesting fact that
M. de Chanot (brother of the naval officer mentioned
below) had once in his hands a violin by Stradivarius,
which was guitar-shaped, and had a flat belly. I have
myself seen such, the work of Peter Walmsley, Ben-
jamin Banks, and other of our native makers. It is
a reversion to mediaevalism, which is, to say the least
of it, feeble and unimportant.
In the year 1832, Carlo Antonio Galbusera, an
Italian officer, exhibited in the Brera Palace at Milan,
a violin of a guitar shape, which he claimed to have
invented, but which was really a reproduction of M.
Chanot's essay. He prepared his wood by chemical
means, by which he claimed to get all the resinous
particles out of it. They were criticised and argued
against by M. Antolini in a pamphlet entitled,
"
Osser-
vazzione su due Violini espceti nelle sale dell' I R
Palazzo di Brera" (Milan) 1832.
The most celebrated instruments having this form
were the violins of M. Francois Chanot, a French
naval officer, and uncle of M. Georges Chanot, of
Wardour Street, to whom I am indebted for much
valuable aid in the production of this work. M.
Chanot would seem to have commenced with the
same line of scientific consideration as M. Felix
Savart in the construction of his trapezoid violin, to
which I shall presently allude.
These violins were very favourably pronounced
upon by a council of the Academy, appointed to
consider their merits, and, indeed, preferred to a
masterpiece of Cremona with which they were com-
paredthe instruments being alternately played in an
adjoining room by M. Boucher, the eminent violinist.
M. Fetis, on the other hand, stigmatizes them as not
worth ten francs apiece, excepting as curiosities, and
a musical critic in the
"
Allgemeine Musikalische Zei-
tung," Vol. xxxii., for February, 1820, finds considerable
fault with their tone. However, for a few years they
found a market, being sold at 300 francs each, and in
late years M. Georges Chanot tells me they have
realised ,10 to collectors. These violins may be seen
at this gentleman's shop in Wardour Street, they are
made in light-coloured wood, and specimens of both
kinds, as represented in Figs. 66 and
67, may be
seen. Their tone is poor and unsatisfactory. Fig.
66 represents the first form in which they were
introduced in 1817 ; it will be observed that the
corners are abandoned, which produces the guitar
shape, the edges do not overlap the sides, but end flush
with them in a rim of ivory, or hard wood, like a guitar.
The sound-holes are openings following the outline, of
the same length as the_/_/ holes of the ordinary form,
but following the curvature of the sides (to which they
are set rather close), they take the form of a segment
of a circle. The reason assigned for this was that in
cutting the ordinary/ form, a large number of fibres
had to be cut through, and were therefore no longer
affected by the vibrations of the bridge. The new
form claimed the merit of reducing these cut fibres to
a minimum, and of producing a maximum of long
fibres. It had been determined by experiment that
the low notes of a fiddle were principally produced by
the long fibres, and the high notes by the short fibres
(and it is on this principle that the sound-post, by
pressing upon the belly against the bridge divides the
violin into two sets of short fibres on the side on
which the high notes are produced, whilst on the other
side, on which the low notes are produced, the fibres
are intact throughout the length of the instrument).
For when the fibres under the low strings were
similarly divided (by shifting the sound-post to the
left foot of the bridge), the low notes lost all their
power. M. Chanot claimed for his violin the merit,
therefore, of having more long fibres to produce the
low notes, and more short ones to produce the high
ones. The bass bar is set as in Savart's fiddle, down
the exact centre on the join of the belly. Close to the
tail-pin will be seen a screw, which, passing through
the tail-piece and pressing on the belly, enabled the
tail-piece to be raised, so as to lessen the angle
formed by the strings passing over the bridge, and
lessen the pressure on the belly at this point. A simi-
lar contrivance to this was patented in England by
one Claggett, in 1788. Passing through the back of
the fiddle was a screw, which, acting on the sound-
post, enabled the 'pressure of this latter, against the
belly, to be regulated at will. M. Chanot at first pro-
posed to place frets upon the finger-board, but aban-
doned this design on the suggestion of the Council.
Two years later (in
1819), M. Chanot discarded,
in Fig. 67,
the tail-piece and tail-pin, and the strings
were fastened by pins to two plates of wood, one glued
outside and the other inside the belly, like the string
Sio THE MANUFACTURE OF NUTS FOR MODEL ENGINES.
attachment of a guitar. The bar was removed from
the centre join, shaped like an arc, the centre of which
was under the left foot of the bridge, and whose ends
approached the centre join. The sound-post was set
in front of instead of behind the bridge. The volute
of the scroll was turned back instead of forward, as
is usual, to give greater facility in manipulating the
ends of the strings inside the peg-box. His memorial
on the subject was read to the Academie des Sciences
on the 24th of May, 1817.
A full description of it may be found in the
"
Description des Machines et Proce'de's Specific's dans
les Brevets d'Invention," Tome xv., p. 161 : Paris, 1828.
And a report of its trial before the Council of the
Academy may be found in the
"
Moniteur Universel,"
22 Aout, 1817.
{To be continued.)
THE MANUFACTURE OF NUTS FOR MODEL
ENGINES.
By JAMES FERNLEY.
N all probability, like myself, many an
amateur has been greatly troubled about
the making of small nuts and bolt heads
for their model engines. There is nothing
that makes a model look so nice as care-
fully-made nuts and bolts ; but a model, otherwise well
and carefully made, is quite spoilt in appearance by the
nuts being badly finished and out of shape. I will
in this short paper do my best to help any amateur
model- engine maker out of his difficulty by showing
ones round iron is used. The wire or iron, as the
case may be, is cut into lengths of about
4
inches, and
must be well straightened if at all bent in cutting.
In Fig. 1 is shown a drill chuck of the ordinary
pattern, that I generally use for making these small
nuts. A is the body of
chuck ; B is a collet
that is fitted in to the
body, and then drilled
to take different sizes of
wire ; C is the set screw,
which springs the collet
upon the work and holds
it secure. In the end
view it will be seen
that the collet is sawn
through to the centre,
this allows of a certain
amount of spring, which
is necessary in order to
clamp the work.
Having given a de-
tailed description of the
chuck, I will now pro-
ceed with the method of making the nuts.
Take a 4-inch length of wire, straighten and file it
up to a hexagon, draw file it, and polish lengthwise
with emery cloth.
Now place it in the chuck, letting it project about
f
fhs of an inch, set the lathe going, and bring up the
cutting centre to the work. This will give a centre
for the drill to start in. Drill as deeply as possible,
say
i
inch, with drill of proper size to allow for tap-
ping ; then, with a tap of proper size, cut the thread
fig.
2.
bevelling
edge of nut.
FIG. I. DRILL CHUCK FOR MAKING SMALL NUTS.
the various plans I have made use of in fashioning
these nuts. Some of these plans, perhaps, will be
old to some of my readers, but I am inclined to
think that a description of them will help many who
are just beginning this kind of work.
For small nuts, as used in models, iron wire of
suitable diameter is the most handy material, for larger
for a depth a little more than that of the nut when
finished.
Now bevel off the edge A in Fig. 2, this will be the
top of nut, and cut off to proper size, taking care that
the cut adjoining the finished nut is at right angles to
the wire. The nut is now finished ; the wire should
be brought out fths of an inch as at starting, and the
THE MANUFACTURE OF NUTS FOR MODEL ENGINES. 5"
same performance gone
through
; if the hole is not
deep enough for another
nut it will form a centre for
starting the drill, so that
once started the nuts are
quickly made.
In Fig.
3 is shown
another method I have often
made use of. Get a piece
of stout sheet metal, mark
off a hexagon. At each
angle, and also in the
centre, drill and tap holes
same size as the nuts are
to be, screw into each hole
a stud and rivet over on the
underside, letting it project
above the plate enough to
n
i
A
B B
A
3
jfi.
FIG. 4. CONTRIVANCE FOR CUTTING NUTS WITH
CIRCULAR CUTTERS ON MANDREL.
M
.'
=sA
<\
V
ra
SL
t==
/
b
rrh
n_
loo
]
tPrHiEP
W~pti^
1
FIG. 5.DIAGRAM
SHOWING METHOD
OF CUTTING NUTS
BY AID OF CUTTING
FRAME, ETC.
I
take two nuts. The plate
will now have the appear-
ance of Fig.
3,
which
shows the nuts in place.
Screw into these studs
your roughly-shaped nuts,
taking care to screw up
tight to prevent shifting,
and when all are screwed
on proceed to file them up.
It will easily be seen that
each nut forms a guide for
the file, and if you are
careful to file all equal, they
will be perfectly hexagonal.
H shows the file in position
in the sides e, f, g.
It is not advisable to put
more than two nuts on
each stud, as the pressure
of the file would most
I I
M.
1 1
O W
~
C7 O
FIC 3.MANUFACTURE OF STUDS WITH ULE IN PIECE OF PIERCED SHEET 1
SI2
HOW TO BUILD A SMALL
HARMONIUM.
likely bend them, and so cause the nuts to be out of
shape.
The next method I am now going to describe
will require some more costly tools, but the work done
in that manner is more accurate, and it will amply
repay the amateur for the little trouble it costs him to
make one. It will be as well to make the mandrel A,
Fig.
4,
rather stout, as it works steadier. I have
made the drawings to scale, half full size, so that they
may be used as working drawings, b b are two
circular cutters that slide on mandrel A, they are
separated by washers cwashers of different sizes, of
course, being used for each size of nut to be made.
The cutters and washer are firmly locked against the
collar H by a f-inch nut, D. E is a hexagonal man-
drel, made of a piece of |-inch hexagon steel, about
5-inch long. A f-inch hole is tapped in the end, into
which must be screwed the holders for nuts, these
being brought up to the cutters by the cross feed of
the slide-rest. When the first cut is taken the man-
drel E should be turned round to rest on the adjoin-
ing face, and another cut taken. It is necessary that
the centre of the mandrel E should come exactly
between the two cutters ; and to save the trouble of
having to adjust it for each fresh cut, I screw two
small pins in the top of the slide-rest for the edge of
the mandrel to bear against, as shown at F and G.
For shaping a number of nuts at a time, the fol-
lowing is the method I generally adopt : The roughly-
formed pieces of metal that are to be accurately
shaped are first drilled and tapped, and then slipped
on a mandrel made as per sketch, in which a b
represents the mandrel. A thread is cut on it the
whole length, then the centre part of the thread is
turned off. A nut is first slipped on it at A, then the
rest are screwed over the threaded portion at B, and
slipped along to A. When full, a nut at B secures the
lot. This mandrel is put between the centres of the
lathe, and a few light cuts are taken along the whole
length with a flat edged cutter. The division plate is
then moved round Jth of a revolution, and another cut
taken. When the six sides are finished they are taken
off and another lot done. They are finished by bevelling
off the top edge and turning the underneath side flat.
If the mandrel be long or extra slender, it will be
found necessary to put some packing behind, or else
the pressure of the cutter against the work at the
centre would cause it to bend, and thus spoil it.
For Fig.
5 I think but little explanation will be
required. The partly-shaped nut is placed in the
chuck, as shown at a. The cutters are then brought
up to it, and a cut taken ; the division plate is then
moved round
fcth
of a revolution and another cut
taken, then one more cut and the nut is finished.
It will be seen that there are two cutters, b and c
;
if only one was used it might unscrew the nut, but
the addition of an extra cutter prevents this. The
nut may now be bevelled off on the front edge, and
then turned and faced off underneath. This will be
found a very handy method for those possessing a
cutter frame.
Before bringing my remarks to a conclusion, I beg
to say that I have tried all the methods that I have
described above, and found them to answer well. If
there is anything else in model-engine making about
which any reader of this paper may find himself in
difficulty, if he will kindly let me know, I will, with
the Editor's permission, do my best to help him.
HOW TO BUILD A SMALL HARMONIUM.
By THOMAS MAIN,
II. The Interior of the Instrument.
HE foot-boards may be made of one inch
deal, hinged on the underside of the
front edge to the foundation-board
already mentioned, and connected from
the top by a cord to the lever arm, which
is fixed into an axle working on centres in two up-
rights placed at the front and back of the inside of the
case. Another arm extends from the other side of
this axle immediately under the centre of the feeder,
to which it is connected by a short lug. The general
view in Part 8 will, I think, sufficiently explain this,
the axle there being shown in section only. The
foot-boards should have a ledge of
j
inch stuff on the
front edge, and they may be covered with a piece of
carpet to make them look neat.
The reservoir having been completed, should now
be fastened with glue to the reservoir-board, which has
previously been referred to. This board lays on the top
of the two wind trunks, which should have a strip of
leather run all round the top edges to make all air-tight.
The holes in the reservoir-board over the wind-
trunks must be covered with leather valves to open
upwards, made in a similar manner to those in the
feeders. These valves are to prevent the return of
the wind after it has been pumped into the wind-chest.
A small hole, 4 inches long and 1 inch wide, is cut in
the centre of the reservoir-board to let the wind into
the reservoir, and if this is covered with a wood valve
lined with leather, so that it may be closed by pulling
out a stop knob, you will then have the stop termed
"
Expression," but if you do not wish for this stop
1. It is cheap.
2. It is easy to make.
3. It is easy to work.
4. It can be put up and taken down within half an
hour.
5. It can be put up in any room of moderate dimen-
sions.
6. It does not damage the walls, etc., of any room
in which it is placed.
Many houses are built with that combination of
back and front drawing-room, which reduces the
erection of a stage simply to the construction of a
cross-beam carrying a curtain, and a row of footlights.
There may or may not exist folding doors, if such are
in being, it is only necessary to screw a cross-beam,
carrying a curtain to the tops of these, which simple
operation will be more fully described when we
approach the consideration of the various forms and
actions of curtains. If there are no folding doors, or
if instead of a front and back drawing-room, only one
long room is at your disposal, it will be necessary to
erect a cross-beam to carry the curtain or curtains, as
described further on. Figs. 1 and 2 represent respec-
tively a front and back drawing-room, and a long
room arranged for private theatricals. Both these
figures are divided, as will be seen, into stage and
auditorium. In Fig. 1 the usual arrangement of doors
and windows is shown, and unless the architecture of
the house differs from this, it will be seen that the
entrances to the stage and auditorium, and communi-
cation with the dressing-rooms, are quite clear and
convenient. It is but seldom that amateurs have
more than one exit by which they can get away, the
opposite exit, like the left hand one in Fig. 1, being
only into the corner. The arrangement of a long
room, as in Fig. 2, requires more science, and it is to
this that I propose chiefly to turn my attention. The
stage must of course be at the door end. The open-
ings on the right hand side of Fig. 2 are generally
windows, but if one be a door it is good, as it can be
utilised either as an entrance for the audience, or
another entrance and exit for the stage. As a rule,
however, the door of such a room is as at C. In this
case the two uprights and cross-beam forming the pro-
scenium, must be set up just below the door, as at
B B, only the left hand upright must be sufficiently far
from the wall, a, to enable the audience to come
through the door c, into the auditorium by the open-
ing D. This opening is covered when the audience
are seated, as set down further on.
In the construction of the amateur theatre no nail
ought to exist. Everything must be screwed, so as to be
taken to pieces and put together again as often as you
like. The proscenium, as seen by the audience, may
be either composed of painted canvas, or otherwise, as
your own taste or fancy may suggest. Such a pro-
scenium, however, as is represented by Fig.
3,
can be
formed of any spare curtains, etc., there may be in the
5
2
4
THE AMATEUR ACTORS' PORTABLE THEATRE.
house, without hurting them in the least. The prin-
ciple of the construction of the proscenium is ex-
plained by Fig.
7,
and consists of two uprights A A,
connected at the top by a cross-beam B B. If your
room is that shown by Fig. I, the ends need only be
long enough to be rested on the tops of the folding
doors, or, in their absence, to reach the walls, or
framework which divides the two rooms, to which
they may be fixed, either by the woodwork already
there, or to two brackets screwed to the wall, as at D,
Fig. 8. If your room is a long one, as in Fig. 2,
with the door through which the audience must pass
being, as at C, Fig. 2, also the entry for performers, the
left-hand upright must be 4 feet from the wall A, and
that end of the cross-beam B, Fig. 7,
extended to that
wall. The proscenium may, if desired, be strengthened
by struts D, D, Fig.
7,
in which case they must be
hidden by the top curtains, Fig. 3. Now as to the
method of fixing up this frame in a room, as at Fig. 2,
this may be done in two wayseither by fixing to the
side-walls at each end of B, B, Fig.
7,
a small solid
wooden bracket, like D, Fig. 8, to which the ends B, B
are screwed ; if you have picture rods round the room
the ends B, B may be perforated and lashed to the rods
instead, or you may adopt the (to my mind) better
method of fixing shown by Fig. 8. From each up-
right of the proscenium B B, to the back wall of the
stage, there run laths, a
1
a
1
,
which are attached to the
proscenium by hooks (or screws), and at the back to
brackets D, or to the tops of any windows or doors
which are generally found at the end of a long room,
or to picture rods if they exist. The framework
being secured to these, will be perfectly secure ; it is
always as well to fix to the bottom of each upright a
block of wood c, Fig. 8, with a perpendicular hole in
it, through which a large brass-headed nail goes into
the floor. It need not be driven home, indeed it is
not absolutely necessary
; and if there is any question
of spoiling the carpet it may be dispensed with, but
really it does no damage to the carpet to be just per-
forated in two places once a year, and proves an extra
security to your rather flimsy structure.
Such, then, is the erection of your proscenium
;
hardly any two houses being similar in construction,you
may have to alter a little, but with these guiding prin-
ciples, anyone clever enough to play a part can build
himself a stage to play it in. The frame being set up,
the next thing is to drape it. This, as I have said
before, may be effected as in Fig. 3 without any detri-
ment to the material used, by lashing the curtains to
the cross-beam. If, however, they are old and useless,
they may be tacked to the frame for better security.
The draperies must fall to the ground, and extend
quite from wall to wall, covering the opening D, Fig. 2.
The door c will, of course, open inwards
;
when the
audience are ready to enter, let the door C be opened
at right angles, and, the curtain being drawn inwards
from D, let it be hitched over the door so as to form a
little rectangular passage, which hides the stage, and
through which the auditorium is reached ;
when all
are seated, the curtain is dropped again across the
opening D, and the door C is cleared for the actors.
The next question is that of curtains. These are
either, to draw apart, as in Fig.
4,
to tuck up, as in
Fig.
5,
or (what is better than either) to roll up, as in
Fig. 6. The final curtain, or
"
green," may follow any
of these methods, but a painted cloth, or act-drop
must always roll, for obvious reasons. Whatever
method is adopted, the entire control must be concen-
trated at the prompt side. This, in amateur stages, is
whichever side there is room for that important person.
To draw apart and close, as in Fig.
4,
requires two
pair of ropes, the first pair consisting of one drawing
the curtain nearest the ropes towards the puller, and
one passing along the top and round by the other end
to the centre, to pull the further curtain away from the
puller ; the second pair of ropes will be arranged in
an exactly inverse manner, their object being to draw
the two curtains from the sides to the centre. The
curtains are hung by rings on to two rods, which just
overlap each other in the middle, so as to effect a good
join of the two curtains. Have a separate pulley (as
at Fig. 13) for each rope at each point, for the deadly
peculiarity of this form of curtain is that consequently
on a "jumble" of the ropes they frequently stick half
way ; and a dreadful anecdote is told of an amateur
performance of
"
Ours
"
whose second act closed in
this way, which necessitated the heroine rising from
her faint, and exewit omnes, individually longing for
an instantaneous earthquake. This danger is obviated
when the curtain is constructed to ruck, as in Fig.
5.
To effect this, the curtain has stitched upon it in ver-
tical rows, at distances of i to 2^ feet, curtain rings.
At the bottom of each column of rings is attached a
cord, which, passing through the whole row, goes
through a pulley at the top to another at the side,
whence it descends to the prompter's hand. For each
column of rings there is a rope and corresponding
pulleys, so that if the curtain is broad, the prompter
has (actually, not metaphorically) his hands full. At
the bottom of each column of rings there must be
stitched a good heavy piece of lead, to weight the cur-
tain down to the floor, otherwise, stopping six inches
before the floor is reached, an exit of visible feet will
considerably mar a good denouement. After all, the
simplest and most effective curtain is that which rolls
up from the bottom, as in Fig. 6. This requires only
two pulleys at the pulling end and one at the other, as
in Fig. 14. It is so arranged that when the roller
1
which forms the lower border of the cloth is on the
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
525
floor the cords are rolled round the ends of the roller,
either on reels (as in the figure) or without. When
the ropes are pulled these cords unwind, and the cur-
tain rolls up neatly with the minimum of unsightliness
and the minimum of anxiety to the person in charge.
Such a curtain is tacked to a beam which carries its
pulleys, as in Fig. 14. The curtain to ruck is fixed in
a similar manner to a beam, which beams are fixed to
strong double brackets, C C C, Fig.
13,
which are
screwed to the upright, or cross-beam, represented by
B B
1
. A A represent the pairs of pulleys. Space
{arbiter seriptorum) bids me go on to the final ques-
tion of lighting. The above directions will, I hope,
enable the amateur to build himself a stage and erect
his curtains in a simple and inexpensive, and at the
same time highly effective manner. It will be observed
no set measurements are given
;
these would be im-
possible, as each amateur stage-carpenter must suit
his figures to his room and material.
The principal charm of the amateur stage is the
lighting, the auditorium being kept as dark as possible
;
this is effected by means of foot-lights, side-lights, and
top-lights, each of which correct the too violent
shadows which would be produced by the use of only
one of them. Foot-lights, which may either be lamps
or candles, as in Figs. 10 and 12, are set along a
board, a, a', as in Fig.
9,
and hidden from the audience
by a tin reflector to each light, or a board, as at a, a in
Figs. 10 and 11, which serves also the purpose of a
reflector to intensify and direct the rays of light. This
board should be painted black on one side, and lined
with bright tin on the side facing the stage, and
should be set at a slight angle by means of a hinge, B,
as in Fig. 10, to throw the light up to the faces of the
actors. The best light is, of course, gas, which is
almost impossible to fit to a private room, after which
comes lamps, as in Fig. 10, which have the objection
of expense and inconvenience in working. The best
light for amateurs is, after all, candles, surrounded by
glass chimneys, as in Fig. 12, which are fixed as
follows. Hammer through your board, at stated inter-
vals, from the other side, nails long enough to stick up
about
1
J inches. Bore a hole with a hot bradawl at the
bottom of each candle, so that it sticks straight up on
its respective nail. Take three strips of stout tin and
bend them in the shape shown at Fig.
15, and at a
1
,
Fig. 11. Bend them so as to have a foot at the
bottom of each, and set them round the nail to receive
the chimney, as in Figs. 11 and 15. These chimneys
may be got at about one penny each at any fairly
wholesale glass shop. If the strips of bent tin do not
hold them firm, tie rings of wire round strips and
chimney to hold them together. Side-lights and top-
lights are built as at Fig.
15,
the reflector (which also
serves in the case of top-lights, as protection to the
ceiling) being composed of a sheet of tin bent to shape.
Make these about a foot long to carry three or four
candles, and screw two such sets to the cross-beam for
top-lights, and two on each side of the stage, on
brackets on the walls of the room, about seven feet
from the floor. The question of side and top-lights
must necessarily accommodate itself to your room
;
the golden rule being, have as many as possible, and
wherever practicable. If it is desired, on some future
occasion, I shall be happy to give further directions
as to amateur stage-carpentry, scenery, etc.
NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
HE majority of articles that demand notice
this month are books and trade cata-
logues, and to these publications I have
much pleasure in calling the attention of
the readers of this magazine, for all are
interesting and instructive, although amateurs, in all
probability, will be inclined to value one more highly
than another, each in accordance with his own peculiar
bent and bias.
From Messrs. Crosby Lockwood and Co.,
7,
Sta-
tioners' Hall Court, Ludgate Hill, I have received two
volumes, one of which assuredly no amateur should
be without. The little book to which I am alluding,
a perfect gem in its way, beautifully and clearly
printed, and very nicely got up and finished, is a
waistcoat-pocket companion, entitled,
"
Tables, Memo-
randa, and Calculated Results for Mechanics, Engi-
neers, Architects, Builders, Surveyors, etc.," selected
and arranged by Francis Smith ;
or, in briefer terms,
''
Smith's Tables." Though barely i\ inches long,
if
inches broad, and \ inch thick, this compact little
vade mecum, bound in roan with rounded corners and
thickly gilt edges, contains 226 pages of memoranda
on every possible subject on which any one engaged
in any department of the building trade, or in almost
any mechanical trade, may require carefully tabulated
statistical and numerical information at a pinch.
Apparently every necessary subject is touched on and
nothing omitted, and, to show the variety and wide
scope of the information given, instructions are given
on the mode of making knots and splices, profusely
illustrated with small but very clear explanatory
engravings. The cost of this book is no more than
is. 6d. It would tend to its better preservation if an
elastic band were passed over it to keep it closely
shut when not in use ;
but any purchaser can add this
for himself. The other book sent by Messrs. Lock-
wood and Co. is
"
Practical Organ Building," by
W. E. Dickson, M.A., Precentor of Ely Cathedral.
;26 NOTES ON NOVELTIES.
This work, which has reached a second edition, affords
reliable information on everything relating to this sub-
ject, in which many amateurs take so profound an
interest, and the illustrations leave nothing to be
desired. A chapter is devoted to the construction of
two-manual organs, and a new and supplementary
chapter has been added on
"
Village Church Organs,"
which cannot fail to be acceptable to those who may
be seeking to purchase a small organ for a country
church, and desire a few hints as to its design and
erection. Much is said about wooden and metal
pipes, their construction and regulation. This book
forms No.
235
of Weale's Rudimentary Series. It
contains 182 pages and
57
illustrations, including an
excellent design for the front elevation of a two-
manual organ with eight stops, in the frontispiece, and
may be purchased for 2s. 6d. By the way, I may take
the opportunity of reminding my readers that in the
next part of this magazine will be commenced a new
series of articles on
f
Organ Building," from the pen
of Mr. Mark Wicks, in the first of which he will
describe his method of making organ pipes of a
material more easily dealt with than either wood or
metal, and whose prime cost is so little that it reduces
the expense of making pipes to a mere trifle.
I mentioned not long ago Messrs. Charles Churchill
and Co.'s new
"
Illustrated Catalogue of American
Tools and Machinery." Of this another and smaller
edition, measuring 5i inches by
4i
inches and
j
inch
thick, has been produced from the larger edition by
means of photo-lithography. It is, therefore, an abso-
lute fac-simile of the larger one, containing (like the
larger one) 160 pages, and is not a selection only from
the larger catalogue, as was the first
"
Amateur Cata-
logue" that Messrs. Churchill and Co. published. I
must not omit to say that the small catalogue of which
I am writing costs 6d. Messrs. Churchill and Co.
have now taken possession of their new and commo-
dious premises at 20, Cross Street, Finsbury, where
they will be pleased to exhibit their tools and
machinery to any amateur who may wish to inspect
_them. Notices of catalogues received from Messrs.
Hamley and Co., and Messrs. Marion and Co., and
other articles, are unavoidably defeired till next month.
I have received from Messrs. Henry
J.
Martin and
Co., Douglas Road, Cork, a compact and handy little
box containing specimens of the Metal-bodied Rubber
Type manufactured by them, and the various appli-
ances necessary for its use. This is an article which
should be found in every family, and, indeed, in the
hands of every individual, for there must be few indeed
who cannot turn the box and its contents to good
account. This firm manufactures and supplies many
varieties of type for family and office use, in different
quantities, according to the requirements of the pur-
chasers, but both quantities and prices can best be
ascertained from the catalogue issued by the firm,
which, I trust I am correct in saying, will be for-
warded to any address on receipt of a penny stamp to
clear cost of postage. The cost of the various outfits,
according to the price-list that I have, range from 7s.
to 3SS. ; but these include forty collections, differing
from each other in the quantity of type supplied
and the case in which it is sent out, so that there is
ample room for choice as regards both personal
requirements and the pocket. The box now before
me contains five rows of type, including capitals,
small letters, types for punctuation, and metal spaces,
neatly arranged in a wooden rack, a pair of tweezers
for taking the type from and replacing it in the rack, a
type-holder in nickel silver, a small bottle of ink, and
two pads for the distribution of the ink and its appli-
cation to the surface of the type. The modus operandi
is as follows :
The initials of a name, or the letters
of any word or words that it is desired to impress on
linen, paper, etc., are taken from the rack by the
tweezers and arranged in due order according to direc-
tions given, in the type-holder. Any void space is
then filled up with metal spaces, and the whole locked
tightly together by the action of a screw with a milled
head at one end of the type-holder. Some ink is then
placed on one of the pads which is covered with
glazed cambric, and this is rubbed over the face of the
other, by which means the ink is distributed over the
entire surface. The surface of the second pad is then
touched twice or thrice with the type with a gentle
pressure, and the type, now sufficiently inked, is
applied with a firm but light touch to the surface to
be marked. The result is all that can be desired,
exhibiting a sharp, clear, but delicate, impression of
the letters that are in use. The types most commonly
supplied are a fancy letter consisting of large and
small capitals, a neat script, and a clear and well-cut
black letter, or old English letter, all of which are
available for printing on linen, on visiting cards, or in
books, etc. In addition to these are a great variety of
other kinds of type and figures, with type-holders of
different sizes, and automatic numbering stamps for
consecutive numbering. I do not find any mention
made of crests, monograms, etc., in Messrs. Martin
and Co.'s catalogue, but I am inclined to think that if
these could be supplied to order at a fairly moderate
price, for affixing the owner's imprint to linen, books,
etc., their manufacture would form a large and lucra-
tive branch of this business. I hope I may be per-
mitted to express a hope that this industry may
flourish because it is an Irish industry, and that it is
in the extension and encouragement of manufactures
of all kinds in Ireland that the future welfare and
prosperity of Ireland chiefly depends.
AMA TEURS IN CO UNCIL.
527
AMATEURS IN COUNCIL.
[The Editor reserves to himself the right of re-
fdsirga reply to any question that may be frivolous
or inappropriate, or devoid of general interest.
Correspondents are requested to bear in mind that
their queries will be answered only in the pages of
ihe Magazine, the information sought being sup-
plied for the benedt of its readers generally as well
as fox those who have a special interest in uDtaining
it. In no case can any reply be sent by post.]
% TO MY HEADERS.On the com-
pletion of this, the First Volume of Ama-
teur Work, Illustrated, a few
words, ex cathedra, on some matters of
importance immediately connected with,
and bearing on, the past and future of the
Magazine, will not be considered inap-
propriate or out of place.
iv The Nature
of
ihe Magazine.As
now and then it is asked when and in how
many Parts Amateur Work, Illus-
trated, nill be completed, it is desirable
to say here once and for all that it is not
a work which, like
"
Every Man His Own
Mechanic," is intended to be brought to
a close in a certain fixed number of Parts,
but that it is, in every sense of the word, a
Magazine, to be continued from month
to month, and from year to year, as long
as a demand exists for it. It is designed
to supply information to the amateur
worker on the modes and means of
carrying out constructive processes in
every department of mechanical art and
science. Knowledge of every kind, both
practical and theoretical, is daily in-
creasing in the present time, and as
long as any desire is evinced by amateurs
for instruction in Constructive and Artistic
Work, so long will Amateur Work,
Illustrated, within whose scope it
falls to give such instruction, continue
to appear.
2. Subjects yet Incomplete. Every series
of papers that has been commenced in
Volume I., and which as yet is incom-
plete, will be continued and brought to a
conclusion in Volume II. The necessity
of giving as much variety as possible to
the contents of each Part in succession, by
dealing with as many subjects as possible,
has chiefly tended to bring about this
result. Want of punctuality in furnishing
copy, according to promise, has been exhi-
bited in one case only. In another case
circumstances over which human power
has no controlI allude to the illness
and regretted death of Mr. Dunman
Ed.]
Inspection of Violins.
A. H. T. (Newport, Mon.).Mr. HilL
or any good maker, would examine your
violin and report on it. We cannot make
arrangements with any maker to do so
for all comers.
Organ Building.
Diapason sends the following list of
articles, and their prices, supplied by
Mr. ]. Dresser, 181, Albert Road, Aston,
Birmingham , trusting that it may be of
service to amateurs engaged in organ
building: Prepared sheep skins, 3s. 3d.
per skin ; stopper handles, 3s. 6d. per
doz.
;
pipe feet, 2s. 6d. per doz.
;
pallet
springs, 5s. per set ; tapped wires, 2S. per
gross ; roller studs, bushed, 2s. per doz.
;
brass tuning cones, 3s. 6d. each j leather
discs for securing silent action, 8d. per
100 ; leather buttons, is. per 100 ;
stopt
diapason pipes, CC to G in alt, 56 pipes,
all wood, voiced, 8 15s. per set ; the
metal treble (stopt diapason), 30 pipes,
about 2,
unvoiced.
Soap Making.
W. P. N. (Darlington).Yon had bet-
ter try the "cold process" described in
the second paper.
Dyeing Sheepskin.
J.
H. W. (
Warrington). You will do
better to send your sheepskin to the dyer.
The writer who proposed to deal with
"picture-frame making" has disap-
pointed us.
Amateur Dentistry.
I believe in every man doing all he
can for himself, or I should not regularly
take and read Amateur Work, Illus-
trated. Therefore, as a dentist, I reply
to "A Paper Stainer." First, can he
work with a blow-pipe with hard solder?
if so, let him try his luck. Process, as
briefly as I can put it is this. Get as
exact a copy of the mouth as is possible.
Do this by putting into the mouth a
softened piece of bee'swax, or any pre-
pared compo
"A COMBINED POULTRY and PIGEON HOUSE," "A STORM GLASS, or HYGROMETER,"
"WALKING STICKS and HOW TO MAKE THEM," Etc., Etc.
Every Article that is capable of Illustration will be
PROFUSELY ILLUSTRATED BY SKETCHES AND DIAGRAMS;
in most instances from the pencil of the Writer of the Paper.
In addition to the above, the following Series
of Papers, commenced in Volume I., will be continued and
brought to a conclusion
:
Exeter
Flying Post.
"It is just the book that boys want, and that
they will greedily devour, acquiring valuable in-
formation while thinking they are only having a
grand treat."
The Graphic.
"
We know of nothing in the
and valuable as these sketches."
Christian Age.
London: WARD, LOCK & CO., Salisbury Square, E.C.
New York: lO, Bond Street.
Royal Svo, price 7s. 6d. per Volume, cloth gilt.
WARD & LOCK'S
nive
OR, SELF-CULTURE FOR ALL.
THE BEST
AND
MOST COMPLETE
GUIDE
TO
LEARNING
AND
SELF-EDUCATION.
FORMING
A
PERFECT
SYSTEM
OF
INTELLECTUAL
CULTURE.
The Planets.
The Work will be Completed in Three Volumes, and will contain
ABOUT 2,000 ILLUSTRATIONS,
VOLUMES 1 and 2 NOW READY.
"
We are quite sure that any person who could really master the contents of this one
volume (Volume I.) would be one of the most accomplished men of his generation."
MODERN.
Volume I. Just Ready.
Royal 8vo, 900
pp.
'
Cloth gilt, price 7s. 6d.
^
i
$
&
/V*V
The object
of
this Work
is to present the course
of
the History of the World
with sufficient completeness
to give the reader a Clear
understanding- of the
various epochs, their
relation to each other,
To be Completed in
Two Volumes,
Price 7s. 6d. each.
Jr)
Menelaus, King of Sparta.
their value, import-
ance, and especially the
influence of various
nations and periods
upon each other. The
Illustrations are many,
and are both attractive
and accurate.
A COMPLETE WORK ON HOUSEHOLD MEDICINE, Sv.
Royal 8vo, 800
pp.,
cloth gilt, price 7s. 6d.
HOUSEHOLD MEDICINE.
A GUIDE TO GOOD HEALTH, LONG LIFE, AND THE PROPER
TREATMENT OF ALL DISEASES AND AILMENTS.
FULLY AND ACCURATELY ILLUSTRATED.
Founded on ^5
""
the Works of
Graham, Reece,
r- -
. - - -.^tt-
.
crrC^-
*
Tn (
^^-h^-^-^-^y
h'fj-'
'%i\f
Cheyne,
L^il
Paris,
Hunter, &c.
Edited by
GEORGE BLACK,
M.B. Edin.,
Author of
"
Sick Nursing," &c.
Apparatus employed in the Reduction of Dislocation of the Thumb.
The Contributors to Ward and Lock's Household Medicine occupy the
first rank in the profession, and the work may be consulted with every
confidence. The style is clear, and such language has been chosen as will
be most readily understood by readers unacquainted with medical terms.
The Illustrations, numbering about 450, are accurate and simple.
WARD, LOCK & CO., Salisbury Square, London, E.C
New York: IO, Bond Street.
jggj
Jpi^^M
.
:#
^
B^^^^^^^^^^^^^^s Hjfjjff*
-"
^
H53
H Itillfl
"^3
LI 1
19
Hot Springs in the Waikato Valley.
ONE OF THE MOST INSTRUCTIVE AND BEAUTIFUL
GIFT BOOKS EVER PRODUCED.
Royal 8vo, 800
pp.,
cloth gilt, price 7s. 6d.
LAND, SEA & SKY;
or, iUContrcrs of Htfe antr
Ifcature.
A DESCRIPTION OF THE PHYSICAL GEOGRAPHY AND
ORGANIC LIFE OF THE WORLD.
Translated from the German of Dr. Kerman,
J.
Klein and Dr. Thome', by
J.
MlNSHULE.
JbaitiifaHij jpfosfrntea
WITH THREE HUNDRED ORIGINAL ENGRAVINGS.
Land, Sea and Sky is a work specially intended to increase our acquaintance with
the Wonders revealed by the investigations
of
Science, and intensify our admiration
of
the marvellous beauty
of
Nature. The Writers are assisted by the Artists, and the
ILLUSTRATIONS, at once faithful to Nature and picturesque, add greatly to the
interest and value
of
the work.
Land, Sea and Sky is offered to the Student
of
Nature as a guide to the
understanding of phenomena ; to the lover
of
the picturesque it appeals by the
beauty and number of its illustrations ; to the adventurous, as revealing
wonders previously but dimly recognized, in many cases unknown; and to all
as a carefully-prepared work of the greatest interest.
In the lev Seas.
London : WARD, LOCK & CO., Salisbury Square, E.C.
New^York: IO, Bond Street.
'
THE BEST COOKERY BOOK
IN THE WORLD.
349th Thousand.
Crown 8vo, half-roan. 7s. 6d. ; cloth gilt, gilt edges, 8s. 6d. ; half-calf, 10s. 6d.
MRS. BEETON'S BOOK OF
HOUSEHOLD MANAGEMENT.
CONTAINING
1,300 PAGES, 4,000 RECIPES AND INSTRUCTIONS,
1,000 ENGRAVINGS & COLOURED PLATES.
WITH
Duties of the Mistress, Housekeeper, and all kinds of Servants ; Directions for
Carving, Legal Memoranda, the Rearing and Management of Children, &e.
"
A volume which will be, for many years to come, a treasure to be made much of
in every English household."
The Standard.
Large crown 8vo, half-roan, 7s. 6d. ; half-calf, 10s. 6d., Ward & Lock's
HOME BOOK : A Domestic Cyclopedia.
WITH
COLOURED
PLATES
AND
600 WOOD
ENGRAVINGS.
Medium Svo, cloth gilt, price 6s.
WARD & LOCK'S THRIFT BOOK.
CYCLOPEDIA OF COTTAGE MANAGEMENT
PRACTICAL ECONOMY FOR THE PEOPLE.
WITH 350 ILLUSTRATION
A book for all who wish thoroughly
to master Household Economy, and to
Icam how comfort and indepen-
dence can be enjoyed v/ith mode-
rate means. To all who wish to
thrive this book is addressed, with the
view of
aiding them at every step, and
of
proving a welcome and handy Com-
panion and Counsellor in all the
varied occupations involved in the
idea of Keeping House.
AND
s.
London: WARD, LOC.C & CO., Salisbury Square, E.C.
New York : 10, Bond Street.
I
Companion Volume to
"
MRS. BEETON'S BOOK of HOUSEHOLD MANAGEMENT."
"In the one thousand and fifty-six pages in this marvellous
'
Home Book' there is
not one worthless or unnecessary item, not one article we would ever wish to
forget."